~e-4 oT ees SB fet - Oe Py = -2 6-8 §~ HES re reer rere yi Li =~ Hawt ws <2 Me Sh deh deta Oak 6 oO tne 2". * 2 e-«-% 7% - ae oe % ~f- 8 90d baw Lae = 4 SO bes ah -G ae RSE he 6 aH DRE WH OF e=%- Ve Gek or pe es -~ ev Somat ae Berane A Attn © &-3- = 2 ea —2 8. eS Meta OB O> &b- Be o's e-r idee oaseces . Eee et ee ee —— —P- 8 ~ 9-Pne~9-F e oS o& oe Rodwt ee et ee wR- Qo wG Re hw t Oo Rnd hued D = 3-3-9 > i an wee Dew 2+? 4-2. 4% 0-2-3 a eo te er pee hee By o oF. 6-t 2. —t- 9 ee “ Se eek ee t—ben 9 Nene ea -~3-¢ —— 9 8 Fe e- we ee F—e~* om tel ~ > cen Po E808 OR OVE V8 Oe Ria Arde 6 t-o- 8-8 Os crue werten ree 30905050 8g Saar: mF EAP PE The eh te A lta es =F OG OR AL Bal OHH a Rar OSE ete R KEN eK e~ Hoe WER $F a8 he Fo Pew ~ rt ees Pee wa =v oS Behe welak * ll Al ~#-@ O-9 wee Owl ee mE SONaT © % SoPae owe ~t toe Sx @ e-em er awent ts Go 8 bak 0 -¥ 6-0 os pe Oy Chm Me Shes - oe a ee +ze- 6-6 fo le ey 49 am ot Oo =8 ro id Pas ‘ es —— S28 5-5-3. etn 4 5 e Bk at oF Pe oS a Bet ~ 6-48.03 Pota tet Ba inten ers we oa ha Gas” ed ee crcetatecae. bake ee wh wee > - : : ees ~eWt~ . 4 - “7 O.) whe et wOe a _.* . —w-t-€- e- ore ee ere ee ee eet ry pated eG ert ate e vente ~* ~e eee 73 —S = - ee ee ee ee ee .-< >. =. > ert etia-g @-% nape ea toe ta eed vie? tee ess. eo a rd Rete DT +8~e ~ Ow teV mts Care Oe On: ee eee ie far ie rte ie ok eee oo eee i ae hoes ee ee 2a ~* =< wel te Gd — ele - Sek - © Set hake et ore Po eee Se ee ee eee Pee le =8- Pan ew 6-9 Petetade eerie pe) Osta OoOee ee ee ee eee rere aa os SO .w © au Pe ee ee ed -%-8 5-i-e cO-e~ enaieiae ai eysi ete + 41>, 4 ue -42.8—8 858-058 -9 : : Sar : ~s-i—s aicices news shcagecetest= teen ° i rt 7.3 . : 3 . ® 3 ° - 20) - ‘ Lt ofet=t= ¢ : : : _ : . he = - : Ht wht 6 35! Smiter hotodobe +4 ‘ : : 3 : = - - - bes “Oe ~ - - -'~ “ft - ? - oF . ot ‘ : - t- - ote le ° = - . - = Gobet ga ‘ - t- > - a. wéet ps . eotne Poa ee a Ly OF THE ASIATIC SOCIETY OF BENGAL. VOL. XXXV. PART I. Nos. I. ro 1V.—1866. EDITED BY THE PHILOLOGICAL SECRETARY. “Tt will flourish, if naturalists, chemists, antiquaries, philologers, and men of science in different parts of Asia, will commit their observations to writing, and send them to the Asiatic Baripty at Calcutta. Tt will languish, if such CALCUTTA : PRINTED BY J. WENGER, BAPTIST MISSION PRESS. 1867, CONTENTS. EG eur No. I. (Published 15th June, 1866.) Outlines of a Plea for the Arabic Element in Official Hindustani. —By J. Beames, Esq., C.S., A Translation of the Chapter on Ordeals, from the Vyavahara Mayukha.—By Professor Grorer Biucer, Elphinstone College, Bombay, Rough Notes on some of the Antiquities i in the Hie District. By W. Peprrx, Esq., — re : Reiary Intelligence, re des am SA ae No. II. (Published 31st August, 1866.) Descriptions of Ancient Remains of Buddhist Monasteries and Temples, and of other buildings, recently discovered in Benares, and its vicinity.—By the Rev. M. A. Suerrina, Tad. B,, and Cuartes Horne, Esq., C. §., Assyro-Pseudo- Sesostris.—By Hype CLARKE, "Esq. “Member of the German Oriental Society, of the Society ‘of Northern Antiquaries of Copenhagen, of the Academy of Anatolia, of the Institution of Engineers of Vienna, Local Secretary of the Anthropological Society, ; Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir , especially those not described by General A. CunninaHam in his Essay publish- ed in the Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal for September, 1848.—By W. G. Cowrn, Esq., M. A., Chaplain on duty in Kashmir during the summer of 1865, Remarks on Barbier de Meynard’s edition of Ibn Khord4dbeh and on the Land-tax of the aes of the Teta Se Dr. A. SPRENGER, es soe Literary Intelligence, ae ose ae ons No. III. (Published 2nd November, 1866.) A Notice of the Gaunaka Smriti—By Professor Grorex Bunter, Superintendent of Sanskrit Studies, Punah College, or eet ns “3: 14 49 60 61 87 91 124 147 149 iV Index. Notes on Atranji Khera or Pi-lo-shan-na of General Cun- NINGHAM, (vide Continuation of Report for 1862-63, No. VIIL page 15.)—By C. Horns, Esq. C. S., Notes on some Buddhist Ruins at Doob Koond. —By Captain W. R. Metvitte, in charge, Gwalior Survey, ... Some Objections to ‘the Modern Style of Official Hindustani.— By F. 8. Growsz, Esq , M. A. Oxon, B.C. S., Description of the Chandrarekh4garh near Sashtani, " Per- gunnah oem Zillah MPGDEROES —By W. J. Huerscuzt, Ksq., B. C. 8S Notes on a Tourin Manbhoom, in 1864- 65. —By Lt.-Col. E. T. Dauton, Comr, of Chota- Nagpore, Notes on a Copper plate- Inscription from Sambhalpur. —By Ba’su RAsenprasta Mirra, vee sos . Literary Intelligence, _.., ps sp aa Nor Pye 5 | (Published 6th July, 2. .., Notes on the History and Topography of the Ancient Cities of Delhi.—By C. J. Campsett, Hsq., C. E., Notes on Pilgrimages in the Countr y of Cashmere. —By Major D. ¥. Newatt, R, A., A. Vocabulary of English, Balti and Kashmiri, compiled by H. H. Gopwiy Austen, Capt., H. M.’s 24th "Regt. Assist. Gt. Trigl. Survey, Notes on Gupta Inser ADORE, from meee ‘and Behar. By Babu RaAsENPRALALA MitRa,. sae Literary Intelligence, She vee eos eve SSIS LILA Page 165 168 172 181 186 195 197 . 199 219 233 268 275 LIST OF PLATES. Pillared portico at Nair, Stone figure at Genjun, Rough Section and Plan of the Koch temple, Oomga temple, za Rough Plan of Tilia N ala Vihar Ch: aitya, oon Buddhist Vihar in the Rajghat Fort,—ceiling, ... View of Buddhist Vihar in the Rajehat Fort, 5 Buddhist Vihar in the Sy eee Fort, —details of Pillars, ‘-‘h “ne Bhanyar "Temple, Colonnade,.. Temple at Lidar, Buddhist Chaitya (ceiling a Rough Plan of Atranji Khera, Conch Temple, _... : Roof of Pandrethan, - Temple in the lake at Manusbal, Figure of Sesostris at Ninfi, Hindu Temple at Chandrarekhagarh, Plan of the Masjid Kutb ul Islam, Hlevation and details of ditto, Map of the sites of the old cities of Delhi, Facsimiles of Inscriptions on a stone pillar i in the Behar Fort, Sy aa ves RI IN NII INDEX TO PART I. Achulpow, on the Kallee Nudee, visit to, ; AcvaLA’YANA, many passages of the Caunaka Kariké ‘agree with the sutras of, , sae: Adampur Mahalla, ancient mounds in n the, Adi Bishweshwara, description of, Adilabad, fort of, : ts Aprtyas, names of the twelve, ADITYA Suna, Adoption, Caunaka’ s Law of, Adultery and theft, ordeals in cases ‘of, Ain-i-Akbar Ys extract from the, Alai Durwaza built by Ala Udin, Axa’ Upin, description of the site of the entrenchment of, Ata’ Upin’s extensive improvements of the Kutb Ul Islam, on Autamsu’s tomb, peculiarities in, Atyy Hasany’s account of weights, Amarnath, pilgrimage to,. Ananpa Swa'Mt, author of S’aiva sudhdkara, Aphsar and Behar Inscriptions, Notes on, ... oP Arabic Element in Official Hindustani, a "Plea for the, Arabic used in the language of law-courts of India, Arhéi Kangura mosque, description of the, A'soxa’s pillars, Lat Bhairo one of, Aureus of Constantinople, Standard of Musulman weights, AURANGZEBE destroyed the temple where Lat Bhairo stood, AURANGZEBE’S mosque near Bishweshwara temple, Austen, Capt. H. H.G., Vocabulary of English, Balti and Kashwniri, aes Avantiswémi temple, description of the, . om Avantiswaémi, pillars at, Bala and Vriddha, defined, Battis Khambha, description ie Buames, J., Hsq., Outlines of a Plea for the Arabic Element in Official Hindustani, Bela, ruins near, eee eee een eGo Vil Index. Benares, absurdity of deriving the word from Burna and Assi, ———-——. antiquity of, — certain Annals of, : extent of the city of, ne Bhagavati sutra of the Jains, "Dr. Weber's Essay on, Bhaniyar temple, description ‘of the, Bhaumajo temple, description of the, Bina’rt Das, author of the Satsaiy4, Bona Durra, founder of the Boonyar temple, Bondr Rasa, "founder of Rajghaut fort, Budaon Mahalld, small mosque in the, as Buddhist Chaityas, at Rajaghat, ... origin of Lat Bhairo and Battis Khambhé, ——— Vihar, Rajghat, and cloisters altered by Mahomedans, * Buutzr, Professor G., Translation of the Se on Ordeals from the Vyavahara M ayukha, : Notice of the Caunaka Smr iti, Burabur Hills, figures removed to Newree from the, Burna, the boundary of Benares, es Caiva sfidhékar of Ananda Swami, aE Campsett, C. J. Topography of the ancient cities of Delhi, es Canja, a system of Musulman weights, Ca’nta Varma’, ste ae Gee Caunaka Smriti, Contents of the, af re 151, Cantis peculiar to the, : cea. aes more extensive than a Grihyasutra, Laghu and Brihat, Genuineness of the first three verses of the, doubted, . ’ Caunaka Katka written by. a Vaishnava, ean Chaityas at Rajghat, description of the Buddhist, coe Cuanp, the bard of the last Hindu King of Delhi,. Cuanprak, sent Umr Sing and Beja Sing to the Doob Koond temple, ... ae CHANDRA RAJA’, ae of phe Chane ‘Garh, Chandrarekha Gar h, measurements of the, Cuaucer, ridiculed for French words, ved Choukhambha mosque, description of the, aes Chullandaraka, gift of the village of, es Churra, Devélayas at, CrarKke, Hsq. H. E., On Assyro- Pseudo- Sesostris,.. Cloisters of Buddhist Vihars altered by the Mahomedans, Court-language of the Bengal Presidency unintelligible because it is highly cultivated, iis 5at oa bs ERE Ee heterogeneous origin of the, os gee Cowin, Rev. G. W., On the Temples of Kashmir,... Fae ! , z | 7 : Index. Coins, silver Hindu, found at the Atranji Khera, Cossai, banks of the, colonized by the Srawaks, Court-language, convenience of the, _ Cubic measure, Qafyz, .. Darton, Lieut.-Col. BE. Pi, ‘Tour in Maunbhoom, Démopara fought with the Hunas, Dattaka Miménsa quotes clokas from Caunaka, Delhi at the time of Timur, ——,, chronology of the different, cities of, rs ate , Various cities of, ave va 214 et Deokund, ruins near, Dhulmi, ‘antiquities of, Droporvs Sicunvs, account of Sesostris by, Doob koond, repaired by Pandu and his brothers, Drubgama temple, description of the, ; Durjankari-panchanana of Rangachari Swami, Dyamun, description of temples at, ... Egyptian measure, the Irdabb, English language, foreign elements in the, Hunuchs, how to be judged, Fire, ordeals by, Firuzdbdd, city of, Futtehgurh, description of the temple at, My “eh Garbhalambhana, rules of, given in the Gaunaka Smriti and the Rig Veda Grihya sutra, Gaya, antiquities of, . ak Genjun, ruins near, Geography of Ibn Khordabeh, Growsr F. §., Hsq., Objections ‘to the modern style of official 205 eee Hindustani, Gulzar Hahaila, Maqdum sahib in the, ; GUPTAS, probable connexion of the, w ith Lat Bhairo, of Aphsar, — of Bhitari ruled in Behar, Hariri and Muhammad, languages of, Hasuxa Gupra, Hellenes observed Iberian Mythology, Heroportvs’s account of the expedition of Sesostris, Herscuzt, W. J., Esq., Chandra-rekha-garh,. Himyaritic dialects spoken by troops of Yaman, Hindi current in Akbar’s Court, — and foreign words compared, ‘ee — different kinds of, Hindustani benefited more by Semitic than ‘by Indian ele- ments, eee eee cee 3 official, Se 3 oh opesdx’ s notice of the affinity between the Caucasian and the | Himalayan Valleys, ee eae . tee x Index, Page Horn, C., Esq., Atranji Khera or Pilushanna, 2h ec 165 —_— Buddhist remains in Benares, ... Shak 61 Isn Batutd’s travels, translation of, gies ebpiged - ohh Inn KuorpaBeEH, MSS. of, Be mo LG Inscription, copper- plate, from Sambalpur, ‘translation Ole. ADE — on Alamgir’s Masjid, a om 77 Inscriptions, Major Dixon’s Sanscrit and Canarese, + selec 60 —— -——— from Aphsar, ee wis aie ok WAFS = 9. Sekar: tk sha ite site: E+ Jahanpanah, Citadel of, ‘ga a “vs sus LS Jain origin of the Bishweshwar me a wit ott 81 JIVITA Gupta, a nee vovitiias. 268 QopaMma’s account of the Sayad revenue, bs ron SG Karika, the original work of Gaunaka, a air ey hed Kasuyapa, the “< Ocean” desiccated D5) bias Sad raced KArvdvana, works of Gaunaka known to, ... series! 0 4D Kausika Gotra, Brahmans of the, we ik edith eh OG Kavya Prakas’a of Mahesa Chandra, Pe coenine, aes) AE Kirta Bisheshwar temple and Alamgir mosque, oe bis 77 Kispa, ruins near, =o 4 ie ie te 52 Kohil, temple at, ... ee “a8 ee gray REG Konch, ruins near, ae cee ose wae fed 53 Kona Devi’, as ae. a eg sae (268 Krisona Gupta, ee an e fo a Kuma’ra Gupta, ek ae wits viel Bo Kunamoh, temples at, a mA ate Seat, nea Kutb Minar, description of, ae ais SE Kutb Minar ascribed to Ananga Pal, 9 3 wh jh ember OE Kutb ul Islam, description of, . wad aig a ee Lalkote, description Oly at, “cue igh = o-niet agate 4M MID Lall Mahal, remains of, . me 217 Language of the Arabs ‘corrupted by Mahomedan conquest, i. 9 Lanka, description of tempie on the island of, ... 111 et seq. Lat Bhairo Buddhist Vihar, oth rr ScitaneE. 73 —_-—— Mahomedan Cemetry, i re Bie 74 LIndar, temples at, stelle 97 Lingam, measurement of the, at t Atranji Khera, & ee] Oe (RE Lomasa Rishi, cave of, ... ae te ince GORE 51 MapHava Gupra, are eed baie = vas 268 Maha Devi, .... dive site edt pba GR Mana Supee Rasa’s grant of land, rus nthe gage eS Maud Sena Gureta, save i sou gal ~~ 268 Ménava Dharmas’Astra notices Caunaka, ae dn RHE 49 Manasbal, description of the temples of,.. vai AO aanebaegs Magdum Sahsb, remains of Buddhist chaitya at, iene 71 Martand, description of the middle chamber in, ... sos - 218 pillars at, compared with those of Bhaumajo, ale 93 Maruts, names of the seven, ... a wid Veal 31 — Index. xl Page Matris, names of the seven, ... ce ee aie 3 Masha, ordeals by hot, ... a ae belitrcnes 45 Maushari, site of, not "determined, wan 208 Menviie, Capt. W. R, Buddhist ruins of Doob Khund, dani OS Mrra Sauep’s tomb near Tilia N ala, sei ee 71 Mithqal weights, ... 5 af =i). vine (426 Mogqaddasy, editor of, ... oes sigs jah ee Months suited for ordeals in gener aie se 17 Nagari characters abandoned on the adoption of Persian dialect, 177 Nair, ruins near, ... ie ve 50 Narain Suan, description of the temple of, we unt awe skees Newa t, Major D. F., Pilgrimages in Kashmir, AK h ieee eRe Newree, ‘figures near the village Of, . as sme 49 Nigumbode, temple of, ... ; ‘ae ee eer Nirnaya-sindhu alludes to Caunaka, j se REG Nowg1, Sri Buddha and Chinamusta, temples dedicated BB yctxcase oe Lote Oaths may be administered to both parties in an ordeal, .... 16 Offerings, burnt, in ordeals, _— gat) awe 33 Omar I. sent Othman to survey Babylonia, seb ie ws Oomga temple, description of the, ... 58 Ordeals, papers on, by Ali Tbrahim Khan, Professor Stenzler and Mr. Macnaghten, 14 to be applied where human evidence fails, ae 1 (Lae S 14 immediate and mediate, ... ace atts 14 invocation common to all, ane ans oo. 20, 22 Pacheta, Raja of, Ga ane siandhi\seana. ( LOM Padinapore, pilgrimage of, — te eae ey: | Palee, ruins near, ee ee 50 Pandit, (the) a monthly journal started at Benares, aus a hbet Pandrethan, description Of, . ... . one ons das, ALS pilgrimage to, nae Peart ee: — Lidar temple copy of that at, Bi ~~ 99 Panjabi Dictionary examined, She dati, oyslte Péathin Sugandhegwara, description of temples at, . fata (ELS Payach and Lidar drains compared... P cou ee 98 Peppn, W. Esq. Antiquities of Gya, vr sis 49 Persian, the effects of the abolition of, in law- courts, Mii coal gee Ploughshare, ordeals by, oes dade fe ive AT Poison, ordeals by, we ees <4 se » a 43 Premsagtir, the language of, ... sAaliaRverwigds: winch he PRINsEP’s ground plan of the Bisheshar temple, di oe. 81 Putra Sangraha vidhi, text and translation of the, Kicidaen ) AY Ra/sENDRALA’LA Mirra, Babu, Shambhalpur Inscription, be vealOS —— Gupta Inscriptions from ame and Behar, ... ‘ee vids he 261 Rajghat fort, key of Benares, ba xa pty 64 Ramayana’ 8 aecudad of the Kols, #3 Sed 193 et seq. Ranga’ cna’ rt Swa’ mi, author of Durjana Kari Panchanana,... 147 Xll Index. Rig Veda, Mantras quoted in the Gaunaka Karika from the, . 154 Ritter doubted the Egyptian character of the monument of Sesostris, a ts ues ae 88 Rudras, name of the eleven, 31 Sabhabilisa, the only Persian word in the, i is the name of the writer, sats wae BS eee ane Sambhalpur and Sarabhapura, identity of, ie oon 6 (398 Sanaka taldo, stone pillars at, iE. 84 SANKARA GAURESWARA, description of temple at, se. Ho 4S Sankshepa Sankara Jaya, edition of, 195 Sanscrit, Greek, German, Latin, and English words compared, . 5 Sanscrit manuscripts of the Royal Asiatic Society, ae oy 60 Sarabhapura, conquered by Maha Sudeva raja, __... nae OS Sarap, Serab, Serak, or Srawak, earliest Aryan colonists, ... 186 Sarnath encompassed by Benares, ro 63 Sarvéntkramani, an account of the writers ‘of the Rig Veda Caunaka, fs y gay | ESD Sasanian king J obad, revenue of the Sawd4d under him, ea Se Sawad, revenue of the, according to Qodama, wv » DSGY > eb eeg. Scales, ordeals by, suited to women, ... in Si 16 — ordeals of, directions for, ... Bi 23 ~—s et: seq. Seasons for special ordeals, ... ee we ys Semitic language, endogenous character of ‘the, sao ee 4 SESOSTRIS, images of, En A= = 88 ———— monument of, near Ninf, oe fee, 87 Shahjehanabad, city of, ae bate or pee) SS Shahpur, fort of, ab bo | VE Shahpur ruins, age of the, determined, a Hf ce aS SHERRING, Rev. J, Buddhist remains at Benares, | me 61 Silver standard in Persia, ac ae oe ee 8 Scrr, description of, : dager, 62206 Son, an only, not to be given away ¢ or r adopted, i 163 SPRENGER, Dr. A., Ibn Khordabeb and land-tax of the Khalyis, Lx ee Square measure of the Arabs not much known, ef Re Srawaka settlements broken up by Hos and Lurka Coles, <42..° 86 Suxsuma Siva, ... a ree. woo theo Takt-0- -Sulimani, description of, #5 is eee ED Tapoban, Rama, ‘halted at, ae, Bace sat ER Tp Tewan, description of a temple at, wi Ne ieee ki! Timira Nasaka of Babu Siva Prasad, +e Os Ae) Trendaraka, Savabhapura in the district of, or ety SS 0) TULSI Dasa, ft we : 2 epee Deel Tourauar Krran’s invasion ‘discussed, _ “He EP He aie, Urdu authors, age of the, 2 , ae 74. Urdu compared with languages of modern ‘Europe, + fig ee 1 Urdu and Hindi, distinction between, not recognised, veer TO Vadivivadabhanjana, edition of, ... a ae ee oe Index, Vapya eaves, boulders close by, as his ey Viwrama'pityA, the raj of Pat Kote claims descent from, ... VIsHNU, Avatars of, ar ote) pou. Vyavahara mayukha permits a widow to adopt a son, - authorities quoted in the, ... 15 Wangat, description of the temples at, ... at 10 Water, ordeals by, Ps she eee Weights and measures of the Arabs, remarks on, 125 Weights, grain, of different kinds, among the Mussulmans, Widow, the right of a Hindu, to adopt a son,. i Ya’sNAVALKYA’s vyavasthé for heavy accusations, owe Yoga Aphorisms, Mr. Cowell’s edition of hacker i ves LDV VOVUPPOPVYPPPPQIPOPPPIYOIVYIOIIPIFFVUUYULUIVVU™ re Re af 26 | iA ty ao) ee ae | « a Sep As Rat tes me Re ame * ne ae Ls JOURNAL OF THE SeplATIC.. SOCIETY. gi Part L—HISTORY, LITERATURE, &. No. I.—1866. —_—~ Outlines of a Plea for the Arabic Element in Official Hindustant,—By J. Beames, Esq., C. 8. [Received 17th April, 1865. ] It is the fashion at present to lavish a good deal of abuse on the language generally employed in our law courts in this country. This unfortunate variety of human speech is condemned as_barbar- ous, a medley of heterogeneous elements, a pedantic, clumsy, unintelli- gible jargon, and the rest. After seven years’ daily experience and use of it, I venture to take up the cudgels in its behalf. I consider it as the most progressive and civilized form of the great and widespread ‘language of the horde.’’ Not only is it compendious, eloquent, ex- pressive and copious, but it is the only form in which the legitimate development of the speech of the Gangetic tribes could show itself. Those who condemn it, in a spirit of short-sighted pedantry and affec- tation, must, if they are prepared to abide by the logical consequences of their opinion, condemn also those languages of modern Kurope, which, by virtue of following the same course as the Urdt, have suc- ceeded in overstepping the narrow limits of their birth-places, and becoming the common property of half the world. To object to the | free use in Hindustani of words derived from Arabic and Persian, is as absurd as to object to, the free use of Latin and Greek derivatives in English. As a merchant, by skilful trading with borrowed capital, 1 2 The Arabic Element in Official Hindustani. [No. 1, may become a millionaire, so English by readily borrowing and mak- ing good use of its borrowed stores, has raised itself from an obscure low German patois to the most extensively used medium of commu- nication between distant countries. I. The parallel between English with its Teutonic and Latin elements, and Urdi with its Sanskrit and Semitic components, is no newly dis- covered thing. It has been used again and again, with more or less learning, to help us to deplore the iniquities of our omla and mukhtdrs. The comparison, however, cuts both ways. It may perhaps help us to find something to admire in the phraseology of a rubakdri or the cunningly woven sentences of a pleading. First then, of English. English is a dialect, as every one knows, of Plate-Deutsch, allied to the Hoch-Deutsch, the tongue of Géethe and Schiller, by the ties of a common descent from the early Gothic, the sister of Sanskrit. It has been brought into contact with many other forms of speech, some closely, others remotely, akin to it. Celtic of Scotland and Wales; Scandinavian of Norway and Denmark; Latin; Norman French, a blending of the two last named; early French, the Frankish struggling still against the Latin element; Latin again, barbarized by monks and lawyers; French again, from the wars of the Henries and Edwards; Spanish, from the Elizabethan wars, bring- ing with it a substratum of Moorish Arabic; French again, of Racine and Moliere in the days of the degraded Stuart kings, from the court of the “ Grand Monarque;”’ Dutch with William of “glorious, pious and immortal memory;”’ finally a sprinkling of Turkish, Persian and Russian from our travellers, and many words from Latin which crept in in a roundabout way from time to time through our neighbours the French avid Italians. ) All these elements skilfully worked up, patiently pieced together, carefully incorporated into the solid Knglish groundwork, have com- posed the bright, varied and harmonious mosaic of our modern mother- tongue. There were doubtless pedants and grumblers ready to find fault at each stage of growth in English. The Saxon clod of the time of the Conqueror objected to the terms ‘beef,’ ‘veal,’ ‘ pork,’ ‘mutton,’ which were then supplanting his pure English ‘ox,’ ‘ calf,’ ‘ pig’ and 1866. ] The Arabic Element in Official Hindustan. 3 ‘sheep.’ Chaucer’s introduction of French words into his poems won for him the ridicule of his contemporaries. But in spite of ridicule and learned objectors, the language assimilated these foreign words and profited by the process. The German on the other hand has absorbed very little of the Latin or other foreign elements. It has endeavoured to meet the wants of civilization and progress by combinations of indigenous words, rather than by borrowing: In other words it has done what our purists wish the Hindustani to do. The result is known to every one. Great as are the expressiveness and power of composition of the German language, its usefulness as a practical, working, every-day speech is far below that of English or any other European language. We have only, for instance, to compare a few German words with their English equivalents to see where lies the flexibility, expression, and delicacy of sentiment. “ Gefangenschaft” (literally ‘catch-hold-ship’) would scarcely be felt as an advantageous change for ‘custody.’ Use might reconcile us to “* Begripship,” but ‘ custody’ means more than mere holding fast. Vergnuegsam (‘ For-enough-some’) is but a barbarous substitute for “contented,” which latter gives us the idea of being contained and se- cure in certain limits;—while the former is a barren enunciation of merely having enough. Not to mention the unpleasantly harsh colli- sion of consonants. Verurtheilung, sentence. Here the English word is far the more manageable than the clumsy circumlocution of “ fore-out-telling” or * parting.” Vervollkommen. ‘To complete” is again better than ‘ To fore- full-come.” Wiederaufleben, revival, ‘das wiederaufleben der Gelehrsamkeit (the again-up-living of be-lore-some-hood) is rather a roundabout substitute for the neat and concise English, ‘‘the revival of learning.’’ | Wiederherstellungsmittel. Here is a nice morsel for throat and teeth. It looks very alarming, but only means ‘a restorative,” and the English word gives the meaning quite as fully as the monstrous Ger- man compound. Wieder = re ; herstellung = stor (stauz) ’s; mittel = ative. Zusammenberufen, to convoke. 4 The Arabic Element in Official Hiudustant. [No. 1, Zuriickziehen, to retract, withdraw; ‘‘ withdraw’ is formed from our own Teutonic stores. The fact is that in making compound words, the English has the advantage of using the short and expressive Latin prefixes, pro, re, con, per, im; whereas the German, rejecting these commodious foreigners, has to fall back on the unwieldy natives; Wieder, zusam- men, zurtick, wider, heraus, &c. The result is that its compounds are of uncomfortable length, and are rather circumlocutions than direct expressions of the idea involved. Turning now to Hindustani for Teutonic, let us put Indian as ex- pressing the class of languages from which the old Hindi Bhashas are derived and for Latin or Romance let us put Semitic. Then the pro- position I would maintain stands thus: The Hindustani language meets the requirements of civilization better by borrowing freely from Semitic sources than by forming words and compounds from Indian sources. To borrow a metaphor from Botany, the Semitic languages are en- dogenous, the Indo-Germanic exogenous. The former grow by addi- tions from within, the latter by accretions from without. Accretions, it is evident, are limited solely by their power of adher- ing to the original trunk. Or perhaps it would be better to say accre- tions may be multiplied up to the sustaining limit of the parent stem. Endogenous growth on the other hand is limited by the space it can squeeze out for itself in the enczente of the older formations. With a strong parent stem like German or Sanskrit, accretive compounds may be formed almost without limit. Sanskrit thinks nothing of a twenty- syllabled compound, and a word like ‘ herausbekommen’ is as nothing to German organs. In Arabic, and Hebrew, on the contrary there is the triliteral root, which may be made to evolve many dozens of new words, but all within the limits of the three radical letters aided by a handful of serviles. The result is that the Semitic languages can ex- press more in a small compass than the Indo-Germanic can, A pre- fixed alif or mem will often have as much power as ‘ con’ ‘ pro’ ‘ re? or half a dozen Latin or Greek words strung together; thus eon nazara to see, the simple lengthening of a vowel gives us “ nazir,’ a word, the technical and ordinary meaning of which, cannot be ex- pressed in any Indo-Germanic language without a compound. e. g. 1866. ] The Arabic Element in Official Hindustant. 5 1. Sanskrit, Adhyaksha. . Upadrishta. Adhikdri. Avekshitd, all compounded with a preposition. Greek, Epistatés. Latin, Inspector. German, Awfseher, Inspektor. 5. English, Overseer, Inspector. Illustrations may be multiplied by any one who possesses a few dic- tionaries. To be able to express ideas of a complex nature by short and simple words is an undeniable advantage. When a language has two or more sources from which it can draw, native sources giving it only long cumbrous compounds, foreign ones giving it neat and conve- nient uncompounded words, it is only natural that the latter should be chosen. The Bengali, like the German, has chosen to trust to its Indian resources; and the result is a collection of ‘ sesquipedalia verba”’ of the most alarming description, and what is more to the pur- pose in these practical days, it is yielding visibly to the more progres- sive Hindustani. j On the score of convenience then I defend the present court lan- guage. If we look at the historical question again, we find good rea- son for the use of foreign words. Hindi is in its origin Sanskrit, with a substratum of Turanian elements, the extent and exact direction of whose influence has never been fully worked out. I believe it to be much greater than is usually supposed. The language thus constitut- ed, was brought into contact with fresh Turanian influences through the Mogul invasions. In the same manner Persian, Pushtoo and Arabic were brought to bear-on it. The point of contact was western Hindustan and the Punjab, but gradually the foreign influence pene- trated the whole country. It must be remembered also, that along with an influx of foreign languages came an entire change in the civil and religious organization of the country. Whole provinces were converted to a religion whose most sacred duties can be expressed only in Arabic. Offices were created on the model of those in Cabul and Persia. Systems were introduced which had long flourished in Central Asia among the Mantchus and the Kirghis. Hence a large importation of foreign words in religion, government, re 6 The Arabic Element in Official Hindustant. [No. 1, arms and art, which ended in the establishment of the Urdd or camp language, a language destined advisedly for the palace, the court, the camp, the market. Its father the Hindi, its mother the Arabic, it borrows freely from both its parents. Up to this point most men will agree with me that the free use of Arabic and Persian is defensible both on the grounds of the origin of the language as well as of convenience, The two great accusations brought against the language, however, are ; first, that the Arabic and Persian words are used in an incorrect, garbled and distorted way, and secondly, that the language itself is unintelligible to the mass of the people. I proceed to discuss these objections a little more in detail. II. First, then it is asserted that the use of Arabic and Persian words in the way they are employed by native officials is mere pedan- try ; that the words are used in wrong’ senses and often utterly mis- applied, that participles are used as nouns, nouns as verbs and so on. Now this may mean either that munshi Arabic is incorrect according to the rules of grammar of the times of the Kuran; or that it is wrong according to the usages of the modern colloquial and written Arabic.— If the former of these two theories is advanced, I meet it by a simple and positive denial of its truth. A few examples may be taken as tests. Ashkhds. The Arabic shakhs, of which this is the legitimate and regular plural, means, literally separation, or the distinguishing of one thing from another; or more strictly, the act or condition of being separate and distinct. Shakhs is therefore the exact equivalent of the English word ‘‘ individual,” a word which is good modern English enough; and ashkhds, signifying the persons or individuals concerned in a lawsuit, is therefore a more accurate word than the Hindi log ; which really means, ‘‘ the world,’ or the collected body of human beings, and is quite out of place in designating a special class or num- ber of people. Mudda’i, from da’a, he called. (Freytag—vocavit, advocavit, provocavit,) is the regularly formed active participle of the 8th conjugation, and literally and exactly means a claimant or prosecutor; “‘ Arrogans vel sili vindicans rem contra aliquem ;” and is therefore a more expressive word than ‘badi,” , ¥ b 3 x 1866.] The Arabic Element in Oficial Hindustani. T which simply means a speaker ; or “ firiyadi” which, besides being a foreign word, means literally one who cries out, a weeper, lamenter ; which a plaintiff often is not. Mudda’é ’alayhi, literally ‘‘the complained against him,” or “he who is complained against ;’ being the passive participle of mudda’/, with the preposition and pronominal affix ’alayhi. Pratibdédi, “ he who speaks back again”’ is far less comprehensive. Hasbw ttafsilvlzayli, ‘‘ according to the specification below’’ is good and grammatical Arabic, and in its Persianized form “ hasb-z tafsil zayl’”’ gives a neat and convenient official formula for the roundabout Hindi “jaisé ki nichhe likhd hud har,’ which cannot be formed into a compound adjective or otherwise manipulated. ? Inkizd, “ completion,” is the regular verbal noun of the seventh conjugation of the verb kazdya the original meaning of which, as I have elsewhere shewn, is “‘ cutting off, finishing, defining, decreeing,” the word is used frequently in pure Arabic in the same sense. ’ is correct Bad inkizd-t mohlat, “after the expiry of the term,’ enough, and almost incapable of being tersely expressed in Hindi without recourse to some half obsolete word of Sanskrit origin. Bi muktazd ; according to; in the phrase, ‘‘ b¢ muktazd rat ’addlat,” “according to the opinion of the court,” the root kazdya in the eighth conjugation, has the sense of deciding. The expression bi muktaza, is used in Arabic authors as the equivalent of “ secundum” “ad.” I should be glad if some of our critics would express this phrase in modern Hindi in terms equally neat, and as generally intelligible. Inkishaf ; rstiswab ; intizdm ; ikbdl ; are further instances of words - which may be found in Arabic and Persian classics in the same sense as they bear in Hindustani. It is useless to multiply instances, were I to give half of the words used correctly by our Munshis I should have to write a volume, not an essay. To turn next to words which are used by Hindustani writers in a sense different from their classical usage, also words which are not found at all in the classics ; we find them tolerably numerous, and they form in fact the chief stumbling-blocks to the purists. The word “istimz4j” for instance is not found in good Arabic or in those Persian authors who use Arabic words. The root ‘mazaja’ means he mized, and the noun ‘“ mizaj”’ implies ‘ mixture’ and is used for that mixture 8 The Arabic Element in Official Hindustani. [No. 1, of feelings and passions which constitutes the temperament of a human being; in other words, his ‘disposition.’ Jstemzdj is used by our Hindustani writers to signify, ‘“‘ wishing to know what the sentiments of a person (mizaj) are on a certain point,” 7. e., asking for permission. In other words, the noun mzzd7 is taken as the root from which a sort of denominative verb in the tenth conjugation is formed zstamzdja, and from this again a regular verbal noun zstimzdj is formed. Now I ad- mit that such a process is not found to exist in Arabic with regard to this verb, but such a process is found with regard to other words ; and we do not know enough of the state of the various dialects of Arabic in the thirteenth century to be able to affirm that such a word may not have been used in some of them; and that it may not have been brought into India by some of the ‘‘ mixed multitude,” who accom- panied the earlier Musalmaén invaders. We have no right to suppose that those writers who, three or four centuries ago, created the Urddé tongue, borrowed their Arabic solely from the classical dialect of the Kuran. So far was the Kuran from being written in the ordinary colloquial style, that we know Muhammad himself was in the habit of pointing to it as one of his greatest miracles, and that the unapproach- able purity ef its diction is to the present day a subject of admiration to all the faithful. The conversazione of Hariri again, from which so many of our European scholars draw their ideas of Arabic, is a profess- edly pedantic work, and it is never pretended that the ordinary Arab of the period talked in such elaborate strains. Wemust seek for the origin of many of our modern Indo-Arabic words in the language of the lower class of which, to this day, we know next to nothing. That the language of the towns even in Muhammad’s time had lost much of its early purity is shewn, inter alza, by the customs of the townsmen.. of sending their children into the desert to learn from the mouths of the Badawin the unadulterated tongue. The prophet himself:is said, in this way, to have spent some years among the tribe of Saad a branch of the Kuraysh. After the death of Muhammad the decay of the spoken language was very rapid. One of the latest and best authorities on this sub- ject says; ‘‘ Every language without a written literature tends to decay more than to development by reason of foreign influences; and the history of the Arabic exhibits an instance of decay remarkably rapid - 1866.] The Arabie Element in Official Hindustant. 9 and extraordinary in degree. An immediate consequence of the foreign conquests achieved by the Arabs under Muhammad’s first four successors, was an extensive corruption of their language: for the nations that they subdued were naturally obliged to adopt, in a great measure, the speech of the conquerors, aspeech which few persons have. ever acquired in such a degree as to be secure from the commission of frequent errors in grammar, without learning it from infancy. These nations, therefore, and the Arabs dwelling among them, con- curred in forming a simplified dialect, chiefly by neglecting to observe those inflections and grammatical rules which constitute the greatest difficulty of the classical Arabic.” (Lane’s Arabic Dictionary. Pre- face ; p. vii. London, 1863.) The inference I draw from the above remarks is, that we have no right to compare the Arabic used in modern Hindustani with the Arabic of classical writers, and to condemn it, if it does not agree with theirs. Still less have we any right to compare it with the elaborate Arabic of the grammarians. The Indo-Arabic of the present day is the legitimate descendant of the Arabic brought into India by the early conquerors, and we may safely give them credit for having spoken their own language correctly, even though that language was not pre- _ cisely the same as that spoken by Muhammad and his tribesmen. When Abu Bakr raised the standard of Islam and sent out the armies of the faithful to the conquest of Syria, warriors from Yaman and - Hadramaut joined his troops. These must have spoken Himyaritic dialects, differing widely from the dialects of Mecca and Medina. Bar-Hebrous, in his Syriac ‘‘ History of the dynasties,” speaks of the Arabs always as “‘ Tayoye,” or men of the tribe of Tai, whose dialect “differed considerably, not only in the use of words, but in grammatical forms, from the literary standard of Arabic. ~ Moawuja’s army was composed almost entirely of Syrians; and the Arab troops which conquered Persia were largely composed of the, ‘same semi-foreign element. There is thus ample ground for supposing that the form of Arabic which the conquering troops of El Islam brought with them into Persia, and which so powerfully influenced that language, was not the form which is reproduced in the Kuran and in the classical works of western and central Arabia. Here again 2 10 The Arabic Element in Official Hindustani. [No. 1. I confine myself to hinting at a probable source of Indo-Arabic; to follow up these suggestions thoroughly, would require an intimate knowledge of all the forms of spoken Arabic, and would lead me too far from the present enquiry. I trust, however, that I have shewn that our Munshi Arabic should not be hastily judged by comparison with an almost foreign standard. _ III. The second assertion, that the court language is unintelligible to the mass of the people, is partly true, partly false. The real fact is that the court language, being the highest and most cultivated form of Hindustani, is intelligible to the people exactly in proportion to their education. To the highly educated native it is perfectly intelli- gible ; to the illiterate rustic it is as Coptic or Chinese. Precisely the same may be said of any language which can boast of a literature. The literary style always will be, must be, in fact, from its very nature, above the comprehension of the masses. Put the Times or the Saturday Review into the hands of a peasant, and see how much he will understand of it. Never was there a more absurd and unreasonable demand made of any cultivated tongue, than that it should exhibit copiousness and expressiveness, and at the same time not be above the understanding of the boor. The ideas of the Indian rustic do not soar above the petty wants and homely occupa- tions of his every-day life, except in a few instances. When they do, he uses Persian or Arabic words to express them. His own Hindi does not help him. A considerable number of simple Arabic and Persian words enters into the vocabulary of the peasant, and they are as familiar to him as they are to the educated pleader or official. Some exist side by side with words of Sanskrit origin, and have a special sub-shade of meaning attached to them. Others stand alone, having no equivalent in the Hindi. Of the first class are such words as wakt, time in general ; and bela or vela, a special time of the day; tarf and ur or dig; makdn and ghar; rasta and sarak ; darwdza and dwdr; kitda and khet ; abdd karnd and jotna ; zamin and matt: ; ’awrat and randé; sarhad and stwdné ; and many others. Of the latter class, ma’léim, matlab, tabdil ; ziydda, (jdsti), xiyddati, roshan, badma’dsh, strat, tajviz, zartr, tamaim, nikdyat, mal, mawdshi, (maweshi), tarah, wdste, mudfik, jabr, zabardast, zulm, zalim, gharib, parwarish, (parwasti), jawdb- seas AGP i pba 1866.] The Arabic Element in Oficial Hindustani. 11 jangal, maiddn, durust, and a long list besides. Any one of these words may be heard from the mouth of the most ignorant ryot in the most secluded parts of the country, as any one who has travelled much in India knows. This large class of foreign words has almost, if not entirely, displaced the corresponding Hindi terms. If any one doubts this, let him read the following list, and judge for himself which of the two he is most familiar with in the mouths of the people—these Hindi words or their foreign equivalents :— Foreign. Hindi, ma’lum., parkash, matlab. parojan, tabdil. pher. uiyada, adhik (aur.) roshan, pargat, badma’ash. gunda, lucha. strat, ui) ee tajviz, (no equivalent.) zarar, uchit (more common in Ben- gali than in Hindi.) tamam. sara, sab, nihayat, bahut. mal. dhan. mawashi, gort. tarah, prakar, (Bengali.) waste, liye. muafik, si (as an affix.) jawab. uttar. jangal, ban (very inadequate.) maidén. badh, r &e. &e. A few of these words express adequately the meaning of the corre- sponding Persian word, but how many of them are known to educated people? Ido not here speak of the English official, who may be expected only to know the simple surface words which meet him in his every day work; but I would ask any educated native how many Hindi words he uses in his ordinary conversation with men of his own and other classes, 12 The Arabic Element in Official Hindustan. [No. 1, As I am here only outlining a defence of my side of the question, I will pass on to another argument. Hindi is not one language. It is ten or fifteen or more different dialects. The following list, taken from a work which relates the early efforts of the Serampore mission- aries to introduce the Bible in his own tongue to the home of every ryot, will shew how great the diversity is. _ Dialect. Locality. Brijbhas‘ha, Agra, Muttra. Canojia, Cawnpore, Futtehgurh, Eta- wah, Bareilly, Alligurh. Koshala, Oudh. Bhojpuri, Benares, Ghazipoor, Arrah. Hariani, Hariana, Hissar, Rohtak. Bundelkhandi, Bundelkhund. Boghela, Boghelkhund, (Central India.) Harroti, Malwah. ) Oojjainee, Ujayin. | Oodeypooree, Udaypir. Marwari, Marwar. | Rajputana. Jaypuri, Jaypur. | Bikaniri, Bikanir. Bhattania, Bhattanir. | Magara, Behar, Patna. Tirhutiya or Maithil, Tirhoot, Purneah. Bhaugulpoor, Monghyr. Now, I would ask those who wish us to abjure Persian and Arabic and draw from “ the well of Hindi undefiled,” which of all these dia- lects is to be considered as undefiled. If to the above dialects we add Marathi, Guzaratti, Sindhi, Ooch, Punjabi, Dogra, Cashmeree, Par- buttia, Moonugee, Palpa—all of which are more or less Hindi—the difficulty of selecting our standard becomes almost insurmountable ; for in these various forms of Hindi not only do the vocables differ, — but the very declensions and conjugations, the very root and fibre of the language. Thus for the genitive case affix, we have kd, ke, ki, Hindi: dd, de, di, didu, Punjabi: cha, che, cha, chya, Marathi: sa, se, si &c. Sindhi, and so on. The verb hond to be, undergoes a wonderful variety of inflections. Not to multiply instances, it may suffice to say 1866. | The Arabic Element in Official Hindustani. Ls that there is no such thing as a Hindi standard of speech which is at once intelligible to all classes, in all parts of Hindustan. For a com- mon standard you are driven to the Urdu, which has selected and embalmed the purest and most widely used forms of the old Hindi. Just as in England, if we threw aside our classical English tongue with all its foreign importations, we should find ourselves in a chaos of Hampshire, Somerset, Yorkshire, Lowland Scotch and other jargons ; so would it be in India. Who that has not lived among the people understands the following words, common though they are in the mouth of the Hampshire peasant ? to brize, to dount, fessey, to hov, kittering, mokin, rumwards, skrow, stabble, tuly, wivvery, wosset, yape, to yaw. Examples without number might be given by any one who recollects the peasant-talk of his own county in England. No one in his senses would recommend our generally adopting any of these words, good old Celtic and Saxon though they. be, and yet we are asked in India to recommend and assist in a precisely similar process. The fact is that the languages of modern times have all arisen from a fusion of cognate dialects, just as most nations have been formed by coalitions of kindred tribes. By throwing aside that which was pecu- liar to themselves, and retaining all those words and inflections which they possessed in common, modern nations obtained a national basis of speech on which to engraft words borrowed from foreign sources ; and thus were built up English, French, Italian, Spanish, Turkish, and all the leading languages of our times. That the Gangetic tribes, by a happy coincidence, have been able to follow the same course, and, by fusing the rough Hindi dialects into one, to add thereto many ex- pressive foreign words, is a circumstance which, far from being lament- able or a sign of decay, entitles the language so formed, to rank among progressive and civilized tongues. If the rudest of the peasantry cannot understand the cultivated language of their educated compa- triots, it is not therefore advisable to despoil the language of its legiti- mate gains, to bring it down to the level of grihasths and gwialas. Rather let the latter be educated till they do understand. The diffi- -eulty which the peasant finds in understanding the Court language has been immensely overrated, and is only due to his imperfect education. The true remedy for the difficulty is not to be found in an insane attempt to impoverish a fine and copious language, but in making it more widely known to all classes in India. LO 14 On Ordeals, [No. 1, A translation of the Chapter on Ordeals, from the Vydvahara Mayukha. —By Professor Grorce Bunter, Elphinstone College, Bombay. [Received 2nd June, 1865. ] The following translation of the Mayukha’s chapter on Ordeals was originally prepared by a Bombay Shastri at the request of my learned friend, Mr. Wh. Stokes, and intended to be inserted in the reprint of Mr. Borradaile’s translation of the Mayukha, which was being published under his superintendence in Madras. When I looked over the Shas- tri’s work, I found that it would be of no use, as his translation was frequently unintelligible, and often decidedly wrong. I therefore retrans- lated nearly the whole, with the assistance of Mr. Vindyak Laxman, late Hindu Law Officer of the Bombay High Court. Circumstances prevented the completion of the translation, before the printing of Mr. Borradaile’s Mayukha was too far advanced to admit of its insertion. These circumstances will explain how it happened that my attention was directed to a part of the Hindu Law, like the Ordeals, which has a purely antiquarian interest, and has become rather trite by the publica- _ tion of two papers on it; one by Ali Ibrahim Khan, As. Res. L., p. 389, the other by Prof. Stenzler, Journ. D. Morg. Ges. Vol. [X., as well as by the appearance of a translation of the chapter on Ordeals from the Mitakshara by Mr. W. Macnaghten, (Principles and Prec. of H. Law, Madras, 1865.) Here (begin) the ordeals : They are used to decide matters which are left undecided by human evidence. They are of two kinds (1st) such, as decide (a case) immediately, and (2nd) such, as decide it after the lapse of some time. Amongst them Brihaspati describes those of the first kind (in the following verse) : ‘“‘'The scales, fire, and water, poison, fifthly consecrated water ; rice grains are declared to be the sixth; hot masha (coins) the seventh ; the eighth is the ploughshare, according to the (ancient sages) ; the lot is recorded as the ninth.” Yajnavalkya declares (II. 95) that the first five (of these nine ordeals) (are to be used) in (cases involving) heavy accusations only. 1866.] On Ordeals. 15 “The scales, fire, water, poison and consecrated water are the ordeals (used) here (in lawsuits) for exculpation, if the plaintiff binds himself to abide by the award (Qirshakastha means ready,) and to suffer the punishment, which the defendant would suffer in case of defeat. Pitamaha (says) : ** Let him (the judge) order the scales, etc. for those, against whom the accusation is urged with great confidence ; rice grains and consecrated water he should order in doubtful cases.”’ Avashtambha (means) confidence. According to this passage (of Pitaémaha) consecrated water may be used when the plaintiff is full of confidence, (as well as when he is) doubtful. In the Kélikfpurana (we read) : ‘In case of an accusation of adultery, of theft, of a connexion with women (the intercourse with whom is) forbidden, or of a Mahdapataka or of high treason, let an ordeal take place. _. “When there is conflicting evidence or (any other) dispute, or if a blame is attached to the plaintiff, then shall the king order the ordeal (to take place) after the plaintiff has declared himself ready to suffer the punishment (of defeat). When there are many witnesses in an action for adultery, let the defendant undergo the ordeal, in order to clear himself without any additional punishment.” Women, the connexion with whom is forbidden (agamydh) are others than married women ; such as common prostitutes. ‘ Caste’ means ‘in the case of an accusation.’ ‘ Sdhasam’ means ‘a crime perpetrated by violence.’ ‘ Avarnah’ means ‘ blame.’ ‘ Girah (head) means ‘ punishment.’ The specification of the accusation by the words ‘for adultery,’ is unnecessary, because this accusation has been already mentioned. Like- wise are the words ‘where there are many witnesses’ (unnecessary). Therefore an ordeal may take place in every action, even if witnesses be wanting. The indication of the object of the ordeal by the words in order to clear himself,” is proper only, (if the passage be to her) in this (sense). And it is acommon saying, “‘ In actions for high trea- son and accusations of an offence which causes loss of caste (the defen- 16 On Ordeals. [No. 1, dant) shonld undergo an ordeal, even if the plaintiff be not ready to _ undergo the punishment of defeat.” _ Narada (says) : Those who are suspected by kings, those who are accused by Dasyus, and those who wish to clear themselves, shall undergo an ordeal, without (any additional) punishment (in case of defeat). The ordeal which decides a case after (the lapse of some) time, is the oath. Narada has declared the different kinds of this (the latter) : ‘(Let (him swear) by truth, (or) let him touch (whilst swearing) a vehicle, arms, a cow, grains, or gold, or the feet of the gods, or of his father or mother; or (let him swear) by his pious gifts, and his good works ; or let him touch the head of his child, of his wife or of a friend ; or he may also—in case of any accusation,—drink consecrated water.”’ The oaths are declared by Manu (to be resorted to) even on very trifling occasions. Though consecrated water decides a case only after the lapse of some time, it has been enumerated in the first (division), because it is used in great accusations (also). Yajnavalkya (says) (II. 96) : ‘¢ According to (their) pleasure either of the two may undergo (the ordeal), and the other may take (upon himself) the punishment Gn case of defeat.” This alternative (lies) only at the pleasure of the plaintiff. If he does not wish (to undergo the ordeal), (it falls) on the defendant, Let nobody oblige the plaintiff to undergo the punishment. ‘¢ The ordeal should be imposed upon the accused by those who know (the rules respecting) the ordeal.” These are the words of Katyayana in the Divyatattva, Here (follow) the rules regarding the different kinds of ordeals appropriate to (different) individuals. Yajnavalkya says (i 98): “The scales (are appropriate) for women, children, old, blind, or lame persons and Brahmans; fire or water, the seven grains of Yava or poison, for a Cidra,” (The scales are for every body) without reference to sex or caste or age. 1866.] On Ordeals. Ly Béla (is a person) who is younger than 16 years, of whatever caste he may be. (A person whois) older than 80 years (is called) vraddha (old). , Here (in this passage it is meant) that the scales only are intended for a Brahman (when the ordeal takes place) at the time generally (appointed for the scales), of which (more) will be spoken (below). But (when the ordeal takes place) at the time (which is fit for the employment) of fire and the like, those (ordeals) are employed even (for a Brahman).”’ Therefore Pitémaha (says) : “* All castes can, according to the rule, be cleared by (taking) conse- crated water. All the (ordeals) (can be employed in case) of every one, except poison (in the case) of a Brahman.” In the Kalikapuraéna (we read) : A hot gold masha coin should always be given to a man of the lowest caste. Narada (says) : * Let (the judge) always examine eunuchs, men bereft of strength, those whose mind is violently agitated, and these three, children, old and sick people, by means of the scales. But neither poison nor water, is prescribed for women ; by means of the scales, consecrated water, etc. let him enquire into the hidden truth about them. Those who are in (bodily or mental) pain, shall not clear themselves by the water (ordeal), nor those who suffer of a disease caused by gall or poison. The (ordeal by) fire is not ordained for the leprous, the blind, those who suffer of a disease of the nails, and the like. Children and women should not be immerged (into water) by those who know the In- stitutes of law, nor (should this be done) to sick, old or weak men. He should (likewise) not immerge into water those who have no force, and those who have been enfeebled by sickness. When they are immerged, they always die; for little life (is left) in them. He shall. not im- merge them even if they have come (to court) on account (of an accusation) of an offence perpetrated with violence. Nor shall he make them take (into their hands) hot iron, nor shall he make them clear themselves by (taking) poison. Vishnu (says) : “ (Let him not impose any of the abovementioned ordeals) upon those, 3 > 18 On Ordeals. [No. 1, who suffer of a disease caused by the phlegmatic humor, or who are (otherwise) sick, or women or asthmatic persons.” Katyayana (says) : ‘‘ Let him not give the ordeal by fire to smiths, nor (that by) water to those who (by their profession) have to work in water (as divers, etc.) nor by any means poison to those who know the application of charms. Let him not order a man, who is engaged on fulfilling a religious vow or who has a disease of the mouth (to undergo the ordeal) of the rice grains. | A man who is engaged on a vrata (vratin) (means) a man who performs the milk-vow and the like. Pitamaha (says) : ‘“‘ Consecrated water should not be given by wise (men) to those who drink spirituous liquor, to adulterers, gamblers or atheists.” Narada (says) : ‘“¢ He shall avoid to give consecrated water to a man, who has com- mitted a great crime, or who does not obey the law, an ungrateful (person), a eunuch, a despicable (person), an atheist, a man whose crimes (faults) are (generally) known. - Katyayana (says) : “ But the king should not order (the abovementioned ordeal) for people, who ought not to be touched, for those of the lowest castes, for slaves, barbarians, evil-doers ; nor for those born by pratilomya (whose mother is of a higher caste than the father). He should order for them, at the time, the ordeals which are known {to be fit) for the (season). Known (to be fit) for them are the scales, poison and the like (each of which is fit for some proper season.) Ii the person who has to undergo the ordeal is unable (to do so,) the same (Katyayana) prescribes a substitute (to be chosen for him,) in the Divyatattva. ‘Tf there is no hindrance (for the person, who has to undergo the ordeal) as far as regards place or time, then let him undergo it, as it is proper. He can have it performed by another (person); that — is the rule in the contrary case.’ Anyena, by another, harayet, he may cause it to be taken, (means) he may have it performed by a sub- stitute, Viparyaye (in the contrary case), (means) if the person who lie aP-- 1866.] On Ordeals. 19 has to undergo the ordeal is unable (to do so), let (then another person) do what is appropriate. In the contrary case, 7. e. when there is a certainty that the defend- ant formerly did commit a great crime, such as the murder of his father or other (near relations) ; or when at some other time (the de- fendant) was suspected of some other matter, the same (Katydyana) declares (that he should perform) the ordeal through a substitute. “(In the case) of people who have killed their father, mother, a Brahman, their spiritual teacher, an old man, a woman or a child, of such as have committed a Mahadpitaka, and especially of atheists, those who bear the sign (of another caste than that to which they belong) of women, of those who are acquainted with the use of charms and yoga (supernatural power acquired by meditation, etc.), or of those who are born in a mixed caste, of those who live or cause others to live in a course of vice ;—in the case of such shameful accusations, a justice-loving king should by no means order (the accused to undergo) an ordeal. The ordeal ought to be undergone by good people appointed by these (the abovementioned sinners). Where there are no good men, there they should be cleared by their own people (undergoing the ordeal).” Svakaih (by their own people) (means) by relations. Here (follow) (the rules regarding) the time (when the several ordeals should take place). Pitamaha (says) : “ Caitra (March, April) Margacivas (December, January) and Vaica- kha (April, May) are months generally (used for a// ordeals), and they do not present obstacles to ordeals.” ' The (ordeal by the) scales is ordained (to be employed) at any season, (but) one should avoid it, if the wind blows. The (ordeal by) fire is declared (to be good) in the dewy, cold and -rainy seasons, the (ordeal by) water in autumn and the hot season, that by poison in winter and dewy season. Poison (is recommended) to be taken in the cold and dewy seasons, (but) other seasons also (at times) are included ; beacuse further on (the passage) varshe caturyavamatra, etc. will be quoted. Narada (says) : ““Consecrated water may be given at any season (of the year), (and) the scales (likewise) may (be employed) at any time.” 20 On Ordeals. [No. 1, Pitaémaha (says further) : ‘“‘ The ordeal by fire must take place in the morning, and in the morn- ing the scales (must be employed). The (ordeal by) water ought to be given in the middle of the day to those who wish (to learn) the real state of truth. But the clearing by means of consecrated water is ordered (to take place) during the first half of the day. But in the last quarter of the night should the poison be given, being cold. These ordeals should take place on a Sunday, thus say the Cishtas, (i. e. those Brahmans who have studied the Vedas and Vedangas and thereby have become authorities in law). Now (follow the rules on) the place (where the ovtibiad ought to take place). Pitamaha (says) : “The scales must always be made to turn towards the east, unmove- able, in a pure place, near to the flag, in the hall (of justice), or in the gateway of the king’s (palace), or on a crossing.” Narada (says) : ‘‘(Let it be placed) in the hall or at the door of the king’s palace, in a temple or on a crossing.” Katyayana (says) : ‘Let him order those men who are accused of a Mahapataka, to undergo the ordeal near the flag, those who (are accused to) have committed high treason, at the door of the king’s (palace) ; those who are born in pratilomya should undergo the ordeal on a crossing, and wise men know that in other cases (the ordeal should take place) in the midst of the hall (of justice).” Narada (says further) : ‘Tf ordeals are not given at the proper time and place, or undergone by people who claim to be exempted from them, they always cause in lawsuits a false result ; of that there is no doubt.” Now (follow) the rules which are common to all ordeals: Pitamaha (says) : Then let the judge, who is conversant with the religious law, invoke the gods according to the following rule ; turning towards the east and joining his hands, let him speak : ‘‘ Come, come, divine Dharma, ap- proach this ordeal, together with the Lokapalas (eight protectors of the — world) and the crowds of Vasus, Adityas and Maruts.” But if he © 1866. ] On Ordeals. wi - has brought Dharma to the scales, he should assign to the subordinate gods their several places. ) The same (Pitamaha says further) : “* Having placed Indra in the eastern direction, and the lord of the dead in the south, Varuna in the west, and Kuvera in the north, he should divide the (other) Lokapalas, etc., Agni in the intermediate points of the horizon. Indra is yellow, Yama dark-blue, Varuna shines like crystal, Kuvera like gold, Agni also (glitters) like gold, and Nirriti is dark-blue, Vayu dark-brown, and let Icina be red—thus he shall meditate on them in their order. To the south of Indra a wise man should place the Vasus. These eight Vasus are declared to be Dhara, Dhruva and Soma, Apah (the waters), Anila (wind), Anala (fire), Pratyisha (early morning), Prabhisa, Between the lord of gods (Indra) and Icéna is the place of the Adityas. The names of these twelve Adityas are declared to be Dhatri, Aryaman, Mitra, Varuna, I¢a and Bhaga; Indra, Vivasvat, and Pishan; and as the tenth Parjanya; then Tvashtri, then last born, though not last (in power), Vishnu. But the western side of Agni (between this god and Yama), they know to be the place of the Rudras. The Rudras are recorded to be eleven (name- ly), Virabhadra, Gambhu and the famous Giriga, Aja Ekapéd, Ahi Budhnya, and the unconquered Pindkin, and Bhuvanddhievara, and Kapali, Vitaémpati, Sthanu, and the illustrious Bhava. Between the lord of the dead (Yama) and the Rax4sa (Nirriti) let him make the place of the mothers. (They are) Brahmi, Maheevari, Kaumiari, and Vaishnavi, Varahi, Mahendri, and Camunda, accompanied by her Ganas. _ They know (tell) that Ganega’s place is to the north of Nirriti (between him and Varuna), The place of the Maruts is declared (to be) on the northern side of Varuna (between him and Vayu). The seven Marutas are said (to be); Gaganasparcana, Vayu, Anila, Maruta, Prana, Prineca, Yiva. A wise man should bring Durga to the north of the scales: and they prescribe adoration to these deities, calling each) by his name. Having given to Dharma in the proper order the (offerings), the first of which is the Arghya and the last of which consists of ornaments (in flowers, etc.), he afterwards should give to the subordinate gods the (offerings), beginning with the Arghya and ending with the (presentation of) ornaments. y2. On Ordeals. [No. 1, (And) he should offer the adoration which begins with the (obla- tion of) perfumes and ends with the (oblation of the) food. By (Brahmans) who have studied the Vedas a burnt-offering should be presented in each of the four points of the horizon. Let him offer at these offerings clarified butter, boiled rice Samidhs accompanying the act with the recital of the Savitri, the Pranava (Omkéra), and the Svaha at the end.’ Havi’s (oblation) (means) Charu, boiled rice. The Eastern Mi- mamsakas declare in the Divyatattva, that the clarified butter, the boiled rice and the sacred fuel (Samidhah) are offered conjointly, just asat the two Sdémndaya-ishtis, because the deities, (to whom they are offered), are not opposed to each other. That is wrong. For (it is declared) in the Stitra of Acvaléyana and the rest: ‘ He cuts off two portions of ajya, he places fuel once on the boiled rice, he cuts off (portions) of the boiled rice twice from the middle and the fore-part (of the heap), and he sprinkles the rice which he has cut off (with ghee). Thisis the rule for cutting off.” Sruva means, (here) fuel, because it has also this meaning. (Besides) the conjoint oblation (of the various offerings) is im- possible, because (in each case) a different instrument (for completing the oblation) is prescribed (by the Sitra) hastasya. But in the case of the two Samndaya ishtis the conjoint of oblation (of the ghee, fuel and rice) is proper, because (there) only one instrument, the juhit, is used. The same (Pitdmaha says) : “The accused having written the (crime) of which he is accused, on a scroll (of paper) together with the following Mantra, places that (scroll) on his forehead. And the Mantra (is the following), ‘Sun and moon, wind and fire, heaven and earth, the waters, (man’s own) heart, and Yama, day and night, the two twilights and Dharma know man’s actions.” Narada (says) : “Then the judge (who ought to be) a Brahman, who has studied the Vedas and the Vedangas, who possesses fame and a good character, who has extinguished (the passions of) his mind, who has forsaken 1866.] On Ordeals. 23 envy, who keeps his promises, pure, clever, rejoicing in the welfare of all ereatures, who has kept a fast (on the day of the ordeal) in wet clothes, (who has bathed in his clothes), who has cleaned his teeth with water, having worshipped all the gods according to the (prescribed) rule....... Yajnavalkya (says II. 97), “(The judge) having called the accused who has bathed in his garments and fasted from sunrise, shall cause him to undergo the ordeals in the presence of the king and the Brahmans.” Pitaimaha also (says) : * Ordeals always (should be ordered) to be performed by the accused when he has fasted one or three days, who is pure, and dressed in a wet garment.” The same (author says) : “ Surrounded by good men, the king should (order him to) perform this clearing (through an ordeal) and should (order him to) gladden the sacrificial priests, house-priests, and spiritual teachers by presents. A king who orders the ordeal to be performed in this way, after having enjoyed heart-gladdening pleasures, having obtained great fame, he becomes fit to be (united with) Brahma. Now follows the rule on the (ordeal) of the scales. Pitamaha (says) : “The king should order (his people) to construct a hall for the scales, which (is) broad, high, resplendent, where a man will not be defiled by dogs, Chandalas or crows, possessing an instrument for (shutting) the doors, protected by watchmen, which contains (jars with) water and the like, which is well furnished.” Narada (says) : *‘ Let him (the king) order (scales ) to be made there, of any Khadira wood, except Cukla Khadira, which must be free from clefts ; Guklavarji- ta (lit. except white) means except white Khadira wood, “Ti there is no (Khadira) (t should be) made of Cimgapa, or (if that be wanting) of Cala, which must be free from holes, or (it may be male of) iron-wood (arjuna), or Tinduki, or of Tinica or red sandalwood. -Mahava gives the following reading (of the passage arjuna-—candana) : The arjuna, Tilaka, Acoka, Tinica, (or red sandal tree) (should be used). He should use such like woods for the scales. Such like (evamvidhani) means (that he may use) also others, as ¥ 24 On Ordeals. [No. 1, Udumbara-wood (Indian fig-tree) and the like; thus (says) Madana. For this very reason, Pitamaha (says) : ‘“‘ Having cut (any) tree, that is fit to be used at the sacrifice, pre- ceding the action, as in the case of the sacrificial post, with Mantras (prayers from the Veda), and having worshipped the guardians of the world, wise men should make the scales. The Mantra are addressed to Soma, and to Vanaspati during the cutting, and muttered only. Preceding the action by a Mantra as in the case of the Yupa (means having muttered): ‘‘ O tree, protect him, etc.” The two Mantras addressed to Soma and Vanaspati, are both spoken during the cutting, because on account of the Mantras being muttered their object isnot visible. (Which Mantras are called) saumyah, ad- dressed to Soma, that is known. The Mantra addressed to Vanaspati is: Vanaspate Catavalgosvaroha, (R. V. II. 8.) The transferring of the qualities of the Yipa to the scales (by the words) asya yipavat i. e. in the case of this as in the case of the Yupa, causes the repetition of something established (before). Pitamaha (says) : ‘But the scales should be made (in length) four hastas, and the side- posts as long, the space between (the scales and the posts) should be one hasta and a half.” Vyasa (says) : ‘But two hastas of each side-post (of the scales) are to be dug into the ground.” | Pitaémaha (says further) : \ “The scale beam is to be made four-cornered, firm, and straight, ‘and hoops should industriously be placed in three places (middle and the two ends).”’ The same (goes on) : Having iastened the two basins to the two ends (of the beam), let him place kuga-gras, the tops of which are directed to the east, also on the two basins. Let him weigh those who undergo (the ordeal) on the western scale, on the other (he shall place) clean clay, bricks or ashes, (but he shall) avoid stones, potsherds, bones. Narada (says) : 1866. ] On Ordeals. 95 “ Having firmly tied the scales (plates) to the two rings (at the ends) of the scale-beam, let him place in the one scale the man, in the other a stone. On the northern side scale let him place the man, on the southern (side) the stone. (Or) let him fill the basin with bricks, dust or clods of earth.” The same (Narada) declares the manner of examining (the respective weights of the man and stone) ; “(Before the weighing) the examiners (should) always (make) the scale-beam even by means of two mason’s plummets, and (people who are) expert (in this business) should (always, when weighing,) pour water on the scale-beam.”’ “That scale-beam on which the water does not flow, is what one should know—to be even.” Pitémaha (also) prescribes the two plummets (to be used) in order (to produce) evenness : *¢ At the two ends should he make two arches( torana), (which should be) higher than the scale-beam by ten fingers, and a mason’s plummet (should hang down from each arch (torana) made of clay, tied (to the arch) by a string, touching the corner of the scale-beam.” Pitaémaha (further says) : “Having weighed the man first, he should mere hime descend from the scale; but he should always adorn the scales with wimples and banners ; then (a Brahman) who knows the Veda should bring the gods near to it by this rule, with drums and horns, perfumes, wreaths and ointments.” Narada (says) : “ Let him first honour the scales, with red sandalwood powder, per- fumes and flower-wreaths, curds, cakes, unground (rice) and the like ; then he should honour the learned (Brahmans).”’ Yajfiavalkya (says): (11. 100 and 101): “‘ People who are expert in weighing should make the accused ascend the scale, (and) when they have placed (in the other scale) a weight equal to his (weight) and made a line onthe scales, he should be ordered to descend. (Before he ascends the scale for the second time, the accused) should address the scales with this Mantra: — “ . re - x . $s ; = > \ - * : 7 ; = aed . =f ie! ’ ‘ - - . = ‘ » ~~ oe - . s . peg at ' - — ; ees. ; x * . - = 7 - . i = - Z : : ; ‘ ‘ . 1 - : > . i 4 - , . . ‘. . ; 7 [? <=. ae sd ; Es. 3 \ . = = 4 we ° > * ¥ c- 7" 3 iy oe : . - . bp a J « @ : ¥ "8 Poe Pee > ‘ x » Ps ‘ ; at e : ° : rar. —* <= : \) . > -” ~ & - e. _ 2 > =< P » a . < e ™ . ~~. < "4 7 a . 7 a A g . F ’ . . ‘ * _ _ ” & ° = ¢ e = Dek. 2. 2 ? . ~ . a oem ® __ < 4 . e :- es = “d val 2 J , - - ~~ a d ™ = | ri oe ox rs > P : ur < Fag = . Fee 2 = . we. : <> ¢ : 5 ‘ p ~ . >; : : es : Pea ir ME; ~~ - z —* « “e — ae 8 ar re a “ it eo ; >. pe ee - oe Snes + 7 >. > Saert 2 le Se Eat fe Journal: As: Soc: XXXV PL. PR LARUO Ne Pn Uther OR RN IR NORMS Draun on Stone by Kristo Hort Das Stadent Govt: School of Art Caleutto. STONE: FIGURE AT SENJUN, Lith: by H. Niven $.G. 0. Calcutta May 1866. 1866.] Antiquities in the Gayd District. 53 course by the villagers, is a very singular figure, and the only one of the kind I have hitherto met with : see Photograph No. 225 (Plate IT.) It represents two figures, life-sized, one seated on the shoulders of the other. From the ornaments and style it is evidently Buddhist, but I am completely at a loss as to its meaning. To the north of the village, there is another little temple in a mangoe grove, with a number of figures, more or less mutilated, collected around it. I noticed a nicely sculptured Lingam of a square form, and the only specimen of the kind I have met with. Kutangee.—About five miles west of this place is a village called Kutangee. There is in it a large mud fort of some pretensions, and ‘numerous mounds of brick rubbish, some figures in fragments, but none of any interest. Mujheawan.—About a koss further north, there is another large mud fort at the village of Mujheawan, and nearly every village about this have mounds and small mud forts, but I saw no figures of importance or interest. _ Kyal.—About eight miles west of Mujheawan, there are large tanks and mounds, but no other features of importance. Deokund.—South of Kyal on the borders of an extensive tract of land covered with shrub jungle is a place called Deokoond, which seems to have possessed a Buddhist temple or monastery. There is a fair held here in the month of Fagoon, when great numbers of people assemble to bathe in the tank or koond. On a former visit, I observed a num- ber of broken Buddhist figures and miniature stupas collected under the trees : these have since been covered with a coating of mud. The temple itself is in the centre of a mass of brick rubbish, through which a road has been cut to give access to the interior chamber which is now occupied by a Lingam. A rude sort of dome has been erected immediately over the central chamber. See Photograph No. 23. ~ No, 24 is the gateway of a fortified serai in the old village of Daoodnuggur, so named from Daood Khan the founder, who died some 200 years ago. Konch.—On. the road Fait Daoodnugeur and Gays, about 16 miles from the latter, is the village of Konch; I have already noticed the temple at this place, but the following notes may not be unacceptable. |The present village consists of two parts, the bazar on both sides of 54 Antiquitees in the Gayd District. [No. 1, the road, and the village proper, which is about 100 yards to the north of the road. Between the two villages there are several extensive mounds of brick rubbish, and a number of scattered Buddhist figures. On the right there is an old mud fort, and it would seem that in digging the mud for its erection, the larger figures were found; the principal one is life-size, highly finished, but wanting the head; see No. 25. This is placed upright ona level with the path. Higher up on the mound to the west are the Buddhist figures with inscriptions shown in Photograph No. 26. To the south are two figures (see Photograph No. 27) of the form I have already referred to, as being the most general all over this district, and which are named according to the fancy of the Purohit, who, provided with a few of these figures only differing in the execution, has the range of the whole of the Hindoo Pantheon, and names them at his own discretion, or according to the wishes or wants of the community. Passing through the village proper, you come to the temple men- tioned by Buchanan, and of which a drawing is given in the first volume of Martin’s India. Photograph No. 28 (Plate XII) is a view of the front of the building from the east with the opening above the entrance, leading into the upper chamber. Photograph No. 29 isa view from the southwest. The accompanying ground plan (Plate III) will give the reader some idea of its structure, and the section will show the superstructure with the arched lower chamber, and the interior recess over the entrance which resembles that in the Boodh Gay4 temple. Nothing but mud has been used to cement the bricks, but the latter have been so well prepared that they fit together most accurately. There would seem to have been a coating of plaster on the outside, but this has nearly entirely disappeared. A porch had been added with an © arched roof, but it has fallen in, the only arch in the original building is that of the lower chamber which is painted. In the centre of the lower chamber there is now a lingam, and in the porch there are a number of figures. Photograph No. 30 is a slab let into the wall with a representation of the avatars. Photograph No. 31 are other figures in the same enclosure. Photograph No. 32 is a nearer view of the entrance and opening above the doorway. Immediately outside, there are a number of granite pillars, and from their number and situation, they seem to have formed an enclosure — round the temple. Journal As: Soc: XXXV. p-l. x ise aly is oe TEMPLE OF KONCH FROM A PHOTOGRAPH BY -J.H. Perre ESO RE Drawn on stone at the Govt: School of Art Calcutta by Kristehurry Dass, Student. LITH: BY H.M. SMITH, SURVEYOR GENERAL'S OFFICE CALCUTTA MARCH 1!866, Plate. XVII. “ ROUGH SECTION OF TEMPLE AT KOCH ——— PLAN OF TEMPLE AT KOCH. ea Lith by H: Niven §.G6.0.Calentia May 3868 Plate IIT. a Feet Seale 20 Feet r 1866.] Antiquities in the Gaya District. 55 In a corner of the village near the temple, there are a great number of lingams collected, of all sizes, many with 3 and 4 sculptured faces. To the east of the temple there is a small tank ; on the banks there are several sumadhs or tombs, of the form which is so common at Boodh Gaya. Palee.—Four miles nearer Gayaé is another village called Palee, which seems to have had several temples ; one at least was Buddhist, and of the same form as the one at Nair and at Poonawa. Judging by the few pillars still standing (see Photograph No. 33, ) a great number of pillars have been removed. When I last visited the place, quarrying for bricks was being actively carried on, Several large lingams had been dug out of the mass of rubbish, and also a bull of the usual form, so that the temple, which was most likely originally Buddhist, had subse- quently been converted into a Hindoo one. A few paces to the west close to the road théte is a large lingam in situ, with a peepul tree growing in the interstices : see Photograph No. 34. Close by is the lintel of a Buddhist temple door, and the side posts are a little distance apart under a peepul tree : see Photograph No. 35. For some distance round there are traces of temples, but those described seem to bave heen the _ only ones of any size. Almost directly south from Konch is a large village called Kabur, and adjoining it is a rather large fort marked Mudun in the maps, but I could find no local name for it. From the extensive mounds in every direction, and the appearance and size of the fort, it is of much earlier date than the generality of the mud forts so common in this district. It is attributed to the Kole Rajahs by the natives, and this is the case with everything which is earlier than the advent of the Mussulmans. I was disappointed in not finding any figures or inscriptions in the neighbourhood. There are one or two pillars of black chlorite which must have belonged to some old Hindoo Temple, but the natives in- formed me they had been collected for the building of a mosque by ‘some former inhabitant of the village. There is a granite stone, itself originally a part of a pillar, inserted in a large well, but which has proved to be the dedication of the well by some obscure individual : see Photograph No. 36. ~ About 6 miles to the south-west is a large village and bazar called Chirkawan ; it is the principal place in the Pergunnah of that name, It * 56 Antiquities in the Gaya District. [ No. 1, is built-on the site of an ancient village, and there is an old mud _ fort adjoining. f | be Oi eS | P f=) . . Cs ® ye wee ’ yf i rs ry 4 . 4 oe ? ‘ * ‘, ‘ 4 tm ) rh 4? ir . fn Ah} i‘ iS 4 ‘ . 3 ' ‘ . Ae Pid \ ua > a | + ay ; . . t , « é pr f i e . J , ai } > ad ; as | = 4 } * : . , @ < . - ~< \ = a - % ( aa e 4 ; eat a7 Pace, pt : — { a ‘4 pa I 4% Tr m i woh 7 : i | jon 0 aah ee ee a id a wi be or “ee of i ’ : a . . é rep? Syl ap 1h Ae pa % ‘ at ‘ : 3 ad ’ Ay reg in he ¢ La A) fabs Me. 7 y Peek, lay Bes ih. Vis ae iA Yas sf ee es , : i) AF & , om ua ms “y J barter re ee ees, | ce ‘ " iy’ save FF hi MRM. ¥ “ oul Taw ; Ae oe " A Pet f / Wilton: 8) ' iPlGh See, oe | | Saha ety we J ‘xr tu : \ ‘ r JOURNAL AS SOC: XXXV. PI. BUDDHIST CHAITYA N.W. OF RAJ-GHAUT FORT. OLD CHAITYA CEILING. Scale 2 fee tolineh. ma Ue Za Pil Lok 2 feet to Linch. 1866.] Buddhist Monasteries and Temples. 67 forbidding. Mr. Horne spent a few rupees in cleaning the building, and in removing, as an experiment, the encrusted soot from some of the carvings. Fortunately the Mohammedans or the British Govern- ment authorities, we know not which, in their care for these beautiful works of art, have embedded them in mortar from base to capital, so that many of them might be restored. The removal of the en- crustations, however, will have to be accomplished with the greatest care, or else the surface stone, rendered friable by the heat to which it has been subjected, will come away with the superimposed mortar, thereby destroying the delicate edge of the carvings. We trust the Government will not grudge a few hundred rupees for the thorough cleaning of this fine specimen of Buddhist architecture. The inner stone wall and the modern pavement should also be removed. Besides these remains, there were, until quite recently, hundreds of stones lying about in the fort, bearing traces of great antiquity. In the mutiny, many of these were collected, and: were made use of for the foundations of temporary barracks which were then erected. These stones may have once belonged to the vihar just described, when it existed in its integrity, but may also have been portions of other contemporaneous buildings situated in its vicinity. During the mutiny, Mr. Tresham, by Government order, blew up some ancient buildings standing near the vihar, and there are yet the foundations of one, which defied all attempts at its destruction. Mr. Horne also remembers a chaitya which was removed to afford space for barracks. Buddhist Chaitya No. I. A few hundred yards due north from the old gateway leading into the Raj Ghaut Fort is a mound of circumscribed extent, now used as a Mohammedan burial-ground, on the summit of which are the remains of an old Buddhist chaitya or temple. They consist simply of four pillars, richly carved with scroll-work, sustaining an ancient roof. At the corners of the shafts is the ordinary ornamentation resembling a chain of lotus seed-pods. The capitals are cruciform and the bases are square with embellished faces. The ceiling is very beautifully sculptured, and is composed of slabs over-lapping one | another, with the centre stone crowning the whole, according to the eS —————— = i 68 Description of Ancient Remains of [No. 2,. primitive mode of Indian roof-building. This latter stone exhibits the out-spread petals of a lotus blossom, while eight out of the twelve. triangular spaces formed by the intersection of the slabs, are freely carved with the scroll-pattern. A few sculptured stones lie about the mound; amongst them is an erect figure of Buddha with garland and armlet, much mutilated. There are also three stone beams or architraves bearing the chess-board and spear-head patterns. In the small terrace likewise on which the chaitya stands, are inserted four carved stones, taken doubtless from some ancient building formerly in the neighbourbood. The occurrence of three or four plain cloister pillars of the usual form, adapted by the Mussulmans as head-stones for graves, together with the carved architraves already alluded to, would seem to indicate that a small cloister for monastic purposes must originally have stood upon this mound, which was then terraced, the stones of which have been by degrees removed both for building: Mohammedan graves, and also for repairs in the Fort. Small Mosque in the Budaon Mahalla. Tn the Budaon Mahalla near the Raj Ghaut Fort, a short distance south of the high road, there is a small mosque in an enclosure, made. up to a great. extent of ancient remains. The building seems to have been curtailed from its original dimensions, leaving a ruined portion: still standing on its southern side. The entire structure contains — seventeen stone pillars, eight of which exhibit ormmamental carvings and probably belonged to a Buddhist chaitya. There are also eight. capitals inserted in the walls without shafts and bases, and in addition there are fragments of other capitals in various places. None of these old remains are in situ. They were brought, most probably, from — some temple in the neighbourhood, perhaps indeed from the mound occupied by the ruins of the Buddhist Chaitya No. L, which is not: far off. i Ancient Mound or Ridge running from the Burna, near its confluence, | into the Adampura Mahalla. This very remarkable ridge extends for a long distance, and com-) mences at the river Burna when at its flood. In the dry season therefore there is a stretch of low land lying between its extremity SHON ROKOKS EA PLATE VIL@ JOURNAL A PRT, by yy L Black: Co Dithrs:Caleulla’ lographed by We Grant Lsqre VIEW OF BUDDHIST VIHAR-—RAJ GHAUT FORT. a 1866.] Buddhist Monasteries and Temples. 69 in that direction and the bed of the stream itself. The ridge is manifestly an artificial work, and was originally intended either as a wall to the ancient city, or as a rampart thrown up against it and the neighbouring fort of Raj Ghaut. The latter supposition was that held by Mr. James Prinsep, who imagined that it was cast up by the Mohammedans in their attack upon Benares, and was specially directed against the fort. This supposition may be true, although it is difficult to perceive how it could have been of much service either in an attack on the fort or on the city, especially in a period when artillery was not in use. Had it reached as far as the river Ganges, we could understand how, by severing the fort from the city, it might have been a source of damage to both, but the south-western extremity is not near the Ganges by a third of a mile or perhaps more. We are inclined to think, however, that this extremity was once connected with that river, but at a time far more ancient than the Mohammedan conquest of India. On the whole, it appears not unlikely that this long embankment was the old boundary of the city in the early periods of its history, which was possibly employed for offensive purposes by the Mohammedans on the extension of the city to the south and south-west, and the consequent abandonment of this means of defence by the inhabitants. The embankment may have been originally carried on to the Ganges in a straight line with its present direction; or, making a short circuit, may have entered it by Tilia Nala, on the banks of which are the remains of a Buddhist temple, which will be hereafter described. In this case, a portion of it must have been thrown down and swept away to make room for the growth of the city, and there is good ground for supposing that the city extended in a narrow band on the banks of the Ganges, about as far as the Man-mandil observatory, even before the Christian era. Should this idea be correct, it would follow that the most ancient site of the city of Benares was situated within the limits of this wall, stretching across from the Burna to the Ganges, cutting off a tongue of land as far as the confluence of the two rivers, and including the high land of the Raj Ghaut Fort, which was, in all “probability, once well populated. The city must have been then of small extent, as compared with its existing dimensions, unless, as we 10 70 Description of Ancient Remains of [No. 2, believe, and as it is almost indisputably certain, it crossed over to the right bank of the Burna. That both sides of the river Burna were in former days better inhabited than at present, is somewhat corroborated by an examin- ation of the ground on both sides. Brick debris is scattered about among the fields on the right bank of this stream, and old coins and broken stone images are occasionally found by the people, or are dug up by the plough ; while on the other, or Benares side, not only are old remains found in the fort, but also below it on the lowland already referred to, blocks of stone, some of which are carved and exhibit ancient mason marks engraved upon them, are still to be seen: Moreover, it is stated in the Ceylon Annals that formerly the city surrounding Sarnath, (about three miles from the right bank of the Burna,) coalesced with or was a part of Benares, which, if true, must have been at a period of remote antiquity. Indeed, the allusion in these records is to an epoch long anterior to that of the historical Buddha or Sakya Muni, and therefore prior to the sixth century before Christ. This account must of course be received with much caution, and not as absolutely authentic’ history. At the same time, it is manifest that there was a tradition amongst the Buddhists of India, conveyed thence by their missionaries to Ceylon, that in remote ages the city of Benares extended to Sarnath. In visiting this ridge or embankment, it will be observed that the high road leading to Raj Ghaut cuts right through it, the earth of the cutting being used to raise the road above the level of the country, It is well to remark too that where the road passes under the fort to the ghaut, the soil has been cut away to make room for it, so that formerly we may suppose that instead of a steep and almost preci- pitous wall which the elevated land to the east of the road now exhibits, the mound of the fort in this direction dimirfished in a gradual slope, terminating perhaps not far from Tilia Nala. ° The ridge is in one part formed of three terraces, the uppermost being perhaps thirty feet above the land, upon which elevated spot is the tomb of Mira Sahib. In the mutiny a large portion of the mound opposite the Fort was cut away for strategical reasons, although what is left is sufficient to prove of great service to an enemy attacking the fort. 1866.] Buddhist Monasteries and Temples. 71 On the south side of the ridge, in sight of Mira Sahib’s tomb, is an Imambara, a modern edifice, built altogether of new materials ; and a few paces distant from it are two small structures, one in front of the other, which, although of recent erection, are partly composed of old materials. Each building possesses four ancient pillars of the Buddhist type, and lying about in various places are four pillars more, five kulsees, two architraves, and seven bases, one of the latter being richly carved. All these are the spoils of some ancient temple or monastery. Remains of Buddhist Chaitya, No, IT., and Buddhist Monastery, No. I1., at Tilia Nald and Magdum Sahib. We have chosen to unite these remains, and to speak of them under one head, because, although separated and standing in different Mahallas, yet they are near enough together to give rise to the sup- position, that they may have been at one time connected. There is no question in our minds that at least one monastery stood in this neighbourhood, which is very rich in old carved fragments of stone scattered about amongst the walls and foundations of dwelling-houses and in divers other places. Perhaps it may be questioned whether the ruins at Tilia Nalé, now forming part of a deserted mosque, were originally a portion of a monastery or a portion of a temple, but our own opinion is in favour of the latter ; yet even though this conjecture were true, it would still be probable that the temple was within the precincts of a large monastery and was considered to be a portion of it. The remains at Tilia Nala are immediately above the Nala on the high ground of its left bank, a very short distance only from the point where it runs into the Ganges, and close to the main street under which the stream flows. The ruins not only overhang the brook, but there is no doubt that at one time they must have extend- ed nearly, if not entirely, across its present bed. They consist of Seventeen massive square columns in three rows, namely four double columns in the front row, four single ones in the second, and five in the third or innermost row. Between the third and fourth pillars of the last row is the Singhasan of Buddha, an immense slab of stone, nine feet three inches in length and five and a half in breadth, retreat- ing beyond the boundary wall behind, into which all the pillars of 72 Description of Ancient Remains of [No. 2, this row are inserted. There can be no dispute that the Singhasan was in the centre of the building, that is to say, that as there are three pillars to the right of it, there were as many to the left, in each of the three rows, the front row being of double pillars through- out. Re-constructing the edifice as it originally stood, therefore, there were one row of six double pillars, and two rows of six single pillars, or twenty-four pillars in all. Each capital is ornamented with the bell pendant, of which the Buddhists were so passionately fond, and which was after them much used by the Brahmins. ‘The double ~ columns are surmounted by one huge capital, five feet and a half in breadth, each of which possesses a long arm for the eaves stone. Over the two inner rows are two domes, one of which is above the Singhasan, and is more ornamented than the other. There must have been originally a third dome to the left of the central dome, corre- sponding to that on the right. Outside the building there is a fine basement moulding which doubtless belonged to the primitive struc- ture. Hstimating the building as it once stood, it was fully fifty-four feet in length and about twenty-four in breadth. The Mussulmans may have altered it considerably in transforming it into a mosque, but we apprehend that not a little of the old temple still remains. Some ofthe large stones have fallen into the Nala or upon its banks, and others have not unlikely been made use of in the repairs of the bridge, and of its adjoining stone wall, so that we believe it would not be a difficult task to find nearly all the missing pillars and capitals. The Maqdum Sahib is a square enclosure in the Gulzar Mahalla near to Tilia Nalé, used by the Mohammedans as a cemetery. On its northern and western sides are cloistered pillars, partially in situ, with portions of ancient stone eaves overhanging their capitals, presenting on their upper surface imitations of wood-carving. There are twenty-five pillars on the western side, and twenty-eight, or, if all could be seen, probably thirty-two, on the northern side. Several of the pillars are carved ; while some of the capitals are ornamented, and some are double. There may be seen also handsomely carved stone brackets for the support of the eaves above alluded to. The eastern — wall bounding the enclosure is evidently composed, to some extent, g of cut stones of an ancient date. The entire court is one hundred feet long from east to west, and sixty feet broad from north to south, ’ OURNAL AS: SOC: XXXV. PI. PLATE VI ROUGH PLAN OF TILIA NALA VIHAR CHAITYA Seale 12 feet =1 inch. eR. Oe to STAMOING i! pot : F Enelosing-wall SB thick with 9 inches of each~pillar butt into tt. Outside measurements 54-. 5". 0. by 24. Belween sh afte of colemne Bf” Double colurmns capitals with’ long arn for eaves store 5. 6 "in one/ pee, Suge of all shafts 78 unches SIUATE. PORTION OF CAPITAL SCROLL ON CAPITAL. LONG ARM OF DOUBLE CAPITAL, SECTION OF BEAM 2 TO GcCait. ae ep ee ER =e oie A, 1866.] Buddhist Monasteries and Temples. 75 Site or Bupputist Vinar—No. III. Ldit Bhairo. At the junction of the old Ghazeepore road with the Raj Ghaut road, to the north of the latter, and about a short mile from the fort, is a large square tank, on the left bank of which, as on a terrace, stands the /dt or pillar, which gives the name to the spot. It is pro- bably not more than three or four feet high inside, and is covered with copper sheeting. We endeavoured to prevail on the faqir resid- ing here to permit us to lift up the copper cap, by removing the plaister which connects it with the flooring below, in order to gain a view of the stone pillar which it now conceals; but so great is the reputed sanctity of this object, that our united efforts were entirely fruitless, and had we persisted in them, a disturbance might have been oceasion- ed. The original stone ‘column, of which the concealed pillar is doubtless a small fragment, was about forty feet high, and, it is re- ported, was covered with ancient carvings, which were most probably inscriptions. This was thrown down by the Mahommedans during a terrible conflict with the Hindu population in the early part of the present century, when Mr. Bird was magistrate of the city. The natives say, that the pillar was thrown into the Ganges, but as that stream is half a mile off or more, this must have been done piecemeal. In all likelihood it was destroyed by fire, the action of which on sandstone soon causes it to crumble to pieces. As there is strong reason for believing that this was one of Asoka’s pillars, it would be exceedingly interesting to inspect the remaining fragment, which we may fairly suppose to belong to the original column, and in that case to possess a portion of an inscription sufficient to verify its connexion with Asoka, or with the Guptas, or with the monarchs of any other era by whom the column was erected, It is important in our present investigations to know that the pillar once stood in the midst of a temple, that is, in its courtyard, which temple was destroyed by Aurungzebe, and on its site a mosque was erected, the courtyard of which enclosed the pillar. On examin- ing the terrace where the Lat stands, it is exceedingly manifest that the upper portion has. been thrown up in modern times, and that the ancient level of the ground was some six or eight feet lower than 74 Description of Ancient Remains of , [Norz, what it now is, and indeed was even with the soil of the Mahomme- dan cemetery close by, in the midst of which are a few Buddhist remains in the shape of pillars and architraves made up into a Mahommedan sepulchre. What this so-called temple was, admits of very little question, inasmuch as the boundary walls of the terrace and of the neighbouring cemetery and garden exhibit a considerable variety of isolated carved remains, sufficient to afford abundant attes- tation to the supposition that formerly a large Buddhist structure, most probably a monastery with a temple connected with it, stood on — this site, covering the whole extent of the ground elevated above the tank on its northern side. Some of the carvings are in excellent pre- servation, and are worthy of being removed to the archeological collection in the Government college grounds in Benares. There are several pillars embedded in the brickwork, and also a stone seven feet in length and one and a half in depth, which is deserving of special — remark, as on its face are projected four magnificent bosses, each ten inches in diameter, with a projection of two inches from the surface of the stone. These bosses must have formed part of the decoration — over the main entrance to the monastery. Below the upper terrace on which the Lat stands, is, as already observed, a Mohammedan cemetery with a Rauza or tomb in the middle. This building rests upon sixteen pillars, each being eight feet two inches in height, and the architraves between their capitals | being one foot two inches in thickness. In addition, there are five pillars in the verandah to the south. Some of the pillars are orna- mented with scroll-work and the lotus plant, while their four corners © are deeply cut with representations of the lotus seed-pod. One pillar — has eight sides in its lowest division and sixteen in its upper, and has also a band of four grinning faces connected together, and under them a row of beaded garlands. The pillar is crowned with a round stone. projecting two inches, on the face of which is a curious assemblage of thirty-two grotesque faces all round the edge of the stone, with beaded garlands and tassels depending, issuing from their mouths. It should be mentioned, that if our conjecture, that the upper ter- race has been only recently thrown up, be correct, then on the suppo- sition that the fragmentary pillar on its summit is part of the original pillar which in ancient times stood here, it would follow that the 1866. ] Buddhist Monasteries and Temples. 75 length of the existing fragment is equal to the depth of the terrace above the foundations of the neighbouring cemetery, in addition to its present elevation above the terrace, and to the extent of insertion of its lower extremity in the primitive but now subjacent soil. In this case, it would be not less than from fourteen to sixteen feet in length. Buppuist Cuartya—No. III. Battis Khambha. About a third of a mile to the east of the Bakarya Kund Remains, is a beautiful little structure called by the natives Battis Khambha or thirty-two pillars. It is a very picturesque object as seen from the Raj Ghat road, from which it is some four hundred yards distant. It consists of a dome sustained by twenty-four square pillars, standing in pairs at intervals all round. Formerly each corner had four pillars, thus increasing the present number by eight, and then, of course, the entire number was thirty-two; but two from each corner have been removed, leaving the spaces occupied by them empty. All the upper part of the building is Mohammedan, while all the lower part is indisputably Buddhist in its style of architecture. On the western side is an abutment for the Singhasan of Buddha, similar to that which exists in the Chaitya at Bakarya Kund, and indeed, so far as our knowledge extends, in all bond fide Buddhist temples. The pillars stand upon a platform raised above the ground, and in the interior of the building is a Mohammedan tomb. _ It is remarkable that there should be so many ancient remains lying almost in a straight line from Bakarya Kund to the Raj Ghat fort, yet most of the remains hitherto referred to, lie in this line. We have no doubt that formerly a large number of Buddhist buildings existed between these two extremes, and that the foundations of some of them might be discovered, if a keen search were instituted, in addi- ion to the more prominent remains already brought to notice. It seems evident therefore that there was a road here during the Bud- dhist period, not far removed from the track of the present one. This road was at right angles to another proceeding from Bakarya Kund in the direction of Sarnath, which still exists. Search might be made along this road for the foundations of ancient buildings and 76 Description of Ancient Remains of [No. 2, for Buddhist relics, as there can be no doubt that constant commu- nication was kept up by the monks of Sarnath with Bakarya Kund, in both which places there were vast monastic edifices and numerous temples. | Near this Chaitya and between it and Bakarya Kund is a small building standing by the road side, in which are several pillars of the most ancient type inserted into the containing walls. They have been very probably brought from Bakarya Kund. The building has an unpretending appearance, and is kept whitewashed by the Moham- medans, its proprietors. Buppuist Vinar—No. IV. Arhai Kangura Mosque. It is not our purpose thoroughly to describe this handsome struc-— ture, which is one of the finest mosques in the whole city, and is — situated in the Mahalla bearing its own name. Its magnificent and lofty dome, as well as various parts of the mosque itself, unquestion- ably exhibit a Mohammedan style of architecture, but we have no - hesitation in saying that by far the greater portion of the building, © and certainly five-sixths of its materials, belong to an epoch far more distant than the Mahommedan invasion. The numerous square columns with their cruciform capitals, and also the screens between some of them in the upper story, are of Buddhist workmanship ; but we are inclined to think that both Buddhists and Hindus have made use of the same materials in different eras, and that in fact the mosque is a mixture of three styles, namely Buddhist, Hindu, and Moham- medan. The first edifice was, we believe, a monastery, with (most probably) one or more temples attached ; but it is hard to say whether any portion of the original building exists in situ, and we have not sufficiently examined it to be able to pronounce a decided opinion on the point. Our conviction, however, is that certain leading character- istics of the first structure were perpetuated by the Hindus in that which they raised on the departure, or rather expulsion, of the Bud- dhists from Benares. It is not easy to determine accurately what this Hindu building was, but perhaps it is more likely to have been a math or a sort of monastery or religious house for Hindu ascetics, such as exist in the land at the present day, than a temple. In the 1866.] Buddhist Monasteries and Temples. 17 roof of the second story of-the mosque a slab was discovered bearing a long Sanscrit inscription, towards the end of which is the date 1248, which, regarded as Sambat, is equivalent to A. D. 1190. The inscrip- tion itself is of no particular importance, except that it abounds with references to the Hindu religion, showing that it belonged to a build- ing erected by a Hindu, and therefore subsequent to the Buddhist period. It alludes also to certain tanks, temples, and maths, erected and embellished in and about Benares, which of course were all in honour of Hinduism. It is not unlikely indeed that these structures were erected and this inscription was written with somewhat of a religio-political object, to testify to the triumph which Hinduism had then recently gained over Buddhism; for there is good ground for believing that the buildings at Sarnath were not burnt, and the monks were not expelled therefrom, till about the twelfth century of our era. We have obtained a copy of the inscription in Sanscrit, with a trans- lation into Hindi, through the kindness of Babu Shio Parshad, Joint Inspector of Schools, whose intelligence, enterprise, and extensive knowledge place him in the front rank of native gentlemen in these provinces. We would direct especial attention to the small side door or postern with its massive wall, to the right of the building, which has a great appearance of originality, and also to two noble capitals of gigantic dimensions, lying in the court-yard in front of the mosque and turned into small cisterns. They are the largest carved capitals we have found anywhere. Hinpv Tempe or Kirt Bisnesnwar. Alamgiri Mosque. Near the temple of Briddhkal, one of the very few Hindu temples of the earlier Mohammedan period still standing in Benares not appropriated by the Mussalmans, and a few paces from the well- known shrine of Rattaneshwar, is a mosque spoken of in the neigh- bourhood as the Alamgiri Masjid, which was erected during the reign of Aurungzebe or Alamgir, and was designated after that emperor. Upon it may be read the following inscription in Arabic :— ply | ome | 2.0 Sha 3 J? Care” [eV aie u : 18 Description of Ancient Remains of [No. 2, The translation of which is, “Turn your face towards the sacred mosque. 1077 Higira,” or A. D. 1659. The mosque is built, tradition states, from the materials of the Hindu temple of Kirt Bisheshwar, and has three rows of lofty stone pillars, eight in each row ; but the pillars at both extremities are not single, but three-fold. The capitals are large and massive, and are cruciform in shape. In the centre of each shaft, upon all the four sides, is the boss ornamentation, each boss being fully afoot in diameter. The pillars have a double base, a false and a true, the one consisting of the lower end of the shaft, the other, the true base, of a separate stone. Both are covered with carvings. Some of the architraves also bear upon them the boss pattern; but it is possible that these were formerly shafts of pillars. The inner wall of the mosque is likewise of stone. Viewed from behind, many of the blocks display various — mason marks inscribed upon them. From an examination of the marks or symbols, and of the archi- tecture represented by the remains now briefly described, there is no reason for supposing that the temple which once stood here, and which was levelled to the ground by Aurungzebe, was of great antiquity. The style of architecture has a Buddhist basis, yet is not purely Buddhist, and the symbols are not necessarily Buddhist at all. We should be inclined to fix the date of the Hindu temple at some five or six centuries ago. It must have been a place of great sanctity, as many Hindus still visit the spot on pilgrimage, and instead of an image (which we suppose the Mohammedans would not allow them to put up) worship the spout of a fountain rising up in the centre of a small tank in the court-yard of the mosque. It is not improbable that the tank is the site of the old temple; but if the temple was a large one, as is likely, it must have occupied not only a considerable © portion of the present courtyard but also some. ground in addition on either side. A few persons perform their devotions in the tank daily, but the grand festival is at the Shio rdt mela, for one day i March, when crowds throng reverently around the sacred spout, and present 2¢ (or perhaps regarding it as a god, they would say him, or her,) with abundant offerings, all of which, down to the last rupee, are received by the Mullah of the mosque, who thinks, we suppose, that if he winks at the idolatry, which in fact he cannot put down, he may as well be paid handsomely for it, 1866. ] Buddhist Monasteries and Temples. 79 Attached to the mosque is a corridor, built a few years later, on the inner wall of which is the following inscription :— ee b lay od) Uy BhuKete AHA cory aliot wo sine Bi yg) lyreinls fost SY 0 MEY, se GidS uly HS 0 pd (sre? 194 die In noticing the remains of the Kirt Bisheshwar temple, we are cil wleaT oles coils hells le dea”? acs slp" oT? 5,6 IOI reetd slQild sly - # * * aware that they do not come under the designation of “old” or “ancient,” as applied to other remains described in this paper, and yet, as they are not without interest, we have given them a place in it. , Buppuist Caarrya—No. IV. Chaukhambha Mosque. The long Chaukhambha street in the city of Benares, in or about which most of the great bankers have their houses of business, takes its name from four low massive pillars of modern erection, standing in the lowermost story of a lofty building, the weight of which they entirely sustain, situated towards its north-eastern extremity. There is a narrow court running out of this street, which terminates in a small enclosure, on the further side of which is a mosque. The entire enclosure has a very remarkable appearance, and, for the archeologist, is a place of considerable interest. The entrance is by a doorway let into a huge breastwork or wall formed of blocks of stone, which is twenty feet long, thirteen feet high, and four feet thick, and is constructed for the most part systematically, as is evident from the ornamentation on one stone answering to that on the stone contiguous to it. Over the doorway is an inscription in Arabic. But with the exception of this doorway and the castellated appear- ance crowning the wall, there is nothing Mohammedan in its archi- tecture. The mosque and corridor adjoining it are supported by twenty-four pillars, of which six are double. The capitals are of the simple eruciform pattern, and their outer limbs are decorated with the dwarf bell ornamentation. To the south of this building is a staircase 80 Description of Ancient Remains of [No. 2, leading up to the roof, built of heavy stones; and along the south side of the enclosure, for the space of about twenty-five feet, is a low stone wall six feet in height, and, attached to it, a peculiar ledge three feet from the ground. It is known that a similar wall exists on the north side also, but hidden from view. In our judgment most of the pillars are in situ, and originally formed part of a Buddhist structure, but whether of a temple or of a monastery, it is difficult to say. Our opinions are divided 6n the subject, and the former has been assigned to the building by way of a heading to this chapter. The wall with the projecting bench is very curious. The latter may have been used by the priests or monks for reclining upon. Bouppuist Vindr—No. V. Aurungzebe’s Mosque near Bisheshwar Temple. The mosque built by the emperor Aurungzebe on the foundations of what is commonly regarded, though erroneously, as the old or original Bisheshwar temple, is of interest not for its own sake—for — notwithstanding its lofty appearance, it is a a structure without any striking beauty in its own right—but for the sake of the ancient buildings with which it is associated, and with the materials of which it has been largely constructed. The courtyard consists of a terrace raised some five feet above the level of the temple quadrangle, in the centre of which it is situated, and occupying a large portion of the area. On walking round the quadrangle and examining the retaining wall of the terrace, one’s attention is arrested by peculiar openings or niches in the wall, in which architraves, and capitals, and parts of pillars on which they rest, are visible, but in some places the openings are filled with earth almost up to the level of the capitals. Proceed- ing from west to east, the ground gradually declines, until, after descending four steps and arriving opposite a large stone bull or Nandi, the opening in the terrace becomes clear, and.a cloister, such as surrounds a Buddhist vihar, comes into view, and reveals the character of the entire series. It consists of a small chamber sustained by genuine Buddhist pillars, severely simple in their type, and without doubt of great antiquity. Formerly a succession of such cloisters: encompassed not less than three sides of the existing terrace, which 1866.] - Buddhist Monasteries and Temples. 81 must consequently date from the same epoch. It would be desirable, if the consent of the Mohammedans could be obtained, to remove the external wall by which these cloisters have become almost completely hidden, in order to ascertain what is their extent and condition. This series of cloisters formed the lowermost story of a large Buddhist monastery, which once enclosed the entire space occupied by the terrace, and rose to the height of probably two or three stories above it. On the southern side stood the chief chaitya or temple, which, on the suppression of Buddhism, passed into the hands of the advocates of another religion, who transformed it according to their own tastes. The mosque on this side is altogether composed of the remains of an ancient temple of large dimensions, and of very elaborate workmanship. The high pillars, moreover, on its northern face have been abstracted from the same spacious building. These remains are partly Hindu, and it is unquestionable that the edifice which was destroyed in order to make way for the mosque, was an old temple of Bisheshwar. An excellent ground plan of this temple, prepared from a minute examination of the existing remains, was drawn by Mr. James Prinsep, and published by him in his “ Views of Benares.”’ These remains, however, are only partially Hindu. Some portions, judging from the elaborate ornamentation of certain details which it was the custom of the Buddhist architects to leave plain, seem to be of Jain origin, and to have been appropriated by the builders of the Hindu temple. If this supposition be correct, the mosque with its terrace exhibits a singular architectural ano- maly, and presents us with no less than four styles, namely Bud- dhist, Jain, Hindu and Mohammedan. Indeed it would not be wrong to add a fifth style, for the square terrace pillars with their cruciform capitals are so simple in structure, that, compared with the highly carved and decorated pillars of medieval and later Buddhist history, they belong to another style, which may be called early Buddhist or Hindu, according to which of these two ancient religious communities is supposed to have invented it. It is not our object to discuss the interesting and also important topic, who were the first Indian sculptors and builders of permanent works, yet it is one which must one day, when materials have been sufficiently accumulated, which they have not been at present, be thoroughly investigated. 82 | Descrption of Ancient Remains of [No. 2, When this is settled, the antiquity and origin of these terrace pillars will be settled likewise. Buppuist Vinkr—No. VI. Ad-Bisheshwar Temple and neighbouring Mosque. Ad-Bisheshwar is the name of a lofty temple situated a short distance from Aurungzebe’s mosque just referred to, and in sight of it, and is held to be, by some persons, the original or most ancient temple of this deity. The derivation of its name only bears out this supposition, for the temple itself, from the pinnacle to the base, has nothing really ancient about it. On the eastern side of the enclosure the ground takes a sudden rise of eighteen feet, forming a terrace manifestly of artificial construction. On this side there is a retaining wall of stone masonry, which is wanting on the southern side of the terrace, where there is only an earthen bank. The other two sides of the terrace are covered with - buildings, which prevent the exact ascertainment of its boundary in these directions. On that flank which is contiguous to the Ad-Bisheshwar enclosures, stands a mosque erected some eighty years ago or less, but not finished then, for want of money. It was built of stones found on the spot, with new Chunar slabs added. The terrace existed before with the but- tress, and is evidently of ancient construction. The building is in two divisions, each of which is 232 feet in length, connected together by a massive wall 53 feet thick, composed of large blocks of stone. This wall projects considerably beyond the — building into the courtyard to the east, and has the appearance of a huge buttress; but what its object is, seeing that the mosque, which is entirely of stone, is amply sustained by its columns and walls, and — requires no such additional support, it is hard to say. Possibly the buttress is pierced with a staircase, leading formerly to an upper story which the buttress supported, and the Mohammedan architects, not caring to remove the massive prop, have retained it in the mosque. — They appear, moreover, to have confined themselves chiefly to mate- rials lying upon the spot, as in three places carved pillars, similar to those sustaining the centre aisle, have been adopted as architraves. — There are fourteen columns in the interior of the mosque, which are peculiarly but not extensively carved, and are crowned with orna-— 1866. ] Buddhist Monasteries and Temples. 83 mented capitals. The western wall is strengthened externally by three rounded buttresses, which are of the Pathan dynasty, like those found at Jaunpore, and were built at the same time. They did not exist in the Buddhist period, and were added as much for ornament as strength. All the mosques about old Delhi have them. There is no doubt in our minds that the Ad-Bisheshwar temple stood on this site, and was destroyed by the Mohammedans, who, as usual, transferred its stones to their own mosque. The neighbouring temple bearing this name, the Hindus built, with the kind permission of their friends, the Mohammedans, of course, for the purpose of perpetuating the worship and the honour of their old idol, Ad-Bish- eshwar. Yet, while allowing that the edifice standing on the site of the present mosque when the Mohammedans took possession of it, was the temple of Ad-Bisheshwar, we are nevertheless equally certain that the primitive building was of a Buddhist character. We were inclined at one time to imagine that, from its proximity to the Buddhist Vihar No. V., it must have been a part of that monastery, but two reasons have led us to abandon that idea. One is, that a separate terrace of extensive dimensions .was appropriated to this structure, whatever it was, and that between this terrace and that of No. V., the ground is depressed corresponding to the depression of all the neighbouring soil; and the second is, that the style of architecture of the ancient buildings upon or around the two terraces, differs exceedingly. We are led to conjecture, therefore, that the original structure was a Buddhist monastery, but later in date by several hundred years than the first monastery erected on the terrace No. V. It was of course a quadrangle, encompassing the four sides of the terrace. Nothing remains of it except the massive transverse wall with the buttress, and the lower portion of the retaining wall. The mosque has been erected perhaps on the site of the principal cloister of the monastery, its second division occupying the position of a Smaller cloister. The amount of stone material expended on the present comparatively small building is preposterously great, and in itself is a proof that an edifice of much larger dimensions formerly stood here. 84 Description of Ancient Remains of [No. 2, Stone Prupar. Sond-kd-Talao. Before closing this paper, we would direct attention to a stone pillar standing in the midst of a tank between the city of Benares and the Buddhist remains at Sarnath. The tank is called Sond-ké- Talao, or the Golden Tank, and is situated on the opposite side of the river Burna, near the road which branches off from the high road. leading to Ghazeepore, and almost close to the point of its junction with several other roads. The road is a portion of the Panch-kosi or sacred boundary of Benares. Proceeding along it for somewhat less than a mile, you arrive at the tank, which is to the right of it, and is approached by a strong and well built ghaut, on which are several Buddhist figures, brought most probably from Sarnath. It is three hundred yards in length, and one hundred and forty in breadth. In the midst of it is a round pillar, eighteen feet high and upwards of nine in circumference, composed of great blocks of stone cut in quadrants and put together without cement or mortar. There is no inscription on the pillar, and no mason marks, so that we have been totally unable to assign any date, even approximately, to its — erection. Its base is always, we believe, surrounded by water; yet it would be worth while to ascertain whether any inscription exists below. We probed it to its foundations, but found no face for an in- scription. Itis likely that both the pillar has somewhat sunk, and that formerly the tank was less choked with mud than it is now. In appearance therefore the pillar was once higher than at the present time. It was probably surmounted formerly by a lion or some other _ figure, and on close examination bears marks of extreme old age. Besides allusions to a few other ancient structures, we have in this paper traced out remains, more or less abundant, of six Buddhist vihars or monasteries and four Buddhist chaityas or tem- ples, still existing in Benares, and have pointed out the sites on which they stood or are still standing. Add to these the remains at Bakarya Kund already described in a former paper, and we have the remains of seven monasteries and at the least seven chaityas. The monasteries are doubtless- a portion of the thirty - monasteries and upwards which Hwan Thsang, the Chinese traveller 1866.] Buddhist Monasteries and Temples. 85 of the seventh century, said existed in Benares in his day. In con- clusion, we may remark that we are much inclined to believe that many of the ancient Buddhist monasteries; and of the temples also, were on a line of road leading from Bakarya Kund to Raj Ghaut Fort in one direction ; on a second line, at right angles to this, ranning from Bakarya Kund to Sarnath ; and on a third, proceeding from the site of Aurungzebe’s mosque and joining one or both the others, possi- bly, at Bakarya Kund, and that hereabouts most of other remains of such buildings, if found at all, will be discovered. Note by the Rev. MW. A. Sherring. Since the above was written, I have visited and examined the country lying on the banks of the Ganges to the north of the river Burma. To my utter astonishment, though I must confess, not con- trary to my anticipation, I found brick and stone debris scattered over the fields for, as far as I could conjecture, five miles or there- abouts. In many places the rubbish lies thick upon the ground, chok- ing up the soil, and to a large extent the deposit can be traced con- tinuously. Here and there small bits of sculptured stone are visible, and occasionally, where the broken bricks and stones are in very great abundance, they have been collected into ridges or small mounds. This is especially manifest at the termination of the deposit at a spot called Patharaké Siwdu, where, in ancient times, doubtless stood a large fort, of which the foundations may even now be partially traced. Although the fields beyond this point seem to be clear of rubbish, yet further on, at Muskabad, at the distance of a mile, it recommences and becomes as thick as in any other place. Perhaps this latter was the site of an outlying town. But what are we to say of these remains? They lie immediately on the great river’s bank, and never retreat from it more than three quarters of amile. It is, I think, very evident that all the way from the mouth of the Burna this bank has been, with the lapse of cen- turies, considerably cut away. Indeed, I believe, that as much as a quarter of a mile may have gone into the river. In all probability therefore the space covered by debris was much broader than it is at present. There can be no question, however, that here a great city once stood. I have no hesitation in expressing my belief that in the 12 86 Description of Ancient Buddhist Remains. [No. 2, entire absence of any bond fide Hindu remains in the present city of Benares, dating from even the Buddhist period, not to speak of the pre-Buddhist epoch, when we know from historical records that Benares was in existence, the ancient city of the pre-Buddhist and early Buddhist eras must have occupied this site. Beyond the north- ern extremity of the remains of the ancient city is a series of mounds also covered with debris, tending in a north-westerly direction, where formerly forts or towns existed. I think it not unlikely that in a far distant age the connexion of the ancient city of Benares with Sarnath was along the course of these mounds. Sarnath is spoken of in the Ceylon records as though it may have been a city of itself ; and there is no doubt that it is referred to in ancient documents as a part of Benares. Now, modern Benares is at least one-third of a mile to the south of the Burna, whereas Sarnath is out in the country about three miles to the north of that stream. If we suppose, however, that Benares, in its most ancient period, was mainly on the north side of the Burna likewise, and if such supposition is corroborated by exten- sive remains of ancient buildings m the shape of brick and stone debris stretching over several miles of country, as already shown, and terminating in mounds lying in the direction of Sarnath, the proof approaches to demonstration that in that early epoch a union, more or less intimate, existed between Sarnath and Benares, as stated by histo- rical records. JE had no opportunity to examine thoroughly the coun- try lying between these remains and Sarnath, but I feel satisfied that at some point in these remains a line of debris would be found con- necting the two spots, with only a few breaks in its course, the debris indicating the former existence of solid buildings and being the broken remains of the same. This point must not be searched for at the southern extremity of the ancient city, but at the northern extre- mity ; and- perhaps the line of junction may be the line of the mounds just now referred to; but of this Tam not able to speak positively. Tf these observations respecting the site of the early city be correct, it would follow that the derivation of the word Benares, as the city lying between the Burna and the Assi, is utterly absurd, as applied to the most ancient city. That it is a correct derivation of the word, as denoting the city of modern times even as far back as the Gupta dynasty, and perhaps somewhat further, I have not the smallest 1866. ] A ssyo-Pseudo-Sesostris. 87 doubt. But Bandr-assi has nothing whatever to do with ancient Benares, and as applied to it would be a ludicrous misnomer. It seems, indeed, probable that the Buddhists were the first people to occupy to any extent the southern side of the Burna, and such a notion is remarkably substantiated by the existence of various Bud- dhist remains there, as described in this paper; but none of them, so far I know, date from earlier than the Gupta period. The Panch- kosi road or sacred boundary of modern Benares, nearly fifty miles in extent, and regarded by many natives as of immense antiquity, 1s no older than the city which it encompasses, and must also be assigned to a comparatively recent date. Many pleasant and perhaps hallowed associations connected with Benares, as it now stands, will in the minds of multitudes be in danger of being snapped asunder, when they discover that the Benares of to-day: was not the Benares which their forefathers knew. Assyro-Pseudo-Sesostris.—By Hypr Criarge, Esq. Member of the Ger- man Oriental Society, of the Society of Northern Antiquaries of Copenhagen, of the Academy of Anatolia, of the Institution of Engineers of Vienna, Local Secretary of the Anthropological Society, [Received 13th July, 1865. Read 2nd August, 1865. ] As the monument near Ninfi (the ancient Nympheum), and twenty miles from Smyrna, has of late years become a subject of some controversy, I have been very desirous of getting it photographed, and at length this has been effected (Plate X XI.) by the zeal and ability of Mr. Alexander Svoboda, an artist doubtless remembered by many members of the Society for his paintings of Indian scenes, and his having first photographed the caves of Elephanta and the monument of Ctesiphon, as he has latterly those of Ephesus. Herodotus, in his second book, as is well known, speaks of the foreign wars and expeditions of Sesostris, and says that he erected various monuments of his victories, of which Herodotus had seen one in Syria, and there were two others in Ionia, one on the road from Sardis to Smyrna, and the other on the road from Ephesus to Phocwa, and that 88 Assyro-Pseudo-Sesostris. | [No. 2, the figures, four cubits and a spathamus high, held a bow in one hand and a lance in the other. . The words of Herodotus are :— “The pillars which Sesostris erected in the conquered countries, have for the most part disappeared, but in the part of Syria called Palestine, I myself saw them still standing, with the writing above- mentioned, and the emblem distinctly visible. In Lonia also, there are two representations of this prince engraved upon rocks, one on the road from Ephesus to Phocea, the other between Sardis and Smyrna. In each case the figure is that of a man, four cubits and a span high, — with a spear in his right hand and a bow in his left, the rest of his costume being likewise half Egyptian, half Ethiopian. There is an inscription across the breast from shoulder to shoulder, in the sacred character of Egypt, which says, “‘ With my own shoulders I conquered this land.” The conqueror does not tell who he is, or whence he comes, though elsewhere Sesostris records these facts. Hence it has been imagined by some of those who have seen these forms, that they — are figures of Memnon, but such, as I think so, err very widely from the truth.” r q Diodorus Siculus repeats the like, and says there was an inscription in hieroglyphics on the monument,.of which he gives the trans- lation. a As the monument near Ninfi agrees with the description of Hero- dotus, it is generally believed to be Egyptian, to bear a hieroglyphic ~ inscription, and to be the Sesostris. As will be seen, there arettraces of characters on the right hand corner, though what, cannot be made out, They are exceedingly unlike any hieroglyphic inscription, which will carry the meaning of Diodorus, and the rock is too soft for the minute characters of the hieroglyphic ever to have been caryed upon it. It would not bear even the ring of the cartouche. Who first doubted its Egyptian character, we have not the means here of knowing, but at any rate the geographers Kiepert and Carl Ritter have done so, and in their works the monument is figured aS ** Pseudo-Sesostris,”’ and is placed with the Assyrian class. Unaware of this, some years ago, I visited the monument and arrived at the same conclusions, and I have since endeavoured to obtain the opinions of competent authorities in Europe. This corre= Journal As: Soc: Vol XXXV. Pl. Plate.XX. ACG: eae abe ay eee a, ey, y sa Nrawn.on Stone atthe Gov School of Art, Caluutta hy K FIGURE OF SESOSTRIS AT NINPI LTH BY H.NWVEN SURVEYOR GENENALS OFFICE CALCUTTA AUGUST Ig66 amakha Uhurn Ghose, Student. , - 1866. ] Assyvo-Pseudo-Sesostris. 89 spondence made me more urgent to get it correctly reproduced, and it is satisfactory that at length it can be examined by all interested in the subject, instead of the very few who could reach Ninfi. It is reasonably to be doubted whether Herodotus ever saw this monument, because he has not described it with absolute accuracy. The monument is quite off the road or any Nigh road, and is a very unlikely place for.a public monument of Sesostris. It is on a friable rock, and it is a miracle it has been preserved so many centuries. It was perhaps attached to the country palace of some king or satrap, or it may commemorate a battle fought in the glen. It does not bear the appearance of having been an object of adoration. Its class is not distinctly Assyrian, for it wants the sharp touch of those workmen, and it must always have been of rude appearance. It is allied to the Assyrian, and is the production of some people of Assyrian character. The question arises, whether this monument and the neighbouring Niobe, and the other rock-cut pictures, are the works of settled inhabi- tants, or of an invading or conquering race. The -latter seems to be the preferable hypothesis, because in this district, even in the time of Herodotus, there cannot have been more than three, and there are few scattered over the country. Those in this district most probably belonged to some petty kingdom. With regard to their epoch, they are certainly as old as the Egyp- tian cities in their neighbourhood. ‘These cities there form a close group, Smyrna, Tantalus, Sipylus and Nympheum, attesting at one time a population of large and strong cities and a relative civilization. These cities, as well from identity of remains with those in the South of Europe, as well from the identity of names with those of the Tberian nations, as well as from the fact of their population having endured beyond the Hellenic invasion, I place as anterior to that epoch, and as Iberian in character. This subject I have treated at length in a detailed memoir read before the Academy of Anatolia, the Kthnological Society, and the British Association. The rock-cut monuments must, to some extent, have preceded the Iberian occupation, or may have been the result of an invasion during that period, proceeding from Cilicia and the south east, that 1s, from the Semitic district, 90 nies A ssyro-Pseudo-Sesostris. _[No. 2, As yet the elements for the determination of these pre-historical questions are very few. They are indeed hardly known, and we are not yet in a situation to judge of the ethnology, the monuments, or the mythology either of an earlier or a later age. There are two elements in particular that exercised a great influence over this region, that "have not been adequately studied, the Iberian and the Caucaso-Tibetan. The remarkable discovery of Mr. B. H- Hodgson, communicated to your Society, of a connection between the tribes of the Caucasus and those of the Himalaya and its valleys, opens up new views as to the history of Central and Western Asia, and will in time afford one of the keys for unlocking their secrets, not less valuable perhaps than those applied to hieroglyphics or cuneiform. I was led by a like train of investigations with Mr. Hodgson to the like results, and Iam glad to find that what I have done, has been in confirmation of such an authority. I lately communicated a paper on this subject to the Asiatic Society of London, with the hope of inviting other inquiries. It is perhaps by means of the Caucaso-Tibetan, that we shall obtain a knowledge of the early history of Iranistan, of the influences which have affected so peculiarly the early Indo-Huropeans, the Armenians, the Ossetes and the Koords, of the third arrow-headed, and the Lycian. It is here we shall perhaps find another element in the determin- ation of mythology, though so far as the mythology of these regions is concerned, and particularly its local character, Iberian sources must be searched. It is there we must seek for the explanation of much of the mythology, and not in Sanskrit sources, however plausible such explanations may appear. The Hellenes found a mythology ready made for them in the Iberian countries, in which they settled, and they adopted Iberian terms. To a certain extent, they brought with them Indo-European dogmas, and here Sanskrit philology will help us; but the local colony is Iberian. This western country of Asia Minor was, in fact, the seat of mythology and the land of the gods, before the Hellenes appeared. In some cases an Indo-Huropean legend may have been attached to a local site, but the Hellenes borrowed more than they gave. The Sesostris I propose to designate Assyro-Pseudo-Sesostris, : { 1866.] Notes on some of the temples of Kashmir. 91 Notes on some of the temples of Kashmir, especially those not de- scribed by General A. Cunnineuam, in his Essay published in the Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal for September, 1848.— By W. G. Cowiz, UW. A., Chaplain on duty in Kashnttr, during the summer of 1865. [Received 1st December, 1865. ] In these notes I have followed as nearly as possible the wording of General Cunningham, in his description of the different temples, which he visited in Kashmir. The temples of Bhaniyar, Waugat, Manusbal, Narayan Thal, Futtehghur, Dyamun, and Lidar do not seem to have been described before. What I have said about those of Pandrethan, the Takht, Pathan, Avantiswami, and Marttand, is meant to be supplementary to General Cunningham’s accounts of those temples. BHANIYAR. The buildings at Bhaniyar consist of a lofty central edifice, standing in a large quadrangle, surrounded by a colonnade of fluted pillars with intervening trefoil-headed recesses.* The ground plan of the temple is a square of 264 feet with pilasters at the corners, 4 feet in thickness. The interior is a square of 13} feet, and the walls are therefore 64 feet thick, which proportion may be considered a strong proof, according to General Cunningham’s} theory, of the antiquity of the building. The roof was pyramidal, and the total height of the temple, estimated at twice its breadth, would be 53 feet. The lowest stones of the pyramid remain in some places, and their external slope is parallel to that of the sides of the pediments over the doorways. The only entrance to the temple is gained by a broad and lofty flight of steps to the N.N. W. On each of the other sides there is a porch containing a closed doorway. These porches are just the same as that of the entrance, each being 163 feet wide, with a projection of one foot in advance of the corner pilasters. * See Photograph, No. I.* + See Cunningham, p. 249, para. 6. * The photographs referred to in this paper are by Messrs. Sheppard and Bourne of Simlah.—Eb, / 92 Notes on some of the temples of Kashmir. [No. 2, The doorways are surmounted by trefoiled arches, 23 feet high ; and the latter are covered by pyramidal pediments, resting on in-< dependent pilasters. Within the large trefoiled arches, there are smaller pyramidal pediments, of which the tympanum is occupied with the trefoiled decoration, like that at Bhaumajo,* resting on the architrave covering the pilasters of the doorway. The pilasters at the corners of the building sustain the entablature, and give a look of strength and solidity to the walls, which was absolutely required for the vast and massive roof. In the interior the walls are plain, except that (as at Narayan Thal) a sort of string-course projects all round, about 123 feet from the floor. It is about a foot high, flat above, and rounded below. Over the string-course and resting on it, there is, on each side, a semicircular headed recess, about 3 feet high, 2 feet wide, and 14 feet deep. Only the one at the back of the building, that is, towards the S. 8. E., is pierced for a window, the opening being rectangular, and © about 2 feet high by 1 foot in width. The roof is hollowed out into a hemispherical dome, of which the centre is decorated with an expanded lotus flower, as in the Payach{ temple. The spandrels of the dome are too much injured to show any trace of figures, if any ever existed; but the dome looks as if it were a modern restoration, and the whole is overlaid with thick whitewash, concealing the material of which it is constructed. There were, however, no figures in any other part of the building, except the tympanum of each smaller pediment over the architraves of the doorways; and there the — remains of heads (for such I took one of them to be) are now so much worn away, that it is impossible to say exactly what they represented. The colonnade had no such ornaments.§ (Plate XX.) The basement of the temple is very fine. It is divided into two portions, each having the same style of moulding as that of the Bhaumajo|| basement ; but they differ from it in being further pro- jected beyond the face of the wall. The lower portion is 47 feet square and 5% feet high; and the upper portion 844 feet square and 6 feet high, with a projection of 4 feet. Hach division of the basement has a massive filleted torus as * See Cunningham, plate X. + See below, § See photograph, No. IT. { See Cunningham, plate XI. || See Cunningham, plate VIII. eS 1866. ] Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 93 the crowning member, with a straight fillet above and below. Under this is a dado, or plain straight face, which is a little higher than the torus itself. Beneath the dado, is a quirked ovolo of bold projection surmounted by a straight fillet, and under this is the plinth, of which (as at Bhaumajo) the lower stone projects beyond the upper one. As at Payach too, there is a stone drain or water-spout, open at the top, for carrying off the water used for the service of the temple. It emerges from the building on the W. 8. W. side, and projects slightly beyond the upper basement; the termination of the drain or spout being made to represent the open mouth of a large snake or some other animal. The temple is approached by a flight of twelve steps,* the lower six being 11 feet in width, and the upper six 10 feet, enclosed between sloping walls one foot in thickness. Besides the sloping walls, the lower 6 steps are further supported by flanking walls} (as at Avantis- wara,) nearly 6 feet high and 3,5 feet thick. The temple is enclosed by a pillared quadrangle (Plate [X.) measur- ing inside 145 feet by 1195; feet, the longer sides being to the W. 8. W. and KE. N. E., containing 54 fluted columns. In the middle of the longer sides of the colonnade, and of that in rear of the temple, there is a pair of large fluted pillars, 12 feet in height and 15 inches in diameter, and 10 feet apart, advanced beyond the line of the peristyle a little more than the corresponding pillars at Marttand. On all these columns the transverse architraves, connecting them with the walls of the peristyle, are still standing. The central porticoes, to which these large pillars belong, are not gateways, but lead only to small chambered recesses, similar to, but a little deeper than, those between the other pairs of pillars. There is, however, one flank entrance to the quadrangle, viz., between the third pair of pillars on the EK N. E. side, to the south of the central porch. This has always. been, as it is now, closed with a wooden door. The quadrangle itself originally contained 48 round fluted pillars (of which all but three are still in their places) and six square parallel pillars (disposed in the corners, and on each flank of the gateway) ; which, together with the six pillars of the central porches and the two of the gateway, made up 56 in all. None of the pillars now * See Photograph, No. I. + See Photograph, No. I. 13 | 94 Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. [No. 2, standing seem to have been injured otherwise than by the wear of time and the elements; but from these causes, many of them have now lost all trace of fluting. Lach pillar of the peristyle is 10 feet in height and 13 inches in diameter, with an intercolumniation of 72 feet. Immediately behind each pillar there is a square pilaster % engaged, of the same height as, and with mouldings similar to those of, the square corner pillars. The pilasters are 94 inches distant from the pillars. Between every pair of pillars there is a chambered recess 7 feet by 4 feet, with a trefoil-headed arch covered by a pedi- ment, (which pediment) is supported on small pilasters, or rather upon half* engaged pillars, as at Avantiswémi. The general style of the pillars is similar to that of the Marttand colonnade; but it is impossible to say whether the pedimental pilasters of the intervening recesses were ornamented or not. The trefoiled heads of the recesses are joined to the side mouldings of the openings by short horizontal returns (as at Avantiswami). Hach pillar is connected with its “pilaster and with the main wall by a transverse stone beam, which, being broader at top than at bottom, bears the appearance of an upper capital to the pillar.f ‘‘ The greatest and most characteristic distinc- tion,’ therefore, as General Cunningham says, “‘ between the Arian ’ and Classic orders, lies in the disposition of the architrave. In the latter it lies immediately over the line of pillars, whilst in the former it is placed over the transverse beams.” Nearly all of this entablature still exists, but the building has been so much injured by the weather, that its character can only be conjectured. It seems to have been much the same as the upper part of that given in No. 2, plate VIII. of General Cunningham’s Essay. The upper part of the roof of the quadrangle has entirely disappeared, but there can be little doubt that it was triangular in section. The outer walls of the quadrangle are ornamented by fine deep horizontal bands,§ the intervals being occupied by rectangular figures 18 inches high, 13 inches wide, and 4,5 feet apart, the whole being surmounted by an entablature of the same design as that of the peristyle. The base of the wall is buried deep in accumulated earth * See Cunningham, plate XVIII. + See Cunningham, plate XVIII, and ante Plate IX. p. 92. + See Photograph, (of Marttand colonnade), No. XXIV. § See Photograph, No. III 1866. ] Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 95 and rubbish ; but to the S. W. of the gateway, and on a level with _ the bottom of the fluted torus which crowns its basement, is part of a similar torus,* or string-course, projecting from, and running hori- zoutally along, the face of the wall. This torus no doubt ran along the exterior face of the whole quadrangle, and is probably still in good preservation below the ground. Lastly, the front wall is ornamented at each extremity with a trefoil-headed} recess covered by a pediment, the latter resting on half engaged pillars, which are flanked by square pilasters 4 (one-eighth) engaged, in every way like those of the interior. The quadrangle has had two large wells in the W. S. W. and EK. N. E. corners, probably to supply water for flooding the enclosure; and half way between the steps of the gateway inside and. the steps of the temple there is a square structure of stone, cut away in the centre as if to receive the end of a prop to a raised pathway,} such as that suggested by General Cunningham as the probable con- nection between the gateway and the temple at Marttand. The object of erecting temples in the midst of water appears to him to have been “‘to place them more immediately under the protection of the Nagas, or human-bodied and snake-tailed gods, who were zealously worshipped for ages throughout Kashmir.” The entrance or gateway§ stands in the middle of the N. N. W. side of the quadrangle, and is 255 feet in width, nearly that of the temple itself. Outwardly the gateway somewhat resembles the temple, in the disposition of its parts and in the decorations of its pediments and pilasters. It is open to the N. N. W. and 8. 8S. E., and is divided into two distinct portions by a cross wall 3? feet thick, with a doorway in the centre closed by a wooden door. These inner and outer porticoes of the doorway are each 163 feet wide and 6} feet deep. Their side walls are decorated each with a miniature temple having a square-headed doorway, surmounted by a pyramidal pedi- ment representing a double roof. The tympanum of each compartment of these roofs is occupied with the trefoiled decoration, common to the Kashmirian buildings, resting on the architrave, as in the door- way pediments of the temple itself. The pediment of the gateway, | * See Photograph, No. III. + See Cunningham, p. 270, para. 25 and Photograph, No. IIT. t See Cunningham, page 273, para, ine and page 287, para, 8, § See Photopraph, No, III, 96 Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. [No. 2, outside and in, is supported on half engaged fluted pillars, 16,5, feet high, and 14 inches in diameter. As at Bhaumajo, the base of the tympanum* is reduced to two short returns of the horizontal mouldings of the pediment, eagh of which serves as a sort of upper abacus to the pedimental pilasters. The doorway pilasters, supporting the archi- trave (24 feet high, and broken through as usual in the temples of Kashmir), are as high as the base of the main pilaster capitals, and 41 feet higher than those of the quadrangle. Besides the doorway pilasters, there are two fluted columns of the same height (including a sort of second capital) and 18% inches in diameter, one on each side of the entrance, 72 feet apart, supporting the architrave. The second capital corresponds to the transverse beam of the peristyle connecting the pillar with its pilaster; but here it is detached on all sides. It is cruciform,t and so projects on each side of the capital proper. These columns are distant from the square doorway pilasters respec- tively about one diameter. The roof of the gateway, like that of the temple, has perished; but it was evidently pyramidal, for the corners of the base of the great pediments (outside and in) remain, and their angles are equal to those at the base of the doorway pediments. The basement of the gateway is approached on either side by a flight of six stepst 7% feet wide, supported by flank walls 7# feet in length, and terminating in upright stones,§ each separated by an interval from the main wall, and ornamented with a standing figure, said by the pundits to represent a servant of Siva. The material of which the buildings are constructed, is a pale, coarse granite, of which there seems to be no quarry within reach on the left bank of the Jhelum. This circumstance is remarkable, considering the enormous size and weight of some of the stones employed. Mr. Drew, a geologist in the service of H. H. the Maharajah, thinks that the blocks of granite must have been carried down some of the valleys on the opposite side into the river bed, whence they were brought for the construction of the temple. Mortar has been used in all parts of the buildings. Opposite the gateway, * See Photograph, No. ITI. is + See Photograph, No. III. and Cunningham, pp. 269-70, para. 24, t See Photograph, No. III. § See Photograph, No, III, , 1866. | Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 97 across the road, there is a large cistern, (like that attached to the central temple of the second group of buildings beyond Wangat*), cut out of a single block of granite. It is 6,4 feet long, 5 feet wide, and 2% feet high. There is another cistern} of the same kind, but of smaller dimensions, close by. The Hindoos residing on the spot say that the temple was built by one Bonadutt (hence the name Boonyar), whose brother built or began a temple at Venapoora beyond Sopur. The situation is very fine, in a deodar forest on the left bank of the Jhelum, which roars below as it descends in foaming cataracts. Immediately behind, the pine-clad hills rise precipitously to a great height. About one-third up, there is a strange formation of rock, resembling a human figure, which is said by the pundits to be the petrefaction of an evil spirit, who formerly devoured men and women passing that way. A very holy fakir, they say, fixed the man-eater for ever where the figure is now seen, After carefully examining every part of the Bhaniyar buildings, I am inclined to think that they are older than the quadrangle at Marttand}, and of about the same age as the temples beyond Wangat. They probably owe their escape from the hand of the destroyer to their secluded situation, which is quite off all the old thoroughfares leading from the Punjab to Kashmir, about three miles lower down the Jhelum than Nowshera, on its left bank. I found no trace of an inscription on any of the buildings. TEMPLES AT LIDAR. About half a mile beyond Ladoo, and two miles to the left of the road leading from Pampur to Awantipore, there are two temples, one surrounded by water, (Plate XIV.) and a smaller one, close by, a little higher up the hill side. The ground plan of the former is a square of 24 feet, with corner pilasters 34 feet thick and 6 inches projected. There is only one doorway, to the W. 8. W. Its head is semicircular, with a pyramidal pediment slightly projected and divided into two portions, of which the upper one is plain, and the other is occupied by a semicircular * See below, p. 106. + See Photograph, No, III, t See Cunningham, p. 263, para. 10, * 98 Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir, [No. 2, ornament. The apex of the pediment reaches to the top of the cornice, which runs round the top of the wallson the outside. The roof is entirely gone. The interior is a circle, the diameter of which diminishes from the ground upwards. Four feet from the floor it is 17, feet. There is a cornice 20 inches high, 95, feet above the floor. Its mouldings are the same as those of the lowest course of the cefling of the small temple,* viz. three fillets, like those of the Payach dome,; but that the edge of the middle one is round instead of square. The diameter of the circle formed by the projecting edge of the cornice is 15 feet. The thickness of the wall at the doorway is 32 feet. The wall on the inside shows signs of fire having been oo perhaps to destroy the roof, which may have been of wood. The top of the doorway inside is formed by the underside of the course from which the cornice of the interior is projected. There is a drain on the south side, as at Payach, for carrying off the water used in the services of the temple. The height of the wall outside from the top of the cornice is 104 feet. The corner pilasters stand on a basement 2,5, feet high, and are 63 inches pro- jected beyond the face of the alr (See Plate XIV.) This basement is carried all round the building, except where it is broken by the door- way ; the bottom of the PEAwene being on a level with that of the doorway. The uppermost course of the basement is nearly flush with the corner pilasters, but the next two courses project 55 inches beyond the uppermost one. The basement of the temple stands on a platform 48 feet square, faced with stone walls, forming a sort of lower basement, as at Bhaniyar.t ; The whole stands in the middle of a tank of very clear water? which issues from two springs in the N. E. corner. The tank is now 8 feet deep, but I could not ascertain whether there was a stone bottom below the accumulated mud. The tank has been a square of about 70 feet, with stone walls supporting the bank, now 2 feet above * See below, p. 100. i See Cunningham, Plate XI. and page 258, para. 10, ft See Photograph, ‘No. L, and ante, p. 92, . Journal As:Soc: XXXV, au Plate. XIV On stone by KristoHari DasStudent Govii School at art Calcurta TEMPLE AT LIDAR: (IN WATER ) LITH: BY H.NIVEN SURVEYOR GENERAL'S OFFICE CALCUTTAJULY 1866. awnbyR ‘T.BurneyEsq™ C.S. if “ — *~ - 1866.] Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 99 the water line, but much injured. Round the tank there are the foundations of walls,* which seem to have formed a square of 100 feet. There is an ancient looking lingam 41 feet high, 14 feet in diameter, with 8 flat faces, of dark limestone, standing in the water near the springs which supply the tank. It probably once stood in the centre of the temple, like that at the Takht. The round head of the doorway outside has a sort of keystone (Plate XIV.), being a projection from the lower face of a stone of the course next above, as in the entrance to the temple at Marttand,+ and other Kashmirian arches. The smaller of the Lidar temples stands a little above and behind (i. e. to the north of) the first. Its ground plan is a square of 104 feet. It has only one doorway, viz., to the west. All the walls have corner pilasters 15 inches thick. The doorway has a square top covered by a pediment, which rests upon the jambs of the door, the tympanum being occupied by the trefoiled ornament. The trefoil contains a niche which once held a figure. This pediment is covered by another, having a trefoiled tympanum. The trefoiled arch rests, as usual, upon small pilasters on each side of the door, but the pediment is supported upon bold square pillars, which are attached to the building by walls of less breadth and 8 inches long. The temple in front is a plain copy of that at Pandrethan,} or perhaps the original from which zt was taken. The capitals of the corner pilasters are ornamented with two animals (I think Bulls) standing back to back; and those of the square pillars, supporting the principal pediment, are decorated with a bold flowered ornament. The roof of the building is pyramidal, but its outer facing of stone has disappeared. The walls are 23, feet thick. The basement is buried. ‘The interior forms a square of 6 feet, the walls being 7 feet high and plain. ‘The ceiling is formed of 9 blocks, four of which rest over the angles of the walls. The same process is again repeated with an upper course of four stones, by which the opening is still further narrowed to a square of 2,45 feet ; and lastly, the opening is closed by * See Cunningham, p. 288, para. 11. + See Photograph, No. XXIII. * See Photograph, No. V. 100 Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. , [No. 2; a single stone without ornament. The edges of the lowest course have =o. ,a plain moulding of three straight edged fillets, (Vide woodcuts) and the upper course a similar Ri one, except that the central fillet is rounded. N To the east and west of the temple are rec- tangular foundations, of the same width as, and continuous with, that of the temple itself; but there is no trace of surrounding walls. There are, however, numberless hewn stones lying about in all directions. From the position of the building, the ground being high on three sidess if may once have stood in water, like the other temple. The pedestal of a lingam remains in the centre of the interior. Buaumagso.* At Bhaumajo (pronounced Bhoomzoo by the natives) there are two temples, besides that described by General Cunningham. The larger of the two has been appropriated by the Mahomedans for a tomb, and disguised as much as possible; so much so, indeed, that when first I visited the cave temple, I did not think it worth while examining this other close by, on account of its new and plastered appearance. It is, however, in a very perfect state of preser- vation, but its. details cannot, at present, be seen on account of the thick plaster with which the building is in most parts overlaid. The pyramidal roof is probably uninjured, but it is buried in a mound of earth surmounting the square Mahomedan roof, which now disguises the nature of the building. Withsome difficulty, I obtained admission to the interior, which I found to be a square of 8 feet. The ceiling is like that of the smaller temple at Lidar.f There is a door on the north side, but the other walls are covered with plaster, rendering it” impossible to see whether they once had doors or not. The third temple, however, on the west of the tomb, has only one door, viz., to the north. ; The exterior is a square of 164 feet, with corner pilasters 2 feet 14 inches thick. There are porches with high trefoiled arches on * See Cunningham, page 251, and the Bishop’s letter to the Asiatic Society, 1865. | ~ See ante, p. 99. 1866. ] Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 101 all the sides. I could not find out how far the porches project beyond the walls, owing to the plaster; but the one on the river side (where the door is) projects 3 feet beyond the small pilasters which support the doorway pediment. The intervening spaces between the sides of the porches and the corner pilasters are filled in with mortar. The small pediment of the doorway within the trefoiled arch is like that of the cave temple,* but is supported on independent pilasters of its own. The porches are 11 feet one inch wide. To the west of the temple above described, also on the bank of the river, are the remains of a smaller temple of the same kind. Its interior is a square of 7 feet, with a roof like that of the smaller temple at Lidar.; Below the roof is a cornice of three square edged fillets, like those of both courses of the ceiling. The building has, I think, had no corner pilasters. It has porches on all four sides, 5 inches projected. The only opening is on the north side: the other porches containing closed doorways, which, like the porch pediments, are an exact copy of those of the cave temple.{ The exterior of the roof has been destroyed. TEMPLES NEAR WANGAT. About 3 miles above Wangat, on the right bank of the river Kanknai, are two groups of temples of all sizes, more or less in a state of ruin. The first group, viz., that nearest to Wangat, consists of six tem- ples,§ with a gateway and an enclosing wall. (See woodcut, p. 102.) The ground plan of the principal building is a square of 25 feet, with pilasters at the corners 33 feet in thickness, and having a projection of two inches beyond the temple walls. There are four porches 143 feet wide, with a projection of 23 feet beyond the corner pilasters. On two sides they contain closed doorways, the recesses of which (like those at Pathan||) once held Jinga, whose pedestals are still in their places. The porches were all surmounted by pediments of high pitch, covering trefoiled arches, which rest on } engaged square pilasters. Over each * See Cunningham, plate X. + See ante, page 99. { See Cunningham, plate X. § See Cunningham, p. 273, para. 31. || See Cunningham, p. 283, para. 1. 14 102 Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. ~ [No. 2, References. A. Massive wall forming facing to hill. | J. (On top). Steep mountain side co- B.B. Foundation of original wall of vered with jungle. enclosure. J.J. (On sides). Dense jungle. C. Gateway. K. Temple to west. D. Base of lingam. L. Temple to east. EK. Road to second group. N. Road to Wangat. H. Teniple to west. R.BR.R. Kanknai river. doorway, within the large trefoil arch, is a pyramidal pediment, of which the tympanum is occupied with the trefoil ornament, resting on the ’ architrave which covers the pilasters of the doorways. The base of the great pediment of the porches is on a level with that of the capital of the corner pilasters, but the upper portions of these pediments have disappeared. ‘There were two entrances, to the E. N. BE. and W.S. W. respectively. The former has the remains of short flanking walls — (afterwards added, it would seem) projecting 2,3 feet beyond the porch. They do not appear to have risen higher than the base of the capitals of the porch pilasters. The roof is still standing, and is — pyramidal, but its outer facing of stone has fallen, forced out, probably, by the expansion of the roots of a tall fir and other trees, which grew out of the pyramid. The interior, which has been much injured by — fire, is a square of 17 feet, the walls below the cornice being 134 feet — high, and plain; but the roof forms a hemispherical dome, 17 feet a in diameter, of which the centre has been decorated by a large — expanded lotus flower. The cornice is one foot high, witha moulding of three bands; the upper two projecting each beyond the one below it. — ; 1866. ] Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 103 The stones of the interior of the dome diminish in size, from about 1} feet long and 6 inches wide in the lower courses, to squares of about six inches near the centre. The foundation of the dome is formed of large blocks of stone, about 2 feet high, decorated with three straight edged fillets as at Payach,* the two upper ones broad and projecting each beyond that immediately below it, and the lowest narrowest. The spandrels of the dome are plain and horizontal. Within a few yards of the principal temple, to the north, there are the remains, more or less ruined, of five small temples, three to the east (L), and two to the west (H and K). All but one of them are built on the same general plan as the temple already described, but — have only one door each. The two to the west have their doors to the east and south respectively. The doorway of the latter (H) is like that of the temple A of the second group, described below. The other three sides of H are decorated each with a miniature double- roofed temple, but without an enclosing porch like those of A. It has a water-spout on the north-west side. The other temple on the west (K) has been a copy of the principal building, without the second doorway. Of the other three small temples, that corresponding in position to the one nearest the central building on the west, has its door to the south east, and is built on the same plan as H. So has the next one to it’(almost touching it) on its north-east side. Its walls have been plain on three sides, and there is a waterspout on the west. The third of these temples, almost touching the first (on its north side), has four doorways; that on the east being larger than the others, with (I think) a flight of steps to the east. (L) ’ It has a stone water-spout projecting on the N. W. W. side. In the interior the walls are plain. The ceiling (as in the Pandrethan temple,t Plate XVIII.) is formed of 9 blocks, four of which rest over the angles of the walls and reduce the opening to a square. The same process is again repeated with an upper course of four stones, by which the opening is still further nar- * See Cunningham, p. 258, para. 10. + See Cunningham, p. 288, para. 10, 104 Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir, [No. 2, rowed to a square of 21 feet ; and lastly this opening is covered by a single stone, decorated with a large expanded lotus surrounded by a nar- row square moulding, whose angles bisect the sides of the upper open- ing of the ceiling. All the angles are occupied by a flowered ornament of three leaves, something like that of the upper part of the tympa- num in the niche of the upper roof at Payach.* The gateway, about 224 feet wide, is to the N. N. E. of the principal temple, almost in the N. EH. corner of the enclosing wall, and about 30 feet from the nearest of the smaller temples. It was divided into two chambers, and had two columns on each front; one on either side of the entrance and supporting the architrave, as in the Bhaniyar gateway.t The surrounding wall formed on two sides a facing and support to the platform, on which the temples stand. On one of these sides, viz. that to the east, the wall is over 20 feet high in some places, and is built of small thin dark-coloured stone without mortar. On another side, viz. that on which the gateway is, and the furthest from the river, only the foundation remains; but 14 feet beyond it there is a second wall, very massive, built of rough blocks of stone, and forming a facing to the hill. It has evidently been erected at a later date, to protect the temples and the gateway from a landslip (probably), which threatened to bury them all in its descent towards the river. There is built up in this wall a fragment of the ee of one af the smaller temples. At the S. W. corner of the enclosure there is . the base of an enormous lingam, 54 feet in diameter. From the N. H. corner of the first group of temples there was a road-way flanked with large stones, leading down to the second group, afew hundred yards distant. Half way down, a little to the right of the road, are the ruins of a small solitary temple, but so much — injured that it is impossible to make out the original form of the — building. Close to it is a block of granite (measuring 10 feet in © length, 16 inches in height, and 26 inches in thickness) which seems to have formed part of the facing wall of a resting-place just above it, where the base of a small column is still in its place, at one corner of — a rectangular platform. A little further down the road, on the same ~ side, is another rectangular platform, which seems to haye been the * See Cunningham, plate No. XII. + See ante, p. 96, and Photograph, No. III. 1866.] Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 105 basement of a bara durree, or some such structure, 100 feet long and 67 feet wide. It must have had a broad open verandah all round. The bases of the pillars on one of the longer sides (viz. that to the east), eight in number, are all but one still in their places. The pillars were fluted and two feet in diameter, with an intercolumniation of nearly 12} feet. Numerous fragments of them are lying about in all directions. The uppermost course of the basement stones (on which the pillars stood) are 15 inches high, and project about 5 inches over those of the second course (which is almost entirely buried in the ground). In the centre of the platform there are the remains of what appear to have been the walls of an apartment. About 20 yards to the N. E. of the platform there are the ruins of the enclosing wall of the second group of temples eleven in number, (see woodcut below), with the remains of a gateway in the centre, about . 22,1, feet wide, similar to that belonging to the first group.* Like TTT i Ili ; R References. K. Small temple on hill side, R.R.R. Kanknai river. 8S. Spring. T, . Tank, A.to G. Temples, H. Oistern. I. Road to first group of temples. J.JJ. Jungle. . the latter, it was divided into two chambers, and had flanking pillars to the front and rear, like those at Bhaniyar.} Their #* See ante, p. 104, + See Photograph, No, IIL. 106 Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. . [No. 2, ‘bases on the river side are still in their places. Immediately inside the gateway, to the left, are the ruins of a small temple A, like those of the first group. Its only entrance, a trefoiled arch covered by a pediment resting on independent pilasters, looks to the N. KH. z. e. in the direction of the central building. Over the doorway pediment, and resting on square pilasters, is another trefoiled arch, occupying the tympanum of the porch pediment. The square pilasters project 15 inches, and are attached to the building by short walls, as at Pandrethan.* The other three walls are ornamented with similar porches, projecting about 6 inches, and containing each the front of a miniature temple with two roofs. The recesses once held linga.t The interior is blocked up with the debris of the roof. Between A and the principal temple, and a little to the north of them, are the ruins of another temple (B), of which the basement alone remains, amid a heap of huge stones, éarth, and jungle. The ground plan of this building was a square of about 18 feet with corner - pilasters 22 feet thick, and four porches projecting about 14 inches beyond the pilasters. Close to the central and principal temple, at its N. W. corner, is a huge cistern (like those at Bhaniyar{), cut out of a single block of granite, 15 feet long, 74 feet wide, and 3 feet high, with a projecting spout on the W. 8. W., one of the shorter sides. S The central building here is much more injured than that of the former group, and is buried half way up the porches on two sides. It appears, however, to have been very much like the corresponding temple of the first group, but it had only one entrance, viz. towards the W.S. W. facing the gateway. The interior is a square of 17 feet. The lowest course of the dome, consisting of 8 stones, each 22 inches high, has not the mouldings — which the other: dome has in this place, but seems to have had one : narrow plain moulding at the edge, and above it there is a concave course, about 18 inches high, with a moulding resembling the frieze of entablature No. 2, (of Marttand), given by General Cunningham on plate VIII accompanying his Essay. The entrance has the remains of projecting walls§, like those of the large temple in the first group, * See Cunningham, plate XXI. + See Cunningham, p. 283, and plate No. XX, t See ante, p. 97. * § See ante, p. 102. s 1866. ] Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 107 The corner pilasters of this temple are 4 feet thick, the ground plan being a square of 25 feet, as in the other case. A few yards to the S. S. E. of the central temple is a small one (C), seven feet square, with one round-headed doorway 53 feet wide, having mouldings the same as those of G, and looking in the same direction as that of the principal building. On the other three sides, there are similar porches with closed square headed doorways. The basement (of which part only is above the ground) seems to have been like that of Bhaumajo.* The entablature over the doorways, beneath the base of the pyramidal pediment, like the entablature over the corners of the building (on each side of the pediment) is decorated like frieze No. 2, of the Marttand entablature, shewn by General Cunningham. The porches project 4} inches. The interior is a square of 42 feet. The roof is constructed of horizontal courses, like these of L. (Wood- cut on p. 102.) The uppermost stone is decorated with an ex- panded lotus flower. “The two lower courses are ornamented each with a moulding of three square-edged fillets, like those of the Payach dome.+ To the N. N. E. and §. 8. W. of this small temple are the ruins of two others. That in the former direction (1)), a mere heap of ruins, had its only entrance on the same side as that of the central temple. ’ The other (E) is a heap of huge stones, scarcely one of which is in its original place. Hight feet behind the 8S. 8. W. temple isa fourth small one (IF), with a square headed doorway which has plain perpendicular and horizontal mouldings. There are similar doorways on the other sides, but only that on the N. N. W. has an opening, The interior is a square of 5} feet The roof has been formed of horizontal courses, of which the lowest alone remains, forming a square opening of about 4 feet. The walls are 20 inches thick. There has been another small temple to the S. S. W. of that last described, but it is now only a heap of stones; and on its N. W. side I think there are the foundations of one, if not two, more temples. To the N. N. E. of the central building are the ruins of a very elegant temple (G), the interior of which formed a square of about 9 feet. The walls were plain, with a cornice of 3 horizontal bands, the centre one having a rounded edge. The walls are 2,4 feet thick. * See Cunningham, plate No. X. + See Cunningham, plate No. XI, 108 Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. [No. 2, The only entrance is to the 8. 8. W. The head of the doorway is round, and has a few parallel and perfectly plain mouldings, which are joined to the similar mouldings of the sides by short horizontal returns. To the N. E. of the last, and a few feet only distant, are the ruins of another small temple, the ground plan of which was a square of 64 feet. The wall enclosing all of these buildings, has been plain and very massive. Many of the stones are still in their places on the N. N. W. _ side, some of them being 7 feet long, 22 inches high, and 22 inches thick. The wall measures 161 feet by 118 feet, the longer sides being towards the river and the hill respectively. On the former side the wall forms a support to the platform on which the temples stand; and on the latter, a facing to the hill side, which has either . been cut away to form the quadrangle, or has subsequently come down in a landslip, threatening to bury all the buildings in its descent towards the river. Wherever the lower part of the wall remains and — is visible on the outside (as it is near the gateway) ; — isastring course, like that at Bhaniyar.* Immediately beyond the enclosing wall, at its N. N. W. corner, is a tank (T') of most delicious water, very cold and clear. The bottom of the tank is considerably above the level of the quadrangle, which might therefore have been kept flooded from the tank. The water issues from the hill on the N. W. W. side of the tank, through the stones of the wall, and was probably the cause of this site being selected for all these buildings. Not only the temples, but the — neighbourhood is now forsaken by all human beings, and there is not — a resident Hindu for many miles.. But the spring (S) still runs on the — same as ever, affording another instance of the temporary nature of man’s greatest devices compared with that of things not human. To the west of the tank, and the north of the second group of temples, on the hill side, and almost buried in the ground, are the ~ ruins of a small solitary temple. The roof is broken into two portions — (like that of the Payach templet), of which the upper one, a pyramid _ formed of a single stone 23 feet square, is still in its place. The situation of the two groups of buildings is very wild and | secluded, but not grand like that of the Bhaniyar temple. * See ante, p. 94, and Photograph, No, III. + See Cunningham, plate No. XII. 1866.) Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 109 They are on the right bank of the Kanknai river, about 3 miles above Wangat, and not on the Brahimsur stream, where the latter place is incorrectly marked in the trigonometrical survey map. The Kanknai is nearer to the temples than the Jhelum is to that of Bhaniyar, and is quite as noisy as the latter river, but its dimensions _ are much less. The mountains on both sides of the stream above the temples rise to a great height and are very steep. They are covered with forests of pine and fir; and, not far distant tothe N. N. &,, the head of the valley is closed by a bare, dark green hill, with the snow still remaining in its clefts on the 27th of July. The temples are built of a coarse, pale granite, like that used at Bhaniyar, and mortar is found in most of the buildings. There are tall firs growing out of the roof of the principal temple of each group, and many of the smaller temples have been much injured by other trees forcing their way through the wails. The best way to the temples from Srinagar is by Gundurbul, Kuchnungul, and Wangat. Dyamun, Between Nowsuera Anp Unt. On the left bank of the Jhelum, between Nowshera and Uri, and about 34 miles from the latter place, are the ruins of a fine temple and gateway, similar to those of Bhaniyar.* There has been also a sur- rounding quadrangle, but very little of it remains. The ground plan of the temple is a square of 23 feet, with corner pilasters 28 feet thick and six inches projected beyond the walls of - the building. The porches, of which three contain closed doorways, are each 16 feet wide, with a projection of 1# feet. The doorways have square heads with plain straight mouldings, and are surmounted by pediments containing the trefoil ornament. The pediments are supported on half engaged fluted pillars. The only entrance, viz. to the W. N. W., is approached by a flight of steps like that of Bhaniyar.+ The interior is a square of 12 feet, but is nearly filled up with the debris of the pyramidal roof. The interior walls had a cornice of three plain mouldings, like those of one of the larger temples at Wangat.t Part of the pyramidal roof is still standing. It has been * See ante, p. 91, and Photographs, Nos, I. IJ. HI. and XIIT. ® + See Photograph, No. I. ft See ante, p. 102. 15 410 Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. [No. 2, very massive, but hollow. The basement of the temple is like that ef Bhaniyar,* but a good deal of it is concealed by earth and jungle. The steps of the temple are about 193 feet from those of the gateway, but the latter are covered with earth and fragments of stone. The exterior face of the surrounding wall has been ornamented ‘like that at Bhantyar,t and there were two recesses in the corners of the front wall, like those at Marttand and Bhaniyar. The colonnade of the interior has entirely disappeared, if any ever existed. I found no fragments of small columns, like those of the Bhaniyar peristyle; but the quadrangle is so filled up with earth, fragments of stone, trees and jungle, that whole pillars may be concealed from view. I think there was a peristyle; because behind the temple I found part of a basement, like that on which the columns of the peristyle stand at Bhaniyar.{ The gateway is built on the same plan as that at Bhaniyar,§ and is 23} feet wide. It is divided into two compartments, each 17 feet by 53 feet. The short side walls of each compartment are decorated with two trefoil headed niches, one above the other, with pyramidal pediments. The upper part of the gateway has disappeared, but fragments of the four large fluted columns which supported the architrave, are lying about in the neighbourhood, and also the capital of one of these columns, elaborately carved with small figures and flowered ornaments. Nearly the whole of the outer wall of the quadrangle is still standing, but its character is concealed, in most parts, by the earth which on three sides is up to the top of the wall. The whole of the ruins are.so buried in jungle that I passed along the road, on my way to Kashmir, without noticing them at all. The material is black stone (I think limestone), streaked with veins of white marble. . The situation is wild, like that of the Bhaniyar temple, the hill rising to a great height immediately behind the ruin. Manvs Bat. At the S. E. corner of the lake of Manus Bal, there is a small temple, of which the roof only was above the water on the 9th of * See Photograph, No. I. £ See Photograph, No. II. + See Photograph, No. III, § See Photograph, No, III, a oe toe Mi h- li — i's. oa ‘ ae Pe ¥ bs “ » Spe | ~ “. b. om : ars 3 . - *' a _— *S _ ; oa “ a : 2 wat . re i sei eG NN tee 4¢ re “ = ; a ie % a - ~ . y ait 7 es , - < ] =) ~ + wt; | or nat x ; =) a > + ri = = a : 4 ~ - 3 = - bene rt ae ’ 2 Pe) A) tia Journal As:Soc:XXXV P.1. Plate: Mia paces De Abe Bm mee On stone by Vristo Hari Das Student Govt:School of Art Caleutia. TEMPLE IN LAKE AT MONUSBAL LITH: BY H. NIVEN, SURVEYOR GENLS OFFICE CALCU TTAJULY,(266 ———= 1866.] Votes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 111 August. (Plate XIX.) In the winter, I was told, the building stands on dry ground. At other seasons the whole is sometimes below the surface of the lake. The roof is very like that of the Payach temple,* being broken into two distinct portions by an ornamental band ; each portion being formed of a single stone. The upper stone is 5 feet square at its base, and is plain on all sides. The ornamental band} is like that of Payach, divided into spaces alternately projecting and retiring. The latter are square and occupied by the lotus; but the projecting ends are carved into upright mouldings, slightly rounded at top and bottom, and surmounted by a straight and horizontal band. The north, south, and east sides of the lower portion of the roof are plain. The top seems to have been crowned by a melon-like ornament, of which the base only remains. The temple appears to be a square of about 6 feet, and has only one doorway, to the west, covered by a pyramidal pediment, which is divided into two portions by a horizontal return of the side mouldings, as in the case of the Marttand colonnade.f The upper portion is occupied by the head and shoulders of a figure holding a sort of staff in the left hand, and with something, which I couldnot make out, under the left arm. (See Plate XIX.) In the niche (like those at Payach§) formed by the trefoil over the doorway, there is a sitting figure, holding a sort of club in the left hand. The angles of the lower portion of the doorway pediment, below the horizontal moulding and above the trefoil, are occupied each with a naked figure leaning against the head of the trefoil, and holding up over the arch a sort of waving scarf, which is passed on through their other hands. LANKA, Gn Lanka island there are the ruins of a very fine temple. Its ground plan appears to have been a square of 344 feet, with a sort of antechamber to the §. HE. E., which is 11 feet wide, including the walls. The latter are 2%, feet thick. This antechamber projects 53 feet beyond the walls of the Naos. The exterior walls of the temple are ornamented with two rows of deep niches with cinq-foiled * See Cunningham, plate No. XII. t See Cunningham, plate No. XVI. + See Cunningham, plate No. XII, § See Cunningham, plate No. XII, 112 Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. [No. 2, heads, flanked by half engaged fluted columns. The wall on each side of the antechamber has three of these niches in each row, ?. e, 12 niches in all. : There are many small pillars lying about, almost uninjured, and more fragments of similar pillars. The columns measure 8 feet 64 inches, including base and capital, the latter being like that of the small pillars of the Marttand* peristyle, but with beading between the egg-shaped ornaments. The capital of these pillars is 143 inches in height. They have 6 flutes, and their diameter is 164 inches. The exterior face of the walls of the antechamber have only one of the niches in each row. The doorway is tothe 8 S. E., but I did not feel sure that there had not been doors on the other sides also. On the 8. S. E. side of the island there is a flight of steps with flanking walls; and close by, in the water, a large lingam. There are heaps of hewn stone on all sides of the island at the water’s edge, including frag- ments of square headed doorways, pyramidal pedi- ments, &c., and I think the island must all have been surrounded by a quadrangular wall, with a = peristyle and recesses on the imterior, as at Mart- "| 10 ¢in tand. . Near the steps are the remains of a cistern like the smaller one} at Bhaniyar. The building stands ona basement, of which a woodcut is given in the margin, Narayan THAL. This temple stands in a small tank{ on the right hand side of the road, going from Baramula to Mozufferabad, and about 24 miles to the 8. W. of the former place. It is situated in a hollow at the foot of the hills, and is buried in trees; and it may, therefore, easily escape the notice of travellers who are not looking out for it. The temple is a square of 131 feet, with plain walls. There is only one doorway 3,5, feet high, and 3 feet wide, on the east side, its top being formed * See Cunningham, plate No. XV, and plate No. VII, fig. 6. + See ante, p. 97. { See photograph, No, XVII. i. re? Ce Ve at Fs _/ Or yng =a vA owt e = 1866. ] Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 113 by the ends of two stones, whose lower corners are rounded off, forming an arch one foot high. The walls are formed of eight courses, of which two are below the surface of the water. The roof of the temple is alow pyramid, also formed of eight courses, of which the lowest projects a few inches beyond the face of the walls. The second course from the top of the roof is formed of one stone, 4? feet square at the bottom, and 14 feet high. Over it are three small stones, forming the uppermost course, of which the centre is pierced with a hole, 6 inches in diameter, apparently made to receive the end of a finial that is wanted to complete the pyramid. The interior is a square of 7} feet, and is 9,5, feet high. The floor was in July more than a foot below the surface of the water. The inside walls are formed of horizontal courses, each consisting of four stones only, one on each side of the building. The course over the doorway is slightly projected and rounded, forming a sort of string course along the walls. Above it are eight courses; the sides of the building diminishing in length as they near the top, and the slope of the walls being straight, The uppermost course of the interior walls, forming a small square opening, is crowned by a single flat stone. There are a great many stones lying about the tank, but I could not find the foundation of an enclosing wall,* and, owing to the rushes and other weeds which abound in the water, I could not ascertain whether the bottom of the tank had been flagged or not. I did not find any part of the pedestal of a lingam in the temple. The tank is fed by a running stream, which comes from a spring in the side of the hill immediately behind. Some of the stones of the temple walls are 91 feet long and 13 inches high. Fourrrnenur, Kasumir. After crossing the hill at the end of the valley, about two miles from Baramula, on the way to Nowshera, a short distance off the road, to the left, towards Gul-murg, there are the ruins of a grand temple, in a village called (since Runjeet Sing’s conquest of the country) Futtehghur, Runjeet had a fort built round the temple, * See Cunningham, p. 288, para. 11. me. Notes on some of the Tenples of Kashmir. [No. 2, using the stone of its pyramidal roof, and probably of its enclosing quadrangle, for the construction of his walls of defence. The ground plan of the temple is a square of 462 feet. There weré four porches, each 274 feet wide, with a projection 84, feet beyond the temple walls. The only door was on the W.N. W. side, the other three porches con- taining closed doorways, like those at Bhaniyar.* The doorways had pyramidal pediments, the tympanum being occupied by the trefoil ornament, and were supported on half engaged fluted columns, with capitals decorated with the egg-shaped ornament.+ ‘The doorway pediments were surmounted by those of the porches, with noble trefoiled arches occupying the tympanum ; the principal pediments being sup- ported on fine square pilasters, and the arches resting, as usual, on half engaged square pillars of their own. The corner pilasters are 74 feet thick, and 43 inches projected. The capitals of the square pilasters, like the entablature of the exterior walls, were ornamented with small trefoil-headed niches, containing naked human figures standing ; and over them was a row of lotus flowers in small square panels. The interior measures 29 feet across, and seems to have been octagonal, the four principal sides measuring each 184 feet, and the other four each 9 feet ; but the whole building is buried in earth and the debris of the roof nearly up to the top of the doorways, and it, is consequently not possible to take all the measurements accurately. Some of the stones (black limestone ?) are very large, measuring 10,4, feet in length 3% feet in height, and 3 feet in thickness. From the exterior face of the porch to the back of the recess formed by the closed doorway is 84 feet. TEWAN. About a mile to the left of the road beyond Bimbaga, at a village called Tewan, near the foot of the hills, there are the ruins of a temple built — after the plan of the principal temples beyond Wangat, but of smaller dimensions. It has only one door, viz. to the south ; but there are por- ches, similar to that on the south, on the other three sides, containing closed door-ways. The roof is entirely gone, and the walls look as if — they would very soon topple over. The basement is buried. The * See photograph, No. I. + See Cunningham, plate VIII. fig. 6, 1866. ] Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 115 interior is a square of about 11 feet: The temple seems to have stood in a tank, and to have had an’ enclosing wall. Immediately behind is the steep hill side, covered with fine spreading cedars. TemMPLes AT PATHAN SUGANDHESWARA.* The inner chamber of this, the smaller of the two Pathan temples, is, as Cunningham says, ‘‘ quite plain,” except that in the west wall there are four small niches in a line, 54 feet from the floor, two with trefoiled heads and two square-headed. ‘To the right of the gateway ruins there is a fragment of a fluted column, one foot in diameter, like those of the Avantiswami peristyle, and, a little further to the front, a fragment of a larger fluted column (having 20 flutes) 12 feet in diameter. Down each flute there is a flat band, one inch wide, slightly projected, Near the latter frag- ment there are pieces of two trefoil-headed arches, and the capitals (with parts of the shafts) of two of the colonnade pilasters. There is also, on the same spot, the base (22 220 inches square) of a small column, cut on three sides only. : SanKARA GAURESWARA. Nearly opposite this, the larger of the two Pathan temples, on the left hand side of the road in a bagh of cherry trees, there is a fragment of a small fluted columnt (having 16 flutes), one foot in diameter, similar to that of the Pampur peristyle. The fragment measures about 3 feet in length, and is standing up out of the ground, marking the site of a Mahomedan grave. And ina field to the east of the temple, there is another fragment of the same or a similar pillar. In the village of Pathan, I found the base of a small column like that described near Sugandheswara, and another of a larger column. In and about the village, there are numberless huge stones, squared and otherwise carved, which probably belonged to the enclosure of one or both of the temples. To the east of the entrance porch of the larger temple, at 90 feet distance, there is the foundation of a wall of squared stones, and I thought I could trace the foundation of a gateway. * See Cunningham, page 281, + See Cunningham, page 283, 116 Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. [No. 2, Koni. At Kohil, between Awantipore and Payach, there is a miniature 7 temple, cut out of one stone, standing near a Mahomedan tomb, within an enclosing wall of recent construction. (See woodcut.) The interior of the temple is a cube ‘of 15 inches, with the centre of the roof hollowed out into a dome; and the walls are 5 inches thick. The exterior walls are 2 feet long without corner aon 2in 3tm _ pilasters, and there is only one entrance. On three sides there are closed doorways, with pe- diments like that of the entrance. The apex of the doorway pedi- ment is on a level with the top of the lower division of the roof, as at Payach,* and projects 5 inches beyond the roof at the same level. Ag at Payach, also, the pediment is unbroken, and contains the trefoil ornament. The doorway pilasters project one inch beyond the face of the wall. The basement of the temple, and the upper division of the roof are missing. | At the same place there are the bases of 3 small columns, whose diameter has been 8 inches. Of their bases, the plinth is 7 inches high and 114 inches wide. The upper member also is square, and somewhat like that of the Marttand peristyle columns,+ 3 inches high. 3in DrusegaMa. Between Ramoo and Shapuyon, a few yards from the road, on high _ ground, near Drubgama, is a miniature temple, like that at Kohil, cut out of a single block of stone 2 feet 8% inches square, and 4 feet 54 inches high. It has one door to the south, with a horse shoe-shaped arch, covered — by a pyramidal pediment, broken into two portions by a return of the 4 * See Cunningham, plate XII. + Ibid, plate XV. 1866. ] Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 117 side mouldings. The upper portion is occupied by a small trefoil ornament, and the lower one contains a small ronnd ornament, resting on the base, thus : The width of the porch on the south side is 2 feet. Onthe north side there is a recess like those of the Pathan temples,* with a cinq- foiled head, covered by a pyramidal pediment broken into two portions of which the lower one is occupied by a flowered ornament. A larger pediment supported on half engaged pillars surmounts the former one. The east and west walls have porches very slightly projected, with pyramidal pediments resting on the jambs of square-headed doorways. The tympanum of the pediment is occupied by a large trefoil ornament. The roof of the temple has been formed of two stones, of which the upper one has disappeared, as is the case in the Kohil model. The temple seems to have stood in a very small tank faced with stone walls. I could not find any trace of a basement. In front of the temple there are stones which I took for the foundation of a small rectangular building. PANDRETHAN.+ The floor ofthis temple on the 7th of August was 3,3, feet below the surface of the water, and above it there were 511 feet of wall. The opening on the south} (differing from those on the other three sides) appears to have been made subsequently. Its sides are not splayed _ like those of the other doorways, and seem not to have been regularly cut, but rudely broken away. In fact, one stone on the west side of * See Cunningham, p. 283, para. 1. + Idem, page 283. { Idem, p. 287, para. 9, 16 118 Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. [No. 2, the opening is not flush with the rest, but projects a couple of inches or so beyond the general level of the face of the wall. I think there had been originally a closed doorway outside on the south, like those at Bhaniyar* and that the interior of the wall on that side was Saeed built up and plain. General Cunningham’s drawing ofthe ceiling of the temple is not quite complete. From the accompanying very accurate sketch made by Mr. R. T. Burney of the Civil Service, (Plate XVIIT.), it will be seen that the angles of the square in which the beaded circle is, are occupied by naked human figures, as well as the angles of the other squares. These innermost figures have both arms outstretched, like those at Payacht seeming to hold up the circle. They have drapery about their shoulders, resembling light scarfs. The brackets supporting the cornice were once ornamented, and show marks of great violence having been used to destroy the carving. Each appears to have represented a human head ; for on several of them there still remains on both sides what looks like plaited hair, The pediment pilasters project 5 inches beyond those supporting the trefoiled arches. The corner pilasters of the building are 1 foot 102% inches thick. I found what I took for mortar in all parts of the building. Marrranp. I The middle chamber of the centre edifice is 14 feet by 64 feet ; and the innermost one, the naos of the Greeks, is 18 feet by 134 fect, having the remains of a cornice, about 18 inches high, in the S. E. corner, I could find no trace of trefoil-headed panels or any other ornament on the outer walls of the quadrangle. The large pillars at the extremities of the wall (in which the gateway is) outside, have, I think, supported the pediments of cells like those in the front wall at Bhaniyar.§ The leading feature of the entablature of the middle chamber is the cingfoiled headed arch, resting upon small half engaged hexagonal pillars. See woodcut on next page, | ; * See ante, p. 92. ¥ Cunningham, plate No. XII. { Ibid, page 258. § Ibid, p. 270, para. 25, and Photograph, No. XXIII. Plate XVII. RS S}c Reb =H 7 fing Drawn by R.T. Burney Esq? C S. = ‘On aa ay ee an ay Student Govt: Schoolof Art Calcutts, ROOF OF PANDRETHAN TEMPLE LTH) 8Y 5 NIVEN SURVEYOR GEMEAAUS OFFICECALCUTTA JUNEINGC - : wer ve Ve 7 < ao are ae Api te als Sara ED gr - # & ‘ ee ee ok. ie Di agate 1866. ] Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 119 The soffits of the arch, leading from the arddhamandapa or porch, to the antarala or mid-temples, is highly decorated. (See Cunningham, plate XVI. and woodcut overleaf.) Lf | Taxkut-1-SuLIMAN.* With all deference to General Cunningham, I should call the ground plan of this temple a square} of 142 feet, with projections on each side. The diameter of the interior of the temple is 151. The thickness of the wall on each side of the door is 5& feet, and the doorway is projected 2 feet. Only one side of the enclosing wall is perfect; and it contains 14 rectangular recesses. The wall on another side is partly standing, and ‘seems to have contained 13 recesses. These walls each measure 22 feet in length on the inside. The outside of the wall is quite plain.j * Cunningham, page 247. + Ibid, p. 270, para. 25, and Photograph, No. <0 { Ibid, p. 250, para. 18, 120 Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. [No. 2, The basement of the wall is 2,4 feet thick, projecting on the inside one foot beyond the wall itself. The height of the basement is 10 inches. (Soffits of entrance arch of Temple. Marttand.) The sloping walls, flanking the steps leading from the entrance, are 23 feet thick. The surrounding walls and the entrance are in much better preservation than the temple itself. The entrance has a round top (like those of the arched recesses in the rectangular panels*), whereas the doorway of the temple is narrow and pointed. For these and other reasons, I believe the surrounding wall and the steps to be much more recent in date than the temple. * See Cunningham, p. 250, para. 8. 1866. | Notes on some of the Temples of Kashmir. 121 I was assisted in taking the above measurement by W. Elmslie, Esq., M. D. To the north of the temple, a few feet distant, there is a small rectangular building. Its interior is 11 feet by 10% feet, and the L1hin walls are 2,% feet thick. The otin ae roof is formed of large plain Stin Ven / slabs, supported on four hori- in ‘Ta @i4in. zontal stone beams, 15 inches wide, and 64 inches high. Kach of these beams is formed of two stones. These beams Bi fs . again rest, in the centre, on another stone beam (formed of 2 pieces) 10% feet long, 11 inches high and 16 inches wide, and supported on two stone pillars (of 8 flat faces each) without bases. Including the capitals, the pillars are 4 feet 10} inches high and 23% inches thick. (See woodcut.) The capitals are not alike. There is one entrance to the east, as in the temple close by. It is round headed, with plain mouldings parallel to the sides and top. The walls outside and inside are plain. The exterior of the roof is gone. AVANTISWAMI.* Though the Dewan at Srinagar readily consented to my opening up the ruins of Avantiswami, I experienced great difficulty in obtaining bildars and coolies for the work. For some weeks I could not get any at all, and most of the work was done by very old men and children. _ Texcavated the whole of the peristyle on the south side of the quadrangle and the part of it between the S. W. corner and the gateway. At first I hoped that the displacement of the entablature over the colonnade was only local; but, on continuing the excavation, * See General Cunningham’s Hssay, p. 276, and the Bishop’s letter to the Asiatic Society, 1865. 1866.] Notes on some of the Temples at Kushmir. 123 I found that the whole of the entablature on the south side had been thrown down before the silting up of the quadrangle. Notwith- standing this circumstance, the pedimental pilasters of the recesses have scarcely been injured at all. This is specially remarkable in the case of one pair of pilasters, which are ornamented with figures . representing Siva or some other divinity. The woodcuts on page 122, from a drawing by Mr. H. Wilson of the Civil Service, give a very faithful representation of four of these pilasters. Kunamon, &o. At Kunamoh and Kroo, beyond Pampur, to the left of the Islama- bad road, there have been temples in the middle of small tanks, which (latter) still remain. At Tapur also, between Pathan and Baramula, there are the foundations, if not the entire basements, of two fine temples; and near Woossun, on the right bank of the Sind, there are likewise extensive ruins of similar buildings. - About one mile from Baramula, on the left bank of the Jhelum, are the foundations of a wall 90 yards square, enclosing a small tope. This is probably the ancient Jayendra Vihar. .Near the wall there dre the foundations of a large village or city. Stones of all shapes are strewn over the ground to the extent of some acres. In one place | there is a heap of huge blocks, which are evidently the debris of a | temple long ago overturned. There is also a small mound resembling, }a Buddhist tope, also covered with loose stones. Near its top isa | very large lingam. we 52271! cern cst> WS 9 walt. wIyne Jlaxe wo} sii &asyf diLe uy Kans wled dive i biSLy.0 wyited y Raed g GU) HI) Blo ame a! wip? SS wy lide GU} Jie LB I) Killen aiSl wo He cath 9d GU) Ll] Qodama, in my incorrect extracts from the corrupted text, says: 9 Aho Gyo Fhe eles Ke (09 ML} Saal (as! Say! eye yt J wd ale sole y alpelt igo Mee! line 9 x55 le yoy ct olf Lt us? yt Cyr shige bo lf 9 EHe GIT Wf sda WY Geel lor! yy! we” w9Kt Jake 9) eryine 9 wa} EB pinnae At] (0 ey! seat or LADS] Lda There is no doubt that both accounts refer to the same fact, yet there is only one figure ‘600 millions of Dirhams” in both identical. This figure appears to me to express the amount of revenue in Musul- man Dirhams. Ten Musulman Dirhams are in weight equal to 7 Mithq4ls, consequently 600 millions Dirhams = 420 millions Mithq4ls or 5,833,3334 Roman pounds. The first figure of Ibn Khordadbeh is consequently to be read 420 millions instead of 24 millions. At the time of Qodama 15 Dirhams (silver) had the value of one Dynér or Mithqal (of gold) ; consequently gold was only 93 times more valuable than silver. It seems, however, that gold had at times a higher rate, and that a pound of gold was equal in value to 10 pounds of silver. 420 Mithqils of silver were therefore equal to 42 Mithqdls or Dynars oi gold in value, I consequently propose to read in Qodama 42 mil- 1382 Meynard’s Ibn Khordadbeh. [No. 2, lions instead of 720,000,Dynars. The’only difficulty is caused by the figure of Ibn Khordadbeh, 795 millions Mithgéls (of silver). It is clear that the author wants to say, that after the eighteenth year of Perwyz the revenue increased, and as 795 is a higher sum. than 600, I take that this is the highest figure to which the revenue rose during his reign. After these observations I change the figures, and translate the passage of Ibn Khordadbeh as follows: ‘The Kheraj of the whole kingdom which was gathered for the Chosroes Parwyz in the year 18 of his reign amounts to 420 millions Mithqdls (of silver, read 0) S342 yf HI] OBI} wy nthe 9 L8!). This makes, reduced to the weight of Musul- man Dirhems, 600 millions of Dirhems. Subsequently the revenue of his kingdom rose to 795 Mithqals.”’ The passage of Qoddma I translate: “It is asserted that Chosroes Parwyz counted in the year 18 of his reign the revenue (for ho read 44a) of his kingdom. He possessed all the provinces which I have enumerated, the Sawad and the other districts, with the excep- tion of the western part of the Musulman empire ; for the frontier of his kingdom was Hyt, and the country west of it belonged to the Greeks. He found that the revenue amounted to 42 millions Mith- qals (of gold), this makes 600 millions of Musulman Dirhams (of silver ).”” The Musulman Dirham was not known to the Persians, they count- ed the revenue, as it seems, in Dirhams which had exactly the weight of a Mithgal or of an aureus of Constantine of which 72 made a Roman pound, and for this reason, in the original accotint which was used both by Ibn Khordadbeh and Qoddma, the sum was stated in Mithqdls. The money was weighed, and of course, if it contained alloy, deduction was made. We are therefore able to calculate the income with great accuracy, it is equal to 172,800,000 Rupees in value. Hf we reduce it to English money, we must bear in mind that the pro- portion of the value of gold to that of silver was not the same as in our days. In the Greek empire, it was fixed by law as 142: 1, and gold was the standard. In the Persian empire, the proportion was probably as 10 : 1, and I am inclined to believe that in the document which Qodama and Ibn Kordadbeh used, the amount of the revenue was stated both in gold and in silver. I have already observed that at Qoddma’s time the proportion was 93: 1, and I haye shown (das 1866. ] Meynard’s Ibn Khordddbeh. 133 Leben des Moh., Vol. 3, p. 1386) that in Mahommedan law, it is as 83 : 1 and even as 7: 1. In Persia silver was the standard, in the Byzantian empire gold. The Musulmans made no change : in the provinces which had belong- ed to the kingdom of the Sasanians, silver remained the standard, and in Syria, Egypt and other provinces which they took from the Greeks, gold continued as the standard. In Makka and Madyna, silver became the standard as early as Omar I., but in southern Arabia the revenue was calculated by Dynars (Aurei.) The great difference of the value which gold had at Constantinople under Constantine, and which it had in the Sasanian and later in the Arabic empire, throws an unex- pected light upon the relative prosperity of the two countries. The fact requires no comment for those who know the elements of Political Economy. Ibn Khordédbeh begins his geography with a description of the Sawad—Babylonia, Immediately after the Musulmans had conquered that country, Omar I. sent ‘Othman b. Honayf to survey it for the sake of assessment. It appears that he measured the cultivated land of every district, and also for the sake of control the whole country en bloc. He found that it is from Hadytha in the north to ’Abbadan in the south 125 farsangs long, and from Holwan in the east to ’Odzoyb in the west 85 farsangs wide. The whole surface of culti- vated and waste land (,«ls 5 ols) amounts therefore to 10625 a far- sangs or 1386607143 Jaryb. Ibn Khordadbeh (MS. of Oxford) and Qodama calculate the surface in round figures at 136 millions of Jaryb. Under the Sasdnian king, Qobad b. Fyrdz, the revenue of the Sawad amounted to 150 millions Mithqals (of silver or Persian Dirhams) = more than 2 millions Roman pounds of silver -= more than 214 millions of Musulman Dirhams. After the Musulman conquest, *Omar I. derived a revenue of 120 millions Dirhams from it. This sum is named by Ibn Khordadbeh and Qoddma. Ibn: Séd includes the revenue of Jebel and mentions a higher sum, but as two figures are wanting in his text, we cannot make out what he means, his words ATE LRO3, eo (31) Sylly (J 5! cot) Cas] wig ne 9 LI} 8} &5 Le I shall speak on the assessment of Omar lower down. Here I will only observe that the 120 millions are made up by the land-tax and 18 134 Meynard’s Ibn Khordddbeh. [No. 2, capitation. The latter may have amounted to 7 millions: the male population of full age consisted of 500,000 souls, and the poorer classes had to pay 12, the middling classes 24, and the rich 48 Dirhams; supposing one in a thousand paid the,highest, and one in a hundred the middling rate of capitation, this tax yielded 7,000,000 Dirhems and the land tax 113,000,000 Dirhems. We see that the total income which ’Omar I. derived from the land of the Sawéd is little more than half of that which it yielded under Qobad. It is not unlikely that ’Omar assessed it somewhat lighter, but the main cause of the diminution of revenue was the decay of the country. Babylonia has some resemblance with Holland, and the Sunderbunds, being the Deltaof the Kuphratesand Tigris; andit appears that great efforts have been made in former times to drain it and to protect it from inundation by dykes, and in measure as they were neg- lected, the land was converted into swamps. We find paludes in the map of Ptolemy, but they seem to have been of no great extent. The Tigris carries much silt, which is partly deposited in its bed, where it slackens its course, and consequently in the progress of time the bed became higher and threatened to inundate the country. To prevent this calamity, it was dammed in below Bacra, and the course was regulated : it was made straight, so that the water might carry off the deposit. During the reign of Qobad (probably after the time at which he derived so high a revenue from the Sawad) the dyke was broken through below Kaskar, and the neighbouring country was inundated, but the government took no notice. Anushyrwan had the dykes restored and much of the land was recovered. In the year 6 of the Hijra (A. D. 628) both the Euphrates and the Tigris swoll amazingly, and destroyed many of the dykes. King Parwyz showed great energy, and it is asserted that in one day no less than 40 gaps were filled up; yet though he granted great sums from the public treasury for the repairs, he was unable to remedy the evil. A few years later, the Arabs waged war against the Persians. The dykes — were in consequence completely neglected, and the swamps gained in extent. The Musulmans, after they had conquered the country, seem _ not to have paid any attention to the matter, and the Dihqians—heads of districts—were unable to repair the dykes. Mo’awiya I. sent his ehent ’Abd Allah b, Darrdj to Babylonia as collector, and he seems 1866. ] Meynard’s Ibn Khordddbeh. 135 to have been the first Mahommedan who recovered some land. Much greater efforts were made by the Nabathean Hassan, who was collector under the reigns of Walyd and Hischam b. Abd al-Malik, and cut two canals to carry off the water. In A. H. 75, Hajjaj was appointed governor of Babylonia. He represented to Walyd IL., that the drain- age of the country would cost three millions of Dirhams. The Khalyf thought he could spend the money more pleasantly on eunuchs and singers, and refused to grant solarge a sum. Moslima b. ’Abd al- Malik, a relation of the Khalyf, proposed to him to drain part of the swamps, under the condition that he should draw the revenue of the recovered land. The Khalyf accepted the offer, and Moslima cut the two canals called Saylaya, and raised dykes. He succeeded in recover- ing a great extent of land, and the peasantry flocked to him to culti- vate it. His family continued to derive the revenue from it up to the time of the overthrow of the Qmayide Dynasty. The ’Abbaside Khalyf granted it to one of his relations, Dawud b. ’Alyy b. ’Abd Allah b. ’Abba&s. His heirs remained for some time in possession of it, but eventually it was considered as one of the crown-lands ra lal} Ky bbe In A. H. 75 Hajj4j was appointed governor of Babylonia, and he ruled 20 years over that country. Ibn Khordadbeh says of the finan- cial condition of the country during his sway: ‘‘ The revenue gathered by Hajjaj did not amount to more than 18 millions Dirhams, and there was consequently a diminution of one hundred (and two) millions. This ‘was owing to his burning down villages, and to his oppression. More- over he was obliged to give advances to the cultivators to the amount of two millions, so that only 16 millions reached the public treasury.” It seems that the peasantry fled, for under the just Omar II. who ruled in A.H. 99, the revenue of the Saw4d suddenly rose to 124 millions. It is a very unexpected fact that at the time of Ibn Khordadbeh not only the limits, but also the names of the districts were in the official language precisely the same which had been in use among the Sasinians, nay some of them seem to be even more ancient than the S4s4nians ; for we neither find a district called Baghdad, nor one called Madayin (Ctesiphon). The province in which these two cities lie, is called Shad-Hormuz and the district Kalwadza, from an ancient town hali way between Baghdad and Madayin. 136 Meynard’s Ibn Khordddbeh. [No. 2, The Sawad is divided into 12 Kur, provinces, and originally it con- tained 60 Zasdsyj, districts, but at the time of Ibn Khordadbeh only forty-eight. The whole province of Holwan, containing five districts, was added to Jebel. We have seen that Ibn Sad includes in refer- ence to the time of "Omar I. the revenue of Jebel in that of the Sawdd. He probably means that of Holwan only, which at the time of Omar and of the Omayyids may have belonged to the Sawéad. The province of the Tigris, containing 4 districts, was given to the Government of Bacra; and it is very likely that the crops which it had to supply to the State, were destined for the support of the troops stationed there. This, however, can only apply to the time of the ’Abbasides, for in former days they received their supply from Mah- Bacra in Persia, which under the Abbasides was placed under another Government. One whole district had become a swamp and disappear- ed altogether. Two districts (one of them is lower Behqobad) had ‘been converted into crown lands after the system of Khorasan. In this manner, the Sawad was shortened by 12 districts and reduced to for- ty-eight, T insert here a detailed account of the revenue of the Sawad, according to Qodéma, and also (distinguished by asterisks) one according to Ibn Khordadbeh. Ina very few instances I deviate from Barbier de Mey- nard’s text, and follow my own copy of the MS. of Oxford. Qodama says of his account, it contains the income as it stands at present. I take the mean since the year 184, this being the first year of which documents are found in the public offices at Baghdad ; for the earlier re- cords were destroyed by fire during the disturbances which took place in 183 under Amyn, known under the name of Ibn Zobayda. Western side of the Sawdd watered No. of No. of by the Tigris and Euphrates. Villages. Barns. Wheat. Barley. Dirhams. Anbér and Nahr-Ma’rit, — —118,000(2)6,400 4,000,000 *Anbar (alone), ... .- 5 250 2,300 1,400 150,000 Qotrobbol, ... ou: 2000-1000 S000 *Ditto, ... 0 ... 10 220 2000 1,000 300 (sic!) Maskan, vy ws las eT 8000-10007 *Ditto, ... is .. 6 105 3,000 1,000 300,000 Badiiryya, ... vs ony |= 8,500 1,000 00 1866.] *Badiryya, Nahr-Shyr, * Ditto, Riimayan, * Ditto, Kiuthé, * Ditto, Darqyt, =Ditto, ... Jubara, * Ditto, es The ike Tabs, vos AD ItGO, ... Babel and Rie ieiniira: * Ditto, rae Upper-Faldja, bea a Ditto, ... Lower-Falija, * Ditto, The two Canals, *Ditto, wexyi-tamr, ,., * Ditto, me Jenna and Bedat, * Ditto, Sura and pavyaiya’ *Ditto, ... Banyama and King’s Canal, ... Ditto, ... Upper and lower Bis, ws No. of No. of Villages. Barns. 14 420 *Tithes of lands belonging to the church or charities and from lands called Sanyn situated in yarious districts, Forat-Badaqla, .., Meynard’s Ibn Khordédbeh. Wheat. 3,500 1,700 1,700 3,300 8,300 3,000 3,000 2,000 2.000 1,500 1,700 1,400 1,400 3,000 2,000 Barley. 137 Dirhams. 1,000 1,000,000 1,700 150,000 1,700 5,000(s‘c) 3,300 3,050 2,000 2.000 2,000 2,000 150,000 350,000 350,000 350,000 2.9,000 200,000 6,000 1,500,000 6,000 7,200 7,200 5,000 5, 500 2,500 150,000 250,000 250,000 350,000 350,000 70,000 70,000 280,000 230,000 45,000 45,000 45,000 51,000 150,000 150,000 250,000 100,000 112,000 250,000 150,000 250,000 62,000 138 Meynard’s Ibn Khordddbeh. [No. 2, No. of No. of Villages. Barns. Wheat. Barley. Dirhams. Forat-Badaqla, vas ass 100 271 2,000 - 2,500"5860,000 Silhayn, ... Ae a — %,-1,000- 1;5000,000 Fe *Ditto, se eo 34 1,000 1,500 140,000 — Rumistaén and Hideenthour —— — 500 500 20,000 *Ditto, ek SOS — 500° 500 =p ape Nister, ... ae eo — 2,200 2,000 300,09) * Ditto, ie sei) os SOT 1638" 1250 200 eee Ighar of Yaqtyn, ... eo — 2,200 2,000 204,800 *Ditto, ote tees -_-_ — — 200,840 At the junction of the two rivers. The provinces of Kesker : it is said the revenue formerly amounted to 90000 Dirhams, ... ... — — 30,000 20,000 270,000 *Kesker and canal of Gillah, Rig: qat and Reyan, the Kherdj and all other taxes yield,... ... — — 3,000 20,000 70,000,000 (and vice) Nahr Cilla, af: _— — 1,000 38,121 59,000 Eastern side of the eas Buzurg-Sabur,... —~ — 2,500 2,200 300,000 *Ditto, 9 260 2,500 2,200 300,000. The two Radan, Bras Tee — 4800 4,800 120,000 “Ditto; ee aie .. 19 362 4800 1800-12008 Canal of Big, ... — 200 1,000 100,000 *Ditto, — — 200 1,000 10000mm Kalwddza and oa of Bae — — 1,600 1,500 330,000 % *Ditto, 3 34 1,600 1,500 330,000 Jadzer, old town out) Big _ — 1,000 1,500 240,000 *Ditto, fa 9 116 1,000 1,400 250,000 Galtilé and Halils, — — 1,000 1,000 100,000 *Ditto, 4) 76 1,020 1,000 100;00058 Desyn, — — 1,900 1,300 40,000 © *Ditto, 4 230 700 1,300 40,000 Deskere, BSA Oe — 1,800 1,400 60,000 *Ditto, «... ts -. - J 447) 1,000 1,000- 7Oeee * Barley and rice, a 1866.] | Meynard’s Ibn Khordddbeh. 139 No. of No. of Villages. Barns. Wheat. Barley. Dirhams. Beraz alrud, ... eS Te — 3,000 5,100 120,000 Mavitto, ... Re .. 6 267?) 38,000 2,000 120,000 Bandanjayn, ... a — 600 500° 35,000 i — ; eo 54 600 500 100,000 *The three Nahrawdn, ... ... 21 3880 — — —_ Upper Nahrawan, ... eo — 1,700 1,300 53,000 *Ditto, oy ie ae pf — 2,700 1,800 850,000 Middle Nahrawin, ... ... — — 1,000 500 100,000 Seto, -... sive oo — 1,000 500 100,000 Lower Nahrawan, five in aie ree — 1,000 1,200 150,000 Baduraéy4é and Baksaya, — — 4,700 5,000 33,000 *Ditto ditto, ... Ma accede NE — 4,700 5,000 830,000 Rustuqbad, we ake? Le — 1,000 1,400 246,000 Silsyl and Mahrid, ith epee — 2,000 1,500 150,000 The Kira (provinces) of the Tigris yielded in A.H. 260 (266?), — — 9,000 4,000 430,000 Land-tax of the Kura (provinces) of the Tigris, —_— —_- — — 8,500,000 In reference to the Tehae of Yaqtyn, mentioned in the preceding list, Qodéma says, no mention was made of it in the days of the Persians, nor was there such an Ighar existing in their times. Yagqtyn had claims on the government, and he received as payment lands in various districts, subsequently they lapsed to the government, and they were called Ighar of Yaqtyn. The canal of Cilla was dug by order of Mahdiy in the districts of Wasit, and thereby a good deal of waste land was reclaimed. The produce (of the Ighar and of the reclaimed land) was destined for prayers and defraying other expenses in the two holy places (Makka and Madyna). It is said the arrange- ment was made that two-fifths of the crops were to be given up by the cultivators for this purpose. This settJement was to last fifty years, alter the lapse of which a new settlement was to be made. Ighar ()! ) is correctly explained by Barbier de Meynard, dict. geogr. de la Perse, p. 65, “‘ I s’ applique & une ville ou & une propriété qui, moyennant une certaine somme stipulée une fois pour toutes, et payée chaque année directement au soulthan, est exemptée de la visite et du contréle des percepteurs du fisc.”” Qodamé defines it 140 Meynard’s Ibn Khordddbeh. [No. 2, in the same mannerr oa! gldos wl Gro Kanal! Cod) wl 92 jet Lo} Kilt ec? Coog2 beat? (5% ed) Gro & plod! oly be ‘latigigleelteie shan! cy Kae 3! J lads ass us? “ Tehar (protection against danger) means, that a landed tenure is exempt from the visits of the collectors and from what is connected with them (rapacity and oppression), in consequence of an order of the head of the State which fixes a certain annual quit-rent to be paid either into the public treasury, or into the treasury for the support of a military cantonment.” The principal advantage of an Ighar consisted in being free from those harpies, the Omlas. The provinces of the Tigris which form the last and largest item, may be those which were ceded to the Bagra government, and they seem to answer to those enumerated by Barbier de Meynard, p. 133, under Nos. V. and VI. Some of the figures in the preceding table, taken from the very incorrect copy of Qodéma, are certainly erroneous, and may be corrected — by comparing them with those of Ibn Khordadbeh. It must, however, be borne in mind that the data reported by the two authors are not in all instances the same. At the time of Ibn Khordadbeh, for instance, the whole of the revenue of the Tigris provinces seems to have been levied in cash, at the time of Qodama partly in cash and partly in kind. For us the sum total alone is of some interest, and this is given by Qodaéma, who says, bist 0 Bras] worl Cogs otgend! ¢ Ry U3, WS pds ASVOAS® Bt er 9 FS VIVE pee! Cpe 9 OS EP VEee pana] 9 &bict (yo Lydd yell or SI bent 25 yhaww Si blew sl wilt ase Peer rt Aseslisas lady y _yine Kmod i y-0, helS yy Catt] uy gD 9 tlds epdhes e233 Fa) Sow Sih yg [eateavse+ Grol! sl VS gree” 9 yo Kiired| he she EprtedS] Cy? Gpds bo uw ¢ IRs) eie=” Yoseces Kiel &s | pro Liiieoy1e* “The revenue of the Sawad, exclusive the poor rates of Baera, consists of 117,600 Korrs of wheat, 99,721 Korrs of barley, and 8,095,800 Dirhams of silver. The grain at the mean market price, that is to say at the rate of two Korrs, one of wheat and one of bar- ley at 60 Dynars, taking one Dynar at the present rate of exchange — equal to 15 Dirhams, is worth 100,361,850 Dirhams. Adding thissum — to the cash payments, there results a total of 108,457,650 Dirhams. The poor rates of Bacra amount annually to six million Dirhams, the - $$ | 1866.] Meynard’s Ibn Khordddbeh. 141 average revenue is therefore (some words unintelligible) 114,457,650 Dirhams.”’ These data enable us to calculate the price of grain at the time of Qodama. We convert the 100,361,850 Dirhams into Dynars, by dividing the number by 15, and we obtain 6,690,790 Dynars. With this money we purchase all the barley, and as many Korrs of wheat as there are Korrs of barley. Our expenditure amounts to 99,721 & 60 = 5,983,260 Dynars to spend and 17,879 Korrs of wheat to buy. Ii we divide the former number by the latter, we find that the Korr of wheat costs 194 (z. e. 839 Dynars and 10 Kirats), and consequently the Korr of barley 203 Dynars. The result cannot be far from the truth ; for at the time of Mohammad wheat was at Madyna twice as dear as arly (comp. my Leben des Moh., Vol. 3, p. 140), and consequently, if one Korr of wheat and one Korr ol barley together cost 60 Dyniars, the price of wheat ought to be 40 and that of barley 20 Dynars. But there remains much too great a cost in the division than that Qodama should have neglected it. I therefore propose to read 117,691 Korrs of wheat instead of 117,600. If we adopt this reading, a Korr of wheat cost 39 Dyndrs and 7} Kirdts (20 Kiréts = 1 Dynar) and a Korr of barley 20 Dynars 124 Kirats. A pound of bread (English weight) may have cost about 3 farthings. In Qodaéma occurs the following passage regarding the assessment of ’Omar I, Wastin ww wlais re 7) vlb=| ryote Wl @ alae er aitia Jls wu le @dyd ry > w9S) BS) wails Sha B29 Slow] mad cs baid Siah, URS) ee) pola Jls leds 9 ae sled Bilis yolby pole Kd ye urls=" cpieeiya eo! ree) ust JS8s Cleves seo ac) Kho wly Qasim b. Sallam asserts that ‘Omar, ‘the son of Khattab, sent ‘Othman b. Honayf of Madyna, and that this Othman measured the Sawad, and found that it contained 36 (sic) millions Jarybs, and he imposed upon every Jaryb of land, cultivated or fallow, provided it could be irrigated, a tax of one Qafyz and one Dirham. Qasim says, I have heard that this Qafyz was a cubic measure then in use in the Sawéd, and that it was called Shabirqany. Yahya b. Adam says it is identical with the Makhttim of Hajjaj. - This account differs from that of other authors, who record that ’Omar I. assessed the Sawad as follows :— 19 142 Meynard’s Ibn Khordddbeh. [No. 2, Every Jaryb of Barley, ...¢.0.-0e03++2ess0s'0,/ | 2; Dirhams, 99 PY] td Wheat, @ecreseeoe asereceses 4 9 . 59, Wineyards and orchards, 6 3 rs 9 @ gnc bbateplantatiompr 5.055240 8 5 The assessment of Omar was according to a tradition of Jabir by himself called Tasq (36 Freytag considers this term cognate with the expression of the Arabic Christians J’aqs (»*b, and it is perhaps also related with gist. No doubt itis derived from the same Greek word from which our tax comes. I believe, but am not sure, it was a permanent settlement, though owing to the disposition of the rulers and to circumstances, changes have taken place. The term tasq is applicable only to taxes levied from conquered land. It is pretty certain that the land-tax amounted to about one- half of the value of the produce. Qodama speaks of the tithes, and then he continues @453 wlewlast| me cole wrardy beild Symbait lef Bi) GUS cle Ula, Sicligl Islive wyySy bo ime che thee Garb ont or) ures who Gab ewe S81 Coy! pated I crlat (he The taxes on conquered land have been fixed in oi pine WR} accordance to the annual produce (of several years); consequently — the tax of a district has been fixed agreeably to justice. In proof thereof we may mention that in case it be necessary to convert tasq- land into tithe-land, one-fifth of the original tasq of the district is taken, because”: 5 = “ (a, in the original We} means in this case the value of the produce.) I believe we may safely infer from this passage that in the assess- ment of conquered lands, the same rules prevailed as in fixing the amount of tithe, with the only difference that one-half instead of one- tenth was levied. The general rule was that land which was watered without the expense of labour, paid the whole tithe. If labour was expended, one-half of the tithe or more was taken. Thus, if land was watered twice by a canal running through it, or if it was three times irrigated by means of a bucket by which water is raised from a canal, the tithe amounted not to ten, but to seven per cent., viz. 4 per cent. for the canal and 3 per cent. for the bucket. The ’Abbasides changed the system of revenue in the Sawad. Qodama says: Abi ’Obayd Allah Mo’4wiyya b. ’Abd Allah, the 1866.] Meynard’s Ibn Khordddbeh. 143 secretary (Katib) of the Khalyf Mahdiy reported on the inconve- niences which arose, if the tasq-payers were obliged to pay a fixed sum of money, or to supply a certain quantity of grain, and he proposed that the taxes should be calculated (annually) by the Jaryb, as there was no telling whether the prices would sink. or rise. In the one case the cultivator, in the other the government were in the disadvan- tage. The best thing, he thought, would be to introduce the same rule which the prophet adopted with regard to Khanghar : he left to the inhabitants the land under the condition that they were to give up to him one-half of the produce (as much the cultivators ought to give up from irrigated land) ; but if the labour of irrigation was very hard, they ought to give up only one-fourth; and if it was less hard: one-third. The choice was to be left to the farmers to give up as much straw* to government as was due to it (7. e. 4 or 4 or $ accord- ing to circumstances), or to sell it and pay the tax according to the market price of grain. In fixing the amount of revenue on vineyards, trees of every description, vegetables and every kind of produce, agreeably to the dictates of justice, the nett price which would be realized by the sale was to be calculated, taking into consideration what distance the land was from the market or harbour, and how great the expense and loss of time would be for bringing it there. After all these deductions one-half was to be charged as revenue. This system of revenue, which was eventually introduced, and by which the above detailed statements of Ibn Khordadbéh and Qodama are to be explained, is called Moqasima, a term which is used up to this day in India very nearly in the same signification as it was used at the time of our author: ‘‘ partition of the actual crop between the cultivator and the State, either in kind or in value.” Certain it is that one-half of the produce was taken fram the cultivators by the ’Abbasides; but it is not certain whether) ’Omar -made so high a ‘settlement as to deprive the farmers of the value of one-half, and whether the above passage of Qodama is applicable to the time previous to’ the» Abbaside dynasty. But we may safely assume that even at the time of 7Omar Is: the: revenue amounted to two- fifths. Now if a Jaryb of wheat paid 4 Dirhams to Government, the value pt the whole produce of a Jaryb could not be more than * In the original Gy 144 Meynard’s Ibn Khordddbeh. [No. 2; 10 Dirhams. This does not square either with the prices of grain in those days, nor with the size of the Jaryb which I have found. There must be something wrong in my calculations, and I therefore would call the attention of men in India, who take an interest in such matters, to the subject. They have means of ascertaining facts con- nected with revenue and agriculture, which are wanting in Europe. I now insert a statement of the revenue of the other provinces of the empire of the Khalyfs,; according to Qodama.* He usually gives the numbers and names of the districts into which every province was divided for the sake of administration, and states the totals of the revenue. As the MS. is very incorrect, I omit the names of districts and confine myself to the provinces : Dirhams. PNW Zio dette ols « tpcaci tees oi sishewaplos aariemnfeliod ven aaatenrd 18,000,000 pits iinet appt ciaihds lets Mele tiles bacco 24,000,000 CERAM. atta hatias iriarens smiebos mhuc a Recor « 6,000,000 Mekran, the ‘Cpanel SMO URC 4 hat we a tat donee 1,000,000 Dgpalani: Ys stax creass tyr wth des ater toes Bases . 10,500,000 Sijistan, the Tetita? revenue, secotne to agree- ment, amounted: £0,» ; nin 0:5 200,700 eco opsdaw cdesinetaaush pl OURO See 60,500,000 Khorasén. If Lunderstand right, this immense province was leased to Abd Allah b. Tahir, that is to say, he received the whole revenue, defray- ed the expenses of administration, and kept the surplus after having sent the tax to the treasury of the Khalyf in cash including the value of a cer- tain number of horses and slaves furnished to him, 38,000,000 Maile, 2.6. AAV UAWOT, ceo ce gence teweesnctio as. 1,000,000 Mah-Bagra, 2. e. Nohawand, ........secsees..2000e06 800,000 Flamadan,, 3.43.00, csnne « Re bieia [sts tes « on ake eee 1,700,000 Blastozan, coerce. Se gare Ses aes ieee ok sive «cg aisles 1,100,000 Mahrjan-Qazaq, ...... Be he g rusle press, chizie Te eee a eatery 1,200,000 — ommmaid: QOshan es o.' whcaPeiedcoss cas ace eee « 8,000,000 * Which may be compared with that of Ibn Khordadbeh. 1866. ] Meynard’s Ibn Khordddbeh. 145 ig Ardebyl, Marand, We. 5 LP.seehsash se. 4,500,000 Rayy,... Pepatine Shines Oe ; A be J ke , + v7 - % © | A A en: # a : \ Np ey - . Fr ‘ ‘or a . bi / Bs o A yap» Sieh eeay's bn Ts = 44 le. - re = =e Tea a ar ; 4 lane ‘ rat ees _ Pa “ Rie a thay eae Hist: : d S94 OLMIS DEL YRARATI : kD Ae eciaes Reb. i ae el es Thee é : eit wha a by io i fhe Esk Ki arene TO pals ot herein ey: 4 Re HED tits eel ech Drab sla ii Oe in g saad 7 : +, t ; ‘ aba sy Ket ea) 4} viednanlay 4tee Mes of Tita a nytbhoi ined a pticandaait! Yep oe BUGREY Seine eerie nena - auiieintsalecaastaiee ~ 5oe io OT cent ther a ortin otek : \ -ese-tah bo! one aeysiee ioe Seong na ae tale tha ati th. eialteben Ms: Fo, kaw jk ha ‘beter: j ti atao wiod aigth palintiats Lap qbep ngs me rors S34 ti 9 horter ROM e xn ait ‘at eps -oieade ; ae: : i ry a a “oveonatl para ten Porn, . fang Pvt =—<8ite , chy cree iL ar {isci« O83 haveveh jot 5 ; ghia. k , relies ts Oeea th an erioasa) "hehasdar ee eae oe . Tes Tete Ws wr sews cuore shot eerie itotanet etary hid) ct@titon heavens inanowth- sti aOFSblbRAa — <1 “oy Ot Spe hue herbert , } int a AE tsar ; | oat) ei dteodk acl Even Be afb . (is infnO . soem Sb te Betis ihe wag . | edriht. iio al B.D pera eiskaguanell Oo) au iri POW, need ifPrix fot Ye) } ) BATS (aay 0% DSits j 45> i +i), to 2m: Ste L3tC fa ows aod wea : wisn aoa duadinth: tre sink ort Sioa gpa ira aes fe ry: , ise oad Aled : sili set wainibainkdo sari ok iAdystal iL ihn act » yo fe es yedad cadr diede BO ihn ee af Tehee % Teese na_gd | an doerde ail ot a “io ott 16 mobtiga aid siulet OF baa. .qilaiom arena OF af i rauifiecom etait? dadt atetoteor OW ae bifid loo lob? deere dé -Jiebrivot Jo qitietomiaimm ’ - -olvgyad adrto- ino teas oil “hiznoila or idadd base (oS Yat lain praplig Insinislng otemtannenos venlgeily clocd offi im JQ URN AL OF THE ASIATIC SOCIETY OF BENGAL. VOL. XXXV. PART. LL. Nos. I. ro III.—1866. AND A SPECIAL NUMBER ON INDIAN ETHNOLOGY, EDITED BY THE NATURAL HISTORY SECRETARY. Lee “T¢ will flourish, if naturalists, chemists, antiquaries, philologers, and men of science in different parts of Asia, will commit their observations to writing, and send them to the Asiatic Society at Calcutta. It will languish, if such communications shall be long intermitted: and it will die away, if they shall entirely cease,” Sir Wm. JONEs, ewer eee CALCUTTA : PRINTED BY J. WENGER, BAPTIST MISSION PRESS. 1867. *y i | | | | | | | | CONTENTS. No. I. (Published 15th June, 1866.) Physical Characters of the Karens.—By the Rev. F. Mason, D. D., Contributions to Indian Malacology, No. VI. Descriptions of new land shells from the Nilgiri and Anamullay Hills, and other places in the Peninsula of India.—By W. T. "BLANFORD, Meg. A. R.S. M., E.G. S., ¥ Catalogue of the Specimens of Meteorie Stones and Meteoric Irons in the Museum of the Asiatic Society of Bengal, Cal- cutta, corrected up to January, 1866.—By Dr. F. SToLrozKa and H. F. BuanrorpD, Esq. F.G.S., ... Observations on the Astronomical points determined by the brothers Schlagintweit in Central Asia.—By Captain Gouv- BIEF, Comparative hypsometrical and physical Tableau of High ‘Asia, the Andes, and the Alps.—By Roserrt pr ScHLAGINTWEIT, Professor at the University of Giessen, oe Notes and Queries, Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observa- tions taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of August, 1865, . a Meteorological observations taken at Gangaroowa 1 near Kandy, Ceylon, in the month of May, 1864, se No. II. (Published 14th November, 1866.) Russian Geographical Operations in Asia.—Communicated by Lieut.-Col. J. T. Watxnr, R. E., Kashmir, the Western Himalaya and the Afghan Mountains, a geological paper by AtBert M. VercuErs, ‘Esq., M.D. al Medical Service ; with a note on the fossils by M. Epovarp DE VERNEUIL, Membre de I’ Académie des Sciences, Paris, Pt. L, Contributions to Indian Malacology, No. VII. List of species of Unio and Anodonta described as occurring in India, Ceylon a Burma.—By Wiu1am T, Buanrorp, gia A. B.S. M., G. :, a= Scientific Intelligence, : Abstract of the Results of the Houly Meteorological Observa- tions taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the months of September, October, November and De- cember, 1865, 507 oes eee aA ve Page 1 31 43 46 51 73 ic WH , be 77 89 . 134 156 1V Contents, Page No. III. (Published 22nd February, 1867.) Kashmir, the Western Himalaya and the Afghan Mountains, a geological paper by Atpert M. Vercuire, Esq., M.D. Bengal Medical Service; with a note on the fossils by M. Enovarp pE VerNevIL, Membre de l|’Académie des Sciences, Paris, Part IL. continued from page 1388, —... 159, EXPERIMENTAL INVESTIGATIONS connected with the ‘supply of WATER from the Hooghly to Cancurta, by Davin Watpiz, Hisq., Ci, ee ae een 203 Mee of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Obser- vations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the months of January and February, 1866, 433 i SPECIAL NUMBER, HiTHNOLOGY. (Published 22nd November, 1866.). The Ethnology of India.—By Mr. Justice Camppett,.. 1 The “ Kols’” of Chota-Nagpore,—By Lt.-Col. E. T. Darron, Commissioner of Chota-Nagpore, ? 153 Apprenpix A.—List of words and phrases to be noted ‘and used as test words for the discovery of the radical affinities of lan- guages, and for easy comparison, by Mr. Justrcn Campsrtn, 201 AppENDIx B.—Comparative Table of Aboriginal words, do., ... 204 ApprnpiIx ©.—Comparative Table of Northernand Arian Words, do. 207 Avprenpix D.—Kashmiri Vocabulary and Grammatical Forms, by L. Bowrtye, Hsq., . 225 APPENDIX KH. —Language of Dravidian Aborigines. N otes on the Oraon Language.—By the Rev. F. Barseu,... , 255 Apprenpix F.—Brief Vocabulary of the Moondah and cognate Languages of the Kolarian type.-—By Lieut.-Col. E. T. Darton, 266 Apprnpix G.—Grammar of the Ho Language. (Kolarian Abo- rigines.)—By Lieut.-Col. Ticxutt, &., oF -. 268 PLB PPO ae -- INDEX TO PART IL. The numbers with an asterisk belong to the Special Number on Indian Ethnology. ) Page Acanthocladia, ... ade i caoee sae Achatina anamullica, n 8., aan 37 — beddome?, n. 8., ove me ai 41 = testudo, 1. 8., ‘see a spoepyge — textilis, nie 41 Aconcagua peak, nha ie 55 Aigialites ruficapillus, (Goa, o ee yee ys Agricultural tribes, be *19 Aha Tung Limestone quarry, 193 Alexandrowskiia chain, °%:. is Alto de Toledo Pass, ‘a, sas te 54 Ammonia in the Hooghly water, we re IE er Analysis of tank water, ... sos as tg ates | — of the river water, . . 219 Anamully land shells, 31 Andria and Ariana, . ote ase Parang Pass, eis ie sed Deatiahs, ... so, ae aa Pasees, ... oa “ae ai se Pastoral tribes, 7 = vee Pasture ground i in the Himalay Si aaa Xil Index. Page Pathans or Afghans, : pe hss Perovski Fort, Rear admiral Boutakof’s expedition to the, ... 84 Pir Punjal chain, sists ae re fe 111—114 Plateaux, : = Porphyry of Buniar, Productus semi-reticulatus, (Martin), — costatus (Sow.), ins ats ee cora (D’Orbigny), + toe humboldtic (D’ Orbigny), ota dy — flemingw (D’Orbigny), longispinus, (Verneuil), ies Pterocyclos nanus, (Bens.), Ee wie Pterocyclos cual, (Metcalfe), Purbhoos, ... Saig wee Fs Puttoons, The leafclad, id ets eke ee Pwo or heu- phlong, Pycnonotus jocosus, (l.) Rajpoot Brahmans, Rawats or Rajis of ‘Rohileund, . Reechpoora Spurs, ron, ;...: Russian Geographical operations in Asia,. Sansees, se ee Saij Aha hills, oe soe xs Saraswata Brahmans, See *.. ae Sarhools’ feast of the Oraons, Res Sarry-kul, the source of the Amu, Determination of, Schlagintweit’ S ge Tableau of er Asia, the "Andes, and the Alps, Scindees, Serairkilla and Thakoors of Khurswan Sgau or Pgha-Knyan, Shan Karens, oe Shanar, ee ate Sheri Bal mountain, Sherrias, The wild, of Bundelcund, Shinku a Pass, Shokum Spring, Singbhoom Ho or Lurka Kols, Snowfall ; in the Himalaya, tee ol Snowline, The Himalayan, Solenopsis embricata ? tis aa a sae Sontals;. ... 4 : sh sine sas Spor aculum hispidum, de rae — beddomit, ni. 8., 5) eoe Index. Spirifer verchervi, (Verneuil), ses Spiriferina octoplicata ? (Sow.), —— stracheyt, (Salter), ... St. Theodule Pass, Stoliczka’s (Dr. EF) Catalogue of Meteoric stones, Strophomena analoga, (Phill.), . - Symphonota bilineata, (Lea), Syrdaria, ... see Tanaolees, ie Tank water, Composition of, Taru or Plu, as Teers, Tehon, Investigations beyond the, Tertiaries near Ori Fort, Thames, and New River, Quantity of solid matter in n the, Than Karens, , Tharoos of Goruckpore, Todas, Peculiarities of the, Total nd matter in river water, Toungthu or Lau, Towns and villages i in High Asia, Tukt-i-Suliman, Turkistan and Western Thibetan lakes, Unio anodontinus, (Lam.), bengalensis, (ea), —— bilineatus, (Lea), ... —— ceruleus, (Lea), —— corrianus, (Lea), cor rugatus, (Miull.), . favidens, var. marcens, (Bens. Se favidens, es : favidens, var. trigona, —— favidens, var. delte, : favidens, var. chrysts, ... ne —— favidens, var. viridula, favidens, var. densa, —— involutus, (Bens.), Ee eee —— lamellatus, (Lea), macilentus, (Bens.), marginalis, (Lam.), dele merodabensis, (Busch.), nagpoorensis, (Lea), — nuttallianus, (ea), —— olivarius, (Lea), —— rugosus, (Gmelin), X1V Index. Page Unio rajahensis, (Lea), — rae Ja a, co teed —— sikkimensis, (Lea), mas baie she ee a eh —— theca, (Bens.), .. ie ot yee ac - 444 —— wynegungaensis, (iea), 46 + aes sat ». 145 Vegetation of Central Asia, ... oa aaa bas 69 Velmas, i PLLA Verchares’ (Dr. A. M.) Geology of Kashmir ée. “00s ggg Op ebnseRs Vernag spring in Kashmir, mak 56 Vincularia multangularis (Portt), os es o. dbl Vitrina auriformis,.n. 8., vs ig ot dn 36 gigas, (Bens.),... «+» Bas ie a 37 membranacea, (Bens.), ... as ae eae 37 Waldie’s (Mr. D.) Investigations connected with the Water Supply to Calcutta, 203 Walker’ s res? J. T)R Russian Geographical operations in Asia, woot) ileetisegh Wastarwan, 172 Water Supply to Caleutta, Investigations connected with the, 203 Water, Constituents of River, os a Sure) Water at ebb and flood tide at Baranagur, ie a BOe Water, Amount of solid matter in the, “of the Hooghly, e--/208 Weean and Kohew valleys, Lar «ania SLbg Western Thibet, Plateaux in, eas me aes 52 Wokuls,, 42:2 ‘ she ac Ay ancy Fag Woolar ‘Lake, sue “ae a de we 20% Yarkand, Cartographical position of, ee sive a 48 Zebanwan spur, aR aes S5 bes sven) ag Zebanwan, < aes ee a eax. \, alli JOURNAL OF THE meLALIC. SOCIETY. —)-— Part IL—PHYSICAL SCIENCE. — eee No. I.—1866. ONIN NLL LCLLN LOLOL ITT TE ee es Physical Character of the Karens.—By the Rev. F, Mason, D. D, [Received 7th January, 1865, | KareEns.* The name Karen has been adopted from the Burmans, who apply it to various uncultivated tribes, that inhabit Burmah and Pegu; but it is used, in these notices, as designating a people that speak a lan- guage of common origin, which is conveniently called Karen ; embracing many dialects, and numerous tribes. These tribes, though speaking a common language, have no common name with which to distinguish themselves; but in this respect, they do not differ from our own ancestors. Cesar found some twenty or thirty different tribes in Britain, but it does not appear that they had pany common name by which they designated themselves. * The following pages are offered as answers to “Queries respecting the human race addressed to travellers, by a Committee of the British Association for the Advancement of Science,” at the request of Col. Phayre; and embrace all the writer has to Say on the general division of the Queries, entitled “‘ Phy- sical Characteristics ;”’ from Query 1 to Query 49. No answers are given to Queries 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, and 30, relating mainly to anatomy, because “satisfactory ones have not been obtained, Nor are answers given to Queries 13, 14, 15, 16, because the writer has already published on the subject of Language i in the Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal, and in his work on “ Burmah.” To write again on the subject, would necessarily compel him to repeat considerable of what is already in print, which seemed un- desirable. 1 2 Physical Character of the Karens. [No. 1, The word Karen has been supposed to signify aboriginal, from yen* “first,’’ and ka} a formative particle ; but the derivation is European, not Burmese. The Burmans have never been so recondite in naming wild tribes. When the Buddhist missionaries landed at Martaban, they denominated the aboriginal inhabitants Beloos, or ‘‘ Monsters,” and the Burmese still retain the name for a tribe of Karens on the borders of Karenee. The subdued Bghais they dispose of as Loo-Yaing,} “wild men; while the more civilized Mopghas that bring honey and bees’ wax for sale, they call Zaubya,§ “ wild bees; and they find in the dress of another a distinctive name, and call them ‘‘ Red Karens.”’ The word Karen is probably a Karen word. One of the northern Karen tribes, with which the: Burmans must have held most inter- course before they conquered Pegu, call themselves Ka-yong, which is sufficiently near the Burmese to be the same word. Then we have a precisely parallel case in the name they give this tribe, which is Gai-kho,|| a Karen word that is manifestly identical with Kaz-khen, the name the other Karen tribes give them. Hight distinct Karen tribes are known, who speak dialects so diverse, that they cannot understand each other; and yet, on examination, the larger proportion of the roots of each dialect are of common origin. These tribes have often several names, and not only are travellers misled by them; but residents often take up wrong impressions and give, for distinct nations, names that refer to the same tribe. A few of the tribes only have distinctive names for themselves, and all, when speaking to each other, use the word for man to designate themselves ; precisely as the Hebrews use the word for man as the proper name of the first man, Adam. Were these terms for man adopted in English, the tribes would be much more accurately distin- guished than they are at present. Thus we should have Pgha-knyan for Sgau. Pie-ya os Bghai. Pra-ka-ya, or Ka ya ___,, Red Karen. Heu-phlong 5 Pwo. Peu pe Taru. Plau . Mopgha. eo) ils hee ai ag Ace § CODD qs sil oy) a /_»pa 1866.] Physical Character of the Karens. 3 Pray-ka-yong for Kay or Gaikho. Lau re Toungthu. Sgau, or Pgha-knyan. This tribe is known by a diversity of names. Sgau, the name the tribe give themselves. Burmese Karens, thus designated by some English writers. White Karens, the name given them by English travellers to distin- guish them from the Red Karens. Myeet-tho, so designated by the Burmese. Shan, the name the Pwas give them. Pa-ku, the name by which they are known in Toungoo, and to the Red Karens ; but it more properly denotes a sub-tribe of Sgaus. Shan-ne-pgha, a name given to another sub-tribe of Sgaus. We-wa, a small sub-tribe of doubtful origin, but probably originally Sgaus. Bauat, or Pin-ya. The Bghais have no distinctive name for themselves, besides Pie-ya. Bghai is the name the Sgaus give them, and they recognise the mame so far as to apply it with an adjective to sub-tribes among themselves. Bghai-ka-teu, ‘ Bghais at the end,” is the name of the Tunic Bghais, as used by the Pant Bghais ; because they live at the extre- mity of the tribe nearest Toungoo. _ Tunic Bghai is the name given to the above sub-tribe, by English writers, because they wear tunics or frocks. - Bghai-ka-hta, ‘ Upper-Bghai.” The Pant Bghais are thus de- nominated by the Tunic Bghais, because they live on the streams above them. Pant Bghai is the denomination by which all the Bghais that wear pants are known to English writers. A-yaing, or Ka-yen Ayaing, ‘“ Wild Karens,” is the name the Burmese give to nearly all the Pant Bghai. Leik-bya-gyie, ‘‘ Great Butterflies” is the Burmese name of a por- tion of the Tunic-Bghai. _ Leik-bya-guay, °‘‘ Little Butterflies” are other villages of Pant Bghai., . % 4 Physical Character of the Karens. [No. I, Pra-pa-ku, is the name given by the Red Karens to the Bghais that live near the Pa-kus. ; Manu-manau is a Burmese name given to a mixed sub-tribe of ~ Bghais. Pray is the Red Karen name applied to the Manu-manau and to some other clans related to the Bghais. Lay-may is Burman for a sub-tribe of Bghais, called Pray by the Red Karens. Shan-kho is a name given to a Bghai clan in the north-eastern part of Toungoo. ; Rep Karen, or Ka-ya. The Red Karens have no name for themselves, except Ka-ya, or Pra-ka-ya. Ka-yeu-nie, “‘ Red Karen” is the name given them by the Burmese, on account of the red-striped pants they wear. Bghai-mu-hta, Bghai-mu-htay, names given them by the Bghais, signifying ‘‘ Hastern Bghai.” Yang-laing, ‘‘ Red Karens” is their name among the Shan tribes. The-pya the name by which the Kay people designate them. Ta-lya a small sub-tribe of Red Karens, are thus denominated by the Red Karens themselves. Yen-ka-la, the Burmese name of the above clan. Tha-vie, or Tha-vie-la-kha is a Red Karen name for a people of their own tribe living ten days’ journey above them, on the Salween, and who were separated from them when driven from Ava, sixteen generations ago. In 1861, our Assistant in Karenee reported a singular letter that was sent by them to Karenee ; the object of which was not stated dis- tinctly, but it was understood as a challenge to fight. The following is a translation:— _ ‘‘ Now, the words of God and his commands have come to us. Let all men give up the customs of their ancestors, and offerings to spirits, and live in peace. As for us in the land of Tha-vie, we will dwell in peace and obey the commands. “* Nevertheless, at the proper time we will make a feast; and this feast is not a woman’s feast, but a man’s feast ; and when the time arrives to dance, we will dance. And the shades of the dead, and the 1 : | | 1866.] Physical Character of the Karens. 5 spirits will look on. We say to you, if you wish to look on, come and look, and bring sword and spear. We have appointed the month of March for the time of holding the feast.” Pwo, or Hrvu-putone. The Pwos call themselves Sho. Pwo is the name given them by the Sgau. Meet-khyen is a name given them by the Burmese, signifying “ River-khyens.” Talaing-Karens is a designation they have in some published papers, and they are sometimes thus designated by the Burmese, because they are principally found among the Talaings. Shoung is a name given to a small sub-tribe of Pwos in the north of Toungoo. . Tarv, or Piv. Taru is the name given to a tribe nearly related to the Pwos by the Red Karens. Khu-hta is the name they give themselves. Be-lu or monsters is the name by which they are characterized by the Burmese. is reported as remarkably loose. The commerce of the sexes among young people is defended as nothing wrong, because “‘ it is our custom.”’ The Sau-bwakepho has a regular rule to give six rupees damages in cases of rape ; but these are the only cases of crim. con. that he enter- tains in his courts. Chastity is cultivated, however, by the other Karen tribes; and one ‘means by which it is preserved, is early marriages. The great majo- rity are married soon after the age of puberty. Still, while the young _ people are as chaste as most people in Christian nations, lapses among the married are not uncommon; but illegitimate children are very rare. The Sgaus at least are not wanting in good precepts, notwithstand- ing, for a contrary course. The Elders say : “O children and grandchildren ! do not commit adultery, or forni- cation, with the child or wife of another ; for the Righteous One looks down from above, and these things are exposed to him. Those that do thus, will go to hell. “Tf you meet the wife of another, avoid her, and pass on the lower side of the road.” . Though the Bghais do not appear to have precisely the same form of command, yet they regard adultery as particularly offensive to God, and as being the cause sometimes of bad crops. Human nature is the same everywhere, and the betrothal of child- ‘ren in infancy often results in unhappy marriages, and unfaithfulness to the marriage tie. _ Sometimes the parties, on becoming of marriageable age, so dislike each other, that they rebel against the authority of the Elders, and form connections for themselves more congenial to their tastes. PoLyGamMy. Polygamy is neither permitted nor practiced by any of the Karen tribes; but Karens who live in the neighbourhood of the Burmese 20 Social Customs é&c. of the Karens. | [No. 1, sometimes adopt the Burmese custom of taking an additional wife, as they do that of worshipping idols. The Sgau Elders charge their children : ‘‘Q children and grandchildren! If you have one husband or wife, lust not after another, male or female; for God at the beginning created only two, one male and one female.” Divorce. Divorces are not unfrequent, arising often from marriages being made by the parents of the betrothed in infancy, and the children grow up without any love for each other. If a man leaves his wife, the rule is that the house and all the pro- perty belongs to her. He is allowed no claim on his money and valuables that may be in the wife’s possessions, after he has left her. Nothing is his but what he takes with him. If a woman forsakes her husband, it is usual to allow a share of the property, but no more than the husband consents to allow. Wipows. Widows retain their husbands’ fireplace, and endeavour to support themselves. When young they usually marry again; but if old and unable to support themselves, they look for help to their own rela- tions, and often suffer from neglect. The obligation to treat widows kindly is recognised in theory, but often neglected in practice. “The following story from the Bghai gives a too true picture of this matter. “Formerly, there was a woman whose husband died, and left her to get a support as best she could. All her children were small. Their father had forsaken them, and the mother took care of them in any corner or interstice she could find. “She had no relations of her own in that country. She had none but her husband’s relations, and her husband was dead, and his rela- tions would not help her. She could not therefore get curry to eat, | and she fed her children on the sheaths of the blossoms of the wild _ plantain flowers: these she called to the children “ brains,” and they q ~ knew not, but that was the proper name. ‘When the neighbours heard the children say they lived on brains, | they said: ‘The woman is a witch! Morning after morning it is 1866. ] Social Customs dc. of the Karens. 21 brains; evening after evening it is brains. It must be she goes and gets human brains to eat. We cannot get so many brains: and they have no father. Where can so many brains come from?’ “ After awhile they concluded they would kill her for being a witch, and they made known their intentions to an uncle of hers. He said : ‘ Wait till I can go and see her.’ When at leisure, he went to see the family. He killed a deer, took the head to the children, and showed the brains to the children, asking: ‘ Does your mother feed you with brains like these?’ They all replied: ‘ No, uncle, mother feeds us with brains that are bright red.’ There are no fibres in them like these.’ “The uncle then repeated his enquiries successively with the heads of a horse, an elephant, a bear, a goat-antelope, a bison, a barking deer, a porcupine, a bamboo-rat, a squirrel, a tupai, a rat, a bird, a fowl, a snake, a frog, a fish, and every kind of animal known in the country ; but the children said to all, ‘ Uncle, our mother feeds us with no such brains as these.’ “ He thought to himself; ‘It is not this, and it isnot that. Surely the woman is a witch, for there is no other kind of brains it can be, but human brains.’ So he concluded it was best to kill her. ** However he went out hunting one day more, and all day he met with nothing; so on his return home he plucked two sheathes of wild plantain blossoms, and bringing them into the house, he laid them down by the wash stand. One of the children saw the bright red sheathes ; ‘My uncle has brought me some brains, I will eat them al) myself, I will not give a taste to any one else.’ All the children rejoiced greatly, and said ‘ These are the brains on which mother fed us.’ “When the uncle knew that his niece was not a witch, he almost fainted at the thought of having so nearly consented to her death.” Foop. A Karen is a most omnivorous animal. Always excepting the feline race, he eats every quadruped from a rat to an elephant; and there is scarcely a reptile unacceptable to his palate, from a sand lizard to a crocodile, and from a toad to a serpent. Flying ants and crawl- ing grubs are in his bill of fare; and there is no bird too tough, no fish 22 Socral Customs &c. of the Karens. [No. 1, too bony for his table. Dogs are not eaten by the Southern Karens, but they are as great delicacies in the Bghai country as they are in China. To this great mass of animated nature, the whole vegetable king- dom is made to serve as greens. Nearly every weed is a vegetable, and the young shoots of the largest trees serve as spinage. They are so careless about what they gather for greens, that one of our young teachers poisoned himself, not long ago, by the vegetable curry he made by the way, while travelling. Besides game, the Karens raise hogs and fowls for home consump- tion as well as for sale, and on festive occasions, those who are able, purchase and kill a buffalo or ox; so they do not seem to lack for animal food. Still, they may be often seen sitting down to rice and vegetable curry, with perhaps a taste of dried fish, and they certainly do not eat as much animal food as Kuropeans. They live much like the wild beasts of the forest. When chance, or something very like it, sends them a whole beast, they eat meat to surfeit; and then they live on vegetables and rice, till the wheel of fortune turns round again. The meat is often cut into small pieces and boiled in curry; but it is also frequently roasted or grilled. Fish is often dried, as is also the flesh of game sometimes ; but dried so imperfectly, that it usually has q a very bad odour. The Karens distil from rice or millet a kind of whiskey, of which men, women, and children often drink to intoxication. But, like their — meat, this too they have not on hand constantly ; and they are sober — a great part of the year, because they cannot get anything to drink to | be intoxicated. x In the matter of quantity, they take more food at a meal than — P| Kuropeans ; and yet, if labouring hard, require to eat more frequently: a I have often walked with them, up hill and down; and though I could walk all day, from sunrise to sunset, after an early breakfast with a couple of crackers, and water from the brook by the way; the Karens were always knocked up by noon; and had to stop and eat a - hearty meal, before they were able to proceed. This is true of all the | natives in the country ; but is not quite understood by some of our medical men. Natives are sometimes taken into the hospitals, and | 1866. ] Social Customs &c. of the Karens. 23 actually starved to death by not having food enough allowed them to keep up their strength. » Dress. The dress of Karen men, south of Toungoo, is a tunic, or frock, and a wrapper ; the latter serving for a sheet to sleep in at night. Hach one, too, usually carries a bag slung over his shoulder. The tunics of different tribes and clans are distinguished by the peculiar embroidery of each.* The Sgau tunic has red horizontal parallel lines on a white ground. The Bghai tunic, on the contrary, has the red lines perpendicular. The Pgho tunic has a broad belt of embroidery at its base, and the Pahu tunic has a narrow band, and the figures varied for every village, originally distinct families, so the markings are equivalent to coats of arms. One clan of the Bghais wear tunics, but by far the larger portion of the tribe wear pants, and no tunic; and all the tribes beyond them, as the Gaikho, Tarus, and Red. Karens wear pants; but each tribe or clan has some variation in the stripes of figures worked on them, so that, like those who wear tunics, they can be distinguished at a glance.t Excepting the Red Karens, all the women wear a short gown, petti- coat, and large turban, all variously omamented. The Red Karen women have corresponding articles of dress, but each one is merely a rectangular piece of cloth. _ The dresses are made of cotton, which the women usually plant, gather, clean, spin into thread, and weave into cloth. The Northern Bghais and Gaikhos, who raise the silkworm, adorn their dresses with a profusion of silk embroidery. In some of their clans, the Elder who officiates as high priest in their offerings, or sacrifices, has a longer and more ornamented tunic presented to him than ordinary, but nothing in their traditions has been found to explain the reason. To describe the different modes of ornamenting their dresses, would require a long article by itself, and a series of drawings. * There is one exception. The Mopghas wear the same tunic as the Tunic- Bghais, but why, no reason is known. They speak widely different dialects. + There is one exception, The Northern Bghais, and the Gaikhos wear the same pants, 24 Diseases of the Karens. | [No. 1, Tattooing is a practice quite foreign to all the Karen tribes, except- ing the Red Karens, who are all tattooed across the back with a figure resembling the rays of the rising sun. They can give no account of the origin of the custom. Karens who are brought in contact with the Burmese and Talaings, often adopt their customs, so that Karens are often found, especially among the Pghos, tattooed and dressed like Burmans. No characteristic mode of amusement has been observed. The Karens dance, wrestle, and show their agility much like the other nations around them. Games of chance are not unknown to the people, but they are little addicted to them, and never bet on them, unless they have been cor- — rupted by the Burmese or Shans. Every village has a good complement of old people in it, and I have met with two men, who considered themselves a hundred years of age. Every village has persons over sixty, seventy is not uncommon, eighty is rare, but ninety is met occasionally. No marked difference has been noticed between the sexes in respect to longevity. SICKNEsS. Where diseases are not deemed contagious, ordinary attention is” bestowed upon the sick by their friends and relatives; but when conta- gious diseases appear, like the small-pox, the whole population seems — struck by a panic, and they abandon their houses and scatter into the jungles, where they build booths, and remain till they consider the disease to have passed away. They deem the cholera as contagious as small-pox, and though husbands and wives, parents and children will unite and watch each other to the end} yet all often run away, as soon as a person is dead, and leave him unburied. It is extremely difficult to get people buried in times of cholera. . The Karens attribute diseases to the influence of unseen spirits, an hence, to cure them, they resort to making offerings to appease the spirits that are supposed to be offended. They have twenty or thirty — distinct names for different offerings that are made for the sick. They q do not, however, exclude the use of medicine altogether ; and the | g Karen Elders have a large Materia Medica, consisting of roots and 1866.) Diseases of the Karens. 25 herbs, leaves and bark, to fall back upon when the offerings do not prove efficacious. From satisfactory statistics the annual death rate of the Mountain Karens has been ascertained as a little over two and a half per cent., or about the same asin London. The same years that these statistics were collected, the death rate among the acclimatized European soldiers in Toungoo, was only one per cent. The difference should be attributed, it is believed, to difference in constitution, difference in habits, and difference in treatment of the sick; and not to locality. The Karen Mountains appear as healthy as the Scotch Mountains, or the Mountains of Pennsylvania. That something does affect the death rate besides the locality, is manifest from the deaths in the Toungoo jail. The very years that one man only in a hundred was dying in Cantonments, from eight to seventeen in a hundred were dying in the jail. : Karens lack vigour of constitution, and therefore present a weak resisting power to disease. They are subject to intermittent fevers throughout life. I have prescribed to shivering infants at the breast and to shaking old men of threescore and ten. An European does not escape them, but he has a strong constitution, which struggles hard, and if it comes off victor, it is a victor for life. For the first four years of my jungle travels, I had fever every year, but for thirty years since, with one slight exception, I have been entirely exempt. Bites from land leeches often result in bad sores on Karens; while an European will sit down and pick off a dozen from his legs after a walk, without the slightest subsequent inconvenience. In some localities, there is a species of gad fly that bites severely, and its bite is often followed by an ulcer on a Karen; while I have had the backs of both my hands dotted all over with blood spots from their bites, without suffering anything beyond the temporary incon- venience. The Karens are a dirty people. They never use soap, and their skins are enamelled with dirt. When water is thrown on to them, it rolls off their backs, like globules of quicksilver on a marble slab. To them, bathing has a cooling, but no cleansing effect. Dirt is death’s half brother, and is the father of a host of skin diseases to which the Karens are subject. About half of them have the itch, and 4 26 Diseases of the Karens. [No. 1, many in the form of dreadful sores. Shingles, and fish-skin, and ring- worm are nearly as common as psora. Many diseases, common to all nations, are much more fatal to Karens than to Europeans. The measles are as fatal as the small-pox in Hurope, and the hooping cough often makes sad havoc among children. I have known more than twenty die of this disease in a small village of some two hundred inhabitants. Consumption kills a few, dropsy more, dysentery many, and occa- sionally considerable numbers are reported to me as dying of fevers; and yet I have never met with a single case of fever among the Karens, that did not yield to medicine. Enlarged spleen is very com- mon, and is sometimes fatal. Ulcers do not kill, but they are as com- mon as skin diseases, and are in great variety. There is a disease very prevalent among the Sgau tribes, in which large ulcers appear on the,limbs. I have had patients brought to the — towns, where they have been sent to the hospitals; and sometimes they have been slightly benefited; but in no case has a cure been effected by European treatment ; and I have never found a Surgeon — who understood the nature of the disease. One said: ‘‘ It is not leprosy ;”’ but I think it is a kind of leprosy. Another remarked on the cases submitted to his treatment: ‘I cannot help thinking there is some- thing venereal in it.” This the Karens uniformly deny, but I have certainly seen cases in which both legs were masses of what appeared to be incurable sores completely cured, by severe salivation administered — } by a Burmese doctor; which favours the idea of the venereal character of the disease ; but [ have seen others die under the same treatment. _ The disease is hereditary in most instances, but whenever an ulcer appears, the Karens consider it infectious, and will not have the patient in the same house with them. They insist on his living in a 4 separate house, as much as they would a leper. The Burmese, how- aa ever, do not consider the disease infectious, in which they are partly | correct. The Bghais say it is a foreign disease, and some call it “the + | 2 ) 5 66 = . a Paku disease,” and others the “‘ Burmese disease ;” while the Burmese - in some sections call it “the Martaban disease,” and in others “the | Toungoo disease.” Goitre is common on the hills in special localities. It abounds in — one village on the granite mountains, while villages three hours’ walk : 1866 | Diseases of the Karens. 27 distant are nearly eXempt, though located on the same hills, with the same geological formation. Three or four days’ journey beyond this, in an extensive region, where the rocks are exclusively secondary limestone, goitre is again found in excess, while other villages, on the same limestone range, are quite free from the disease. In neither of these districts has any metallic mineral been: found. Still, there must be something special in the localities where it abownds to produce it ; but what that is, remains to be discovered. All that can be said of it with certainty is, that it is a disease of the hills, for it is not found on the plains ; nor did I ever meet with it on the hills in the 'Fenasserim Provinces. The Karens attribute it to the soil, and say that the dis- ease is caught by eating beans, pumpkins, and other vegetables raised in the infected locality, and by drinking the water that runs through it. Their theory has probably some foundation in fact. Fowls and hogs that the Karens raise, are occasionally attacked by a violent disease by which they die off as if they had the cholera ; and buffaloes on the plains are subject to a like complaint, Worms. Entozoa are very abundant. The round worm, ascaris lwmbricoides, is often vomited up by Karens, both children and adults. The com- mon tape worm, tenia solum, is a common inhabitant of the bowels, as are also thread worms, ascaris vermicularis. Derara. When an elder among the Bghais, with a large number of descend- ants, dies, the people build a place in the hall for the deposit of the corpse, and they hew a coffin out of the body of a tree, and hew a eover for it, like the Chinese coffins. The body lies in state three or four days, and during the time men blow pipes, and the young men and maidens march round the eorpse to the music. At night, the piping is discontinued, and singing is substituted. When the piping and marching is not going forward, the exercises are diversified by weeping and mourning; or by the men knocking pestles together, and others showing their dexterity by putting their hands or heads in between, and withdrawing them quickly before the missiles come together again. 28 Burial rites among the Karens. [No. 1, and the fragments gathered are looked upon as charms to prolong life. When about to bury the corpse, two candles made of bees-wax are lighted, and two swords are brought. A sword and a candle is taken by the eldest son, and a sword and a candle by the youngest ; and they march round the bier in opposite directions three times, each time they meet exchanging swords and candles. After completing the circuits, one candle is placed at the foot of the coffin, and the other at the head. A fowl or a hog is led three times round the building in which the body is placed, and on completing the first round, it is struck with a strip of bamboo once; on completing the second round twice; and at the third round it is killed. Ifa fowl, it is killed by twisting its head off. The meat is set before the body as food. Young people are buried in a similar manner, but with some abridgement of the forms. When the day of burial arrives, and the body is carried to the grave, four bamboo splints are taken, and one is thrown towards the west, saying : ‘‘ That is the east.”” Another is thrown to the east, saying: ‘‘ That is the west.” A third is thrown upwards towards the top of the tree, saying : “‘ That is the foot of the tree; ” and a fourth is thrown downwards, saying: ‘‘ That is the top of the tree.” The sources of the stream are then pointed to, saying: “‘ That is the mouth ? of the stream ;’’ and the mouth of the stream is pointed to, saying : ‘‘That is the head of the stream.’ ‘This is done, because in Hades — everything is upside down in relation to the things of this world. The body is then buried, and the grave filled in without further B > Before the burial, an elder opens the hand of the dead man and puts into a bangle or some other bit of metal, and then cuts off a few particles with a sword, saying: ‘‘ May we live to be as old as thou art.” Each one in the company goes through the same ceremonials, ceremony, and when the top of the grave has been neatly smoothed _ off, a little fence of trellis work is built around it. Within this fence, boiled rice and other food is placed for the dead. On returning from the grave, each person provides himself with e | three little hooks made of branches of trees, and calling his spirit to follow him, at short intervals, as he returns, he makes a motion as if — hooking it, and then thrusts the hook into the ground. This is done 1866. ] Karen feasts for the Dead. 29 to prevent the spirit of the living from staying behind with the spirit of the dead. After the funeral, the grave-digger washes his clothes, or the neg- lect to do so renders him unfortunate. Married children may dig the grave for a parent, but young ones are prohibited. They must hire some one to do the work, and give him five rupees. Feast ror THE Dean. Like the Chinese, the Bghais make annual feasts for the dead, for three years after a person’s death. The feast is made at the new moon near the close of August, or the beginning of September; and all the villagers that have lost relatives, partake in it. Before the new moon, they prepare food, plantains, sugar-cane, tobacco, betel nuts, betel leaves, and other articles of consumption. A bamboo is laid across one angle of the roof of the room, and on it are hung up new tunics, new turbans, new petticoats, beads and bangles ; and at the appropriate time, when the spirits of the dead are supposed to be present, having returned to visit them, they -say: ‘“‘ You have come to me, you have returned to me, It has been raining hard, and you must be wet. Dress yourselves, clothe yourselves with these new garments and all the companions that are with you. Hat betel together with all that accompany you, all your friends and associates, and the long dead. Call them all to eat and drink.” After dark, all the people eat bread made of boiled rice beaten in a mortar. The bread is spread down, and the people are invited: “ All who are hungry, eat bread here.”’ Next morning, the first day of the moon, which is deemed the proper feast day, the previous last day of the month being regarded as the day of preparation, all who have Kyee-zees hang them up, and beat them. Then they kill a hog, and make thirty bottles of bamboos. Into one bottle, they put honey, into another water, in a third whis- key, in a fourth salt, in a fifth oil, in a sixth chillies, and into the seventh tumeric. The other twenty-three are laid aside. Loopholes are made to each bottle through which a string dyed yellow is tied. After setting apart the seven bottles that have been filled, the re- maining twenty-three are filled with food indiscriminatively. Some with pork, some with boiled rice, some with bread, some with whis- key, and some with betel. When these are filled, xice bread is rolled 30 Karen feasts for the Dead. [No. }, up in leaves, and the rolls piled up together ; and then a large basket of open work is woven, into which all these bamboo bottles and the rolls of bread are put. When the rice and meat is cooked for the feast, after the above arrangements have been made, the food is placed on kyee-zees, or little bamboo stools, if they have no kyee-zees; and they have to be very particular to spread out all the food at the same instant, lest some of the spirits of the dead, being delayed in eating, should be left behind by their companions. So soon as the food is arranged on the tables, the people beat the kyee-zees and begin to cry, which they say is calling the spirits to come to eat. Each one calls on the particular relative, for whom he has prepared the feast, as father, mother, sister or brother. Ifa mother, he says; weeping : “O prince-bird mother, it is the close of August, Oh! It is the new moon in September, Oh! You have come to visit me, Oh! You have returned to see me, Oh! I give you eatables, Oh! I give you drinkables, Oh! Eat with a glad heart, Oh! Hat with a happy mind, Oh! Don’t be afraid, mother, Oh! Do not be apprehensive, Oh!” After the weeping exercises are over, the spirits are supposed to have finished their repast, and then the people sit down to eat what is left. More food is then prepared and put into the basket with the bam- boo bottles, that the spirits may have food to carry away with them ; and at cock-crowing next morning all the contents of the basket, including the bamboo bottles, are thrown out of the house on the ground ; when the same scene of crying and calling on the spirits of the dead is repeated, as detailed above. They do not weep long, because it is related that in ancient times — a woman had a daughter, whom she loved much, and after her death she made this annual festival for her and wept long; when a prophet reproved her, saying: “‘ That is enough. Your daughter says : ‘ My companions have left me. They have all gone on before.” Then | the mother said: ‘ Seize her for me,” and the prophet attempted to 4 grasp her, but he got only a single hem from her garment. Hence the people never weep long, that the departed spirits of their friends may not be left behind by their companions. — eel 1866. | Contributions to Indian Malacology. 31 Contributions to Indian Malacology, No. VI. Descriptions of new land shells from the Nilgirt and Anamullay Hills, and other places in the Peninsula of India.—By W. T. Buayrorp, A. &. S. I, B. G..8. [Received 3rd February, 1866. ] Of the shells described in the following pages, the greater portion were collected by Captain Beddome, Deputy Conservator of Forests, in the Madras Presidency. This is the case with all the shells from the Anamullay hills, and also the remarkable species of Spiraculum from the neighbourhood of Vizagapatam. The Nilgiri Hill shells were found by myself in a recent visit, and H. intwmescens was given to me some years since by Mr. Theobald as AH. Bajadera, Pir. I have since collected the shell myself living at Mahableshwar. 1. Sprracutum Beppomet, n. s. Shell very broadly umbilicated, depressed, sub-discoidal, smooth, (?) solid, white with transverse chesnut zigzag stripes. Spire flat or sub- convex, suture deep. Whorls 5, rounded, the last cylindrical, de- scending gradually towards the aperture, and furnished, 7-10 milleme- tres behind the peristome, with a short open sutural tube, projecting forwards and upwards, not touching the penultimate whorl. Aperture diagonal, circular, peristome double, both lips continuous, the inner slightly expanded, curved back into a shallow angular sinus at the suture, the outer expanded, and inverted upon the upper and dextral margins, rising near the suture into a compressed wing, which is at- tached throughout on the left side to the penultimate whorl. Opercu- lum horny, concave within, convex without, flattened near the centre, 2 or 3 outer whorls furnished with a free spiral testaceous lamelliform border. Millem. Inches. Major diameter, ............ bani 27 1.12 PRIROTOUUUG, nececds vqaccdtcescass, 20 92 PEM rel cee anintsiaeses ~ LO A Interior diameter of aperture,.. 8 O2 Habitat. Kimery Hills near Waltair (Vizagapatam), northern divi- sion of the Madras Presidency. 32 Contributions to Indian Malacology. [No.3 This species is of about the same size as Sp. hispidum, Pearson, which it closely -resembles in many particulars, though differing in several essential characters. Of these perhaps the most remarkable is the forward direction of the sutural tube, which, in all the previously described species of Spzraculum (even if the Moulmein Opisthoporus Fordont, Bens. be included), is retroverted. In several forms of Opis- thoporus, however, the spiracle projects forward, as in the present species. ‘The wing of Sp. Beddome: is much more distinct, higher and more pterocycloid than that of Sp. hispidum ; the inner peristome, (which is deficient in the last named species), is angularly sinuate beneath the wing, but there is no approach to the deep sub-circular opening of the Indian species of Pterocyclos. All the specimens pro- cured by Captain Beddome were dead and weathered, and had lost their epidermis, but the traces which remained, shewed no approach to the hispidity from which the Khasi hill shell derives its name. The operculum has even more resemblance to that of Pterocyclos tenuilabiatus, Metcalfe, than has that of Sp. hispidum. This is the first discovery in the peninsula of India of a species of Spiraculum, that genus having hitherto only been met with to the east of the Bay of Bengal, in Assam and Burmah, while the sub- generic form Opzisthoporus occurs in the Malay countries and Borneo, In a country like India, which intervenes between two great zoologi- cal provinces, the Malayan, and the Africano- Asiatic, such exception- al occurrences are natural, and instances are known not merely of out- lying species, but of genera, such as Cataulus and Cyclotopsts, peculiar to the Indian peninsula or to Ceylon, though belonging to Malayan or African families. The presence of a Spzraculwm on the eastern coast of India, is a parallel case to the existence of Otopoma Hinduorum, — W. Blanf. in Hattiwar. It should also be noted that the discovery of — specimens of the two Burmese helices, H. Castra, Bens. and H. lewi- cula, Bens., on the hills of Orissa, shews that some few Burmese species even have extended their range down the western side of the — Bay of Bengal. 2. Nanina (ARIOPHANTA) INTUMESCENS, 0. 8. Shell sinistrorse, narrowly and sub-obtectly umbilicated, globose, thin, finely, subplicately, transversely striated with obsolete decussating Se 1866. ] Contributions to Indian Malacology. 33 sculpture, dull fulvous brown, horny, rather lighter in colour just above the periphery and around the umbilicus... Spire convexly conoid, apex very obtuse, suture scarcely impressed. Whorls 43, slightly convex ; the last bluntly carinate, descending very little near the aperture, tumid beneath, compressed around the umbilicus. Aper- ture large, diagonal, truncately sub-circular; peristome white, sub- expanded, margins approaching each other, columellar margin nearly vertical, rather broadly reflexed, partly covering the umbilicus. Millem. Inches. PavOr CIAMGLCL,- 50.2. .ccccccetsses 32 1.3 Mumor ditto,......... Aestere gang he 26 1.05 le epee enate 22 0.9 Habitat. Mahableshwar. Western Ghats of Hindustan. This fine species of Arzophanta has long been confounded with Nanina Bajadera, Pir. which is, however, although a_ variable shell, easily distinguished. N. Bajadera is more globose and thicker, being at the same time more transparent, it has much stronger sculp- ture (and deeper sutures) and is always rounded at the periphery near the mouth, and frequently throughout, while in N. cntumescens, the blunt angulation is persistent. N. Bajadera too has a fine vitreous lustre, while cintwmescens is dull, and the former shell is usually of a greenish olive colour, though varying in this character and sometimes resembling the latter. The animals also shew a difference in colour, that of N. intwmescens is uniformly, so far as I have seen, dark cine- rous, while that of Bajadera is much lighter, but very variable. The latter shell is found mostly on shrubs, the former on the ground, and while zntwmescens has as yet only been found at Mahableshwur, 4,500 feet above the sea, Bajadera (which is rare at Mahableshwur) abounds on the equally or nearly equally high hills of Singhur and Poorundhur, and along the summit of the Western Ghats at about 2,000 feet. It abounds at Khandalla at the top of the Bhore Ghat. Ihave already mentioned, in a previous paper, (An. Mag. Nat. Hist. for February, 1863) that an examination of the type specimens of N. Bajadera, Pir. and N. ammonia, Valenciennes, has shewed these two supposed species to be identical. I long doubted the distinct- ness of the species now described from N, Bajadera, but although 5 34 Contributions to Indian Malacology. [No. 1, I have specimens of the latter from many different places, they are all easily distinguished from NV. intumescens. 3. N. (Hemzplecta?) Stsparica, n. s. Shell openly perforated, subumbilicated, depressed, rather thin, striated, white with a yellowish brown epidermis, having a rather dull oily lustre. Spire convex, apex obtuse, suture flat, linear, submargi- nate. Whorls 4, very flatly convex above, apical whorl marked with very fine decussated plicate striation, the last not descending distinctly, but bluntly angulate above the periphery, convex beneath. Aperture oblique, semiovally lunate, white and pearly within, the breadth ex- eeeding the height, peristome thin, margins distant, united by a thin callus, columellar margin very oblique, and triangularly reflexed close to the perforation. Millem. Inches. Major diameter, Wilt. seen 37 1.5 var dito: 7 ee a 31 1.3 Se has eC er ee cs Fae aes 18 15 Habitat. Sispara ghat, Nilgiri hills, 8. India, rare. I know of no near Indian ally of this species. N. Orobia, Benson, from Darjeeling, which approaches it in some respects, is more globose and more solid, and has impressed sutures. The Ceylonese NV. Chenu, however, closely resembles the species above described in form, though it is easily distinguished by its peculiar impressed sculpture. I ob- tained but two specimens, one of which was living, near the top of Sispara ghat. It is remarkable that so fine a shell should have escap- ed detection before. The animal differs in no essential character from those of the sinis- trorse Ariophanta section. It has a large mucus pore at the end of the foot without any lobe above, the mantle is of moderate size, the head and neck granulated, the caudal portion of the body marked by | ¢ oblique parallel, impressed wrinkles, and broadly margined near the sole with a double, impressed line. 4, N. (Macrochlamys ?) Husescens, n. s. Shell scarcely perforate, inwardly depressed, yellowish or fulvous, thin, horny, dull, marked with very close microscopic impressed I 1866.} Contributions to Fndian Malacology. 35 oblique lines above, more polished and radiately striated below. Spire low, apex rather acute, prominent, sub-acuminate, suture deep. Whorls 54, rounded, the first narrow, the last much. broader, very bluntly sub-angulate at the periphery, and tumid beneath. Mouth large, nearly vertical, lunately sub-ovate, breadth exceeding the height ; peristome thin, straight, margins sub-distant, united by a very thin callus, columellar-margin nearly vertical. above, very briefly. and broadly reflexed, nearly covering the perforation. \ Millem. Inches. Major diameter, ....... aaa As te 0.6 DNs set Gi Hd i cciags enw sins bmn ntash) LO 0.5 a 84 0.33 Habitat. Anamullay hills. S. India. This species resembles the Bengal N. subgesta, Bs., and the Cey- lonese N. carneola, Pir. (as figured by Reeve) in form, but has a duller lustre and deeper sutures, resembling in the latter character some of the Ceylon Nanine of the same section.. The microscopic sculpture is peculiar, the impressed lines being very close, but some- what irregular and wavy. They cause the dull appearance of the surface. An ordinary lens is insufficient to shew them: under a microscope with a 14 in. objective they are very. distinct. 5. N. (Macrochiamys ?) Lixa, n. si Shell obtectly perforate, rather depressly turbinate, very thin, ful- vous, horny, dull, obliquely striated and marked with very fine and close impressed lines, also oblique, only visible under the microscope, polished beneath. Spire conical, apex acute, suture impressed. Whorls 53, convex, gradually increasing, the last much broader, obso- letely sub-angulate at the periphery, tumid beneath. Aperture nearly vertical, roundly lunate, breadth very little exceeding the height. Peristome thin, straight, margins sub-distant, columella nearly vertical and very briefly reflexed above, almost concealing the perforation. Millem. Inches. Major diameter, ......000.0....... 134 0.54 MiMondithe, «aigelenAudesoaen! 12 0.48 BEMIS: (0. sce ul dite Sodanite roi OR 0.38 Habitat. Anamullay hills. HH. side. 36 Contributions to Indian Malacology. [No. 1, This is a shell with a similar dull greasy lustre to the last and owing it to the same cause, viz, microscopic sculpture. It is a well marked species. Very possibly, however, intermediate varieties may be found connecting it with N. hebescens. 6. N. (Macrochlamys) Inrausta, n. 8. Shell openly perforated, convexly depressed, very thin, fulvous horny, obliquely finely striated, spire convex, apex distinct, suture scarcely impressed. Whorls 6, flattish above, gradually and regularly increasing, the last not descending, depressed, swollen beneath, obso- letely sub-angulate above the periphery. Aperture oblique, lunate, breadth exceeding the height ; peristome thin, margins distant, united by a very thin callus, columellar margin vertical above, briefly and triangularly reflexed. Millem. Inches. Major diameter... ene 23 0.92 Rhinor ditto 2h ache 20 0.8 ABE). 5k. ie La 0.5 Habitat. Anamullay hills, S. India. Three specimens of this species occur amongst Captain Beddome’s Anamullay collections. The above dimensions are those of the largest and most perfect specimen. In both of the smaller specimens which measure respectively in their major and minor diameters and axis 193, 3 18, 10, and 17, 15, 9 millemetres, there is more or less descent of the — last whorl at the aperture, but both specimens have a stunted appear- ance, and irregular descent of the last whorl is very common in abnor- _ mal individuals of all forms of Helzx. This species has no very marked character. It is very near N. wi- trinoides, Desh., but may be recognised by its smaller and rounder — mouth, narrower last whorl and more convex form. In shape it re- sembles H. monticola, Hutton. 7. VITRINA AURIFORMIS, 0. 8. Shell very depressed, irregularly ovate, ear-shaped, very thin, striat-_ ed, polished, with a membranaceous epidermis, greenish or brownish yellow in colour, paler at the nucleus. Spire flat, suture slightly impressed. Whorls 13. Aperture oval, occupying the whole under 1866. ] Contributions to Indian Malacology. 37 part of the shell, and exposing the interior to the apex ; peristome membranaceous. Millem. Inches. REED LS AOI S APs. cod edee cadence 13 0.52 Breadth, ......:.. sdctar at eens os OF 8 0.32 Height, ...... Pere ee 24 0.1 Habitat. Sispara ghat, Nilgiri hills, Southern India. _ This species is very near V. gigas, Bens. and still more closely allied to V. Peguensis, Theobald, being, however, a more depressed species than either, and more open. It is also less solid than the last named species. I have not met with the animal, avhich may possibly differ from those of other Vitrine. If the animal resemble those of V. gigas and V. Peguensis, the oc- eurrence of this mollusk on the western flank of the Nilgiri Hills: ' will be one of the most anomalous with which I am acquainted amongst the land-shells of India, since I know of no other instance of a Malayan type, unrepresented on the Himalayas, of which species occur on the hills of Southern India. A small auriform shell such as this may, however, have been easily overlooked, and the Himalayan Molluscan fauna is, probably, far from thoroughly known.* The animal of V. Peguensis has been partly described by Mr. Theo- bald who, however, has unfortunately not mentioned the form of the mantle, the presence or absence of lobes covering the shell, nor the existence of a caudal gland, unless by the expression ‘‘ caudali papilla nulla” is intended to imply its absence ; more probably Mr. Theobald’s | meaning is that the overhanging lobe, so conspicuous in some forms of Nanina is absent, the gland existing, as in Ariophanta &c. This Vitrina is not the only south Nilgiri species. A larger mem- branaceous form also occurs, which requires comparison with Mr. Benson’s V. membranacea from Ceylon. 8. AcHatina ANAMULLICA, N. 5. Shell turrito-ovate, thin, finely striated, horny with high vitreous lustre. Spire turrited, sides convex, apex obtuse, suture impressed. __ * Mr, Theobald (J. A. S. B. XXXIII. p. 244,) includes V. gigas in his list of Himalayan shells, but the species is found on the Khasi hills, the fauna of which differs widely from that of the Himalayas. 38 Contributions to Indian Malacology. [No. I, Whorls 8, scarcely convex, the last rounded beneath. Aperture oblique, peristome thin, columella moderately arcuate, obliquely trun- cated below. Millem. Inches. eneth; > gs. ieaeeeee Meee veer ents 27 kA Diainébercor eer need Wet 12 0.48 Aperture 10 millemetres high, 64 broad. Habitat. Anamullay Hills. Intermediate in its characters between A. Nilagarica, Bens., and the oblong ovate, Achatina of Ceylon. Captain Beddome’s Anamullay collections comprise the following species in addition to those above described :-— Nanina vitrinoides, Desh. var. N. Shiplayi, Pfr. N. Indica, Pfr. var. N. Travancorica ? Bens. N. Basilens, Bens. N. ampulla, Bens. N. auris ? Pfr. Bulimus Nilagaricus, Pfr. var. B. physalis, Bens. B. sp. near B. trifasciatus, Rv., one imperfect specimen. Cyclophorus Jerdoni, Bens. C. deplanatus, Pir. 1 C. sp. near C. ravidus, Bens. (or possibly an immature Aulopoma.) — C. sp. (apparently near C. Shiplayi, Pir., but finely costulated, | possibly the young of an Alycceus. ) Pterocyclos nanus, Bens. Pt. rupestris, ?! Bens. Paludomus, sp. Neritina Perrotettiana, Recleiz. 7 To which there only remains to be added Cataulus recurvatus, Pir., 4 | to complete the list of known shells from the Anamullays. I add a a few remarks upon the species above quoted. = But one specimen occurs of the shell which I am acid to con-— = sider a variety of Nanina vitrinoides. It is small, measuring only 183 4 millemetres by 16 in its two diameters, and 83 in height. It is de- % pressed in form, and of a greenish tinge, but appears to differ in no 1866. ] Contributions to Indian Malacology. 39 essential particular from the Bengal variety. The species has not before, so far as I am aware, been found in Southern India. N. Ship- | lay, Pir. inhabits the eastern base of both the Anamullays and the Nilgiris ; on the latter hills I have found it at the foot of the Coonoor ghat. The animal is a Nanina, closely resembling N. indica, Pir. and NV. acuducta, Bens., having a large mucus pore at the caudal extremity of the foot without an overhanging lobe, or with but a very rudimen- tary one. The mantle lobes are small, and the animal in all respects closely resembles that of the sub-genus Ariophanta. A solitary speci- men of NV. indica from the Anamullays is very solid and rather strong- ly marked, the sculpture being less regular than in the common Nilgiri form, and scarcely granulate, the last peculiarity being perhaps due to weathering, as the specimen is decorticate and somewhat bleached. It is a dwarf form, less depressed than the type, and mea- sures 17 and 15 millem. in its two diameters, and 10 in height. The — shells found on the Nilgiris vary considerably. N. Basilens, Bens. (H. Titanica, Pir.), I learn from Captain Bed- dome, is far from scarce in the teak forests of the Anamullays, a tract 2,000 to 3,000 ft. above the sea, where N. ampulla, Bens. also occurs. _ The range of the latter shell extends a considerable distance to the north in the Wynand district, where it was found by Dr. Jerdon, if not to the base of the Coorg hills, while N. Baszlens does not appear to be found north of the remarkable gap in the Western Ghats at Paulghat cherry, which, traversing the very highest portion of the whole chain, divides the Nilgiris from the Anamullies, and through which the railway from Madras to Beypoor passes. Both VN. ampulla and N. Basilens have only been found west of the Hills. I have not had an opportunity of comparing the shell referred doubtfully to Mr. Benson’s recently published N. Yravancorica with the full description, and the identification is therefore unsatisfactory. The shell referred to N. awris, Pir. is identical with a species found at Neddiwuttom on the Nilgiris, and corresponding closely with Reeve’s figure of that N. auris in Conchologica Iconica. The little shell which I have called Bulimus Nilagaricus, I was at first disposed to consider a distinct species. It is only 14 millem. in length, and base by 6 in diameter. But some specimens from the Nilgiris are no larger, and there are graduations in size from these to 40 Contributions to Indian Malacology. [No 1. the typical shells. The solitary specimen of B. physalis has only traces of spiral sculpture, but it appears to agree in every other respect with Mr. Benson’s description. A dwarf form ef Cyclophorus Jerdont, only 29 millem. in diameter and 19 high, and 2 species of Pterocyclos, one of them unquestionably identical with Pt. nanus, Bens., are also comprised in Captain Bed- dome’s collections. The second species of Pterocyclos of which a single weathered specimen was found, shews no essential distinction from the Bengal Pt. rupestris, Bens., but it appears improbable that that form should really exist so far to the south. Cyclophorus deplanatus, Pfr. some decorticated specimens of which were amongst the Anamullay shells, occurs abundantly on Sispara ghat, at the western extremity of the Nilgiri plateau. A small shell in Captain Beddome’s collections, with more colouring than C. ravi- dus, Bens., and ornamented with zigzag transverse stripes, may possi- — bly be a young specimen of that species, but its thin and continuous peristome recalls that of some forms of Aulopoma, and the possibility of its belonging to that genus is strengthened by the deficiency of the epidermis close to the peristome. As the Anamullays have already furnished a Cataulus, the occurrence of a species of Aulopoma is by no means improbable. . The Paludomus is perhaps a variety of the species common near Bombay. The little Neritina Perrotettiana was previously unknown except in the Pykara river on the Nilgiris. We have evidently, as yet, only an instalment of the molluscan fauna of the Anamullays. None of the shells above specified are from. the higher ranges. So far as they have been collected, there is, as might have been anticipated, a general identity with Nilgiri shells, but at the same time a somewhat closer approximation to the Cinga- lese fauna. 7 P. S.—The above paper was written six months ago, and would have been sent for publication in the Society’s Journal at once, but that I hoped to be able to procure drawings of the shells for the pur- pose of illustrating it. In this, I have again been disappointed, and I am compelled a forward the pes: of the shells by thenivolyaam . A) omy several additional shells me the sahil hills collected by him 7 a ellen EE PLL OF Fe 1866. ] Contributions to Indian Malacology. 41 during the past year. Besides several new species, the collection com- prises Helix Anax, Bens., and a fine large Nanina resembling N. Cy- sis, Bens. but dextrorse, and which is very possibly a large variety of Mr. Benson’s H. Basilessa. It occurred at a height of 7,000 feet above the sea. I append descriptions of 3 of the new species sent. 9, AcHatina Buppomet, n. s. Shell turrito-ovate, solid, finely and closely sub-costulately striated, dark purplish brown, epidermis in parts having a tendency to assume a dirty cream colour, especially in dead specimens. Spire convex below, slighly acuminate above, apex obtuse, rather inclined to the right, suture impressed. Whorls 74-8 convex, the last 2 of the entire length, rounded at the base. Aperture nearly vertical, sub-pyriform, milky within; peristome thickened, white, outer margin rather straight, not arcuate, columella deeply curved, lined with callus, sub- obliquely and rather broadly truncated at the base. Millem. Inches. ESS dhe ee 30 Lo i oe ae tu ee oS A5 Aperture 10 millem. long, 6 broad. Habitat. Anamullay Hills, 5,000 to 7,000 feet (Beddome.) This is a more solid form than any of the Nilgiri species, and it differs from all of them, and also from the solid Ceylonese forms, in its sub-acuminate apex. It is a well marked species. 10. ACHATINA TEXTILIS, n. s. Shell ovate-oblong, rather solid, translucent, striated near the suture, smooth, polished, dark chesnut with close vertical and horizon- tal lines of a greyish yellow colour, varying in breadth and resembling the threads of an irregularly woven cloth. Spire elongated, conoidal with convex sides, apex obtuse, sutures impressed. Whorls 7, convex, _ the last about 2 of the entire length, rounded beneath. Aperture ver- tical, truncately semioval, milky within ; peristome slightly thickened, white, right margin slightly sinuate toward the base, columella deeply curved, obliquely truncated beneath, margins united by a thin callus. 6 - 42 Contributions to Indian Malacology. [No. f, Millem. Inches. Length23% Lyte PRC 26 1.05 Diameter; (sigs ade 2: Lee ore 0.52 Aperture 104 millem. long, 7 broad. Habitat. Anamullay Hills, 6,000 feet, (Beddome.) This is the only indigenous Indian Achatina with which I am ac- quainted, possessing coloured markings. In form it approaches some of the Ceylon Achatine, and also an undescribed Deccan species. 11. Buuimvs trurra, n. s. Shell perforated, conically ovate, thin, finely striated, light yellowish, with two spiral rows of sub-distant chesnut spots, sub-quadrate in form, on all the whorls, and two spiral chesnut stripes, the lower sometimes very faint, upon the last whorl below the periphery. Spire conical, apex acute, sutures impressed. Whorls 53, convex. Aper- ture nearly oval, slightly oblique. Peristome thin, margins united by a thin callus, columellar margin vertical, narrowly reflexed, the reflexed portion meeting the penultimate whorl at an angle. | Millem. Inches. Lengthy: .::.22%: Pare eee » ae 335) Dianienet, (25. <0 oe ds weston nace 89 Aperture 7 millem. long, 43 broad. Habitat. Anamullay Hills, (Beddome.) There is some doubt whether the shells above described be adult. They have a somewhat immature appearance, but all the specimens sent, four in number, are of precisely the same size, and the thin peristome is characteristic of the group of Bulimus Bengalensis, to which the present species belongs. From that species and its allies, it s easily distinguished by its short conical form. | ‘OULIONJOUL SUIYSOIOJUT BIYY JO SodoId E GFRT ur possessod Ajoroog oq} VOYSuIpplg “IPT Surps099y § ‘kjao ysvo ev Lq poyuesoidaa oav 4 yavut @ yZIM suaMLoedg—'Z 40N *[PULSIIO ey} JO suotaroeds oy} 0} UOIJIPpe UT OU} oITZTA OY} JO ysvo v Aq popuasaidar saptseq ere tyre & WIM susuoedg—'T 940N 43 2 ‘SUIVIS PUB SeOUNO ‘spuNod UI UALS a1B SJYSIONM x i eee S , "813 19 ‘sid yy an + fadoH] poor) Jo oder “4ppeaeyxog PTO} “1940990 WET! SEST |9T 's "S15 FOE "SIS POR!" or fe " SaIpuy qseq ‘aeteg ‘10odeyepueyy ‘oun y}9| SE8T {ST S see nee ree wes {‘sorpuy seg ‘etoduryrarg ‘orodanqyy ‘Q97 Y38T| SE8T ITT S "Sae PEE ‘20 F| “SIS PET ZO Pl" “id — ob Precrpuy yea “ex0R 80280) ‘MOU ‘qt 4991 Lest él "S15 QQ. “ZO [| ‘S19 BOT “ZO T/""* * sx st ie Ppt, BOND MY TPE SESE 6610 CESLIGL "S “S19 BHp"Z0 ETAT €/"813 OTP 20 STUIT| ‘se Psorpuy yseq “peqeye[ry JOM “N Sa[iar gf eanogyg) = “AON 906) G@8T IIT 3S "SIS JOP 'Z0 | ‘SID Jyp zo gl’ nag “+ gourd ‘aqoopary ‘ZauUOqIyT Iwou seueane) ‘eune yyg{| Té8T jor % vee tee eee {‘sorpuy 4seqy ‘eyeAyed jo Aroypii1084 “eT]eANG ‘q94 438T| SIST {6 S ‘s13 g] °20 ‘si eT -z0 pitt ove wes ‘BISSNY ‘ME[SOULIOJYyO X “nuypoeg ‘qaq 49ST) PIST {8 7a) "918 6IE °20 Z ‘SIS 6] G ‘20 en: eee ove = “Sour SOOpUua A ‘Aeuuojueyy ‘qsnony us| GIST (|Z ‘= ‘SB 18 "S13 1Qg|"" **" = + mt §‘saipuy qseq ‘peqeprloyy d 808T |9 = "SIS 977 20 G| “SAS QZzZ ‘ZO G|""* "a gon igs ‘CIARIO[ (NVIST reou) wouurjyg] ‘Avy pugzZ} B8O8T |g 3 813 T1T sa8 ggi"*** ap (‘suoumioads Z) “VW “S “f) “FHoIqoeUUOD “uo}seM | = “9 WAHT) LO8T /h = ‘S13 pep zo [| ‘S13 Pep “zo ]\"** i mn se. ountg (uO J ep ydeq) eSry /T] — ‘Tady 98} GOST |& Sak, ‘S13 spe ‘zo [| ‘sis spe zo zi * eee + ‘solpuy yseq (qnyyzeay wou) soreusg ‘00d YIET| S6LT |Z " ‘13 pp ‘zo {| “sa pp ‘zo qT)" vs vse = eouvayy ‘Sses[gy ‘uNeysisug| “AON Y9Z} BEPT |T s ‘SHNOLG OIMOALT—'T Ee ee hy Ea a se, ee | Z W ‘suoutiads i ‘meoy | & ow ul sudUl qsoSxe] 243 JO pure yyuoyT 5 -weds ey JO ‘uoIyeny}s Teorydersoes pue Ay1]oo] Jo oure NY & «MFM oh eae ‘er i, "ay dar * ‘7° : : : dn payvattoa ‘D7n2)v) SD) V7 ‘Oso ‘auoaNVIg “| “ pur vuzorI0rg “ug Ag “QORT ‘huonune of dn p ‘wwbhuag fo hyavoogy cia ay) fo WNaSN]T AY} Ut SUOLT D.wOAJA]T Pwo sauojy oi00}0 HT fo suaundeds ay fo anbojny09 1866.] eS ae 3° Zz eel Catalogue of Meteoric Stones and Meteorre Irons. Ad ‘S18GOZ"Z0 GSI E| 819 GEF'20 6'S41E Stata SQ|TI|'S48[ZT'209'Sq101 | "g15.99 °Z0 4 °O[T ‘S18 Z['p "20 'p 20. @1-“S4.-OTl "SIS QOQG ZO CT" "S13 Zp °Z0 pl" "S193 Gp ‘sid Cpl" ‘18 [19°20 T'SQ[6T| "$1999 "20 [1 S418)" eee ‘S13 GPE “ZO G]| ‘SIS SPE "20 CT ‘S13 OPT '20LSQIS|SISQ0T 20ET SAIS) "** ‘S15 QZ'p ZO 9 S18 9GP °Z0 9/""" ‘s13 96 20 OT] “S48 96 °20 OT)" “918 19 ‘Z0 ii "SIs 896 eee S13 2% "818 QOT)""” "20 BGG "20 G|__“st8 QZe ‘20 gt" ~ *CUNesn AL ‘suotutoeds ey} UL sudUt qsasie[ 84} JO -roads ey} JO SSS SS a "FY STO MA eee eee ‘paynqiiystpun yok sv ore yom suoumtoods [eUrsII0 oy} Jo JYSIOM 12404 OUT, |p ‘S18 ETE ‘ZO T “sq] G Surpaedxe yeymouros svA [][VJ OY} 4B FYSIOM [eyo} ONT, || Se ene Se a ee a ee eT ay SE CASEI PSG fC, Jean oe eee eee eee eee eee tar0sso p eee ves Pe eee eee vee eee ove ‘£4j,051049 eos Atin ee t(‘suouttoads [eroaos) ‘sarpuy 4Seq (JO "NI ‘Ut QP TeJAYG) voovg qsndny WIT] gost ize a “+ +(suaumtoads g) ‘sorpuy ysegl ‘(isreusfiq) erodyonson) “AP WIZT| TOST | TE i “++ (‘suountoods gZ) ‘salpuy yseqy ‘qefung “eyesuiny(y ‘ | CO Lb 9. Sandstone of rolled grains of MOREEL Aras ai Bee sek std occas) SRR: a0, Slate, as before. ..........020. see sese sas Net ani sedh avin tevivaie bnnade |e eCEes 11. Compact and dark rock, much jointed and breaking in flat square pieces. Hither a baked clay or a laterite. It is all broken to pieces on the sur- ee ee ft. "A conglomerate of water-worn pebbles of trap united by a calcareous cement. The pebbles are not lenticular, but rounded.................. 2 ft. 13. Dark shales containing débris of fossils not determinable. .. 10 ft. _ 14, Limestone; dark greyish-blue; coarsely crystalline ; In places very impure, argillaceous and shaly, It is a mass of fossils. .....660...... 5 ft. ‘4. Compact amygdaloidal greenstone. ......., tial ' * Having now reached the fossiliferous strata, I shall not, in charity to the reader, give the section of the spurs of the Tukt-i-Suliman and Zebanwan which face the little lake or Dal. But the map (see Map B) will enable any one wishing to know the geology of these spurs, to satisfy his curiosity. Ihave indeed to apologize for the minutéhness of the section of the Tukt-i- uliman, &c. But ina country new to the geologist, a section, I think, cannot be too minutely detailed. bens 130 Mr. Verchére on the Geology of Kashmir, [No. 2, . 15. Dark brown calcareo-ferruginous shales, exfoliating in thin plates and undergoing quick PEON; It weathers nearly black. Extremely rich in HOSSUS. | .5. . +s cam cogine operas spade dey ipas bills eject pepe eRe paiseee eabcas @aRana tena 16.) — Limestone, seek soca sao + 00 tbant 9 Sate ae Ra a 17. Dark brown eet donates chats us asieaeleenisnoe een sens Sb. US... Taisho’. 7. Hiertsiele crus seca acicine <4 nes eelaeetnn caterer e eee 10 ft. 19. Sandy shales, very all eee black ; do not efferrasee with acids; — MO een tl es very rich in fossils. ... nana spiNieh ia aepinae te roe 20. Limestone; less coarse ae Eee ay very 7 foasilitende, ce wee 21. Limestone; hard and arenaceous; separated by thin layers of shale which weather dark brown and appear in relief on the section of the . WEG. 48 Boe tia. aT cotta ek wa rectenoeptes deve desnys 8s 63.0) Scien aa) ele Any further bed which may exist is concealed under Hboulis. 22. When I first met with this bed of limestone, I was particularly delighted, as I had seen no limestone in Kashmir, except the huge carved blocks of the Buddhist ruins near Srinagar and at Pandrettan. — I was told that the fine bluish-grey limestone of these ruins © was no longer to be found in the country, and that nobody could guess whence the stone had been obtained. Even some of the Sur-- veyors of the Kashmir Series, G. T. S. corroborated this opinion, which appears to be the received one amongst the natives. I could see at a glance that here I had the very stone, and in examining the ~ bed I came across the remains of an old quarry. I subsequently found some much larger Buddhist quarries of limestone, as we shall see by and. bye. 3 Misled by Mr. Vigne and Dr. A. Fleming, who, as I have said, stated that they obtained nummulites from the Kashmir valley, I began to look diligently for these foraminifers. I found indeed a few rounded bodies which might be taken either for nummulites or rings of crinoid stems. I did not at first hit on a very good portion of the bed for fossils; those I found were extremely weather- ed, and I could only pay flying visits to Zeeawan. But I tried once 4 more to discover nummulites, when lo! I came across a Productus! The following genera were found to be abundant: Productus, a Athyris, Orthis, Strophomena or Leptena, and Spirifers amongst — the Brachiopods. Very few lamellibranchiates and gasteropods were seen, but- an immense number of Bryozoa, especially two or three genera of Fenzstellides—viz. Acanthocladia and Fenestella and ho a 1866.] the Western Himalaya and Afghan Mountains. 131 innumerable inviduals of what has been called Vincularia multangu- laris (Portlock), but which some say is not a Vincwlarva at all. Some gf the fossils are familiar to every body: the Productus semi-reticulatus (Martin), P. costatus (Sow.), the Athyris Rovssyt (L’Eveillé). Other fossils are interesting on account of their rarity, and first amongst these is the claw of a crustacean, the pincers of which are two and a half inches in length. Though the pincers are neither teethed internally nor flattened into organs of natation, we may, I think, refer the fossil provisionally to the genus Lurypterus, if it is not even a true Limulus. (See Pl. V. fig. 4.) 23. We have therefore, resting on the volcanic rocks, beds of carboniferous limestone. These beds are of great thickness, and they change their characters very considerably as we follow them upwards. I have divided them into three great divisions, and I have called these by the names of the localities where they were found to be well developed. The lowest bed, which we have just seen, I have called the Zeeawan bed, from the village of Zeeawan. The next above will be called the Weean bed, from the village of Weean near which it is well developed ; and the uppermost division Ihave named the Kothair bed,* from the name of a small district at the foot of the mountains where this upper bed is well seen. I have preferred adopting these names to the plan of using the desig- nations of Lower, Middle and Upper, as further observations’ may render it desirable to sub-divide any division into two or more sec- tions, in which case the terms lower, middle and upper would become inconvenient. In the present state of our knowledge of the geology of Kashmir and the N. W. Punjab, we may nevertheless remember with advantage, that the Zeeawan is the lowest, the Weean the middle, and the Kothair the upper bed of the mountain limestone. 24. To come back to our section near Zeeawan: we must first notice the inwrapping disposition of the beds around the end of the spur. The general strike of the volcanic rocks is N. N. H.—S. 8. W. __* So few fossils were found in the Kothair bed, that it is not possible to place it, with any certainty, in the carboniferous; the same reason prevents its being placed in the Permian or Triassic. The place of this bed as the uppermost carboniferous is therefore only temporary. See the remark after the list of fossils found in the Kothair bed, Chapter II., para. 50, 132 Mr. Verchére on the Geology of Kashir, [No. 2, } and the dip E. 8. EK. High up the spur, this dip forms a considerable angle with the horizon, but it diminishes gradually as we descend towards the plain; at the bed of quartzite it isabout 45% and at the limestone it is generally 40°. But these rocks, that is from the quartzite upwards, appear to have been upheaved by a narrow band of - hard rock catching them in the centre and pressing them upwards in that central point, whilst the sides of the beds were unsupported. Instead of yielding softly and shaping themselves into a carapace- like coating, as slate and ash would have done, the limestone and the shales have separated into thick bands or slices, and these bands have spread themselves out like a fan. At the small end of the fan there has been a considerable crushing of the beds one against the other, and enormous blocks, indeed whole pieces, of the limestone courses have been squeezed out of place; whilst, at the circumference of the fan, the beds have been parted from one another, and in some place we can see the layers of limestone separated by open intervals two or three feet wide. (See horizontal section, Sec. C.) 25. I will now try to define the character of the Zeeawan bed of carboniferous limestone :—Its lithological characters are, that it is a rough, coarse and semicrystalline limestone of a dark bluish-grey colour, weathering a rich grey. If we break it, we find it made of innumerable irregular grains of a darker limestone united by a lighter cement more or less crystalline. It is full of debris of fossils ; indeed I am not quite ‘sure that the darker grains are not the debris of the organisms ot excrements of animals. It is fetid. Portions of it are arenaceous of rather shaly, and these, when exposed to the air, decompose partially | becoming soft and crumbling. ‘The stone is soft to work and cutg | with great ease, except where there are too many large fossils. I contains an immense number of minute crinoid-stems converted inté spar: it breaks obliquely to the surface and gives flashes of light at certain angles. It is interstratified with courses of rich-browa | calcareous shale, often of a bright rust-colour, and generally much | decomposed and with bands of a black, not calcareous, sandy shale: it is also full of fossils, these being apparently converted into oxide of iron. Finally, it contains limited short lenticular layers of a much paler limestone, in thin-bedded and false-bedded patches hav ng somewhat the appearance of a fine mortar or cement. : 1866. ] the Western Himalaya and Afghan Mountains. 133 The characteristic fossils of the bed are the following :— Productus Costatus (Sowerby). 4 Semireticulatus (Martin). a Cora (D’Orbigny). a Humboldti (D’ Orbigny). . (D’Orbigny). ‘a Longispinus (Verneuil). Athyris, Sp. Pl. IL. fig. 1 & la. gested that it was, possibly, South American. 1866.] Contributions to Indian Malacology. 147 Kiister’s type is narrower anteriorly and has rather different, coarser plication posteriorly, than Lea’s. It may be a different shell. * No. 34.—Unio Nourtautianvs, Lea. Assam, teste Benson. Lea, Jour. Acad, Nat. Sci. Phil. IIL; 310; ply 80;.f, (25. _ The locality is simply stated to be India by Lea. Benson, Ann. and Mag. Nat. Hist. 1862, X., 194, states that he has received speci- mens from Assam. The volume containing the description of this shell is not procurable in Calcutta. No. 35.—Unto Jenxrysranvs, Bens. Burhampooter River, Assam. _ Benson, Ann, and Mag. Nat. Hist, 1862, 3rd Ser. X., 185. _ An ally of U. marginalis, distinguished by “the very tumid form, the sloping posterior end, absence of a wing, the short ligament, and the nature and position of the teeth.” (Bens. 1. c.) In the Asiatic So- ciety’s collection there is a shell from Bhagulpoor perhaps referable as a variety to this species, No. 86.—Unto pacnysoma, Bens. Burhampooter River, Assam. Benson, Ann, and Mag. Nat. Hist. 1862, 3rd Ser. X., 186. “An inflated form of the ceruleus type.” (Bens. 1. c.) Mr. Benson also states that he has received a distorted variety from Calcutta. A pe- euliar tumid form which is not uncommon in Calcutta tanks is doubt- less referred to. It agrees generally with the description given. This form therefore adds one more to the Bengal list. No. 37.—Unto SmaRaepitEs, Bens. Burhampooter River, Assam, "Benson, Ann. and Mag. Nat. Hist, 1862, 3rd Ser, X., 190. q A shell allied to U. favidens, _ Besides these forms a variety of U. Javidens, Bens. (var. marcens) has already been quoted as occurring in Assam. Mr. Benson also records the receipt of a variety of U. ceruleus (J. A. S. B. VI. 750) and of a small variety of U. marginalis (Ann. and Mag. Nat. Hist. 3rd Ser. X. 186) from that region. | 7 e III.—Cryvton. No. 38.—Unto Lavarpt, Lea. Ceylon. Lea, Jour. Acad. Nat. Sci. Phil. 2nd Ser, IV., 243, pl. 36, f. 122. | _ This is a shell of the margimalis type with a convex dorsal margin, jand generally rounded outline. It appears to be a fairly distinguish- jable form, though very close to Bengalensis and lamellatus. 148 Contributions to Indian Malacology. [No. 2, No. 39.—Unto Tuwarrtest, Lea. Ceylon. — Lea, Jour. Acad. Nat. Sci. Phil. 2nd Ser. IV., 246, pl. 37, f. 125. This shell only differs from the last in having a rather straighter hinge line, and being slightly more inequilateral. If such differences are to rank as specific, half a dozen “ species’ might be manufac- tured out of any tank in Calcutta. The separation of these two forms is perfectly unjustifiable in a genus like Unio. The above are the only species that I can trace specially described from Ceylon. amarck’s variety 6. of Unio marginalis described as var. testd minore, breviore, and 75 millimetres broad was also from Ceylon (Lam. VI. 79). Sir Emerson Tennent, in his work on Ceylon, ‘enumerates only U. corrugatus besides U. marginalis. He, however, adds that Mr. Cuming possessed six species from the island, which had been sent to Mr. Lea. U. Thwaztesic and U. Layardi are doubt- less two of these, as they were from Mr. Cuming’s cabinet, but no mention is made of the others by Mr. Lea. IV.— Burma. No. 40.—Unio Tavoyrnsis, Gould. Tavoy, Gould, Proc. Bost. Soc. Nat. Hist. I., 140. ,, Ot. Conch, p. 190. Kiister, Mart. and Chem., p. 166, pl. 48, f. 2. “Closely allied to U. corrugata, Lam. which is less rounded and less corrugated” (Gould, 1. c.) More nearly allied to Lamarck’s than to Chemnitz’s type of U. corrugatus. Kister’s figure agrees well with Gould’s description, but represents a young shell, not mature. The specimen figured was from the collection of Dr. Sturm (and not from that of Dr. v. d. Busch). No. 41.— Unto crispatus, Gould. Tavoy. U. crispata, Gould, Proc. Bost. Soc. Nat, Hist. I,, 141. Ot. Conch. p. 191. 9? 39 No. 42.—Unto routaceus, Gould. Tavoy. U. foliacea, Gould, Proc. Bost. Soc. Nat, Hist. I, 141. Ot. Conch. p. 191. An ally (variety ?) of U. marginalis, Lam. ‘“ Closely allied to Tie Bengalensts and Corrianus, Lea.” (Gould, 1. ¢.) 1866. ] Contributions to Indian Malacology. 149 No. 48.—Unio Exonyscens, Gould. Tavoy. Gould, Proc. Bost. Soc. Nat. Hist. I., 141. »- Ot. Conch, p. 191. Apparently, from the description, another ally or variety of the U, margmalis type. No. 44.—Unto eenrrosus, Gould. Tavoy. Gould, Proc. Bost. Soc. Nat. Hist, II., 220. » Ot. Conch, p. 201. I believe I possess this species. Specimens were sent to me by Mr. Theobald from Pegu, which agree with the description fairly, except that they are smaller than the type. No. 45.— Unto tutus, Lea. Newville, Tavoy. Lea, Jowr, Acad. Nat. Sct. Phil, ITI., 302, pl. 27,17. Thave not access to the description or figure of this species. _ No. 46.—Unto crispisuncarus, Bens. Bangong R. near Thayet Myo, Pegu. _ Benson, Ann. and Mag. Nat. Hist., 1862, 3rd Ser. X., 193. I am indebted to Mr. Theobald for specimens of this shell. It ap- pears doubtful whether it be more than a variety of U. erispatus, Gould, to which Mr. Benson does not refer in his description, and with which he was possibly unacquainted. Gould’s description is very brief, and gives the idea of a more coarsely sculptured shell ( “ rugis angulatis radvantibus undique erispata’”’) besides being somewhat shorter (from the dorsal to the ventral margin) in proportion to its breadth, but these are not necessarily specific distinctions. No. 47.— Unto Pvato, Bens. Ava and Pegu. Benson, Ann, and Mag. Nat. Hist., 1862, 3rd Ser, X., 193. A solitary valve was sent to Mr. Benson by Mr. Theobald, who gave the locality as Ava. Isubsequently found the same form in the Mya- noung district of Pegu, and Mr. Theobald has since obtained larger | varieties, I believe from Prome. It is a well marked type, extremely inequilateral, and with a peculiar acuminate form posteriorly. As already observed, the type form of Unio marginalis, Lam. abounds in Pegu. I found unusually fine specimens in large swamps about Henzada and Myanoung in the Irawady valley. The type gra- |dually passes by insensible gradations into a much less transverse 19 > 150 Contributions to Indian Malacology. [No. 2, form, almost subquadrate. The posterior portions of the valves were often covered by the remarkable fresh water Bryozoon Hislopia of Carter, apparently a new species. I have other species from Pegu, but [ am unable at present to com- pare them with the numerous named forms described by Lea from Siam, many of which probably extend to Burma. Genus ANODONTA, Brugiere. No. 1. —Awnoponta soLENiForMIs, Bens. Assam. Benson. J. A. 8. B, V., 750. The type specimen is in the Asiatic Society’s Museum (now the — Imperial Museum). There is also an A. soleniformis, D’Orbigny, but Mr. Benson’s name is the oldest, as it was published in 1836. Mr. Lea has described a species from Siam, evidently very closely © allied to this, as Mycetopus emarginatus, Lea. (Jour. Acad. Nat. Sci. — Phil. 2nd Ser. V., 398, pl. 50, £. 805). As the animal has not been observed, it may be doubtful if it is really a Mycetopus. At the same time the character of both the Siam and Assam shells are so distinct from those of any true Anodonta, that perhaps the best provisional. classification is that adopted by Mr. Lea. Specimens of A. solensfor- mis with the animal living are a peculiar desideratum. ~ No. 2.—Anoponta Satwenrana, Gould. Salween R., Burma. Gould, Proc. Bost, Soc. Nat. Hist. I., 158. Ot. Conch. p. 193. A very peculiar broad shell, belonging to Monocondylea. (See next species.) I have never seen this form. No. 3.—ANopDonTA INoscuLARIS, Gould. Salween R., Burma. Gould, Proc, Bost. Soc. Nat. Hist. I. 158. Ot. Conch. p. 193, : Subsequently in the same volume, p. 161, Dr. Gould suggested that this species might be the type of a new genus which he named Pseudodon, This name is by Adams quoted as a synonym of Anodonta, — the genus, adds in brackets “ perhaps equivalent to Monocondylea, D’Orb.”” So far as the shell is concerned, this is undoubtedly the ~ 1866. | Contributions to Indian Malacology. 151 correct position of these species, if the hinge teeth are trustworthy indicators of generic affinity. H. and A. Adams, in the Gen. Rec. Moll., include under Monocondylea, M. Vondenbuschiana, Lea, from Java,* described by Lea as a Margaritana (Baphia of Adams) and several species of the genus have been described from Siam and Cochin China by French and American naturalists. I have received from Mr. Theobald fine specimens obtained in Pegu which correspond admirably with Margaritana Vondenbuschiana, Lea, and unquestionably belong, I think, to that ‘species; and also shells which appear to belong to a variety of Anodonta inoscularis, agreeing with the type in size, shape and every character of importance; and not only are the two forms unmistakeably congeneric, but I even think it probable that specimens might be met with to unite them specifically, as they differ in no essential character, except the very different degree of development of the cardinal tooth, which in Vondenbuschiana is scarcely raised, while in the specimens which I refer to inoscularis it is sometimes nearly a quarter of an inch high. _ There are in the Asiatic Society’s collection, also, two forms which appear to me certainly varieties of M. Vondenbuschiana. One of them, however, agrees more closely with the figure of M. Cuming, Lea (Jour. Acad. Nat. Sci. Phil. 2nd Ser. IV, 235, pl. 33, f. 114) a Ma- lacea shell, which only differs from Vondenbuschiana in unimportant minutie. _ M. Vondenbuschiana is described and figured by Lea in Trans. Am. Phil. Soc. VIII, 222, pl. 18, f. 39, and also in Kuster. - Were there nothing but the form of the hinge teeth to connect the South American species of Monocondylea with the Burmese and Java- nese Pseudodon and Margaritana, especially having regard to the very diverse form of the shell, I should suspect them to be in reality distinct types. But there is one little peculiarity which appears to tend to unite them. At the termination of the portion of the hinge line in which, by close inspection, flattened obsolete representations of the lateral teeth may be seen, there is a very peculiar expansion of the end of the ligament which covers a small sinus in the inner surface of both valves. This is very well shewn in Lea’s figure of Margaritana _ * Yet they state, “ All the species of this genus known are from the rivers of South America.” 152 Contributions to Indian Malacology. . [No. Z, Vondenbuschiana, and also in both Adams’s figures of different species of Monocondylea from §. America. The same occurs in Anodon and in the type species of Margaritana of Schumacher,* (YW. margaritsfera, L.). I have not had an opportunity of examining the animals of the Burmese species of Monocondyl@a, and therefore cannot say if the gills are free or not. } Besides the above forms, a minute species of Anodon is stated by ~ Mr. Benson to inhabit ponds in Bundeleund, J. A. 8. B., V. 750. P. 8. No. 2a.—Unio spurtus, Gm. Tranquebar. Mya spuria, Gm, vol. I, Pt. VI, p. 3222, No, 16. Unio spuria, Lam, VI, 80, No. 45. Mya spuria, Wood, Ind, Test. p. 12, pl. 2, No. 35. Since writing the note on this species at p. 146, [ have found that it was described originally as from India. Gmelin refers to Schroeter Kinl. in Conch. II, 617, No. 9, pl. 7, f. 5, so perhaps the name may have been given by Schroeter, though that by no means follows from the reference. The description is very brief: “ I. testd rhombea viridt, © natibus glabris’’ and the shell is said to be like corrugatus, but near- ly twice the size and perfectly smooth in front of the beaks (“‘ praete vulve regionem tota glabra,” Gm. l. c.). Wood’s figures are all poor. The shell can scarcely be a young form I think, if a oa larger’ than corrugatus. _ Mya radiata,} I find, is attributed to Malabar by Gmelin, an 3220.) fabri whom Wood appears to have only copied his localities. The species is, | think, correctly attributed to Chemnitz by Mr. Benson, although other authors give Gmelin as their authority. Gmelin’s description runs thus—‘‘ WM. testa equivalvi pellucida tenuissime transversim stri- ata viridi flavicante livido radiata ; valvis altero latere latissimis, altera angustissimis.” I know of no ca of Indian Unio to which this de+ scription would be applicable, and I cannot help suspecting that the writers who have applied the name to an American species may very possibly be right. Wood’s figure, also, does not recall any Indian * It is by no means clear that Margaritona and Monocondylea are more than subgenera, or even artificial sections of Anodonta. M. Vondenbuschiana is inter- mediate between the second and last in characters of the shell, and there is n known essential distinction in the animal. +The Linnean genus Mya, like most Linnean genera, was an artificial group _ to some extent. Besides Mya as now understood, it comprised Unio and. seve= ral other genera. _- 1866. ] Contributions to Indian Malacology. 153 species ; for it is evident from the above description that the radiating lines shewn do not refer to strie but to coloured markings. Mr. Benson’s shell from Malabar was striated. Good collections of the Unios of both Coromandel and Malabar are greatly needed to determine all these doubtful species. Monoconpyta cresristriata, Anthony. Pegu. American Journal of Conchology, I., 205, pl. 18. MonoconpyL“#A Prcauensis, Anthony. Pegu. - Am, Jour. Conch, I., 205, pl. 18, I am indebted to Mr. Theobald for the above quotations. The shells are the two Monocondylea above referred to, the first being that referred by me, though with some doubt, to Anodonta (Pseudo- don) inoscularis, Gould, the second to Monocondylea Vondenbuschiana, Lea. So long as it is the practice of naturalists living in foreign countries, and, necessarily, imperfectly acquainted with the fauna of distant regions, to give a “specific” name to every animal or frag- ment of an animal which reaches them, lists of synonyms must multiply; and as everybody will contend for the distinctness of his “ species,” false notions as to the nature and value of specific distinctions must prevail. Thus, in the same paper, one of the numerous varieties of Melania variabilis, Benson, is called MM. gloriosa, Anthony. Now it is worthy of remark that Mr. Benson, who has examined far more of the Mollusca of Burma than Mr. Anthony can possibly have seen, has not for years described a single Melania from that country as new, and has only described two species of Unio, although he had speci- mens of all Mr. Anthony’s supposed new species. I can only add that it would be easy for me to describe, from the materials I possess, 20 or 30 forms of Unio (and nearly as many more of Melania) with as good claims to distinction as one-half at least of those already pub- lished from India and Burma; but were I to do so, I cannot help thinking that, while burdening science with additional names, I “should have added nothing to the knowledge of the fresh water mol- lusca of India. Amongst fresh water shells I am convinced that forms pass into each other far more than amongst land shells, that “species,” in the usual definition of the word, have no existence, that all the characters relied upon for distinguishing ‘‘ species” of Unionide in especial, the form and thickness of the hinge teeth, form 154 Contributions to Indian Malacology. [No. 2, of the shell, prominence of the umbones, shape of the muscular im- pressions, colour of the nacre, characters of the epidermis, &c. vary ad infinitum—-in short that species must be described like genera and grouped around types, not distinguished by characters. I see from a notice in the Paris Journal de Conchylrologie that, in the same volume of the American Journal of Conchology, Mr. Conrad proposed a new genus Z'rigonodon for Monocondylea crebristriata of Anthony, from which, as [ have stated above, Anodonta inoscularis, Gould, is at the best but dubiously separable specifically. But the last named shell is the type of Gould’s genus Psewdodon, and Gould himself suggested the identity of that genus with D’Orbigny’s Mono- condylea.* Unless Mr. Conrad has procured the animals of the Pegu forms, and shewn them to be distinct from those of South America, (and I scarcely think he can have done so,) I cannot believe that any useful object is attained by inventing these generic appellations. Even — if Trigonodon be not Pseudodon over again, (Mr. Conrad appears to — have already furnished one synonym before for Pseudodon, viz. Monodontina,) there has been no distinction of any generic value shewn between the shells of Burmese and Malay species of Monocon- — dylea and those of 8S. America; and bearing in mind that there are some genera of more restricted distribution than those belonging to the Unionidae, e. g. the Tapir, and amongst Mollusks, Cyclophorus and Megalomastoma, common to the two regions, it would, I think, j be more scientific to examine the animals of the Burmese shells allied to Monocondylea, before founding new genera to comprise them. There is of course the possibility that Mr. Theobald may have been misinformed as to the respective names of the two species, and that — the type of Zrigonodon is the form I have referred to Monocondylea : Vondenbuschiana. I can only add that the specimens of the same shell — from the same locality sent to me by Mr. Theobald, do not differ j more from Kiister’s figure of V. d. Busch’s original specimen of M. Vondenbuschiana in Martini and Chemnitz, than that figure does from — Lea’s. ; Unio Pra@urnsis, Anthony. American Journal of Conchology, Vol. I. I cannot learn what species has been thus named _ I hope to be * Ot. Conch., p, 194, 155 1866. | Contributions to Indian Malacology. Two Indian species of Unio in the Musée d’ Histoire Naturelle at Paris have received MS. names from Valenciennes. I am unable to ascertain at present if these names have been published or not. Corrigenda in Contributions to Indian Malacology, No. VI., in this volume: P. 31, line 2, from bottom, for Kimery read Kimety. 32, ” ae top, » Fordoni » Gordont. ye » 98, >, bottom, ,, Hattiwar » Kattiawar, 8 ad » inwardly » conoidly. en ato, . top, » subgesta » subjecta, ists, 22; 5, bottom, supply “it” after nulla, a i Pp omit the word South. Mera 20, 4, top, » oblong ovate, Achatina read oblong ovate Achatine. ” TS eae » Basilens ;, Basileus. - » 12, ,,- bottom, ,, Alyceus » Alyceus. a a y » Recleiz » Recluz. 39, lines 21, 16 & 11, from bottom, for Basilens » Basileus. ,» line 17, from bottom, for Wynand » Wynaud. ~ won vddecuaaeageamanes Ue Le d. Shales; no fossils,. 5¢SGhN CORAL CAN nN nan ous va cos soadeescarvgnes eer ok LOS e. Limestone, oa Aa aud Henk grey, ne Wenthching How It is much shivered, and is divided by innumerable white lines crossing each other. No fossils except what appear to be worm-burrows filled with sandy ochre, 15 ft. f. Very argillaceous limestone of a pale blue colour, with patches of a dirty MEOW OQLOUT, 5p coe oak ast cae icy taaas+hegnnsatinnpenyecsecsccp use, 2 tbe 29. I consider that these beds are the top of the Weean division of the carboniferous limestone of the Himalaya, as the following beds show a very great difference in their fauna, which is nearly entirely confined to gasteropods and corals, the gasteropods presenting a great variety of shape and size, The corals of the Cyathophyllide are abundant and of considerable dimensions. The crinoid stems, some of them minute and starred, continue to be seen everywhere. The beds characterized by gasteropods and corals form the Kothair bed, which we shall see better developed elsewhere. Continuing our section, we have therefore, resting on the argilla- ceous limestone, the following layers : g. Limestone, fine grained, blue, compact and argillaceous, with patches of _ dirty yellow. It contains many fragments of fossils, nearly entirely gasteropods. Some of these are two inches in length. Starry rings of crinoid stems a abundant. The limestone becomes gradually of a richer blue colour, some portions being indeed light blue; it weathers rugose like frosted glass. The upper part contains no gasteropods, but fossil roots and rootlets the size of the finger. It is about 25 feet thick, . lotsa Md supe ebiiekeke die aN Ebe This is all we see here of the Kothair bed, as a fault running N. S. brings up again the’,Weean bed; but this patch of the Kothair is interesting, as showing its relation to the Weean bed, a relation which I have not been able to trace so well anywhere else. The Weean and Kothair beds are quite conformable. On the other side of the fault we find : a A limestone, bluish-grey and compact; weathering sandy and dull grey. Itis divided in layers by several sandy partings. It contains only a few encrinite stems and dotted white patches which are probably decomposed fossils. It is shivered and traversed by innumerable white lines,..,... 20 ft. 164 Mr. Verchére on the Geology of Kashmir, [No. 3, b. Brown foetid limestone, full of a transverse species of a plaited Spiri- ferina and a globular Terebratula. It is probably a lenticular bed, and takes the place of the Spirifer bed noted. above, ......se.swessersssosesseseaesens 8 Lhe c. Limestone like a. The end of this spur is cut by a transverse fault in the same manner as we have seen in the preceding spurs. The cut off beds are much disturbed, being vertical at the tops of the ridge, and dipping N. E. at high angles along the slope. Beyond this is I have not examined this fine section of the lime- stone of Kashmir. I was never allowed to visit it again, as I was suddenly ordered away from Srinuggur, my professional services being required elsewhere. Had I had time, I intended to follow the section across the range into Nawan and down to the bottom of the Harrah Valley. 30. From the brow of the last spur which I have visited, a fine view is obtained of the next spur, which is remarkable for a great twist of the strata which compose it. The limestone is extremely white and resembles chalk-cliffs at a distance. We shall, however, see this white limestone at Manus Bal, and find that it is probably a portion of the Weean bed altered by heat. We shall find it similarly altered at Islamabad. The whole mass of hills of Nawan appears to be limestone. The summits of Boorwaz and Batgool appear behind the range, present- ing high rugged peaks of porphyry. To our right, the limestone forms a small chain which advances for some miles into the Pampur valley, and behind this chain a long line of mountains, also entirely composed of limestone, runs N.—S. to join the Wastarwan. (See maps B. and C.) 31. The little chain which descends into the Pampur valley terminates over the village of Weean. At its extremity, the Weean limestone, or middle bed of carboniferous limestone of Kashmir, is well developed, and we will now proceed to examine this locality. It is, to me, the classical ground of the Weean limestone, as the Zeeawan spur is that of the Zeeawan Bed. 1866. ] the Western Himalaya and Afghan Mountains. 165 Section of the hills above the village of Weean in the Pampur valley. (See fig. 7.) The little hillocks above the villages of Weean and Kohew, are separated from the main hill by a fault running W.—E. The beds have moreover been folded on themselves and dip due W. (at Weean), with an angle of 55°, whilst in the main hill the dip is to the N. E. with an angle between 20° and 30°. This does not, however, prevent the section of the little hill near Weean being a very good one for study. We shall proceed from E. to W. 1. Impure arenaceous limestone with fine spangles of mica. It is very shaly in the centre of the bed and there very much decayed. It changes its aspect repeatedly, adding here more sand and mica, there more a giaaciyni's oe ads as bain aie bee eee +09 v90 apeeen's chats a uk siaas Sa ID She; _ 2. Limestone, sratigadate: in ie ae eile sti SP rere A ft. _ 3. Blue limestone, weathering brown and rough. It is arenaceous near - its upper part. It contains a very few fragments of fossils, ......... 20 ft. i 4. Finely crystalline limestone; nearly saccharine; grey and zz EI dist ncce hain} cajeh' as prin Sind. Shari web anid pasts nanSRE TEs wdaidacide avai 15 ft ia ak dings ole concep ods wp nines watsiadieplnd obowasie Se Sw calling my atten- Pcie tion to this bend Fig. 9.* of the courses of limestone at the bottom of the quarry. If this curving of the limestone was not seen, it would be nevertheless easy to understand the true position of these beds, as they are precisely similar to those on the other side of the road (see Section), but in an inverse position: the rock nearest the greenstone is a glaring white and much altered limestone. It is succeeded by a dark, greyish, argillaceous limestone, weathering bluish and rugose. On the other side of the road, the dark limestone appears first, and underneath it the bed of glaring white altered limestone. There is therefore every evidence of a synclinal; but, of course, the discovery of the bend of the beds in the quarry completes: the evidence very satisfactorily. Taking our Section from the S. to N., beginning at the road and leav- ing out the beds. redressed against the Aha Tung which I have just described, we have the following strata :— 1 Greyish-blue limestone ; marly, rugose, hard, dips S. 60°, increasing to 70°; much broken bed: about as re ... 20 ft. thiek, * q@ White Limestone. b Dark Limestone, ce Alluvium. d Road. é Dark Limestone. f White Limestone, ~ 194 Mr. Verchére on the Geology of Kashmir, [No. 3, 2. Pale limestone, weathering glaring white ; filled with geodes, lined with small spar-crystals. No fossils, Dips 8. 80°, ... ie og AO TEs 3. Thin-bedded, shaly, striped limestone, ... “as: , 0 Th. Fault. It runs E.—W. and is about 10 feet wide at the al It is filled with rocks similar to No. 3, folded in all directions. 4. Limestone like 3; vertical, nite abe dod pent Lk iF 5. Pale limestone; with geodes, like 2. Traces of fossils were observed, but much altered and not recognizable, wat mae aos OO EE, _6. Pale blue, shaly limestone; dips N. 80°, ... nee San Ae 7, Like5; dips N. 80°, ... Se tae aaa amas WO Gs Fault ; it runs E.—W. 8. Same as 7, ... eat Se on ode tLe GO £6, 9. Argillaceous, thin-bedded, pale grey limestone, breaking in flat thin pieces, like pottery, nee oe ove gee SO) ee 10. Sandy limestone, had sad saath = ~— one 20s 11. Conglomerate limestone, varying from a coarse sandy limestone to a perfect conglomerate, the pebbles being rounded, pieces of limestone im- bedded in a soft calcareous paste. It contains many sections of the Aviculo- pectens and other large bivalves peculiar to the Weean bed. Portions of the bed are white and altered, ... = ae ayo ove. LOO £5 - 12. Sandy, micaceous, limestone ; ile grey, de ae i 13. White limestone; no fossils, ... a cua i | DE a: 14. Argillaceous limestone, blue and pale; weathering lustreless and velvety, sill see waa 4 gi hing one we abe 15. Conglomerati¢ limestone like 11, Le gee . BO Hh 16. Brecciated and sandy limestone; sometimes a coarse calcareous sand- stone, due wide Ee ae ret A ici Sey 17. Ash-blue, pale, muddy limestone; weathering lustreless, ... 25 ft. 18. Brecciated and sandy limestone, ws vee deh fics. Sa 19, Ash-blue, pale and muddy ; weathering Iustrelegs,............ 25 ft. All these beds dip S. with an angle diminishing gradually from 80° to 35°. 20, This bed is the top of a well defined anticlinal. The rock is a yellowish- grey limestone, with rolled pieces of limestone imbedded. It is sandy, some : times quite a sandstone, oftener a sandy impure limestone. It contains a great many remains of fossils. The southernbranch of the anticlinal dips S. 35°; the northern branch dips N. N, W. 25°. There is therefore a squeezing of the strata at the western end of the strike, and a divergence or opening of the fault at the eastern end, Thickness about 30 feet. . Then we get a repetition of the beds seen before, as follows: 21. Ash-blue, lustreless muddy limestone, .., wee S 25Ee 22. Brecciated and sandy limestone, wie po wae LZ tee 23. Ash-blue limestone, .., Mer ey ee. -. 25 thes ; 24. Brecciated limestone,,,, a “. Nati va 5 ft 1866. ] the Western Himalaya and Afghan Mountains. 195 25. Conglomeratic limestone, with sections of large bivalves, ... 50 ft. 26. Ash-blue, lustreless limestone, ... abe Ln Jc Me Eh. 27. White limestone, he sia i a ae 28. Micaceous and sandy limestone; thin- bedded dark grey ; dips N. N. W. 80°, .. sal “0 Spe ee tena s 29. Conglomeratic limestone; gritty ; in places a oonpiciiennie in others a breccia; dips N. N. W. 85° at first; then it becomes vertical and at last dips S. 80°, at whe at a igs . 100 ft. 80. Arenaceous limestone, dark, rough and forming Team ridge ; it dips south 80°, ar oss = acu} oh Ft 31. Thin-bedded, muddy joy ae teeabng in pieces like pottery ; dip irregular ; bed folded and wavy, much disintegrated, snd .. SO Tt. 32. Shaly limestone, very impure ; dips N. 80°. 33. Sandy limestone, dark and rough and hard ; dips N. 70 to 75°. These two beds together are about, vee eee ove - Jed 1BO1 RE: 34, Limestone, generally sandy and grey, but sometimes more compact and bluer, and then showing innumerable white lines crossing each other in all directions. It dips N. 70°, ... he ae a we LOO: ft, 35. These several varieties of limestone, viz. shaly and sandy, and blue with white lines, repeat themselves continually as far as the top of the hill, but the rock becomes more and more massive and presents portions of erinoid stems well preserved and petrified into a black spar. Sometimes the rock ig - flesh-coloured, and then the crinoid stems are lighter in colour, and weather in relief on the surface of the rock. These are the sections of crinoid stems which have been taken for nummulites by Mr. Vigne and Dr. A. Fleming. 150 ft. The strike of the beds of limestone wheels more and more toa N. to §&. direction. As we approach the volcanic rocks of the Safapoor, the dip becom- ing more and more westerly. This wheeling of the strike is well shown by the Sketch-Section (Sect. F), where we see the face of the limestone-courses uncovered and exposed, and facing the W. N. W. The thickness of the Weean bed is altogether 649 ft. _ Alarge fault, well marked by a deep ravine, separates the limestone from the volcanic rocks. It runs N. E.—S. W. At. the highest point the limestone is seen to attain, the fault is a mere crack, and the limestone is in contact with the volcanic rocks ; but at the S. W. end of the fault, it widens considerably, and beds of limestone are to be observed on its northern side, applied against the trap and conformable and superior to it. The trap dips S. S. E. On the western face of the Safapoor, long beds of well-stratified laterite and ash are conspicuous ; they dip S. with an angle of 40. 54. Our section runs through the spur of limestone nearest to the lake; three other spurs, parallel to it, descend towards the village of Paturmoola (see Section F.). They present very won- 196 Mr, Verchére on the Geology of Kashmir, [No. 3, derful twists and foldings, but appear less altered than the beds which are bathed by the lake; their fossils are better preserved. I have not ascended these spurs, but amongst the ébouwlis, I saw many fossils characteristic of the Weean limestone, amongst others large Aviculo-pectens and Anthracosie, of which sections only had been discovered in the rocks in situ. Some blocks of limestone were also found exhibiting Gastero- poda, so conspicuous-in the Kothair bed, and it is therefore evident ‘that this bed forms the uppermost layers of the limestone of the higher spurs. I need hardly say, that the beds of Manus Bal belong tothe Weean group, and that they have been folded and altered in part by volcanic action, subsequent to the formation of the volcanic rocks on which they rest. The order of the beds is from the anticlinal upwards on both sides of it, and the rocks nearest to the trap are the most superficial, excepting, however, the detached beds which are ~ ‘ conformable to the volcanic rocks on the northern side of the great © fault. If the limestone had been baked by the amgydaloid and the greenstone, we would naturally expect to find the beds nearest to these rocks most altered; the reverse is however the case; and we — must therefore admit that a burst of hot gases or hot water had taken — place at the time these limestones were still a soft and plastic mud, and that it upheaved, folded and metamorphosed them. | It must not be forgotten, that the limestone might have been much less folded by this first disturbing action than we see it now, when the last upheaval of the Himalaya took place: the beds then slightly folded would naturally give way in the same direction as they were already bent, especially if the space they occupied between two un- yielding trappean hills had become so restricted that the limestone — must of necessity either be folded or override the trap. On the appli- cation of such lateral pressure, a straight, flat, hard bed might have slided over the trap, but a bed already undulating would more natu- x rally give way at the weakest parts, viz. the angles of the undulations, | and thus become gathered in crumpling folds. Such folds are well ! shown in the Sketch-Section, (plate F). 4 55. Having terminated our examination of the several moun- tains which form the first catenated chain on the N. E. of the valley of Kashmir, we can now understand how this chain was once conti- _ 1866.] the Western Himalaya and Afghan Mountacns. 197 nuous, the several summits being re-united to one another by ridges of stratified ash, agglomerate and limestone. These connecting ridges have been denuded by the several streams which flow towards the bottom of the valley, and the limestone is now found only in limited beds, which have escaped denudation from the shelter they received of large and hard volcanic mountains. These streams and rivers, it is hardly necessary to mention, have had a volume very different from what we see now-a-days ; the enormous layers of lacus- trine conglomerate, which they have accumulated near their entrances into the valley, demonstrate plainly their former great denudating power. The direction of these streams being from the high moun- tains in the N. E., to the bottom of the valley in the S. W., they have _eut for themselves channels which are directed from N. E.—S. W., and thus bands of the ridges, which united the summits of our first chain to those of the second chain, have remained between the channels of these streams, and given to those mountains the appearance of being long spurs descending from the N. E. to the S. W. 56. I shall, I hope, best terminate these detailed Sections, by _ appending a table of the fossiliferous and other rocks in Kashmir, to- - gether with such observations as the nature of the rocks or the fauna ; best justify. , q ; be Masses, Beds, &c. &e. Fossils. Conditions indicated. S ——— | —_—____—______ —$<$<—_— | ——____—__ ——— a. Granitoid porphyry; tra-| a... Melted masses which have not chyte and felstone. flowed, or have flowed under water. Centres of volcanic . action. b. Greenstone amygdaloid, vaenee Melted masses which have flow- tee basalt. ed under water or in the air. &%/|c. Felspathic and augi- dure Volcanic ejecta falling in shal- tic ash; agglome- low water. . rate, &c. g d. Black slate, sometimes! sass Mud derived from volcanic = amygdaloidal. rocks, rearranged by shallow 8 water, often heated by b showers of hot ashes, vapours or currents of lava. . Slate and shale. None. Rivers bringing down mud to a P shallow sea. Sublittoral oscil- lations. & © E c. Sandy limestone with- ses ece Drift on shallow shelving coast. out fossils. * MM @ | \d. Shales; sandy shales;} _...... Shelving low land near sea- : clay iron-ore in ribbons. shore, traversed by rills from hot chalybeate springs. Sub- littoral oscillations. e. Limestone like a; pass-]| Gasteropoda |Shallow creeks or protected sea ing into calcareousjand Cyatho- | coast. Swamp with grasses? slates. phyliide. Shallows between tides ? ~ i Thickness — 500 feet. _ This succession of beds shows a steady shallowing of the sea. If we reflect for a moment how the sea bottom which received the limestone was formed, by volcanic ash and ejecta falling into the ‘sea around the craters of numerous volcanoes, we would be led to expect a shallow shelving sea coast. Whether the volcanoes had existed for ages and prevented the development of life during the Silurian epoch, or whether they broke out after the Silurian beds had been deposited and buried these beds under their ejecta, I ‘cannot say. It appears much more probable however that the voleanoes existed during the Silurian epoch, and prevented marine animals | from living, by keeping the water at such a temperature or per- ‘meating it by such gases as were incompatible with life. However this may be, there can be no doubt that the volcanic ejecta were | disposed in very gently sloping beds all around the volcanoes which | produced them, and, as these ejecta were arranged by water, we would | maturally expect the beds they formed to extend far into the sea, Hence a long shelving shallow coast would be formed, a coast which | would speedily become more and more shallow from the enormous 25 200 Mr. Verchére on the Geology of Kashmir, [No. 3 amount of sand and clay which was washed into it from the volcanic islands which studded it, by a rain-fall of tremendous volume. 57. We have yet to describe the second and third catenated chains of Kashmir; the second is marked by the summits of Liwapatur (18,012), Churn Wolkalbul (14,310), Girdwali (14,060), Batgool (14,423), Boorwaz (13,087), Handil (18,273), Saijhaha (11,334), and joins the first parallel at the Safapoor on the eastern shore of the Woolar lake. On the other side of the lake, it is continued by the Kahoota, the Manganwar (8,728), and the Sheri Bal. These moun- tains are all composed of volcanic rocks and of azoic slate inter- bedded with ash and agglomerate. They need not therefore be described in detail. The Boorwaz, Handil and Batgool form a porphyritic mass which is generally described by travellers as granite ; it passes gradually on the west into amygdaloid and green- stone to form the summits of Saijhaha over the village of Gunder- bul. The transition between the porphyry and the greenstone is a feldspathic rock of a pale colour and imbedding very numerous: transparent crystals of quartz, a description of rock which is also found to form a passage between the porphyry and the felstone of the Kaj Nag. From the examination of a few specimens, kindly given to me by travellers, I have no doubt that the whole of this mass of mountains is composed of volcanic rocks, volcanic ejecta and slate, I am not aware that limestone exists anywhere amongst the spurs of these hills. Between the valley of Thral or Trahal and the river Lidar, there is a great labyrinth of mountains with many of the summits enumerated above, but I could obtain no informatior regarding them. I therefore requested Captain MacQueen, of the Punjab Irregular Force, who had arranged a shooting expedition to these hills to be kind enough to bring me a few specimens of the commonest rocks of the country he was about to visit, and also any rock which appeared to him in any way remarkable. By the use of the speci- mens thus obtained, and the examination of Captain MacQueen’s route on the map, I was enabled to ascertain that the whole mass of these mountains is composed of the same volcanic rocks, which I have — described in detail at the Tukt-i-Suliman and the Zebanwan. Ashes — appear to have been accumulated in enormous quantity; they are | interbedded with bands of black compact slate such as is so well seen 1866] the Western Himalaya and Afghan Mountains. 201 in the Wastarwan and Zebanwan, and both ash and slate are occa- sionally cellular or amygdaloidal. There is neither limestone, granite or porphyry among Captain MacQueen’s specimens, and I believe therefore that the two last rocks at any rate do not occur in these ‘Mountains, as pieces of granite and porphyry generally attract the attention amongst the dull ash-rocks and would not have failed to form part of the collection, if they had existed. It is very possible that remains of beds of limestone are to be found amongst the spurs of the hills. On the north of the Woolar Lake, many mountains of no great height form a sort of amphitheatre. They are nearly entirely composed of amygdaloidal greenstone, ash and slate interbedded, but near the village of Bundipoor, about two miles east of the road, some beds of limestone are seen. Mr. Drew has kindly sent me some specimens of it that are a flesh-coloured, sometimes greenish, very arenaceous and argillaceous. They are not at all ‘erystalline, but contain an enormous number of encrinite stems transformed into spar with a cleavage oblique to the axis of the stem, so that when the section of a stem weathers, it appears striated “across. This crystallisation has destroyed the structure of the stem, but the central canal is seen in a few specimens. We have seen this rock well developed at Manus Bal, towards the end of our section, where the beds of flesh-coloured limestone alternate with grey sandy | limestone containing crinoid-stems transformed into a spar as black | ascoal. (See 35 of the section of Manus Bal). The limestone of | Bundipoor is therefore Weean limestone. - On the west shore of the Woolar lake, the Taltiloo and the | Chralkoot present perpendicular cliffs of volcanic rocks descend- | ing into the water. From a boat on the lake, it is easy to observe the usual thick and confusely bedded masses of greenstone and amygdaloid forming the centre of these hills, and the more sloping | and regularly stratified layers of ash, laterite, agglomerate and slate well developed, in the long spurs which descend on all sides. | The whole mass of hills appears to be made of volcanic rocks, and the lowest spurs which approach the shore of the lake present no fossilifer- | ous beds. Of the higher peaks, the Kahoota, Manganwar and Sheri | Bal, I know nothing, but there can hardly be a doubt, however, of their being volcanic in their formation. 202 Mr. Verchére on the Geology of Kashmir, &c. [No. 3, 58. The third catenated chain is composed of summits of great — ‘height, the Gwashbrari (17,839), the Harbagwan (16,055) the Basmat (15,652), and the Haramook (16,903), and many other peaks which, with their spurs and connecting ridges, separate Kashmir proper from Tillail and Gurais. All these high summits are formed by porphyry having a granitoid appearance, which passes, towards the north, into felstone generally earthy and similar to the earthy fel-— stone of the Atala Mount near Baramoola. On the north-western extremity of the chain, this felstone becomes continued with that of the great chain of hills which unites the Kaj Nag to the Ser and Mer chain. This flaggy rock is continued to near the city of Gurais’ where, in the valley of the Kishengunga, beds of limestone appear extending from about 15 miles N. W. of Gurais to Tillail. The limestone is, after a break, continued at the Sono Murg” and is in all probability identical to that of this locality. I have never seen any specimen or fossil from the Tillail limestone, but the Sono Murg limestone is Carboniferous, and it is most probable that the Tillail limestone, which appears to be the continuation of that bed, belongs to the same epoch. Due north of Sono Murg, the limestone is much developed and forms the summit of a considerable peak. The porphyry-centres of mountains pass towards the south to rocks of an appearance different from that of the northern spurs; while we have seen that, towards the north, the porphyry generally graduates © to a felstone more or less earthy. Towards the south it changes, as we travel from the peaks towards the end of the spurs, into trachyte, greenstone, amygdaloid, basalt, ash and agglomerate, together with interstratified, azoic and often amygdaloidal slate. . The northern spurs of Gwashbrari, the Harbagwan and the Basmai are composed of felstone, and near the road to Drass, in the valley of the Sind Torrent, of amygdaloid and ash. On these beds of | ejecta rest fossiliferous beds, and, near the small village of Sono Murg, the beds of limestone are well developed. Captain Godwin-Austen found in that locality some fossils which he was kind enough te . show me. ‘They were identical with the forms described as charac- teristic of the Kothair group of Carboniferous limestone, viz, the 4 Gasteropoda and Cyathophyllide which are represented at PI. VII. 1866. ] Mr. Waldie on the water of the Hooghly, &c. 203 fig. 4, 4a. They occur in a thin-bedded, dark-grey, argillaceous limestone, having in some places the appearance of a calcareous slate. But beds of Weean limestone must exist not far from Sono Murg and form propably some of the beds of limestone which are seen in the high valley between the Ambernath and the Gwashbrari, as blocks of limestone of this description, rounded by running water, were found in the bed of the Sind, near the traveller’s home at Sono Murg. To be continued. EXPERIMENTAL INVESTIGATIONS connected with the supply of watTER from the Hooghly to Caucurra, by Davi Watpin, Esq. I. C. 8. de. [Received 31st August, 1866. ] The attention which of late years has been given amongst civilized communities to the preservation of health and prevention of disease, has naturally been directed amongst other subjects to that of the water employed for economical purposes, and more particularly to its purity and wholesomeness asa beverage and as the medium for the ‘preparation of food. The subject has been under the consideration of the municipal authorities of Calcutta, who, as is well known, have organised a scheme for the supply of the town from the river Hooghly, for the carrying out of which arrangements are now in progress. ‘The Sanitary Commission appointed some time ago in the Bengal Presidency, and I believe in the other Presidencies also, recommended to the several governments of the Subdivisions, that the water of the | various cantonments and stations should be subjected to chemical | Boar for the purpose of ascertaining their wholesomeness, and | these recommendations are in course of being carried out. In England, and more particularly in the metropolis, much attention has been given to the same subject, and also to another one closely connected with it, namely, the disposal of the sewerage of towns. This subject is connected with that of water supply, not only, because in the plan generally followed for getting rid of sewerage in towns, a large 204 — Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [No. 3, supply of water is necessary, but also on account of the circumstance that in many cases the readiest way to dispose of the liquid sewerage is to turn it into rivers. And as it frequently happens that these rivers may afford the easiest or perhaps the only practicable source of supply of water for other towns, the pollution of their waters so produced may be not a little deleterious. From the enormous extent and population of the English metropolis, and the comparatively small size of the river on which it stands, the evil in that case has become palpable and notorious. The most eminent chemists and engineers have been engaged in the examination of the subject as respects both the supply of water and disposal of sewerage, and the results of their enquiries have been published and subjected to public criticism and discussion. So far as I am aware, nothing has yet been published of the results — obtained by the examination of the waters of the Military cantonments of India, nor do I know if it be intended that anything shall be. With respect to the Calcutta supply, as is well known, a series of analyses has been made, and a Report of results and conclusions drawn — out, by the Chemical Examiner to Government, Dr. Macnamara. That report, no doubt from being intended for a non-professional, and (regarding it collectively and officially) not a professedly scientific body, gives only results and conclusions, omitting altogether the details of analyses and the specification of the methods employed. Dr. Macnamara’s attention seems to have been directed chiefly to the water of the Hooghly, to ascertain the proper point nearest to the town - from which a supply of water of sufficient purity all the year round could be obtained. The examinations were made on samples from Cossipore, Pultah Ghat near Barrackpore, and Chinsurah. The general conclusion arrived at is, that the influence of the tide is little felt at Chinsurah at any period of the year, not much more at Pultah Ghat, except towards the close of the hot season in May and June when it is decidedly perceptible though not great, and not only decided but to a large amount at Cossipore during the months of March, April, May and June; and that the river water from its admixture with sea water and the sewerage of Calcutta during that time is unfit for human con- sumption. The organic matter is stated to be much larger in quantity during these months than at other periods, and also to be highly . nitrogenized ; the quantity amounting to 6 or 7 grains or even 10 or — / 1866.] _ with the supply of water to Calcutta. 205 12 grains per Imp. gallon during the months of April, May and June; and this increase in quantity and deterioration in quality is considered to be due to the organic impurity from the sewers and banks at Calcutta. The analyses, I may observe, were chiefly made on samples taken at high water, obviously to get the water at its worst. Analyses are also given of the waters of two tanks inthe Maidaun or plain round Fort William, namely Monohur Doss’s Tank and General’s Tank, which are considered as unquestionably superior to the river water. I may observe that, when I commenced this investigation, it was not in connection with the water supply of Calcutta at all, or even in con- nection with the economical use of water or its wholesomeness as a beverage. These enquiries had been placed in the hands of others ; but it occurred to me, that residing, as I did, on the banks of the Hooghly, and possessing certain facilities for the purpose, it might be a contribu- tion to science of some small value to make a minute examination of the constituents of both the water and the mud of a great river draining so large an extent of country as the Ganges. The investiga- tion is as yet far from completion, but during its course, it occurred to me that many of the results obtained might have some value in relation to the subject just adverted to—the economical use of water ; ‘and that the local interest attached to it might render it in some degree appropriate to publish these results, more particularly at a time when all the knowledge attainable connected with the subject is desirable. This communication then is not intended to present a full statement of the composition of the Hooghly water, but only to treat of such : ‘points as are of more particular interest in connection with its applica- tion to supply the wants of the inhabitants of Calcutta. And indeed | this is all that is necessary for the purpose in view. As regards the | general composition of the river water at different seasons of the year, ‘my own results only go to confirm those already given in Dr. Mac- mamara’s Report, but in some particulars, not of minor importance, the results I have obtained and the conclusions drawn from them are somewhat different ; and in other particulars it may be found that I have added to the stock of information on the subject. It is scarcely necessary to allude to the course of the seasons in Bengal and the way in which they affect the river. But for 206 Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [ No. 3, convenience I shall briefly state how I shall speak of them in what follows. From the middle of June when the rains generally commence and the river rises, till the end of October or middle of November, when the rains have ceased and the river is rapidly falling, I shall speak of as the rainy season; thence till the end of February as the cold season; and thence again till the rains recommence as the hot season. The first is identical vues is Macnamara’s “‘ Full season,” the two latter with his ‘‘ Low season.’ During the rains, the river comes down in full sisi from the parent Ganges through the effluents which unite to form the Hooghly, viz. the Bhagiruthy, Matabangah and Jellinghy, with contributions from other tributaries from the west. During that period, and more particularly during its earlier part, the water is loaded with mud in a very fine state of division and very slow in settling. As the season comes near its termination, the water becomes clearer, and remains so during the cold season, any mud in suspension rapidly settling. The water, which during the rains naturally contained the smallest proportion of saline matter, now contains more, the proportion gradually increasing | till the end of February, the first increase having been more rapid at the stoppage of the rains. All this, of course, is the natural and obvious — result of evaporation without any rainfall to supply the place of the lost water, aggravated by the diminished supply of water from the Ganges caused by the bars at the entrance to the tributary effluents. These causes operate with still greater power during the hot season, aided by strong southerly winds and powerful tides. During this season the mud is stirred up, and the water rendered more dirty, but the mud is not in the same state as during the rains, and settles without difficulty. The influence of the tides becomes increasingly felt as the season advances, and the admixture of sea water becomes unmistakable. The following table exhibits the results I have obtained as respects — the amount of solid residue obtained by evaporating the water. They — quantities per gallon are obtained. The following Lable showing the amount of solid matter dried a 7 212° to 220° Fah. an the river water at ebb tide, at a point from two q three nules above Calcutta. are given for 100,000 gyrs. of water, instead of the Imperial gallon used 4 by Dr. Macnamara. By multiplying by 7 and dividing by 10, the 1866.] with the supply of water to Calcutta. 207 Tasze I. For 100,000 grs. For 70,000 grs. or Imp. gall. 1865 August 31st, 1865, including very fine clay,* Ebb, 12.13 8.41 December 6th, Ebb, 24.00 16.80 1866 February 25th, Ebb, 30.00 21.00 May 2nd, spring tide, Ebb, 36.20 25.34 \ Flood, 88.50 61.95 _ 24th, Neap tide, Ebb, 21.25 14.88 June 14th, spring tide, Ebb, 30.70 21.49 \ Flood, 151.90 106.33 July 6th, including very fine clay,* Ebb, 12.59 8.81 ugust 8th, clay and some silica deducted, Ebb, 8.13 5.69 ba These numbers confirm the results exhibited by Dr. Macnamara’s : port, making allowance for difference of seasons. They shew clearly e increase of solid contents more especially during the dry season. nd here I may remark that samples were chiefly taken during bb tide, as my primary object was the examination of the river water oper, and it was only during the hot season that particular attention Ps as paid to the state of tide, after my attention had been directed in | part to what is the special object of this paper. And indeed, except fein the hot season, the composition of the water is little affected by | tides. is "And further, as the object was to make a full analysis of the water | ; several different seasons, I did not adopt the readiest or simplest oe of merely comparing the water at different periods for sanitary a oses, which would have been done, had that been my primary i ject. The methods adopted will be noticed in due course. ay: The preceding table exhibits a very great variation in the amount of solid constituents during the hot season, owing to the influence of fret tides, a subject which will be separately considered. Che These waters had settled well—that of August 1865 for 19 days, that of duly 1866 for about 35 days, yet by comparison with that of August 1866 it ot be observed that about one third of their solid contents was fine clay. 26 mt) | i} 208 Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [No. 3, Influence of the Tides. It will indeed be convenient to take up this subject first in order, Dr. Macnamara’s results exhibit very clearly the increased quantity of saline constituents during the hot season, commencing in March, and coming to its height just before the commencement of the rains. His table shews as much as 77.7 grs. dry saline residue from 1 gallon of water at high water on 12th June, 1862. I obtained from water taken at full spring tide, on 14th June of this year 1866, as much as 106.3 grs per Imp. gallon. This is easily accounted for when it is found, as ascertain- ed from examination of the rainfall, that from June 1861 to end of May 1862 there had fallen 87.4 inches of rain, while during the correspond- ing period of 1865-66 there had been only 47.9 inches: the river must have been much lower and its current feebler, and consequently the sea water had penetrated farther. My observations were all made on water taken from the river near my own residence at the village of Baranagur or Barnagore, with a few exceptions which I shall notice alterwards. The locality is about two miles above Cossipore. But made observations also on the effect of time of tide. This point is also noticed in Dr. Macnamara’s report, though not very fully. He mentions that the water varies much in the degree of its impurity with the time of tide, falling as low during April and May as 23° at low water, that is, 23 grains of saline matter in 1 gallon. My observations indicate even a greater amount of variation than is by this suggested, as will be shown by the table I have prepared. As the evaporation to dryness and weighing the residue of numerous samples is very tedious and troublesome, another plan was adopted for estimating the amount of variation. The river water proper contains very little chlorine in its composition, while in the state of common salt this is the characteristic constituent of sea water. The quantity of chlorine was therefore ascertained by the usual volumetric process with nitra ie of silver, and calculated as if it existed entirely as chloride of sodium of time, trouble, &c. that I could not devote to it. Any noon that I did make were only confirmatory of Dr. Macnamara’s results. — The following table exhibits the results of my observations on the ; - - 1866.] with the supply of water to Calcutta. 209 + . : ; , _ influence of the tides. The change of course is gradual, commencing in March and increasing as shewn by Dr. Macnamara’s report. I did not make observations until the first of May. i - Taste II. D : Chiorinecale. Saline matter dried as Chloride at 220° fF. _ To compare Ebb and Flood Tide, of Sodium. For 4866 a mile above Baranagar— For 100,000 100,000 Imp. gal. 2 gers. grs. May Ist, second day of full moon. —“—— Low water nearly complete, .....:... 28.0 19.60 High water nearly complete, Surface, 61.55 43.08 Deep, 59.55 41.68 At Calentta— 2nd, third day of full moon, _ ¢ About % Ebb, stream, Surface, 36.20 25.30 t Opposite Bankshall. Deep, 15.50 About } Flood, stream, Surface, 88.50 62.19 { Opposite Hatkolah. Deep, 55.50 i a 16th, third day of new moon, Above 1 or 13 hour Ebb, Surface, 40.00 66.40 46.48 Deep, 68.60 Above i Flood, Surface, 78.00 107.20 ” Deep, 75.00 109.00 76.30 9 Newly high water complete, Surface, 82.50 104.70 ; Deep, 80.00 106.20 _ To shew state at Neap tide. 2th h, fourth day of first quarter of moon. ~ Thour after beginningof Ebb,Surface, 17.50 4 Deep, 18.50 hours after do. | Surface, 12.50 ban iLbo 21.25 15. bn shew rate of change during | i a | Ebb and Flow. May y 30th, third day of full moon. Brat shore 5 h. before tide begun, ... 27.00 a MPT PeHOKe dO, 85.0)... ..besseteeesces 2ESO | | 2 At Baranagar— | | . 05 210 Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [No. 3, Stream, above 4 hours flood,......... 64.00 83.85 58.7 June Ist, fifth day of full moon. 5 h. 10 m. before tide begun, .......... 35.00 1-20 ditto ditto; i220... 222 cme alte 16.50 21D altandscho,s senate ety sss 2 anunees 26.50 5-10 after ditto, Surface, 69.50 Deep, 58.50 14th, third day of new moon.* Tide commencing about noon, At 6h. 40 m, A. M. Surface, 63.50 _ Deep, 65.90 Lis &. 0 ‘es 12.00 | 30.7 21.49 2-20 P. M. Surface, 71.00 Deep, 85.50 4-20 P. M. Surface, 123.00 Doon 26 U0 151.9 106.33 The water was collected either by filling vessels from the surface, or in the case of the deep water by lowering atin bucket provided with proper valves. The much larger quantity of heavier mud brought up by the bucket proved that it acted properly. The water was collected in almost every instance under my own personal superinten- dence. The collection was made by means of an ordinary small boat or dinghy. The changes of position which could not be avoided account for the irregularities between the surface and deep waters taking into account the strong currents and eddies that prevail. The table exhibits the great influence of the tides: taking the extreme case of 14th June after long drought, just two days before the rains commenced, we have in 100,000 fl. grains of water 151.9 grs. solid matter at high water, and 30.7 gr. at low water, or nearly 5 to 1 while comparing the Chlorine as Chloride of Sodium or common sal ; the proportion is fully 8 to 1. These great differences occur chiefly at spring tides. The results of 24th May shew how comparatively small this is at Neap tides, 19 grains of salt at nearly high water to 12 grs, at nearly low water, 9 * Highest tides are on third day of new or full moon, 1866.] with the supply of water to Calcutta. 21T A study of the particulars of this table shews that the period during which the water can be obtained with the smallest admixture of sea water is during the last three or four hours of ebb tide and the first one or two of flood. From tables of the analyses of the waters _ gupplied to London which [ shall have to refer to more particularly afterwards, it appears that the water of five Thames Companies contains at an average from 26.41 to 26.97 grs. of saline matter per 100,000 ; and that of four other Companies,—two river waters contain about 26 _grs., and two artesian well waters contain from above 38 to 40 grains. _ The Hooghly water at Baranagur therefore even during the hot season at ebb tide contains little more solid matter than the Thames water, but probably a larger proportion of this is salt. : Constituents of River Water proper. _ We have now to direct our attention to the river water proper, which we may consider that we can get from the Hooghly at different degrees of dilution all the year except three or four months of the hot season. The water of rivers is of course in greater part generally water fallen _ from the atmosphere. Aided by the carbonic acid of the atmosphere, ‘it acts upon rocks, even silicious rocks, producing a certain amount of decomposition and carrying off their constituents partly in solution, partly in suspension as mud; it carries off similar constituents from the soil, which consists of decomposed rocks ; and also from this source a quantity of organic matter, the result of the decomposition of vegeta- ble and animal substances, as also the excrementious matters deposited ; there. Except in special circumstances the water of rivers generally contains a rather small proportion of alkaline salts in the state of Silicates, sulphates, chlorides and carbonates, with a larger proportion of _ carbonates of lime and magnesia kept in solution by excess of carbonic ~ acic gas. They differ from spring or deep well waters and agree with surface waters generally in containing a notable proportion of potash is well as soda, and also more silica, phosphates, earthy carbonates an¢ organic matter, and sometimes ammonia and nitrates, than deep spring waters do. When brought in contact with argillaceous deposits, _ they part with their potash, ammonia, silica, phosphoric acid and | organic matter, while the soda, lime, magnesia, sulphuric acid and | chlorine are generally retained, forming the usual constituents of / - spring waters, This subject is treated of fully in an Essay on the 212 Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [ No. 3, Chemistry of natural waters by Mr. T. Sterry Hunt, which will be found* well worthy of perusal. I am not aware whether much consideration has been given to the peculiarities of the constitution of such surface waters in regard to their mineral constituents and their action on the animal economy, except in the case of the abundance of earthy carbonates. This, however, is perhaps the least characteristic of these constituents, as many spring waters abound in earthy carbonates, or at least in earthy salts, sulphates and muriates of lime and magnesia. More charac- teristic is the deficiency of muriate of soda or chloride of sodium in the surface waters and its comparative abundance in spring waters. Soda is the characteristic alkali of the components of the human body, but some curious observations have been made by physiological — chemists on the relative proportions of the two alkalies in different parts or tissues of the system; and though it is stated in these cases that the peculiarities exist entirely irrespective of the nature of the food taken, it would scarcely be warrantable to assume as certain that such differences in the predominance of potash or soda in food or drink are entirely destitute of influence. The point is at least worth bearing in mind, Phosphoric acid, when present, exists in such small quantity that only in very minute analyses is it sought for by the analyst. Silica is found much more generally. From its neutral and indifferent character, much attention has not been given to it in its influence on animal bodies. But attention has been given to all of these substances in relation to vegetable physiolog y, as plants draw their | food directly from the soil in part at least, and the nature of its constituents is therefore of immediate importance. To the other constituents I have mentioned, namely organic matter with the products of its decomposition, including ammonia and nitric | acid, more attention has lately been paid in connection with water to be used for human consumption. Indeed this may be said to be the principal point to which the analysis of waters selected on sanitary considerations has of late been chiefly directed. The water of the Hooghly has a composition similar to that already given as that of river waters generally. According to Dr, * Silliman’s American Journal of Science for March, July and Sept. 1865. — ' 1866.] with the supply of water to Calcutta. 213 Macnamara’s report, in the month of August there was in 1 gallon of water 1.2 grains of soluble salts and 5.4 grs. of insoluble earthy salts, beside silica and organic matter, and in February 1.8 of soluble and 13.4 of earthy. Or, asI prefer to express it, there was in August 1.7 _ grs. alkaline salt and 7.8 grs. earthy carbonates in 100,000 fi. grs., and x in February 2.6 alkaline salt and 19.1 grs. earthy carbonates in the a same volume. The first represents the water in its most diluted state - during the height of the rains, the last in its most concentrated state at the end of the cold season, just before tidal influence begins to be & felt. I do not intend to give any of my own results, partly because a full analysis of the water is not the object of this paper, and partly ~ Decause a circumstance entirely unforeseen and unexpected has thrown Bicat on the correctness of some of those obtained, and I do not _ wish to give them in an imperfect state, as they cannot be corrected % until the return of the cold season gives me a new supply of water. 5 It is sufficient to say that they do not appear to differ materially from those given in Dr. Macnamara’s report. The only point to | be noticed is, that Dr. Macnamara, in accordance with the usual custom, where minute accuracy is not required, assumes that the alkali is soda, Both potash and soda, however, are present in the river water ; to what extent they vary, I have not yet ascertained. During the hot season, _ from the increase of common salt from tidal water, there is of necessity | a a great increase in the proportion of soda in the state of common salt. - The; alkaline salts consist of potash and soda in combination with . 8 Bitpharic acid, silicic, and probably hydrochloric acid (or more strictly their metals combined with chlorine) and perhaps some organic | acid. The earthy salts are carbonates of lime and magnesia, kept in solution by excess of carbonic acid. On evaporation nearly the “whole of the lime and magnesia separate as carbonates insoluble. Besides these there are a few minute constituents to be noticed after- 4y ards. The only™ particular now to be noticed is, the different proportion of solid constituents in the water at the two extremes ; in _ August thereis 9.5 grains of alkaline and earthy salts in solution in 4 100, 000 fl. grs. of water, in February there is 21.78 grs. or about two | t da quarter times asmuch. This great difference is of course due to % he nature of the seasons’ in Bengal, where almost all the rain falls du ing four or five continuous months. 214 Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [No. 3, It may be useful to refer for the purpose of comparison to the composition of some other waters supplied to towns, and I shall take for that purpose one of the most recently published reports on the subject, namely, that by Professor Frankland on the water supply of London during the year from February 1865 to January 1866.* The only points determined connected with the mineral consti- tuents are the total amount of saline matters and the amount of earthy salts as ascertained by the soap test ; this, as is well known, — being the application of the familiar fact that hard water curdles soap, to ascertain its purity; a solution of known strength of soap being added to a measured quantity of the water to be examined from a graduated tube, until the curdling effect of the salts of lime and magnesia which cause the hardness is exhausted, and the water produces a lather on shaking. The quantity of soap required indicates the amount of earthy salts present; an easy and speedy means of obtaining a sufficiently good estimate of the amount of earthy salts in water. By deducting from the total solid matter first the amount of organi¢ matter, the total. inorganic is obtained ; and by deducting from this the amount of carbonate of lime, the remainder will indicate, with sufficient approximative accuracy, the amount of alkaline salts. Here are the results of this preceeding —for the waters of Five Thames New River Kent and 8S. Companies and River KHssex Co.'s average. Lea, Artes. Wells. Total solid matters, mean 26.63 26.11 39.03 Deduct organic and volatile, mean 1.60 1.30 L734 25.08 2481 — 87.30 Carbonate of Lime 17.69 20.65 25.16 Alkaline salts 7.34 4.16 12.14 ~ It will be observed that the alkaline salts are in much larger proportion to the earthy carbonates than in the Hoogly water, thi being specially the case in the Artesian well waters. The waters of Ne River and River Lea come nearest the Hooghly. The amount of soli matter is much greater in the average than that of the Hooghly rivel * Journal of the Chemical Society, June 1866, = “ Se 1866.] with the supply of water to Caleutia. 215 water proper, the mean indeed being nearly as much as the maximum of the Hooghly before tidal influence begins. The amount of variation is much smaller in these waters: of the Thames water the highest quantity of solid matter was 32.62 grs. the lowest 18.78, and the well waters vary less. And it was observed that the quantity of solid matter tended to increase after heavy rain fall. Other river waters contain more or less of such constituents, dependent on the nature of the rocks and soil they traverse. Mr. Sterry Hunt gives an analysis of the Ottawa water, taken before the melting of the _ snows, containing 6.12 grs. solid in 100,000. Bischoff, in his Chemi- cal Geology, gives a pretty large list of analyses of river waters, show- ing a variation of from 2.61 to 54.5 grains solid matter in 100,000. e The nature of their mineral constituents also varies greatly, but that will not engage our attention at present as it is more a geological question than a sanitary one. We shall proceed to the point more immediately connected with the object of the paper. ( x The substances treated of can scarcely be called impurities with ference to natural waters. They are rather constituents, and are only to be considered impurities in a sanitary point of view when _ they are excessive in quantity, as for instance exceeding 40 or even 50 grains in 100,000. The remaining substances to be noticed may _: purely chemical point of view be called constituents also with 7 ite as much truth, but with reference to sanitary considerations y with propriety be termed impurities. They were enumerated e as organic matter, ammonia and nitric acid. It may be better consider them as organic matter of vegetable origin and organic | er of animal origin, with the respective products of their decom- position. Vegetable substances of all kinds mixed with the soil, exposed to air and moisture or immersed in water, dead animal bodies of every arie y in similar circumstances, all rotting, fermenting and putrefying, with the excrementitious matters from living animals, constitute the ms erials from which river water derives that portion of its consti- tuents called organic matter. Its nature is so heterogeneous and its q antity so small, that it would be hopeless to attempt to separate it its proximate constituents. All we can attempt is to get some Micra idea of its nature, from which to form some judgment of its 27 216 Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [No. 3, properties, especially with reference to its action on the human system. Of late more attention has been paid to this subject, previously little thought of. The first point requiring attention is to ascertain its quantity as correctly as practicable. The plan formerly followed was to dry the solid contents of the water obtained by evaporation carefully at a certain fixed temperature such as 212° or 250° F., or even about 300°, till the weight remained constant ; then to burn off the organic matter by as moderate a heat as possible and weigh again : the loss of weight was considered organic matter. But this method is liable to great error, and may give grossly erroneous results. Other substances may be volatilised : salts of ammonia have been mentioned, but they may be included amongst organic matter ; nitrates may be partially or wholly decomposed, but they generally exist in very small quantity. Earthy — carbonates may lose carbonic acid :—carbonate of lime will not readily lose it if the heat be moderate, but carbonate of magnesia will very © readily, and moreover chloride of magnesium (or muriate of magnesia) loses part of its acid easily. It is the magnesium salts which are the chief source of loss, but this can be prevented or remedied. If the © contents of the water be not naturally sufficiently alkaline, a sufficient quantity of accurately weighed and perfectly dry carbonate of soda is added to the water on evaporating it; the soda combines with hydro- chloric acid to form chloride of sodium and water, while the magnesia remains as carbonate; and by this means, as the chlorine is not separated by ignition from the sodium, the loss of chlorine is avoided, The only loss is of carbonic acid, which can be restored again. This is done by adding to the ignited residue in the platinum crucible distilled water charged with carbonic acid and evaporating to dryness | by gentle heat, drying again at the same temperature as was employed at the first weighing before ignition till the weight is again constant. The loss of carbonic acid is by this means corrected, the acid being restored, and the difference of weight shows the quantity of organie matter, at least more correctly than by any other method known. . This plan is attributed to Dr. Thomas Clark, the inventor of the soa > e test, by Dr. W. Allen Miller in a paper* to which I shall have further occasion to refer. It is tedious and troublesome, requires a fine balance, * Journal of the Chemical Society for May, 1865. , 1866.] with the supply of water to Calcutta. 217 patience, and care ; but it isnot too much to say that the results obtained without the above detailed precautions are of no value, or rather worse than useless, asthey mislead. The results which I shall give were ob- tained by this plan carefully carried out. It will be found that they differ materially from those given in Dr. Macnamara’s report; and I can only account for the discrepancy, by supposing that some precau- tion requisite for ensuring accuracy in the process was omitted, either from inadvertance, or because it had not at that time (1862) been generally known to or used by chemists. In the table in that report the smallest quantity of organic matter entered is 0.9 grain in 1 Imperial gallon, the largest 8.3 grains, gene- rally however 3 or 4 grains per gallon, which are equal to respectively 1.23, 11.8 and 4.3 or 5.7 grains per 100,000 grains. My own results have yielded me only from 0.6 to 1.9 grains in 100,000 and Dr. Frank- land’s in the report already alluded to, vary from .54 to 3.3, or average about 1.6 for the Thames, and 1.3 for the other two river waters, The table which will be given will exhibit the results[ have obtained, ‘Remarks will be postponed till the whole subject is considered. The time, trouble, and care necessary for estimating the amount of organic matter by weight is so great, that chemists have been desirous of finding some easier and speedier method of estimating its amount. Precipitation of the organic matter by salts of lead or reduction of salts of silver and gold have been proposed, but never come into general use. But another re-agent has of late been very generally employed, “the permanganate of potash, which from the facility with which it yields its oxygen to organic substances has been made the means of estimating the amount of these ; and as it can be very easily employed, ‘it has come very much into favour. A good deal of difference of “Opinion prevailed at first as to the proper method of applying it and as to the value of its indications, but more agreement is being arrived | atlately. It is used in the state of weak solution poured from a graduated tube, and the permanence of a slight pink tinge in the water to which it is added is the sign of the action being complete : the quantity by measure of the solution required indicates what is wanted. Dr. Letheby continues to add the solution at intervals for 24 hours: if the action was completed, then this would be very well, but it is not, as there are different kinds of organic water, some 218. Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [No. 3, of which act slowly on it, others more rapidly. Dr. Miller strictly enjoins that the water should not be warmed, without however stat- ing any reason, and other English chemists seem also to practise it cold; Dr. Woods, who wrote a paper on it some years ago published in the Chemical Society’s Journal, recommends warming the water, as also does Dr. Macnamara, and gives reasons for it. It now generally seems to be agreed that it is desirable to restrict the use of the permanganate to the oxidation of those substances that can be rapidly acted on; and after consideration and experiment, I have adopted with some small modifications the details of Dr. Frankland’s practice, except that the water is heated to about 120° F. at the commencement. English chemists forget that what is our natural cold here, requires artificial heat with them, and that it is desirable to follow a plan that can be easily made uniform for all climates. The solution of per- manganate is added in small portions at intervals, until a perceptible tinge of pink remains for ten minutes; when this is the case, the quantity used is read off. I use 4000 fluid grs. of water with 80 fluid grs. of diluted sulphuric acid, containing 1 grain concentrated acid by weight in 5 fl. grs., heat the whole to about 120° F. and having — removed it from the lamp, proceed to add the solution. This is made — of such strength that each measure of the tube (it may be, each equal. to 1 cubic centimetre or to 10 fluid grains) yields .0OL grain oxygen as ascertained by its action on oxalic acid in solution in similar circumstances, that is dissolved in a similar quantity of pure distilled water with the same quantity of sulphuric acid and treated in the” same way. As .63 grains oxalic acid requires .08 grain oxygen, the solution will be of proper strength, if 80 measures are required for oxidizing that quantity of oxalic acid: that is, 80 measures are equal to .08 grain oxygen, or 1 measure is equal to .001 grain oxygen. Although it is certain that in many or most cases the permanganate as used in this process does not oxidise all the organic matters, and that we cannot tell how much remains unacted upon; and though at present at least we do not know what is the particular chemical constitution of the matters oxidized, it is at least certain that it acts upon those substances which give the putrid odour to stagnant water, and renders them after a time, when the products of its action have settled, pure and transparent and quite free from offensive smell, 1866.] with the supply of water to Calcutta. 219 Tt thus removes the matters which are actually in a state of putrefac- tion, and I believe preserves the water from further putrefaction for at least a considerable time. For this purpose it is advantageously employed for the purpose of purifying water for domestic use. In such application it is used alone, no sulphuric acid being used: a very small quantity being, added to the water, just sufficient to give it a very slight pink tinge, which will remain for above 15 minutes; the water is allowed to stand till next day, and is then decanted off and filtered and is fit for use. The minute quantity of potash salt produced can do no harm. _ Provided it be properly understood what the use of this re-agent indicates, and it be not credited with more than it does effect, the permanganate test is a valuable addition to our means of examining the quality of drinking water. The results of my examination of the Hooghly water by means of it, and the amount of organic matter Dy weight, are given together in one table. - The quantity of oxygen required is very small. ~ The results are given as obtained, but cannot be counted on too minutely, as there is a ‘certain amount of error unavoidable, in not getting the colour exactly of one degree of intensity, in slight difference of quantity required dependent on rapidity of adding the liquid, and probably on other causes “not very well ascertained. ‘The purity of the waters as respects such offensive constituents is in proportion to the oxygen required to oxidize pen : the purer the water the less oxygen is necessary. bia Tasue III. | River water taken from the Hooghly two to three miles above the north | ig end of the town, except when otherwise specified. | 7 For 100,000 fl. gs. water. |. Organie | z matter dried. at | 4 212° to 220° Oxygen re- m Fah. quired. me. Grains. Grains. 6th July, 1866 Ebb, from surface, see cite 80 0375 | 10th ditto, from shore, 2a aa Sib backs .0338 h August, Ebb tide, ... nen ate bs .60 0450 ditto ditto, _ ‘3 ” 86 .03845 } Blst August, 1865, Ebb tide ; a 65004 in ae ed bottles ten months, ei much vegetable growth had been removed, bats Donnas 74 0225 220 Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [No. 3, 9th December, 1865, Ebb, Surface, we: i? - auE OZ Deépy 22. re alae .78 0175 25th February, 1866 Ebb, Surface, ae st 92 : J Deep, ... YP TS A5 2nd May, Ebb at Bankshall, southern part of Calcutta, aE at 4 C05 i. 0325 Flood at Hatkolah, northern - of Gatdaidter: i) Dae 30th May, Ebb, ee ey oe 90 .0238 Flood, Os See 0275 14th June, Ebb, =e vee xg .90 0250 Flood, ss Bg B28 .0225 6th June at Chandernagore, 20 miles above | Calcutta, Ebb, Surface, iyi: poNtHRS, 5 .60 0163 Deep, La 67 0213 — From an inspection of this table, it will ‘e observed that the permanganate test exhibits the largest quantity of organic matter in ~ the river water during the rainy season, and the smallest quantity . during the cold season, the hot season giving results intermediate.* The same ratio is not so distinctly perceptible in the weight of the organic matter. If the water at all these seasons were at the same state of dilution as regards saline matter, there would be the largest proportion of organic matter during the rainy season and the smallest during the hot season. The hot season is usually associated with ideas of corruption and concentration of impurities, the rainy season with In point of fact it is directly the reverse. The same thing has been purification by the abundance of pure water from the clouds. observed in England, as will be manifest from the following quotation from Dr. Frankland’s report on the London waters. He says, “ This * It was with considerable hesitation that I left the indications given by the permanganate test in the table, on account of objections raised to my determinations of the organic matter which led to a supplementary paper read at the succeeding meeting of the Society. But after due consideration, they were allowed to remain .as sufficient for the purpose required. The objections will be noticed as occasion calls for it, in notes or in the Supplement. It is to be observed also that, as reported in the Proceedings of the Society for October, page 1866, I had stated 1.4 grains per gallon as the largest amount of organic matter obtained, Two of the results in the table, those of 2nd and 30th May somewhat exceed this, viz. 2.7 and 2.6 grains corresponding respective- ly to 1.89 and 1.82 grain per gallon. The correctness of these was doubted from supposed inaccuracy in the process, but this not being certain they have beams introduced into the table. 30th Nov. 1866. 1866.] with the supply of water to Calcutta. 221 comparison shews clearly (as might be anticipated) how closely the condition of river waters is connected with the amount of rain-fall ; but, in opposition to the commonly received opinion, it proves that the waters in question are much purer in dry than in wet weather, even if the drought occurs during a very hot summer.”’ He seems, however, to hesitate a little about drawing general conclusions from the observa- tions of one year; and in the report of the discussion which followed at the Chemical Society’s meeting as reported in the Chemical News, some of the speakers seemed inclined to attribute it to special and particular causes. I have no doubt that it is owing to general causes, and that when we consider the circumstances, we cannot expect any other result. Unfortunately in the case of the Hooghly at Calcutta, the question is complicated by the admixture of sea water during the hot season. This introduces two sources of error into the process of examination, namely an increased amount of saline matter, and a difference in its nature and properties. These will probably tend to cause indications of an amount of organic matter in excess of the truth. The point is under examination. There is also great difficulty in estimating correctly the amount of organic matter during the rainy season, on account of the impossibility of getting the water clear by filtration, and the very long time it requires to become clear by subsidence, This point is also under investigation.* _ There can be no doubt also that the kind of organic matter in the ‘sea water mixture is different in some respects from that of the river water proper. Iwas much struck with the observation made many months ago of the difference of colour presented by the different speci- | mens of water when highly concentrated, that of the August water | ie so much deeper in colour than the others. On the contrary, | % sample of water from the salt water lake to the east of Calcutta, though indicating both by the weighing’ and the permanganate ‘processes much more organic matter than the river water, when concen- trated, was almost colourless. But to return to the greater proportion of organic matter during the Tains, it seems to be nothing but what may be expected. During the * For the reasons stated there is considerable uncertainty respecting the cor- rectness of the weight of organic matter in the waters of July and August 222 Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [No. 3, remainder of the year, vegetable and animal matter of every kind is deposited in or upon the soil in all stages of decomposition. The amount of drainage is small and the flow of water gentle: the water carried thus to the river is comparatively pure, and that from the sources of the streams is from places bare of vegetation and part of it from melting snow. But when the rains come, they wash off all the accumulated products of decomposition of vegetable and animal sub- stances in the state both of solution and suspension, of which the appearance alone of the water and its flavour give ample evidence. The increased proportion, it is true, is counteracted by the largely — increased quantity of the water which dilutes it; for if, instead of — looking to the proportion of organic matter to the water, we look to its amount in proportion to the inorganic or mineral saline matter, then in the rainy season the excessive proportion of organic matter is rendered much more evident. After the rains the mud subsides, which is favourable to the purification of the water, and the atmo- spheric oxygen contained in solution in the water, as it is in natural waters generally, acts upon the organic matter in solution, oxidizing and destroying it. And as heat in general materially increases the energy of chemical action, there can be little doubt that this purifying - influence goes on more rapidly in tropical than in temperate climates, and that this explains why the organic matter in the Hooghly water is smaller in amount than that of the London waters, both of river and wells in their natural state. But we have to consider not only the quantity but the quality of the organic impurity. We can scarcely expect to go more minutely into this than to endeavour to ascertain the relative proportions of vege- table and animal matter, and to get some idea of their state or of the stage of decomposition in which they exist in the water. The chemical constitution of these gives us some aid in this enquiry, the main constituents of vegetable compounds being carbon, hydrogen and oxygen, those. of animal substances containing nitrogen im addition ; a statement which, though not strictly exact, is sufficiently characteristic, so much so, that by azotized or nitrogenous substances are generally understood compounds of animal origin. The ultimate products of the decomposition of non-nitrogenous organic matter in presence of oxygen, namely water and carbonic acid, of course give us n help in this enquiry, nor are the intermediate products likely to be 1866.] with the supply of water to Calcutta. 223 possessed of any such striking properties as to aid us much, as they are mostly of a neutral nature without active chemical or physical characteristics. Nitrogenous bodies, however, yield products more readily recognised, and as it is this class of substances which are most likely to possess properties injuriously affecting the animal economy, their detection is also the most important. The ultimate products of the decomposition of nitrogenous organic substances are, in addition to water and carbonic acid, also ammonia, and where excess of oxygen is present, nitric acid. But there are also humerous intermediate products, and these are often characterised by offensive smells which give a certain character to the putrefaction of animal substances, different from that yielded by the fermentation or corruption of vegetable bodies. The smell or flavour then of a water is a very good test of its purity, though it indicates rather the stage of decomposition in which its organic matter exists than the amount of organic matter present. And in connection with this I may mention the test of keeping the water and observing the changes Which take place in it, the production of animalcules or of aquatic vegetation. Now Ihave kept samples of water taken from the river at all seasons for many months. Those taken during the cold and hot seasons settled easily and suffered very little further change; at the most a little greenish deposit at the bottom of the bottle formed, which is the case, however, with ordinary distilled water. It was very different, however, with the water of the rainy season. Some water taken from the river on 31st August, 1865, was kept for about two or three weeks, then syphoned off the deposited mud into other clean stoppered bottles in which it remained, the bottles being closed for about four months, when the bottles were found to have their sides covered with abundant green branching vegetation: the water was again syphoned off quite clear to other clean bottles and kept for about six months longer, when the same appearances were observed, though toa much smaller extent. There was abundant proof in this case of the presence of organic matter, probably both in the form of living germs and of chemical compounds dissolved in the water. The water taken during the hot season may have contained as much: possibly the presence of the excess of saline matter may prevent such develop- ment, but I am not prepared to give an opinion on the subject. The 28 224 Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [No. 35 water of the hot season shewed more indications of vegetation than that of the cold season, though greatly less than that of the rains. Ammonia. Ammonia, perhaps one of the most characteristic evidences of the presence of nitrogenous matter, can be detected in natural waters, and even when in such minute proportion as in natural waters, its quantity can be estimated. Dr. Miller has given a process for doing so with sufficient accuracy, and without the necessity of operating on very large quantities of water, which will be found in the paper I have already mentioned on the analysis of mineral waters in the Journal of the Chemical Society for May 1865. It depends on the great delicacy of the test for ammonia possessed by an alkaline solution of the — Hydrarg-Iodide of Potassium, which produces a fine rich yellow brown colour with a very small quantity of ammonia, or a precipitate, — if the quantity be larger. In the weaker solutions, the colour varies’ in depth of shade with the proportion of ammonia present, and by a comparison with another solution containing a known quantity of ammonia the proportion is estimated. Dr. Miller attributes the plan of proceeding to Mr. Hadow, and gives the details of procedure. He gives the formula for the preparation of the alkaline solution of Hydrarg-Iodide of Potassium, which I have strictly followed and adopted. His standard solution for comparison is a weak solution of pure muriate of ammonia of such strength that 1 fluid grain of the solution contains .0001 (one ten-thousandth of a) grain of ammonia or 8.17 grains muriate of ammonia in 10,000 fluid grains. I also adopt this solution, but have modified the plan of proceeding, it appears to me with advantage. It is thus: A convenient quantity, 10,000 fluid grains is very suitable, of the water, to which a small quantity of pure hydrochloric acid has been added, is concentrated by a gentle heat to about 1,000 fluid grains: it must of course be slightly acid. This is put into a flask, some excess of pure milk of lime added, and the flask connected by a bent tube with a small Liebig’s condenser, to the extremity of which is connected a small Woulfe’s bottle, and to this another one furnished at its further neck with a tube containing broken glass moistened with water, this | being to prevent escape of ammonia. About half or 500 fluid grains of 1866. ] with the supply of water to Calcutta. 225 product is distilled over and emptied into a tube graduated into 100 ‘divisions of 10 fluid grains each, the bottles washed out with distilled water and added to the tube to make up 100 measures of liquid which isto be thoroughly mixed together. Two wide mouthed bottles or jars of as nearly the same size as possible are provided, into each of which 25 fluid grains of the Hydrarg-Iodide solution is introduced with some distilled water. Then into one of these an aliquot part of the distilled liquid is poured, say ;!, or 4, so as to produce a distinct colour, and the bottle is filled up with water. Another similarly graduated tube or burette has been prepared ready filled with the standard solution of muriate of ammonia, and this is carefully added to the second bottle, until the colour produced is as exactly as possible of the same shade as that of the first, both bottles being of course made equally full. The quantity added is then noted, and then calculated on the whole. Thus: suppose 74 fluid grains of the standard solution of muriate of ammonia has been required, this is equal to 74 & .0001 grains or .0074 grains ammonia. If 25 measures of the distilled liquor has been used for trial, this is 4th of it, consequently the whole contains 0074 K 4 = .0296 grains ammonia, and as this was from 10,000 fluid grains of water, by consequence the standard quantity of 100,000 fluid grains water contains .296 grains ammonia. The process requires great care, that there be no accidental admixture of ammonia. The vessels must be scrupulously clean, the distilled water and the lime used must be carefully examined to make sure that they contain no ammonia. The plan of measuring the distillate enables the operator to repeat the trial in case of accident or uncertainty. It is better to work with rather weak colours, as the eye can better detect differences of shade: .0074 grains ammonia is too much for a 2000 grain bottle: any size of bottle may be used, provided the two bottles be as exactly as possible alike in size, shape and capacity. 226 Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [No. 3, The following table shews 6th July, 1866, 21st August, Taste LV.. River water of Rainy SEAson. Average, Coxtp SEAson. 9th December, 1865, Shore, Ditto, Ditto, 27th ditto, 30th May, ... 14th June, Stream, ditto, ditto, Average, ae Hor Season. Ebb tide. Ditto repeated, ... 30th May, 14th June, Ditto repeated, ... Average, Flood Tide. ece Average, the results obtained by this process. Ammonia in 100,000 fl. grs. 1866.] with the supply of water to Calcutta, 227 carefully examining wherein they lie, in order to see if they can be avoided. Yet notwithstanding these inaccuracies, it seems to me that the general results are pretty evident, that the amount of ammonia is greatest in the rainy season, diminishes during the cold one, and again increases during the hot, which increase, however, is probably not in the river water proper. One examination of water from Chandernagore, which was very slightly if at all contaminated with tidal water, yielded only .0118 grain ammonia in 100,000 flood grains. ‘This conclusion is not a certain one; to make it so, it would be necessary to have examinations of the Chandernagore water at all seasons; but other considerations, to be afterwards noticed, render it probable.* I am disposed to attach a good deal of importance to the estimation of the ammonia, not only because it helps to indicate how far the nitrogenous matter has gone in the stage of decomposition, but because that stage is not improbably one of importance. It has been long known that many, I may say most, of the organic proximate principles found in vegetables are alkaloids possessing active properties and producing the most marked physiological effects, and that there are many similar principles produced in the decomposition of nitrogenised substances by destructive distillation or otherwise, which possess marked physical properties, and probably, if they were examined, also decided physiological actions. But by modern chemical research, it would appear that these alkaloids are all formed on the type of ammonia, or are ammonias having one or more atoms of its hydrogen replaced by some other organic combination or radical. Hence it seems not at all unlikely that such compound ammonias as they are called may be produced at the same time and along with the ultimate or ordinary ammonia. And even though no such compounds should exist, the amount of ammonia would give some probable indication of the stage of decomposition, and existence of compounds is a state of transition | towards ammonia. _ * The examinations for ammonia were all made about the same time in the month of August, consequently the waters were of different ages. The samples | had been preserved mixed with a little Hydrochloric acid and mostly in a concentrated state. Ofcourse objections may be made to their value on this account and possibly may be valid. This will again be referred to in the sequel. 30th November, 1866, 228 Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [No. 8, | I have seen few published analyses of water indicating the presence or amount of ammonia. Such examinations have been made, but they do not seem to be common. In the case of waters examined for sanitary purposes it appears to me that the point should be attended to. One observation that has come under my notice on the subject is in a-paper by Messrs. Lawes and Gilbert on town | sewage,* in which is mentioned the quantity of ammonia found in the River Wandle before and after receiving the drainage water — from the land irrigated by the sewage of Croydon. In both instances, it amounted to .18 grain per gallon or 70,000 grains, being therefore more than I have found at the worst in the Hooghly water viz. .185 grains per 100,000 grains. Nitrates. The presence of nitrates has been more noticed than that of ammonia, though it appears to me less worthy of attention. It is — true that they indicate the existence of nitrogenous matter, but it is rather as a thing of the past: the animal matter has been there, but is no longer now, at least that part of it which now has the form of nitric acid ; it is now fully oxydized, its animal essence and corruptibi- lity destroyed: it ranks with water and carbonic acid, no longer an organic substance. A process has been devised for estimating small quantities, known as Pugh’s process, which Dr. Miller in the above quoted paper recommends for application to water. I have not made use of it, indeed have not had time, but have satisfied myself with some other observations and experiments on the presence of nitrates in the river water. In many instances indeed very distinct deflagration © has been observed during ignition of the residue obtained by evapora- ting the water. This alone does not give good grounds for forming an opinion as to the quantity of the nitrate, as it may be masked o altogether obscured by an excessive proportion of other salts, as of common salt during the hot season. The presence of nitrites can also be observed by the blue colour produced with starch and iodide of potassium by the water acidulated. But as nitrites are simply imperfectly oxydised nitrates, the same observations apply to the former as have been made respecting the latter. * Journal of the Chemical Society, April, 1866, 1866.] with the supply of water to Calcutta. 229 I had intended, and still intend, to estimate the quantity of nitric acid for the complete analysis originally contemplated ; but for the reasons just stated, I preferred, for the purpose of this communication to direct my attention to other points which appeared of greater importance. That of ammonia which has been just discussed was one of these, and a greater number of determinations of ammonia would have been made, but time did not permit: besides I wished first carefully to examine the ammonia process in order to ascertain the causes of the discrepancies already referred to, with a view to discover the precautions necessary to be taken to ensure more concordant results. Other nitrogenous matter. But ammonia and nitric acid are only the ultimate terms of the fermentative and oxydised decomposition of nitrogenous organic matter, and there may be much more present in all stages of decomposition intermediate between these and unchanged animal or vegetable constituents. The amount of these could be estimated by ascertaining the quantity of nitrogen they contain, but the operation is too trouble- some to be generally applied to such minute quantities of matter as exists in drinking waters. Animal matters in being ignited or burnt, as is well known, omit a peculiar smell, different from that produced by burning non-nitrogenous substances such as wood, and this has been used as an indication of the presence of, and even as a means of forming a judgment respecting the proportion of matter of animal origin. But it affords a very uncertain means of judging, as even corrupting vegetable matter gives a different smell from fresh, and the peculiar animal odour may be more or less obscured by the greater or less proportion of vegetable matter mixed with the animal. .... the most characteristic smell given by burning animal matters is that produced by albuminous or gelatinous substances such as muscular fibre, blood, skin, or in short the undecomposed tissues of animal bodies in general. But these substances are probably not to be found in sewage except in small quantity, its constituents are ‘more nearly of the nature of urine and other excrementitious animal matters and the sour products of vegetable decomposition: many of jthem are volatile and evaporate by a moderate heat with a peculiar 230 Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [No. 3, nauseous smell, but one not so characteristic as that produced by burning horn or wool for instance. Nevertheless not to neglect any means of obtaining information on the subject, I not only, in the course of ascertaining the weight of organic matter by burning it off, paid attention to the appearances then presented, but afterwards made a few experiments on purpose. But with all I cannot concur in the satisfaction expressed by Dr. Angus Smith on the results, as quoted by Dr. Macnamara in his review of the pamphlet.* He speaks of the remarkably clear insight given by boiling down a few thousand grains of water and burning the residue. He says, “ We can by the eye and the smell detect humous and peaty acids, nitrogenous organic substances, and nitrates, and estimate their amount toa very useful degree of accuracy. We may even decide by it the animal or vegetable origin of the matter.” Now I have © carefully evaporated down repeatedly quantities of 50,000 and 100,000 grains of water and attended to these appearances, and the only conclusion I came to was, that the information obtained was very limited and unsatisfactory. Ihave also varied the experiment and. instead of burning the matter in an open platinum crucible have heated — it ina glass test tube. For some of the objects in view this is a better plan; and I compared in this way samples of water of the rainy season, of the cold season, and of the hot season during flood tide, For the latter, which is a mixture of river and sea water it is necessary to mix the saline matter with some dry carbonate of soda, or better, to evaporate the water to dryness with this admixture, in order to prevent the evolution of hydrochloric acid vapours. The mouth of the tube is to be loosely closed with a glass stopper which is removed from time to time to examine the smell and try with test papers. Examined in this way, all those samples gave some ammoniacal vapour with no very marked difference; all gave a somewhat urinous animal smell, but not one the characteristic smell of burning flesh or horn: there were — slight variations, but none very distinct. The rainy season water gave — more of the smell of burning vegetable matter than the others, this being the most distinctive point observed ; but altogether the informa-_ tion obtained was very small. ) After the failure of all these plans, there remained but one likely to * Indian Medical Gazette, April, 1866, of 1866. ] with the supply of water to Calcutta. 231 be satisfactory, and that was to determine the amount of nitrogen existing in other forms than those of ammonia and nitric acid, this being the only way in which the amount of undecomposed or imperfectly decomposed animal matter can be estimated. The way in which this is usually done is by what is well known to chemists as the soda lime process, and depends on the circumstance that all such animal substances containing nitrogen (this not including nitric acid however), when heated to redness in contact with a hydrated alkali, yield up all their nitrogen combined with hydrogen as ammonia, and this ammonia can by suitable arrangement be collected and its amount ascertained. Jam not aware that this plan has been much applied to the examination of animal matter in waters, no doubt on account of the minute quantity of nitrogen present ; nevertheless it appeared to me that it might be modified so as to estimate it even in drinking water. I intended to have postponed the trial of this process altogether, as I had not time to make proper arrangements and test the accuracy of the plan. However I made three experiments in a rather hasty and crude manner with such means as I had at hand. They are not at all to be depended on, but I may give the results as obtained, _ River water of 2nd June, Ebb, from Chandernagore, containing very little tidal water. 100,000 grains gave .028 grains ammonia. River water of 21st August, Ebb, from Barnagore. 100,000 grains gave .030 grains ammonia. _ River water of May and June, Flood tide, from Barnagore. 100,000 grains gave .010 grains ammonia. The results, as I have already said, are not to be depended on. Yet it cannot be denied that they are in accordance with the results obtained in other ways, respecting the organic matter. The ready formed ammonia existing in the water had of course been previously removed, ' Ina practical point of view this portion of the subject. is of the principal importance, as more than any other it bears on the question | as to how far the river water is contaminated by the sewage of Calcutta. Judging from the results obtained and just mentioned respecting ammonia and fixed nitrogenous organic matter, the amount. is not great: even at the highest tide at flood on the 14th June of this year, after twelve months of an unusually small amount of rain- 29, 232 Mr. Waldie’s investigations connected [No. 3, fall, it is no worse as regards ready formed ammonia than the water of the rainy season ; and if the rough experiments on the other nitrogenous matter are to be trusted, it is no worse or not so bad even in this respect ; and comparing the results with the one observation quoted respecting the river Wandle as regards ammonia, the Hooghly water even at the worst, has the advantage. In considering this point, it must be borne in mind that the refuse which Calcutta can yield must bear but a very insignificant proportion to the great volume of the waters of the Hooghly compared with that which a large English town will yield to an English river, and more particularly London to © the Thames. And then the purifying influences here are so much more active that contaminating constituents are much more speedily destroyed ; nature with her all pervading oxygen, its power exalted by a tropical temperature, burning all up. The water of the stream in constant motion presents perpetually renewed surfaces to the atmosphere to absorb the great purifying agent, and the importance of this will perhaps be more clearly manifested by comparison with — another class of waters with which I shall conclude this paper. Tank Waters. This class is the tank waters, a few of which I have made a partial | examination of, for the purpose of comparison. These are General’s tank, near the entrance to Park Street; Monohor Doss’ tank, near that to Lindsay Street, both of them on the plain round the Fort; Dalhousie Square tank, supplied by the river ; Cornwallis Square Tank, at the | northern part of the town; a newly cleaned and dug out tank at Dhurrumtollah (supplied by Mr. Dall); and a village tank near my own premises, Also I have examined slightly two well waters, and — the water of the Salt Water Lake to the east of the town; the results | of all will be given in one table and a few remarks appended afterwards- The water of the two tanks from the plain in May and June had @ slightly putrid flavour; in August this was much less. Cornwallis Square tank was very low in May and putrid, had not increased very — much in August. and was still bad. The Dhurrumtollah tank was bad — flavoured and abounded in vegetation ; the Barnagore tank in May and — June was covered with a thick coat of floating vegetation, and was very | dirty and bad smelled, quite unfit for use even by the villagers, In August during the rains its appearance improved somewhat. 1866.] with the supply of water to Calcutta. Taste V. For 100,000 fluid grains, Date of col- lecting. 1866. General’s Tank, ... 16 June, 14 Aug. Monohur Doss’s Tank, ...{L4 May, 6 June, 14 Aug. Dalhousie Square Tank, .../L4 May, 6 June, Cornwallis Square Tank, settled and veg. matter de- posited, ...,14 May, not settled, . {l4 Aug. Dhurrumtollah Tank, ... Aug. Barnagore, .-.(L1 May, 8 June, 17 Aug Dhurrumtollah well, oath AS Barnagore well, ... 18 Aug. Salt Water Lake, from Canal at Dhappa Toll _ House, ...|13 June, Ditch conveying sewerage of ~ Calcutta, ...|1 June, * Ditto, ...18 Sept. * Ditto, .. |13 Sept. Solid matter, 908.00 295.80 Organic matter. 1.35 2.00 1.50 4.40 5.15 4,25 20.00 33.10 27.33 22.25 233 Oxygen |Ammoe reqd. to oxidise. nia. .0825) .235 1225 .0913 .1000 .1400 0750 .1550 2975 3170 .2938 3379 .0725 0900 1250 5.680 .204 .237 _ Qn examining this table, it will be observed that even the best tank | water contains more organic matter by weight, and requires more | oxygen to oxydise it than does the river water during ebb tide; even | Dalhousie Square water appears to deteriorate by being removed from the running stream into a stagnant reservoir. organic matter in the bad tanks is also very noticeable. | well waters require more oxygen than the river water generally. * Added since the date of the paper. The excess of The two 234 Mr, Waldie’s investigations connected - [No. 3,am The Salt Water Lake water did not require more oxygen than the tank waters.* | I have little to add in the way of concluding remarks, as my object was not to report on any scheme or recommend any plan, but simply to communicate to a scientific society the results of numerous experi- ments and observations on a subject of practical importance. Some of these investigations are defective, but I intend to endeavour to remedy these defects by further investigation. And even after these are remedied, the results may indicate that there are yet other points o examine. There is work for the naturalist in the investigation of he animal and vegetable life in such waters, possibly exercising as great an influence on their salubrity as their chemical composition, Yet even this can only be aided by a full and accurate knowledge of © their chemical constituents. There are also questions connected with the preservation and use of the water, and these too are more likely — to be correctly answered, the more complete is our knowledge of the nature of its composition. | But I may briefly sum up the conclusions arrived at with reference to the application of the Hooghly water to the supply of the wants of Calcutta. As regards its inorganic coustituents,; the Hooghly water taken near Calcutta is at least as pure as any of the waters supplied to _ London, or indeed generally more pure for about eight or nine months of the year; during the hot season it is mixed with sea water under the influence of the tides and thereby rendered brackish. This can_ be avoided by taking the supply of water from further up the river. As regards organic matter, again, my results, if correct, indicate that the state of the water seems to be worst during the rainy season, and that notwithstanding the influence of the tides and the sewerage of Calcutta, it is doubtful if even at the hottest part of the hot season in June its impurity equals that of the water during the rains; and it is * T have already stated that it was with considerable hesitation that I left the indications of the permanganate Test in table III. on account of the. objections raised to their value: similar hesitation was felt as to inserting Table IV. and it was the indications given in Table V. which determined me to retain them. The same objections indeed apply to the results shewn by it, but this does not materially affect the purpose for which it is introduced. It — will serve sufficiently well for purposes of general comparison, the trials for’ oxidizable matter and ammonia having been made at the same times on both ~ river and tank waters, so that generally both kinds were of the same age or ~ nearly so, More exact determinations will be made in future, 30th Nov. 1866. — 1866. | with the supply of water to Calcutta. 235 questionable if even in the nature or quality of the organic impurities it is worse. Now as it is not likely that during the rains the water is materially different at Barrackpore from what it is at Calcutta, there will be little or nothing gained by taking it from Barrackpore during these months, the chief advantage being therefore that the salt water of the hot season will be avoided. Still even as it is, there seems to be no better source; for the organic impurities of the tank waters, even the best of them, seem at least equal in amount to those of the river water during flood tide, and greater than the same during ebb tide. And so far as a judgment can be formed from the means of comparison within reach, the water during the rains probably contains less organic impurity than the London waters.* Such are the conclusions I have arrived at, some of them unexpected even to myself, and which may be disputed by others. They are of course open to criticism and discussion. They may be suggestive of other things possibly of practical application, but into these I have not yet had time to enter, * T have much doubt upon these points, as much of the organic matter of the rainy season is probably adherent to the finely divided mud in suspension in the water, which is so difficult to separate. With a view to the use of the water, the point would require to be investigated in connection with the process to be employed for the purification of the water. Judgment may be consi- dered suspended on them, more particularly on that of the purity of the water of the best tanks at all seasons of the year, and of the nature and amount of the organic matter of the river water during the rainy season. Further remarks will be made on these subjects in subsequent communications, 30th Noy, 1866, ao ee ‘ GEOLOGICAL MAP of the ZEBANWAN Vol XXXV. PLT Map B. he Shakinen Bi = Nasech Bagh ChenarTrces Voleanie Ish & Slate viterbedded Mate (Avo) Sthaian. | Cirboraerous Tonestone: (/ The parallel. tines endieate the Strike of beds. Whe arrows trudicate the dep. { and Neighbouring Mountains Seale- Pinch « 2 Buglis® Miles Athan MV ect, ee . ee Ay igh : Cone CN at Pe i ae é 4 5” : 4* ae 4 oo Onn ’ : | . : : : . a 4 - ~ ‘ . Fen | lian ge ; - * 5 f ; ’ “<¥ 4 4 i 7 . bata, S's pp oN Se ee ee ~—_ i ‘ : * ! . € : 2, esas F Re aig eee “2 7 A i 2,5, ae C, , ‘ pe Neg ¢ a + / . 1 z ‘ ’ 3 ‘ ' 2 . p. y : ‘ y D ad m — . AES : shy FS TES é 8 ya J ° _ a -\ he a whens ‘i: : eo 4 ’ ; - « < "i - ied ‘ . &, a ‘ : 7 > r f “ : 7 . ry wa 2 a : ‘ id : q Mg » . ” 5 : 3 5 ™ ‘ . = ; s ; f > A , , . ¢ y a a : be * - : ‘ % 2. : A , - j % \ y on * P i b' - r Ps . ' 5 ‘s : “—- " ‘ : 4 / ‘ . \ , ‘ 7 , “ 4 ’ = ‘ - - 7 Journal As. Soc. Vol XXXV. Fl I. Section. © af] Prof Hos WSC) / . : / a [i / / haw /* | eee Sone ee : Scale | Inch= 100 feet a /*/ / / on —— Y 200 th HORIZONTAL SECTION of the ZEEAWAN SPUR of the ZEBANWAN Showing the ranlike disposition of the Gigs of lumestone and brown Shales at the expanded end of the Fan. = a A Crushing of the beds at the small end: of the Far BBR. Opervigs between the beds and. courses of racks NW Scale] Inch-= 00 leet. or yobz th 100 100 77] 300 SJ OM Vous NAN ‘ se Tiel oF the Mieelume abou 246 feeb above theSea, 1 VERTICAL, Journal As. Soc. Zecawan SECTION of the ZEEAWAN SPUR oi the ZEBANWAN Vol XXXV. PL UL. Section B. hacustrine clay : Jeurnal Ae. Sco GEOLOGIGAL MAP of the WASTAR WAN in Kashmir Quartzite Volcanic Rocks L} Azote Slate (Silurcan) [EN Gar sendtrous Donestone Slate indicate Strike of Bots sy, J indicate Dip tee VS eee Journal As. Soc- Vol XXXV. PI IL Section DPD tins Scale: One inch =100 feet or 1200 th AA Ae Ieee cantare aie GO 1g0 200 300 0 9 70 60 30 10 Dip SSW Go 0 Mah /h. Wordle $s ; N SS : sue 2 _ do 1) O 8 7 a Ash Quartile Ash; ete. Level of the Lacustruve deposit hevel of the Jheelum, about 5250 teet above the Sea, SECTION acrogs the Spur of the KAMLAWAN abovethe Village of MURHAMMA, n ives . em is aha? Vind y : ined Y A eh) eee “= le ug Aa ec gee ah 71 Journal As. Sec. Vol XXXV. Wil wl. 5 fi ‘Secl IV of Z Section Hi ff General Map Scalwy One Tnch = 500 Fut. or 6000 soe foe soo 200 toe e ooo 14000 1500 2000 2500 3000 — = Stee 5e AN | Nee bh Pe . fault Fault: The Strike wheels to the’ ae eens 6 A i ‘ ae : d, eee pore ; : - Aniygialoidel Greenstone, dips 5 SE-Contisely— WNE- SSW and the dip a Le : H Ruin of B. j shy Boag Datum line: the level of thy Manus Bal Lake abt 51907 above the Seu Hundabal SECTION of the MANUS BAL LIMESTONE between the SAFAPOOR and AHA TANGH. Lith: by H. Niven Surv Generals Office Calcutta Augt 1866. 1 Scale 1 Hnglish Inch =1000 feet, or 12000 4 0 000 soon ft 4000 00 Mish esaiise N 65° W Murrey Prabut Marshes § Gardens The Dal or small lake S209 abeve the Sea \ = Symugeur Tourns! As. Soc, Vol/XXXV P). Il. Ser lS Section I of Section A ( Generot orf) ap) Budédast Kuan Vukht -i-Sulimnan . 6063! above the Sea " i STSION 1 yBHEIr ie 20 . He Hie a ' 0 70 55% 70 ' ; Dip aan E Dh Sanwor a Mternate 10 feet thick Beds oP brown | Augitic Ash, often alearedis Pagglome. | rate anu of axsio slate. SECTON across the HURR! PURBUT, TUKT-I- SULIMAN and WNW. portion of the ZEBANWAN Sost E XXXY Pl I. a Section I of © S eclion A ( Ginerat orf) Wap) my i asi a * 3.8 ¢ aN Ree Sanit of Lebanwan y a gig 3 & § a8 cae . 8813.1 above the Sea. 3 Sg 2S 5 As) 3 is aS Ey BS Say Salk P x SS SPs 3 : 3 Sess iS = Sy &) 2S 5 ny x a8 S22 g s SS 35 SLES § RS Se gy S RSIS § xX) eg $x 7607 S| S aS ae S iS y> g 5 x é is = & S BS A Basalt with Slate, Ish Laterite he Sea — —Frult 3 Alternate 10 feet thick Beds of brown | dugitic Ash, oftere alewredis Pagglome. | . - | -rate aul of axoio slate, ANY NN \\ ; g wie Dip Eafew Gees Dip E Bezrets S. - Panckhoska Cheenax Trees Loterile and dark compuct Slate W Mead to Neshert Bagh Panchtioeka ss the HURR| PURBUT, TUKT-I- SULIMAN and . (NW. portion of the ZEBANWAN Vol: XXXV. PILI. aring due Fast) € B Manus Bat from the Lake ( Journal As, Soc. Section Safapoor (10309), similarly composed. 4.The = Tang; wonderfully contorted hy dippmmg WNW. 9 small beds of Limestone conformable G. The bed of Limestone between the Safapoor and Aha stone,Ash.&. 5. One of the Spurs of the 8. Face of the beds of Limestone, ed. 5. The AhaTang, similarly compos having heen squeezed between the iwo hills. 7. The spur of Limestone of which'a detailed seclion is given, (seeSection |i} to the Ash,and Greenstone, dipping SSH. 10. Fault- 2. The Northern Extremity of the Saij-aha (11334). composed of Green: 1. The porphyritic Suramit of Kutwal (14271 ft). Spur of Safapoor which overhangs Manus Bal (lake) Greenstone, Basalt, Ash, &c. . i a CUPID vo IL) mosrng Yb E [AsO 52) AINE NY PTO BS Ly Mannrene yeouinen nag parmerg k (ox poling snaneg) iam parmeareg ji Cp mani MONT) IOI BERNARD sol = AVA! 2) rani) sunny) Kenyan pany, = 4 | Trarestrine Cy tavern pero HbeND Dip cvoees eh) ures pliant, Tip x eqs ooay jah) pinay ny SMaL)) MENPBIYL: L201, SUOTION ACROSS the WESTESN HIMALAYA, the GREAT FUNJAB MIOCENE PLATEAU ard the ATOHAS MOCSTATIS epi], by, eet) Punjab Miocene Plateu ef the Great (8 2 panic) so)s) YM] weary, sre Geqepey, (icalee YD YS Bunnoo //3ee/ enh wesEH4) Rughzah (700% (aperee) 0) TY HL (Teret®) Kandahar towards Plains ee a arurpiac (emien w Trace?) [ria antes (Granate Meta Telowtic Stier (Carberaferme Sabra Surazne Bammailitic Mivrcee (porter fe ¥ i Ske Plea) Siping towards the Swenpe of Qe Larrak Lake © the deserts of Eaten Posi New ¢ porteze Text Flzocene) Scaled Vol_XXXV. PI: MI. Sec. Journal As § |e S| os ete 4 8 3 S| an s 7 IN x Ss S) S Q) : § é 2 : s a Ca) iN OR —e 8 o s = S © § Mv 00 2099 p | | | 070 20g 8 | S = = x eo cor & S mS 8 N 5S = | u ‘Sian 200 0027} = ar 8 S | = Ss = az s i? 2 yy S § 3 eS Ss I Ss mt Rm 8 poops TS 1 Mr) S ee { 000 st R i cop0s e i | coe (qso00s1 ynoqo 29 02 pesoddng) wroy) wang -uany i 1 5 i Sy 8 Si a 8 She vo it 5 2 |i } (4400081 11) sessny jo py I21 (q000LE-82) URBYD UDLOYDLOY = > = Zr) = Valley ? Shayokh yyohoye evry) (,40003/ 490) ssn uassos ayy hh Pessalr abuny. (is0e0f®) Nubra (320012 - ) 2 SREP PY) Saw LL) SmpUy wane 1a00r® Ladak piikeoy apa JOURNAL OF THE ASTATIO SOCIETY Part II. —1866. ETHNOLOGY. —= Fo - CONTENTS. 7 SPECIAL NUMBER. _ ETHNOLOGY OF INDIA, BY MR. J USTICE CAMPBELL. Inrnopvcrory. = General remarks, a ‘Points recommended for observation, General divisions, Tur Aportarzs. General description, ... Main divisions, ‘ Southersi 6r Dravidian tribes, Northern or Kolarian tribes, _ Tribes of Western India, ... __« Tribes under the Himalayas, iy . The ‘ Bhooyas’ of the Bengal borders ~ _. Question regarding the Brahuis, rr) ? Tae Mopzrn Inprans. ; The Bramins or Khashas, _.., The Jats, Yous The Rajpoots, : The Koonbees or ie Some Punjab tribes, . tak | Mahommedan les, Pastoral tribes, Goojars, Aheers, de, aes eoe @oe Page . 1 8 13 20 25 34 30 40 46 51 54 56 17 85 92 95 ° 98 101 oft buy SOC Ofis TW) JAITTING & oa iO apn tot me 2 J) fe ime id e Acusile ih a 940 ~ foo ; “a ‘ ; - 5 * 4 ? 2 i * —_ ‘ 2 5% Lae , a t - a ‘ . = a=" . she r wm, thy. - v i y + - an! ¢ ] ) <<, Dm 5 ¥ te ay } m bad, e ' 4 : i . Ea . JOURNAL. OF THE SOTATIC SOCIETY. ONO ie Orne saws SUPLEMENTARY NUMBER. | Vou. XXXV. Parr IL. —e ees . The Ethnology of India —By Mr. Jusricn Campseun. : [Received 4th June, 1866. ] J trust that the great subject of Indian Ethnology has been taken up by the Society in a serious and earnest manner, with a view to that actual observation and practical inquiry which is only possible in the countries and on the spots where the various races are found, or _ where specimens of them may be collected together. The Govern- - ment has already consented to take the first step in aid of the move- os ment by collecting from its officers, in all parts of India, lists of the _ races and classes existing in the various districts. The present paper Zi. designed to assist both Government officers and private persons in % making classified and descriptive lists in such a uniform manner, and q with such a uniform nomenclature and arrangement, that it may be ~ afterwards possible to weld together the whole of the information thus obtained. Without some common plan and nomenclature, without, as it were, some Ethnological skeleton to serve as the guide and model into which the various details may be fitted, and by which they may ‘be classed, I fear that there may be much confusion and error in bringing together lists which must necessarily often be made by offi- cials who have little knowledge of Ethnology as a science, and whose practical knowledge and nomenclature are limited to their own par- ticular parts of India. My object then is, to supply a sort of rough 24 The Ethnology of India. hand book of existing information on the subject, particularly as re- gards the North of India, and my hope is, that such a guide may render much more easy, intelligible, and uniform, the collection of a mass of details, which will render our knowledge ample and complete. It happens that my personal experience has been wider than that of _ most officers; I have also travelled much in those parts of India in which I have not served, and have made the people a constant subject of observation and inquiry. I have farther, for some time past, noted the information on this subject which I could collect from books. And lastly, I have received much aid in my inquiries from many kind friends. During a late visit to the Punjaub frontier, 1 was under great obligations to many of the officers employed there, and feel that -Ican always look for assistance in that quarter. Recent papers by Colonel Dalton, Commissioner of the Chota-Nagpore territories, have given much information respecting several of the tribes of that locality of which T have made free use, and I had looked also to use another paper on the Coles promised by Colonel Dalton. It has not been received, but I hope that it will soon add to the information which T am now able to give. During a tour in the Bombay Presidency, I was fortunate enough to make the acquaintance and to obtain the assistance of Mr. Perceval of the Civil Service there, since Private Secretary to His Excellency Sir B. Frere, and through Mr. Perceval [ have received a series of very interesting notes on the aborigines of that part of India by Captain Probyn, Major Keatinge, Mr. Ash- — burner, Mr. Probert, and the Rev. Messrs. Moore and Taylor, con- taining information not elsewhere procurable. During a former tour — in the Mysore country and in some of the Madras districts adjoining, I received much kind assistance, and Mr. Bowring has since been good — enough to point out to me some very interesting additional informa- tion. With respect, however, to the Telinga country, and the extreme South of India, I have not been fortunate enough to obtain all the information that I could desire. ; It will be understood, moreover, that as respects every part of India, I by no means profess to give a complete sketch. I have not the necessary information, and have not time for the necessary study to enable me to attempt that. Indeed, in this as in so many other things, the more one learns, the more one sees one’s ignorance and the vast The Ethnology of India. 8 amount of inquiry that still remains. I only desire to teil so much as _ I know, and to suggest points on which inquiry is desirable. Although I have always been much interested in the people, I have usually not had time and opportunity to commit all that I have observed to _ writing; it is in fact only of late years that I have in some degree done so. Iam obliged therefore frequently to use such expressions as ‘I think,’ not because I do not speak from personal observation, but because, writing from memory, I must give my impressions subject tothe chance of error. In attempting too so wide and general a subject without great opportunities of study, I am at every turn liable _toerror. I would at once avow that I warrant nothing, even when I do not specially qualify my phrases. I only give my impressions for what they are worth. It is true that it would have been possi- ble to verify many doubtful points, to fill up many gaps, and to solve _ some difficulties which occur to me in writing this paper, by farther _ enquiries in the proper quarters; but looking to the character of my paper, as an avowedly imperfect sketch, designed to elicit the infor- mation which may afterwards render possible something more com- plete, I have preferred not to delay, but to give what I now can, as I now can. In truth, my object is to suggest our deficiencies, to point to them, and to prospect the quarters where valuable strata of in- formation may be found. I shall say what I have to say in the most ‘simple and least technical form—in a rough and unpolished way. : My philological acquirements are very deficient. As respects South- parison easy. But there is no such synthetical account of the Northern ' languages. The character of each can only be separately learned. | G izeratee, &c. when compared to Hindee and Punjabee, I find no 5 easy guide, and have not been able to acquire any adequate knowledge. } —Cashmiree is still scarcely known at all. We very much want such an account of the languages of the North as Dr. Caldwell has given : ns for the South. — Inthe mere matter of nomenclature, it is surprising how much confusion arises, both from calling the same tribes by different names, and also from calling different tribes by the same name. The former 4 The Ethnology of India. error can only be met by explaining in detail the tribes variously known in various localities ; but in respect to the latter, some general caution seems necessary. It often happens that the same term is applied both to a Tribe or Caste, and to the profession usually exer- cised by that caste, and that while in one sense the term is proper to the caste, whether exercising the same or any other profession, in another sense it is applied to all exercising the profession, whether of the same or of any other caste. For instance, in the greater part of the Punjaub, the great agricultural tribe is the Jat, and there the words ‘ Jat’ and ‘ Zemeendar’ have come to be used by the people as almost synonymous. A man who is asked of what caste he is, will reply ‘a Gemeendar,’ meaning a Jat. And, vice versd, a Punjabee will sometimes call a man a Jat, meaning only that he is a Zemeendar. When I pressed some of the servants of the Maharajah of Cashmere regarding the Ethnology of the valley of the Upper Indus and other little known parts, I was at first much puzzled by finding them de- — clare that the great mass of the people there are ‘ Jats,’ but I pre- sently discovered that they meant merely Zemeendars or cultivators, there being in fact no Jats within the Hills. In the West and South too, I believe that the terms ‘ Koonbee’ and ‘ Wocal’ are used both to designate certain agricultural tribes, and cultivators generally ; so that while “‘ the Wocals are by the Mahommedans called Koonbees,” — that circumstance gives no assurance that the tribes are the same. The term Bunneah or Banian is properly applied to the great trading — caste, but it also means a trader, and is often so applied. Again in — India relzgious denominations are often applied in a way which con- — founds them with proper tribal denominations. The character of the — Hindoo religion is such that it is a pretty safe Ethnological guide, — converts not being ordinarily received. Mahommedan and other pro- selytising religions, on the other hand, are no guide in Ethnology ; on $ the contrary, the Mahommedan Laws of Marriage and Legitimacy are such as to tend very much to efface Ethnological demarcations. For our purposes therefore, Mahommedan denominations may be entirely” put aside. But the mere fact, that people are Mahommedans, should not deter us from seeking their Tribal denominations in the back ground, Many Mahommedan tribes still retain their Hindoo caste names, some Hindoo laws, and something of caste exclusiveness. The Ethnology of India. 5 Though not so pure or characteristic as their Hindoo brethren, many Mussulman Rajpvots and Jats are just as well known as such as the Hindoos; while many whole tribes have become Mahommedans with- out changing their tribal designations and occupations. Most of the modern Sikhs in no way separate from their tribes, and are known as ‘ Jat,’ or ‘ Khatrie,’ or ‘Braman Sikhs,’ one member of a family being frequently a ‘ Sing,’ while others are not. Jains, I believe, are not ethnologically distinguished from Hindoos. Among the Bun- neahs, it appears that some are Hindoos and some Jains, in the same tribes and sections of tribes. Very puzzling in the South is the term * Lingaiyat’ applied to those Ultra-Sivites who wear the Lingam, who seem almost to form a caste, and who are generally spoken of as such. _ So far, however, as I can gather, the term is really a mere religious denomination, and the Lingaiyats are of various castes, which should be distinguished. Inall inquiries then, great care is necessary in sifting out tribal, as distinguished from mere professional and religious denominations. When we arrive at proper tribal titles, it is farther desirable to in- quire into the aliases or varieties of title often possessed by the tribes; for it may happen that while an obscure local title is in the most - common use, another, less frequently used, will at once indicate iden- tity with some well known and widely spread caste. It is also very necessary to attend to the distinctions between great caste titles, and the sub-divisions of those castes. All the great -eastes have numerous gotes or sub-divisions ; and when a man is asked to what caste he belongs, he will sometimes give the name of the general, and sometimes of the special caste or gote. Some of these -sub-divisions really are or may be ethnological sub-divisions, others, _ from the peculiarity of Hindoo laws, are not so. On the principle z which forbids the marriage of relations (carried by Hindoos to an re extreme) men of the Rajpoot and other castes cannot marry in their own ‘ gotes,’ but must seek their wives in other gotes. In blood therefore such castes really form but one race—so far at least as the ~ intermarriages are carried—for there are many tribes claiming to be _ Rajpoots whom the higher tribes will not recognize. Of other castes, the primary sub-divisions keep altogether apart. I apprehend that under the general term ‘Bunneah,’ are to be found many separate By The Ethnology of India. tribes who would on no account eat together or intermarry. I think, however, that throughout all the great Hindoo castes, a strong ethno- logical resemblance exists. I do not propose in this sketch to at- tempt to notice the sub-divisions, except in any case in which they may suggest marked ethnological features. The details of Rajpoot and Bramin heraldry and hierology have been amply given in several excellent works, and I shall touch on nothing of that kind. A caution which seems to me to be necessary is, that the accounts of their origin given by many tribes, and especially by their Chiefs, must be received in a very guarded way, because there is a great tendency to invent origins illustrious in the eyes of men of the races and reli- gions to which they belong. Among the Hindoos, the Rajpoot rule is so famous, that almost all tribes which have taken to soldiering or ~ acquired power, pretend to a Rajpoot origin. At this day, some of the followers of Maratta Chiefs have the impudence to tell strangers that they are really Rajpoots, as if their origin was not matter of the most recent history ; and almost all the aboriginal tribes who have risen to any power (or at least the chief families among them) affect a Raj- poot descent. As Colonel Dalton describes it, they are undergoing a gradual process of ‘ refining into Rajpoots,’ a process probably founded on a very small Rajpoot immigration and alliance, and a very large amount of invention. Even the Jats and other tribes who need — hardly descend to such stories, frequently make themselves out to be Rajpoots who have been separated from the orthodox for some loose- ness of practice ; but my impression is, that most of these stories are © quite idle. Even acknowledged Rajpoots of the North-Western hills : who are, in an Ethnological point of view, a much finer and purer race _ than any in the plains, assert that their ancestors came from Ajoodea — or Oude. So in Cashmere, the Bramins there, whose mere features at £ once proclaim them to be one of the highest and purest races in aa world, instead of adopting the more ancient and better traditions — which would point to their country as the common origin of the "7 Bramin races of India, prefer the story that when Kashyapa dried up_ the Lake (a geological fact patent even to Hindoos) detachments of all the most famous and most sacred of the different Bramin classes were brought into Cashmere, who, amalgamating, formed the present * The Ethnology of India. T Cashmeeree Bramins. The real cause of all these stories, I take to be this. The Hindoos, as Hindoos and from an orthodox Hindoo point of view, did not attain their highest religious, literary, and political development, till they were settled in the plains of India ; consequently the early Bramins of the valleys of the Himalayas are not considered nearly so orthodox, so sacred, or in the Hindoo scale so high, as the more famous Bramins of the plains. And the Rajpoots of the Pun- jab and the adjoining hills, are not so high in the scale of strict Rajpoot orthodoxy as the Solar and Lunar races of Ajoodea. Hence it is that the races, really earlier and purer, think it necessary to claim descent from those who, in our point of view, are really very inferior. Again, most tribes which have been for many centuries converted to Mahommedanism, set up some origin founded on the traditions and literature of the dominant Mahommedan races. They are generally descended from Soleiman or Nooshervan, or something of that kind. Jewish names and traditions are particularly in vogue among the Mahommedans (Abraham, Jacob, Joseph, and many others known to “us, are their most common names, in the form of Ibraheem, Yacoob, Yoosoof, &c. &c.) and it has been pointed out, that the Affghan asser- tion of Jewish descent loses most of its significance, when we find how many other tribes have stories of the same kind. I have not been ‘able to ascertain whether the ‘‘ Soleiman’s Throne” met with in so : many places is to be specially referred to the Jewish Solomon, or whether the term is merely the ‘‘ Suleh-man”’ or wise man of the Hast. At any rate I believe that most of the pretended Mahommedan f enealogies are in brief ‘ bosh.’ , - Ido not mean that popular traditions are to be neglected, on the » contrary, I think that they often lead us far towards the truth ; but I say ‘a \ ) that we must use caution and discrimination, to sift the wheat from _ the merest chaff. - Ishould add that I believe that the claim of aboriginal and other tribes to Rajpoot and such like origin, is not always without some oundation in fact. The Rajpoots seem, like the Normans, to have frequently found their way in small numbers among inferior races, and _ there amalgamating and intermarrying with them, to have acquired | by force of character a leadership over them, and to have considerably 8 The Ethnology of India. raised the position of such tribes. There is, I think, a good deal — to suggest that during the various invasions of Southern India by a succession of Northern ‘ Yavanas,’ small tribes of these latter may have taken up their position in difficult parts of the country, and there, amalgamating with the aboriginal tribes, have formed half-breed races of much robber-like and semi-military energy. Before going farther, I would suggest the following as especially deserving the attention of those who are willing to aid in a popular way in classing the various tribes and castes in India. 1. Physical appearance. The three main types, Caucasian, Mon- golian, and Negro or Negrito, are well-known. In India we have, in the extreme North, the finest and purest Caucasian type, the handsomer and more open form of that which we know as the Jewish cast of countenance ; fine head and features, high brow and nose, long beard, _ tall, lithe, powerful figure, colour generally light. Throughout India, we have this type modified and subdued by every variety of straight and snub nose and plebeian features, much as in Hurope, and with a dark skin unknown in Europe. Sometimes the skin becomes very black, and the lips are thick and protuberant; there may be marked the infusion of blood of the Negrito type which probably modifies the — higher phase of the Caucasian type, even when actual Negrito features — cannot be traced. This Negrito type we find in India not accompanied with the — muscular form of many Africans, but in a small slight race. The © principal points to be marked, in addition to colour, are the lips, already — alluded to, shape of face, nose, and eyes, presence or absence of a — considerable beard, character of the hair. ; Among the Thibetans and Nipalese we have extreme examples of _ the type which I call generically Mongolian. The eyes particularly — there is no mistaking. The hair is straight. The colour is yellowish, — but never dark. ha 2. Language is liable to disturbances, and has been perhaps too much taken as a sure guide, but it is always of great assistance, and in 19 cases out of 20 tells a true tale. In practice I think that no_ considerable philological acquirements are necessary to enable an ob-— server to make most useful observations of a language quite unknown to him, if he can only get the rudest interpreter. There are certain ) us my 4 ¥ 1D -. The Ethnology of India. § words which may almost be taken as unfailing tests in classifying lan- _ guage ; for instance, the first few numerals, the names for the com- monest parts of the human body—as hand, foot, nose, eyes, mouth, head, &c.—the names of the commonest family relations—father, mother, brother, sister—sun and moon, fire and water—the personal pronouns, and one or two others. I shall try to add to this paper some of Mr. Hodgson’s lists. I do not know that they are all the best selected words, but they are uniform lists of different languages in parallel columns, and will enable any observer to determine on the spot whether the savage he has caught, primd facie, seems to belong to one or other of the classes represented in the columns. I shall also make a smaller list of English words, a translation of which I would recommend to be sent with each account of a tribe or race, speaking a language in any degree peculiar. It should be observed that it may not unfrequently happen that - men who seem to speak but a rough jargon of some well known lan- guage may, on close observation, be found to use peculiar terms for some of the most familiar objects, and that these latter may be inva- -luable as containing the remnants of their original language, all but ab- sorbed in another which they have for the most part adopted. Especially will such words be valuable, if they can be in any degree identified with those in any of the Aboriginal Vocabularies. Grammatical structure is somewhat more difficult of observation, and 80 far as I know, the general structural character of all the modern eervetion, which would be eminently useful. And on the Hastern Frontier, the distinction between Indian and Indo-Chinese grammatical - forms might probably be readily marked. y | 8. Religion. There isso much similarity in the religions of so any rude tribes, that there may be doubt whether such worship as that of the Sun, Moon, and the lord of Tigers represents a wide spread religion, or merely a coincidence of very obvious ideas repeated again ‘and again; but it is worth noticing these ideas, in the hope that some 10 The Ethnology of India. substantial inductions may. be formed from putting together many observations. | And among the mofe civilised races, I think it not improbable that an accurate observation of the prevalence of Sivite and Vishnuite ideas respectively, among particular tribes and castes, may be found to have an ethnological significance. I cannot help thinking that these two forms of modern Hinduism may in fact represent entirely different religions derived from widely different sources, and that while the Vishnuite faith came from the north, the Sivite may have had some other origin, and may be the special property of races which of old peculiarly affected it. Sivite monuments certainly seem to be marks of a very old faith in the greater part of India, and the essential element of it, the reverence for and deification of the procreative power, seems to be the same idea of natural progression which is carried on by the Buddhist doctrine of gradual perfectibility (raismg man almost to the rank of a god) in opposition to the Vishnuite or Vedic creed of a separate creation of gods and their occasional incarnation in the form of man. If then pure Sivites, Buddhists, and Jains are in some way connected, and they all prevail most in the West, who are those who brought their doctrines there ? and whence did they come ? 4. Laws. I believe that, laws are among the most persistent — ethnological marks, and that, as such, they have been too much ne- — glected. Caste, and Marriage as a sacrament strictly limited by © caste, seem to be Arian institutions. Arian are strict rules of inhe- : ritance, resulting from that sacred form of marriage and subject to none | of the caprices of Mahommedan and similar laws. Arian is the pri- = vate property in land, as distinguished from the Tribal; the property : first of the village—then of the family—then of the individual ; a. a consequence is, the attachment of the Arian to his native soil. Espe-_ cially Arian is the form of what we call constitutional, as opposed to patriarchal and arbitrary government. The Indian village or Com- — mune is a constitutional unit, common to all the Arians. A main 4 distinction, as I think, between two great classes of Arians is to be traced in the constitution of these Communes—Aristocratic among the one—among the other democratic, and recognizing as equals a all free citizens, tothe exclusion of Helots only. The Ethnology of India. _ Il seems to be patriarchal and arbitrary—property in the soil is tribal rather than individual. There is little local attachment to the soil. he aboriginal tribes of India move from place to place, abandoning _ one location and taking up another in a light way; they are even ready to give up their land, to become labourers, and to emigrate in a way to which the Arians are by no means prone. They seem to _ have among themselves no caste, they eat anything and every thing. _ Marriage is, I fancy, but a loose tie. On all these points, however, we want much information. 5. Manners and mental characteristics. Under this I must in- elude so much that I cannot attempt to detail it. Suffice it to say, that any information regarding the temperament and_ bearing, the intelligence, the customs and habits, the amusements and the cere- - monies of little known tribes, may be in many ways most useful. _~ It is patent in India to the most superficial observer that, owing to _ the peculiar institution of castes, mere vicinage (even lasting many hundred years) has not, as in Europe, led to the welding of different races and tribes into proper local nationalities : that, in fact, in the same locality many different races exist together without complete intermixture, while a single race may frequently be traced through “many different provinces and countries, always retaining its own pecu- liarities under a great variety of circumstances and in coktact with “many varying races. On the other hand, language can never be exclusive, it must be the means of inter-communication between man and man, caste and caste, without distinctions of race or creed. Hence, however much by religion and race a tribe may be segregated, il it be politically and to a great extent socially united with other : eoples, it almost always in the end adopts their language, or a com- ‘mon language is formed by intermixture. That is the ordinary state of Indian society. In the business of life, the different castes are united in one society ; some are in the upper, some in the lower strata ; me is the lord, another the priest, another the free cultivator, ano- _ ther the hewer of wood and drawer of water; but still they form one ‘social whole. Farther, although the rules of caste and marriage may hi nder the inter-communication of blood, it cannot but be that in the long course of time, during which ‘different tribes live in the closest intercourse, there must be some irregular percolation from one 12 The Ethnology of India. to the other; in the course of thousands of years, something of the blood and features of one will be infiltrated into the other. Thus it has happened that in India there is a sort of double classi- fication of the people, similar to that which we sometimes see in rocks in which there is a double stratification, one line of strata running say horizontally, and another line crossing the same rock say vertically. When we trace a tribe or caste from one Province to another, we shall find that in some things it retains the class charac- ter, in others it varies according to provincial character, the latter chiefly prevailing in point of language. I propose to trace, so far as I can, the different tribes and classes throughout India, irrespective of local nationalities, and to some extent irrespective of language. I had thought that I might afterwards, when that is completed, remark on the quasi-nationalities created by the use of special languages and the social specialities of particular pro- vinces ; but I find that our information is as yet so imperfect, that L prefer to leave this latter task to another day. I shall merely make some casual remarks on language and a few other national features, as they occur in the course of my narrative. Till we have accomplished an Ethnological Geography, whether — Tribal or National, I shall for the most part use the ordinary terms of our Modern Political Geography, and speak of the Punjab and Scinde, Bengal and Mysore. But for facility of reference, I must make one — or two explanations. I shall speak of Hindustan and the Hindu- — stanees as the terms are applied by the natives, to the whole of the great Central region of Northern India from the Punjab on one side to Bengal on the other, and from the Himalayas to the Southern de- — clivities of the Satpoora Range running across India im about the - parallel of 22° Lat. I include in Hindustan, Bahar, (confining the term of Bengal to Bengal Proper) as well as Oude, Rajpootana, and Malwa. South of Hindustan to the West is the Maratta country, which c may be roughly indicated as bounded by a line drawn from Nagpore to Goa. And farther South are the Southern countries, sometimes called Dravidian, first the Telinga or Telugu country to the East, the Canarese to the West; beyond them again the Tamil country to the Kast, the Malabar or ence country to the West. As respects the physical features of these countries, it will be remem= The Ethnology of India. 13 bered that the whole of Bengal proper, the N. W. Provinces and Oude, the Punjab and Scinde, with part of the adjoining desert coun- try, form a great semi-circular plain in which there is no place of refuge (with little exception) for remains of aboriginal races; in all these countries the modern races live together as one social whole. But throughout Central and Peninsular India, while the most open plains and best cultivated parts of the country are similarly inhabited, there are scattered about, over every province, hills and jungles giving cover to aboriginal tribes which hold themselves aloof from the general population, and are very different in language, manners and other particulars. It is well known that the great plain is bounded on the north by the line of the Himalayas, rising almost suddenly im great and rugged height, but yet habitable for a considerable distance inland before the snows are reached. That boundary is so uniform that more need not be said respecting it, except as regards the northern extremity of “India. There the plain is not at once succeeded by the Himalaya. ~The range called the Salt Range runs across from Jhelum to Kala- Bagh on the Indus, and thence to the Affghan mountains, cutting off as it were and enclosing a sort of triangle, and supporting a somewhat elevated country something of the character of the Peninsular portion _ of India, and lying between this Salt Range and the Himalaya. The Salt Range, it will be presently seen, is an Ethnological boundary of some interest. TI now commence my survey according to Tribes and Castes. - First, I take as a great division the black aboriginal tribes of the interior hills and jungles. There can, I suppose, be no doubt that _ they are the remnants of the race which occupied India before the | I need not here go into any question, whether any portion of them had received any civilization from any other source. It is ~ enough that all these tribes have many ethnological features in com- | mon. They are evidently the remains of an element, the greater | portion of which has been absorbed by, and amalgamated with, the “modern Indian race, and which, mixed in various degrees with the | high-featured immigrants, has contributed to form the Hindoo of to-day. In the South their speech still forms the basis of the modern languages. If proof were wanting that the predominance of Caucasian 14 The Ethnology of India. features has been attained, in a great part of India, but gradually, and that it is within the historical period that these features have alto- gether preponderated, it is only necessary to look at the ancient sculptures of the South and West. Take for instance the caves of BKlephanta near Bombay. Who, looking at the faces there cut in stone, and observing the universal thick lip and peculiar feature, can doubt that when those were cut, the non-Caucasian element was still large even among the higher classes ? My scheme, however, is not to separate any of the tribes or castes of modern Indian society, and to designate them as aboriginal. AlL those people who have been either completely or partially amalga- mated into Hindoo society, whether as proper Hindoos or as Helots and outcasts, I regard as coming within the designations of ‘ Modern Indians.’ I shall class as Aborigines only those tribes which still live _ apart, forming communities by themselves, under their own leaders, — and often speaking their own peculiar languages. : As Modern Indians again I class together all the high-featured $ northern races, and all the various trikes, castes, and nationalities i formed by them after absorbing so much of the aboriginal element as has been amalgamated with them, whether they are now Hindoos, Mahommedans, or of any other religion. Of course they are mainly Hindoos. I draw no wide ethnological line between the Northern ¥ and Southern countries of India, not recognising the separate Dravidian — 4 classification of the latter as properly ethnological. It seems to me ‘ that among all the Hindoo tribes the Arian element now prevails, and _ that the presence, more or less, of the aboriginal element is only a question of degree. As a question of degree, I do not think that there is, at any geographical parallel, any decided line. It is remarked by Max Muller that languages are seldom properly speaking mixed. Vocables may be mixed, but a single grammar and structure usually _ prevails. Therefore the change from one language to another must — in so far be sudden. It is still, I believe, open to dispute whether — the grammar of the present languages of Northern India is of Sanscrit or of Aboriginal origin ; but at any rate this we know, that in the North the Arians gained so rapid and complete an ascendancy as to introduce their own radical words, numerals, &., and to render the language ~ essentially Avian, while in the South the Aborigines held out— The Ethnology of India. 15 longer, the tide of Arian immigration was more gradual, and the Aboriginal grammar and radicals formed the mould which was only filled up by a large over-lay of Arian words. The change then of language takes place, where passing southwards we exchange the Maratta for Telugu and Canarese. But looking at the people, we see no radical change of feature or characteristics. The last of those who are more properly Arian in language, are not essen- tially superior to the first of those whose language is by its structure classed as Dravidian. The Marattas who are classed as Northerners (though they probably take their name and much of their blood from the aboriginal Mhars and such like tribes, whose features survive in their monuments) have no decided advantage over their Canarese neighbours; on the contrary, the Canarese of Belgaum and Dharwar are deemed superior to the Marattas of the adjoining districts, And _ to a traveller in Mysore and most of the Southern countries, the general features and appearance of the people is, I think, not very greatly less Arian than that of the lower classes of Hindustanees. The truth I take to be, not only that in a mixture of races there is a _ tendency of the higher, more marked, and more prominent type to _ predominate, but also that it may well be that, although the people “speaking a Dravidian language in the South, may always by force of j numbers have linguistically prevailed over each separate batch of immigrants, and so far annexed them, still by successive immigra- ‘tons, notwithstanding a Dravidian form of speech, the Arian blood has come in reality greatly to prevail. The mere fact that they are recognised as Orthodox Hindoos, seems to imply the Northern ‘origin of all the better castes in the South, and that is their own account of their origin. I have no doubt that the Southern Hindoos n ay be generally classed as Arians, and that the Southern society is ir its structure, its manners, and its laws and institutions an Arian 80 ciety. After all, in their main characteristics, the Southern people are very like those of the North. 4 _ Among some of the inferior tribes of the South, the remains of the thick lips, the very black skin, and other features may, as I have said, still be traced, but, colour perhaps excepted, the aboriginal features are probably gradually wearing away. Notwithstanding the identity in the main of the North and the 16 The Ethnology of India. South, it will be seen when I come to details, that the change of language very much puzzles and baffles me in the attempt to trace the tribes and castes from North to South, and in fact causes a substantial gap in the contiguity of my survey, which I trust that others will fill. To return to a geological metaphor, there is as it were a serious fault at the point where the change of languages takes place. A similar series of strata goes on upon the other side, but I can’t exactly identify the particular veins and say which is which. The same series of classes with similar cha- racteristics prevail in the South, and, knowing that they must have come from the North in a continuous stream, one feels sure that they must be identical with Northern congeners. It remains for those who have an intimate knowledge of the country on either side of the Fault to connect the broken links. Meantime, with the exception of the Bramins (who may be traced all through India), I must notice the people of the Southern countries separately. : Commonly as the term is used, it may be well to say a word ~ in justification of the use of the term ‘ Arians’ as applied to all : the Northern people. Not only are they known by the South- — erners as Aryas, (see Buchanan,) but in fact I believe the term to i be the correct one. Iam aware that some have set down the Jats and others as Scythians and Turanians. I have no intention of quar-_ relling with any one who chooses to call them Scythians, for that is a very wide and uncertain word, which may have been applied to | Germans as well as to Jats. But if the word Turanian is applied to — Punjabees, in the sense of expressing that branch of the human race ; the term is wholly inapplicable. Anything more unlike Mongols — than the tall, handsome, high featured, long bearded Punjabees if is impossible to imagine. To say, on the strength of some obscure similarity of names, that any of these people are Mongols and Tartars, is not only as unfounded as the connection between Mon- Negro, than a Punjabee is unlike a Mongol. The Ethnology of India, Bert Assuming then that the North-Indians are what we call Caucasian in feature, the only question would be whether they may be in any degree Semitic. This there seems to be no ground for supposing; there is no radical trace of Semitic language, and we nowhere trace any considerable immigration by land of Arabian or other Semitic tribes. That being so, I hope that I may properly call the North-Indians Arians, and extend the title to all those Indians in whom Arian features predominate, even where they have been softened down and otherwise qualified by intermixture. 7 Although I believe any division of the Northern tribes in India into Arian and Turanian to-be quite out of place, I have long had an impression that the result of a thorough examination may be to divide the Indian Arians into two classes; the earlier Arians, the de- scendants of the most ancient Hindus, a people acute, literary, skilled in arts, but not very warlike, and rather aristocratic than demo- cratic in their institutions ; and the later Arians, warlike people—pos- sibly once Scythians—democratic in their institutions, and rather _ energetic than refined and literary. War does not seem to have been one of the earliest arts; we are told that the earliest Egyptians have left little in their monuments which suggests that art, and it may be that the earliest Hindus had little occasion for it, meeting with but simple _ and peaceful savages. The later Arians appear, in my view, in their - manners and institutions more nearly to resemble the German tribes, and _ perhaps to them might more properly be applied the term Indo-Germanie. 4 The earliest Hindus appear to have had an intimate connection with = hills immediately adjoining India on the North-west, and there may 7 well have been gradual immigration from the hills to the plains. But ata later period, when the people in possession of the North of India had acquired considerable power, it seems hardly possible that large bodies of conquering immigrants should have found their way to India by Cabul and the Khyber Pass. Those defiles are far too difficult to be forced by strangers in large bodies accompanied by women and children. The Affghans, and those who have ruled the Affghans, have had the command of the direct route ; but if Rajpoots, Jats &c, came as immigrant peoples, they probably came by the route of the Bolan, occupying the high pastoral lands about Quettah, and thence descend- ‘ing into the plains below. We shall find accordingly that the Jats 18 The Ethnology of India. (whom on this theory we may suppose to have been the latest comers) occupy just the area which would tally with such a mode of immigra- tion. In physical appearance I would divide Indian Arians into two classes, as far as we can call that a division which is only a question of degree. The people of the extreme north, the pure Arians, large, fair, high-featured, I shall call “‘ High-Arian” in type. The prominence and beauty of their features is remarkable. The brow is remarkably high and well shaped; the nose connected by a high bridge with the high brow is also well shaped, sometimes straight, more often slightly curved ; the eyes are very fine, the lips thin, mouth of a good shape, the beard long and full. The type once seen cannot be mistaken. The prominence of the brow in adults somewhat conceals the eye, but in the children it is something marvellous. On the other hand, the more subdued features, more frequently approaching a low and snub- nosed type, and resembling those which are common among the lower _ classes in Europe, are in India generally accompanied by a shorter (but still pretty robust) form, a skin darker (but still more brown than _ black), and an appearance altogether inferior, but yet not aboriginal in its style. This I shall call the ‘‘ Low-Arian” type. In addition to the two main divisions, of aborigines, and modern 7 es oa. se Indians, I propose to put under a third division, those whom I shall — generally describe as ‘‘ Borderers,” that is, the tribes on the borders, 3 whose blood and manners show the influence of immigrants of races — other than those already noticed. These meet and mix with the — native populations, and form some marked classes. On the West Coast — there has been a considerable immigration of Arabs and others; the same 4 has been the case in Lower Sinde. Along the whole line of the Himalayas, and on the whole of the Eastern Frontier, Turanian races meet the Indians. Thus then I have three main classes :— ul os Re PRE 1. Aborigines, os 2. Modern Indians, and 3. Borderers. The 2nd are of course by far the largest and most important class. Besides making the distinction among modern Indians of high anc low Arians, there are one or two other points which I wo notice, before going into details, a - Pe) ‘os Pi val — a we " a The Ethnology of India. 19 I should like to class Hindus as High and Low Hindus. There is a full-blown style of Hindus (principally Hindustanees) who have adopted to the full all the modern Hindu superstitions and obser- vances, who are very particular about their cooking and such matters, _ and in consequence generally eat but one large meal once a day, whose widows may not re-marry, and who are in a continual state of anxiety _ about the rules of their caste. These are high Hindus. There is another class of Hindus, much less particular, whose religion and religious observances sit very easy upon them, whose widows re-marry, and whose prejudices do not prevent their taking good wholesome meals as often as they can. Such are the Punjabees, some of the Hindustanees, and I believe a good many of the Southerners. These I would call low Hindus. With respect to caste, whatever there may once have been, there is now no proper Military caste. The fighting and dominant tribes are, it may be said invariably, in the main Agricultural and are classed as such. Why the old Vaisyas are sometimes said to have been the Merchant class I do not understand. It is clear that they were the body of free people, whose duty it was to till the land, keep flocks, _ carry on trade, and many other things besides. The Soodras were the Helots, ‘‘ whose duty is expressed in one word, viz., to serve the } other three classes,” evidently the conquered race. Now-a-days it seems to be considered that, except the Brahmins, almost all are _ Soodras, that is, all have more or less intermixed with the lower races ~ and lost their purity of blood. Hindu Society then has lost its former _ great divisions, and has been split up into an infinite variety of decent “castes of mixed parentage, who have absorbed the old Soodras, as well as the Vaisyas. Under them again new tribes of Helots are : found, probably tribes more recently conquered. - The Agricultural tribes may, for the most part, be divided into _ three classes :— & 1. Those whose proclivities were originally Pastoral, and gene- | rally somewhat predatory. | 2. Agricultural tribes in the proper sense, that is, Farmers—men | who both cultivate the soil on a large scale, and keep cattle and -Waggons when the country is favorable to that kind of Farming. | These tribes are also most frequently those who have the greatest 20) The Ethnology of India, Military vigor, and most democratic constitution, and generally occupy the dominant position in the country. 3. The gardening tribes, 7. ¢., those who do the smaller and finer farming and kitchen gardening. These are generally peaceable and unmartial people. IT shall not always exactly follow this order, but shall take first the tribes who are politically most important. The Mercantile tribes I shall notice separately, and then the Writer tribes, where such tribes exist. When I speak of literate occupation, I mean exclusive of mercantile business, that being almost every- where in the hands of mercantile castes. Next come the Artizans, and finally the Helots and inferior classes. Tur ABORIGINES. In giving any general description of the Aborigines, I must premise that it is by no means to be supposed that all or most of the indivi- duals of the race will correspond to the description. The fact is that the Aboriginal tribes now remaining are but like scattered remnants ; z they have been all but melted, and in which they are on the point of — of a substance floating here and there in a mass of water, into which disappearing. By far the greater part of their substance has already — it, and it is only in the very kernel and inner centre of the largest — lumps, that something like the pure original substance is to be found. | There is not in Peninsular India any very large tract of very high _ and difficult country ; the Aboriginal tribes are for the most part not collected in any great masses supporting one another, but are found in small and detached tribes here and there, wherever a bunch of hills or an unhealthy jungle has given them a refuge. Even in these q retreats, they are everywhere closely surrounded by, and to a consider- The Ethnology of India. 21 probably to a good deal of robbery, have come down on the enervated people of the plains and valleys, and have established a temporary _ dominion over considerable tracts of country. Just as on the depart- ure of the Romans and before the establishment of Teutonic rule, the Picts and Scots came down on the cultivated portions of Britain, so it seems certain that, at periods long subsequent to the glories of the Solar and Lunar Rajpoots, Aboriginal Bhurs and Cheroos estab- lished considerable principalities in parts of Oude and of the Benares and Behar Provinces. So also Bheels, Mairs, and Kolees seem to have had at one time considerable power in Rajpootana and Goojerat. In comparatively modern times, the Bedas or Beders (whose name is I believe really identical with that of the Vedahs or Vedders) seem to have established considerable power in the South, and the Gonds in Central India acquired quite a wide dominion. Under such circum- stances, the savage conquerors are generally themselves socially conquer- _ ed, and the tribes so situated, while gaining some civilisation, Jose much of their peculiarities of blood and feature, and more of their language. By far the largest tract in which the Aboriginal tribes prevail, and may be said to form the mass of the inhabitants, is that extending through the hilly country from the western and southern borders of Bengal, Behar and Benares to the frontiers of the Hydera- bad and Madras territories, and from the Eastern Ghats inland to the ¢ivilised portions of the Nagpore territory; but even in this tract it _ appears that there are evident monuments of old Hindoo civilisation, showing that Hindoos, or at any rate Sivites, had at one time a far greater hold on much of this country than they now have, and that - probably after being partially civilised, it was gained back by the Aborigines. Even now this country is intersected by settled and cultivated tracts. Hindoos are scattered about it, and there is an admixture of Hindoo blood. Still, in all this part of the country, Aboriginal tribes muster very strong, and they preserve their lan- BS g uage, their manners, and their peculiarities much better than elsewhere. It is, however, as I have said, only in the heart and kernel of the | best preserved tribes, that we must look for the real original character- istics existing in a palpable and little-diluted form. In less pure | specimens, they will be found less distinct. My impression is that, if we look carefully, they will seldom be altogether wanting. The 22, The Ethnology of India. thick-lipped expression of countenance lingers long. The Gond Raja of Nagpore is of a family for generations civilised and Mahommedan, doubtless of very far from pure Aboriginal blood, and rather fair- skinned, but even in him I noticed the thick lips as prominent as in an African. Major Tickell seems to describe the ‘ Hos,’ who are iden- tical with ‘ Lurka Coles’ and closely allied to Moondahs and Sontals (one of the ugliest of races), as handsome ; but everything is compara- tive, and I suspect that this beauty is of the same kind as that which enthusiastic African travellers are constantly discovering in Negro tribes. The Hos of the border land have probably much intermixed with QOoriahs, and are less ugly than their congeners are always described to be. | Setting aside then the numerous half-breeds, borderers, and people _ of imperfett type, I take it that the general physical type of all the | purest Aboriginal tribes, is that which is commonly known as Negrito. They are small and slight, very black, face broad and flat, the thick lips already mentioned very prominent, noses broad and nostrils wide, beard scanty, hair very abundant and tangled, of a shock-headed — appearance, sometimes curly or even woolly. The peculiar Mongolian — or Chinese form of the eye is not conspicuous, and altogether the — features and the face are rather what we best know as African than — Mongolian. This description crops up everywhere in all the various © descriptions of Aboriginal tribes. I have not collected all these testi- — monies, but I will give one or two on which I can lay my hands, — Col. Dalton says, “The Jushpore -Oraons are the ugliest of the race, ~ with foreheads ‘ villainous low,’ flat noses and projecting maxillaries, — they approach the Negro in physiognomy.’’ And again, “ The Kaurs, next to the Jushpore Oraons, are the ugliest race I have seen, dark, — coarse-featured, wide mouths and thick lips.” In a note which he was good enough to send in answer to some inquiries which I made, — he adds, ‘‘ The Oraons have more of the African type of feature, and I have seen amongst them woolly heads.” An isolated tribe on the — Hast Coast, called ‘ Chenchwars,’ are described in similar terms, and said to be “ just what you might suppose to result from the crossing of the Malacca Aborigines with the common people of this country,” the Malacca Aborigines being very marked Negritos. The Savage Gonc s in the forests east of the Wyngunga seem to be of a similar type. So — The Ethnology of India. 23 in the papers with which I have been favoured from Bombay, I find that Major Keatinge, describing the three tribes of Gonds, Koors, and Bheels who meet about Asseerghur, says, “‘ All three tribes are very black, with a decidedly African expression when met in the centres of their country.”” And Capt. Probyn, speaking of the more civilised _ Gonds who are now, he says, finer and fairer, still adds, “ with some- what African features.” Major Keatinge adds what illustrates that which I have already said, “ On the outskirts of their country, their - features are much modified, showing plainly that they do not succeed in keeping their blood pure. The Chiefs have generally made it a point to get women of other castes into their households, and I have consequently observed that none of them have the national features.”’ In the South, the Chermars of Malabar are described as “‘ very di- -minutive, with a very black complexion, with not unfrequently woolly hair.” And of some of the tribes of the Kodagherry hills it is said that “flattened noses, dark complexion and large white teeth filed into the form of a saw give them an African appearance.” The Nagadees are said to be “in complexion invariably of the deepest black, their hair hick and curly, their features brutish, their forms diminutive,’’ That the type which I have described prevailed among the Aborigines generally in ancient times, is. evident from the Purans, where they are described in extremely uncomplimentary terms as ‘ vile monsters,’ “allied to monkeys,’ ‘ as black as crows,’ ‘ of flattened features and of ‘dwarfish stature.’ Their long thick matted hair is also particularly mentioned. _ The ancient Greeks also describe the South-Indians as like Ethio- pians, and it is difficult to assign any other country to the Oriental Ethiopians of Herodotus. It may be stated, as a physical peculiarity of the Aboriginal tribes, th at most of them seem to have a remarkable power of resisting malaria, and thrive in the most malarious jungles where no other | human beings can live. This may, however, be the result of long habit; some tribes inhabiting healthy localities sicken easily enough ~ elsewhere. Mp The languages of the Aborigines seem to have all this much in | common, that they are of the structure described as Turanian. They are neither like the Monosyllabic Chinese on the one hand, nor on the 24 The Ethnology of India. other like those Arabian and African languages which seem to form their changes by variations in the body of the word. The Indian Aboriginal languages, in common with the Hindustanee, the Turkish, and some Arian tongues, seem to form declensions, conjugations, and derivations, and to supply the place of what we call ‘ prepositions’ by post-posttions and post-inflections. The verb or governing word comes at the end of the sentence, instead of at the beginning as in English, somewhat thus, our order being just reversed. Rem acu. tetigit Cheez sui-se chuha Thing needle with touched he. The word ‘ Turanian,’ as applied to an immense class of languages, does not, however, imply any immediate connection with Thibetans or Mongolians, from whom the Indian Aborigines are physically so world-wide asunder. It is used in that very wide sense which in- eludes not only all the Mongolian races, but all the Polynesian races, and all the Negritoes of the Indian Archipelago, Australia, and Van Diemen’s land. A few vocables are said to be found, common to the Dravidian tongues and to some other Turanian languages. But the greatest resemblance is said to be not to the nearer Mongolians, but to— the most distant Finns, and it is at the same time admitted that there are at least as great indications of a special connection with the — Australian Negritoes. It may then generally be said, that both _ physique and in the structure of their language, the Aborigines present — a type analogous to that of the Negritoes of the South Seas, Papuans, — Tasmanians and others, as well as to the nearer Negritoes of Malacca and the Andamans, . That which I have already said of the general character of the laws and institutions of the Non-Arians as distinguished from the Arians, is — all that I can give as common to all these tribes. On this and any other points, we require much more information. One tribe only I must except, as quite without and beyond the general descriptions of the Aborigines which I have given, viz. the Todas of the upper plateau of the Neilgherry hills. They are nob properly Hindoos, but no one who sees them, would for a moment P. suppose that they belong to the Negrito races. They are evidently — Caucasians of a high type. In truth they are but a very small tribe; the — The Ethnelogy, of India. 25 common tradition and consent of the country makes it clear that they came as conquering immigrants to their present position at a compara- tively recent period, and their pastoral habit renders their migration easy. Their language, so small a body may well have almost lost during their wanderings among Dravidians. They may be anything Caucasian, and from anywhere ; ordinary Aborigines they are not. It has been said, that in their speech some words have a resemblance to the Brahui dialect, but personally they do not seem to resemble Brahuis, they are rather like Greeks. The points of structure which I have given, as common to all the Aboriginal languages, are, it will be observed, of the widest character. And this brings me to the fact that by the test of language the Aboriginal tribes may be divided into two great classes, having very few vocables in common. The first great division is that of the tribes speaking dialects. radically allied to the civilised languages of the South, commonly called the Dravidian languages. These then I shall call the Dravidian Aborigines. There is no doubt that the wild tribes of the southern hills speak wild and primitive forms of the southern languages. The Carambers seem to be ancient Tamil speakers, the Maleasurs of the Western Ghats approach nearer to the Malayala. The Burghers and Kotahs speak a primitive Canarese, the Ramooses, a language which seems to be for the most part Telagoo. The Gond language is as clearly Dravidian as Telagoo or Tamil, and the Gonds are so, considerable a people that the Gondee might almost be added to the list of regular languages of the southern type. The name Khond is so like Gond that, next neighbours as they are, one would almost suppose the words to be the same. They are said to be different, but at any rate the Khonds also are shown by their language _ tobe clearly Dravidian. More distant is the tongue of the Oraon tribe, to whose physical characteristics I have already alluded, and who are now found among tribes of the other division (to. be presently noticed) in the Chota-Nagpore territory. But the radicals and main features of the Oraon language leave no doubt that they are of Dravidian stock—a circumstance which does not suprise us, as we learn that they are comparatively recent immigrants from the west into their present locations. Hast of them again, in the Rajmahal hills, we have the last of the Dravidian tribes (so far as has yet been 26 The Ethnology of India. ascertained), speaking a language akin to that of the Oraons. Those hills form a kind of knot at the extreme eastern point of the hill country of Central India. It was known that the people were entirely different from their neighbours the Santals. The latter cultivate the lower lands, and it may at first sight seem surprising that the higher grounds should be in the possession of more recent settlers of a distant southern stock. The fact, however, seems to be explained by the plundering habits of the Rajmahal hillmen. They seem to have occupied those hills as a kind of stronghold, from which they could conveniently plunder the plains around them. The greater part of the Chota-Nagpore division and adjoining tracts is occupied by tribes whom I take as representative of the second or northern division of the Aborigines. There are ‘ Lurka Coles,’ ‘ Hos,’ * Bhoomiz,’ ‘ Moondahs,’ and Santals, and wilder tribes of the border hills, all speaking dialects of a language very different from the Dravidian. In fact, so far as vocables go, no substantial connection can be traced. Max Miller speaks of these tongues as quite unconnected with any other. Still I venture to think that there seems to be some A ' similarity of structure between them and the Dravidian languages. Major Tickell has published in the Journal of the Society a grammar of the Hos or Lurka Col language ; and I note the following as a few of the peculiarities common to it and to the Dravidian tongues, as the — latter are set forth by Dr. Caldwell. First, there is the general coincidence of structure, which I have already noticed as common to all the Aboriginal tongues as well as to Hindustanee, Turkish, &e. In this respect, the northern Aborigines — do not differ, and they similarly use postpositions, &e. F Further. In the Dravidian tongues there is no regular senden all inanimate things are neuter, and the terms male and female are prefixed when necessary. Zz It seems to be the same in the northern abotiaiaal tongues. Adjectives do not decline, nor are there degrees of comparison. It is the same in the northern tongues. There are two forms of the first person plural, one to include, and the other to exclude the person addressed. This peculiarity also is found among the northern evibe as ves ag in the Australian tongues. . The Ethnology of India. 27 Relative participles are used instead of relative pronouns in both classes of languages. The northern tongues seem to be considered more highly inflected than the Dravidian, and they have aregular dual form which the others have not. The verbs have no passive voice. It would seem to imply a higher organisation in the northern aboriginal languages, that the vocabularies show them to be more complete, and less to borrow from their neighbours all words beyond the very simplest. for instance, in the matter of numbers, while the Gonds do not go beyond ten, the Oraons beyond four, nor the Rajmahalees beyond two in Dravidian numbers, (borrowing all the rest from the Hindee,) the Coles and Santals count up to high numbers in their own tongue, only using scores instead of the decimal notation of hundreds, as do many Arian tribes. I have seen it stated that the Dravidian Khonds count by dozens. Max Miller remarks that savage tribes, with no letters to fix their tongues, alter their speech much more rapidly than civilised _ nations ; and it may be that, when we have two groups of people adjoin- ing one Shes and with a general physical similarity, such a general I structural resemblance of language as I have noticed may mark a remote common origin, even when the community of vocables can no longer be traced. But at any rate, the difference is now so wide as to _ establish, as I have said, two distinctly marked groups. : The generic name usually applied to the Aborigines of the hill , country of Chota-Nagpore, Mirzapore and Rewah is ‘ Coles’ or ‘ Koles.’ - Europeans apply the term to the Dravidian Oraons as well as to the :.:.. but perhaps erroneously. It is difficult to say to which tribes the.name is properly applied, for most of them have other distinctive names. But in the south of the Chota-Nagpore country, about Singbhoom, &c. it is certainly applied to the ‘ Lurka Coles,’ and I can ‘ myself testify that on the Mirzapore-Jubbulpore road, the Aborigines are called by the natives Coles or Kolees, which they volunteered to explain to me to be the same word “ which you call Coolee.” On the i Bombay side again a very numerous class of Aborigines are styled Kolees. In the Simla hills also, the inferior people are known as Kolees. Altogether I have myself little doubt that the ordinary word Coolee, as applied to a bearer of burdens or labourer, is the sarne word, 28 The Ethnology of India. and that in short it is the word generally applied by the Northern Indians to the Aboriginal tribes, most of whom they reduced to the condition of Helots. There seems to be good reason to suppose that the original form of the word was ‘ Kola’ or ‘ Kolar.’ In fact, India seems to have been known to the ancients (who approached it coastwise from the West) as Colara or Coolee-land (Asiatic Researches, Vol. IX.) and the people as Colaurians. If Kolar be the original form of Kolee, it would seem not improbable that, as in the mouths of some tribes by dropping the‘7”? it became Kola or Kolee, so in the mouths of others, by dropping the ; ‘?’ it would become Koar, Kaur, Koor, Khar or Khor, a form which ; _ would embrace a large number of those tribes as now designated. I propose then to call the northern tribes Kolarian or Coolee Aborigines. One may see frequent allusion to Kolarees or Colleries in the south of India. It appears that the word there used is properly ‘ Kallar.’ In the Canarese language, the word ‘ Kallar,’ it seems, simply means a thief or robber, and hence some of the predatory Aborigines of the hills, are designated Kallars or robbers, just as the thieves of Central Asia are called ‘ Kazaks’ or ‘ Cossacks.’ The word is applied so_ 4 differently from that of Coolee, that there may fairly be doubt of its s being the same. ut the subject is worthy of farther inquiry, and if it prove that in fact the two words are identical, the term Coolee or — Kolarian must be applied to the Aboriginal tribes generally, not to one division of them. Meantime, however, I apply it to the Northern — : tribes only, but I confess I have misgivings whether the more general 3 sense may not prove to be the true one. Beyond the difference of language, I am unable to state with con- _ fidence any very marked features distinguishing the Dravidian ‘and % Kolarian groups of tribes (each taken as a whole) from one another, _ But a marked difference in habits, manners, and national characteristics, — ; has been found to exist where the two classes are in the closest conti-_ guity. The Santals and Rajmahalees are known to present a marked contrast, and on the Chota-Nagpore plateau I am told that “ the difference is so great, that they appeared to be quite another nation,” q and ‘their customs, appearance, even manners, are very different.” Of these differences we have not the details, but I hope that they ma a a be furnished in Col. Dalton’s promised paper on the Coles, { The Ethnology of India. 29 The Kolarian Santals are a very ugly race, and I gather that their neighbours, the Dravidian Rajmahalees, have rather the advantage of _ them in this respect, but these latter have probably kidnapped a good _ many Arian women from the plains. I have fancied that I have noticed in some of the ‘Dhangar’ labourers in and about Calcutta, a peculiar q little ‘pique’ ‘retroussé’ sort of nose, as distinguished from the flat broad-nosed features of the Santals, but this scarcely amounts to an observation. It may be noticed that in the passages which I have quoted in regard to the general type of the Aborigines, the African ‘style was more especially attributed to Dravidian Oraons, Gonds and Chenchwars, &c. The Kolarians, Kaurs, Khairwars and Koors, are also represented as only one degree less ill-favoured ; so, on the whole, Timagine that in point of personal appearance there is not much to choose between the two groups. Ethnographers seem to distinguish the Negritoes of the Southern Seas into two groups, a woolly or curly- haired group, and a straight-haired group ; perhaps there may be found to have been some such division in India. The Santals and most of their immediate congeners, are certainly amore simple, mild, and industrious race than the Rajmahalees, Gonds, Khonds, and Southern Kallar tribes; but again the Lurka Coles seem to be warlike, and the hill Khorewahs are described as wild savages, armed with battle axes and bows and arrows. On the whole, I should r ather imagine that the Kolarians are more frequently good Coolees, and the Dravidians oftener troublesome Kallars. 4 a descriptions of the Aborigines as a good-natured people, ever d meing and singing (in a way that reminds one of the pleasanter lescriptions of the Negroes,) I find to be applied to the Kolarians,— als, Moondahs, Khorewahs, &c.—more than to the Dravidian tribes, respects religion, although the indications are too slight for any mfident generalisation, the accounts of the Kolarian creed seem asanter than those of the Dravidian beliefs and rites. The latter to deal in demonology, fetishism, frantic dances, bloody and human sacrifices, in a way which reminds us of the worst African }; while several different accounts of Northern Aborigines, in widely erent parts of the country, represent them as reverencing in an no ffensive way the sun, moon, and Lord of tigers, and mild and innocent | Bhoots or houschold spirits. The superstitious belief in tigers’ claws | ' ) . | 50 The Ethnology of India. as a charm, is shared with the Aborigines by all the Hindustanees. Another practice of the Aborigines the latter also have in hilly tracts, the heaping up cairns of stones at particular points, and tying bits of rag to a particular tree as votive offerings. This last may be seen anywhere, and these practices are probably very widely spread. If there really be such a distinction between the Dravidian and Kolarian religions as that at which I have hinted, it is very like a similar distinction in Africa. In a work on South Africa by the Rev. Mr. Grout, we are told that the gods of the Hottentots are above, the sun, moon, &. while those of the Kaffirs and more war- like Negroes south of the line are below, demons and evil §pirits. © Among some of the latter too are seen the horrid rites and bloody sacrifices. It strikes me that there is some resemblance in appearance ~ between Hottentots and Santals. A curious testimony to the ancient rights of the Indian ‘ Boomeas’ — or people of the soil, is the practice in many parts of Central India ~ where Hindu chiefs are dominant, that a new chief on his accession 4 receives the ¢eka or investiture from the blood of an Aboriginal Kole, | Gond or Bheel. € I proceed to mention the various tribes in detail, so far as my imper- fect knowledge of them permits. The Aboriginal tribes now living apart from the general population — in the South of India, appear to be very small and scattered. They _are there for the most part absorbed in the general social system, Pariahs and others, as is well known, merely form a lower social grade. | The robber tribes, Beders and such like, seem for the most part to have robbed themselves into a respectable and even aristocratical posi tion. The Beders in some parts of Mysore now form a consideraole portion of the population, and they have many Polygarships. There | seems to be some doubt whether the Badagras and Kotas of the lowe! Neilgherry hills are properly Aborigines, they being, it appears, immi | grants in those parts, and the Carambers the true Aborigines. I hayé not been able to meet with any very connected or detailed account of the thoroughly Aboriginal tribes of the hills and forests of the Neilgherries, Pulneys, and Western Ghats. The word Maleasur seems to mean simply a hillman, and the more proper tribal designations: appear to be Carambers, Irulars, Puliars, and Veders, These seem #0” The Ethnology of India, 31 be tribes in the very lowest stage of savageness, with in fact searcely any agriculture, mere men of the woods. They are represented as of very diminutive stature, with thickly matted locks and supple limbs, living under trees in caverns or in the rudest wigwams, keeping sheep or collecting forest produce, very stupid but also very mild and inoffensive, except that they have a great reputation as sorcerers, and themselves believing in a religion of demons and witchcraft, are by their neighbours believed to be highly gifted that way. | Altogether they seem to be very inferior to the simple but sturdy and industrious Coolees of the north. - The Chenchwars, already mentioned, and several very petty and isolated tribes exist in the Hastern Ghats about and north of Madras. I ean only give the names of “‘ Chendaurs” and “ Yende” as near the Kistna and Pulicat Lake. Allusions seem to be made to the existence of Aboriginal or quasi-Aboriginal tribes at different points in the Western Ghats and Coasts; the name of “ Chermars” and “ Neade’ te mentioned in Travancore and Cochin, but they are no doubt the ame as Chermars and Nagadees, the slaves of Malabar. The Dhers nd Ramooses of the centre and west of the Peninsula seem to be mixed ith the general population. On all these points more precise informa- ion is much required. ‘It is not till we cross the Godavery to the north, that we come to e country really held by the Aborigines. , In the highlands between the Godavery and the Mahanaddee, the ge Khonds, notorious for their human sacrifices, are to the Hast, e barbarous and less known tribes of Gonds to the West and more — the interior. The Khonds appear to be in contact with Hindus and to have some that race among them. Their blood is probably somewhat mixed, 1 they are not described as so ugly and ultra-Aboriginal as some ner tribes. J. the Gonds of the forests of Bustar and thence running up towards Ww yngunga we know very little, except that they are extreme mages, black, ugly, barbarous and dangerous. The name ‘“ Marees”’ sms to be there applied to them, and they appear to be nearly inde- dent, owning a scant allegiance to chiefs whose blood is for the most. part Gond. From thence the Gonds extend a long way North, and 32 The Ethnoloyy of India. occupy a broad tract east and west wherever the country is jungly or hilly, but becoming more and more civilised and more dominant over others as we go northwards. The valley of Sumbhulpore may be taken as for the most part marking the division between the Gond country on one side, and that of the Aborigines of northern stock on the other. On the east the Gonds, under the name of Gours, extend into the borders of the Chota-Nagpore agency in QOodeypore and Sirgoojah, but they are there much Hinduised and have lost their language. The Raja of Sirgoojah, though pretending to be a Rajpoot, is suspected to be a Gour; at any rate the Gours are there the dominant tribe. ~ Thence westward along the line of the Sautpoora hills, through all the © hilly country of the districts of Mandla, Jubbulpore, Seonee, Chand- — wara, Baitool and Hoshangabad, in fact in some degree to the neigh- — bourhood of Asseerghur, the Gonds predominate. In the wilder parts, | they speak their own Aboriginal language, and seem there to be a i simple and not intractable people, following both pastoral and agricul-— tural pursuits. In the older maps, the name Gondwana is given to a | wider tract of country in this part of Central India, being that which was in modern times rather politically than ethnologically Gond. — The Gonds (in a somewhat civilised form) were in fact for some time | masters of all this part of the country, including the open and culti- | vated tracts about Nagpore, Raepore, Jubbulpore; &c. and perhaps as | far as Ellichpore on the one hand, and on the other to the south of the | Godavery, where some of them are found among the ordinary Telinga population. Deogurh in the Sautpooras was the chief seat of thei 7 power. They immediately preceded the Marattas. These latter | ousted them from the open and valuable tracts, and they do not now form any considerable part of the population of the plain country, but | < they maintained a feudal dominion in much of the hilly country ; and | i range, but most of the men of considerable position in parts of Saugot | Following up the Dravidian tribes, we next come to the Oraons, now located in the midst of Kolarian tribes and much mixed up w | The Ethnology of India. 33 them. The Gonds or Gours have been mentioned as found in a not very pure form in the west of Oodeypore, and Sirgoojah of the Chota- Nagpore division. In the highlands to the east of those states and of Jushpore, the Oraons are found. Col. Dalton mentions them as form- ing the greater part of the population of a considerable portion of the Jushpore highlands, and it is these whom he describes as the ugliest of _ the race. Thence eastwards the Oraons have pushed themselves into the proper country of the Moondahs (of Kolarian race) in the plateau of the Chota-Nagpore district and adjoining country. They must _ have been strong, to effect an ingress to a country not originally their own, but I do not understand that they are now at all dominant over the others. In fact they seem to have very much adopted the habits of the Kolarians, among whom or in contact with whom they live, _ are industrious and laborious, and as much as the others contribute to _ the supply of the labour market*of Bengal. I understand that they _ form a considerable proportion of the Calcutta Dhangars ; that last term being one the proper meaning of which I cannot ascertain, but which, so far as I can learn, is applied generically to the aboriginal labourers in Calcutta. Separated from the Oraons by a considerable space (principally of lower but still more or less hilly-country, occupied by mixed tribes of Kolarians, Hindustanees, and Bengalees), are the Dravidian Rajma- halees, whose proper tribal name, I have not ascertained. They are ‘sometimes called Maler, but that is merely the Dravidian form for been in those days terrible depredators. That all the parts of India adjoining the Central hills, both at this point and throughout a con- | siderably wider range, were ‘in times of anarchy dreadfully subject to | injury from the hill-men, is still attested by the numerous and exten- | sive ‘ehatwallee’ tenures held all along the foot of the hills and |about the Ghats and passes. They are particularly numerous in the | Bhaugulpore and Beerbhoom districts, adjoining the Rajmahal hills |on either side. Such estates pay little or no revenue, but are held on \the condition of guarding the passes against hill robbers, murderers, jand cattle-lifters, The hill-men have been successiully reclaimed, . 34 The Ethnology of India. I believe that they cultivate quietly, and there appears to be now little complaint against them. Organised and serious raids on the plains are, I understand, unknown. The Rajmahal men are those who were enlisted into the British military service to form the local corps known as the Bhaugulpore Hill Rangers ; but when the usually quiet Santals were impelled by a sense of wrong to a headlong sort of rebellion, the other (and it was supposed more military) race forming the Rangers, when opposed to them, by no means distinguished themselves, and they have since, I think, been disbanded. I now pass to the Kolarian tribes. The more civilised and numerous tribes of this race, occupying an extensive country about 150 miles . west from Calcutta, and known as Moondahs, Bhoomiz, Hos, and | Santals, speak languages so nearly identical, that they may all — be regarded as Sub-divisions of one people. They are in fact very | like one another in many ways. They occupy most of the British | districts-of Chota-Nagpore, Singbhoom, Maunbhoom, and the hilly part — of Bhaugulpore (Rajmahal hills excepted) now known as the Santal Pergunnahs; also parts of West Burdwan, Midnapore and Cuttack. They are a simple industrious people, and are reputed to be _ remarkably honest and truthful. Their country is healthy and, unlike most aboriginal tribes in most parts of the world, they seem by no means to be dying out, but multiply and supply the labour: market. Partly on account of the cheapness of labour in their | country, partly on account of ‘their tractable disposition and freedom from all caste and food prejudices, and more especially, I think, because — of that want of attachment to the soil which distinguishes the Aboriginal from the Arian, they are much sought after and highly | prized as labourers. Many of them are settled in the service of Bengal Indigo-planters ; they are very well known as labourers on the Railways, roads, and other works of Western Bengal’; and they are now, I believe, ~ the favourite material for emigration to Assam. Unfortunately however, coming from a healthy high and dry country, they have not that capacity for resisting malaria for which the wilder tribes are remarkable, and seem to die very rapidly. | In the Chota-Nagpore country, the ‘ Moondahs’ seem to have so fat adopted Arian manners, as to live together in considerable villages, instead of apart in detached houses or isolated hamlets, according to 4 The Ethnology of India; 3g the common practice of these tribes; but I am told that so great is their instability and want of attachment to any particular spot, that not unfrequently, on some petty quarrel with their zemindar, a whole village will abandon their houses and seek other locations, or put, themselves under the guidance of a Coolee recruiting-agent. The Hos and Bhoomiz* of the lower parts of Singbhoom and Maunbhoom, seem to be tolerably civilised. The Santals, though geographically near _the plains, seem to be among the most shy and socially-isolated of the race. They cultivate the lower lands of their country, but seem to have kept very much to themselves, and to prefer locations surrounded by jungle and segregated from the world. They too, however, have now taken much to labour for hire, and they must have become intimate with Europeans. In the case of these people is to be found practical illustration of a truth of wider application in India, viz. that in a mere pecuniary and commercial point of view, tact and scrupulous fairness in dealing with the natives are more effectual than all other means, and go farther than any laws and any administration. I believe that certain of the Railway Engineers, who have gained the special. confidence of the Santals. and allied tribes, construct the railway mile _ for mile infinitely cheaper than any others. On the borders of the hills, a set of half-breeds seem to be not only by profession Ghatwals, but to constitute a sort of caste under that name. I have alluded to the language of these Kolarian tribes. One would hope or expect here to find the origin of the non-Arian _ elements of the Hindee and other northern languages. This, however, has not yet been so. It is difficult to distinguish between words _ borrowed by the Aborigines from the modern Hindustanee or Bengalee and those of acommon origin. A few of the words in Hodgson’s lists are like Hindee, but most of them seem to be Arian. words. Some words seem to be used throughout India as ‘ Donga,’ a boat, and some are yords of much wider use as ‘ Ka’ ‘ Kahee’ or ‘ Kova,’ a crow and ‘ Pussi,’ ‘acat. It is then no doubt the case that the very brief and imperfect vocabularies.of the Kolarian tongues yet published, have not shown “an immediate connection with any other known language. More * Bhoomiz, I believe merely means ‘ people of the soil’ from Bhoomi, being ‘nearly the same word as the Persian ‘ Zemindar.’ What the Hindoo-tribes are to the Mahommedans, the aborigines are to the Hindoos. 36 The Ethnology of India, minute inquiry would be very desirable. Besides a more exact and full grammar, I think it would be well to separate out from the Hindee a list of non-Sanscrit words of common use, (and which are not also common to the greater part of the world, such as ‘‘ kowa,” a crow, and some of the universal Turanian words), and having thus got what I may call a Hindee proper vocabulary, to compare it carefully with the dialects of the Santals, &ec. In addition to the semi-civilised tribes which I have mentioned, nearly the same language is spoken by the wilder Lurka Coles of the hills to the West of the Singbhoom district. North of these latter again, in the highest hills to the North of Jushpore, and in those between Sirgoojah and Palamow, Col. Dalton mentions a considerable tribe called Khorewahs, who speak much the same language, whose manners and habits are the same, .and who are evidently of the same stock, though much less civilised; some, he says, utterly savage and almost Nomadic. They are said to be of small stature, but better looking and lighter than their neighbours, the Dravidian Oraons, with shaggy heads of hair and some beard. Mention is made of some other very wild tribes scattered about the Chota-Nagpore division, Kherrias (who are a mystery even to Col. Dalton), Bendkurrs and Birhores in the south of the division, and Bhuhars or Boyars (not to be confounded with very different Bhuyas to “be subsequently noticed) in the north; but the languages and affinities of these tribes have not been ascertained sufficiently to place them, They are described as “‘ regularly wild inhabitants of the hills and jun- gles, who have no fixed villages, but move about from place to place, — burning down the jungles, sowing in the ashes, and after reaping what is produced, going elsewhere.” On the Sumbulpore borders, the Coles, intermixed among the Cont are said to be known as “ Kirkees.”’ F Mr. Samuells mentioned a wild tribe in the jungles of Cuttack, : whom he calls ‘Janguas,’ perfect savages, small, slender, nearly naked, and horrid in appearance. They speak a strange language, and he gives a few words, some of which seem like the language : of the Santals, &c , as ‘ Minnah,’ one, and ‘ Bana,’ two. The Aboriginal eae near Cuttack strike a bargain by breakin | a straw, The Ethnology of India. 37 In some places the word ‘ Soor’ or ‘ Sourah’ seems to be used, as if the same as ‘ Santal;’ and Mr. Stirling, in an article on Cuttack, (in the Asiatic Researches) enumerates ‘ Santals’ and ‘ Soors’ separately among the tribes of Coles. It would seem then as if Soors or Sourahs were a tribe of Santals on the borders of the Cuttack division. But the Soors under the hills north of the Mahanaddee, while described as small, mean, and very black, and like —_ <<, the Santals naturally harmless, peaceable and industrious, are also said to be without moral sense and ready to cut firewood or other men’s throats indifferently, an accusation not, I think, brought against the - Santals. Again, Macpherson tells us, that the hill tribes south of the Khonds, and running up to near the Godavery, are Sowrahs. That is quite a different location, and I have not found any farther account of these - Sourahs. Caldwell says that the Tamil people were anciently called - *Sorahs,’ but as they are the most Dravidian of all the southern ‘ people, they can hardly be allied to the Kolarian Santals, and the word must be different. The whole subject requires a good deal » of fresh light. _ Passing north, I have till now reserved, for separate notice, the of Mirzapore and Rewah, and the borders of Benares and Behar. “These are the Aboriginal tribes most directly in contact with the “modern Hindustanees, and there is this difficulty about classifying i are more mixed with the Hindustanees, perhaps I may say generally ‘more civilised, than the tribes located farther in the interior of the hills. The principal tribe of these parts are called ‘ Kharwars’ or *Kharawars.’ There is also a widely spread tribe of ‘ Rajwars.’ A division of the Kharwars are called ‘ Bhogtahs.’ The Kharwars seem | to be altogether the dominant tribe of Palamow and Singrowlee | (the Mirzapore hill country). Both Kharwars and Rajwars are also | found in considerable numbers westward, in parts of Sirgoojah and | Jushpore, while to the north-east, in the parts of the plains adjoin- jing the hills, they are numerous. In the Gya district, near the hills, the Rajwars are the chief labouring class. They live in the 38 3 The Ethnology of India. villages as a kind of serfs and bearers of burdens, carty palanquins, and when out of employ, are apt to be thieves and robbers. A little farther west, the Kharwars seem to perform the same functions ; they are mentioned by Buchanan as in the outskirts of the Patna and Arrah Districts. On the road from Mirzapore to Jubbulpore, where it passes through Rewah, &c., the palanquin bearers and coolies are Aborigines. When I passed that way some time ago, not having then gone ,into the subject, I did not ask the particular tribe, nor have I since been able to ascertain it, but in all probability they are Kharwars. All these people have in their faces unmistakeable marks of their aboriginal origin. But they speak Hindee. This then brings us to the difficulty about language. Col. Dalton is not aware of any Aboriginal language spoken by the Kharwars. I have had the im- pression that in the Mirzapore district they spoke their own language ; and Capt. Blunt, who in the last century made a remarkable journey | from Chunar right through the hills to the Godavery (see Asiatic Researches, Vol. 7), almost at the outset of his journey mentions the Kharawars of the Singrowlee hills as very savage, and speaking a separate and quite unintelligible language. But the Rev. R. C. Mather of Mirzapore, who has been good enough to write for me a note on the subject (of which I have already made use), and who refers to a tour made by the Rev. Mr. Jones, is unable to say that any aboriginal language exists in these parts. He says that both the Kharwars and another similar tribe, locally called ‘ Majhwars,’ speak the Hindee, or at least understand it when spoken. It would be very interesting to ascertain if the remains of an original language exists among these people, for with them more especially we should expect to find the non-Aryan Hindee roots. If aboriginal tribes so situated have no separate language of their own, it may arise from either of two causes; either they may have abandoned their own language and adopted that of the people who are flooding over and as it were submerging them; or the fact may be that, in its most radical parts, the language of these latter having been the same as their own, an influx of vocables on this common basis may altogether obliterate the landmarks by which languages are distinguished. Till however, this is cleared up, I think that we must on other grounds The Ethnology of India, 39 class the Kharwars, &c. with Kolarians rather than with Dravidians. ‘Mr. Mather, quoting Mr. Jones, says that, passing on from the Khar- wars, he came to the ‘ Oraons,’ in whom he fopnd “the difference from the Mirzapore Hill people to be so great, that they appeared to be quite another nation.” In fact, the Oraons are now a good deal interposed between the Kharwars and Kolarian Moondahs, but Col. Dalton also says that the Kharwars and Oraons, though in contact, are very unlike one another in language, appearance, manners and customs. The Kharwars, he says, are not quite so African looking as the Oraons, but some of them seem to be not much better favoured. A long connection with the plains would best account for the adop- tions of the language and some of the manners of the plains-people by the Kharawars and Rajwars. And here the question has suggested itself to me, whether they may not perhaps be identified with the ‘Cheroos and Bhurs, those aboriginal tribes whose dominion in the plain country to the north of these hills is matter of history, who seem certainly to have come from and to have gone to the country now inhabited by these tribes, and who frém this point of their his- tory almost or wholly disappear. Buchanan seems to speak ambi- ‘guously, sometimes classing Kharawars and Cheroos together, sometimes treating of them as separate. While mentioning the Cheroos as - nearly extinct in the plains, he speaks of them as still existing in ~ numbers in the high country within the hills. In the accounts of _ the latter country, on the other hand, I find no mention of either _ Cheroos or Bhurs under those names. Farther inquiry seems neces- 4 ‘sary. Our use of Roman letters applied to native names is very uncertain, and if we could suppose the C in Cheroo to be pronounced t hard asin Cole, Cheroo would become Kheroo, and Kheroo would be Bit very different from the Khara of Kharawar (the ‘war’ is a mere termination), while Khara might again be connected with the name of the Kolarian Khorewahs already mentioned, and with the Koors, equally Kolarian, to be subsequently noticed. Again, the Bhurs are ‘more commonly known as ‘ Rajbhurs;’ may not Rajhbur have been corrupted into ‘ Rajwar ?’ The present dominant position of the Kharwars in a considerable ‘country would seem much to tally with the idea of their representing ‘the tribes once so famous. Both the Rajas of Singrowlee and Jush- 40 The Ethnology of India. pore are Kharwars, however they may claim an origin from Rajpoot foundlings, and they are the people who most affect what Col. Dalton calls ‘refining into Rajpoots.’ Although many of them may have achieved a good deal of improvement in their blood and appear- ; ance, they are not originally a handsome race, for Col. Dalton expressly _ tells us that in the more remote parts, the Kharwars of Palamow, and especially the Bhogtahs, are very ugly and ill-fayoured. Like the other aborigines, they have no proper caste and eat anything. I leave, for separate notice, a very numerous tribe all along the borders of Bengal, Orissa, and part of Bahar, called Bhuyas, whose connection with the races above described is not clear. In this region of India, it only remains to mention one more Abori- ginal tribe, called Kaurs, found in the extreme west of the Chota-Nag- — pore Agency about Korea, Oodeypore, and the adjoining parts of the territory of Nagpore proper, the Pergunnah of Korbah of Chatteesgurh. They are described as a very industrious thriving people, considerably advanced in civilisation. They now affect Hindoo traditions, pretend to be descended from the defeated remnants of the Kooroos who — fought the Pandavas, worship Siva and speak Hindee, but in appear- — - ance they are ultra-aboriginal, very black, with broad noses and thick : lips, and eat fowls, &c., bury most of their dead, and contemn Bramins ; so that their Hindooism is scarcely skin-deep. From the last mentioned point westward, through a broad tract of — country, the plains are occupied by the ordinary Indian Arians, the hills and forests by the Gonds (who here in the centre of India meet — the Hindustanees on the North, the Telingas on the South, and the Marattas on the West); and we do not again come to Kolarian Aborigines, till we get in fact to the West of India. There isthena hiatus, as respects the Kolarians, of four or five degrees of longitude, where by the advance of the conquering Gonds they have probably been split asunder. It somewhat singularly happens that the first people of — this race whom we come to in the West, bear as nearly as possible the same name as the last we left in the Hast. The latter were called ‘Kaurs.’ In the Western Sautpooras, in the hills about Gawalghur near Ellichpore, and thence towards Indore, is a tribe called ‘ Coowr j or Koor Koos. These people speak an undoubtedly Kolarian language. The name is sufficiently near to Gowr to cause them to have been The Ethnology of India. 41 sometimes confounded with their neighbours, the Gonds, but the difference is clear. In the notes with which I have been favoured from Bombay, Major Keatinge mentions them as “a tribe of Gonds ealling themselves Koor Koos,” but he goes on to distinguish them from the Gonds, mentioning the geographical location of each, and adding that the two tribes keep themselves separate, do not intermix, and that each has a separate language of its own, He does not give particulars of the language, and it is from a paper on which I stumbled in an old number of the Society’s Journal, and which does not appear to have been previously much noticed, that 1 have been able to identify this tribe with precision. Dr. Voysey, writing at Ellichpore so long ago as 1821, also at first calls them Gonds, but he goes on to say that they are also called ‘ Coours,’ and that the Gonds consider themselves a distinct tribe from the Coours and neither eat nor inter- marry with them. He then gives a small list of Coour words. This was taken long before Hodgson’s vocabularies were published, and the _ two seem never to have been compared. I have compared Dr. Voysey’s list with Hodgson’s lists of words of the Kolarian tribes of Lurka Coles, Santals, &c. and find a remarkable coincidence. take the numerals. -. Coour UNE tivdviivdsddnias eeveds do va 2.. Bariah, .. ; Me Gs ADE, 02.0 Se eee RNERTMOO fo 5(5250i50.. Ser ceaeden Men, Munes, 2....050esesee Late BT WUITUING,” ) soca deceive. x 7. PMR hati ctea : Sveik:s dels pececee me) 8. Dhar, st reptiles Seeo., Arhe, ..... ‘ I GL) ec suseervsecases edsalt. _ And again. 4 Coour Man, © Hoko, ©) Water, Da, 1. Fire, Singhel, Tree, Darao, ser eee sereee For instance, Hodgson’s Coles, &c. Mi. Barria. Apia. Apunia, Monaya. Turia. Hodgson. Ho. Dah. Sengel. Daru. aS ¢ OO SF 42 The Ethnology of India. House, Oah, | Oa. Mouth, ~ Ah, A. Eye, Meht, Met. In fact, of the first nine of Voysey’s words which are also given by Hodgson, seven are identical, a circumstance very remarkable, seeing how far these illiterate tribes are separated from one another. None of the words correspond with the Dravidian synonyms, so there can be no doubt that we have traced the Kolarians so far. Immediately beyond the Koors, from Asseerghur westwards, we are in the Bombay Presidency. | As I cannot ascertain that Mhars and Mangs and Ramooses now live as entirely separate tribes, I may at once say that, so far as my information goes, the Bombay Aborigines are (for my present purpose) all comprised in the two tribes of Koolees and Bheels. These tribes are scattered over a great portion of the Presidency, and in some parts, the Koolees especially, seem to live as a part of the general population. But the Koolees in part, and the Bheels more © generally, are still found in portions of their original seats as distinct q tribes, and they both seem to be numerous. Their name, position, | and character seem to mark the Koolees as Kolarians. But beyond this, the more precise test of language is unfortunately wanting. I_ haye not been able to find that these tribes have now any aboriginal ~ languages of their own. ‘They are generally said to speak dialects of the civilised languages of the neighbouring countries. In one or two places allusion is made to the existence or. supposed existence ofa Bheel language in remote jungles, but I have not found any precise ; indication respecting it. | a I was at first inclined to conjecture that the separation into two tribes of Koolee and Bheels, and perhaps the more predatory character of the latter, might point to a division of race; that the Bheels might | be Dravidians, I find, however, that the general opinion of those qualified to judge seems to tend to the belief that there is no essential difference between the two tribes. Forbes in his’ Ras Mala says : ** Kaolees or Bheels, for though the former would resent the classi fication, the distinctions between them need not be here noticed.” Capt. Probyn says, ‘I think there is no actual difference between Koolees and Bheels. Their religion is the same.” Mr. Ashburner: | The Ethnology of India. 43 * There is no real difference between Bheels and Koolees; their habits, physiognomy and mode of life are the same, modified by local circum- stances.” And the Rev. Mr. Dunlop Moore says, ‘‘ Koolees frequently marry Bheel wives.” Other authorities, however, say that they do not intermarry. They both seem to claim a northern and not a southern origin, pointing to the hills of Rajpootana and the north of Goozerat. The Bheels say that they were originally called Kaiyos; Sir John Malcolm says that they are related to the Meenas of Rajpootana, and once ruled in the Jeypore country. Forbes again tells us that the Koolees were originally called Mairs; while in Rajpootana, Col. Tod speaks of Mairs or Meenas as one race. The Rev. Mr. Dunlop says that, though these tribes speak the - same languages as their neighbours, “‘ certain words are universally recognised as peculiar to Koolees as well as Bheels.” He only instances one word written in a character which I can read, and that is ‘ Bhoroo’ or ‘ Bhooroo,’ the head. As I write, I have turned up the word head in Hodgson’s vocabularies, and find that the Kols, Santals, Bhumiz and Moondas use the word ‘ Bu,’ ‘ Buho’ or ‘ Bohu’ which seems to be the same word. The Dravidian words for head are entirely different. Tt would be in many ways very interesting and important to rescue ‘any remains of aboriginal words or aboriginal dialects of these tribes, and especially to find whether among them can be traced any “hon-Aryan radicals of the Goozerattee, Maratta, and the Hindee dialects of Rajpootana. _ Though probably in the main of the same class and similar origin, the Koolees and Bheels are now quite distinct tribes, and there is this considerable difference that the Koolees have come much more into contact with Aryan blood and civilisation, are in appearance generally much more Hindooised than the others, and consider themselves altogether a higher class. As has been said, both tribes are now much scattered over many parts of the Presidency and in places a good deal intermixed, but their proper locale seems to be as follows. The Koolees are the Aborigines of Goozerat (where they now live in considerable number), and of the hills adjoining that Province. The hills east of Goozerat are called ‘ Kolwan’ and seem to be the property of Koolee tribes, just as in the Chota-Nagpore Ad The Ethnology of India. territory the country of the Lurka Coles is called “ Kolhan.” The Bheels are the proper possessors of the hills farther in the interior and east of the Koolees, there occupying both the Sautpoora and the Vyndia ranges, and extending into Rajpootana. In the latter j direction and about the Vyndians some of the tribes claim to be ‘ crossed with Rajpoots, and these are called Beelalahs. The Bheels are numerous in Candeish, and are found in some parts of the adjoining Deccan. They sometimes find their way to the Coast where they are stated to be known as ‘ Dooblas’ or the ‘‘ Kala Pooruj” or ‘ black men.’ The Koolees seem to be scattered down the Coast country nearly as far as Goa, and north again into the ‘ Thurr’ and the neighbourhood of Scinde. While the wilder Koolees of the hills are like the Bheels, the mass of more civilised Koolees are said to © be not only fairer and more Caucasian in feature, but also more sly and cunning and less truthful. A large proportion of both races | have been much diluted in point of ‘ aboriginality’ of feature by — intermixture, but the Bheels less than the others. Many of the q Koolees live in villages and adopt some Hindoo practices. They are | stated to average about 5 feet 3 inches in height. Though most of — them are now quiet agriculturists and labourers, they were not always so. The wilder tribes of the race are still predatory, and Forbes mentions the Koolees as by far the most numerous of the arm-bearing — castes who in former days, living in the hills between Goozerat and — Rajpootana, disturbed the country. He describes them as of dimi-~ nutive stature, with eyes which bore an expression of liveliness and cunning, clothes few, arms bow and arrows, habits swift and ee | bold in assault, but rapid in flying to the jungles, independent i id spirit, robbers, averse to industry, addicted to drunkenness, and quar- | relsome when intoxicated; formidable in anarchy, but incapable o uniting among themselves.. This description seems exceedingly we | to apply to the wild Bheels of modern days, whom indeed Forbes classes with the Koolees. i Many of the Bheels are so independent and so much apart in their own hills and jungles, that it seems very strange that they should have no language of their own; I think that the search for such a language, or the remains of it, should not be abandoned without very careful inquiry. The Ethnology of India. 45 I have not been able to ascertain whether there are any of these aboriginal tribes in the Kattywar hills, or who are the aborigines of Kattywar. I have not met with any precise mention of them. Lassen in his map places Koolees (Kolas he calls them) in the centre of Kattywar. He had probably some authority for doing so, but more precise information on the point would be desirable. North of the Bombay country, in the Aravallee range running towards Ajmere, is the country of the Mairs or Mhairs, with whom I have said that the Koolees claim kindred, and whose name also suggests the question whether they may be related to the Maratta Mhars. Tod says that Mhair means Mountaineer, from ‘ Meru’ mountain. _ The modern Mhairs are probably a very mixed race. Col. Dixon, who is avowedly enthusiastic in their favour, makes them out to be rather good-looking, and tells the usual story (as told by the chiefs to him) of their descent from Rajpoots. They admit to have taken _ a few Bheel and Meena women. It is probably the case, as Col. Dixon says, that for hundreds of years they have been recruited by Hindu- stanee refugees and rascals of all sorts. Though now out of the way, it must be remembered that Ajmere was, under the emperors, one of the chief seats of Mahommedan power. The Meenas constitute a large portion of the population of Raj- pootana, especially in the Jeypore country between Ajmere and Dehli. T have said that they are supposed to be related to the Mhairs, and they are called the aborigines of the country, but I doubt if they are so in the sense in which I am now dealing with separate aboriginal tribes. In Upper India, out of their own country, these Meenas are principally known as dacoits; and of those that I have seen in that capacity, my impression is, that they were not small and aboriginal-looking, but fine powerful men. I suspect that if ori- ginally a half-breed derived from aborigines, the Meenas are now Members of the ordinary Indian society, and that Aryan features predominate in them. ‘Farther information, however, is required. I am not aware of any aboriginal tribes in Bundlecund. In a recent Archeological paper read at a meeting of the Society, mention | was incidentally made of “the wild Sherrias” found about the southern sources of the Nerbudda, and I also find mention of a tribe | called ‘ Naikras’ in the hills of Oodeypore, said to be like the Bheels, 46 The Ethnology of India. but somewhat lower in the scale of humanity. I do not know whe- ther these are really sub-divisions of the Bheels or separate tribes. In fact there may be many remnants of tribes in the jungles of Central India yet undescribed. I have now, however, noticed all the aboriginal tribes of the hilly portions of the Indian Peninsula known to me, with the exception only of the Bhooyas of the borders of Bengal. In the plains, of course, we do not look to find separate aboriginal tribes, and those now classed as ‘castes’ will be afterwards noticed ; but before leaving the subject of Koolees or Kolaries I may mention an assertion of Col. Tod that all the weaver caste throughout Hindustan are of this class, though they now call themselves ‘ Julahas’ or Julahees. Ido not know what is the ground for this assertion, but the weavers who have not turned Mahommedans are certainly sometimes or generally known as ‘ Korees’ and considered to be low in the social scale. . There are no aboriginal tribes, of the character which I have been describing, in the Himalayas. The Kolees of the Simla hills and Domes of Kumaon are merely inferior castes living among the general population. Both in Kumaon and Nepal, there seems to be a sort of tradition or popular belief of the existence in some remote forests of a ‘ Ban-manush’ or wild man of the woods, but I cannot find that any one has ever seen one of these creatures, or that his —; o— existence is really in any way authenticated. One can hardly say whe- ther the story points to the recent disappearance of the last remnants of an ancient race, or whether it is merely a nursery tale. | It is not then in the Himalayas, but in the forests at their foot, that we must look for some aboriginal tribes. And here I must ~ observe that I think the use of the term Sub-Himalayan by Hodg- © son, and (following him) by most other authorities, leads to a good deal 7 of misapprehension, from an Indian point of view at least. We are ee in the habit of considering the Simla hills, Kumaon, and Nepal to be — part of the Himalayas (and with good reason too I think), but Hodgson calls everything below the Snowy Range ‘‘ Sub-Himalayan,” and classes as ‘Sub-Himalayan’ people who live higher than th | highest mountaineers in Europe, in the most precipitous mountains, — 8,000 or 10,000 feet high; while the people really living under th hills are usually put in another class. I am now about to notice The Ethnology of India. 47 tribes who have nothing whatever to do with the hills, but live in the forests and what is called the ‘ Terai,’ at the foot. No two climates and locations can be more dissimilar than those of the hills and the Terai, and no races are more distinct in their habits, manners, and aptitudes than the people of the hills and those of the jungle belt below. It may be generally said that there is no Terai or forest belt northwest of the Seharunpore district and the Dehra Dhoon; but thence eastward this belt stretches along the foot of the hills through Rohileund, Oude, and the Bengal Frontier, up to Assam. A great part of it belongs to the Nepalese. A very interesting paper by Dr. Stewart on the Boksas, a forest tribe found in western Rohilcund and in part of the forests or Sewalik hills of Dehra Dhoon, was published in the Society’s Journal last year. They are entirely con- fined to the forest tracts, where they enjoy a wonderful immunity _ from the effects of malaria. They never (says Dr. Stewart) settle more _ than two years on one spot, but after getting a little out of the soil, * move to fresh locations. They are of short stature and spare habit, and i 7 ‘in feature certainly Turanian of some sort, with broad faces, depressed - noses, prognathous jaws, thick lips, and very scanty beard and ~ moustaches, but in colour apparently not darker than the ordinary Hindoos of the country. They are fond of game and pigs, eat almost % anything, have no caste, and are reputed to be very skilful in witch- ‘craft. They have no separate language. They are simple, inoffensive, and good-humoured, but very ignorant and indolent. Their culti- vation is very scanty and rude, but they also collect forest produce and wash for gold. They are supposed to be dying out. I have seen mention of another small and savage tribe in the Rohilcund Terai called “ Rawats’’ or “ Rajis ;”’ and passing westward We come to a very important tribe, the ‘ Tharoos,’ who in fact occupy all the Terai from eastern Rohilcund all along the frontiers of Oude and into Goruckpore. They are in many respects very like the Boksas—in physical appearance and manners I should say extremely like—but they are much more industrious, and altogether a larger, more settled, and, one may say, less savage tribe. They, like the Boksas, keep exclusively to the Terai and forest, living where no one else can live. They are shy and timid, but frank and truthful, when you get hold of 48 The Ethnology of India. them, and are very good cultivators in their own simple way. They are not particularly dark, and, in addition to the ordinary breadth and flatness of face, have a good deal of the Chinese-looking form of eye; so that it is difficult from appearance to say, whether they really belong to the Negrito, or to the Indo-Chinese stock. The fact is that | though no two races can be more unlike one another than the slim, black, tangled-haired Negrito, and the stout, fair, lank haired Thibetan, yet when we come to half-breeds, the difference may not be so great. When the colour is softened or heightened, and the size increased or ALS decreased to that of the ordinary Hindoo, and the hair reduced to civilised limits, there is the same appearance of breadth and flatness of face, and these latter characteristics are more apparent at a glance than < oe any distinction between prognathous and pyramidal skulls. It would seem too that the Chinese peculiarity of eye is caused by the broad cheek bone common to both races, and perhaps it may be that while the eye being sunk deeper in the Negro and Negrito, and more _ covered by a more fleshy form of face its form is not so apparent, in ¢ the half-breed it is brought out, and the skin tightened by the high — cheek-bone shows the Chinese-looking form of eye. I have noticed some of the Ghatwals on the borders of Bengal and Behar, who looked ~ not unlike Goorkas. Thus then it becomes difficult to distinguish ; those tribes, on the northern and eastern frontiers, whose blood may be | supposed to have become a good deal mixed by long contact witha other races, and whose colour may have been softened by the cool, moist @ and shady climate of the Northern Terai. f I must also say that I think Hodgson has somewhat contributed to mix up the two races in our ideas, for in his enthusiasm to establish an connection between his Tamulians and the eastern races, he scarcely _ attempts to distinguish them, and classes as Tamulians, Bodos, Dhimals, — i &c. of whose connection with the Aborigines of the South of india there does not seem to be the slightest evidence in language, and who in appearance are as different as can be. | : a To return to the ‘ Tharoos;’ as I said their appearance might . doubt of their origin, and unfortunately they are not known to have any language of their own. Those with whom we have come more imme- diately in contact (including all those in eastern Rohilcund) certainly 4 now speak Hindee, but the tribe is so large and important, that The Ethnology of India. 49 would be, I think, desirable not to give up without farther inquiry the attempt to find a Tharoo language, though it will be more difficult now that, by the transfer of the Oude Terai, the great mass of them, and all those least mixed with Hindustanees, are Nepal subjects. In other respects the habits and manners of the Boksas and Tharoos certainly point rather to an Indian than a Thibetan origin. I saw something of the Tharoos before they were annexed to Nepal; and their general style suggests a good deal of resemblance to the Santals for instance. Mr. Robert Drummond, who has served both in Pillebheet and in Central India, and who knew the Tharoos well, tells me that in many ways they remind him very much of the Aboriginal tribes of the Central hills. They have the same simple ways and the same _ religion of Bhoots and familiar spirits. He also mentions a singular circumstance, that on looking over a map of the hill country of Bhau- _gulpore (now called the Santal Pergunnahs), he was struck by the occurrence of many names which he had supposed to be peculiar to the - Tharoos. The claim of the Boksas to Rajpoot origin is of course ridiculous, but it is clear that all their traditions point to the south and south- west as the country of their origin, not to the northern hills. These ibes have in fact little intercourse with and no known congeners in the hills. The Boksas and Western Tharoos are separated from the Thibetan tribes by a great tract of very difficult country occupied by Arians; and though the Eastern Tharoos are nearer to Nepalese races who show Thibetan blood, it seems hardly probable that inhabitants of the hills should be driven out into the Forest below (of which the hi ll-men have a great horror); while, that Aboriginal Indians should be driven from the plains to the neighbouring jungles, would be probable enough, I am inclined to think that the Tharoos and Boksas are bi p ‘obably not Thibetan, farther than the accession of refugees and others from Nepal may have introduced a little of that blood. Dy. Stewart “suggests the possibility that they may be akin to the Indo-Chinese aces who occupy the lowlands near the Berhampooter; but though that may be possible, it seems to be a long way for emigrant tribes to fin ind their way up to the Dehra Dhoon in countries where, for so many | Witared miles, there is no trace of their congeners. On the whole, it seems more probable that they are Aboriginal Indians a good deal i) SN PERERA SLE LEAL ALT Sa = 50 The Ethnology of India. diluted. I have not heard of the Tharoos serving as labourers, but if they are akin to the Dhangar Coolees now so much sought after, seeing their Immunity against malaria, they would be very valuable to any one who could induce them to emigrate. As yet, however, they are very shy. From Goruckpore eastward in the Nepal Terai and along the Frontiers of Bengal, I cannot learn that there are any Aboriginal tribes till we come to the neighbourhood of Sikkim and Kooch Behar. Those whom I have asked knew of none, and it is probable that if there were any, Hodgson would have mentioned them. Dr. Campbell of Darjeeling speaks generally of the population of the Nepal Terai as composed of a most varied assemblage of bastard Hindus. The Kooch Behar people have become so Hinduised, that theli original character cannot be distinguished with certainty. They call themselves ‘‘ Rajbansees,” as I think do several Hinduised Aboriginal tribes. About this parallel we come upon the Meches or Mechis who ford the chief population of-the forests and Doars at the foot of the Sikkim and Bhootan hills, and a few of whom have recently settled in the extreme eastern portion of the Nepal Terai. I understand that these people are the same as the Bodos of Hodgson, who are of Hl : an Indo-Chinese family. I shall rank them and other similar tribes — as ‘ Borderers,’ and now only notice them for the parpose of com: — Th 5 parison, They are described as very Mongolian or Indo-Ohinese in — feature, fairer than the Hindus and of a yellow tinge, taller and larger than the Nepalese cultivators, addicted to spirits and to smoking — opium. They make small and temporary clearances in the forest and are proof against malaria. In an industrial point of view they are evidently much inferior to the Tharoos. Dr. Campbell incidentally mentions among the lowland neighbours. of the Mechis a tribe inhabiting similar tracts called ‘ Fhawas’ whom I have not seen mentioned elsewhere. They seem (so far as one can gather from the slightest notices) to be more industrious and settled than the Mechis. Dr. Campbell seems to speak of them as a different race. It would be ‘interesting to know whether these Thawas may not possibly be related to the Tharoos. Also among the neighbours of the Mechis are the Garrows, whowe main habitat is the hill country Just within fue end’ of the Berham: The Ethnology of India. 51 pooter as it sweeps round from Assam into Bengal, the extreme western portion of the range which separates Sylhet, &c. from Assam. More to the east are the Cossya hills, to the west those of the Garrows. While all the tribes of the eastern hills are Indo- Chinese, I am inclined to suspect that the Garrows alone are Indian Aborigines, more or less mixed it may be. They seem to be quite distinct and different from the other tribes of the neighbourhood, and several officers, to whom I have talked, agree in thinking them more in the style of Coles and Bheels than of Indo-Chinese. I have not found any very exact description of them, but gather that they are small and dark, savage and troublesome. That they should belong to the Aboriginal races of India, is primd facie by no means impro- bable, seeing that their hill country is, as the crow flies, scarcely more than 150 miles distant from that of the Santals and Rajmehalees, as may be seen by a glance at any map. There is a kind of straight between the eastern and western hills through which the Ganges and Berhampooter run before expanding in the broader Delta of Southern Bengal. The little that is known of the language of the Garrows has not sufficed to connect them with any of the Aboriginal tribes mentioned hi by me, but it also seems to show that it is radically different from s _ the surrounding Indo-Chinese dialects. It seems especially desirable b _ to know something more of the Garrows and their language. rd Ihave kept to the last the Bhooyas or Bhooians, because they _ Seem to belong to both sides of Bengal, to West Bengal and Orissa on _ one side, and to Assam on the other. I have not met with any de- _ tailed account of their position in Assam, but I imagine that there ean be no better authority than Col. Dalton who intimately knows / “Poth Provinces, and he, while describing them in the western hills, | distinctly states that they were once the dominant race in Assam. ‘tt is always necessary to be cautious in dealing with names of this ‘sound, since, as I have already mentioned, ‘ Bhoomea’ means ‘ man of the soil,’ and I believe that the word earth or soil also takes the form ‘Bui. The Bhooyas have no immediate connection (that is looking only to the name) with either the Bhumiz or the Boyars. But Col. Dalton no doubt looks farther than this; and indeed he goes on to notice a considerable connection between Assam and the west both te * a a a SSS t32? PERCE ? 52 The Ethnology of India. im races and in language. The Bhooyas in the west seem to be numerous. They appear to be the original occupants of much of the lower country to the south of the Chota-Nagpore plateau, great part of Singbhoom and Bonai, and the borders of Orissa. From a portion of their country they have been partly driven and partly they are dominated over by Coles, themselves probably impelled south and east by pres- sure from the north and west. They are still very numerous in all the districts and petty states hereabouts, and are found more or less all the way across the lower hill-country to the borders of Behar. Col. Dalton calls them a dark complexioned race, with rather high cheekbones, but not otherwise peculiar. They have no language of their own, but speak Oorya on the Ooriah borders, Bengalee on the borders of Bengal, and Hindee farther north. They are now some- what Hinduised, but have still priests of their own and traces of an old religion, which seems even down to recent times to have included human sacrifices. Major Fickell speaks of the Aboriginal Bhooians who preceded the Coles in lower Singbhoom as “an inoffensive simple race, but rich in cattle and industrious cultivators.” The: descriptions of Col. Dalton and Major Tickell seem to suggest a resemblance in appearance to the Ooryahs, among whom high cheek bones seem to prevail with good features and straight hair. The Bhooyas whom I have seen in the hills towards the Bahar border seemed to have a larger dash of the black Aboriginal type. Seeing how far these Bhooyas are spread to the west, I was curious to know whether they might be related to the Buis, a tribe of Telengana and — Central India who serve all over the centre, south, and west as palanquin bearers and domestic servants, and from whose name is, E believe, the most authentic derivation of the widespread word Pus ‘ Boy’ as applied to a dark servant. Travelling from Nagpore towards — Jubbulpore IE observed that I changed the Buis of Central India for the Kahars of Hindoostan. Col. Dalton did not know whether there — was any connection between Bhooyas and Buis. But quite recently, — making a trip through a part of the Chota-Nagpore country, I found — that the palanquin was carried by. Bhooyas there and below the hill country till I got close to Gya, and I ascertained that they had no connection with the Hindoostanee Kahars by whom they were then relieved, but were considered to be a wholly different race. I cannot The Ethnology of India. 53 help thinking that the Bhooya palanquin bearers of Chota-Nagpore may be the same as the Buis of Nagpore Proper. At any rate it might be worth inquiring. These Bhooyas or Bhooians have been reputed to be the Aborigifies of Bengal, and if that be so, it would quite account for their being found both in Orissa in the west and in Assam on the east. The difficulty is that there seem to be no such people now in Bengal, nor have I been able to identify them with any caste under another name. If, however, one travels in a palanquin from the Chota-Nagpore country into Bengal or Orissa, the bearers will be relieved not by Kahars as in Hindoostan, but by Gwallas or cow-keepers. These Gwallas do the work of palanquin- bearing and domestic service in Bengal, functions not performed by Gwallas so far as I know in any other part of India. An Aheer or up-country Gwala would never dream of such work. In fact the Gwallas in Bengal take the place of the Buis or Boys of the centre and south of India. They are now the most numerous Hindoo caste in Bengal and especially in Orissa. As I said, Major Tickell describes the original Bhooians as rich in cattle. May not the _ Hindoos have adopted them and turned them into Gwallas? I _ should also however mention that the lowest or sweeper class are called I understand in Bengal “ Buimals,” but I have not been able to ascertain the derivation of that word. The Bengalees are certainly in many respects different from any other people of India, and if the Bhooyas are the Aboriginals of a ‘great part of Bengaly we may the more readily believe that they are ‘in fact different from the Coolees and Dravidians who have gone to compose the Hindoostanees and Southerners respectively. Who they are, and where they came from, are questions which open out a wide field of inquiry. Can any Aboriginal language or words spoken by them be traced? may they have any dash of more eastern blood? Is the mode of carrying palanquins rather a Chinese than an Arian fashion ? If we knew something more of the Garrows and the Garrow lan- guage, they might possibly supply.a link in the history of Bengal. Another race mentioned by Col. Dalton, as found both in the West and in Assam, are the Kolitas, whose name might suggest some relation to Coolees; but they seem to be now considered rather high 54 Lhe Hihnology of India. caste and good looking Hindoos, so the name is probably not the same. Is every direction, however, there is room for inquiry. One word regarding a people in another quarter who have been classed with the Indian Aborigines, the Brahuis of the higher parts of Belochistan near Khelat, &c. These people are set down as allied to the Dravidians upon, I think, the slightest possible evidence, but itis one of those things that, having once got into print, is in the absence | of farther information repeated again and again, till it seems an =m established fact. Dr. Caldwell, in his amiable enthusiasm for his > beloved Dravidians, and seeking to establish for them an aristocratic 4 pedigree, without acknowledging obligation to the northern Hindoos, ef seizes upon the Brahuis as the link to connect them with the more E northern nations and goes somewhat into the matter. The Brahuis are described as a stout, squat, somewhat flat- faced people, fair, with hair and beards often brown if not red. That they have indications of some Turanian element both in feature and PRE ae speech, may be at once admitted, using the word Turanian in its widest e sense ; but for the rest anything in greater contrast to the slim black ‘) Dravidian Aborigines, it is impossible to imagine. They are very — remote from any Dravidian tribe, the nearest being the Gonds. Their — language is not supposed to show any affinity to the Kolarians. § On the other hand, in one direction we have not far to seek for an explanation of the Turanian element in the features of the Brahuigill The Hazarehs of the hill country near Ghuznee and Candahar have ib in a more marked degree, and are without doubtof Mongolian blood. — They seem to be in many ways like the Brahuis, and we are told a that at one time they possessed the country on the Khelat side of i Candahar, and were nearer than they now are to the Brahuis. That — the latter have some of their blood, or may even be a branch of them — driven to the hills by Belochees or Hindoos, would seem prima facie the most probable thing in the world. It is then only by the test of — language that any Dravidian connection can be assigned to the Brahuis, and in the case of people otherwise so dissimilar and so dis-— tant, the linguistic evidence ought to be very strong, to satisfy us. a have been unable to find a paper giving a list of Brahui words said to have been published by this Society, but Dr. Caldwell seems to. sum up all the evidence on the subject. He admits that “ the Brahui = a a A np? eee aaah el oe eo The Ethnology of India. DD . language, considered as a whole, is derived from the same source as the Punjabee and Scindee” (in which no one ever suspected a Dravidian connection), but he goes on to show that the Brahui has also a Dravi- dian element in it. Now there are scarcely any two languages in which here and there words of similar meaning and similar sound may not be found, but so far as the vocabulary goes, Dr. Caldwell’s list seems to show that he must have been very hard put to it. ‘ Khaff,’ the ear, and ‘ pid,’ the belly, seem to me at least as near to the Hindoostanee ‘ kan’ and ‘ pet’? as to the Dravidian ‘ kadw’ and ‘ pir’ or ‘bir.’ ‘ Kat,’ a bedstead is, I think, distinctly a Hindee or Punjabee word. ‘* Dir,’ water, seems to me as near to the Kolarian ‘ dah’ as to the Dravidian ‘mir.’ ‘ Ae’ or ‘ ayi,’ a mother or nurse, and ‘ pussie,’ a cat, are words of world-wide use. So also the pronoun ‘nv’ or ‘nim,’ thou or you, appears in some shape in every dialect not purely Arian, from Australia to northern Siberia and from Japan to Finland. I really cannot find above 6 or 8 words which Dr. Caldwell shows to be especially like Dravidian words, _andto make out these, he picks and chooses from every one of the different Dravidian dialects and accepts some rather distant resem- _ blances as ‘pak’ to go, Tamil ‘pogu.’ This much seems to me to _ prove nothing whatever. Again, take his grammatical resemblances. Some seem to be too wide, applying to many other languages, and others too minute. The i use of postpositions and the want of comparatives and superlatives in | adjectives is equally a coincidence with Hindoostanee and many other languages, neighbours of the Brahui on one side. The expression of _ gender by separate words and of plurals by postfixes denoting plurality _ is equally common to many other languages, including the neighbour ‘of the Brahui on the other side, the Persian, e. g. ‘nar-gow’ a ‘* male tow,’ and Aspahan ‘ horses.’ The genitive in ‘na’ seems just as like to the Hindoostanee and Punjabee ‘ka’ or ‘da’ as to the Tamilian ‘ ma.’ ‘The dative-accusative in ‘e’ is a familiar Hindoostanee or Punjabee form, thus instead of ‘ Mujh-ko do’ Give me, it is constantly ‘ Mujhe do, and ‘ Use maro’ beat him, especially with the Punjabees. So also ‘ten,’ said by Dr. Caldwell to mean ‘ self’ in Brahui, seems very like the same syllable used to give precision in Hindoostanee as ‘“ Use-ten do,” which I should translate ‘ give to lim himself” At any rate ‘ten’ is found nearer at hand than the Dravidian ‘ tan.’ 66 The Ethnology of India. Persian, and not go all the way to the Canarese for it. It comes then in my view to this that the only real appearance of analogy to- the Dravidian class of languages in particular (as distin- The copulative ‘w’ ‘and,’ most people would think palpable guished from the body of Turanian languages in general) is reduced to two numerals. In Brahui neither ‘ one’ nor ‘ four’ and upwards in the least correspond with Dravidian numerals, but the two numbers ‘two’ and ‘ three’ as given by Dr. Caldwell do seem similar. He gives the Brahui two, ‘ zrat’ and three, ‘ muszt’ or ‘ muozrt? which bear com- parison with the Dravidian two, ‘ eradu,’ ‘crandu,’ ‘ randu,’ ‘ ranw’ and three, ‘murw’ ‘ mudu,’ ‘ mundu,’ ‘ munnar,’ ‘ munu, The Brahui one ‘ asit’ seems very like the Pehlevi ‘ achat,’ and ¢ the Brahui irat may come from the Pehlevi ‘tarein’ two, the Cauca- — sian ‘derw’ and the Georgian ‘ort.’ If so the ‘three’ would be the © ' only tie to the Dravidians left, and that is not very close. The | ground of induction seems insufficient to connect such dissimilar 4 people. My impression is, that if, instead of saying that the Brahui — language is mainly Punjabee with a Dravidian element, Dr. Caldwell had said that it is mainly Arian (Indo-Persic) with a Turanian — element, that would have been more correct. At any rate in so important a matter fuller inquiry is necessary. THE MODERN INDIANS. I commence with the Bramins. | It is well-known that the Bramins as Priests are a necessary part of every Hindu society, and as Priests they are to be found wherever — there are Hindus. In that character then it would be unnecessary 7 to my purpose more particularly to trace them, for with their reli- — gious sects and tenets I do not deal. I shall only trace them fo : Kthnological purposes through the countries in which they form one important part of the general secular population. In fact, far from being restricted to the character of Priests, they are one of the most numerous castes in India, and probably that which follows the greatest variety of avocations. On the whole I should say that they ar ‘ less prejudiced than any other of those whom I call full-blown or High Hindus. At any rate, whether it be that their character as keepers an . expounders of the Law gives them greater licence, or that their intellect The Ethnology of India. 57 is more varied and their necessities greater, they do in various places and under various circumstances turn their hands to very many odd jobs as it were. Throughout Hindustan they have almost entirely : lost that function of Clerks and Bureaucrats of the community _ which they still retain toa great extent in other parts of India; and it will be as members of the ordinary agricultural populations that I shall most deal with them. | Beginning from the north, we first meet with the Bramins in that J quarter to which all their traditions point, within the hills north of the Punjab. The first Indians encountered by a traveller from Central Asia would be these Bramins of this extreme North-West corner, occupying both the valley of Kashmir and the hills imme- diately to the west and south-west of it. Kashmir is a Bramin country. The lower classes have long been converted to Mahommedanism, but they seem to be ethnologically identical with the Bramins, and tradition also asserts that they are _ of the same race. At the present day no other Hindu caste save the Bramin is known, nor is there any trace (so far as I could find) ¢ that there ever was any other in the country. The Bramin popula- } tion ‘is numerous, but it would seem as if, while the illiterate multitude adopted the religion of the ruling power, the better edu- ~ eated and superior class maintained their own tenets; and at this day the Bramins (or Pandits, as they are usually called) form quite a sort of aristocracy. hey are almost all educated and exceedingly clever, : and so, being to a great degree above manual labour, they are an €xcessive and somewhat oppressive Bureaucracy, which not only has ‘Yuled Kashmir under every successive government, but sends out t colonies to seek a livelihood throughout Northern India. The Kash- | imtermixture of the blood of any lower race. It may be partly race nd partly occupation, but they have certainly a greater refinement and regularity of feature than the Affghans and others of a rougher type ; with, however, a less manly-looking physique and a colour less ruddy and more inclining to a somewhat. sallow fairness. The high nose, slightly aquiline, but by no means what we call Jewish or Nut-cracker, is a common type. Raise a little the brow of a Greek 58 The Ethnology of India. statue, and give the nose a small turn at the bony point in front of the bridge (so as to break the straightness of line), you have then the model type of this part of India, to be found both in the living men and in the statues dug up in the Peshawar valley. There arealsoa good many straight noses, and some varieties as in all places, but much less departure from an ordinary handsome standard than in most countries. wet! Al The figure of the ordinary working Kashmeeree is strong and athletic. But none of them are martial, and the Bramins are in this respect no exception. They rule by the brain and the pen, and not by the sword. It is this character that has gained them the favour of so many rulers of a different faith. Kashmere long belonged to the Cabul kingdom, but it was never in any degree colonised by Affghans, and is singularly free from any modern’ intermixture of foreign races. The fact seems to be that the valley never belonged to the Affghan nation, — but was always retained asa Crown Appanage of the kings, who were very jealous of admitting into it subjects whom they might find it difficult to turn out again, and much preferred to govern through the Pandits. Others have to a great extent followed the same policy. a From a Hindu point of view, the Kashmir Bramins do not rank well. As they are Priests to no one but themselves, they are necessarily much more secular than Bramins who among other © Hindus claim to be a priestly class, while they eat meat and are altogether loose in their observances, to an extent which makes them — very far short of the modern Hindu standard. They are in fact not — recognised among the modern Divisions of Indian Bramins, belonging — neither to the 5 Gours nor to the 5 Dravidas, but forming a class apart. 1 have alluded to their attempt to claim the blood of all the © Bramins higher in the sacerdotal scale, and suggested that it is “ney LP « ee ee more probable that the latter have sprung from and (in their sense} — improved upon the Kashmeerees. In fact, the founder of the latter — (Kashiyupa who drained the lake, colonised the valley, gave his name to Kashgar and Kashmere and to the people originally called Kashas or Kassias,) is still recognised by the Bramins and Hindus as the first of the seven Rishis, and even far away down on the west coast of India, the Bramins in general still trace their descent to Kashiyup vo I shall afterwards notice the name Kash as Khas occurring again and again in other parts of India, in a way which requires explanation. Ft 7 | The Ethnology of India. D9 The Kashmeeree Pandits are known all over Northern India as a very clever and energetic race of office-seekers. As a body they excel in acuteness the same number of any other race with whom they come in contact. Probably they are in no respect inferior to the Maratta Bramins, but they have not in Hindustan the same ad- vantage as the latter have had in their own country among inferior races. The Kashmeerees, as foreigners among energetic races, have a much harder struggle, and though they get a good share of good things, they are nowhere dominant, nor have they usually risen to _ such high stations as many Maratta Bramins. The most conspicuous man whom I recollect was Raja Denonath, Ranjeet Sing’s Financier and in some respects Chief Minister. Although the Kashmeerees seldom find their way as far as Caleutta, it is somewhat singular that in Bengal the first native to attain very high office is a man of this race, viz., Shamboonath Pandit, Judge of the High Court. Almost all the secular Pandits use the Persian character freely; they are perfectly versatile, and, serving abroad, will mount a horse, gird on a sword, and assume at a push a semi-military air. The Kashmir language is separate and distinct, and the dress, manners, and fashions of the Kashmeerees mark them as in every way a distinct people. Of the language we only know that it contains a very large proportion of Sanscrit. The Institutions of the people have nothing of the democratic character. In the hills also, between Kashmir and the Punjab, Bramins occupy the van (or perhaps we should call it the rear) of the Indian race to the west, though they have abandoned their Hindoo teligion and become partly Mahommedans and partly Sikhs. They are in habits, language, and manners quite different from the Kash- Meerees, and seem now to belong to a different nation. Their language is a dialect of the Punjabee (a very Pracrit tongue and cer- tainly not borrowed from any Mahommedan race), while they are good Soldiers and altogether more Punjabees than Kashmeerees. Beyond the Jhelum, the hill frontier is occupied by a tribe called Bambas, now Mahommedans, but originally Bramins ; while on this side the Jhelum the hills are shared with other races by a numerous tribe of Bramin- Sikhs. The position of these men is curious. They became Sikhs long before the extension of Sikh power to those regions, and in a ee 60 The Ethnology of India. much more complete sense than most modern Sikhs, abandoning all pretence of Hindoo religion and adopting to the full the Sikh reformer’s tenets. Indeed they were converted during Mahommedan rule, and when ‘ Sikh’ was really a religious rather than a political — name. The fact probably is, that they found the country too hot for Bramins, but did not care to become Mahommedans, so adopted the alternative of becoming Sikhs, and so free from the trammels of caste. These men are very useful soldiers and servants, especially under Sikh rule. A good many of them have been introduced into Kashmir as a sort of military colonists, partly by a Hindu governor under the Affghans, and partly by the Sikh rulers ; but they remain quite apart q from the Kashmir Bramins. One of the best native officers m the Punjab force, who is himself of this class, told me that the Bambas are without doubt Bramins under a corrupted name. He says that — to this day the Sikh Bramins and Bambas exchange cakes on the — occasion of certain ceremonies (births, funerals, &. 1 think), and that . there is no doubt that they are of the same stock. I believe that it certainly is so. It seems to be a common practice in India to give to — tribes who have departed from the faith or mixed the blood of their ancestors, names derived from their original tribal names. Thus half- _ civilised Bheels are called ‘ Bheelalahs ;’ Mahommedan Rajpoots are called ‘‘ Rangars ;’’ a tribe of bastard Bramins to be afterwards noticed — (in Benares and Bahar) ‘ Bamuns’ or ‘ Babhans.’ E The Bramins of the frontier hills are, I think, even handsomer — than the Kashmeerees. To my view, the people in general of those hills are the handsomest of the human race. n. Descending from the Himalayas, there are some Bramins near the foot of the hills. Except a few priests, Ido not think that they are found beyond the Indus, but they are, I understand, pretty numerous in part of the Rawal Pindee district. South of the Salt Range, _ in the plains, they are well nigh overwhelmed by the strong flow of Rajpoots and Jats (advancing, as I believe, at a later period and from. another direction). The Bramins either never occupied the plains of the Punjab to the south-west, or they have been driven from that country. Even nearer the hills they are not exceedingly numerous. Bt t still in that fertile and pleasant strip under the hills we have, amo oo other races, villages of agricultural Bramins in the districts of Sealkot, The Ethnology of India. 61 Goordaspore &c., in the valleys of the broken country between Hosheearpore and Kangra, and in parts of Umballa district and the adjoining Simla hills; and thus we, as it were, mark the trail of the Bramin race in its progress southwards from the hills of Kashmir to the banks of the sacred Saroostee or Saraswatee and the famous field of the Gulcheter at Tanessur close to the Grand Trunk Road, some thirty miles south of Umballa. _ Here also the Bramin population in the country is not specially numerous. Other races have swept over the scene. But lower down _the course of the Saraswatee, where it may be traced through the } now somewhat desolate countries of Marwar and Jessulmere, the ; Bramins are still numerous. Where the low and comparatively moist tracts, in which the river once ran, still admit of cultivation, the Saraswatee Bramins are found very industrious and good culti- ators, who claim to have occupied the country before Jats and i Rajpoots became dominant. There is found (at Pokhar) the only _ temple in India still dedicated to the worship of Brama the Father. _ The town of ‘ Palli’ seems to be a Bramin centre, and thence come a race of mercantile Bramins called ‘ Palliwals.’ & Sir John Malcolm also mentions the Marwarree or Saraswatee Bramins as forming a considerable proportion of the most industrious cultivators in Malwa. And following the Saraswatee down to the Indus, we find hat (some southern immigrants excepted) they are also the Bramins “of Scinde, but said to be much looked down on by more orthodox _ southerners as eaters of meat and altogether little advanced Bramins. The settlement on the banks of the Saraswatee is a well-known ge of Hindu history. ‘Here the Bramins came in contact with ler races, castes were recognised, and early Hinduism became iterary and historical. But the extreme caste and religious system, the full-blown High-Hinduism of the Gangetic Bramins, was not yet. The descendants of those who continued to dwell on the Saraswatee seem to have much kept to the tenets of their forefatheis. ‘They are separate from the Kashmeerees and have a place among the recognised divisions of Indian Bramins, but their more advanced brethren give them the lowest place in the orthodox scale, and in their native country they chiefly shine by those simple and agricul- ‘tural virtues in which their remote ancestors also probably excelled. 62 The Ethnology of India. It is a curious problem, that lost river, the Saraswatee. The evi- dent river-traces all the way down to the Indus, ancient Hindu history, and the universal traditions of the people of those regions, all go to make it as certain as any historical fact can be, that the Saraswatee was once a fine river, and that the countries through which it flowed (now for the most part desert and barren) were once well- — watered and green. No mere diminution in the amount of rainfall, caused by denudations or the like, could have occasioned such as change. The outer range of the Himalaya runs all the way from the Sutlej to the Jumna without a break, and the tributaries of the Saraswatee receive but the outer drainage of the slope a few miles wide. No doubling or trebling of the rainfall could make any of these considerable perennial streams; nothing in fact short of a change of elevation of the ridges to the extent of several thousand feet would render possible any outlet in this quarter of the drainage — of the interior of the Himalayas. The Saraswatee itself is now not a stream at all, but an absolutely dry bed, which is only filled by surface flooding in the height of the rains. The high embankments on the present Grand Trunk Road, on the Umballa side of Thanessur _ or Peeplee, mark the levels, and show the hollow where a great river once flowed. I have long had a theory that, in truth, the stream now called the Jumna once flowed in this channel. The present channel of the Saraswatee points upwards to the point where the Jumna — issues from the hills, and ends in a confused drainage within 2 or 3 miles of that almost natural channel in which the Western Jumna — Canal (running more like a river than a canal) carries the Jumna — water in a course which eventually leads it lower down into the ve re bed of the Saraswatee. The Jumna at its first issue from the hills” ' runs in a course which points directly towards the Saraswatee and the lower Indus, and the moment you cross, to the west, the high’ bank (which is accumulated along the course of most rivers), the whole of the drainage of the country is to the Saraswatee and not to the Jumna. In fact the bed of the Jumna is higher than that of the Canal, to carry it directly into the Saraswatee channel, and I believe that to divert the whole river would be a work -within easy reach modern engineering. May it not then be that nature caused a change — The Ethnology of India. 63 the other way, that the stream now called the Jumna then belonged to the Saraswatee, but that those hill torrents from the Sewalik, bringing down masses of sand and earth, raised between them and the main stream a sort of James and Mary which eventually caused the latter to break away to the south-east? If the stream moved, most of the Hindus would probably move forward too and find them- selves in the Gangetic valley. The Saraswatee Bramins are also called (in the south at least) *‘ Kashastalee”’ a name which seems still to mark the time when they were considered to be of Kashmeeree or Kasha origin. In fact there seem to be several stages in the history of Braminism. The oldest of the race may be the people of the upper hills who date from a time altogether prior to Hinduism. The Kashmeerees were a civilised and literary Braminical people not yet fully Hindu. The Saraswatee Bramins (those Kasha settlers in the plains of India) were the earliest and most simple and pure Hindus of Vedic faith, that faith being now worked out and developed ; those of the Ganges and the rest of India are in various phases the types of modern Hinduism. From the Gulcheter down to Dehli and in the country about Dehli, Bramin villages are scattered about, but the Bramins cannot be said to constitute a very large proportion of the agricultural population. Wherever they are found in this country, they are capital cultivators, quiet, industrious, intelligent ; there is no better population, and the | Women work as well as the men. It was remarked by the fugitives | from Dehli at the time of the mutiny, that whenever they came to | & Goojar village, they were always plundered ; whenever they came to a Bramin village, they were always kindly treated ; while at any other | village their treatment was uncertain. These Bramins too are, I should think, descendants of the Saraswatee Bramins. Some of the less pure agricultural Bramins of these parts are called ‘ Tugas’ or | $Gour Tugas.’ South of Dehli, in the Jyepore country, Bramins seem to be numerous, but I have not been able to ascertain if they are of the same branch. In the Seharunpore district too there are a good many _| Bramins of secular occupations, besides the priests of Hardwar. | Sir H. Elliott has remarked on the difficulty of accounting for the | fact that all the Dehli country is occupied by ‘ Gour’ Bramins. They can hardly, he thinks, have come from Gour in Bengal, from which 64 The Ethnology of India. they are separated by great tribes of Kanoujeas and others, and their own traditions point to Harriana as their original country. I would suggest the following explanation. The principal tributary of the Saraswatee is the ‘ Guggur’ or ‘ Ghargar’ which now gives its name to the main channel where it passes through the Harriana district. May not the name of ‘ Gour,’ borne by these Bramins of Harriana, be a mere abbreviation of ‘Guggur’ or Ghargar? May not the Gour Bramins be simply Bramins of the Guggur or Lower Saraswatee ? Generally speaking I think it may be said that in the western parts of the present N. W. Provinces, in the Rohilcund, Meerut and j Agra Divisions and in Western Oude, the Bramin population is not — specially numerous. They are scattered about everywhere here and there, both as cultivators and in other capacities, but I know no large | body of them. I don’t know that they follow much any profession involving manual labour, except cultivation and almost any kind of service ; unskilled labour as Coolees or spade labourers, they may undertake when pressed, but I do not think that they are artisans. | There are a few considerable Bramin bankers in Hindustan, or at least one great house, but that trade is not generally in their hands. ~ Farther east, in the Lower Doab, Hastern Oude, and the adjoining districts, is the great country of the modern Hindustanee Bramins. Kanouj, the ancient head-quarters of the race, is on the old Ganges 50 or 60 miles above Cawnpore. It is now an insignificant place, and the mass of the Bramin population lies to the east of it. In the districts of Cawnpore and Futtehpore I believe that the Bramin cultivators far exceed in number any other class ; in Cawnpore alone there are some 250,000 of them. It is much the same immediately on the other side of the Ganges, in the adjoining parts of Oude. The country of which this is the centre may then more than a y other be considered especially that in which the Bramins are now settled as a people. And in the far distant country in which also the Western Ghats. The Lower Doab is well-known all over Centré ~and Southern India as the ‘‘ Unter-bed.”’ : The Eihnology of India. 65 Whether from the example of the Rajpoots, or for other reasons, these Bramins of the Unterbed and Oude have taken largely to the profession of arms, not usually much followed by them in other parts ofthe country ; and beyond their own boundaries in their Military character they are reputed the most overbearing and disagreeable of their race. Yet I fancy that it is rather their profession than their natural character, which has attached to them this bad name. Numer- _ ous as they were in the Sepoy Army and foully as that Army behaved, I cannot find that the Bramins were really by any means worse than others; some of the most Bramin Regiments stood the best. And at home they seem to be quiet and peaceable enough. _ The Bramin district of Cawnpore pays, I think, a higher revenue rate than any other in India, except the peculiar Delta of the Cauvery about Tanjore. Numerous as the Bramins are in this part of the country and apt as soldiers, they have not been the dominant race. I do not know much of the history of the Cawnpore district, but I have never heard of Bramin rule ; and certainly over the river, in Oude, the rule is with the Rajpoots, not with the Bramins. All the really old - Talookdars are Rajpoots, as are the Rajas of Bundlecund and Baghel- ~eund beyond the Jumna. - I[.am not sure what is the extent of the Bramin population in pBundlecund. In the Banda District I think that they are common, and certainly in ‘ Baghelcund,’ or Rewah, they are very numerous ; but Bethe the same martial race, I do not know, for there they sonal - peend to very menial services and groom most of the horses on the 4 ubbulpore road. In the proper Bramin country, I think that some of them affect ‘te Rajpoot prejudice against actually holding the plough, but even there they perform every other agricultural labour. Agri- cultural and military as they are, they rejoice in the classic names of Dobee, Tewaree, and Choubee, that is men of two Veds, of three Veds, of four Veds, and are considered to be very high caste. Between the | Ganges and the Gogra, as we recede from the Ganges, the population | becomes more Rajpoot than Bramin, but there are many Bramins | about ‘ Ajoodia,’ the old ‘ Oadh.’ Beyond the Gogra again is a nu- | merous Bramin population of a different tribe from the martial Bramins of the Ganges, humbler, and not soldiers, Thence to the * 66 The Ethnology of India. north of the Gogra and Ganges all the way into Tirhoot there are, I believe, many Bramins. South of the Gogra and thence across the Ganges, into the Arrah District (Bojpore), runs the Rajpoot dominions. But about Benares, and still more in the greater part of Bahar, the dominion is held by a numerous class of bastard Bramins called ‘ Bamans’ or ‘ Bhabans,’ to which belong both the Raja of Benares _ and almost all the great landholders of Bahar. There seems to be no doubt that this class is formed by an intermixture of Bramins with some inferior caste. They live in strong and pugnacious brother« hoods, and are in character much more like Rajpoots than Bramins. The main country of the Bramins may then be described to be that 4 part of Hindustan (between the Vyndyas on one side and the Hima- layas on the other), from the longitude of Kanouj and Lucknow to near the frontiers of Bengal, with a large segment of more especially Rajpoot country (stretching from Lucknow to Bojpore) — cut out of the centre of this tract. £ The Hindustanee Bramins are all strict Hindus of the modern type, i They are generally good sized and on the whole well-looking men, not I think particularly fair among the higher castes, but seldom so dark as the lower. Their features are good, but by no means ‘a generally of the peculiar High-Arian and sub-aquiline type. In fact the breed has here lost some of the purity of its blood, and the features are very much as in Europe. I think I have noticed among many of the Hindustanee Bramins a good deal of the open, blunt, bullet-headed, and as it were anti-aquiline style of countenance ; not | so handsome as more High-Arian features, but still pleasant enough. I do not think that in appearance they have any decided superiority over the higher castes of Hindustanees in general, though the higher | castes have some general advantages over the inferior castes. By ~ far the greater number of them are quite illiterate and have nothing | of the clerkly character about them. The priests and Pandits are learned _ enough in their way, but they have never taken to the use of the | Persian character. I doubt whether Hindustanee Bramins are as @ ~ as they have done in several other parts of India. As it 1s, they have scarcely any share of high office and very little literate services : The Ethnology of India, 67 Besides serving as soldiers, they may be found among the lower hangers-on of courts, jails, &c., as process servers, guards over prisoners, and so on, but little in anything higher. As I have said, they turn their hands to many miscellaneous occupations not peculiar to any one else, and of course occasionally rise. Sir H. Elliott calls the bastard Bramins of Benares and Bahar * Bhoonhars’ and seems to consider them a branch of the Sarwarea or Transgogra Bramins. Again he speaks of them (quoting from the ‘ Harivansa’) as Military Bramins descendants of Kasya Princes, and here he seems:to connect the term Kasya with Kashee, the Hindoo name for Benares. I do not know the derivation of Kashee, or whether it is connected with Kashupya. Bramins are numerous in Kumaon and Gurwhal. The great tribe of those Provinces are however ‘ Khassias’” who now claim to be - Rajpoots, but whose title to that character is more than doubtful. Education is, I think, more general here than in the plains, and the Nagaree or ordinary Sanscrit character is always used. Again the Goorkhas, the dominant tribe in Nepal, are properly called ‘ Khas,’ whence Gor-khas. They are certainly for the most part of Arian and Hindoo origin, and pretend to be Rajpoots; but, according to Mr. Hodgson, they are really bastard Bramins, the offspring of a cross between Bramin immigrants and the people of the hills. Both the Khassias of Kumaon and the Khas of Nepal assert that they are “comparatively recent immigrants from the plains, but this is probably in a great degree connected with their claim. to the blue blood of the Rajpoots: of the plains. The latter by no means acknowledge the connection. The circumstance that a bastard Bramin race is dominant inthe plains immediately under the Central parts of Nepal gives much colour to Mr. Hodgson’s account of a similar race in the hills, May it not be that the Rajpoots have never got so far east in the hills, and that the hill country was occupied by pre-Rajpoot Bramins ? May it be that the names Kashee, Khassia, and Khas, point to a time when the Bramins were known as Khasas or Kashmeerees, just as English colonists are known as Anglo-Saxons ? | Myr. B. Colvin, long Deputy Commissioner of Almorah, tells me a curious circumstance, viz. that in Kumaon, although the hill dialect is in the main Hindee, it has some curious grammatical affinities to 68 The Ethnology of India. the Bengalee, both in some of the popular terminations, in the verb ‘to be,’ and in other particulars. I had before learned that there was a peculiarity of this kind in the Hindee spoken in the high country immediately south of Bahar, but there I supposed it to be a mere intermixture of the not distant Bengalee. The existence, however, of Bengalee affinities in the patois of Kumaon would seem to suggest the question whether these are not the remains of a form of Arian speech older that the modern Hindee, spoken perhaps before Rajpoots and Jats came on the scene, and then driven forward to Bengal in one direction, into the hills in another. I have not myself any acquaintance with Bengalee, but it would be interesting to enquire ifit has any affinities with the older forms of speech in — Kashmir and the north-western hills, or again with the Maratta . and western dialects. To get an idea of the Bengalee formation, I asked a friend the other day a single word, the pronoun ‘he’ and the genitive ‘ of him,’ which he gave me ‘ Se’ and ‘ Zaha’ or ‘ Tah.’ At this present writing, by way of experiment, I have just turned up these same words in Mr. Edgeworth’s small Kashmir Grammar and find ‘he,’ ‘ Sw ;’ ‘of him’ ‘Teh.’ The ‘ Se’ is a very old Arian form, found in the Kaffir hills, which disappears in Hindee and reappears in Bengalee ; but the genitive ‘Teh’ in Cashmiree, ‘ Tah’ in Bengalee, seems a singular and hardly accidental coincidence. j To return, this brings me to the Bengalee Bramins. They all assert a northern origin as a historical fact, and I believe that there is no doubt of it. Still their nationality is altogether Bengalee, and as the Bengalees differ from all other Indians, these Bramins" also differ much in language, dress, habits, and general style from the Hindustanee Bramins. : r In appearance they are certainly fairer, larger, and altogether Aryans of a higher type than the mass of the Bengalees. There is much more difference, I think, between Bramins and the mass ing Bengal than in Hindustan. Some of them are fine looking men both in size and feature. They regain here too, some (though not all) . of the aristocratic and bureaucratic position which. they have lost in Hindustan. They have little competition from Rajpoots and | rough northern tribes, and might have it pretty much their own way, a ‘ a The Ethnology of India. 69 were it not that they are hard-pushed by the clerkly caste of Kaits who also are numerous in Bengal. As it is, the Bramins have a large share of the landed property, the public offices, the educated professions, and some mercantile and banking business, They are very numerous. In the entire absence of statistics and detailed information in Bengal, the only source of ethnological information which I can find is in the jail statistics. These show that about 9 per cent. of the total number of Hindu prisoners are Bramins. We may suppose that the Bramins of Bengal proper come to jail less frequently than the inferior classes, and this return certainly seems to prove that the Bramin population must be very large. I do not understand that anywhere in Bengal they form the mass of the population, or that they are often found in the lowest ranks of agriculturists and labourers. They are rather more or less an aristocratic class, and though following a variety of callings and to some extent cultivating the land, will not ordinarily put their hand to the plough, and affect as far as possible the position of superiors. They are altogether unwarlike and somewhat effeminate in their habits. In Eastern Bengal Mahommedans prevail, and some Bramins are _ supposed not to like to cross the Berhampooter, hence in that quarter _ they seem not to be very numerous. In Orissa I believe they are very many, and I see it stated in the Gazetteer of Southern India _ that in the Oorya portion of the Ganjam District many of the Oorya - Bramins both obtain their livelihood as cultivators and traders, and follow the occupations of brickmakers, bricklayers, &c. _ The result of education shows the Bramins of Bengal to be most acute and intellectually capable. But they do not appear to have the practical energy of the mercantile and some other classes, nor ig the political and administrative success of Maratta and Kashmeeree | _ Bramins. In native times I do not remember to have heard of Bengalee Bramins in great places, unless we except Nandcomar who attained so unfortunate an eminence. In these days I believe that intellectual eminence is often combined with much high principle among the educated Bengalees, and I hope that both may bear practical fruit. Going to the other side of Indiag in Goozerat the Bramins appear to be numerous, but I have not yet visited that Province, and have not exactly ascertained their position and avocations. Forbes does 70 The Ethnology of India. not seem to speak of them as forming any large portion of the culti- vating classes. They trace their descent from Kashyupa, and are divided into a large number of tribes and sub-divisions. In a secular capacity they seem to have a good share of office (although there also they encounter an energetic writer-caste) and also to trade. The Jains of Western India have Bramins among them, and these would seem to be for the most part Goozerat men. Next to Goozerat comes the Maratta country, extending from _ Damaun to the neighbourhood of Goa, and from Bombay to Nagpore and the Wyuganga. The Maratta Bramins are the most famous and successful of their race. That their fortune is due to their talent and energy, is shown by their success beyond their own bounds, in fact throughout Southern and Central India. But in their own country © and among their own people, they are also favoured by circumstances. The lower caste men of the pen, who have ousted the Bramins in ~ some countries of the north and more than rivalled them in others, — are not found in the Maratta social system (those now found in the Bombay country are Goozerattees, and Bombay itself is in a mercan- tile sense very much a Goozerattee city). The mass of the Maratta people are of a comparatively humble class, without the pride and jealousy of Bramins shown by Rajpoots and Jats. Hence wherever there is a Maratta people or Maratta rule, Maratta Bramins are the- brains and directing power. At first they contented themselves with the highest administrative offices under Maratta rulers, but later, as is well known, the Peshwa and other Bramins usurped the supreme power itself, assumed the command of armies, and openly ruled the confederacy. In truth, so miscellaneous, and so loosely held together by any other tie, were Maratta confederacies and armies, that these Bramins may be considered to be the real source of the power and fame of the Marattas as rulers in India. They were the heads of @ body of which others were but the hands guided by them. Even to the present day in many States and places beyond their own limits, they have the chief power. 5 ; The Ethnology of India, 71 It might be conjectured that centuries of Mahommedan rule might have caused the retreat of the Bramins from the more open plains to these regions; but I do not know that there is historical ground for this supposition, and think it more likely that under any tule they would hold their own and circumvent even foreign rulers. Their personal appearance would lead one rather to suppose that they came from the North-West. Many of them are very fair, and I think that there is among them a much greater tendency to the common occurrence of a somewhat aquiline, or what I call sub-aquiline type of feature than among Hindustanee Bramins. A very marked feature, not uncommonly met with, seems to be a light greyish kind of eye. Altogether, I cannot suppose these Bramins to be a branch of the _ race which, after occupying Hindustan, extended southwards. I can- not imagine how they could in the south, as it were, in some degree have returned towards an earlier type, instead of step by step becoming darker and more Indian-like. It is undoubtedly the case and is a subject of common remark, that all along the West Coast of India the people are much fairer than in the interior, even though most of the interior country above the Ghats is considerably elevated. Some have accounted for this by saying that colour does not alto- - gether depend on the thermometer, that the inhabitants of the _ more umbrageous Coast are less exposed to an unclouded sun and dry atmosphere than the people of the bare and treeless plains of the Deccan, and that thus the difference of colour is to be accounted for. Iwill not say that this cause is wholly without effect, but I think it quite insufficient to account for the whole difference. The Bengalees ‘im a moist atmosphere and amid a luxurious vegetation are generally dark. The blackest of the Aboriginal tribes live in the densest forest country in a moist malarious climate. Even on this very Western | Coast I find the Aboriginal Helots of Malabar described as being “of the deepest black.” We must look then to some other cause Modifying the complexion of many tribes on the West Coast, and that I take to be immigration by sea. That there has been much | such immigration, is not only probable, but a historical fact. All along the southern portion of the West. Coast, a large part of the | population is notoriously to a great degree of foreign blood. The Moplahs are to a great extent Arabs, the ‘ Teers’ or ‘ Teermen’ are also ae 72 The Ethnology of India. 7 said to be immigrants (as their very name indicates), and there are many Jews and Christians, though the latter I believe have not much trace of Western blood. All along the Bombay Coast also, from Goa to Kurrachee, are the descendants of Persian, Arab, Portuguese, and other Western immigrants. Hence I did not think it by any means absurd when an educated Bramin of Poonah suggested to meas a theory, that the Bramins owed the light eyes and light complexion noticed among them to an intermixture of Western blood. The Bramins would be less liable, however, to casual and recent intermixture than other races, and I incline rather to the theory that these Bramins of this part of the Coast may have more directly come from the original seats of the race by the route of the Saraswatee and the Indus, and thence perhaps by sea, without passing through Hindustan and tral India and there suffering any infiltration of Aboriginal blood. I have already traced the Bramins down the Saraswatee. Is it not probable enough that in very early days, when they were pressed by | Rajpoots and Jats, they may have colonised the Konkan, reduced to — subjection the rude Aborigines, and transmitted to descendants features preserved from great deterioration by caste rules, and forms only somewhat deteriorated in size and robustness by a southern ~ climate and the absence of manual labour? If such an immigration 7 took place so early as I suppose, it might well happen that, in long contact with southern elements and southern creeds, the colonists in the Maratta country would separate themselves from the old Saras- watee Bramins and become a separate division. : I have seen some allusions to Konkan Bramins as disting dice 3 from Maratta Bramins, but have not been able to make out the exact distinction. Certainly Maratta Bramins are altogether the | dominant race in great part of the Konkan. But it appears that | there is a strip to the south, extending beyond the district usually — known as the Konkan to some way beyond Goa, in which a mixed — language called Konkanee is spoken. In this Konkan there are some Bramins still called ‘ Kashastala or Saraswatee’ and from the Konkan some of them have penetrated into the north-western part of the Mysore country, where they are traders and in public employment, ane described as very clever but greatly looked down upon by souther n Bramins who profess to be much more rigid in their rules, In t the 3 The Ethnology of India. 73 towns of the North Canarese Coast, the Hindu traders are said to be chiefly ‘‘ Konkanee Bramins who trade and keep shops.” In the Maratta Konkan the Bramins are at the head of the agricultural community. Most of the ‘ Kotes’ or village zemindars who rule over and claim the proprietary right in each village are of this caste. I have not been able to ascertain what proportion of the actual cultivators are of the same class. For the rest, office of every kind, including the village and pergunnah accountantships all over the country, and every service of the head and the pen, seem to be their great resources. They are not military, nor generally in any way - men of the sword, though, as-I have said, they have in their prosperity _ taken the command of Maratta Armies. Nor do they seem to have "any great commercial proclivities. Among the various races who push to so great a point mercantile enterprise in Bombay I cannot find that the Bramins have any great share. Under our Government they have almost a monopoly of office in Western India. Adjoining the Maratta country on the east is the Telinga or Telagoo country, very little of which I have visited and of the castes and population of which I have been able to learn less than of any other - part of India. ‘This at least, however, I find that here also the Bramins, though not so famous nor, I apprehend, so clever as those of Maharashtra, are numerous and powerful. The Telinga people are described as generally illiterate and as (unlike their Tamil neigh- hours) leaving literature and science to the Bramins; so that the | latter would seem in Telingana, free from the competition of a. | writer caste, to have in their hands all the secular business of a | elerkly character and a good deal more besides. I have not ascer- | tained what proportion of the population they there form, and Whether many of them are actual cultivators; but in more than one place I find it stated that many of the Zemindars are Bramins, and in Rajamundry the more respectable inhabitants of the Town are said to be chiefly Bramins. Ican only trust that this meagre account of the Telagoo Bramins will be supplemented by some one better qualified to describe them. _ Towards Madras I gather that there are some learned Gwallas called | Yadavas and Telagoo Chetties (perhaps a merchant class, but I am | not sure), who must a good deal interfere with the Bramins. They 74 The Ethnology of India: do not seem to be very conspicuous in Madras itself, which, though in’ the Tamil country, is not far from the Telagoo frontier. In the Canarese country (comprising Canara, Mysore and parts of the Bombay Southern Districts and adjoining Nizam’s country) the Bramins are not rivalled by a specific writer class, and have a large share of literate office, very generally (it appears) occupying that of Shanbogue or village accountant, besides many higher offices. But a very large proportion of the Canarese people are of the ultra-Sivite or Lingayet sect, who altogether ignore Bramins in their sacerdotal character ; and there are energetic mercantile and other classes. The rule of the Marattas in one quarter, and of the Mahommedans in another: was also unfavorable to the power of the Canarese Bramins, and thus they are by no means dominant. Maratta Bramins, Mahommedans,. East Indians and others have a large share of the higher offices and occupations. In the North Western part of the Canarese country, in the district. of North Canara, in the high and hilly country above and about the ghats, and the adjoining parts of Mysore, there is a large population — of Bramin cultivators who are on all hands represented as exceedingly industrious, thriving, and in every way good. Most of these people are called ‘ Haiga’ Bramins, and they seem to be of pure race and of no bastard or doubtful caste. They especially affect the cultivation of the betel-nut, and both own and cultivate the land over a large extent of country. In the Canara District they constitute one of the most numerous castes, being given by a census taken some years 3 ago as 147,924, to 146,309 Banters (corresponding to Nairs), and 151,491 of the inferior class called Billawars. In the Nagar district. of Mysore they are also numerous, and they are there described as “very fair, with large eyes and aquiline noses,” a description which would seem to imply for them a derivation from an uncorrupted and little intermixed northern source. They are stated not to be very literary or highly educated, being more devoted to agriculture. . In South Canara and what is called the Talava country, there are again many Bramins who do much cultivation, and on the whole; West Coast, down to the extreme South of India, the country is said to have been extensively colonised by the Bramin colony led from Calpee by Parasram, who caused the sea to retire for their eae e, a - | The Ethnology of India. 75 Tn the centre of this tract, in Malabar, the Bramins, owing to political circumstances and hostile rule, have been to a great extent driven ‘away, but they are very numerous in Travancore and Cochin; and in the Palghaut valley (a little inland, where the break takes place in the line of the ghats) the Bramins seem to be very numerous as cultiva- tors, and are industrious and good in that capacity. The principal class of Bramins on the South Coast are called Namberees, and they have some very peculiar customs. They affect, however, much of the sacerdotal character, and seem to be very influential in Travancore and Cochin. Throughout the South Western Coast, however, wherever _ the Nairs and allied tribes are or have been politically dominant or are now numerous, the Bramins have by no means a monopoly of office, even among Hindus; for the Nairs themselves are frequently _ educated and hold very many public offices. The Namberee Bramins are described as very like the Nairs and Seneral Hindu population of the South Coast, but as not unfrequently _ fairer. It remains to notice the Tamil country. There also the Bramins : : _ are numerous, but it appears that throughout the extreme South, they again lose that literary predominance, or almost monopoly, which they enjoy in the Maratta and other countries in the middle zone of India as well as in the extreme North.- I have mentioned that the Nairs _ of the Malayala and Talava country by no means resign the pen to | the Bramins ; and so also it appears that throughout the Tamil country offshoots of ‘the dominant tribes, under the names of Modelliars, | Beileys &c., do much of the clerkly work, and the Bramins have not | generally the office of village accountant and collector—the posses- sion of which is the greatest test of predominance in that respect. I “gather that the Lingamite sect is less numerous in the Tamil than | in the Canarese country, and consequently the Bramins are in a | sacerdotal point of view more important. They also push their fortunes in many secular ways. They rent much land, but will not | hold the plough, and are extensively employed in the public offices | as hurkaras (messengers or process servers) and in such like capa- cities, also as keepers of choultrees and in many other occupations. With reference to what I have said of them as renters rather than cultivators, I should add that, though the Palghat country is included 76 The Ethnology of India. in Malabar, it appears that most of the cultivating Bramins there are of Tamil extraction. Many of them condescend to officiate as astro- logers and religious guides to the very lowest and scarcely Hindu castes of Southern India. Briefly I would thus recapitulate the position of the Bramins in the principal Provinces of India. | In Kashmir, they are altogether dominant by the brain and pen, — but are not military. ro In the Punjab, Scinde; and countries about the Saraswatee, Bramins are superseded by other races, and are only found here and there in the eastern part of this tract as industrious cultivators claiming to be the ancient occupants of the country. In Hindustan, Bramins have altogether lost literate predominance q | (with the exception of some immigrant Cashmeerees), sand also political predominance, except something retained by quasi-Bramins — of mixed caste in the extreme east of this country. But they constitute a large section of the population of Hindustan, especi- ally of the eastern half, and a large proportion of the cultivators, soldiers, &e. : In Bengal and Orissa, Bramins form a large portion of the Hindu population, occupy to a great extent an aristocratic position, and have a large share in the superior rights in land, in offices, and in the literate professions; but are at the same time quite rivalled by Kaists. In the Maratta country, Bramins are altogether dominant in literat 7 work, and have the largest share of political power. In the Telinga country, Bramins are in possession of most of the literate work, and apparently of a good deal of office, land, de. j but my information is very imperfect. In the South of India, Bramins have but a moderate share of the literate work; but on the West Coast, they have a large share of the land and form a large proportion of the best cultivating population; while in the east of this country they seem to be not dominant and are rivalled by several other tribes, though here also they are numerous and employed in many capacities, secular as well as sacerdotal, 3 The Ethnology of India, 77 Ture JATS. On the general scheme of tracing the Arian races from the North- West, I take the Jats before the Rajpoots. These Jats are in fact by far the most perfect specimen of the democratic and more properly Indo-Germanic races, whom I believe to have appeared in India later than the early Braminical Hindus, and who, while Hindu in much of their speech, laws, and manners, have also some peculiarities and institutions, and perhaps some grammatical forms of speech not to be traced in the earlier Braminical writings. These tribes, now consti- tuting over a great part of India an upper and dominant stratum of : society, have given to a great degree their own tone and colour to many Provinces. In great part of Jat-land the Jats are not only _ the upper stratum, but the great body and mass of the free people; P and hence we have among them their original institutions in the _ greatest purity, little modified by modern Braminical Laws, or by those "necessities of Military and Feudal organisation which so much alter _ the institutions of a free people, when they become dominant con- - querors over other races greatly superior in number. _ There is some variation in the pronunciation of the word ‘ Jat,’ it _ being sometimes (chiefly in the west country) pronounced so short that it may be written ‘ Jut ;’ sometimes (in much of the Punjab) variably used, and sometimes (chiefly in the east) pronounced very long as ‘ Jat’ and even occasionally written by early English authors ‘ Jaut.’ And the present religion, dress, &c. of the race also differing in different ‘Tegions (they are Mussulmans in the west, Sikhs in great part of the Punjab, and in some sense Hindus in the east), some people have supposed Mahommedan Jats of Scinde to be radically different from Hindu Jauts of Bhurtpore, and the wide extent and populousness of this great race is not very generally known. In fact, however, any apparent differences in the extreme of the type disappear, when we trace them as one great continuous population throughout the whole tract, and find that the one extreme gradually and imperceptibly merges | into the other. _ To prevent future doubts, I will, however, add that there may possibly be small local western tribes of similar name, distinct from the great Jat nation. It seems that on some parts of the frontier Jats are 78 _ . The Ethnology of India. known as a somewhat pastoral and light-fingered tribe; and Burton in his ‘ Scinde’ speaks of a tribe of Beloochis bearing the name; also says that it is the name of a wandering tribe found about Candahar, Herat, Meshed, &c., and that in all the Western parts of Central Asia, the term is used as synonymous with thief ‘and scoundrel. These gentry may be offshoots of our Jats thrown by circumstances on the — resources of their mother-wit, or they may be some other tribe; but at any rate they are in no way a type of the great agricultural nation — whose habitat Iam about to describe, and about whose oneness and — complete ethnological nationality there can be, I think, no doubt — whatever. In all the east of Beloochistan, about the routes by which the most open and constant communications between India and the countries’ to the west are maintained, in the Provinces marked in the maps as ‘“Sewestan’ and ‘ Cutch Gandava,’ Jats form a large, probably the largest portion of the agricultural population, and claim to be the original owners of the soil. In fact the Beloochis are there but a later wave and upper stratum. The Persian Tajiks are the original agricultural class of all the west of Affghanistan and Beloochistan; then there is a tribe apparently somewhat mixed, called ‘ Dehwars,’ found about. Candahar and thereabouts. The Jats are not found in Affghanistan, but in Beloochistan they succeed the Tajiks and Dehwars, as we go east by the Bolan and routes thereabouts. Here then they are not confined to the plains, but occupy the hilly country. ; Descending into the plains, we find the Jats spread to the right anil left along the Indus and its tributaries, occupying upper Scinde on one side and the Punjab on the other. But it is particularly to be remarked that in the Punjab they are not found in any numbers above the Salt Range, and they are wholly unknown in the Hima- laya. In fact, to the north they are altogether excluded from the hilly country, a circumstance which seems to me conclusively to show that they did not enter India by that extreme northern route. The hills to the north seem on the contrary to be a barrier by ve the flood of Jats was checked. In all Upper Scinde the Jats are still the prevailing population, a their language is the language of the country. It is moreover matte . of history that they were once the aristocracy of that land, though | & 7 The Ethnology of India. 79 latterly other races have dominated and the higher classes among the Jats have lost somewhat of their position. In the south and west of the Punjab too they have long been subject to Mahommedan rulers, but latterly as Sikhs they became rulers of the whole Punjab and of the country beyond as far as the upper Jumna, in all which territories they are still in every way the dominant population. Over great tracts of this country, I should say that three villages out of four are Jat, and that in each Jat village the Jats constitute perhaps two-thirds of the entire population, the remainder being low caste Helots, with a few _ traders, artisans, &c. The Juts of the Indus seem on the map to be separated from the _ Jauts of Bhurtpore and Agra by the whole breadth of Rajpootana, but the fact is that the ordinary geographical nomenclature gives rise to ‘much misconception on the subject. By far the greater part of what we call Rajpootana is, ethnologically speaking, much more a Jat than a Rajpoot country. The great seat of Rajpoot population and ancient ‘power and glory is on the Ganges, and it is said that since the Mahom- ‘medans conquered them there, the chief Rajpoot houses have as it were ‘doubled back on the comparatively unfruitful countries which now bear ‘their name, but where, notwithstanding, the most numerous section 4 the population is Jat. Col. Tod expressly tells us that northern Rajpootana was partitioned into small Jat republics, before the Besipoots were driven back from Ajoodea and the Ganges. It is clear then that the Jats extend continuonsly east from the Indus over | Rajpootana. They do not seem to have occupied (or at least do not . now occupy) lower Scinde, nor are they found in Goozerat, although in the history of the latter country mention is made of incursions of | Jat horsemen on the frontier in conjunction with Katties. Their line of settlement lies farther north. They may have arrived on the Saraswatee, before its banks lost their moisture, and if so, their passage to the east would be comparatively easy. Throughout the more open parts of Rajpootana they share the soil with the Aboriginal or semi- Aboriginal Meenas, the remains of the Bramin population, and the ‘jdominant Rajpoots ; the Jats having, I gather, the largest share of the iltivation. The southern and more hilly parts of Rajpootana (where \Mhairs, Meenas, and Bheels so much hold their own,) are not Jat, but im Malwa again they are numerous, and seem to share that Province with Rajpoots and Koonbees. 80 The Ethnology of India. To the north, in the north-eastern Punjab and Cis-Sutlej districts, as we get near the hills, I think there are evident indications that the Jat population has been advancing on what has once been a proper Rajpoot country, after having perhaps been, before that, a Bramin country. It is not clear whether the Bhattees of Bhatteana were originally Rajpoots or really are Yuti or Jats. But from Bhatteana northwards, Rajpoot villages are scattered about in considerable numbers among the Jats, and there are traces of more extensive Rajpoot possessions. The Rajpoots seem to be here undergoing gradual submersion. But in the extreme north of the Baree and adjoining Doabs of the Punjab (the Baree is that Doab in which Lahore and Umritsir are situated) there is still a strip immediately under the hills, which may be classed with the adjoining hill country as still mainly Rajpoot. To the west, advancing through Rajpootana, we come to the Jats of Bhurtpore and Dholpore, famous in history. Gwalior was a Jat fortress belonging, I think, to the Dholpore Chief. They do not go much further south in this direction. From this point they may be said to occupy the banks of the Jumna all the way north to the hills. The Dehli territory is principally a Jat country, and from Agra upwards the flood of that race has passed the river in con- siderable numbers, and forms a large part of the population of the Upper Doab in the districts of Allighur, Meerut, and Mozuffernugger. They are just known over the Ganges in the Moradabad district, but. they cannot be said to have crossed that river in any numbers. To define then the Jat country ; take as a basis the country on both: sides of the Indus from Lat. 26° or 27° up to the Salt Range ; from the extremities of this base draw two lines nearly at right angles to the river and inclining south, so as to reach Lat. 23° or 24° in Malwa, and Lat. 30° on the Jumna, thus including Upper Scinde, Marwar, and part of Malwa on one side, and Lahore, Umritsir, and Umballa on the other; then connect the two eastern points by a line which shall include Dholpore, Agra, Allighur, and Meerut. Within all that ambit the Jat race ethnologically predominates, excepting only the — hills of Mewar and the neighbourhood, still held by Aboriginal tribes, . point of view, as fine athletic men with handsome features, but rath er dark. » The Ethnology of India. 81 In Upper Scinde, up the course of the Indus, and in the south-west- ern Punjab, they are now for the most part Mahommedans, and in that character seem to be somewhat inferior to their unconverted and perhaps purer brethren; the more so as they have been long subject to foreign rule. The language spoken along the line of the Indus and throughout Upper Scinde is there known as the “ Jatee Gul” or Sat language, but is in fact identical with that which we call Punjabee. The Punjabee may, in fact, properly be called the Jat language ; to the Jats the dialect seems especially to belong, and by them chiefly it is spoken. Advancing eastwards into the Punjab and Rajpootana, we find Hindu and Mahommedan Jats much mixed ; it often happens that one-half of a village or one branch of a family ig -Mahommedan, and the other Hindu. Further east, Mahommedan Jats _ become rarer and rarer, and both about Lahore and all that part of _ the Punjab and along the line of the Upper Sutlej and Jumna the _ great mass remain unconverted. In the Punjab they all take the name of ‘Sing,’ and dress somewhat differently from ordinary Hindu Jats, but for the most part they only become formally Sikhs, when they take service, and that change makes little difference in their _ laws and social relations. The Jats of Dehli, Bhurtpore, Ge. are avery fine race. They still bear the old Hindu names of ‘ Mull’ and. such like, and are not all ‘Sings.’ In Rajpootana the Jats are pro- _ bably a good deal intermixed by contact with Meenas, &c., and they have now been long subject to an alien rule. One does not there P hear much of them otherwise than as quiet and submissive cultivators. 5 The Jat Sings of the Punjab and the Upper Sutlej] may probably de taken as the best representative type of the race. They are a’ ‘emarkably five variety of man—tall, large, well-featured, with very plentiful and long beards, fine teeth, and a very pleasant open expres- ‘sion of countenance. I am told that in the Punjab Regiments, which ‘select from several of the finest races in the world, the Sikhs are upon the whole the largest men, although they are not so stout-limbed or in certain respects quite so robust as the Affghan Pathans. Perhaps the larger population to choose from may have something to do With the superior size, but I should say that on dn average they are taller than Pathans, with the upper part of the body especially well developed. In pluck and Military qualities they excel the fairer and 82 The Ethnology of India. in some degree more beautiful non-Pathan races of the northern hills. Altogether then they are not excelled by any race in Asia. There is among them a large proportion of High-Arian feature, but there is much more variety and not so universal a high-nosed type as among the men of the frontier hills. Compared to northern races they are dark, but in every other respect they are, take them all in all, a very remarkably fine handsome people. They are as energetic in the arts of peace as in those of war. There are no better cultivators; hard-working and thrifty, they let little land lie waste, and pay their revenue punctually. They have this great advantage too that among them a woman is almost as good as a man, works as well and makes herself as generally useful. They — are not literary, they leave that, with proper mercantile business, to the Khatrees (to be afterwards noticed). But many men and some women ~ can read and write in their own rough way, and as waggoners they not unfrequently carry their grain and other goods to distant markets on their own account. | They have an excessive craving after fixed ownership in the soil, and are essentially agriculturists. They seldom undertake a garden- ing style of cultivation, and prefer broad high lands to more cramped though moister locations. Where the country is more fitted for cattle, they breed them largely, and both ordinary carts and large © mercantile waggons are generally plentiful in the Jat countries. Camels too they sometimes breed. But still, in India the Jats have never anything of the pastoral, roving, Gypsy-like character. I have alluded to the democratic institutions of the Jats, institu-_ tions to which we do not find allusions in the books of the Bramins. . Yet it is certain that such institutions prevailed in the North of j India as early as the time of Alexander the Great. The Greel = accounts are distinct on the point. They represent the institutions — as in fact extremely democratic, and add that the Indians ascribed their free constitution to Bacchus, by whom they were led into the country. I mentioned Col. Tod’s testimony to the former oxistongl of Jat republics in great part of what is now Rajpootana. I know — of only one recognised republican State which came down to ot i day, that of ‘Phool’ or ‘ Maraj,’ from which sprung the chiefs vin founded the States of Patteealah, Nabah, Jheend, &c, The old terr The Ethnology of India. 83 tory of the Phoolkeean race was recognised, and treated, among the Protected Sikh States, as a regular republic. But I fear that, with many less creditable institutions, it has now been brought under the general rule of British dominion. However, States apart, every Jat village is on a small scale a demo- cratic republic. As respects property, there is neither that common tribal right which we find among the wilder Arabs, Turcomans, and New Zealanders, nor that complete joint family which figures so largely in the Hindu Law of the Braminical sages. Every man has his share of the cultivated land, separate and divided. It may be that a father and sons cultivate in common, but entire commensality _ seldom goes farther. The union in a joint village community is rather the political union of the Commune, so well known in Europe, than a common enjoyment of property. The village site, the waste lands and grazing grounds, and it may be one or two other things - belong to the commune, and the members of the commune have in i these rights of common. For all the purposes of cultivation, the _ remainder of the land is in every way separate individual property. } And the government of the commune is no patriarched rule, but _ simply representative government. A Communal Council or Punchayet tules by right of representation. For the rest, the laws of these people j are of Arian, Indo-Germanic, and to some extent of the more liberal Hindu type. Marriage is a sacred and irrevocable bond, though “remarriage of widows is permitted; and alliances are restricted by q and exclusive marriage, prevails among the Jats. Property is equally divided among sons. Daughters get nothing but that which may be ‘given to them at the time of marriage. All the Jats are divided into wm any Gentes and Tribes, after the universal fashion of the peoples of t ‘th his stock, and the usual fashion is to marry into another Gens. | In that portion of the Protected Sikh Territories which Sikhs from the Lahore country had occupied as conquerors, there was a perfect feudal system. The chief of a tribe, as General, had a large appanage; smaller chiefs owed him allegiance and service for their smaller domains, and under-holders under them again (all holding on @ permanent hereditary tenure), till we come to the tenure of a single 84 The Ethnology of India. horseman. ‘These latter again have come to be divided under the operation of the rules of inheritance, But this system, it will be observed, is only adopted abroad for purposes of foreign domination. Beyond the caste system common to them with most Indo-Germans, the Jats have very little of the ceremonial strictness of Hindu caste. In Punjabee Regiments, they mess freely like Kuropeans, and have their comfortable two or three meals a day. The Jats sometimes claim to have been originally Rajpoots, and it is so stated in some of the written accounts; but that is only one of the many stories of the kind prompted by a desire to stand high in the Hindu scale, and its futility is illustrated by a counter-story told by some of the Mahommedan Jats, viz. that they are descended © from one of the companions of the prophet. That the Jats and — Rajpoots and their congeners are branches of one great stock, I have no doubt. It may be possible that the Rajpoots are Jats who have advanced farther into Hindustan, have there more intermingled with — Hindu races, have become more high and strict Hindus, and achieved — earlier power and glory. But that the Jats are Rajpoots who have receded from a higher Hindu position, is a theory for which there is — not the least support, and which is contradicted by every feature i In the present position of the now rapidly progressing Jats. | The suggestion that Rajpoots may be Jats more highly developed _ in a Hindu point of view, would make the latter the earliest and most primitive, though at the same time perhaps the purest of the race; just as I have supposed the Bramins of Cashmere and the Frontier hills to be Hindus of an earlier stage of Braminical development. j But I am more inclined to suppose the Jats to be later immigrants” from Central or Western Asia. The character of the northern hills is such that immigration from thence could only gradually filtrate into the plains; but by the passes of the Bolan, great immigrations are possible. Looking at the area of Jat occupation, it is just that which we might suppose to be covered by the steady flow of a large flood of population issuing from the Bolan, about Lat. 28° or 30°, as from a funnel, and thence spreading over the plains and pushing away before it other populations. The Rajpoots, again, when I come 4 to treat of them, will be found to be ranged in a kind of horse shoe 4 form round the outer edge of the Jat area, the mass of them occu> The Ethnology of India, ) 85 pying the richer valley of the Ganges. My conjecture is that the Rajpoots are an earlier wave from the same source, and who came in by the same route, who have farther advanced and have been more completely Hinduised, while the Jats have come in behind them. The Jat or Punjabee language is but a dialect, bearing somewhat the same relation to the Hindee of the Rajpoots and other Hindustanees that Lowland Scotch bears to English. In its main grammatical and essential features it is not widely different. There are certainly in it many words which sound strange to a European only superficially acquainted with the common Hindustanee, and it would be very interesting to examine all these words and ascertain whether any and what foreign elements can be found. But I may state broadly that by far the greater number of these words are really of plain Sanscrit origin, and very many of them are quite familiar to those well acquainted with the purer Hindee dialects. I have been surprised to find how Sanscrit are most of the words which (little linguist that Iam) I had supposed to be peculiarly Punjabee. Indeed the Rev. _ Mr. Trump broadly states the Jat language to be one of the most - Pracrit of Indian Vernaculars, and so it clearly is. There remains _ the old question which concerns it equally with the Hindee, whether _ the grammar can be derived from the Sanscrit. It seems very im- _ probable that so great a mass of people as the Jats should have lost all traces of a separate language, if they ever had one. If so, it may surely be recognised in some Punjabee words. For the rest, the | or y doubt seems to be whether the Jats and Rajpoots, speaking an “Tndo-Germanic tongue allied to the Sanscrit, may have brought with them the grammar which now distinguishes the Punjabee and Hindee ; or whether the Bramins, when they spread wide over “Hindustan and mixed among a large Aboriginal population, adopted some Aboriginal grammar, and fitted into it their own vocabulary, making a language which Jats and Rajpoots also have received in. ndia; or whether in fact all these tribes have derived a common Fongre by direct Pracrit descent from the Sanscrit. Tue Raspoorts. a have already made so many allusions to the Rajpoots, that I have half anticipated my description of them. The best proof that they 86 The Ethnology of India. are not a part of the original Hindu system, but rather something engrafted upon it, is (I think) to be found in the difficulty of defining what is and what is not a Rajpoot. I have already shown, in noticing many tribes, that it is almost impossible to say where the Rajpoots begin and where they end. I shall now, however, confine myself as far as possible to the tribes who are generally acknowledged to be real Rajpoots of blue blood. They can scarcely be said to have any broad general tribal name like that of the Jats. It is hardly contended that they are really the old Kshatryas of the early Braminical accounts; and though, in a military point of view, they have occupied and more than occupied the place assigned to the Kshatryas, still their numbers, their position and the existence among them of the institutions shared with them by the Jats and unknown to the old Hindoo Shasters (in them we © find no trace of democracy) would all go to show that the Rajpoots are another race. In fact the days of the Kshatryas were those of the — earliest Hindu annals, many hundred years before Christ, while the Rajpoots may be considered to have been the immediate predecessors of the Mahommedans in the rule of Hindustan. Except then in an affected way and with direct reference to the old Sanscrit Nomen- clature, the Rajpoots are not usually called ‘ Kshatryas,’ while the name Rajpoot also is by no means universal among them, and merely means ‘Son of a Raja’ or ‘ Royal.’ In some parts of the country, they usually call themselves ‘ Thakoors,’ a word which also means: Chiefs or Nobles. They are more frequently known by the names of their tribes as ‘Chouhans,’ ‘ Soorujbansees,’ ‘ Bais,’ ‘ Rahtores,’ ‘ Baghels’ (or Waghels’) or the like, but the practice of marrying into another tribe makes all these high-caste tribes identical for ethnological purpony I shall continue, then, to call them Rajpoots. They are chiefly known to Europeans in their military character 3 and as feudal conquerors. But in reality, in their own villages im i the plains of the Ganges, they are simple agriculturalists of a con- stitution very much like that of the J ats, only less pure and complete. — The fact is that the Rajpoots have had their day, and are now roa down-going race. Partly the furnishing of armies and feudal hosts — has exhausted the material and corrupted the simplicity of their ori- The Ethnology of India. 87 ginal villages ; partly infanticide and other causes tend to diminish their numbers; the result of all which is, that over great tracts of country we find them rather a minority trying to maintain a failing rule over a scarcely subject majority, than forming full democratie bodies of free Rajpoots. Still, in some parts of the country the agricultural Rajpoot villages are strong and numerous; the land is divided among them, every Rajpoot is free and equal, and the commune is administered on democratic principles. Wherever this is so, their _ institutions are like those ofthe Jats. Although they have never cared much for Bramins, they have, unlike the Jats, the ceremonies and " superstitions of Hindu caste. They cook once a day with ‘great fuss and form, almost every man for himself after the most approved _ Hindustanee fashion, and are very particular about caste-marks, &. &e, _ Their widows may not remarry, and it is their excessive point of honour to marry their daughters to none but men of the best tribes (a feeling allied to our chivalry no doubt) that renders the daughters such a burden to them, and makes female infanticide unfortunately so common among them. Their wives again are shut up after the ~ Mahommedan fashion, and are lost for agricultural labour. Altogether Rajpoot females are a very unsatisfactory institution, and this goes far to weigh down and give a comparatively bad name to men who who are often industrious enough. Like the Jats, the Rajpoots are not found in any numbers to the North of the Salt Range, nor are they inany of the hill country west ‘of the Jhelum.* If they ever occupied the Western Punjab, they have been driven forward by the Jats, and they are nowonly found about the Salt Range itself, where a small tribe called Jhanjhooas’ (now “Mahommedans) represents a Rajpoot race that seems to have been “once great in those parts. But in the North-Hastern Punjab near the hills, the Rajpoot population is (as I have already noticed) more numerous, and the Himalayas of the Jummoo and Kangra districts are occupied by Hindu Rajpoots who are there altogether the domi- nant race. I do not know if the highest Rajpoots to the south east _* It was somewhere suggested that the Gadoons or Jadoons just over the | Indus, where that river issues from the Himalayas near Torbela, are Rajpoots, but that seems to be a mere conjecture, founded on a fancied resemblance to the name of a Rajpoot tribe. There is not the least doubt that the Gadoons | are pure Pushtoo-speaking Pathans, 88 | The Ethnology of India. would admit the equality, but the Kangra and Jummoo Rajas and their clans affect among themselves to be of very blue blood indeed, and they are certainly very fine handsome men. The Kangra Rajpoots in particular are very fair and handsome and High-Arian looking. I fancy that in all these hills, for a considerable distance to the east, there is a great deal of Kashmeeree or rather old Kasha blood. The women of the hills are in deserved repute and much sought after — in the plains. The Kangra Rajas have endless genealogies, but I think that their clansmen are somewhat effeminate looking and not very first rate soldiers. The men of the Jummoo country, the im- | mediate clansmen and subjects of the Maharaja of Cashmere, (and who also occupy the west of the Kangra district), commonly called Dogras, are not spoken of with so much Hindoo respect, and are not so pretty and be-jewelled looking as the Kangra men, but they are much more robust and brave. In the Punjab force, no men are pre- ferred to them as soldiers ; they are quiet, staunch, steady and reliable, without the disagreeable Hindustanee airs of the old Sepoy Rajpoots. The Rajpoot population of these hills must be very considerable. Fast of the Sutlej, in the Simla hills, many of the Rajas and their followers are Rajpoots, but most of the agriculturalists are of anothe caste called Kanaits. 3 A large proportion of the Rajpoots scattered about the Hastern Punjab, Cis-Sutlej territory, and Dehli districts are now Mahomme- dans, as are occasional Rajpoot villages all over Hindustan and a good many Rajpoot Rajas, this being no doubt the result of the favour shown to the Rajpoots by the Mogul Emperors; but east of Dehli conversion is quite the exception, by far the greater number are staunch Hindus. ; In the Gangetic valley the body of the Rajpoot population may be said to lie next to the Jats to the east, in the middle Doab, Rohilcund, and Oude; and still farther east the country is shared with a Bramin population. Before Rohilcund (given as a jagheer t Rohillas) acquired its present name, it was known as the Rajpoot Province of Katerh, and to the present day in all lower Rohilev nd the Rajpoot communities, (they are there called Thakoors) are strong and numerous. They are also numerous in Western Oude, but fo1 what reason I know not, neither the Rohileund men nor those of The Ethnology of India. 89 Western Oude entered the Sepoy Army in large numbers. In the Central Doab, in the districts of Mynpooree, Futtehgurh, Etawah, &c. -Rajpoots are numerous, and a good many of them served in the army. The Raja of Mynpooree is, I think, one of the highest of the famous Chouhan clan. The lower Doab is, as I have before noticed, more a - Bramin country ; but Eastern Oude, especially most of the broad tract between the Gogra and the Ganges, is the home of the great Rajpoot population which supplied so large a proportion of the Sepoy Army. At home these Rajpoots are by no means a loose military class, but a purely agricultural population. The prejudice against the particular act of holding the plough which so many of them affect, is reduced “to the narrowest possible limits, and many ex-Sepoys may now be seen grubbing up weeds, raising water by manual labour, and performing all the lowest agricultural functions. Baiswara, the country of the . Bais Rajpoots, lying almost parallel to the Bramin country of the ower Doab, is a famous nursery of Sepoys. In all this part of the country, so far as there still subsist ancient superior rights in the ‘land, they belong to the heads of Rajpoot clans. _ Some of the inferior clansmen hold subordinate tenures and village 5 proprietorships, but the great mass of the Rajpoots of Oude are now teduced to the position of mere ryots, in which capacity they are “much intermixed with Bramins. Many of the superior rights have 7 passed away to modern men. q 4 Passing to the east of Oude, Rajpoots are pretty numerous in Azimghur and Ghazeepore, but, as I have already mentioned, in the ‘Surrounding districts and those farther to east, the chief Rajas and ‘landholders are the bastard Bramins or ‘Bhamuns’ whose clansmen abound in Behar. In the Arrah district only (in the east) in the small Doab between the Soane and the Ganges, the Rajpoots are strong and numerous. Their leader was the famous rebel landholder, Koer Sing, | nd they supplied to the Native Army the numerous class known | as ‘ Bhojpore’ Sepoys. This is almost the limit of Rajpoot ethnological occupation to the | east, but turning round to the south-west, the Raja of Rewah is | chief of the Baghel Rajpoots (whence his country is called Bagheleund), and has no doubt a numerous following of his clansmen, though Aborigines on one side and Bramins on another are also numerous in 50 The Ethnology cf India. his territory. The Boondeelas of Bundlecund are not, I believe, con- sidered to be very pure Rajpoots; they have probably suffered some intermixture, but they are notoriously bold and martial, form a domi- nant aristocracy, and used to be very troublesome to us. I do not know the proportion of Rajpoot population in Scindia’s territories to the west, but believe that it is numerous. In Malwa, Rajpoots of the Rahtore, Chouhan, Sesodya and other clans form a large proportion of the population, and all the surrounding hilly country which is not~ held by pure Aborigines seems to have been from very old times in — the possession of Rajpoot or semi-Rajpoot chiefs. The Mewar or © Oodeypore Rajpoots, occupying a strong and elevated country in the west, claim to be the most ancient of the race; and I have seen it stated that some of the western Rajpoots are comparatively fair, with light or grey eyes. Ii so, that would seem to indicate that they reached their present location by a direct route from the west, and not by doubling back from the Ganges, as is supposed to have been the case in northern Rajpootana. a In the history of Guzerat the Raipoots are very famous, and many of them seem to have been of the same high-caste tribes whose blood is reputed the best in the east, the Waghels, for instance, being (it appears) the same as the Baghels. They are evidently still numerous, but I have not been able to ascertain what proportion of the popula tion they form, and to what extent they take part in the actual cul- tivation. Forbes does not speak of them as if they were among the most numerous cultivators. ; In Kathywar, Rajpoots seem to be numerous, and from the practice of infanticide we may suppose that they consider themselves high- easte, but I cannot exactly make out whether the Kathis are counted as Rajpoots, or whether the many petty chiefs of Kathywar are prin- cipally Kathis or proper Rajpoots. The Kathis seem to have been undoubtedly immigrants from the west and at one time neighbo 1S and allies of Jats. a In Lower Scinde there are undoubted traces of ancient Rajpoot rule, and the Summa Rajpoots ruled more recently under the Mahom- | medan emperors. Farther west, in Beloochistan, there seem to be traces of Hindu rule of a character more orthodox than that of the Jats, but whether the Rajpoots ever had dominion there, I am unable to say. a: Tne Ethnology of India. 91 ~ Looking back, it will be seen that (as I before said would be the case) I have traced the Rajpoots all round the edge of the more com- pact mass of the Jat population ;—from the Salt Range through the Northern Punjab and adjoining hills to Rohileund, Oude and the Centre Doab; thence by Bundlecund through Scindia’s territory, Malwa, Mewar, Guzerat and Kattywar into Lower Scinde. There remains in the centre of this circuit the greater part of Raj- _ pootana which I have described as ethnologically more Jat than Rajpoot, though the Rajpoots now rule, after doubling back from the Ganges. They form a numerous and dominant aristocracy, organised on the feudal principles necessary to domination. Though a full and complete Rajpoot village mainly inhabited by Rajpoots is democratic in its constitution, I have never heard of a - Rajpoot Republic on a larger scale ; and whether it be from long habits of domination by means of a feudal system, from the imbibing of a Hindu spirit, or from their original genius, they seem to be more than - the Jats given to suffer the rule of Rajas and Chiefs. In Rajpootana, however, the chief seems generally to be but a chief, and not a despotie ruler. Numerous fiefs are held by subordinate chiefs, who are again surrounded by Military followers holding many petty jagheers and grants of land on a hereditary service tenure. It may well be sup- posed that under such circumstances, when the British peace-preserv- ing power is at all relaxed, the authority of the chiefs is very apt to ollapse. They never could hold their own against the Marattas. Sut still, as a quasi-chivalrous aristocracy, with their bards, and genealogies, and military get-up, and contests about the possession f high-caste young ladies, they make a very pretty picture. j The normal Rajpoot, however, to my view is, as I have said, the iltivator of the Gangetic valley, where, at the eastern extremity. of he horse-shoe which I have described, they spread out in a broad egion into a large population. Physically I do not know any strik- ‘ing features which broadly distinguish the Gangetic Rajpoot’ from . 4 lis neighbour the Gangetic Bramin. In a Sepoy Regiment, setting aside caste marks, &c., I doubt whether they could be distinguished, They are both in fact the type of the higher class of the modern Hindustance population. Both are tall men, though in the native | army Commanding Officers went in too much for height, and many 92 The Ethnoloyy of India. of the unpadded recruits looked at first rather lanky. The modern Rajpoots are quite as Hindu as, and a good deal more prejudiced than, the Bramins. In their own villages they are pleasant good fellows enough, but as Sepoys they were a disagreeable overbear- ing set, and, so far as L[ can gather, were upon the whole about the worst class in the mutiny. . As agriculturalists their style of cultivation, &c., is much the same as that of the Jats, although very greatly inferior. They are very fond of land, and do not affect the finer garden cultivation but the broad farming style of agriculture. They also keep cattle when the country is fitted for it, and are very fond of laying their hands on other people’s cattle when they have the chance,—a weakness from which the Jats also are not altogether free. They are as a rule wholly un-literary, and very much confine them- selves to the two professions of agriculture and arms. The Rajpoots everywhere speak dialects of the ordinary Hindee. — I am not aware that any traces of any other language have ever been found among them. Tue Koonsers orn KoorMEzs. To the south of the Rajpoots and Jats, the country is mainly occu-_ pied by the class above mentioned. In all the central and eastern parts of the N. W. Provinces, or in fact of Hindustan generally, the Koormees are scattered about in considerable numbers as a well- known and-very industrious class of quiet cultivators. They own villages of their own, and are also more widely spread in detached families or groups of families. They affect the finer garden style of cultivation much more than Jats and Rajpoots, and like the Jats are assisted by industrious women. . As I shall afterwards notice, the Koonbees seem to be nearly con- nected with the Mallies, whose name we apply to the whole profession of gardeners. The name is variously written, Koormee or Coormee, Kunabi, Kunbee or Koonbee, and there is no doubt that the terms are syno: nymous. In Hindustan the Koormees do not go much beyond their own agricultural calling, but they are not absolutely unknown as Sepoys, The Ethnology of India. 93 and they have occasionally, though rarely, risen to higher posts, espe- cially one somewhat notorious family in Oude. In fact, in the Gangetic valley the Koormees, though much appreciated as cultivators, are somewhat looked down upon by the higher castes as mere humble tillers of the soil. If we proceed south from the Lower Doab, towards _ the Jubbulpore and Saugor territories, Koormees become more numer- ous, and there are hereabouts a good many ‘ Lodhas,’ a tribe appa- rently cognate to Koormees, and who are also pretty well known in the _ North West Provinces. They seem in this part of the Central Provin- ces to have at one time occupied a very considerable position. _ Thence westwards, on both sides of the Nerbudda, and still farther west to the north of the Nerbudda in parts of Malwa, that is in fact throughout the southern borders of Hindustan, Hindee-speaking Koormees are very numerous. In most of this country they are the chief cultivating class. In Malwa they meet the Jats and share with them the character of the most respectable and industrious cultivators. 5 In Rajpootana there is a cultivating class called ‘ Pittuls’ who are i supposed to be Koormees under another name. Farther west in Guzerat the Koonbees form the main body of the best cultivating population. They seem to be in the main the owners _ Throughout the whole of the Maratta country, the Koonbees are the main agricultural and landholding tribe. Here also they generally “are quiet simple agriculturalists, but the Maratta Koonbees do not seem to be so energetic and good in this way as their northern congeners, % agreed that the abies are decidedly superior in te ane agri- | cultural energy. | I have seen an allusion to Telinga Koonbees in the north-eastern q ortion of the Nizam’s territory, in the country down the Godavery | b low the limits of the Maratta tongue, but whether these are really | Telingas of this caste, or whether the word is only used to express | Telinga cultivators, I am not sure. 94 The Ethnology of India. In Hindustan the Koormees, as a lower class, are on an average darker and less good looking than Bramins and Rajpoots, but still they are quite Arian in their features, institutions, and manners. So they are in the Maratta country ; indeed the Marattas are still known to the people of the south as ‘ Aryas,’ but they have probably towards the south a larger intermixture of Aboriginal blood, and it is noto- rious that the Marattas are small men compared to the northern tribes. The constitution of the Koonbees seems to be less democratic than that of Jats and Rajpoots. In the Maratta country (and indeed in the countries to the north of that also) the villages are for the most part ruled by hereditary patels or headmen without much trace of representation, so far as I could learn, and individual property in land has been in many parts subject to many changes and vicissitudes. Nothing puzzled me more than this, viz. to understand whence came — the great Maratta Military element. In the Punjab one can easily — understand the sources of Sikh power ; every peasant looks fit to be a soldier. But the great mass of the Maratta Koonbees look like nothing of the kind, and are the quietest and most obedient of hum- ble and unwarlike cultivators. On inquiry I gathered that in fact throughout by far the greater part of the Maratta-speaking country, all through Nagpore, Berar, and the Northern Bombay districts, the ~ agricultural Koonbees furnish very few soldiers, nor ever did furnish many. Although the Koonbee element was the foundation of the - Maratta power, though Sevajee and some of his chiefs were Koonbees, it appears that these people came almost exclusively from a compara-= tively small district near Sattara, a hilly region where, as I judge, the Koonbees are very much mixed with numerous aboriginal and semi- aboriginal tribes of Mhars and others, and where, losing with the intermixture many of their agricultural virtues, they acquired more of the qualities of predatory soldiers. It is notorious that Sevajee relied principally on his ‘ Mawallees’ of the Western Ghats, who were apparently little better than non-descript predatory tribes. In their best days, it does not appear that the Marattas were ever Koonbees: to the same extent and in the same sense that the Sikhs were Jats. In fact the Maratta confederacy was more a political than a personal union. Many of the oldest chiefs were not Koonbees. Holkar was of the shepherd, and the Guickwar was of the cow-herd caste. All these The Ethnology of India. 95 as well as the Koonbees were quite illiterate, and would have done little without the directing power of the Bramins. When they were farther advanced, the Maratta forces seem to have been mere mercen- ary armies, a congregation of every loose fortune-seeker of every race and class, Mahommedans included, with a nucleus of the population of Sattara and Poonah, from which the proper Maratta chiefs had sprung. Take them all in all, I think that the Koonbees must be considered one of the most important as well as one of the most useful and most easily governed tribes in India. A great territory is in the main theirs, extending from about 23° or 24° to about 16° Lat., and from the western frontiers of Guzerat to the countries watered by the Wyngunga and the Middle Godavery, and the upper streams of the Nerbudda. OruerR AGRICULTURAL TRIBES. I have traced the Jats, Rajpoots, and Koonbees as the three chief territorial tribes peculiar to Northern India. I must now go back to - notice other landowning tribes intermixed with them. I shall take first the farming tribes, apt in the use of arms and of a - constitution similar to the Jats and Rajpoots; these are principally - found in the Punjab. Second, the tribes more or less pastoral in their proclivities, though now almost universally settled in agricultural - communities. Third, the fine-farming or gardening tribes. Ihave noticed how much the Salt Range seems to be the northern limit of both Jats and Rajpoots. The people north of this range are _agreat puzzle. They are those who seem to me the finest and hand- somest in India, perhaps in the world. They are all now Mahom- _ medans, but are wholly Indian in their language, habits, manners, and constitutions. There can, I think, be no doubt of that ; the line between them and their Pathan neighbours is very distinctly drawn, 3 the languages especially being totally different. Knowing the Pathans so well, any relationship with them is never suggested ; a Pathan is with them a Pathan, and a man of another tribe 1s not a | . But they have fanciful Mussulman genealogies, the | = and Tanaolees from the Caliph Abbas, the Kurrals from | Alexander the Great, the Awans from Roostam and the Gukkurs | from some other Persian hero. _ There are a large number of petty tribes, very like one another, but 96 The Ethnology of India, known by their own tribal names only ; they have no common appel- lation. On the one hand much in their features, &c. would seem to show that they have kindred with the Kashmeerees or with the pre-Hindu congeners of the earlier Indians found in the hills farther west; on the other hand, their language and character, dress, and the architecture of their houses would indicate that they are nearly allied to the Punjabees. The language is altogether Punjabee. In these respects they wholly differ from Kashmeerees. Jats and Rajpoots are so well known that one would think that if they belonged to those tribes, they would say so. As it is, the only tribe which admits a Hindu- — stanee origin, is that which seems to have the least claim to it, the Dilazaks, the predecessors of the present Pathan tribes in the Peshawar valley, and who seem to have themselves so considerable an infusion — of Pathan blood that it has been doubted whether they are not earlier — Pathans. The Swattees too, the people driven out of Swat by the Euzofzyes, though in the main of the blood which supplied the early Indians, ~ must be considered pre-Hindus, and have now a considerable Pathan ~ intermixture. The Gukkurs were the rulers of the Rawal Pindee district in com- paratively modern times. They might possibly be foreign conquerors, but if so, it would seem singular that they should have completely — lost their language, and so entirely assimilated to those around them. — In appearance I do not think Gukkurs could be distinguished from Awans. JBoth are very large fine men, but not exceedingly fair, in- habiting as they do a dry, bare, rather low country, hot in summer, The Awans are the most numerous of these frontier tribes, and the best ; there is no finer people in India. They are settled in large” agricultural communities in the ‘ Chuch’ plain, immediately facing the Peshawur valley on this side the Indus, and are also found in smaller bodies somewhat to the east, in the Jhelum, Guzerat, and Sealkot districts. They are good soldiers as well as good cultivators, and might be taken for the best class of Jats. 7 The Dhoonds and Tanaolees are to the north in the outer range of the Himalaya and about the Indus near Torbela. I have not been in the Tanaolee country, but the Dhoonds seemed to me to be the hand- somest among handsome tribes. It is to be remarked, however, tha The Ethnology of India. 97 in the country far towards the frontier in this direction, the people who are the fairest and handsomest, are not considered the most | plucky and trustworthy ; the blood of Cashmere and Swat does not seem altogether to tend to these latter qualities. I cannot attempt to trace the minor tribes of Alpials, &. &c. &e. Both the Awans of the lower lands and the Dhoonds, &c. of the higher lands seem to have democratic village constitutions. Till we know something of the language of the tribes of the hills west of Cashmere, it would not be safe to speculate on the origin of the people of this corner of India. If the language of the hills is _ nearly allied to the Hindee and the Punjabee, we may suppose that 4 these are Indianised tribes from the same source. If on the other 2 hand the hill tribes speak a tongue of an earlier Arian form, then we i: must look to people of the blood of the Jats and Rajpoots for the introduction of the Hindee form of speech both here and in the rest - of Hindustan. Looking to the want of any proper tribal name of _ the Rajpoots, it might be that before they became famous in Hindu story, some of them occupying the Punjab surmounted the Salt Range and mixing with some aboriginal Caucasians, formed the present tribes. Nowhere is there room for more interesting inquiry than in this direction. - Passing farther down in the Punjab I only remember one class of the character that I am now describing, the Doghurs, a Mahommedan tribe found near the Sutlej, fine, good-looking, high-featured men, but "not very reliable and rather given to cattle-lifting. I do not know In the Simla hills, most of the land is held by a local tribe called Kanaits. They are inferior in position to Rajpoots, more perhaps of the level of Koormees and Lodhas, but they are often educated, and ‘men of this class are generally ministers to the Rajpoot chiefs. In | e rtain places there is a partial and local practice of polyandry among them, but it is not the general custom of the tribe. All those who | are not (in the upper hills) in contact with Tartars are quite Arian, though not very large ; the women very nice-looking. 98 The Ethnology of India. It will also, I think, be proper to mention the Indian Pathans, before I leave my present class of Fighting-Farmers. I do not now touch on the proper Pushtoo-speaking Pathans. I do not reckon them as Indian, and all the Pathans beyond the Indus, as well as a few on this side (in the north of the Hazareh District and west of that of Rawal Pindee), are Pushtoo-speakers. The Pathans are the only Central-Asiatic people who have in comparatively modern times colonised to a considerable extent in India. They have never come in large bodies, nor occupied any large tracts at any one spot, but Affghanistan has always been as it were the base of opera- tions of all the successive Mahommedan Empires in India; and from that base Pathans have immigrated in the service or under the pro- tection of Mahommedan rulers, and have settled themselves here and there at many places. throughout Northern India and even in some places in Southern India. They are not nearly so much mere Urban fortune-seekers as other Mahommedans, but are generally settled in villages, in many of which they own and cultivate the soil, and in some of which they form large brotherhoods, approaching those of — Jats and Rajpoots. Their constitution and mades of government also seem to me to be in these villages very similar. They have been generally a favoured class who have had in places a good deal of jagheer and rent-free land, and still look a good deal to service, but many of them pay their rent or revenue by honest cultivation like sf % FH acre Or Sree Oe ws ee &5 any one else. Indian society is a wonderful solvent and absorbent; — every one who long lives in it, becomes Indianised; and so all the Pathan colonists, even those whose immigrations are matter of recent — history, are essentially Indian, not Affghan. Among Indians, they have very marked characteristics, but their nationality is changed, and the Pathans from the Frontier, who came down in the mutiny times, — utterly refused to acknowledge the proudest Indian Pathans as having anything in common with themselves, and chopped off their — heads with the utmost non-chalance. In many respects, however, the Indian Pathans are a very great improvement on the wilder Pathans of the Frontier. They are very much more civilised and educated. In India, in fact, the Pathans are quite an aristocratic class. Not- withstanding the wide door to corruption of blood opened by the Mahommedan laws of marriage, they are still a very handsome people; | The Ethnology of India. 99 a large proportion of them are in a respectable well-to-do position, and many of them are very well educated. After all a well-educated Mahommedan has much more in common with us than most Hindus, and comes much nearer our idea of a gentleman. It may be, too, that these Pathans retain some little trace of that non-Indian character which makes us readily become familiar with Affghans. Altogether I have no hesitation in saying that (putting the Punjab apart), among Hindustanees, the Pathans are by far the best class with whom we come in contact. They have always been very numerous in our Irregular Cavalry and also had a large share in our Civil Service. I shall be sorry, if, partly on account of the more insinuating and it may be in some respects sharper character of subservient Hindus, and partly from the difficulty of imposing our education on those who have already an education of their own, these and other Mahommedans are gradually extruded from the public service. Pathan settlements are dotted here and there about the Punjab, but they are not very numerous. In Hindustan they are more «so. They are found about Dehli, and are very numerous in the Upper Doab and Rohilcund, though it must not be supposed that _ the latter is really a Rohilla country ; it is only a Rohilla jagheer, and the Pathans, though positively numerous, are relatively but a small minority of the population. It may be mentioned that the term * Rohilla’ does not signify any particular tribe, but is applied in India to Pathans generally, meaning apparently “‘ mountaineer.”” The Rohil- cund and Dehli Provinces are the chief nurseries of Pathan soldiers, &e., but all over Hindustan, and indeed all over India, Pathan Princi- ‘palities and Jagheers, Pathan settlements, and Pathan families are found here and there. It will be well here to dispose of the other Mahommedan settlers, that is, Mahommedans who do not own or cannot be traced toa Hindu origin. With the exception of the Pathans, their origin is, in fact, generally obscure and doubtless very mixed. The name of Mogul is assumed by but few, and whatever the word may originally have been, it must be understood that it does not now in India in any degree mean ‘ Mongol.’ There is no ethnological trace of Mongol immigration into India. Even the leaders who inherited Mongol claims had, in fact, changed their blood in passing 100 The Ethnology of India. through Persian and Affghan peoples. And on the Frontier, the term Mogul is now applied to Persian-speakers, as distinguished from Pushtoo-speaking Pathans. Most people will there tell you that ‘Mogul’ means a Persian, but it is really a somewhat wider designa- tion. In Cabul, the Mahommedan population is simply divided into Pathans and Moguls (or non-Pathans), the latter being chiefly compos- ed of Persian Kazzilbashes and the like. So then in the armies and followings of the Emperors of Dehli, Foreigners were divided into Pathans and Moguls; but while the Pathan settlers are many, the Moguls are, as I have said, very few. = In small Mahommedan countries there are numerous people claim- img to be descendants of the prophet after the easy Mahommedan — form of descent. Indian Syuds are generally mere loose waifs of - low degree among the Urban population; but here and there we have | considerable settlements of Syuds holding villages or jagheers, and where these occur, they generally claim and maintain a good deal of dignity and propriety, and are a superior and well educated, if some- i times somewhat bigoted, class. It is generally said that a ‘ Sheik’ means only a Mahommedan whem is neither Pathan, Mogul, nor Syud. There are, however, a good many respectable landholders, and some village communities who bea the name of Sheiks; for instance, the old proprietors of Lucknow, when it was but a village, were Sheiks. It is impossible to trace the erigin of these people, much less that of the loose Urban Mahomme- — dan population. But I think it may be said that, generally speaking, | the Mahommedans retain among them considerable traces of north- western origin. Dress and manners may have something to do with it, and there are of course many exceptions, but on an average they are fairer and show fewer marks of aboriginal intermixture than the Hindus. High-Arian features are not unfrequently to be seen among them. Even among those who do not directly claim to belong to 0 Pathan and other tribes of the North-West, one often sees handsome: faces, features, and beards, such as would make good ‘ wise men of the east,’ or the very best of our oriental imaginings. It is impossible to attribute to these features, in Northern, Central and Hastern India, a Semitic origin (on the South Western borders it is another matter), id Lattribute them to the hilly countries of the North-Western Arians. — The Ethnology of India. 101 Of the races which I call in some respect pastoral, I will take first THe Goosars. They have been long known to us as cultivators of predatory pro- clivities in the country about Dehli, and after 50 years of enforced peace and quietness, they distinguished themselves by breaking out into wholesale plunder all over that district within a few hours of the out-break of the mutiny, just as if the present generation had been accustomed to it all their lives. However, we must take a wider survey, for the Goojars are a far extending people, numerous in the Punjab and on the Northern Frontier. In fact, they now extend - farther to the North-West than any other Indian people. I understand _ that they are still numerous in Swat and the adjacent hills, and they _ are said to have been the original inhabitants and owners of part of the Hazareh District, on this side the Indus, before they were in great degree dispossessed by the Swattees, themselves pushed forward by the Affghans. In the hills about Kashmere the Goojars are very “numerous ; and there more than anywhere else they have an actual - pastoral character, being apparently somewhat vagrant in their habits, and at one season receiving the cattle of the Kashmeerees to graze, while at another they bring their own down for sale. Perhaps ‘these are the Goojars who were dispossessed of their homes in Hazareh. It is supposed that in the event of any disturbance in kK ashmere, they might visit the valley for other than pastoral purposes. ! Descending into the plains of the Punjab, we find the Goojars about Goojerat and the country thereabouts in very much better repute than elsewhere, in fact they are there said to be among the best cultivators. , They are very numerous, settled in prosperous communities, and give, it appears, their name to the town and thence to the district of | Goojerat. There might be some question whether the word is not the Persian one, ‘ Goozerat,’ 7. e. ‘ Fords’ or ‘ Ferries,’ in allusion to t 1e ferries over several rivers thereabouts, but I understand that it is really Goojerat from Goojar. And there are frequent names in the Punjab derived from the same source. In fact, Goojars are very much mixed with Jats in all the northern, if not in all the Jat country, and form a considerable proportion of the population. About Dehli they are, as I have said, very numerous, and they are so in the Meerut and Seharanpore Districts of the Doab. They are numerous 102 The Ethnology of India. in all Northern Rajpootana, and extend into Malwa and the adjoining parts of Central India.* They there extend as far east as Bundle- cund, where one of the chiefs is.a Goojar.. But in the other direction they do not approach Goozerat, and, so far as I can learn have never been known there. I believe that the Bombay ‘ Goozerat’ is a name derived from some other source. Its proper form is said to be Gurjarat, derived from ‘ Gurjar’ Princes. I do not know the derivation of this last term, but there are Gwurjat Chiefs in the Cuttack and Southern Nagpore territories, where there are no Goojars. I fancy, however, that I have heard it said (though I cannot now trace the source), that a similarity of names can be traced between places in Goozerat and in the Punjab Goojerat. If that be really so, it would open up an interesting inquiry. To prevent mistake, I q should here notice that in the Bombay Presidency the word ‘ Goozar’ is used, not to signify a Goojar in the northern sense, but merely E an inhabitant of Goozerat, as thus ‘Goozar Bramins,’ ‘ Goozar Banians.’ : The Goojars are generally a fair good looking people, especially — towards the frontier, and have no aboriginal traces about them. — Those located to the east trace their origin from the west. All, I think, to the north of Dehli are now Mahommedans; but those to the east and south of that place are sometimes half-Mahommedans, some- _ times a sort of Hindus, though of so lax a character that I believe — they are hardly admitted within the pale, and are considered to be in 4 some degree a sect apart. They are sometimes said by the natives to have a language of their own; at least so I was told in the aaah It may not improbably be that this is only the patois of one province al carried by them into another, but it would be interesting to inqaial whether they may possibly have among themselves some sort of Gypsy tongue. Their most proper calling seems to be the keeping of cattle and buifaloes, not sheep ; but they do not generally exercise — this as a mere caste profession among the Seren population. They * The last Nagpore Prince is stated to have been a Goojar adopted into the family, the son of ‘Nane Goojar, but I apprehend that there must be — some mistake, as the Nagpore family were, I believe, Maratta Koonbees, of the same race as the Sattara family. Hither ‘Goojar’ must be here a mere name or title of the individual, or the allusion must be to some supposed indiscretion of a lady of the family. The Ethnology of India. 103 are usually settled in separate villages of their own, and in the absence of pastoral * and predatory opportunities are cultivators, like other tribes, though in most places indifferent ones. I shall here just mention ‘ Mewattees,’ not because I am prepared to class them as ‘ Pastorals,’ but because they are very frequently classed with Goojars, as ‘‘ Goojars and Mewattees,” with reference to their plundering propensities. In fact, although I have always been familiar with Mewattees as a very thieving tribe of cultivators found here and there along the south-western borders of the North West Pro- vinces, I have not been able to make out what they really are. Theyseem to come from the Central country, from somewhere in Rajpootana or Central India, and their name might seem to indicate a connection with Mewar. I have seen mention of ‘ Mewassees,’ hill chiefs, in those _ parts, but don’t know if they are connected with the Mewattees. In fact, the Alwar country near Dehli seems to have been of late called ‘Mewat.’ Mewattees are mentioned as common in Malwa in the characters of irregular soldiers and depredators. They extend farther east than the Goojars. I think the villages razed to the ground in the station of Allahabad, for their predatory activity in the mutiny, were those of Mewattees. My impression is that they are mostly Mahommedans and not bad looking, but in truth I know and ean find very little about them. The Goojars are succeeded as cattle-keepers to the east and south by the ‘ Aheers,’ who seem to be the pastoral element of the Rajpoot and Bramin countries, as the Goojars are of the Jat countries. ‘Aheers and Goojars are sometimes spoken of as if connected, but that I believe is an error arising from mere coincidence of profession. Meeting as they do in the country east and south of Dehli, they keep entirely apart (in a social point of view), and are universally recognis- ed as entirely separate and distinct castes, with no connection what- ever. The Aheers are not a very strict sect of Hindus in the modern sense, and their widows re-marry, but still they are decided Hindus of the respectable position which their charge of the sacred animal demands. In the strictest days of caste there were a good many Aheers in the Sepoy army. They are good and upper-class-looking Hindustanees. Like we Goojars, es are ae a mere cow-keeping 104 The Ethnology of India. country are in considerable tracts almost the principal landholding class. Under these circumstances they are very fair agri¢ulturalists, only a little given to cattle-lifting, when opportunity offers. Besides the Aheer villages, families of the caste are much spread about the country as cultivators and herdsmen, ‘ Ghosees’ also, common as buffaloe-keepers, are said to be related to the Aheers ; they are, I think, Aheers converted to Mahommedansm. Except in the country occu- pied by Jats and Goojars, Aheers are found all over Hindustan, but do not generally extend east into Bengal. There are many of them just between the proper Jat and the Rajpoot country about the Ganges, to the east of Meerut and Allyghur, and on the other side in part of Rohilcund, and they seem to extend into the south-east of : Rajpootana and of the Dehli territory, and are found about the Jumna : near Muttra, and in many places farther east. In the Benares and : Behar Divisions there are also many of them. Thence through Central India I am not prepared to say what pro- ~ portion of the population are Aheers, but they were certainly very famous in old time on the Southern frontiers of Hindustan, in Guzerat, and in the Maratta country. The famous Fort of Asseerghur derives its name from Asa Aheer, a noted leader of this tribe, and Aheers are still, I believe, found in those parts. They are said to have been once powerful in Goozerat and to be still numerous in — Kattywar. That western country is stated in fact to have been ~ formerly called ‘ Abhira’ or the country of the Aheers. And thenall southwards, it seems probable that Aheers were one of the principal Hindu races who along with the Bramins conquered and colonised Southern India. Bramins and Herdsmen are said to have been the first conquerors, and the Aheers may probably be the progenitors of the cowherd castes who are still numerous in the Southern Districts, One can only suppose Goozerat to have been a Goojar country, by assuming Goojars and Aheers to have been originally identical, which — at any rate would require that we should go back a very long way. The subject is, however, worthy of inquiry. ¢ Besides the Aheers known in the Maratta Districts, there seems to be in the south of that country and also in the Canarese country & quiet respectable class of cultivators called ‘Dhangurs.’ The word is translated ‘Shepherds,’ but I have also seen it stated that the The Ethnology of India. 105 Dhangurs and Aheers are nearly the same. It would be well to know more on the point. In Hindustan sheep and goat herds, ‘ Gaderias,’ form a separate and very inferior caste and profession. They have no villages of their : own, but tend sheep in the villages in which they reside. _ In Bengal Proper and Orissa, the Aheers are succeeded by the Gwallas, whom I have already incidentally noticed as very different in their style, manners and occupations. ‘ Gwalla’ is not a tribal name, but merely means a cowkeeper (from the old Sanscritic word, _ go, a cow), so that the name does not necessarily imply any tribal connection with the Gwallas of the south and elsewhere. The _ Gwallas (as I have before noticed) are, with their congeners the _ ‘Satgopes,’ by far the most numerous Hindu caste in Bengal; and as - Bengal is not much of a grazing country, they constitute a large _ proportion of the cultivators, besides carrying palanquins, acting as _ domestic servants, and following some other avocations. In the jail returns they are about 13 per cent. of the non-Mahommedans, that a is, of Hindus and Aborigines of all sorts taken together; and as ~ Aheers prevail in Behar, it is probable that fn Bengal and Orissa the Gwallas amount to fully 20 per cent. _ There are no democratic villages in Bengal; indeed village commu- nities in the proper sense, with anything like a municipal constitution | of any kind, can hardly be said to exist; the Province is in that | Tespect peculiar. Consequently it is unnecessary to add that the yallas are not in regular communities. They are scattered about the ‘land and attained to respectable positions. They seem to be a quiet, | decent set of people. Tam not well versed in the manners and customs of the Bengallees, | and there seems to be a great want of information on the subject, which I trust may be supplied. | PI have before hazarded a conjecture whether the Bengallee Gwallas | ‘may not have been formed on the basis of the Aboriginal Bhooyas. _ Of the fine cultivators or gardeners, the most important are— a Tue Matwizs, | to whom TI have alluded as apparently allied to the Koormees, and _ who are not only the humble gardeners to whom Europeans ordinarily 106 | The Ethnology of India. apply the name (as to a profession), but a considerable and far extended people. On the Frontier, above the Salt Range and extending up into Peshawar, there is a considerable class of ‘ Mulleals’ who are I believe Mallies (though like most of the people of those parts now Mahom- medans), and who are very industrious cultivators and gardeners. Throughout the plains of the Punjab, there is again a very im- portant and numerous class who seem to be allied to the above, — called Raees or Raeens. These people have generally villages of their : own, or hold divisions of villages on equal terms with Jats and others, — and under a similar constitution. They chiefly affect the best lands ~ and finer cultivation, where they pay a high revenue and are much Py appreciated by native governments; for they are probably, on the — whole, the best cultivators in the Province. They are not martial, but are generally (like almost all Punjabee Mahommedans) fair and ri good-looking men. They are all, so far as I know, Mahommedans, ~ which may account for their bearing a different name from their — Hindu congeners, if congeners they be. So far as I am aware, they — are not known by this name beyond the Punjab. t A little farther east, long before we come to the Koormees, we meet with Hindu Mallies. I know that between Umballa and Dehli, in the | operations), there are a good many Mallie villages. Inthe North West — Provinces I do not think that they are much known as independent landholders, but as gardeners they are scattered about. I find men-_ tion made of them as common about Ajmere and on the Southern frontier of Hindustan. Beyond Jubbulpore they are common, mixed with the Koormees. Thence going onwards to the Maratta country, I in Nagpore also they share the country with the Koonbees, and are the class next in importance to these latter. In fact, in all this. part of Central India, (the southern limits of Hindustan and the Maratta — country), Koormees and Mallies seemed to be classed together. The — Patels, I learned, were either Koonbees or Mallies, and they often divided the same villages. The two classes (I was told by the Patels — of the Nagpore country) will. eat together, but do not intermarry. In this latitude both Mallees and Koormees extend far to the east. I find mention of the former in Orissa, and of the latter in Maunbhoom and other districts of Chota-Nagpore, f The Ethnology of India. | 107 The Lodhas I have already mentioned as connected with and of the same character as the Koonbees, though they are strictly speaking - distinct from them. The remaining classes of Northern India, whose proper profession is cultivation or gardening, have not generally, to my knowledge, villages of their own. There are, however, scattered through most villages in Hindustan many industrious Kachees and Koerees and Morows (tobacco cultivators) and Kumbohs, and some (though not many) who have no other caste name than that of ‘ Kisan’ or cultivator. The farther we go down in the scale, the greater seems to be the infusion of aboriginal blood, the shorter is the stature, the darker the skin, and the more low- Arian the features ; but in none of these decent castes of Hindustan do _ the features or the complexion and hair assume at all an aboriginal type. In Bengal the names of castes are different, and there very many of the cultivators, the majority I believe in all Eastern Bengal, are _Mahommedans, whose original caste and ethnological history I am at present unable to discover. Among Hindus, the most numerous _ castes after Gwallas, Bramins, and Kaists, are Bagdees (who are I am told of an inferior and aboriginal type), and a decent class of cultiva- ‘tors called Kyburtos. I am as yet altogether puzzled about the | ethnology of the mass of Bengal ryots. Most of them, though dark, | look Arian, but some are very dark, and have a decided tendency to a | ’ thickness of lip, and to some features either Aboriginal or Indo- Chinese. I am half inclined to think that there are two types among | them, Some of them seem to have a great tendency to curly hair, | and to a cast of features which I should be disposed to attribute to . the influence of the black woolly-headed. Aborigines, who may have Stretched across from the Rajmahal to the Garrow hills. Others, especially the Ooryahs, with the Bhooyas of those parts and some of the Bengalees, seem rather to have straight hair with high cheek bones. and complexions not very dark, which might suggest an Tndo- Chinese element stretching from Burmah across the Soonderbuns. But I have acknowledged that I do not understand Bengal, and I | hope that others will throw more light on it. The inferior Helot classes, who generally, all over Northern India, | eultivate to a considerable extent, either on their own account, or as _| the servants of others, I leave for another givision of my subject. * 108 The Ethnology of India. : It must, however, be understood that a good deal of cultivation, in most parts of the country, is carried on by miscellaneous cultivators of a great variety of classes, who by caste properly belong to other professions. Cultivation is the one profession which is open to all alike, and is occasionally followed by almost all. In a great part of Hindustan in particular, wherever Rajpoots and Bramins are compara- tively few, and Koerees and Kachees are not numerous, there is in the present state of cultivation a large space not occupied by the classes which I have enumerated, and lists of tenant cultivators of these tracts | present a very great variety. It isthe same in Bengal. The caste of ‘ Telees’ are supposed to be properly oil-manufacturers, but whether _ (seeing the large growth of oilseeds) they were also in their origin © oil-growers, or whether their multiplication is accidental, they certainly — in many parts of the country form an important and respectable section of the agricultural community. Many of them are found both | in Hindustan and in the Bombay Presidency, and in Bengal and ~ Orissa they are particularly numerous and well-to-do. In Bengal the Tantees or weavers are also a prosperous class, and own a good deal of land. The Chumars or leather workers form a large proportion of the population of Hindustan, and are both labourers and cultivators, but they may perhaps better be put among the inferior labouring classes. iq For the rest the list of cultivating artisans and others would be | endless. They must be classed under their own professions. | THe Mercantitte CLassEs. % First under this head, I will put— Tue Kuarrens. - Trade is their main occupation, but in fact they have broad= | er and more distinguished functions. Besides monopolising the trade of the Punjab and the greater part of Affehanistan, and doing a good deal beyond those limits, they are in the Punjab the chief civil administrators, and have almost all literate work in ‘hee hands. So far as the Sikhs have a priesthood, they are moreover the priests or gooroos of the Sikhs; both Nanuk and Govind were, and the Sodees and Bedees of the present day are, Khatrees, Thus then The Ethnology of India. 109 they are in fact in the Punjab, so far as a more energetic race will permit them, all that the Maratta Bramins are in the Maratta country, besides engrossing the trade which the Maratta Bramins have not. : They are not usually military in their character, but are quite capa- ble of using the sword when necessary. Dewan Sawan Mull, Gover- nor of Mooltan (and his notorious successor Moolraj), and very many of Runjeet Sing’s chief functionaries were Khatrees. Even under Mahommedan rulers in the west, they have risen to high administra- _ tive posts; there is record of a Khatree Dewan of Badakshan or _ Koondooz, and I believe of a Khatree Governor of Peshawar under the t Affghans. The Emperor Akbar’s famous minister, Todar Mull, was a Khatree ; and (though I was not before aware of it) a relative of that man of undoubted energy, the great Commissariat Contractor of Agra, Jotee Pershad, lately informed me that he also is a Khatree. Altogether there can be no doubt that these Khatrees are one of the most acute, energetic, and remarkable races in India, though in fact - (except locally in the Punjab) they are not much known to EKuro- _ peans. They are, either on account of their name confounded with Rajpoots (by those who only see the name), or more frequently, on _ account of their mercantile profession, are confounded with the Bun- -neahs or Banians, with whom socially (as matter of tribe and caste) _ they have no connection whatever. The Khatrees are staunch Hin- dus, and it is somewhat singular that, while giving a religion and priests to the Sikhs, they themselves are comparatively seldom Sikhs. And though, judged by a modern Hindu standard, they can hardly penetrate as they do into Central Asia with much regard for caste, _ they show their staunchness by never succumbing to the Mahomme- dan faith, where all the Indians around them have done so. I scarcely "think that there are such people as Mahommedan Khatrees in lati- / - tudes where Jats, Rajpoots, and others are all Mahommedan; and ~ even in Affghanistan they seem to maintain their faith intact. The _ Khatrees are a very fine, fair, handsome race. And as may be gather- ed from what I have already said, they are very generally educated. _ There is a large subordinate class of Khatrees, somewhat lower, but of equal mercantile energy, called Rors or Roras. The proper Khatrees | of higher grade will often deny all connection with them, or at least only admit that they have some sort of bastard kindred with Khatrees, 110 The Ethnology of India. but I think there can be no doubt that they are ethnologically the same, and they are certainly mixed up with Khatrees in their avoca- tions. I shall treat the whole kindred as generically Khatrees. Though the Rors have not usually risen to such high posts, at least one of Runjeet Sing’s ministers was of this class. Speaking of the Khatrees then thus broadly, they have, as I have said, the whole trade of the Punjab and of most of Affghanistan. No village can get on without the Khatree who keeps the accounts, does the banking business, and buys and sells the grain. They seem too to get on with the people better than most traders and usurers of this kind. Of course, like all people so situated, they are often a good deal abused, but ina Punjabee village I think that the Khatree is generally rather a popular character and on friendly terms with his. — clients ; at any rate they appreciate the necessity for him, and are by no means anxious to get rid of him. In Affghanistan, among a rough and alien people, notwithstanding occasional exceptions, the Khatrees are as a rule confined to the position of humble dealers, shop-keepers and money-lenders ; but in that capacity the Pathans seem to look on them as a kind of valuable animal, and a Pathan will steal another man’s Khatree, not only for the sake of ransom (as is frequently done = on the Peshawar and Hazarah frontier), but also as he might steal a milch-cow, or as Jews might, I dare say, be carried off in the middle Pa ages, with a view to render them profitable. I do not know the exact limits of Khatree occupation to the west, ~ ‘ but certainly in all eastern Affghanistan they seem to be justas much a part of the established community as they are in the Punjab. — They find their way far into Central Asia, but the farther they get, the more depressed and humiliating is their position. In Turkistan, a Vambery speaks of them with great contempt as yellow-faced — Hindus of a cowardly and sneaking character. Under Turcoman — rule, they could hardly be otherwise. They have even found their way to St. Petersburgh and made money there. They are in fact the only Hindus known in Central Asia. In the Punjab they are so numerous that they cannot all be rich and mercantile, and many of them hold land, cultivate, take service, and follow various avocations. But I do not think that there is in the plains such a thing as a Khatree village or Khatree community, The Ethnology of India. 111 such as I have described to be the social form of other castes. They are always mixed among other classes. It is somewhat singular that the Khatrees, so important in Affgha- nistan, and who also push so far into Central Asia, are altogether excluded from Bramin Kashmere ; they are not found there at all. In point of acuteness, I fancy it is an instance of ‘ two of a trade.’ In the hills, however, the ‘ Kukkas’ on the east bank of the Jhelum are said to have been originally Khatrees, (they are a curiously handsome race); and in the interior of the Kangra hills there is an interesting race of fine patriarchal-looking shepherds called ‘ Gaddees,’ most of whom are Khatrees. There are some Bramins among them, and some of low caste, but the great majority are Khatrees, and their story is that they are the remnant of the former rulers of the plains of the Punjab, _ driven to the hills by conquering invaders. They are a very pleasant, frank, simple people, quite apart from their present neighbours, and a great puzzle. Khatree traders are numerous in Dehli, are found in Agra, Lucknow and Patna, and are well known inthe Burra Bazar of Calcutta (though there they are principally connected with Punjab firms). But as soon as they pass east from the limits of the Punjab, 4 they get into the mercantile field of the Bunneeahs, who are quite their equals in mere mercantile ability where little physical courage is required, and in the Bunneeah country the Khatree merchants are _ mere exceptions in large towns. _ In Behar there seems to be a considerable agricultural class called | Kshatrees, Chatrees, or Khatrees, who are distinct from and considered _ to be somewhat lower in rank than Rajpoots. They seem somewhat _ to affect a Military character, sometimes serve, I believe, as soldiers, and are well known as ‘ Darwans’ and the like in Calcutta. Bucha- han seems to have been inclined to suppose that they are really Kha- trees from the west, but I have not yet been able to ascertain whe- ther they are in truth of the same caste as the mercantile Khatrees. I do not know the exact limits of the Khatrees to the south. I have not visited Mooltan which is a great mercantile centre of the race, and cannot accurately distinguish between Khatree and Bun- neeah sects called by their sub-tribal names. The term ‘ Mooltanees’ Seems to be applied to several trading sects in different parts of Cen- tral India, &c., some apparently wandering Pathan traders, and some, 112 The Ethnology of India. I suspect, of some Khatree sect. The Khatrees do not» seem as a rule to reach the western Coast; the Guzerat and Cutch traders appear to be Bunneeahs (or Banians) not Khatrees, and in the Bombay market I cannot find that they have any considerable place. In Scinde, however, I find (in Captain Burton’s book) an account of a race of “pretended Khsatryas who are really Banians of the Nanuk-Shahi (Sikh) faith,” and who trade and have a large share of public offices. These are evidently Khatrees. I had supposed the Lohanee merchants to be Pathans coming under much the same cate- gory as the “ Povindeahs,” but again Captain Burton makes mention of the “ Lohanos, a Mooltanee caste of Banians,” a robust and good- looking race who trade with Central Asia, and also with the Arabian Coast, who form a very large proportion of the Government servants in Scinde, and who also do some agriculture and labour. I cannot at this moment ascertain whether these Lohanos are really Banians or Khatrees, probably I think the latter. Palgrave again mentions among the Indian traders of the Arabian Coast, as distinguished from _ Banians, people whom he calls ‘ Loothians’ or Loodianah men. I take it that these must be Khatrees, unless indeed they may possibly — be Kashmeree shawl merchants. Loodianah is a large and thriving ~ town of mercantile Khatrees, with a numerous colony of Kashmeree shawl-weavers. — The Khatrees claim to be the descendants of the old Kshatryas, and I am inclined to think that they really have the best claim to that honour. With all their enterprise, it is difficult to imagine them ° iy so completely domiciled in Affghanistan, among so alien a people, if — they are entirely foreigners in that country. It is well known that the Pathans themselves have advanced into the North Eastern por- tion of the country which we call Affghanistan, within comparatively © ie recent and historical times; and although the upper valleys of the — Indian Caucasus have pO all along been held by pre-Hindu — tribes, there seems to be little doubt that the lower valleys of the — Cabul country were once Hindu. To this day the peaks of the — ‘ Sufed Koh’ between Jalalabad and Cabul bear the palpably a names of ‘Seeta Ram” and such like. The old Sanscrit books make the, Bramins and Khsatryas to uote remotely sprung from a common origin, May it not be that in-early | The Ethnology of India. 113 Aryan days the Bramins of Kashmere may first have become literary and civilised, and ruled on the Saraswatee by peaceful arts, after the fashion of the earliest Egyptians before the art of war was invented, (See M. Renan’s abstract of recent Egyptian inquiries); and that later a cognate tribe of Khatrees of the Cabul country, rougher and more warlike, may have come down upon them like the Shepherd Kings, and assumed the rule of the Military caste of early Hindu his- tory? That warlike conquerors of one age should become astute money-dealers of ancther, is but the ordinary course of history—Jews, Greeks, Lombards and others are instances in point, and perhaps when the New Zealanders rule in England, the English may be knewn as the Khatrees of those parts. Tue Bounneaus, Baniays, Banuzs, on WanNzES. No race is more important in India than the Banees. What I have described the Khatrees to be in a mercantile point of view in the Punjab, that the Banees are in the whole of Hindustan and Wes- _ tern India. No village can get on without them. Unlike the Kha- _ trees, they are for the most part confined to their proper mercantile business. A few of them are found in Government offices and such Service, more properly the domain of the Kaists, but these are only tare exceptions. They have also under our system acquired by pur- chase large rights in the land, and take farms of more, but this is in fact with them a mere mercantile operation; they do not cultivate ‘the land, but make the most of the rents payable by the ryots, and the ejected proprietors reproachfully term the British Government Bunneah ka Raj” or the shopkeepers’ rule. Bunneahs may cultivate a few fields, like any one else, or even reduced individuals may earn their livelihood as ryots or labourers, but so far as I know, a proper Bunneah village is nowhere to be found. There is no doubt that in their own way the Banees are a people of wonderful energy and enterprise, and it is their energy that gives tone and sinew in a commercial, and to a great degree an industrial sense, to the greater part of India. Without the Banee to supply the _ sinews of war, little would be done. Their function permeates every operation of every village. In all the great cities of Hindustan, they are found in a position commanding much respect as Bankers and ee ~~ 114 The Ethnology of India. Merchants, and they are also most daring speculators, as is well known in the markets of Bombay and Calcutta. Indeed they often carry the rage for speculation to the point of gambling. In respect of physical courage, however, the case is quite different. Both their habits and their religious ideas make the use of a sword a thing unknown to © them, and they have no affectation of personal manliness. If the Banees are not generally very tall or strong, they are not much the contrary, and they are generally very fair. For this latter feature their indoor avocations may in part account, but that alone is not, I think, sufficient. When one gets peeps of the faces of their women ~ on the occasion of great religious gatherings and the like, they seem to be fair beyond almost any other Hindustanee caste. The men, though flabby and un-muscular looking, are, I think, to an © unprejudiced eye often by no means bad looking. They have, how- ever, none of the high-Arian sharpness of feature, but rather a sleek comely pudding-faced kind of countenance, something like those old — ‘Egyptian faces which are said to come nearest to the Hindu type. — They are, I think, generally reputed more grasping than I have dea scribed the Khatrees to be; are more often accused of being hard % on those in their power, and exercising a severe tyranny of the purse. _ But even in their case I believe that this is a good deal exaggerated, and = that many of those who abuse them most, can least get on without - them. Possessed as they are of so much capital and energy, there can be no doubt that, from an industrial point of view, the acquisition a by them, from indolent and unprovident proprietors, of a good deal . of the land is beneficial, when it becomes their absolute property. — They, almost alone among superior landholders, perform something of — the industrial functions of landlords, and they know too well the — value of ryots, altogether to expend and sell up those in whom they have a permanent interest. There is to be set, on the other side, the political weakness resulting from the existence of large numbers of strong-armed pre-owners still, as they think, natural proprietors, side by side with new owners who in a difficulty will not fight. Still, if the Bunneahs will not fight, they may perhaps pay others to fight for them. It is only when they are set to ‘exploiter’ the ryots in a speculative way, as mere temporary lessees and middlemen under the great superior Zemindars, that they are often a great curse, The Ethnology of India. bts The great seat of the Bunneahs seems to be in the west, and most of them point to a western origin, or rather, speaking from a Hindustanee point of view, [ should say south-western, not to the Punjab, but to Rajpootana and the Bombay country. There are a great many sub- divisions among them, and my impression is that the different divisions do not intermarry as do those of Jats and Rajpoots. There may therefore be ethnological distinctions among them, but I do not know that itis so. The most famous of them are the Marwarees ; and that is the name of the country, and not of the sect, intimating their habitat in Rajpootana. The red-turbaned gentlemen so conspi- cuous in the Calcutta Opium marts and Bombay share-markets are generally Marwarees. In Hindustan the highest class of Bunneahs are called ‘ Aggerwals,’ and there are several other sects. The Bunneahs professing the Jain religion are called Srawaks, and under that name they seem to have been famous in very old times, even in parts of Central India which are now comparatively barbarous. In Hindustan, Hindu Boras are a sect of money-lenders and traders and, Limagine, Bunneahs. I believe the name is the same as that of the ~ Mahommedan ‘ Borahs’ of the Bombay side; but the latter, with some peculiar Mahommedan tenets, have probably got some traces of transmarine blood, and I shall reserve them for the category of ‘ Bor- derers.’ Towards the south of Hindustan I have heard of a sect of inferior Bunneahs called ‘ Jashwals’ who, unlike the race generally, are lax Hindus and even permit their widows to remarry. So far as I can make out, the proper Banees are not thoroughly and completely domiciled in Bengal proper, and to the want of that element (or of anything’ equal to it) I attribute the absence of enter- prise and practical achievement, which seems to be remarkable among the Bengallee, notwithstanding the great value acquired by the land ‘under the permanent settlement, and the accumulation of wealth ‘during a hundred years of peace. In Calcutta most of the considerable trade and banking business and all the Hindu speculation is done by ‘up-country Marwarees and other Bunneahs, not by Bengallees. In the Bengal districts, though a good many Banee colonists. are settled in towns and considerable places, the money-lending and shopkeeping business seems to be in great part in the hands of a variety of other classes. Bramins do, I believe, a good deal of money-lending, and the 116 : The Ethnology of India. goldsmith class are also Bankers in Bengal. Then there is a class of Sahoos, whose proper profession is spirit-distilling and vending, but who have a large share of the general trading business. The common ‘ Modees’ or grain-sellers, instead of being almost universally Banees as in Hindustan; are, I understand, of various castes, and there are separate spice-sellers, oil-sellers, &c. If there are not so many enterprising Banees to make the most of the land, there is at any rate this advantage that, I believe, the ryots are now not nearly so much rack-rented in Bengal as they are in Behar and other parts of Hindustan, where the lands of great landholders are almost in- variably farmed to speculators. In Goozerat, Forbes describes the Wanees as very universal and very grasping. But at any rate the traders of the Coast of . Goozerat and Cutch are very enterprising. The Banian of those parts is ar important institution all over the coasts of Arabia and Africa on the opposite side of the Ocean. And in Bombay, Premchand and “other Banees have made their names famous. In the Maratta country, — the higher trade and banking seems to be done by Marwarees, the village business by local Wanees. Farther south, in the Canarese country, the classes of trading proclivities called, ‘ Banijagas’ seem to be very numerous, but as the name is derived from the Sanscrit — ©Banij’ a trader, I cannot be quite sure that the northern and southern traders are se by blood. Inquiry is necessary On this point. 7 £ Almost all the Banees are strict Hindus, that is, strict in their own _ form of the faith ; for in some sense Jains and such like may be said S 5 not to be proper Win das In Hindustan, though there are a good many Jains, the great majority are proper Hindus. They may be considered to be in religion very high Hindus, and carry toa great — extreme respect for animal life. This tenet, I think, connects them — a with the wena Jains and others, ae foundation of oe — souls from one creature to another. The Banees are, I think, really the most sincerely religious among the Hindus, and much attached to their tenets) Among many other Hindu classes, religion is littl better than form. In the west country, Jain tenets very much pre at the present day .among all the Banee classes, and seem to ha‘ | Bes As The Ethnology of India. ' Vi7 had a very ancient hold upon them. In the south, the Banijagas are, it appears, now chiefly Lingamites and, as such, scarcely Braminical Hindus. But at one time the Jain form quite prevailed among them. In fact, in all the west and southwest the Jain religion appears to have been at one time predominant. The Jains seem to assert that the Rajpoots were once of their faith, The Pali language and cha- racter would seem especially to belong them. What then is the origin of the Banees? That is a very puzzling question. I cannot account for them in any historical way, but the speculation which has occurred to my mind is, whether they may not originally have been immigrants by sea from the west who brought . with them the Phallus or Lingam, and those ideas of a continually I self-reproducing procreative power which took shape in the worship of Siva, and eventually gave birth to Buddhism and to Jainism, and which finally, meeting and amalgamating with the Braminical faith, _ produced modern Hinduism. If this be so, we might suppose that the Banees had done much to civilise the Central and South of India, before the Bramins got so far. But, as I have said, this is mere speculation ; much farther inquiry is necessary. ; Among the mercantile classes of the north (as well as of the south) 7 should be classed the well-known Banjaras or wandering grain mer- _ they carry on their trade all over the country, they have in some re aces fixed homes. On the borders of Rohilcund, towards the Terai, “they have in fact considerable settlements, are considerable landed Pp oprietors and altogether important people. 4 I now come to the Writer classes :— Tue Karts orn Kayasts. | : Important as this caste now is, I am totally at a loss to imagine how or why it came into existence. In old Hindu times, with a great 4 ramin class occupying something the position which Bramins now d among the Marattas (by no means confined to sacerdotal duties, but performing all literate functions), one can see no room for a sepa- rate Writer class. If the Rajpoots, coming in as conquerors, wished to put aside the Bramins, they would probably have found Khatrees and Banees ready to assist them. The Mahommedans, we know, had 118 } The Ethnology of India. always among them a large educated class of their own, so much so that in the early days of our rule in Upper India most of our public servants were Mahommedans. Yet somehow there has sprung up this special Writer class, which among Hindus has not only rivalled the Bramins, but in Hindustan may be said to have almost wholly ousted them from secular literate work, and under our Government is rapidly ousting the Mahommedans also. Very sharp and clever these Kaits certainly are. They are looked on by Hindus as rather a low caste, and their appearance is not aris- tocratic. Most of them are decidedly dark, generally spare thin men, and, I should say, on the average short, with often sharp weasel-like features, small and quite low-Arian. They are somewhat lax in their ways, given to drink, and on their great annual festival, when they worship the pen, it is rather the correct thing than otherwise to have a good debauch. They have generally the office of Patwaree, or village accountant ; and of high office, having always had a good share, they are getting — more and more a monopoly. They are, in fact, first-rate men ol business, and without pride ready to adapt themselves to our ways, they have become almost indispensable to us. They have acquired much landed property, some by honest means, some by dishones 3 - means, when very loose practices prevailed in our courts. And of | course, with dignity and wealth the respect with which they are re- garded from day to day increases. What I have said of loose ways, is ; only applicable to the lower and more common members of the sect. It is” : only fair to acknowledge that there are now many high officers and worthy proprietors of this class, whose respectability is great and con- a duct unimpeachable. I never remember to have heard a conjecture as to the origin of the Kaits. They are never found in separate villages, but are scattered about rather as a separate profession than a | separate race. .There are a good many illiterate men among them who earn their bread as they best can ; but most of them are educated: I should not say that they anywhere in Hindustan form a very large” population. One may suppose that when the Bramins got indolent, this class grew up asa sort of low-caste clerks to the Bramins, who- ruled by supplanting their masters. But whence did they get their talent? Some of the Aboriginal races seem to have activity and | bodily energy, but none of them mental talent. | The Ethnology of India. 119 In Bengal the Kaits occupy a higher relative position and are very numerous. It is related as a historical fact that they accompanied the Bramins into Bengal from the North-West, and indeed it would seem as if the Hindustanee colonists in Bengal had been almost ex- clusively Bramins and Kaits ; there are scarcely any other castes of well authenticated Arian descent, while a large proportion of the inhabitants show some aboriginal traces. In Bengal then the Kaits seem to rank next or nearly next to the Bramins, and form an aristo- cratic class. According to the Jail Returns, they are 7 per cent. of _ the Hindus incarcerated in Bengal, Behar and Orissa, and in the _ general.population they are probably in still larger proportion. They have extensive proprietary rights in the land, and also, I believe, cul- tivate a good deal. Of the ministerial places in the public offices they have the larger share. In the educational institutions. and _ higher professions of Calcutta, they are, I believe, quite equal to the Bramins, all qualities taken together, though some detailed informa- tion of the capacities of different classes, as shewn by the educational tests, would be very interesting. Among the native pleaders of the High Court, most of the ablest men are either Bramins or Kaits ; | _ perhaps the ablest of all, at this moment, is a Kait. | Not knowing where else to put them, I shall here mention a caste | who are, so far as I know, peculiar to Bengal, the Boidyas or physicians, | They are not very numerous, are, I believe, often learned and respecta- j ble men, and rank high among Hindus, but in truth I do not know | very much about them. It would be interesting to know more. The Kaits extend west all through Hindustan, are numerous in | Malwa and are found in Goozerat. But in this latter Province we come upon either another caste of the same kind, or a branch of the Same bearing a different name, and called— 4 Pursuoos on Purvors who are very conspicuous in that part of India and in the town of Bombay, where they do most of the work of clerks. I cannot make out whether Kaits and Purbhoos are in the main the same or differ- ent. Of two well informed native gentleman whose opinions have | been sent me, one seems to think that they are mere sub-divisions of an original writer class, another, that they are different. Those whom _| Isaw in Bombay seemed to me different in appearance as well as 120 The Ethnology of India. very different in dress from the Hindustanee Kaits; they are, I should say, generally fairer and better looking. I should much like to know more about them. Tne ARTISANS. For ethnological purposes it would be useless to go through the long lists of professional castes, as they cannot, so far I know, be distinguished as representing races, but are merely the modern Hindu social division into professions. It will nearly suffice to say that in : : d Northern India almost every possible profession has its separate caste, and that there is no grouping of them together, either into right hand and left hand, or into such groups as the Punchalas of the south, Nothing of the kind is known; Carpenters, Blacksmiths, Goldsmiths, Bricklayers, Potters, Barbers, Confectioners, Washermen, Spirit-sel- lers, and very many others, have all their own separate castes, and they eat and marry within those castes. Some are more and some less strict Hindus. All are of a low-Arian type, and I am not prepared — to suggest any ethnological differences, except that they are better — looking in the Punjab, and less so to the east and south, I doubt, whether substantial differences can be found till we get lower, to tribes” exhibiting more decided aboriginal traces. Most professions bear different names in Bengal from those in Hindustan. I do not know much of these classes in Goozerat and the Maratta country. ‘- The Hindustanee Kahars or Palkee-bearers are a considerable class, i. and are strong hard-working men, rather good looking than otherwise, — % They stand well among Hindus, whose water-carriers they are, and — who will therefore generally drink from their hands. They are also fishermen and cultivate a good deal. They have by caste nothing — whatever to do with cow-keeping, though they may own cows, like other people. I believe that they are quite distinct both from — Bengal Gwallas and from south country Buis or Booes. They are found in parts of the Punjab as well as in all Hindustan, but not in - the west of the Punjab. | t Tue Inrerion AND Hetot Cuassss. a Finally I come to the inferior labouring classes, the Helots and out-castes, among whom, if anywhere, the aboriginal blood should show itself in a marked way. .. The Ethnology of India. 121 ' Castes originating in a difference of races, it may be pretty safely assumed that Helot races represent conquered peoples; but it some- times happens that the form remains when all substantial difference has disappeared, just. as in fossilgswe have the form although in fact the substance is stone like that which surrounds it. In the hills of the extreme north, where we have the high-Arian race in its purest and most unalloyed state, even the form of a Helot caste is wanting ; which is just what we might expect in a country where the Arians themselves are the aborigines. There are no out-caste Pariahs. In Kashmere a tribe called Wattals are said to be low, but they appear to be rather immoral than ethnologically low, a gypsy kind of tribe which supplies dancing girls and prostitutes. The women are noto- riously among the handsomest in the valley, so they are not at all Helots such as I mean. In all these hills, the ‘‘ Chooras’’ of the plains are altogether wanting. ' In the plains of the Punjab there is a thorough Helot tribe. The arrangement of castes is there generally more simple than elsewhere, and a single low caste tribe are both the ordinary labourers who do all the inferior Coolee work, and at the same time the out-caste scavengers of the community. They are in fact all considered to be of the lowest sweeper caste, and are called ‘ Chooras.’ As in most democratic communities there has generally been under _ the freemen a Helot class (the Helots of Greece, the Slaves of Rome, the Negroes of South and the Irish of North America), so also every dat village has its Helot quarter, where the low caste people, fewer, but still considerable in number, reside. They sometimes cultivate on their own account, but more generally act as labourers, and do all that ‘is done by the Chamars in Hindustan. When a traveller of rank arrives at a village in Hindustan, the Chamars are called out to carry his baggage ; the Chooras in the Punjab. - These Punjabee Helots are in fact fine powerful men and tolerably good looking. They were well-known under native governments as good soldiers, fit to be expended on desperate enterprises. The early Sikh reformers, preaching their doctrines of equality, tried to bring these men within the pale, but with very partial success, though a few were admitted to a respectable position as Sikhs. They were only occasionally used as soldiers by chiefs who were hard-pressed, 122 The Ethnology of India: It has been reserved for us to enlist them in regular regiments, and to try to raise them to a good position. Like most low-placed men, they look low, when in low case performing low offices; but that they are well grown and powerful, isgalways clear. I had recently an opportunity of looking at them carefully, in a body drawn up on Regimental Parade, and looked especially with the view of seeing whether I could detect any ethnological peculiarity. I was quite’ satisfied that nothing of the sort is to be found. There may not be so large a proportion of good looking men as among the higher castes, but as a body they are fine Arians, not very materially inferior to the other people of the country. The only physical peculiarity that I have noticed among people of this class in the Punjab is, that a large proportion of them have only one eye. I apprehend, however, that: this is not an ethnological peculiarity, but the result of inferior labour in a dry and dusty country, as may be seen in Egypt. “In Scinde also the low caste people are mentioned as large men of Punjabee origin and speaking the Jatee language. They are there called ‘Bale Shahe’ or Royal, a term also I believe applied to the sweepers in some other parts of India, and which may seem ironical, but. : may possibly be founded.on some traditions of their former rule. ~ In the Punjab, in addition to the functions which I have mentioned, the Chooras are generally the village watchmen ; and it may be observed, ba that this office is all over India very generally held by the represen= | tatives of the oldest races, especially when they possess any fighting capacities. It may be supposed that when conquerors came in, they. would find the headmen of the conquered races best acquainted with the localities, and most capable of dealing with those of their brethren who had taken to the jungles. I should always be inclined to look — to the watchmen for ancient ethnological traces. The same races who . do the watching also often do the thieving, and the Punjab Chooras — have done a good deal of theft and robbery and some thuggee. — What may be the origin of these Punjabee Helots, I must leave to conjecture. Hither they may represent an old aboriginal tribe, whose features have been wholly absorbed by infiltration and intermixture, and who have left no ethnological traces but a dark tinge in the colour of the Punjabees and Affghans of the lower hills, or they may. be early Arian inhabitants, conquered and enslaved by subsequent | | tribes of Bramins, Khatrees, Rajpoots, and Jats. >| The Ethnology of India. 123 © At any rate it may generally be said, that the whole population of the Punjab, both high and low, is above the average Arian type. ~ Ihave before mentioned that the lower class of cultivators and labourers in the Simla hills are called “‘ Kolees.” I have not noticed among them any marked aboriginal features. ‘ I have alluded to the Chamars as the labourers of Hindustan; but there the functions of the Punjabee Helots are divided; the Chamars are the labourers (besides their own proper profession of curing skins), and the out-caste sweepers are an entirely separate and lower class. I have never quite made out whether the Chamars are considered to be properly Hindus. They are not considered abso-+ lutely offensive to the touch like the unclean out-castes, but their name is commonly used to signify a low man, and the greatest insult commonly proposed is to beat a man by the hands of Chamars. © They used to be sworn ina court by a peculiar Gooroo of their own, not by the ordinary name of God; and the sweepers again had. a different Gooroo. They really are the modern Sudras of Hindu society, and no Hindustanee village could get on without them, Like others, they do not appear to advantage when engaged in menial offices, but to judge them fairly we should take them clean and decently fed and dressed. Most of our Hindustanee Syces are _ of this caste, and any one in Northern India may among them satisfy himself of their general style. It seems to me that they are a good specimen of the lower grade of the low-Arian type. An ancient "proverb, quoted by Sir H. Elliott, speaks of a black Bramin and a fair Chamar as perversities to be avoided. In these days I think many Bramins may be found darker than many Chamars; but as a rule and on an average the Chamars are very decidedly dark, also rather small, though active and well knit. In features they are as it were quite the opposite of the high-Arian; there is a want of prominence, a simplicity as it were of feature; but still they do not I think show anything whatever that can really be called aboriginal. Judged by a@ European standard, and colour and size apart, I think that their features are quite as good as the average of Europeans of inferior degree. \ The Chamars have never been soldiers, though I believe that we haye enlisted some of them since the mutiny ; nor have they generally 124 The Ethnology of India. held the office of watchman ; that is more frequently held by the unclean out-castes. In their own trade as leatherworkers and shoemakers, they are clever intelligent men, and they are the same as Syces and some- times Coachmen, and as Coolees and hired labourers. In some parts of the country, a good deal of the cultivation is in their hands; but I have not heard of their acquiring considerable landed rights or rising high in the world, except in Chateesgurh in the Central Provinces, where I understand that a colony of Chamars of a reformed faith have come to occupy quite an aristocratic position. ) - The Chamars generally are apt to be somewhat . foul feeders ; the lower people of the race habitually eat the dead cattle which they skin. They are also a good deal given to drink, when they can afford it. The unclean outcastes are generally by no means numerous in Hindustan, and are for the most part confined to their own proper — functions. There are various sub-divisions of them, and they are somewhat indiscriminately known by various names, Bhangees, Meh ters, &c. General Briggs, in an ingenious paper, tracing the names of provinces to aboriginal tribes, makes the Bhangees the Aborigines of — E Bengal, but the term is a Hindustanee one, not Bengalee. The term ‘Dome’ is somewhat generally applied to these people, or if specially, : I should say that their particular function is more particularly con- 5 nected with dead dogs. It would appear, however, that in the north : | of Hindustan under the Himalayas, the Domes were once a consider- | able tribe, and in the Kumaon hills, they are still a numerous Helot a: section of the population, being in fact the only inferior class, and 2 assuming the functions of artizans as well as those of ordinary labourers. They are there described as very black, with curly hair, and alto- gether very aboriginal in appearance. I had not myself noticed this, — but when I knew Kumaon I had not much taken up ethnology. In the plains where races have been longer and more mixed, and where, as I have said, the lowest caste are few in numbers, they do not, I think; exhibit aboriginal features. The fact is that so small a class has beem recruited by people turned out of other classes, to a degree which has quite obliterated their original type. There are now many decidedly good-looking people among them, and their women often take up with men of other caste. On the average, I should say, that they are now decidedly better looking than the quiet decent Chamars, The Ethnology of India. 125 ' The result is that, in my view, in Hindustan, after 3,000 or longer years of juxta-position, the Arian element has quite prevailed in feature over the aboriginal type, and the population, take them all in all, are in this particular about as Arian as Europeans, but dark in skin and usually smaller. - It is on the authority of one of the most learned native members of the society that I have alluded to the Bagdees, one of the most numer- ous non-Mussulman castes of Bengal, as aboriginal, but I have no particular description of them; and though I have observed the much greater frequency of aboriginal feature in Bengal, I am not sufficiently acquainted with the people to distinguish the special per- sonal characteristics of the different inferior classes. The Bagdees seem to be cultivators, fishermen, watchmen, and dacoits. On the borders of Bengal and Behar, the work of labourers is done by Raj- wars, Bhooyas and other aboriginal tribes whom I have noticed, The unclean tribes seems to be very various, and to have among them a system of castes more particular than that of many Bramins, I was lately obliged to dismiss the lowest servant in my establishment, an excellent man, because he respectfully but firmly declined to wash the cat, as impossible under the rules of his caste. In the Prison Returns there is a large entry under the head of _ *Chandals,’ the orthodox low caste name, and others appear under the titles of ‘ Dosads,’ ‘ Harees,’ ‘Bhoomallees,’ &c, Altogether they must be numerous in Bengal. There is in the list a cgnsiderable caste of ‘ Mooshers,’ but I cannot find what they are. . - I consider that in Bengal there is still a very great field for ethno- logical exploration. In the plains of Goozerat, the Kolees seem to fill the place of the inferior grade in the social scale, as labourers and lower cultivators, being there rather members of the ordinary community that a separ- ate aboriginal tribe. The unclean outcastes are there called Dhers- and Olganas. 7 * In the Maratta country, the ‘ Mhars’ seem to perform the functions of ‘Begars’ (forced bearers of burdens), watchmen, and Helots gener- ally, much as the Punjab Helots do among the Jats. There is also a low caste of Mhangs. The lowest unclean caste are called ‘ Dhers’ there too, but I have also seen it asserted that the ‘ Mhars’ are really the 126 3 The Ethnology of India. same as the ‘“ Dhers.’”’ There is a low caste called ‘‘ Parwarees’’ in the country below the Ghats. They are found in the Bombay | army. They, also, seem to be much the same as Mhars. Everything seems to point to the reasonable expectation, that if we could but trace the matter back far enough, the Goozerattee language would be found to be the tongue of the Rajpoots and Koormees with an infu- sion derived from the Koolees, and the Maratta that of the Koormees and Mallies with a considerable infusion derived from the aboriginal Mhars. I have not any good description of the personal appearance of the modern Mhars. The Ramooses of the south of the Bombay country, seem to have been a bold robber caste, now settled down to cultivation. They came apparently from the Telagoo country and are not aboriginal to the Maratta districts. Besides the settled lower classes, there are also in the north some tribes of a character which is apparently more common in the south ; people who are a kind of half-tamed huntsmen, watchmen, and thieves, doing little regular labour. In all Oude and in some of the neigh- bouring districts to the east, there prevails a very peculiar tribe called “ Pasees’” who almost monopolise the office of village watchmen and who are in their way extremely good active men. They are also huntsmen and thieve extensively, also to some degree cultivate and labour. On the whole they are superior to most of these tribes. Then there are several wandering tribes of Bhoureahs, Sansees, Harnees, Koonjars, Dhanuks, and others who go about on pretext of trapping vermin and the like, and are great robbers. There are also é everywhere the gypsy ‘ Nuts’ or ‘ Sirkie-bashes’ (dwellers under reed- ‘ mats), but Gypsies are too well-known all over the world to need farther specification here, a Tue Tripes oF THE Soutnu. » I have already avowed my ignorance of the Telinga country, and — without a good knowledge of the races there existing, it would be im- possible to trace the Aryan tribes in their progress from North to South—for I find that a very large proportion of the tribes farther South refer to Andria, the Telinga country, as a former stage in their southward progress. That country seems in fact to have been a great nursery of the southern tribes, Whether “ Andria” is another form of The Ethnology of India. 127 “ Ariana’ I am unable to say. The change, on the southern frontier of the Maratta country, to a Canarese population seems to be abrupt, and there are few traces of progress of the tribes southwards at that point. Iam inclined to think that the aborigines held out in the hilly country about Sattara and Poonah till a more recent date, and that the Arian immigration into the south principally occurred by a route farther to the east through the Telinga country, which may possibly have been then more extensive than it now is. In this I put aside the question of maritime immigration from the west. The Telinga country seems, from some source, to have been civilised at a very early date, and there appears to be reason to believe that a good deal of the country about Warangal and thence eastwards to- wards the sea, was in a better state than that into which it has since fallen. Much of the ancient Telinga country is said to have been taken from the Koles who (in the sense in which I have used the word) are not now adjacent—the Gonds intervening—and the country Was it seems anciently called ‘‘ Kalinga” which may be another form of Coolie-land. The old Telingas seem to have been a maritime people, and it was probably they who carried Hindu ideas and perhaps some Hindu blood into the Hastern Isles. To this day the Hindus _ ofthe Hastern Coast are called “‘ Klings’” on the opposite side of the _ Bay and in the Islands, a name evidently derived from Kalinga or \ Kalinga. It is then much to be hoped that we may obtain some _ better knowledge of the Telinga country. + The Bainjagas, who are very important in the Canarese country, are 3 Stated to be comparatively humble in the Telinga country and reduced to the condition of cultivators and labourers, while the mercantile business is in the hands of Comtees or Comatiyas, claiming to be a ‘Yace of pure Arian Vaisyas. The dominant classes are others of Arian s ij é character, whom I shall presently mention so far as I know them. All this would seem to indicate that if the Banees, being according te. ‘my speculation western immigrants, ever reached the Telinga country as Srawaks or Lingamites, or with some earliest forms of that type of faith, they have since been redueda and humbled by Northern -_* The principal people of whom I find mention in the Telings — are Aylmas or Velmas, said to be “the Rajpoots of the 128 The Ethnology ef India. South,” and apparently somewhat like them in character, a dominant agricultural tribe of military proclivities. But of the nature of their settlements I have no information. Another similar tribe are men- tioned as ‘ Ratsawars.”’ Another fine tribe called Reddies and found in the Northern Canarese country, are also stated to be a Telinga tribe, but of their — jocation in the latter country I have no particulars. The original Telinga “‘ Andras” seem to have come from the North ~ West by the valleys of the Godavery and Wyngunga. ‘The better classes of them would seem to be taller, fairer, and better looking than most of the southerners. The “common Telinga peasantry” are described as people of spare form and dark complexion, with little spirit or enterprise, but it is added that they do well inthe Madras Army. I cannot make out what are the common castes of these people! ‘Naik,’ a word known in the native army and elsewhere, is in some sense a Telinga, but more properly I believe an aboriginal word, — There are I think some people called Naiks towards the Hastern — Ghats, but in most places ‘Naik’ is the title of a headman. The — Telinga villages, I find it stated, are not compact and fort-looking — like those of Northern India and the Maratta country, but loose and — detached, which would seem to be rather an approach to the very — loose Bengal form. There are a good many Gonds in the North Hast, — but the common low tribes are ‘ Dhers’ and * Beders' who have their = Helots’ quarter in each village. iq 4 The Telinga palanquin-bearers are widely spread over the south ~ f and are, I imagine, the Buis of whom I have before made mention, The bearers who ply at Madras itself and on the East Coast seem to come from Ganjam and the Northern Circars, which also furnish many pi of the so-called “ Coolee” emigrants to the Mauritius. i= The Canarese country is a remarkable instance of the way in which — : names are transposed in India. The Canarese name igs given to a everything that is not Canarese, and to nothing that is. What ie called in Bombay the “Southern Maratta country,” because the Marattas conquered it (the districts of Dharwar and Belgaum and the country about Beejapore) is for the most part ethnologically Canarese, while the Canara districts on the West Coast (though there is some Canarese intermixture and they were once ruled by a Canarese- PT ten i The Ethnology of India. 129 dynasty) are principally inhabited by races alien to the Canarese, more akin to the Marattas in the extreme north, and akin to the Malayala people in the south. About and under the Ghats, the Marattas and Northern Bramins run farther south than they do on the plains of the Deccan. On the other side of the Peninsula, the Carnatic, wholly Non- Canarese, will always be called the Carnatic, because a dynasty seated in the Canarese country once had authority there. The real Canarese country is, the southern part of the Bombay Presidency, part of the adjoining Nizam’s territory, part of Bellary, and nearly the whole of Mysore. The Canarese can scarcely be said _ to be Hindus, the Lingamite sect so much prevails, and those Linga- mites so entirely ignore Bramins, and so completely make their Lingam worship a separate faith. Most of the people are called ‘ Lingamites’ or ‘ Sibahtagars,’ a name which conceals various castes and races; for 4 are the Banijagas who both trade and hold land, and are very In the north of this couutry the Reddies, whom I have already men- ~ tioned, are described as a fine handsome powerful race, capital culti- : vators, living together in large villages, and raising much cotton, which with other produce they often export as well as grow. They pay their _ revenue well, but are jealous of interference in their village concerns, and somewhat litigious. This is an old account, and it seems very | 1 ke what might be said of Jats. Ido not know what is the present eondition of these communities. The widows of the Reddies re- a aarry. ‘They are much superior to their southern Maratta neighbours | Mm an industrial and personal point of view. f. Farther south the chief castes of Hindu cultivators are ‘Wokuls’ or ly * Ooculagas,’ said to be called by the Mahommedans ‘ Koonbees,’ and whom the Abbe Dubois considers to be in essentials the same as_ or ilar to the Tamul Vellallers, isege they will not eat or sbynehi « now a different caste och both Rionheds and Fosilalbenan 1 — few | particulars regarding their character, but they seem to be on the _\whole good cultivators, The headmen of Caharese villages are called 130 The Ethnology of India. ‘ Gaudas,’ and under native governments not unfrequently farmed the rents. There also seems to have been the village communal system in some degree, but in most places not democratic. The Wokuls are indifferent soldiers, but serve as Militia. They eat flesh freely and are not a strict class. There are, it seems, a number of sub-divisions among them. One of the chief are called Gungacara, but whether that indicates a northern origin, I can’t say. In truth Wokul seems to be a very wide word. A considerable proportion of the cultivators, in several parts of this country, seem to be settled and reclaimed 9 aborigines, sturdy ‘‘ Beders” and “‘ Malawa’”’ or “ hillmen,” and there are a class allied to the Billiaru and Teermen of the Western Coast. The low Helot outcastes are numerous and called ‘‘ Hollayers.” Some of this caste seem to be still aboriginal] in the Western Ghats, they are mentioned as coming down to the Coast nearly or quite | naked; but most of them are agricultural labourers and serfs. They are said to correspond to the ‘“‘ Dhers” to the north and to the Palli or — Pallers to the south. ‘‘ Halaya’”’ means ancient, and the word Hollayer J perhaps only means “ the ancient race.” The Gollars, Golavadu or — Gwallas seem to be few, but the “‘ Dhangars,’’ mentioned as connected with Aheers, extend a good way south, and there is a large class of © the aboriginal shepherds the “‘ Carambers.”” There are Banjaras called — also “ Lambadi,” and I believe also “‘ Warali” or ‘‘ Katode Warali,” but — IT am not sure whether these last are not a kind of Gpysies found also | in the Bombay country. The Buis and Bustars are palanquin-bearers, fishermen, ferrymen — and distillers. } The old Ganarese dynasties and most of the people were at one time Jain, but those of that faith are now few, they have returned — to the worship of Siva and the Lingam, which seems to be their ancient faith. This former Jain profession seems to be, however, a . link of connection with the Banees farther North. . My impression, in passing through the country, has been that the Canarese as a body are fairer and better looking than mast of th in southern neighbours ; and as the tribes of a northern character see x to prevail among them less than in the Tamil and Telagoo country, it may be a question whether their features are influenced by an infusion from the west. It seéms that the ancient name of the Canarose The Ethnology of India. 131 people and language is ‘‘ Arabee,” but I have been unable to trace the origin or derivation of that name. There are some vague tradi- tions of former Arab conquest in those parts, but I have not been able to connect them with the Canarese name. The language is certainly, like the other languages of the South of India, Dravidian with Sanscrit super-imposed, but it is an undoubted fact (as we shall see when we come to the Western Coast) that a succession of immi- grations has occurred there; and one of them seems to a considerable extent to have flowed over into the Canarese country. Perhaps still more ancient immigrations may have flowed farther, and it might be well worth while minutely to inquire whether any Hithyaritic or Kgyptian importations can be traced in the Canarese tongue. In the Tamul country there is little suspicion of Western blood. The dominant tribe is of a very decided Northern character, while the mass of the lower classes is probably more aboriginal than in any other part of India. Consequently most of the Tamul people are small and black, and there seem to be among them frequent _ traces of aboriginal features. The superior agricultural class, owning and cultivating most of the -Jand and in possession of many chiefships, &ec. are the “ Vellallers,”’ \ a people of whom their own traditions of immigration from the North, Beried with their laws and institutions, leave in my mind no doubt that they belong to the class of later democratic tribes. Much has Been done to dissolve the old communal system, but the early deserip- tions of Vellaller villages, their apportionment of the lands and mode of self-government are exactly such as would describe a Jat village of the present day. The term Vellaller, like the Canarese Wokul, seems to be used to express a cultivator of the soil, in fact may be translated zemindar or cultivator, just as “Jat” is synonymous with zemindar in the Punjab. Whether the Vellallers are directly connected with the Velmas of the Telagoo country or with the Bellalla Rajas (who, ruling in the Canarese country, carried their arms into the south), I am unable to say. They appear to burn their dead, but are Hindus of the looser sort in their religious observances, and in their rules respecting marriage, &c. Like most of these tribes, they do not ordinarily marry more than one wife, unless the first fails to bring 132 The Ethnology of India. children. They have apparently some Poojarees of their own caste, but also to some degree accept Bramins as priests. Some of them are educated, or at least some sections of them are quite literate. Of this sort I have mentioned the Modelliars, who are distinctly stated to be a branch of them, but I am not quite sure whether it actually is so as regards the Pillays. The Vellallers are the principal tribe among the Tamul population in the north of Ceylon. The whole race seems to be an industrious good people. The cowherds in the Tamul country are it appears called “ Idayan,”’ and I have alluded to the learned branch of the cowherd race called Yadavas. "I have not been able to ascertain who are the merchant class among the Tamul people, whether Modelliars, Pillays, &c. or whether there are any Banijagas. The artisans in the south generally seem to be classed in groups, one caste comprising several different handicrafts, the principal of — which is that of the Panchalas or Pancham-Bandams, comprising © carpenters, blacksmiths, coppersmiths, masons and another which has — escaped me. } , The principal low caste tribes are the Palli or Pallers, and the Pariahs, — who, though somewhat similar in name, are quite distinct and in fact seem to be a good deal opposed to one another one (the Pallers ;) forming the lowest grade of what are called the right hand castes, the other (the Pariahs) holding the same place among the left hand ; castes. Then there are the robber castes, Kallars and Marawars. I have been unable to make out accurately whether these are the same or different, whether Marawar is the name of the tribe and Kallar only means robber, or whether there are two tribes. However pre= datory their disposition, they are not all now robbers, but seem to form a considerable portion of the settled-mhabitayts of the extreme south of the Peninsula. In one place I find the Marawars described | as very aboriginal in feature, and in that respect giving much ground i for the belief that they are descended from the monkeys who assisted in the conquest of Ceylon, while in another place they are said to — be well made and featured and of a martial disposition. Probably The Ethnology of India. 133 Ramooses of the southern parts of the Bombay territory, the better Beders of the centre of the Peninsula, and the Kallars and Marawars of the south. All are of a sturdy, semi-military, predatory character. They have generally, in times of trouble, acquired considerable posi- tion, and their chiefs have risen to be Polygars. Evidently they are _ superior to the simpler aborigines. The Ramooses are described as a ill-favoured, but not altogether different in appearance from the ordinary _ population. They have many customs which seem to indicate some eonnection with the northern democratic tribes (see full particulars in the Madras Literary Journal), and have the Rajpoot-like traditions of the Sacred Horse, Ge. It is in such tribes that I think an infusion of Yavana blood may well be suspected. The Pallers are probably related to the Puliars of the Pulney hills, but as settled inhabitants they seem to be decent cultivators of low _ degree. They are very numerous, and seem chiefly to cultivate kitchen * gardens and small farms. They bury their dead, and have Poojarees F; of their own caste, eat animal food when they can get it, and drink freely. Like most non-Arian tribes, they appear to practice polygamy when they can afford it. _ The Pariahs are well known, their name having become proverbial. _ They also seem to be numerous, and somewhat lower in degree than § quarters attached to the Vellaller villages. I think that traces of the thick lip and something of the prognathous jaws of their ancestors 1 ay sometimes be traced in those whom we see in service. Yet they | a e certainly very intelligent good servants. It appears that they are “Sometimes educated, and that there have even been Pariah authors. | q _ A strong mark that even yet Hindu ideas and manners have not | fully taken hold of the extreme south, is this that there, as it appears, | even some pretty decent and respectable castes bury, instead of burning ‘hei dead. The division into right hand and left hand castes, which prevails all over Southern India is very extraordinary and unexplained. They are sometimes violent factions, and yet, for anything that we are told, there is as little occasion for the feeling as for the feud between the 134 The Ethnology of India. three-year-olds and four-year-olds in Ireland. The Canarese Bani- jagas seem to be the chief of the right hand castes, with the lower cultivating classes of Hollayers and Kallars under them—while the better classes connected with the land appear to be the left hand, with the Pariah serfs under them. The Abbé Dubois seems rather to. reverse this arrangement as respects right and left, but the more recent statements are probably the better. The artisans seem to be divided. I think that the subject deserves farther inquiry. Possibly these factions may represent two different streams of civilisation and domi- nation meeting in the south. The old dominant tribe of the South Western Coast are the Nairs, who seem long to have dominated that country from the Western Ghats. These Nairs are the chief people of Malabar and Travancore, and the Bunts, who occupy a similar position in Canara, are cognate to them, as are the Coorgs above them. They are chiefly notorious for the — singular custom of polyandry, and the consequent order of succession through females. Polyandry is not now universally practised (though . not uncommon), but the rule of succession through females is at this — day the actual unvarying law of this people. They are a good-sized ~ well-featured race, but rather dark, especially compared to the other inhabitants of this Coast. They are not only soldiers and landholders, but are also often educated, and are then considered to be remarkably good accountants. I have mentioned the prevalence of Bramins in this part of India. They seem to get on very well with the Nairs, and share the land with them. Indeed, it is said, that the Nair women are not always satisfied with their own polyandrical arrangements, and that a good deal of Bramin blood has been infused into the Nair aristocracy by the channel of female descent. There seem to be a considerable number of the Agrestic slaves of Malabar, the black aboriginal Chermars, to whom, as well as to the Nagadies (if possible still lower), I have already alluded. The re- maining important sections of the population of this part of India I shall soon come to, but with regard to the effect of immigration upon them, I shall class them under the head of Borderers. F The system of village communities does not prevail on this Western me} Coast. The land is there considered to be the private property, in full right, of private landholders who hold separately, more after a modern — The Ethnology of India. 135 European fashion. It is also a general observation that in all hilly and broken countries (such as are the Western Ghats and their spurs on either side) village communities are neither required, nor can be easily ‘formed. In the midst of great plain countries, the cultivation of a community is concentrated within fixed and not distant limits, and concentration of habitation is required for defence. In hilly countries, the occasional spaces fit for cultivation are occupied by petty scattered hamlets and individual habitations. I have never heard any attempt to account for the singular poly- andry of the Nairs. My impression, however, is that polyandry is only a step in advance of the custom which is well-known as existing _ both among the old Jews and among almost all those modern Hindu tribes which permit remarriage, as well as among some other races, viz,, that the wife of one brother passes on his decease to the next brother. Among the Jats, the men strenuously assert this right, and the women generally as strenuously deny it ; but as we do not enforce it, it has never been decided which is in the right. At any rate it is _ always asserted. Now when the woman is recognised to be family _ property, and when moreover the Hindu and older than Hindu doctrine r. ot joint family property is brought to bear on the matter, it seems - to require but a little pressure and a little philosophy to convert a Minocessive holding into a joint contemporaneous holding; especially when childless elder brothers are getting old, and younger brothers Bare rising Np who may supply the want. In an early state of society, ~ we know that in war the women are always carried off as the prize _ of the victors ; consequently, as the fortune of war varies, tribes must a, often be left with a deficiency of women to an inconvenient degree, which the polyandrical arrangement among brothers (already pos- sessed of contingent remainders in the same woman) obviates. This ‘result seems to have followed among some of the Scythian tribes, and there is a tendency to the same thing among some of the Arian tribes of the Himalayas. In this last case, the cause assigned often is, that the women being good-looking and much prized in the plains, fathers have great temptations to make advantageous matches for their daughters (to sell them, rude people say), and women become scarce in the hills. We may suppose that the Nairs were perhaps a tribe who had y 136 The Ethnology of India. pushed far ahead of their base of operations, possibly their baggage and most of their women had been cut off, and being left with a scant _ supply of wives in their new settlements, they may have adopted the — present arrangement. Yet it seems one which has little to recom- mend it to permanence. The extraordinary thing then is, that it appears that in some parts of the Malabar Coast, parts of other tribes have actually to some degree borrowed the practice from the Nairs: There can be nothing about the country unfavourable to the propaga- tion of womeny Any cause tending to female infanticide would also tend to polyandry, but this has not been assigned as the reason in | Malabar. | In the Canara districts, the Jains are still numerous, many of the © Bants, &e. being of this sect, and it appears that this country (known — also as the Tulu or Tulava country) was formerly a great stronghold — of the Jains and ruled by Jain Rajas. THE BORDERERS. Tue TEERMEN oR ISLANDERS oF THE SoutH West Coast. On the Malabar Coast there is a numerous class called Teers or Teermen. They are generally a fair good-looking race, but considered — to be of very low caste. Caste ideas are there carried to an extreme — unknown in Hindustan, where, with the exception of the unclean scavenger caste, mere contiguity and general intercourse is not sup-_ posed to affect caste, and all classes mix freely together. In Malabar and Travancore, the Nairs do not pretend to be more than Soodras, | but they make out the Teers and Shanars (who are much the same) to” be so infinitely below them, that they must get out of the way when a Nair calls out to announce his approach in the public road. Anée yet the Teers are by no means a low and degraded caste; on the contrary they are, as I said, a good-looking, and they are also a thriving prosperous people, who are largely educated in the Government schools, obtain much public and private service, are acquiring land, and are in every way well-to-do. t They have (it seemed to me in Malabar) not the least aboriginal trace, but are fairer and in appearance more refined looking than the Nairs. The Shanar women of this class are those about whosé “a liberty to cover themselves a disturbance was made in the Travancore | The Ethnology of India. 137 country by the classes who considered them too low for this decent practice. Al] the Teer and Shanar people are said to be by caste or profession palm-growers or toddy-drawers, in allusion to the prin- cipal product of their native regions. ‘ Teer’ it seems means ‘ Island’ and the Teermen are generally understood to be Islanders or immi- grants by sea. Their relationship to the Maldivians is spoken of, but that is a petty group, and the only people to whom it is clear that they are related are the Singhalese. I am not acquainted with Singhalese ethnology, but the Singhalese whom I have seen seemed, I think, to be a fine-featured straight-haired people with no dash of the Indian Aborigines and like the Teers, only somewhat darker and somewhat different in dress, &c. Caldwell speaks of the Teers as bemg a reflex of the previous Hindoo emigration to Ceylon. Yet if all the accounts be correct, it is difficult to suppose all the congeners of the Teers to have come from Ceylon. Not only are the Teers very numerous in Malabar, where they form a great proportion of the population, but all the Shanars farther south are stated to be of the _ same race, as are the Billiaru (said to mean ‘Bow men’), the lower _ Yace im Canara, and a considerable number of people related to the _ latter who are found in Mysore, and there called Halaya Paika or old % Paiks. Some of these people are, however, I believe much darker and _ less good looking than the proper Teers. The latter are also said to have contributed to form the Moplahs. If so large a population has “immigrated, it must have been a long time ago. I said I think that there can be little doubt of their relationship to the Singhalese. It - would seem from the published accounts, that the Singhalese are not ravidian in language and manners, but derive the main portions of their language and religion, and perhaps of their civilisation, from Bengal and Magadha. That they received their present Buddhism from Magadha, and much of their language from a Sanscritic source, there can, I believe, be no doubt. But here also Western elements | may be mixed with the other, and very careful inquiry is necessary. ' It would be curious if it proved that, as it were in the three extremities of India, in Cashmere in the north protected by moun-— tains, Bengal in the east protected by the marshes of the Ganges and Berhampootra, and parts of Ceylon and Malabar on the south "| protected by distance and water, there remain three remnants of the 138 The Ethnology of India. older and softer Indian civilisation, not swept over by the democratic tribes of the north-west, and still retaining considerable points of resemblance among themselves. Tue SoutHerNn CHRISTIANS. I have not been able to find any precise ethnological description of the Christians of the Southern Coast, but so far as I can learn, they are principally Shanars. Tue Mopiaus. I believe that the notoriety of certain events has led most people at a distance to suppose the Moplahs to be a small sect of religious fanatics on the West Coast. Nothing can be a greater mistake, They are a large, most energetic, and most prosperous people ; in some industrial respegts perhaps the best population to be found anywhere in India. In point of numbers alone they are very considerable. In a large portion of the Malabar country, they form full half the popu- lation, and in the Malabar district their total number by census is — not far short of half a million. They are also numerous in Canara — and very numerous in Travancore. The Lubbays of the Tinnevelly Coasts seem to be as nearly as possible the same race. It is evident then that they are numerous enough to form a small kingdom, and in point of wealth and individual comfort and prosperity they certainly exceed any similar number of any other race in India, | confidently assert that no one can see the comfortable, neat, superior two-storied houses and homesteads of the Moplahs of the West Coast, without feeling that he has come upon a people non-Indian in their vigour, progressiveness, and whole style. One hardly feels oneself in India. There is no doubt that the Moplahs have a very large share of Arab blood. Ihave not been able to ascertain particulars of the date of their immigration, nor of the parts of Arabia from which, and the tribes from among whom they come, which latter points would be important now that Mr. Palgrave has led us to distinguish among Arab and quasi-Arabs; but the general native belief, which is probably correct, is that the Moplahs are a cross between Arabs and Teermen. The result is a fine, stout, manly, good- looking race. Their religion and much of their energy and manners The Ethnology of India. 139 are Arab, but at all events they are Arabs of an industrious money- getting stamp. They have most of the trade of the Coast in their hands, and they are rapidly acquiring a larger and larger share in the land, not only inferior rights by settlement and lease, but also superior rights by purchase and mortgage. As respects their religious fanaticism, I believe it will generally be found that fanaticism is most frequently used as an instrument of political warfare, and that in the most sincere it is but a symptom of political discontent. In spite of Mr. Palgrave, I think that when Arabs beyond their own country are Mahommedans, they are pretty zealous, especially when | they find themselves confronted with unbelievers. Probably the _ Moplahs are as good Mahommedans as are usually found, and in time of political discontent there is no lack of religious leaders from : Z = o7 see te | _ Arabia; but in fact I understand that it is perfectly clear to those _ acquainted with the matter that the Moplah outrages of which we _ hiave heard so much, are really political, or perhaps I should rather } say social, outbursts of a few individuals among an energetic people, i directed not against the British Government or Christian rule, but _ against Hindu landlords. The land question is at the bottom of it all. It is the old story of an inferior race with the law in their favour, and a more energetic race who wish to progress somewhat more ! rapidly than a conservative law allows. The more serious attacks _ 6n Kuropean officers have been made on them, not because they are @hristians, but because they have not taken a view sufficiently favourable to the Moplahs in questions between them and the Hindu landlords. _ They are a sturdy and independent as well as an intelligent and educated race, and though they make, I believe, capital public servants when they enter our service, they do not much seek it, and circum- “stances seem to have rendered them somewhat apart and over-indepen- dent. There is perhaps less intercourse and friendly feeling than is desirable between the governors and the governed. Still the Moplahs are an ethnological fact, and a strong and rapidly progressing fact ; we can’t get rid of them, and we must try to guide their energy in the right direction. After all, their outbreaks have been those of a very few individuals, and have only been serious on account of their _ extreme pluck and energy, with which only European soldiers can cope, 140 The Ethnology of India. MIxED AND IMMIGRANT RACES ON THE BomBay Coast. The Mahommedan Borahs, with equal mercantile energy, are a pleasant contrast to the Moplahs in their quiet demeanour and ready acceptance of British rule. They seem to be of the sect of Ismaleahs or Assassins, who are supposed to hold murder among their tenets; but — the Borahs are very mild, peaceable, shop-keeping assassins indeed. I believe that the name is that of the Hindu mercantile Borahs, but there is an evident infusion of immigrant blood, which probably came in together with their religion. It is probable that they are a cross between immigrants from the Persian Gulf and Hindu Borahs. Whether called Gulf-Arabs or Persians, the population of the coun- tries at the Northern end of the Gulf is evidently more Persian than Arab, and there also seems to be a chief seat of the Ismaleah sect. The Borahs seem to some extent to cultivate and hold land, but their proper avocation is trade; and a most useful and prosperous race they are. They are very numerous in Bombay, and thence west and north-. west ; they have a large proportion of the trade of Western India, and — form an important class in all the large towns up to about the centre of India. Boorhanpore is, I believe, the “city of the Borahs” to — which they attach peculiar importance, and where they desire to lay their bones; and they are found in Hllichpore, Nagpore, Indore, — Nusseerabad, and many other places in those directions. They are generally a fair good looking people, and deal largely in all sorts 7 Europe and foreign goods. | The Parsees are so well-known that I need say little of shen ; They must form altogether a considerable population in the west ofa India, comprising many humble members in service, &c. as well as % merchants. They are, I think, in feature, in the main, of a high-Arian~ 4 type, somewhat intermixed perhaps after a very long residence im — India, and somewhat blunted and thickened as compared to the sharper — and more chiselled northern faces; but still there is generally the prominence of feature which we might expect from an extraction — originally Persian. a I believe that there are some bade Jews on the Western Const, . but the comparatively recent Jew settlers somewhat numerous about Bombay, and who form a considerable community in Calcutta, are one The Ethnology of India. 141 of the most striking and, I think I may say, handsome of all races. A remarkably showy oriental dress, setting off a complexion almost European, no doubt goes for something ; but still the people themselves are very remarkable. Far from the dingy old-clo’ looking complexion which we are apt to associate with European Jews, their complexion is the most bright and transparent looking to be seen anywhere, and the blood seems quite to over-master the faint tinge of olive in their _ skins. The features are large and prominent, almost to excess, and their forms tall and goodly. I believe that these people are all connected with the Persian Gulf, and that they derive their blood from thence. After Mr. Palgrave’s description of the true Arab _ physique, one may well believe that their traits are really rather Persian than Semitic. Tur ScrnDErs. I have already noticed the people of Upper Scinde. The people and language properly called ‘Scindee’ are almost confined to the lower part of the Province, andI have reserved them to be classed ‘among the Borderers, because they are not altogether an extension of i any of the Indian Arians of whom I have treated, but a composite _ race largely influenced by other elements. The Arabs seem to have conquered Scinde some centuries before India at large was overrun by Mahomedans of other races; and at this day there is both much Arabic in the Scindee language, and probably a good deal of Arab ey blood in the Scindee people. There is also probably some Persian, some Hindu, and perhaps some aboriginal Koolee blood. In short both E. the people and the language are altogether composite. The amal- gamation does not seem to have had the good industrial result shown | in the Moplahs and Borahs. The Scindees are described as well 13 Me rown and rolust, but dark in skin, debased in morals, and idle. The _ Delta and the country of the Lower Indus seem to be very ill and in sufficiently cultivated ; and the people are given to hunting, ones | = pastoral pursuits ee as much as to cultivation. , i a Tur BELocuens. Ri I have not alluded to the Belochees as an element in making up the Scindees, because it would seem as.if the Belochees themselves were a 142 The Ethnology of India. composite people, made up of the blood of Persians and Arabs, and I don’t know what besides. However, if that is so, it is not now a mere mixture, but a chemical union of the elements thrown together, and the Belochees, if their language is composite, are still now a people of distinct traits and nationality. They acquired, as is well- known, at a comparatively recent time the dominion of Scinde, and they are pretty well-known as settlers in the North-West of India, say to about as far as Dehli; but they have there none of the dignity and station of the Pathan settlers. I dare say there are decent cultivators among them ; but they are more often camel-drivers and such like, and they have not a good name, being generally supposed to have consider- able robber and cut-throat proclivities. I don’t think they have any villages of their own; they are generally only scattered about in the capacities which I have mentioned. They are fine powerful men, but rather dark. Those whom [ have seen of the families of the Ameers of Scinde are fair and good looking, but even in Belochistan — I believe it may be said of the Belochees generally, that they are a F good deal darker than the Pathans. They are similarly arranged in tribes, and are similarly predatory upon the border ; but I understand 3 that they are a good deal less democratic in their constitution, and more amenable to the authority of their chiefs than the Pathans. This too may make them preferable as mercenary soldiers. It is somewhat curious that, while in the west of India Arabs are en-— tertained in that capacity, on the Coasts of Arabia itself and of Africa, Belochees are the people so employed by the chiefs. They are in fact the Swiss of those parts. I have alluded before to the Brahooes, and as I believe that they a are not known as residents within Indian limits, a need not recur to — : them. 7. “ 3 4 J “2 Tur AF@HANs orn PATHANs. _ [have included the Indian Pathans among modern Indian tribes, — and have sometimes called the Pathans proper “ Afghans,” to distin- guish them, and in deference to English habit. But among the people themselves, the name Afghan is hardly known. Physically these people are among the very finest on the earth. And they have a pleasant, frank, simple, unaffected way, that makes The Ethnology of India. 1438 4 man at once feel, when he gets among them, that he is out of India. A European will really more amalgamate with a Pathan in a week than with a thorough Indian in seven years. The Pathans are decidedly high-Arian in feature; and if their — features are less universally very high and chiselled than those seen in the northern hills, they have on the other hand more of a broad, robust; ruddly, manly look, and the people are in fact a hardier and bolder people. About Cabul they are fair, but some of the tribes in the lower and hotter hills and valleys adjoining India have somewhat _ dark skins. Rough, simple, and frank as these people generally look, _ they are in fact by no means simple. I believe that some of the ~ more isolated tribes, Wazeerees, &c., have more simple virtue, but the t great majority of the Afghans, rail probably by nature and more in consequence of long dealing with many nations (holding as they - do the portals of India), have the reputation of being a very astute, Ck ee _intrigruing, ambitious, avaricious, and crafty people. Great allowance must, however, he made for their situation and temptations. One : cannot but feel that so energetic and fine a race, living in a country 80 poor, but the highway of so many nations, must of necessity learn | to live a good deal on their neighbours. I am told by officers on the frontier, that in point of bold unblushing lying, a Hindu is a mere ehild to a Pathan. I suppose this habit comes from long living by their wits. The character of faithfulness, however, is in the main injurious to the Pathans. They are distrusted as mercenaries. It is felt that if they are always ready to do any work when it is made — their =, they are also people of a calculating pu deeb fay our of another sluts as ‘the Persians found to their cost in the | last century, when they too much availed themselves of the services| | ‘of the Afghans. At present they are very popular in our native amy, and certainly make capital soldiers. But they are fickle and } uncertain, and seldom serve long without a break. A man gets a Message to say that it is absolutely necessary that he should come home and murder his uncle, and off he goes with or without leave. They come back, however. It is a thing to be understood that the Ameer of Cabul pretends to no authority whatever over the Hastern | Afghan tribes. They are avowedly politically quite independent, 144 : The Ethnology of India. while in one sense, without our attempting to interfere in their internat affairs (that they will not permit for an instant), they are becoming more and more our military retainers. A very large number of them pass though our service, and a steady income is derived from it. The. Pathans south and south-west of Peshawar are pure and rough, but the Eusofzies and tribes to the north seem to differ con- siderably in character. In fact, as I have before mentioned, the Pathans are comparatively recent conquerors and colonists of the northern hills and valleys. They have there mixed much with people of an Indian : type, pre-Hindu it may be, but probably the ancestors of Hindus. These people have not the Hindu caste which, for the most part, pre- vents amalgamation on the part of the Khatrees, and I think there can be little doubt that their blood has much influenced the character of the Husofzye clans. The purer Afghans are extremely — illiterate, and the very opposite of bigots in matters of religion. The Eusofzies are perhaps all the fairer and handsomer for the inter- — mixture of blood; they are also more civilised in their manners and — much more literary. And they have imbibed very much of that veneration, that religious capacity, which distinguishes the oldest ~ Indian branch of Arians. Mahomedans as they are, they really : seem to have some religious zeal, and they are very much priest- — ridden. In fact the Akhoond of Swat and other priests have, to _ some extent, induced the tribes to submit to a certain and partial | religious government, if it can be called by that name. The priests seem to have considerable grantsof land, and at any rate succeed in levying a regular tithe from the landholders and cultivators, whose ; differences they settle as far as they can. It is among these people — that discontented Mahomedan immigrants from Hindustan have found some sort of shelter. It should be understood that intermix an ture has not destroyed the military qualities of the Eusofzies themselves. With an inferior population at home to cultivate their — fields, they are amongst the most notable Pathan soldiers who have pushed their fortunes in India. © The proper Afghan constitution is democratic in the extreme, sO — much so that any sort of government on a large scale is almost im- possible, and the Ameer’s authority is confined to a few open valleys — (for the most part cultivated by inferior races) and to a very uncertaim — Lhe Ethnology of India. 145 feudal chiefship over the western clans. They have their regular system of democratic representation and self-government by the assemblies of Jeergahs and Qolooses; but like mest rude people so _ situated, no man’s nationality goes beyond his own clan (just as in civilised Greece, it did not go beyond his own city), and within the clan order is very insufficiently maintained. Afghan individuality in ‘very irrepressible. A considerable population of proper Pathans are now our subjects ain the districts of Peshawar and Kohat, and it would be very interesting to examine critically, how far their constitution is really different from that of the Jats and other democratic Indian tribes. _ dt is generally said that as a people they are very different, and non- Indians must be very different from Indians. The language too shows that, Arian though they be, the Pathans are a branch separated by a wide interval. But still I have not been able to discover by cursory inquiry that their constitution is other than that of the more ‘democratic Indo-Germans. I rather incline to think that they are probably of the same stock as the Jats and other tribes, but of a common ancestry, long anterior to the entrance of the latter into India. It | may be that while some tribes poured into India, others have been gradually working their way though the hills, dispossessing the _ Khatrees and Khasas and more aboriginal Caucasians who held what 4 | as now modern Afghanistan, if. Tux Aporiainat Artans or Tue Inp1an Caucasus. | I have lately called attention to our ignorance of these most | interesting people, probably the remains ef the pre-Hindu ancestors | of the earliest Hindus. Of the Kaffirs of the most inaccessible ' portions of the range, between the Kashgar river and Bameean, we have heard a great deal, but learned almost nothing. They are thought to be related to Europeans, because they sit on chairs and drink wine copiously. They must be a sturdy race, to have maintained their independence so long. All the other tribes seem to be more or _ less Mahomedans. ‘There are the * Neemchahs” or half breeds on the southern slepe of the Caucasus, between the Afghans and the , higher peaks, speaking a language with a strong affinity to the Indian tongues, and which also seems to present some curious affinities te 146 The Ethnology of India. the Latin. In the lower country near the debouchure of the Kashgar river, the people speak a mixed language called ‘‘ Laghmanee.” In the upper valley of that river, the name Kashgar seems to mark the trace of early Khasas. The ancient language of Swat seems to have disappeared, and the country is now Pathan, with a subject race of aboriginal blood, that is pure Arian aborigines. But farther north, in the valleys of the Ghilghit river, running into the Indus from the West, we have an Arian people speaking a language of their own, which is cognate to the tongue of the tribes east of the Indus in and about the country called ** Chilas.’’ Some of these latter are independent and scarcely known, but most of this country, and also Ghilgit, is now subject to the Maharajah of Cashmere. The “ Dards’’ seem to be among these tribes. It may be asserted of all these Caucasian tribes (excepting the Kaffirs of whom we know so little) that, while they are physically as handsome and fine as possible, they are not so democratic and sturdy in independence as the Afghans. We know very well what — an undertaking it is to subdue, still more to rule, an Afghan tribe in © their own country. But the Aighans have certainly subdued many of these Caucasians. The Maharajah of Cashmere has conquered ~ and governs many more. Those in contact with our own frontier : are quiet and not troublesome. And in Kashgar it is understood that — the people submit to their rulers, in a way which Afghans will never | suffer. Altogether it may be assumed that this race is less indepen- dent (though it may be more intellectual) than the democratic races; _ more amenable to Rajas and Priests, and altogether just such a people as we might expect to give birth to Khasas and early Braminical — Hindus. Living in countries most favourable to the Vine they seem | to be generally given to the use of wine. Whether the use of chairs extends beyond Kaffiristan I cannot say. We have in fact everything — to learn about these people and their languages. 7 Tue NortHERN BorDERERs OF MIXED TARTAR OR THIBETAN BLOOD, The Mongolians and Arians seem to cross well. Most of the tribes falling under this heading are physically vigorous and industriously energetic, The Ethnology of India. 147 I have before alluded to the Hazarahs beyond Cabul and Ghuznee, who come down to Peshawar and the Punjab for labour. This name “Hazarah” has no connection with that of the Cis-Indus district so called froma town of that name. These Hazarahs are Persian in speech, Sheeah in religion, and decidedly Mongol in feature, charac- teristics, which would seem to tally with the story of their having been a body of slaves in the train of some Mahomedan conqueror; but whether this is really historical, I cannot say. They are very independent and industrious, decidedly a good race. The people of Ghilgit are the farthest Arians of the country whence the Indus flows. To the north the people are of Turkish race, and in _ the valley of the Indus above the junction with the Ghilgit river are the Bultees of Iskardo, &c. The language of the Bultees is decidedly Thibetan, and their features show a large proportion of the blood of that race. Some of it may be, as they say, that of Alexander, for anything I know to the contrary; but we should hardly have heard of it, if they _ had not been Mahomedans. They are Sheeahs, as are several tribes in those higher countries, a circumstance which has not been explained. They seem to be a good, stout, quiet race. The Maharajah of Cashmere (who rules the country) has enlisted many of them into _ his service, apparently with advantage. In the upper valleys of the Sutlej, in Spiti, Kanawer, dc. there are _ mixed races exhibiting much Thibetan blood, and apparently more Buddhist than Hindu in religion. A very Thibetan-looking colony used to be settled at Mahasoo just beyond Simla, and people of that ace did much of the heavier work, carrying wood on their backs. They are powerful, ruddy-looking people, and as entirely unlike Thdians as anything one can imagine. The women especially are -vemarkably fine females in an industrial sense; but in other respects, whatever they may be from a Turanian point of view, they are not likely to be dangerous to the Arian visitors to the sanatarium. From this point for many hundred miles to the east, all the passes, the very crests and centres of the passes through the snowy range, are occupied by a peculiar tribe who almost monopolise the trade across, principally carried on upon the backs of sheep. They also cultivate some land. They are known as the “ Bhooteas,” but that is so wide @ word (in fact identical with Thibetan) that it is little guide to us. 148 The Ethnology of India. I believe that there are some very curious tribes m valleys near and immediately beyond the snows, but I have not the means of specifying them. As respects the Himalayas generally, the following may, I think, be: said. From Cashmere eastwards, all the easily accessible portions of the Himalayas are occupied by perfectly Arian Hindus, as: far as the eastern border of Kumaon and the Kalee river, separating that Pro- vince from the Nepal dominions ; the Thibetans being here confined to the valleys about and beyond the snow. Throughout the whole length of Nepal again people of Thibetan blood have partially flooded ever into the Nepal country, have there met and intermixed with other races, and have formed mixed tribes who appear to be generally (the proper Goorkhas perhaps excepted) more Thibetan than Indian: in physiognomy and speech, but are or affect to be more Indian than Thibetan in religion and manners, doubtless under the influence of the dominant “ Khas.’” East of Nepal, in Sikkim and Bhootan, Thibetans are altegether dominant, and the Hindu element almost. disappears. ‘Fhe soldiers whom we erroneously call ‘ real Goorkhas’” are mostly of the Gurang and Magar tribes of western Nepal. Their features are ultra-Mongolan, but they are small, whereas the Thibe- tans are generally large. Of their pluck and energy there can be no doubt. At the Simla Government School, the children from a — Goorkha Regiment were found at least to equal, in fact rather to beat — the Hindus. They themselves affect to be Hindus, and stoutly — i deny being Buddhists, though they are free from most disagreeable Hindu prejudices. The Newars, the cultivating peasantry of the” : valley of Nepal, are stated to have Thibetan looking features, with a ey fair and ruddly complexion. Both their language and that of the — = = Gurangs and Magars seem to be in the main Thibetan, at least i in 4 the fundamental numerals, pronouns, &e. Still more is it so ay regards the languages of the tribes farther east, Kerantis, Murmisy — and others, of whom I know little. The Lepchas of Sikkim and Lopas of Bhootan are unmitigated Buddhist Thibetans. There seem to be several tribes of ‘‘ Rong,” “ Khampas” or Kambas, and Limboos, who come from different parts of Thibet, and there are some differences of language. The Lepcha tribes are described as a dirty, good-natured people, in character said The Ethnology of India. 149 to be something like the Mongols from beyond the Chinese wall, as described in recent accounts. The Lopas, &c. of Bhootan seem to be more difficult to deal with. Farther east are, I believe, still wilder Thibetan tribes. All these people are idle, but very powerful; and when they do work, they carry enormous loads, both men and women. They are said to carry up to Darjeeling as much as 250 lbs. ina single load. And at some of the Hill Stations on the Eastern Frontiers of Bengal, I understand it is the fashion that a European ‘visitor is carried up the hill in a basket on the back of an old woman. THr PEOPLE oF THE EastERN Frontier. The people of the very lowest hills of Bhootan and of all the low country at their foot are of another race, the Meches or Mechis (before alluded to in marking the boundaries of the Indian Aborigines), who are apparently the same as Hodgson’s “ Bodo.” They are, it appears, _ now quite ascertained by their language to be Indo-Chinese of the _ Lohitic or Burmese branch of the Turanian family, a connexion which their physiognomy confirms. They seem to be a good-sized, 3 fair, but rather yellow-looking people. They are described as rude z in their agriculture (using the hoe, not the plough), and erratic in their habits, but good-natured and tolerably industrious. They pro- fess a kind of debased Hinduism, but are very omnivorous in their habits. The Dimals are a smaller but somewhat similar tribe, _ Speaking a language which in some degree differs. _ Passing over the Garrow and Cossya Hills to Cachar, the Cachar _ people again are ofthe same race as the Mechis. So, it would appear (so far as I can gather), are the Nagas, Abors, and some other tribes 4 in the hills bordering on Assam. There are aboriginal tribes of : /Tipperah and Munneepore, but of their ethnology I am not informed. In the Cossya hills are an isolated body of people of the Taic or _ Biamese race. Of this race were the Ahoms who once ruled Assam, as are, it appears, the Khamtis and some other tribes of the more “distant hills of that Province; also the Shan tribes of the Burmese interior. The Karens are, I rather think, Lohitic. It is evident, however, that on this Eastern Frontier I have got into a vast ethnological region, with which I have no personal acquaintance, and with which I cannot deal farther than to point out the vast field for 150 The Ethnology of India. inquiry, and to suggest how great a service any one would render, who would briefly classify and describe these tribes.. There are endless distinct tribes, even the names of which I do not attempt to give. a POSTSCRIPT. When this paper had nearly passed through the Press, Colonel Dalton’s paper on the Kols (to the want of which I have alluded) was received in the office of the Society, and it will be printed along with this. Ihave only had an opportunity of hastily glancing at it, but have seen enough to be sure that it will admirably fill up just what was wanting in regard to our knowledge of the aboriginal tribes, and will be read with extreme interest. The two papers, thus published together, having been written without concert, may be found to express or assume different opinions on some points; but I hope that the general result of Colonel Dalton’s paper will tend rather to. confirm than to contradict most of that which I have written. In — regard to the general Negrito character of the Dravidian tribes he — fully bears me out. At the same time he seems to point to a consi- derable difference in the type of the Moondahs, Hos, Sontals, and others speaking the language which I have called Kolarian. He © seems in some degree to support Major Tickell’s account of the supe- — er SE ee rior physical qualities of the Hos, but he also tells us that other — tribes of this race are much more degraded and less good looking, — In fact, the principal tribes of the race, the Moondahs and Sontals, are now extremely well known, and it is patent to all that they are among the ugliest of mankind. The Sontals are a proverb for a — combination of simple good nature and ugliness. Still, I quite admit — that most of these people are less black and Negrito-looking than the — b Savage Dravidian tribes. I think I have already suggested, and ies ; am inclined to repeat, that they look in some respects more like - Hottentots than Negroes. It is very much to be desired that a more | complete study of their language should in some degree break through the complete isolation which has been hitherto attributed ‘- it. It seems to have no affinity to the more Eastern tongues so far as _ has yet been discovered. > The Ethnology of India. 151 I have been struck by those parts of Colonel Dalton’s description, which would seem to show, among the more civilised of these tribes, some institutions akin to those of the modern Hindoos. Not only does it appear that the Kolarian tribes burn their dead, but also I notice that the systematic division of their tribes is very similar to that which I have described among the Hindoos, and especially that they have the peculiar rule which forbids intermarriage among people of the same tribe, and imposes on every man the necessity of taking his wife from another tribe. The question will be, whether the prac- tices common to Kolarians and Hindoos are borrowed by Kolarians from Hindoos, or by Hindoos from Kolarians. Many interesting sub- jects of inquiry may be opened out. Colonel Dalton’s account of the tenacity with which some of the tribes cling to their ancient rights in the soil, seems somewhat at variance with the information which I had noted respecting their ready emigration. That many of them do emigrate, is certain; but perhaps my information has reference to the Dravidians and less settled tribes, Colonel Dalton in one place speaks of the Kolarian Hos as more dignified and more like North American Indians, and the Dravidian Oraons as more like light-hearted Negroes; but in other places he _ seems rather to confirm my suggestion that the Kolarian Sontals and ~ Moondahs are an especially light-hearted race, and the Dravidians less’ 80; the Dravidian Oraons having, he says, learned their songs and dances from the Moondahs and other Kolarians among whom they have settled. Certainly the flat and broad-faced Sontals and Moon- - dahs seem to bear no resemblance to the North American style of - feature. Colonel Dalton more than confirms what I have said in regard to the increase of numbers of the Kolarian tribes of the Chota-Nagpore division. He tells us that, notwithstanding their tendency to drink, they increase rapidly. He evidently takes a most favourable view of | them, and I think it impossible to doubt that we have in these tribes, ina healthy and accessible country in the immediate vicinity of the Capital of India, a people whom it behoves us to cherish and utilise— a people comparatively free from the peculiar vices of the modern Thdians, simple, truthful and ready to receive our religion and the 152 The Ethnology of India. — impress of our manners—possessed moreover of much industrial energy, laboriousness, and ductibility. ‘To make such a people tho- roughly our own—to render the central and healthy plateau occupied by them a completely Christian and Anglicised country, would be (higher considerations apart) a very great source of strength and comfort to the English in India. I think that every effort should be made in this direction. Colonel Dalton has sent with his paper a grammar of the Oraon language by the Rev. Mr. Batsch. This is a Dravidian tongue. The Rev. Mr. Phillips has published a grammar and introduction to the Sontal language, but he has put it in the Bengallee character, some- — what unfortunately, as I think—for although I have not advocated the ‘Romanising of the written vernacular languages, I should prefer to give to the Kolarian tribes, hitherto entirely without a written cha- racter, our own Roman letters, rather than those of the foreign and hated Bengallee. Since then Mr. Phillips’s work is not available for ‘my present purpose, I propose to re-publish, for comparison with Mr. — Batsch’s Oraon grammar, the brief grammar of the Kolarian “‘ Ho” language, published by Major. Tickell in an old number of the So- ciety’s Journal. I hope then, by placing, as appendices to the present publication, vocabularies of test words both Arian and Aboriginal (Gncluding in the latter both Dravidian, Kolarian and Indo-Chinese dialects), and the sketches of Dravidian and Kolarian grammar, to— supply the rough elements for a comparison of all the dialects of | India. And I trust that if a beginning is thus made, we may here- — after obtain much information, more full, ample, and complete. The “ Kols’”’ of Chota-Nagpore, 153 The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore.—By Lt.-Col. E. T. Dauron, Commis- sioner of Chota-Nagpore. [Received 27th July, 1866.] The country called Chota (or properly Chuttia) Nagpore is the eastern portion of the extensive plateau of Central India on which are the sources of the Koel, the Soobunreka, the Damoodah and other _ less known Indian rivers. It extends into Sirgoojah and forms what is called the Oopur Ghat or highland of Juspore, and it is connected by a continuous chain of hills with. the Vindhyan and Kymore ranges, from which flow affluents of the Ganges, and with the highlands of Omerkuntuck on which are the sources of the Nurbudda. That the population of this watershed is found to be, for the most part, a hetero- geneous collection of non-Arian tribes, is in itself a fair proof that these tribes were at one time the inhabitants of the plains who, driven from their original sites at different periods by Braminical invaders, gra- _ dually fell back, following converging lines of rivers in their retreat, till from different directions, nations, some bearing marks of common origin though separated for ages, others bearing no trace of such affinity, met at the sources of the streams, and formed new nationali- ‘ties in the secure asylum they found there. _ The plateau averages more than 2,000 feet above the sea level ; it is on all sides somewhat difficult of access, and it is owing to the _ security thus given, that the primitive tribes, still found on it, retained Y for ages so much of their independence and idiosyncracy. After over- coming the difficulties of the approach, these first settlers must have ‘Tejoiced at finding they had not merely reached the summit of a ‘range of hills, but had ascended to a new country, well suited to their wants and out of reach of their enemies; and here they made their final stand. _ They found a genial climate at this elevation and a well-wooded un- ‘dulating country, divided and diversified by interior ranges of hills | uplifting the fertilizing streams, or breaking out in rocky excrescences, sometimes in vast semi-globular masses of granite, like sunken domes of gigantic temples, sometimes in huge fragments piled in most fan- 154 The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. tastic forms, viewed with awe by the new settlers as the dwelling places of the local gods. The total area of the plateau thus occupied is about 7,000 square miles, and the present population may be estimated at a million ; more than half of whom are of the race best known to us by the name of “iol.” This word is one of the epithets of abuse applied by the Bramini- cal races to the aborigines of the country who opposed their early settlement, and it has adhered to the primitive inhabitants of Chota Nagpore for ages. It includes many tribes; the people of this pro- vince to whom it is generally applied, are either Moondah or Oraon ; and though these races are now found in many parts of the country occupying the same villages, cultivating the same fields, celebrating together the same festivals, and enjoying the same amusements, they are of totally distinct origin and cannot intermarry without loss of caste. The received tradition is, that the Moondahs first occupied the country, and had been long settled there, when the Oraons made their appearance. The Moondahs believe themselves to be autochthonous, or at all events declare that they are all descended from one man and woman, who were produced or established themselves, at a place called : § Pe Satyomba, which is reyered by the whole tribe as the cradle of the race. ; Satyomba is the name of a pergunnah on the edge of the plateau overlooking the valley of the Damoodah. It is not improbable that ; the Moondah race had previously occupied a position on that river, s and that, in departing from it, the division took place which separated a Damoodah, and call it their sea ; and the ashes of their dead are always preservedtillthey havethe opportunity of disposing of them by throwing | them into that stream or burying them near its banks. The Sonthalgi remaining in the plains, had easy access to the river and retained their veneration for it. The Moondahs, settling on the highlands, were — less faithful to it, but from its name they might claim it as their own ; for, though Damoodur has been adopted as one of the sacred names of “ Krishno,” does not Dah-Moondah in their own language mean ‘‘the water of the Moondah ?” ad The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. 155: We find the Moondah settlements chiefly in the eastern and southern parts of Chota-Nagpore, the Oraons predominating in the western; and this strengthens the hypothesis that the Moondahs ascend- ed from the eastern side of the plateau. The intimate connection between the Sonthals, the Bhoomij and the Chota-Nagpore Moondah tribes has long been known. I have pointed out théir affinity with the Korewahs of Sirgoojah and Juspoor, and have given some account of that wild clan.* Ihave now to add to the list the ‘‘ Kheriahs,” another aboriginal tribe settled on the plateau of Chota-Nagpore, and the ‘“‘ Juangas’’ of the Cuttack tributary mehals, whose women are so conservative in their notions, that they still adhere to the fashion in dress first introduced by mother Eve and wear nothing but leaves. I had often met with individuals and families of the Kheriah tribe, living in mixed communities, but from contact with other races they had lost much of their individuality, and I found it difficult to place them. This year, I happened to come upon some of their principal settle- ments in pergunnah Bussiah, on the southern borders of the portion of the plateau occupied by the Moondahs, and collected round me the elders of the tribe. These settlements all lie near the Koel, one of the streams from the watershed of Chota-Nagpore, which, after its union with the Sunkh in Gangpore, becomes the Bramni and terminates its career at Point Palmyras. The Kheriahs venerate the Koel as the Sonthals the Damoodah. ~ They were in all probability once settled on its banks in the low- lands, and clinging to it in their retreat and adopting the place of ‘refuge that it led to, regard it still as communicating with their fatherland, and with this idea the urns contaming the ashes of their dead are dashed into a rock-broken rapid of the river, so that their contents may be rapidly borne away by the current to mingle with the ashes of their forefathers. | They say their first settlement was Pora, a village om the Koel, and that there were no Moondahs in the country, at least in that part of it, when their ancestors first came there. There is sufficient resem- blance between the Kheriahs and Moondahs in language and customs * As, Soc, Journal, Vol. XXXIV. p. 1. 156 The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. and appearance, to make us certain of their consanguinity, and at the same time sufficient divergence to lead to the inference that the relationship is a remote one, and that the two branches of the family had been long separated when they met again on the banks of the Koel. These points of resemblance and divergence I will describe, when treating of the manners and customs of the race generally. The Juangas or Puttoons (leaf-clad) are noticed in a paper by Mr. BE. A. Samuells.* They are found in the Cuttack tributary mehals of Keonjur, Pal Lehra, Dhekenal and Hindole. They are thus isolated from all other branches of the Moondah family, and have not themselves the least notion of their connection with them ; but their language, a specimen of which is given in the table appended, shews they are of the same race, and that their nearest kinsmen are the Kheriahs, a fragment of the tribe left behind when the remainder ascended the valley of the Koel. The Hos of Sing- bhoom have a tradition that they once wore leaves only, and not long ago threatened to revert to them, unless cloth-sellers lowered | their prices ! The Bhoomij form the majority of the population in all the estates — of the Manbhoom district to the south of the Kassae river, As they | approach the confines of Chota-Nagpore, they appear to be called indiscriminately Moondahs or Bhoomij, and they intermarry. More to the east the Bhoomij have become Hindooized, or rather Ben-— galeeized, toa great extent, and many of them have acquired consider- ; able estates, like the Mankees of Chota-Nagpore, and positions of j , influence as ‘“ Sirdar Ghatwalls,” the hereditary custodians of ‘hea passes. ; The characteristics of the tribe that they most tenaciously cling to, ea are the national dances and songs. The Bhoomij appear to have been the first to colonise the large pergunnah called Dhulbhoom or — ' Ghatsillah, attached to the Singbhoom district. The Rajah or Zemindar is, in all probability, himself a Bhoomij by race, though ancestor, according to their version, was a washerman, a Dhoby who * As, Soc. Journal, Vol. XXV. p. 295, 1856. 7 The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. 157 saved the goddess Kali when, as Runkini, she ran away from Pochete, Discredit has attached to the Bhoomij and Sonthal in consequence of the human sacrifices offered at this shrine of Runkini, but the whole establishment and ritual are essentially Braminical. The Bhoomij and Sonthal races personally do not much care for the blood-thirsty goddess. The Bhoomij is the brarich of the Moondah race that has spread farthest in an eastern direction. Bhoomij are to be found in Mohurbhunj and Keonjur, though perhaps not so much at home there as in Dhulbhoom. The Sonthals are now chiefly massed in the Sonthal Pergunnahs, but they muster strong in Mohurbhunj, and there are several colonies of them in the Singbhoom district. They are au erratic race, and their ancient traditions are lost in the history of their modern migra- tions; but my idea is that their chief settlements in Bengal. were once on the Damoodah river, and that they gave way to the Koormees, an industrious Hindoo race, who now form the bulk of the population in that part of Manbhoom. In a southerly direction the next tribe of ‘‘ Dasyus” that we come across are the Khunds, but I am unable to trace any point of resem- blance between them and the Moondah, either in their religion with its morbid superstitions and horrible human sacrifices, or in their language. To trace the further ramifications of the Moondahs we must proceed. ‘west, not south, and take up the link in the hills and highest table- ~ lands of Sirgoojah and Juspore, where we find the wildest of the race in the Korewahs. Ihave given a brief note on them in the paper _ above quoted, and have only to add that the Korewahs are quite unaware of the connectionship between themselves and the Kols. They do not acknowledge, and do not see, that the languages are almost — identical. This would not, I conceive, have been the case if the -Korewahs had broken off from their Satyomba kinsfolk. The Korewahs are another branch of the family, and the history ‘oftheir migrations is no doubt an independent one. It is probable ‘that they were forced back into the hills they now occupy by the ~Gooands, as a Hindooized clan of that people became the dominant yace in the plains of Sirgoojah. Moreover, as pointed out by Mr. G. Campbell, at a late meeting of the Society, we have in 158 The ‘ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. this Journal* a brief notice of a tribe called “ Coour Gooand,” and a vocabulary which proves them to be not Gooand at all, but another branch of the great family we are describing, occupying the Gavilghur range of hills near Ellichpore. Dr. Latham mentions in connection with them another tribe which he calls Chunah, but I have no further information about them. If the investigation is carried out, we shall, no doubt, find connecting links in the intervening ranges of hills. Thus we have in the Coours of Ellichpoor, the Korewahs of Sirgoojah and Juspore, the Moondahs and the Kheriahs of Chota- Nagpore, the Hos of Singbhoom, the Bhoomij of Manbhoom and Dhulbhoom, and the Sonthals of Manbhoom, Singbhoom, Cuttack, tributary mehals, Hazareebagh and the Sonthal Pergunnahs (the author of the introduction to the Sonthal lauguage, the Rev. J. Phillips, adds ‘‘Nakales and Kodas,’”’ I do not know where they are to be found,) a kindred people sufficiently numerous, if united, to form a nation of several millions of souls. They were, in all probability, © one of the tribes that were most persistent in their hostility to the Arian invaders, and thus earned for themselves the epithets of “worshippers of mad gods,” “haters of Bramins,” ‘“ ferocious lookers,”’ “‘ inhuman,” “ flesh-eaters,” ‘‘ devourers of life,” ‘ of magical powers,” “ changing their shape at will.’}+ To this day, the Arians settled in Chota-Nagpore and Singbhoom firmly believe that the Moondahs have powers as wizards and witches, and can transform themselves into tigers and other beasts of prey, with the view of devouring their enemies, and that they can witch away the lives of man and beast. It is to the wildest and most savage of the tribe that such powers are generally ascribed ; and amongst the Kols themselves the belief in the magic powers of their brethren is so strong, that I have heard converts to Christianity assert they were first induced to turn to our religion, because sorcery had apparently no power over those who were baptized! The upper classes of the ~ Moondahs, those who aspire to be Zemindars, have assumed the “ »oita” and taken to Bramins and Kali, but the mass of the people — adore their ‘‘ mad gods” still, after their own primitive fashion. The great propitiatory sacrifices to the local deities or devils are carousals * As. Soc, Journal, Vol. XIII, p. 19.. t See Muir’s Sanserit texts. _ possessed ( : F The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. 159 at which they eat, drink, sing, dance and make love, but though the austere ‘munis’ of old must have stood aghast at such wild ebulli- tions of devotion, it is a fact that whilst the mass of the Kols have not taken to the worship of any Hindoo idols, the Hindoos settled in the province think it expedient to propitiate the gods of the Kols. It is gratifying that the darkness in which this primitive and interesting people have so long dwelt, is now being dispelled by a brighter light: that their paganism is at length yielding to the gentle influence of Christian teaching ; that there is abroad amongst them a widespread feeling that a change is necessary, a change more perfect than can be typified by the adoption of a “ povta.” As the Moondahs first settled at Satyomba spread over the country, they formed themselves into communities called Purhas, or the country was divided into Purhas, each consisting of twelve or more villages under a chief. They do not appear in their earlier days to have acknowledged any chief, superior to the head of the Purha; the ordinary business of the community was conducted by him, and on extraordinary occasions, the Purha chiefs met and took counsel together. Vestiges of this ancient system are still met with in many parts of the country. Though ignored as geographical or fiscal or territorial divisions, the Purhas still exist in the eyes of the people, and they still have chiefs whom they call Rajahs, men of influence and weight, _ who preside when a meeting is called to adjudicate regarding breaches of social observances, and who take the lead on the great hunting expeditions and national festivals. It is said that the Moondahs were in a very wild state, occupying but a small portion of the plateau, when the Oraons, driven from the Rhotas hills, swarmed into the country, and sought and obtained permission to occupy it jointly with the Moondahs. Both Moondahs and Oraons declare there was on this occasion no fighting. The former were glad to obtain assistance in reclaiming the country they had adopted, and the Oraons are said to have come with large herds of cattle and implements of husbandry previously unknown to the Moondahs. It is probable that the Moondahs of those days were not more advanced than are to this day their brethren, the hill Korewahs of Sirgoojah, a tribe that know not the use of the plough: but they 160 The ‘‘ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. were great hunters, and could sing and dance and make merry. The Oraon youth and maidens speedily acquired: the songs and the steps, and this I doubt not aided greatly the harmonious blending of the two peoples. . There are no ancient temples or other antiquities on the plateau of Chota-Nagpore to indicate that the early Braminical races or Buddhists ever obtained a footing there; there is no tradition even of the “‘ Munis” having sought retreats amongst its rocks or by its waterfalls for their devotional exercises. We find such monuments in Sirgoojah to the very foot of the western face of the plateau ; and, as I have recently described in a paper dovoted to the antiquities of Manbhoom, we find numerous remains of Arian colonization close to © its southern and eastern approaches, but none on the platean itself. Left to themselves, the Kols increased and multiplied, and lived a happy arcadian sort of life under their republican form of government for many centuries ; but it is said that a wily Bramin at last obtained a footing amongst them, and an important change in the form of government was the result. , The Rajah of the Purha of which Satyomba was the head alto j was a Moondah named Madura. His occupation of the supposed — cradle of the race gave him precedence in the confederate councils; and a child of his house, reared in it if not born there, was, through — his influence and by the advice of a Bramin he had taken into his ~ service, elected supreme chief over the whole confederacy ; but as it would not suit the noble family, his descendants, to have it supposed | that their ancestor was one of the despised race called Kol, they have’ adopted the following legend as their origin :— : ‘When Jonmajoya, Rajah of Hustinapoor, attempted the destruc- tion of the Nags or Serpent race, one of them, Poondorik, assumed the . form of a Brahmin and went to the house of a Bramin at Benares to study the ‘ shasters.’ The Benares Bramin, pleased with th 2 intelligence and grace of his pupil, gave him his only daughter ‘ Parbutee’ to be his wife. Poondorik and his wife, Parbutee, together visited Juggernath, and on their return, passing through this country, then called ‘Jharkhund,’ the forest land, she was seized : i with the pains of labour near Satyomba, and gave birth to a child and died. ae The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. 161 “ Madura’s Bramin happening to pass, bearing an image of the sun worshipped by the Moondahs, saw the child sleeping and protected by a snake with expanded hood. This snake was Poondorik, relapsed into his original form. He addressed the Bramin, told his own story and the story of the child’s birth, declared that the babe was destined to be a great Rajah, and that his name was to be Funimatuk Roy, ‘the snake hood crowned,’ a worshipper of the sun, whose image the Bramin bore, and the Bramin was to be the family priest. The snake then vanished. The child was taken to Madura’s house and adopted and brought up with his own son, a boy of much the same age. When Funimatuk Roy was twelve years of age, Madura convened the Purha chiefs, and it is said the neighbouring Rajahs, including the Rajah of Sirgoojah and the Dytya Rajah, and suggested that one of the two lads should be selected as the Rajah of N agpore. The lads were subjected to an examination, when it was found that the snake boy had already acquired all the accomplishments necessary for his destined position, whilst the other was a mere rustic. It was then (according to the annals of the Nagbunsee family) ruled, that _ Funimatuk Roy and his heirs for ever should be the Rajahs, and that the Moondah’s child and his descendants should bear burdens, and thus all who claim to hold lands as descendants of the Moondahs and Oroans that first cleared them, are bound, when called on, to bear the burdens imposed on them by the Rajah and his assigns !” It is frankly admitted in the annals I quote from, that a difficulty _ arose regarding Funimatuk’s birth, when he sought in marriage the _ daughter of the Sikurbhoom (or Pochete) Rajah. The Sikurbhoom family priest was sent to examine the certificates of birth and found none: but Rajah Matuck Roy prayed for the intercession of his ophidian parent; he had calmly contemplated his position and put it to his father, that if the Sikurbhoom priest was not satisfied, a Moondah or an Oroan girl should become Queen of Nagpore. This Was not to be thought of. So the Nag once more entered an appear- ance, satisfied the Bramin by a relation of wonders, and since then the Nagbunsis have always intermarried with the best Rajpoot families. It is particularly noted that at Funimatuk Roy’s wedding-feast the ~Oroans and Moondahs all got drunk and began to fight, and the Rajah _ of Nagpore and Madura had to obtain the assistance of his guests, the 162 The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. Rajah of Sirgoojah and the Dytya Rajah, to separate them. The Dytya Rajah was, I presume, the Rajah of Patkoom, as that famuiy bear the surname of Adytya to this day. The marriage was celebrated at Satyomba, and there the first Rajah resided in a mud fort. The fourth in descent from Funimatuk moved his court to Chuttia, where we have the remains of a fort with masonry walls and some stone temples ascribed to him. Subsequently Doisa was chosen as the seat of Government, and here are some fine buildings, shewing that the family were improving in art and in civilization, when they moved there. This site also has been abandoned, and the present Rajah lives in a very mean house at Palkote. The sway of the Rajah of Chota-Nagpore does not, in early times, appear to have extended beyond the plateau or fringe of hills which divide it from the plains, but the Moondahs overran those limits and formed colonies in what are now called the five pergunnahs—Silli, Tamar, Barundah, Rabey and Boondoo—which did not acknowledge the Rajah-elect of Satyomba. In time, each of these pergunnahs — elected a Rajah of its own, who (their descendants declare) were each of a divine or miraculous birth, ike Funimatuk Roy; and on the strength of it they all call themselves Chuttrees and wear the cord. They intermarry amongst themselves or with the petty Rajahs of ’ Manbhoom who are of similar origin ; so their claim to be Chuttrees, — or at all events Hindoos of respectable caste, is not disputed. According — to their own tradition, the Rajahs of the five pergunnahs first forfeited their independence by submitting to pay tribute to the Rajah of — Cuttack. Eventually, however, they were subjugated by the Maha- ¥ rajah of Chota-Nagpore, and submitted to pay tribute to and accept es the “ Tilluck” or symbol of investiture from him. The Moondahs oH comprise about two-thirds of the population of the five pergunnahs, a and all who are not Moondahs are settlers of no very ancient date. E A In the northern and western parts of Chota-Nagpore, the authority Ns of the old Moondah or Oraon chiefs has been almost effaced by the middlemen who have been introduced by the Zemindars as more. profitable farmers, or by the Bramins, Rajpoots and others to whom, for religious or secular services, grants have been made by the Maharajah and members of his family holding under him. In many instances, the Kols have been entirely dispossessed of the lands their The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. 163 ancestors brought under cultivation, and ryots from other parts of India, more subservient to the wishes of the farmers, have been intro- duced. In some villages the peasant proprietory right of the aborigines has been entirely extinguished, and the few of that class that remain are found in the position of farm labourers. In the southern parts of Chota-Nagpore the Moondah chiefs, there as in Singbhoom called Mankees, have managed to retain their position, first, by resisting in open arms all attempts to encroach upon it, and lastly, by a settlement suggested and brought about by the officers of the British Government and concluded with the Maharajah shortly aiter the Kol disturbances in A. D. 1833. These Mankees have each under them about as many villages as formerly were included in a “ Purha,”’ and they pay a quit rent to the Maharajah as a commutation of the service and tribute in kind formerly paid to him as Lord Paramount, and they collect this and a little more as the contribution for their own support from the heads of villages, who again collect according to ancient custom at fixed rates from the villagers. There is fixity of tenure throughout, from the Maharajah to the cultivator, notwithstanding the intervention of the Mankee, the village Moondah, or Mohto. This is no doubt a living exemplification of the relation that, in older times, subsisted between the cultivator of the soil and his chief in most parts of India. In the Hoor Lurka Kols of Singbhoom we have a people who, till recently, had no notion of what it was to pay rent to any one, or even to give pecuniary support to their chiefs. They had their Mankees and Moondahs, but no one exercised any right arising from a title in the land except the cultivators. We have a very interesting description of the Hos, their country and their languages, by Colonel ‘Tickell,* and to this, before proceeding further with my memoir, I will add a brief sketch of their history. ’ The Singbhoom district is of a singular interest to the ethnologist. That portion of it called the Colehan, the Ho-desum or country proper of the Hos, is a series of fair and fertile plains, broken, divided and surrounded by hills; about 60 miles in length from north to south, and from 35 to 60 in breadth from east to west. It has to the south and south east the tributary estates, Mohurbhun. Keonjur, Bonai * As. Soc. Journal, Vol. IX. pp. 783, 997; 1063. 164 The “ Kols’ of Chota-Nagpore. and Gangpore, inhabited by Ooriah-speaking Hindoos, to the east and north the Bengalee pergunnah of Dhulbhoom and district of Manbhoom, and north and north-east the Hindee district of Lohar- daggah, and it is occupied by a race totally distinct by descent, custom, religion and language from any of the three. A people on whose smiling country covetous eyes have often been directed, but into which no one ever attempted with impunity to intrude. It is impossible to say when the Hos first entered Singbhoom ; but as we find that the Chota-Nagpore Moondahs more and more assimilate to the Hos, as we approach Singbhoom from Chota-Nagpore, we may safely infer that the Hos came originally from that country ; and this is their own tradition. They appear to have brought with them and retained their system of confederate government by Purhas, but in Singbhoom the word now used to express it, is Pirhi or Peer. Thus the Colehan is divided into Pirhis, each under a Mankee as chief of the Pirhi, and each village having its Moondah as headman. According to their own tradition, the Hos displaced a nation of — Jains settled in the eastern parts of Singbhoom, some remains of — whom are still extant, and a nation of Bhuyahs from the western and , southern parts, driving them out of, and appropriating to their own — exclusive use, the richest part of the country. From these early times, probably more than 2,000 years ago, they have proudly held the ~ country they acquired; and, in my humble opinion, they have the | right to say they never submitted to rulers of an alien race, till they — ) were forced to do so by the power of the British Empire. At the commencement of the present century, Singbhoom was only | known to the British Government as a country under the rule of certain Rajpoot chiefs, all of one family, whose independence, when we — first occupied the Orissa Provinces, Lord Wellesley promised to respect, After the final cession of all the surrounding districts in 1819 these ie chiefs, occupying a territory that embraces the Colehan, volunteliial | es submitted to the British Government, and immediately sought the sal assistance of that Government in reducing the ‘“ Hos’ to submission, asserting that the Hos were their subjects then in rebellion ; but they bd admitted that for fifty years they had exercised no arithaoce over, Be them, and I find no proof that the Hos had at any former period ever submitted to them. It is not pretended that they were conquered, — Ane The “ Kols’” of Chota-Nagpore. 165 but supremacy was claimed by the Rajpoot Rajahs over the Ho tribes next to them, thus dividing the country and the people amongst four Rajpoot chiefs, the Rajahs of Mohurbhunj and Porahat, Koer of Seraikilla, and Thakoor of Khursowan. It is true that the chiefs of Singbhoom, ancestors of the Rajahs of Porahat, Seraikilla and Thakoor of Khursowan, obtained great influ- ence over their wild neighbours. They were gradually induced to believe tales which gave to the founder of this family a miraculous birth in their country, and they accorded to him divine honors, whilst they repudiated the idea of his being their temporal chief. The oldest surviving member of the Porahat family tells me that no regular tribute was ever received from the Colehan, but they were treated and employed rather as friendly allies than as subjects, and at certain seasons presents of trifling value were received from them and presents given in return. When a division of the estate of the Singhoom chief occurred, the brothers each took, with the share assigned to him, a share in the good- will of the Hos. Thus the Seraikilla and Khursowan families claimed the allegiance of the tribes nearest to them. The claim of the - Mohurbhunj Rajah sprang up as the Kols extended their cultivation, till it touched or ran over his boundary. But it is admitted that all ‘recorded attempts of the Rajpoot chiefs to subdue them had been ‘signally defeated. On the last occasion, the great grandfather of the present Maharajah of Chota-Nagpore, at the head of 20,000 of his own men co-operating ‘with the forces of the Singbhoom Rajpoot chiefs, entered the Colehan. ‘The Hos allowed him to do this; they then fell on his army in masses, and, routing it with immense slaughter, ignominiously expelled him, pursuing him into his own territory, and severely retaliating on the border villages of the Maharajah and his allies. __ It was no doubt in retaliation for these attacks on their independence that the Hos now became, as they were found to be when first brought to our notice (in 1819-20), the scourge of the inhabitants of the more civilized parts of Singbhoom and of all the surrounding districts. They shewed no mercy to the Braminical inhabitants of the villages they attacked and pillaged. A long line of Bramin villages on the Bramin river in Gangpoor was laid waste by them and has remained 166 The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. depopulated ever since. No traveller ever ventured to pass through _ their country. No Bramin, Rajpoot or other Hindoo caste, or Mussal- man was suffered to reside in it. In 1820, the Agent Governor-General, Major Roughsedge, entered the Colehan at the head of a force consisting of a battalion of infantry, with cavalry and artillery. He was surprised to find the wild race, of whom he had heard such disparaging accounts, in possession of an open undulating and richly cultivated country, studded with villages in groves of magnificent tamarind and mango trees, abounding in unusual indications of rural wealth. He was allowed to enter on this scene unmolested, but the slaughter of some of his camp-followers, who had incautiously strayed into one of the villages, demonstrated the hostility of the people, and an attempt to capture the murderers brought about the first collision between the Hos and our troops. A party of cavalry, sent to the offending village, was met in the open field by 300 warriors, who undauntedly advanced to meet the charge, - rushed between the ranks of the horsemen, hacking especially at the — horses with their formidable battle-axes, and shewing no disposition to : yield or to turn, till half their number had been sabred or shot. In { the village where the murder was committed, was found a reserve of 60 men who fought desperately and were all killed! The same evening another body of Lurkahs* attacked the rear of the column and cut off a convoy of supplies. It became necessary to act with vigour, and the old Hos of the present day describe the retaliation that now fell — upon them as dreadfully severe. Eventually some intercepted mails were restored uninjured, as a token of submission, and the Lurka chiefs : in the vicinity entered into engagements to acknowledge and pay = tribute to the Rajah of Singbhoom.t : Major Roughsedge met with further opposition in his progress. towards Sumbulpoor through the Southern Peers: he had in fact to fight his way out of the country ; and on his leaving it a war broke — + out between the Kols who had submitted, and those who had not. lf One hundred Hindustanee burkundazes under a Soobadar were sent by the Agent to the support of the Rajah and his Lurka allies, and this for a time gave them the advantage; but the Soobadar having * “ Laraka,”’ the fighters, a common name for the Hos. ie + Major Roughsedge’s dispatches, . The ‘ Kols’’ of Chota-Nagpore. 167 been induced to enter the Colehan to assist in levying a contribution, was attacked, and he and the whole of the party cut up ! In 1821 a large force was employed to reduce the Lurkas to submission, and after a month’s hostilities, the leaders, encouraged by a proclamation surrendered and entered into engagement, binding them- selves to subjection to the British Government, and agreeing to pay to the chiefs at the rate of 8 annas for each plough. It was now noticed that the Lurkas evinced a perfect willingness to be guided and ruled by British officers, and the utmost repugnance to the authority arrogated over them by the Singbhoom chiefs; and it would have saved much blood, expense and trouble, if this feeling had at the _ time been taken advantage of. Made over to the chiefs, they soon _ again became restive and reverted to their old practices of resistance and pillage. The circle of depredations gradually increased, till it had included Dhulbhoom, devastated Bamunghatee, and extended to some parts of Chota-Nagpore. The chiefs under whom the Lurkas had been placed could not control them, and for some five years, from 1830 to 1836 the Hos, maintained this hostile attitude. _ In consequence of this unsatisfactory state of affairs, a proposal ‘made by Captain Wilkinson in August 1836, to employ a force and thoroughly subdue the Lurkas, and then to take the whole tribe under the direct management of British officers, was favourably received by ; Government and promptly acted on. Two Regiments of Infantry and two Brigades of guns entered Singbhoom in November 1836, and ., were immediately commenced against the refractory Peers ; ‘and by February following all the Mankees and Moondahs had ‘submitted and bound themselves by fresh engagements to obey and pay revenue to the British Government, and no longer to follow the, orders of the chiefs to whom they had previously been required to submit. Six hundred and twenty-two villages, with a population, | estimated at 90,000 souls, of whom more than three-fourths are Hos, were thus brought and have since remained under the immediate control of the British Government. Since then, the population and | spread of cultivation have immensely increased, and the people are now peaceful, prosperous and happy. rom the region round about the station, Chybassah, 170 miles due west from Calcutta, the waste | lands have entirely disappeared. Colonies of Hindus may now be 168 The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. found settled in the heart of the Colehan, occupying villages apart from the Hos, but without demur placing themselves under the Ho Mankees of Peers. For their own system of government is, as far as possible, preserved, and the Mankees are officers of police as well as the tuhsildars or rent-collectors of their circles. One great change is now being peaceably introduced, the old system of assessment on ploughs is under process of commutation toa light assessment on the land. This is undoubtedly the nucleus of the Moondah nation, the most — compact, the purest, most powerful and most interesting division of — the whole race, and in appearance decidedly the best looking. In their erect carriage and fine manly bearing, the Hos look like a people that have maintained and are proud of their independence. Many have features of sufficiently good cast to entitle them to rank as Arians; — high noses, large but well formed mouths, beautiful teeth, and the facial angle as good as in the Hindu races. The figures both of male and female freely displayed by the extreme scantiness of the national costume are often models of beauty; but this description applies only to the people of the highly cultivated part of the country who have seldom been subjected to severe privation and who generally fare right well. The inhabitants of the imperfectly reclaimed hill forests are more savage-looking, but they seldom deteriorate to the almost simian physiognomy that the Oraons are found with under similar circumstances. When the face of the Moondah varies from the Arian or Caucasian type, it appears to me rather to merge into the Mongolian than the Negro. High cheek bones, small openings for the eyes, having in some rare instances a tendency to the a x oblique set of the Mongolian, and flattish faces without much beard or whisker. They are of average stature, and in colour vary from brown to tawny yellow. IIl.—Tue Oraons. The Oraons have a tradition that they were once settled in Guzerat. a They were expelled from that part of India, and, retreating east, made a stand at fort Kalinjur where they fought the “ Loorik Sowrik” of “ Pali- pipri,’’ were defeated, and, retreating still east, settled on the Rhotds hills. Here they say, they remained unmolested till attacked and The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore, 169 driven from the hills by the Mahomedans in the reign of the emperor __ Akbar, but as they aver this occurred fifty-two generations ago, there ‘is an anachronism somewhere. I think they were settled in Chota _ Nagpore centuries before the days of Akbar, but it is probable that I some of the clan-remained in the Rhotas hills until the Mahomedans ; constructed their fortress there. | ; The accounts of ancient Guzerat faintly confirm the Oraon tradition. H I find from Thornton’s Gazetteer that there is a race settled there from _ remote antiquity who are called Coolies ; but there is nothing in the - name, which, as I observed before, appears to have been applied very generally to the aborigines by the Arians, and the account given of the Coolies does not lead me to suppose they are of the Oraon family. q There is, however, a short description of what appears to be a remnant of a tribe, which would answer perfectly forthe Oraons,—“ A small, active, well built race, engaged to some extent in cultivation, but by choice deriving their subsistence, as far as possible, from the chase, fishing, _ or the collecting of wild fruits and the marketable produce of the f jungles for sale. Their peculiar pursuits, little relished or shared in by the rest of the community, caused them to be viewed with dislike ~ and dread, and the reputation of possessing great powers in sorcery _ subjects them to much cruel treatment.” . Every word of the above description applies to the Oraon tribe, ‘and the name given to this remnant of a people viz. ‘‘ Dunjas,” is an * Oraon word not unlike the term Dhangurh, so commonly applied to the Oraons in the countries to which they emigrate for work. _ The names traditionally handed down amongst the Oraons, as Loorik Sowrik, allude probably to some tribe of Sravacks or Sowoks or Jains, and the Palipipri might refer to the Palithana mountains, the Jain ‘temples on which are amongst the most interesting architectural works | inIndia, The etymology of the word Oraon, I have not been able | Gr (0 trace satisfactorily, but it may have been applied to the tribe in consequence of their migratory habits. They call themselves ~ * Khoonkir.” | @. Between the language of the Oraons and the language of the _ Moondahs and their cognates, I can trace no similarity either in | ‘pronunciation, formation, construction or general character. With | pretty copious vocabularies before me, I can find no analogues, and 170 The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. whilst the language of the Moondahs is soft and sonorous, that of the Oraons is guttural and harsh. Doctor Latham, in his descriptive ethnolo- gy, has noticed the near connection of the Oraon, Rajmahal hill and Tamul languages, and especially observes on the similarity of the personal pronouns. English. Rajymahal. Oraon. Tamul, dc Li En En nam, En. Thou Nin Nin » Mia He, she, it Ath As Ata We Nim Km Nam Ye Nina | Nim Nim They Awar Ar Awar Out of a vocabulary of about 24 Oraon and Tamul words, I find the following analogues. * EE English. Tamul. Tuda. Oraon, Man Al Al Al Hye Kam Kan Khan. Tooth Pal Paroh Pulla — But I find in the language now spoken by the Oraons, words of Sanscrit origin not in common use, as “‘ puph,” flower, “‘ amb,” water, “kesh,” hair, indicative of their having occupied some country in — common with people speaking a Sanscrit or Prakrit dialect. The annexed notes on the language with which I have been favoured by the Rev. Frederic Batsch, senior Missionary at Ranchee, will, I hope, throw some light on the subject. The resemblance between the Oraon and Tamul language does not invalidate their own migratory traditions, for it is mot more marked than the relation between the Tamul and the language of the Gonds and others. Their physical peculiarities are as different from those of the Moondah as are their linguistic characteristics. The Oroans. must be regarded as a very small race, not. short and squat like some of the Indo-Chinese stock, but .a well proportioned small race. The young men and women have light graceful figures and are as active a8 — monkies. Their complexions are, as a rule, of the darkest; but if we take as our type those who dwell in mixed communities, we find great variety in feature and colour. If we take those who, living in isolated positions, may be supposed to offer us the purest blood, we find them The ‘ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. 17t generally dark and ill-favoured. They have wide mouths, thick hps and projecting maxillary processes, nostrils wide apart, and no elevation _ of nose to speak of, and low though not in general very receding foreheads. I have seen amongst them heads that in the woolly crispness _ of the hair completed the similitude of the Oraons to the Negro. It _ may be said that the class [ am describing have degenerated in feature from living a wilder and more savage life than others of their clan ; but Ido not find this degeneracy of feature amongst the Jushpore Korewahs, who are to the Moondahs of Chota-Nagpore what the Jushpore Oraons are to the Oraons of the same district.* I found the Korewahs mostly short of stature, but with well knit muscular frames, ~ complexion brown not black, sharp bright deep set eyes, noses not. de- _ ficient in prominency, somewhat high check bones, but without notable maxillary protuberances. In the more civilized parts of the province, both Oraons and Moondahs improve in appearance. The former indeed & still retain their somewhat diminutive appearance, but in complexion _ they are fairer, in features softer, some even good looking, and the youthful amongst them all pleasing from their usual happy contented expression and imperturbable good humour. Driven from the Rhotas hills, the Oraons, according to their own tradition, separated into two great divisions. One of these, moving east, found a final resting-place in the Rajmahal hills; the other, going . south, sought refuge in the Palamow hills, and wandered from valley to valley in those ranges, till they found themselves in Burway, a hill- locked estate in Chota-Nagpore proper. From thence they occupied the highlands of Jushpore and formed the settlements in the vicinity of Lohardugga, on the Chota-Nagpore platedu, where they still ‘constitute the bulk of the population. The Satyomba Moondahs had } The identity of the language spoken by the Rajmahal hill people | (mot the Sonthals) and that of the Oraons is full and sufficient confirmation of the tradition of their common origin, and of the | bt the Rajmahal hill people, who being isolated must have retained | Whose they brought with them to the hills, with the customs of the | Oraons, demonstrates that the latter are derived from the Moondahs. | * Asiatic Society’s Journal, Vol. XXXIV. p. Lo. ie The ‘ Kols’ of Chota-Nagpore. Referring to Col. Walter Sherwill’s account of the Raéjmahal hill people,* I find, in regard to marriage, that it is customary for the young couple to sleep together on the same bed before marriage. The Oraons would consider this a very indecorous proceeding, though a public recognition that the young couple have slept together aiter the marriage is with the Oraons an important sequel to the ceremony. - Inthe Rajmahal hills, says Col. Sherwill, the dead are buried. The Rig Veda and Ramayun tell us that this was the custom of the Dusyas, but the Moondahs and their cognates all burn their dead, and the Oraons follow their example. The Réjmahal hill men swear on salt, the Oraons have a veneration for salt, but swear on dub grass,+ huldee and rice. The Oraons know nothing of Bedo Gosain, the invisible spirit adored by the Rajmahalies. Their supreme deity is the sun under — the title of Dhurmo, but as that and the Réjmahalee term are both of Sanscrit origin, it evinces that neither race have in their own language any word for the Deity. Lastly, the hill man is described as less cheerful than the Sonthal, — less industrious, and as not joining in the dances that the people of the Moondah stock are so-devoted to. In Chota-Nagpore the Oraons : are more lively than the Moondahs, quite as industrious, and the most enthusiastic and nimble-footed of the dancers. The two races, Moondah and Oraon, must have been for ages the | only colonists of the plateau; it is singular that they have no tradition of any disqute having arisen between them. Affecting jealously to guard against admixture of the races by sexual intercourse, they in other respects lived as one people, the Oraon conforming more to the customs of the Moondah than the Moondahs to the Oraon, and ix many instances adopting the Moondah language and losing their own. In villages east of Ranchee, though inhabited wholly by Oraons, the Moondah, not Oraon, is the language spoken ; but the Moondah language is not much known in the vicinity of Lohardaggah or in Jushpore. _ The village systems of the two people became almost identical in form. The village priest, called the Pahan, is probably an Oraon institution, as, [ think, amongst the Moondahs the principle is that the head of the family is priest; but the Moondahs of Chota-Nagpore * Asiatic Society’s Journal, Vol. XX. p, 544, + Agrostis linearis, ; e “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. 173 adopted it, and in their villages, as well as in those of the Oraons, there isalwaysa Pahan. The village system now existing is such as it became after many encroachments by the Rajah and the middlemen introduced by him. Still as bearing the impress of a very primitive form of government, it is worth describing, and in doing so, I will make use of a very elaborate report on the subject written by Doctor Davidson in 1839. The actual descendants of the men who formed the villages are _ called Bhuinhurs. They are a privileged class, who hold their lands - at low fixed rates or rent-free, but they are bound to do service to the _ chief or his representative. The head of, the Bhuinhurs is called the _ Moondah, and is generally the representative of the old Moondah chief _ of the village. He presides when meetings are held to settle disputes ~ about social customs ; and all demands for service on the Bhuinhurs by the proprietor or tase are made through him. He holds his lands as b Bhuinhurree, and has no other emolument. _ The Mahto, though second in point of rank, is the most important F | functionary in the village. He has the assessment and settlement of all lands not held by the hereditary cultivators ; collects all dues and t rents, and is responsible for them to the farmer or proprietor. He - holds for his services one powa of land rent-free, and in some villages _ gets a fee of one or two pice annually from each ryot. The office is not hereditary. 4 _ The Pahan is the village priest. He is a Moondah or Oraon by are performed by him. No Bramins are permitted to interfere. The " office of Pahan is generally hereditary, but is not necessarily so. He has under his charge the land called “ Dalikhatari,” and. from the proceeds of this land, he has to support himself and to provide the rice - kerai or bundle of each crop as it is mit ‘There is a Gorait for each village, and a Kotewar for one or more | villages. The former is the messenger of the Zemindar or his repre- | Sentative, the latter is the Police officer, 174 The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. The villagers maintain a blacksmith and a Gowala or herd; the latter takes care of all the village cattle, and is supposed to be respon- sible if any are stolen. They each get a maund of dhan for every ‘ plough and three kerais, bundles, of other crops. According to the tradition of the Kols, the Rajah is entitled to the rent of only half of the land in each village. The remainder is Bhuinhurree, or rent-free under some other denomination, but in most villages rent is now taken on from two-thirds to three-fourths of the land. The — land is thus divided :— I. Rughus—the land that pays rent to the owner or his represent- ative. II. Bhetketta, a certain portion of the Rughus which each ryot, not a Bhuinhur, is allowed to cultivate free of rent, but for which he has to perform various services to the landlord or farmer. III. The land allotted to the Mahto, the Pahan and the Bhundari, IV. Munghus—the land at the disposal of the landlord or his agent | or the farmer of the village. For the cultivation of this land, the — holder of the village can make any arrangement that he pleases. V. Bhuinhurree is the land held rent free by the descendants of the founder of the village, who are, however, bound to render certain services to the Rajah or his representative. VI. Bhootketta—the land, the produce of which is appropriated to the expense of the great village poojas and festivals; a portion of this. called “‘ Dalikhatari” is assigned to the Pahan for the ordinary annual _ poojas, and the proceeds of the remainder are reserved for the triennial sacrifices and extraordinary occasions. The rent is assessed on the wet land only. The cultivator is entitled to upland in proportion to the wet land for which he pays. If he cultivates more, the custom is for a payment in kind called Muswur, to be made when the crop is harvested. The Bhuinhurs cling most tenaciously to their Bhuinhurree lands. Insurrections have followed attempts to disturb these tenures, and eve 2 now such attempts are sure to lead to serious affrays. The Kol insur- rection of 1833 was, without doubt, mainly caused by the encroac h- ments of alien farmers and sub-proprietors on the rights of the descendants of the old settlers. The first burst of the outbreak was a pretty broad hint, a general conflagration of the houses of alien farmers The “ Kols’”’ of Chota-Nagpore. 175 and sub-proprietors, and the massacre of all that the incensed Kols could find. The Kols of Chota-Nagpore, generally a good-tempered, mild, inoffen- sive race, become wild with excitement on this question, and nothing _ ean reconcile them to a decree or order which in any way infringes on what they consider their proprietary right. According to their theory, ; dispossession for generations can no more annul their right in the land than it can extinguish the ties of blood. The courts will not always accept this doctrine, and the Kols cannot regard as equitable any decision that excludes it. _ An Oraon family lives very promiscuously in a small, indiffer- ently constructed and untidy looking hut, and their village often consists of a street or court of such huts. In all that relates to their inner domestic life, they are less susceptible of improvement than the other f tribes. They have no gardens or orchards attached to individual houses, but the groves of fruit-trees that they plant outside the village form a § property. In every Oraon village of old standing there is a house called the ‘‘ Doomcooreea” (Bachelor’s Hall), in which all unmarried men . and boys of the tribe are obliged to sleep. Any one absenting himself and spending the night elsewhere in the village is fined. In this _ building the flags, musical instruments, yaks’ tails, dancing equipments d other property used at the festivalsare kept. They have a regular system of fagging in the Doomcooreea. The small boys have to shampoo the limbs of their luxurious masters, and obey all orders of the elders, who also systematically bully them to make them, it is lleged, hardy. In some villages the unmarried girls have a house to themselves, an old woman being appointed as Duenna to look after them. She is always armed with a stick to keep the boys off. A circular space, in front of the Doomcoorea, is kept clear as the village dancing ground. It is generally sheltered by fine old trees, and seats are placed all round for spectators or tired ¢ ancers. | _ The Doomcooreea is never used by boys of the Moondah tribe. It isan institution quite unknown to the Hos, but the Moondahs and Hos build | themselves houses in which all the family can be decently accommo- 176 The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. dated. Their houses are more isolated, occupy much more space and are in appearance much more civilized than those of the Oraons, with verandahs, well raised plinths and separate apartments for the married and single members of the family. Every Moondah village has its : dancing place, though it has no Doomcooreea. The best Korewah | villages consist of about forty houses built round a large square, in the centre of which is the dancing arena; but as the Korewahs are nomads, changing their abodes every second or third year, their villages may — be regarded as mere standing camps. The Kheriahs build substantial — comfortable houses like the Hos. It is curious they have the same word “‘Q”’ for a house and the sky. The Moondah word ‘ Ora” is, like the Turkoman “ Ova,” a house or tent. The flags kept in the ~ Oraon Doomcooreea appear to be an Oraon institution. Every village or group of villages, probably the head quarters of each “‘ Parha,” has | its peculiar flag, and we have actually had cases in courts praying for injunction against villages charged with having assumed flags that did not belong to them ! I will now proceed to review the customs of the Moondahs and Oraons together, taking care to note all points of divergence that are known to me. : After the birth of a child, the mother has-to undergo purification, and on the same day that this ceremony takes place, which is simply a process of ablution, the child is named. Elderly females or matrons, friends and relations assemble for this purpose, and a vessel containing water is placed in the midst, and as the name first selected is pronounced, one of the women. drops a grain of rice into the water, If the grain of rice sinks, that name is discarded, and the experiment is repeated with the second name on the list, and so on till, as the name is pronounced, the grain floats. (Tho Garrows of the eastern frontier have a similar method for divining the name of the spirit they ought to invoke on particular occasions.) If the name of some friend is chosen, it is considered as establishing a tie between the child and his namesake, resembling that which subsists between a Christian child and his godfather. The person whose name is selected is always called Saki or Sakhi, a word of Sanscrit origin meaning friend, so that in ‘‘nam Saki” we have in meaning and sound our word namesa ke. The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. 177 Sulgi,* Pongla, Madhi, Makoo, Roomeea Saggi, Dinli, Natri, Akli, oo”) Bangi, Julli, and the Hindoo names of the days of the week are very commonly given. The following are the names of boys—Rumsi, Birsa, Somra, Daharoo, Singra, Satri, Dubroo, Doolkoo, Didoo, Runka, Biggoo. But they have adopted many foreign names, and the names of British officers they have known and esteemed, are thus preserved amongst the Hos of Singbhoom, and may be handed down from generation to generation. Thus ‘‘ Major’ and “ Captain” have become common names in the Colehan, originally taken from Major Roughsedge, the | first British officer they ever saw, and Captain Wilkinson (now Col. _ Wilkinson) whom they regard as their greatest benefactor. Doctor, Tickell, &c. are also common. Girls, when three or four years of age, _ receive their mark of caste. Three lines tattooed on the forehead and _ two on each temple, four dots on the chin and one on the nose. It _ does not appear to be connected with any religious custom, nor is it applied with any ceremony, and as neither the Moondahs nor the ‘ Oraons have any particular term for it in their own language, it is { probable that they adopted it from the Sudhs or Hindoos. Some & “Moondah girls of Chota-Nagpore have different marks. Those of ; Singbhoom have adopted the arrow, appropriately enough, as the national weapon of theim lords and masters. _ The Kheriahs and Juangas, though isolated from the Moondahs and | Oraons, have the same triple and double marks on the forehead and % emples. _ rather a severe process of puncturation, which they consider it manly to The Oraon boys are marked, when children, on the arms by endure. The only reason I have heard assigned for this custom is, that _ through it even the naked dead may have a distinguishing mark. __ When a girl approaches maturity, it is incumbent on her to bind Uy her hair, and from that period of her life she is restricted to food ‘prepared by her own people. Asa child with her hair loose, she is permitted to partake of whatever is edible, no matter by whom prepared. Young men enjoy this liberty of appetite tillthey marry. They then, to use their own expression, put salt in their flesh, and must not partake of food prepared by aliens. The Oraons have a veneration for salt, and they are not absolutely prohibited ia om partaking of "* A common name and also the name of a goddess, A the name, I see, of one of the young ladies from the Andaman Islands, 178 The ‘ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. plain rice cooked by others, provided they are left to salt it themselves. The salt, it would appear, thus applied, removes the “ Taboo,” and makes fas what is otherwise nefas. As a rule, marriages are not contracted till both the bride and bridegroom are of mature age. It is sometimes left to the parents to select wives for their sons, but the young people have ample opportunities for studying each others characters, love-making and following the bent of their own inclinations; and it very often happens, that plans concocted by the parents are frustrated by the children. In Chota-Nagpore, amongst the agricultural classes, and in Sing- bhoom amongst all classes of Kols, the girls have all a price fixed upon them, and this the lover or his friends must arrange to pay, before the parents of the bride will give their consent. In Singbhoom, the price is so high, especially for young ladies of good family, that marriage is — frequently put off till late in life; and girls valued not so much for — their charms and accomplishments as for their pedigree, often grow grey as maidens in the house of their fathers. Singbhoom is perhaps the only place in India in which old maids are found; they have ~ plenty of them there. But though urged to change this practice by — all who take an mterest in them, the old Mankees of Singbhoom are — inflexible, not only in demanding a high prite for their girls, but — in insisting that it shall be paid, according to ancient custom, chiefly in cattle. A Mankee of the old school will not take less than forty head of cattle for his daughter; but the eyes of .the rising generation are opened to the absurdity of the practice, and some of us _ may live to see it changed. ’ In consequence of this custom, the grown up boys and girls are quite a separate institution in every Kol village ; there is very little | their own, from which the old people sensibly keep aloof. If a flirtation is known to have gone too far, the matter is generally settled by the young man being made to pay the price for the girl and — marry her. . a In Chota-Nagpore the daughter of a Mankee was, some years ago, % valued at about 36 Rs , but they are gradually adopting the custom of the Hindoos in re to their marriages, and giving up the — objectionable practice of putting a price on them. The price paid ‘= The “‘ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. 179 the common people ranges from 10 to 12 rupees. These disagreeable preliminaries having been arranged, the bridegroom and a large party of his friends of both sexes enter with much singing and dancing and sham fighting the village of the bride, where they meet the bride’s party and are hospitably entertained. The bride and bridegroom are now well anointed with turmeric, and bathed, and then taken and wedded, not to each other, but to two trees! The bride to a Mowa tree, the bridegroom to a Mango. They are made to touch the tree with “ seendoor,” (red lead), and then to clasp it in their arms. Qn returning, they are placed standing face to face, the girl on a curry stone over a ploughshare supported on sheaves of corn or grass. The bridegroom stands ungallantly treading _ on his bride’s toes, and in this position touches her forehead with the red lead ; she touches his forehead in the same manner. The bride’s maids then, after some preliminary splashing and sprinkling, pour a jar of water over the head of each: this necessitates a change of raiment, and apparently concludes the ceremony, as the young couple going inside to change, do not appear again till the cock-crowing announces the dawn or its approach. At the first crow the bride’s maids, who with the young men have been merrily keeping it up all night with the song and dance, burst into the nuptial chamber and bring - forth the blushing bride and her bashful lord; and then they all go } down to the river or to a tank to bathe, and parties of boys and girls - form sides under the leadership of the bride and bridegroom, and pelt “each other with clods of earth. The bridegroom next takes a water vessel and conceals it in the stream or water for the bride to find, She then conceals it from him, and when he has found it, she takes it up “filled with water and-places it on her head. She lifts her arm to ‘support the pitcher, and the bridegroom, standing behind her with his bow strung, and the hand that grasps it lightly resting on her shoulder, discharges an arrow from the pretty loophole thus formed into the path before her, The girl walks on to where the arrow falls, and with head erect and still bearing the pitcher of water, she picks it up with her foot, takes it into her hand, and restores it to her husband with a graceful obeisance. She thus shews that she can adroitly perform her domestic duties and knows her duty to her lord and master, whilst he, on his part, in discharging an arrow to clear 180 The ‘ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. her path of an imaginary foe, indicates that he is prepared to perform his duty as her guide and protector through life. In the Oraon marriages, many of these symbolical ceremonies are omitted, and the important one of exchanging the “ sindoor’’ is differently performed. The bridegroom stands behind his bride with his toes on her heels, and stretches over her head to touch her forehead with the powder. She touches his forehead by reaching back over his shoulder. The cold bath completes the ceremony, they go to their own apartment to change their clothes, and do not emerge till morning. The price paid for a girl in cows is called ‘ Sukmur’” by the Kheriah tribe. They have no word for marriage in their own language, and the only ceremony used appears to be little more than a sort of public recognition of the cohabitation. They have learned to call this “‘ bzha,” but they admitted to me that this public recogni- , tion was often dispensed with. 3 It takes place in this wise. After the settlement of the usual prelimi- naries, the bride is brought to the village of her intended bridegroom by her own people and their friends, and they halt and bivouac in the — village grove. The bridegroom and his friends join them in the grove — where they all regale themselves and dance, and during these nuptial — dances the bride and bridegroom are each borne on the hips of one of their dancing friends; they are not allowed to put their feet to the ground. Thus wildly dancing, they proceed into the village, and the bride and bridegroom are taken to the latter’s house and anointed with oil ; they are then brought outside, and the ceremony of touching each “sindoor” is performed, followed by the . splashing and sousing which becomes a general romp. Then the young couple are left to themselves till morning. The bride’s maids other’s forehead with the arouse them as the cock crows, and after the public ablution of garments and their wearers the party breaks up. ANG The gestures of the dancers on these occasions, and the songs, all bear more directly than delicately on what is evidently = as the main object of the festivities. : In Singbhoom, marriages, notwithstanding the lateness at which they take place are generally arranged by the parents, but nelle wishes are not unfrequently anticipated by love matches. In the various journeyings to and fro that are found necessary when a match The ‘* Kols” of Chota-Nagpere. . 181 is being arranged, omens are carefully observed, and the match is broken off, if they are unfavourable. At the actual marriage there is much feasting and dancing, but little ceremony, The turning point of the affair is, when the bride and bridegroom mix and drink off some of the beer they have each been helped to ; the boy pours some of the beer given to him into the girl’s cup, she pours from her cup into the boy’s cup, and they drink and thus become of the same “ keel”’ or clan, for the Hos, Moondahs and Oraons are all-divided into families under this name, and may not take to wife a girl of their own keelt. This division of the primitive races into something having a semblance to caste, will be found in the North Eastern Frontier as well as in this province. The Garrows, for instance, are divided into what ~ ae are called “ maharis,” and a man may not marry a girl of his own ~ mahari. | It is obvious that the custom does not spring from any such notion of caste as are found amongst the Hindoos, and that it is not one which these races have adopted from the Hindoos, because with a Hindoo, caste is destroyed by a marriage out of it. It is equally opposed to the custom of the Jews, whose daughters (at least if A _heiresses) were obliged to take husbands of their own tribe.* i _ In Singbhoom the bride and bridegroom do not touch each other - with “¢ sindoor’’, as is the custom in Chota-Nagpore. The Oraons and ~ Moondahs may have adopted the custom from the Hindoos, and the primitive practice of the race is probably as it is found amongst the _ more isolated Hos. 4 _A very singular scene may sometimes be noticed in the markets of Singbhoom. A young man suddenly makes a pounce on a girl and carries her off bodily, his friends covering the retreat (like a group from the picture of the rape of the Sabines). This is generally a ‘summary method of surmounting the obstacles that cruel parents may have placed in the lovers’ path ; but though it is sometimes done in anticipation of the favourable inclination of the girl herself, and in spite of her struggles and tears, no disinterested person interferes, and the girls, late companions of the abducted maiden, often applaud the exploit. - The Ho husband has to pay a high price for his wife, and it is * Numbers xxxvi. 6, 182 The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. certain that he highly appreciates her. Although he is not known to have for her any more endearing epithet than “my old woman,” yet by no civilized race are wives treated with more consideration than by the untutored Ho. The whole of the domestic arrange- ments are under her exclusive management. She is consulted on all occasions, and I know one or two husbands whom I am almost inclined to regard as henpecked. The Kols seldom take a second wife during the lifetime of the first, but I know instances of their having done so. The wife always cooks for her husband, and when the dinner is ready, they sit down and eat it together like Christians ; but the Oraons have followed the Hindoo custom of making the woman eat the leavings of her lord. It is customary with all these tribes to pay particular attention to — omens, when any of them set out to arrange the preliminaries of a marriage. The Hos who are more under the influence of this © superstition than their cognates or than the Oraons, have a long list — of deterrent signs, which have been described by Tickell in his paper above quoted, I subjoin the most noticeable of those that are observed by the Oraons. . 1.° On leaving the house ‘‘to win a bride’, they look out for omens. If acowcallsand the calf responds, it is good. If there is no response, the wooing is postponed or abandoned. 2. If they find a dead mouse on the road, they must stop and make a diagnosis. If ants and flies have possessed themselves of the carcass, it is good, they go on. If the insects appear to have shunned it (which is not very likely to happen), they go back. 3. It is not good to meet oxen or buffaloes with their horns” crossed, or to see a hawk strike a bird, or to come upon women washing clothes. It is good to see people burying a dead body, and to find on their road a cow giving milk to her calf. z 4. If they see a man cutting a tree, and the tree falls before they can get past it, it is very bad. If they pass before it falls, it is all right. A certain bird heard on the left gives a note of joy; if — on the right, he is a harbinger of woe. P 5. If, on approaching the village of the girl, they come on women with water-pots full, it is a happy omen. If they meet a party witll hy empty water-pots, it is a bad one, Z| The “ Kols’” of Chota-Nagpore. 183 The Nagpore Kols, whether of the Moondah or Oraon tribe, and all the cognates of the Moondahs that I know of, are passionately fond of dancing, and with them dancing is as much an accomplishment as it is with the civilized nations of Hurope. They have a great variety of dances, and in each different steps and figures are used, of great intricacy, but they are performed with aneatness and precision that can only be acquired by great practice. Little children are hardly on their legs, before they begin to learn their dancing steps; and the result of this early training is that, however difficult the step, the limbs of the performers move as if they belonged to one body.’ They have musical voices and a great variety of simple me- lodies. It isa fact fhat, when we raised a corps of Kols, their early practice in keeping step and time greatly facilitated the operations of drill; and the Missionaries have availed themselves of the musical talents and taste of the Kol converts to produce congregational singing that would be a credit to an English country church. The dances are seen to the greatest advantage at the great periodi- cal festivals called ‘“‘ Jatras.” They are at appointed places and seasons, and when the day comes, all take a holiday and proceed to the spot in their best array. The girls, on these occasions, put on their _ best dress, generally a white “ saree’ with a broad red border. They - tastefully arrange flowers in their hair and plumes of the long breast j feathers of the paddy-bird. The young men wear Turkey red turbans, and add a snow white cloth to their usually scanty garb, and also adorn themselves with flowers and peacock’s feathers. As parties from the different villages come near the trysting place, they may be observed finishing their toilettes in the open fields; when all is ready, the groups form, and their approach from different sides, with their banners and yak’s tails waving, horns and symbols sounding, mar- shalled into alternate ranks of lads and lasses all keeping perfect step and dress, with the gay head-dresses of the girls and the numer- ous brass ornaments of the boys glittering in the sun, forms a very lively and pleasing picture. They enter the grove where the meeting is held in jaunty dashing style, wheeling and countermarching and forming lines, circles and columns with grace and precision. The dance with these movements is called “ khurriah,”’ and they are held in all months of the year, a series of them following each other at 184 The ‘‘ Kols”’ of Chota-Nagpore. short intervals at different places all over the country, and the atten- dance, at some that I have seen, could not be under 5,000 people, all enjoying themselves. When they enter the grove, the different groups join and dance the khurriah together, forming one vast dancing procession. Then each takes its own place and plants its flag and dances round it till near sunset, when all go dancing home. ‘This is followed by a carouse in the village, after which the dance is often continued at the ‘““akrah” all night. At each of these ‘‘ Jattras,” a kind of fair is held, and fairings and | refreshments are to be had in abundance. The young men can treat their partners with sweetmeats and do so, “As already observed, there is a place in every village called “ akrah” set apart for dancing and ceremonies. This is a circular arena with a post in the centre, © and around it are benches for the spectators or for the dancers when wearied, the whole being generally shaded by fine old tamarind, the — most beautiful of village trees. . The season dances in the village open with the kurrum in July, — at the commencement of the planting season. There is a moyement | in this dance called ‘‘ hojar’’ when the girls suddenly kneel and pat the ground in time to the music, as if caressing and coaxing it to be- productive. On the day appointed for the ceremony, the boys and girls go in procession to the kurruwm tree, cut and bring back to the village some branches, which are planted in the akrah. An old man with a liberal allowance of beer is placed to watch these, whilst the young people refresh themselves. They all, old and young, then assemble in the akrah, and one of the elders harangues them, and after giving them much good advice, concludes by directing them to commence the dance. Thesongs sung on this occasion are in Hindee, and contain allusions to the flooded state of the rivers and fields. They also sing an ode to the Satyomba Rajah. The kurrum is kept by the Soodh or Hindoo population as well as by the Kols. After harvest of the earlier crop of the planted rice, in November the “mathe” is danced by the boys and girls in the village. The girls, moving in a semicircle and clasping eath others hands, dance with a very lively step and bowing motion of the body to the men . who sing and play to them. The girls have another dance at this The “ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. 185 season called “‘ angua,”’ because it is danced in front of the house instead of the akrah ; to this and to a feast held on the occasion the young men are not invited. The “ Jadoor’ dances commence on the completion of the great harvest of the rice crop, and continue till the commencement of the hot season. This is one of the most characteristic dances, from the peculiar way in which the arms are interwoven and clasped behind the back of the performers. Then comes the “ Sarhool,”’ at the close of the month of Phalgoon or early in March. The Sarhool is the flower of the Saul tree which now blossoms. The boys and girls make garlands of these flowers, weave them in their hair and decorate their houses with them. The dance on this occasion, called the ‘‘ Baihini,” is a very frisky one. The boys and girls dance to each other, clasping hands and pirouetting, so as to cause ‘ dos-d-dos’’ concussions which appear to constitute the best part of the fun. Yet the subject of the song sung at the Sarhool feast is a sad one. It is said by some, that at the seasons of their great festivals amongst themselves, breaches of chastity are of frequent occurrence ; but the mere freedom of intercourse allowed to the sexes is likely to be viewed with unmerited prejudice and misconstrued by their neig be bours of different race who place such restrictions upon it, and I believe that this may give rise to false imputations of impropriety. It is, ab The “‘ Kols” of Chota-Nagpore. 197 all events, a fact that illegitimate births are rare. Out of her own tribe, a Ho girl is hardly ever known to go astray, though from the freedom allowed to her and, for a tropical climate, the ripe age at which she is likely to be sought in marriage, she must have to pass through many temptations. The Hos are acutely sensitive under abusive language that at all reflects upon them, and may be and often are driven to commit suicide by an angry word. If a woman appears mortified by anything that has been said, it is unsafe to let her go away till she is soothed. The men are almost as sensitive as the women, and you cannot offend them more than by doubting their word. It has often seemed to me that the more a statement tells against themselves, the more certain they are to tell the exact truth about it. It frequently happens that aman is himself the first person to bring to notice that he has com- mitted a crime; he tells all about it, and deliberately gives himself up to be dealt with according to law. The Oraon is, I think, less truthful, he is more given to eiecebarntise ing, and wandering over the face of the earth in search of employment ; he soon loses all the freshness of his character. He returns after an _ absence of years, unimproved in appearance, more given to drink and self-indulgence, less genial and truthful than before, with a bag of money that is soon improvidently spent. Those who have never left _ their own country have far more pleasing manners and dispositions, than “those who return to it after years spent in other parts of India or beyond the seas. The fact is, they are not an improvable people. They are best seen in their wild state. There is no more pleasing trait amongst all these tribes than their ‘kindly affectionate manner one towards another. I never saw girls “quarreling, and never heard them abuse each other. They are the Most unspiteful of their sex, and the men never coarsely abuse and ‘seldom speak harshly of the women. This is remarkable on this side of India where you seldom pass through a bazar without hearing women ‘Screeching indecent abuse at each other across the street, whilst the menlook on. A Kol girl’s vocabulary is as free from bad language of this kind as a Bengalee’s is full of it. The young Oraons of both sexes are intensely fond of decorating their persons with beads and brass ornaments. These they entirely 198 The ‘‘ Kols”’ of Chota-Nagpore. discard on embracing Christianity, and the converts may be always recognised by the total absence of all such adornment. The converts do not join in the dances, or festivals, and must not even be seen as spectators, when they are going on. ‘They appear indeed to lose all relish for their old amusements, and shrink with horror at the idea of resuming their discarded ornaments. And as Christianity is rapidly spreading amongst them, and in all probability will continue to spread more and more rapidly every year, it is quite possible that inthe course ~ of a few generations, the most marked characteristics of the races I am describing, will have been effaced for ever. It is marvellous with what firmness old prejudices are abandoned, old customs discarded, and even tastes changed, when they become Christians ; and there is now a wide- spread feeling amongst the Kols themselves, that this change will inevitably come upon them all. : The Moondah-Oraon are a rapidly increasing people. We may form some calculation as to the rate of increase by the statistics of the Mission. In 1864, the baptised converts numbered 5,923, and in that year there were 195 births to 80 deaths. In 1865 there were 7,828 baptized Christians, and the births during the year were 309 to 86 deaths. The number of professing Christians is probably double the number registered as baptized. I subjoin in a tabular form brief vocabularies of the Moondahs and their cognates, referring to Tickell’s memoir for a full notice of the language. I annex notes on the Oraon language with which I have been kindly favoured by the Reverend Frederic Batsch. | ” a : . * \ A ~ q 4 rs 2 > . ad \ . >> Sia tured yeq nz [epsov Sov OOM vYysvy OM 84 THOOM NZ gop Byory ysvA ose} ook vsunut Qyp vysey of 84 ward NZ HEY ot Teua Jer oq plnoys J 25 Wet ST W99q SULAVTT ono OLOM TLO KX O10M 9 AA SUM OF] qsva. NOU], SUA T ere AQUI, o18 NOX O18 OA ST OF] qv Noy, We J 4soq loyeg poo) emouvyee AouNuUL veauvyes AOUNUE | epuvyes uvdeyes Appendia C. umouvyeys AoULvUL "QSo[BSUIG 218 e@esere ‘Tedon Jo seyyy uvkey syed TOG snsv uvAv] Yoq uvfvy Weurse uvAv] UOIvVUL IO uvAry] ayo uv] UIT} yemoyo uviey 1y07 ayo uvARy ssve nyo uvdey ns ynyo uvdevy nsy snyo uvdey yoq ‘QaLOULYSBY) urelesueko0A Td vsuviooA 19 S@eeeee suviooar @eeecee @eeesce e@aoeoven IsuvA00A B.SIS stsuvfo0A NY wesuvsooa 10 ‘UvIsvoney [VULSLI0g VW (‘panurjuoy )—‘spuoy, uniipy fo aQn7, aarjnundwop wieleam Yeq nz weplea nz ooTeylem Teplea fen golem vysry, ofem osey ofem vsunut olem vy.sey alem vy wuelea nz a “OoVYSU yeoq TPYS T 7v0q PIP I qvoq SUIARTT qvoq Oy, qeog qroq Aoyy, qvoq Nox qwod OAV syvoq OFF qso}Boq noYy, yweoq | "Ystpoug ks, UNIBUL oyfeut royqure vArpeum ‘emuetT surly, = Taeut oyleu royquie rout ‘au oul JO any : TU Avyqure TU I nos IByqures afoys e408 poipunyy setpoud seuurd osvyouod setpourd AVL SIq STA 9-910 Liny “YStq Ayuo MT, sep eyep oysop sep Udy, now nou 0-0u seu OuIN, = 1 7 oyye Ve VSTY ~ Ws qes oyeys es uos0g S eyo BILRs oyyo Aeyqyo xIg S yourd youed oyourd youed OAL aS teyo 1eyo Lieyo eyo INOW 0} ‘ue1y U9} TUT} ult 901 J, si uop T-00p lap OMT, ye yo oy yo oud ‘90}BIOZN) "BIJVIVY RY "yvA10K ‘goTeouog "YStpsag LL (‘panurjuog )—‘spuoy, unrp fo ajqny, earyoundumog ae yeu Sed ae nu0e} nuoe} 004 nus4 nus4 0} DAIGULOY NIBULOY oul0y Appendix C, *90}BIZN) 220 yeu ped qyey aqpouyorvsy isvyoyeAy eyoeyore sy eyousy vyovsy 0} oTORYOT BIW} ‘ayouny Oop ato Vueey sO me? eyouroy ‘oyfny oylny roe dL Ad ei i sede ‘oyo-sede Tere 0108 0yvy, rloyuvyey LOyULYyRy Avueures 1OyUey IOYUvY IByey ooyunueM oqui0cy oyUBU OY qU004 UBUL OYqWU004 IVYyquU00y IByquiooy Avyquroo04 ooyunurM eyque ooyuBUL vYquie ooyquie oyeu wy eATpe} ropeyyy ‘“Tepey prvyyy “v.rey eA1pe}y eye “rey os ‘TUTY vArpeurgsnt Jopo} ‘toprulo} BIULO}Y vATpemy “eqey 10} ‘reuL04 TUINY 74 Jopow ‘tepeure PLU 9p oLyIp toyyoyouq alloq ‘teuued gltoq ‘1148 Snueul woq qq yeut deq Appendix C. yqul nyyeur [?4 wv] qayp paqear yay BIVGEAC] pa peRte ‘oATINS ‘yoAT orynd ‘yoy ‘ayo ‘TpRyURS nyroq BYLOG snupul uryeq ney q Te ‘reut deq yal qs “yop Soy ayy +P puoy o1ep %104 opueyo oAl1008 oAtyl o-ood eid “eyo odrut vAUTy eu odiurut SoU MOY Lge vu odeq equil eyyOuL Oe ouvy ovuRp oyoouL DTS vIRy pueyo elims eAvUt ejoyyo ueqyues 1138 ‘SeuUL veut ‘eXeut ysnueul Ie4Q Lo Cold 74 ung Toyyone cy wog PIMO OTL. UBULO AA UBT, 1048 IOYIOIGE TOY OT IO Ie ensuoy, peor IIVEL IVT q00y, qMoW! oAgy > deq qpreyyy deg. | dyq neq dyq oq dyq uop Tyjosed deq insyd vdeq oudeq sedeq nudyq | ayo vdeq et GssyuL LLBTOQ « . dolueut : O13 valqny 2 Tee 13 8 Ss S o10ys BIOs a rpys viva ays & DOLL] INR] ‘O.LYLl urwez *934TUL uimez ‘Tayyid ued ued 6e ‘Tus nysiq ‘Use "907VIZNY) "BY VIVY LI a . qq NA (‘panuejuog)—‘spioy, woisp fo aqnyz, aarzosndwuog | deq vpueut y seurmdeq odeq ov0p orvy} oysundeq oysundeq indeq sot OVUl Sore By yooy Iva ey1os INysS oyywy semyyoo1d Tued UBIU | arey} rodyq oydeq rodeq TOR ut Tetrq anyny n10s eLoys IVs | yer rag ‘FyeUL el unse "g0[B.0UNg “sie S1OYIVE OMT, IOYIV] B WOLT 1OYIC} B OF, IOY}L} BIO Ustiy veO sog MOD aS10 FT osnoyyT pooMm Wye 199 AA. Saf a ES CEES ty | ee CS SS "Ystpougy nN tojoy indkeyy ‘ ouvAOY Toqoy} ‘inoy BJOY 004 ejoy Tomo4 eyoy UOURY, 0j0Y 04 ojoYy 074 oyoy UNY ayy 004 oTYD Woul0y gay yo WoULRy, Appendix C. eyyo 04 eyyo Uny ungqyo uny atyVpoq “nies n.vs | 9y}U0S nivs oieypoq nies esnueul Lies BSNURUL DIS oq SnUvUL OBS yo area! eyoRuoy ‘dal ajoy yoresy Byoy YorIwNy oyoY YorLpue Boy 07 ysvyoy 13 oyoY ou qoye yoy iy ay eek Our inl ae oT 07 qoye TyUo} 10 svye ny ss pe o[sueyo ynyeq asuvyo UINYe oy to ‘opsueyo evysyode 94 opoueyo BSNUeT P[SUBTO - RSHUBUL o[SuBYD WOp SNUBUL opouBya yo 00-0 a oooy vpoyytoy Avuvu Avs Blouy -roy Avuvut Avyqurooy ooyeyytoy Aouvur Avyquue voy} toy Avs ney} rooy Avyquro0y ay} looy Avyquue uoooy Avuvut Aes oooy Avuvur AYQurooy ooy Avuvm Avyquiv tyW000y Avs oooy Avyqui0y uoooy Avyqure BYSLIyyN opey Cor vpeyq icflate ba AVUOU OOT VTVYG OF0T FSA? OF0] BIRT Bp oprey, “vArey O}IVY, ovy UETITYO vrvy BTLYYO VIULOY OOPS Yay UOT TUT} BY TUN uy] EY Tuy waTpR vy BY OVW BIULOY rye vruy waYOR THT} eyoe TuIny Tyoe rune VUIv}}OUIRIIN BIvICUIEyIN epeqq vIOYOT BByq OLB Teua ep Useq SULALFT oq OL ed o1oa AO, o10M NOX O1OM OA SUM OFT qsvm Noy, SUM J oie AO, ol8 NOX - 018 9M ST OF] qv NOU, We T qsoqr 193}9q_ poox wat Poor) us Po0o0s OM, usm poos y — Appendix C. 224 stew TnYy OaIBUL OUL ooreul oURM TRU UNOIVUL ayyooreut 004 oyyoorent temo} | eAYYooreul WoURy eT Too1e 94 ey yooIvul 04 toyyoniem ony vrol ney} ougur semoy) unY "99}B1ZN-) UdIPUL TUL o]{BUL TUL ouy] Pytea Bleleul ¢ IeUL O[IVUL YOTOy RIVUL TYWNY OVLIBUL YorryUe OPIUM 04 SO}LIVU NY oY VLABUL LUT OR ugAo TUL “BL VIVY LI oqosireu Avyqure vpeyjoorvu Avyqure 901BUL eq LeU eIvUl eyuooiem Avuvut Avs oreta Avuvut AvTqU00Y orem Avuvu Avyquie TyUOTeM Avs ort ABYqU00y eorvur AVY que @eenee uoqdvy Avyqure » "eA10() soe oqireuL Ture TyovATeUL Ture eTIVUL OPE UL IvUL UsIVUL VIE} OLVU BITLOY LIVUL BIULe UW9IBUL TUT} ole TUN LIBUL THY ureyrey] Ture oqrey Tur “90[BOUOg (‘panuyuog )—‘spsoy, unwp fo a19qn7, aarqounduog quod [Leys T ywoq PIP J Uoqywoq SUIAR FT 78289 OL, qvag qvaq oy, qvoq NOX. qwoq OA4 syvoq OFT ysoyvoq NOU, yeO0 SCE PEO UAL ode ea a "YSIS Appendix D. 225 APPENDIX D. Kashmiree Vocabulary and Grammatical Forms. In consequence of recent discussions in the Society, Mr. L. Bowring, Commissioner of Mysore, was kind enough to let me know that he had many years ago compiled and sent to the Society a Kashmiree Voca- bulary. The result has been the discovery of a paper as valuable as the hereditary reputation of the author would lead us to expect, which the Society now loses no time in publishing, and which it has been thought well to put in this,place in connection with our Ethnologi¢al in- quiries. Mr. Bowring’s paper gives us a far fuller and better knowledge of the Kashmiree language than anything that we have yet had. The Vocabularies are very full, exact, and well arranged, and the grammati- cal forms of the verb especially are very fully set forth. It is only neces- sary (treating the matter ethnologically) to observe that since Persian has been for several hundred years the language of Government, religion and literature in Kashmir, and there has also been a long connection with Hindustan and the Punjab, a vast number of Persian words and phrases, and some Hindustanee and Punjabee expressions have necessarily incorporated themselves in the modern Kashmiree, especially as spoken by the better classes. In fact, that wonderful language Persian infuses itself wherever it comes in contact, and it abounds in Kashmiree just as in the upper class Hindustanee and in fact in Turkish also. Hence a faithful specimen of the Kashmiree of the ‘present day will be found to contain many foreign words. But they are easily distinguishable, still wearing their foreign dress and little adapted to the native forms; and for the most part such words need | not be confounded with original native words in such a way as to mislead us regarding the radical affinities of the language. I have taken the liberty of omitting from Mr. Bowring’s vocabularies a few evidently Persian words of a literary, and for the most part com- | pound character, as I thought that these would not serve our present purpose. Some remain as now part of the ordinary vulgar tongue, but looking both to the vocables and to the grammar, I think it will | be found that Kashmiree is certainly allied to the Indian languages | rather than to the Persian. 226 Appendix D. | Mr. Bowring has, perhaps, in the examples which he has given, put the declension of the noun rather too simply. He has used the unin- flected Indian‘form ‘ Manush’ for man and the Persian word ‘ Zananah’ — for woman. He shows, however, that most Kashmiree nouns are in- flected to form the plural, and I think it will be found that almost all real Kashmiree nouns are inflected for cases also. Both my own observations and those of Messrs. Edgeworth and Leech, as well as Mr. Bowring’s dialogues give the proper Kashmiree form for man ‘Mohnyn,’ plural ‘ Mohnivi.’ And the following which I take from Leech is, I believe, the true declension of the Kashmiree noun ‘ Nichu,’ a son. A son, nichu Sons, nichivi. Of a son, nichivi-sand Of sons, nichiven-sand. To a son, nichivis To sons, nichiven. From a son, nichinishi From sons, nichiven-nishi. With respect to the variations of the genitive case, Mr. Edgeworth seems to differ from Mr. Bowring, saying that the genitive affix is, like Hindustanee, governed in point of gender by the noun which fol- lows rather than by that which precedes it. So far as I could make out from cursory inquiry on the spot, it seemed to me that in fact the form of this affix is affected by both the preceding and the following nouns. Indeed it seems to have the most extraordinary chameleon- like variety of shapes, according to the positions in which the words are placed, and the only conclusion of my inquiries was, that the rules of Kashmiree declension are so complicated, that nothing but careful and scientific study will reduce them to shape. , It may be added that feminines are formed from masculines by inflections, as— Masculine. Feminine. Gur, horse. | guir, mare. Kokur, cock, kokair, hen. Tsawal, he goat, tsavij, she goat. Batak, drake, batich, duck. Kay, male crow, | kavin, female crow. The language is evidently altogether subject to very many ee t- inflections, and abounds in affixes and postpositions. c G. CAMPBELL, Appendix D. 227 Voctbulary of the Kashmiri Language.—By L. Bowrine, ae b5 Commissioner of Mysore. The following vocabulary was prepared in Kashmiri in 1851, after comparison with another copy in Urdu. It may -be observed of the Kashmiri that the pronunciation of the letter 6 is very broad, resembling the aw in aw/ul, as for instance ‘ mdl,’ father, read ‘mawl.’ The language also affects the compound letter ts in lieu of ‘ch,’ as ‘tsor,’ four. The formation of the plurals of substantives is irregular, but they generally take the affixes ‘cha’ and ‘chi.’ The genitive of substan- tives takes its gender from the noun preceding, not from that fol- lowing as in Urdd. . The particle us is not used with verbs. The great number of Sans- krit words existing in Kashmiri is evident, but there are many words peculiar to the language. The character is generally written with Persian letters, but a form of Nagri is also in use. | : Substantives, Air akash Boat nau, shikari ” Apple tstint Brick sir | Ass khar Book pith Arm nar Buffalo moesh Army fauj | Bread tsuit Age bujar Breast vachh Assistance yari Badness yach Answer uttar Beard dor Arrow tir Bone adij Abuse lék | Bill tont Bird pak Breath shah Brother boi Brass sartal Boy lokat Business kom : Branch a Tang Basket phut, dak Barley lishak Bush | kradzél Butter thain Blood rath Blackberry bar Bag thil Birth parsun Bow kaéman Bridge kadul Blow chék 228 Butterfly Burglary Bee Child Cucumber Cherry Clothes City Copper Cow Cat Camel Chin Coat . Ceiling Cotton Cheese Claim Corner Colour Chesnut Cedar Carrot Cloud Crossbeam Chair Corpse Chalk Candle Day Dew Daughter Death Dog Deer Duck Dirt didar san tilar balak lor glas kapar shahr tram gad barur unth hongain faran talaii kapas chaman dawa kon rang bin deodar gajar abar thathar | sandal mur slap soyet duh shabnam kar maran hin loh, rus battuk mal Appendia D. Deceit Darkness Dream Danger Drop Dram Dance Earth Klephant Egg Kye Kar Eyebrow Evil Edge East Elbow Enemy Exertion Fire Father Father-in-law Fruit Flower Flour Fowl ~ Fox Fish Frog Food Field Foot Forehead Fear Flesh Firebasket Foreigner bram gath supan khatar phitr henur nagmah zamin hasth thol tchh kan bumah yach buth pur khon shitar talash [gul tungul, nértun-— mol, bab zamtur mewah posh ét kukkur patslo gad nihimondij bat Khyeti khor dek bayi shun kangar bishahri Fraud Face Feather Fever Fireplace Friend Family Ferry Finger Fisher Fist Funeral-pile Flea Fly God Girl Grass Gram Garlic Gold Goat Goose Grain Garden Goodness Greatness Grape Groom Game Girth Husband Hail ~ House Horse Head Hair Heart Appendix D, dagha bit par tap bukhari mitar shirbots ghat anguj gadhanj musht chenta pish mach dé lokat kur gas chhola ruhan son tsdwij, tsAwul ans anaj biagh jan bajar dach Sais gindun tang ran dot garh, lur gur kalah wal yandah Hand Height Heap Hunger Health Hedge Hoof Honey Horn Hour Hemp Ice Insect Tron Indian corn Interest Interference Ink Juice Jest Jackal Knife Leaf Leg Lip Length Lie Life Light Letter Linseed Lime Liver Lock . Load Log Lizard 229 ath thazar dér, anbar buchi balan var padur mach hiang gar bang yak kim shistar makhai sidh khalal, toth mil ras thatha shal srak barak lang uth zechar apuz umar gash achar, harf alish chunah jigar kuluf bar hat - hadzing 230 Moon Mountain Mist Month Morning Midday Man Mother Mushroom Marriage Mosque Money Mule Mouth Moustache Measure Medicine Milk Molasses Manure Minute Market Mat Mine Monkey Mortgage © Mustard Mint Musquito Meteorite — Mouse Name Night Nephew Niece Nose Nail Appendix D. zn koh, parvat vunar riat subah, prabat dopahar manush, mohnu m6] hedar khandar mashid nakd katir és génch minun dawa dédh gor pah laza, pal koth vagu kan vandur band asur podin mah trath . anmur nav rat bapitar bapitar beni nast nam Neck Needle Nest Noise Number Nettle Net North Onion Oil Oar Oath Pumpkin Pear Partridge Pearl People Platter Pain Price Pair Poplar Piece Peg Pepper Pace Paper Pen” Pillar Pillow Pit se | Plough | Pole Power Pocketpicking Question River gardan stizan él shor, kraknad ganzrun swai zal vutar paran til kar, chapa dri alah tank tsar mukt lok thal dod mol jora farast tukra mekh marach pur kaghaz kalam tham vatrun -khad alah chob kowwat thappul prachun darya vi Rain Rains Rice Raspberry Road Rat Rump Roof Relation Rope Red pepper Rind Rate Rein Remedy Ring Rose Rust Sea Sun Star Snow Son Sister Son-in-law Spring - Summer Stem Salt Strawberry Street Stone Silver Sheep Snake Shoulder Stomach Appendix D. rad barsat tumal chanchh vat gagar mandul bain rishta raz martsuwangan diyal mol lakam i14j vO] gulab khai samandar’ aftab, saria tarak shin nichii bei heur behar rathkél mil nin kandachh dur, kocha kain chand gobh sarp phiuk yad Smallness Strength Shadow Shoe Sleep Skin Sound Seed Sugar Stick South Shop Sugarcane Staircase Saddle Sorrow Sack Stool Spider Species Sand Saw Scale Screw Sheath Sheet Shield Side Silk Sleeve Smoke Soap Spot Sting Scorpion Steel Straw 231 shikaslad zOYr sdyah paizar nindar cham awaz beul shakar lar duchan van waishakar hér zin azab gun rayat, garusth zallur kism slak lotar trak, hayuk pech kum chadar sipar tarf pot nar duh sabun dagh toph bich folad gas 232 Sweat Storm Spoon Thunder Tree Temple Teeth Tongue Thigh Truth Time Throat Turban Thirst Tank Tea Tail Trade Toe Tomato Turnip Thread Tent - Table Taste Thorn Theft Trust Uncle Umbrella Udder Urine Use gumah vai choncha gagrai kul mandir dand jiau ran puz vakt, vél hut dastar tresh talau chahi dumah saudagari khorij anguj ruvangan goga] pan khema mez maza, swad kanth tsur itimad, pats | pitar, chacha tabdan than mutr kam Appendix D. Venom Velvet Vein Vice Village Water Wind Woman Wife Winter Wheat Wood Wrist Width Well Weight West Washerman Watermelon Wall Worm Whore Weed Wager Wax Wheel Widow Wing Wire Wool Yard Year zahar makhmal rag pap gam ab, pot hawa zenanah kolai vand kanak zun mats khajar chah, krar tolin pachum dub handwand dos amkhitim hafiz gas dau mom hagur mond par tar won gaj varih Appendix D. Declensions, . N. Aman < G. Of aman = Acc. A man 2 tLAb. From a man N. Men 8 |G. Of men re Acc, Men Ab. From men A woman Of a woman . A woman From a woman N. Women 8 G. Of women = Acc. Women Singular bee fe) ‘Kul ‘Barak Gam Gas Tanwar Active Blunt Boiling Broken From women 233 manush manush-sund manush-is manush-nishin manash manash-sund manash-is manash-nishin zenani zenani-hund zenani zenani-nishin zenanah zenanah-hund zenanah zenanah-nishin Examples of Plurals. a sister Benicha sisters a brother Bai brothers a father Mail fathers a mother Maji mothers a son Nichii sons a tree Kuil trees a leaf Barakchi leaves a village Gamchi villages a grass Gascha grasses an animal Janwarchi animals Adjectives, takra Blind un mund Blue nitil tut, bahar Black karhin Bitter tsok, chok phutmut 234 Appendix D, Bad yach Hard dur Cheap sug Hungry | - buch Clever gatul Heavy gubh Clear sdf Hot garm, ushan Coarse viut Tl, bad yach Crooked hul Low past, tsut Cold turun Long dsiit, khul Certain pats Little kam Deep sun Less kehna Dear drug Last brunthun Dark anigut Lame lung Deaf zur Leprous hitrilad Dumb kul Lazy sust Dead mudmud Light lut Double zuh Loose diyul Dry huk Left hul Dirty malburut Lower tal Drunk mut Many sitah Easy asan Mad dewana Empty khali Middle sum Expert fazil New né First pathiim Naked nathnun Former bronth Old pur6én, budh Fat viut Proud kibar False apuz Putrid dudriyomut Frightened khochtin Poor gharib Fine zayul Quick tikan Full barit Ready tayyar Fond téth Right sind Good jan Ripe papiimiud Great béd Raw khém Glad khish Small lik Greedy ldlachi Sweet miut Green sabz Stupid nddan Generous datah Straight siud General 4m Square chankunjal High thud Sharp tej Appendia D. Slippery pishul Thirsty treshut Thin lissa Tight tang Ugly yach Upper piath N. A good man G. Of a good man . A good man Ab. From a good man N. Good men G. Of good men . Good men Ab. From good men Declension. 225 Weak liyad Well jan White safid Wet tar, udar Young jawan jan manush jan manush-sund p ; Singular. jan manush-is jan manush-nishin janchi manash ) janchi manash-sund Plural. janchi manash-is janchi manash-nishin Comparison. Good Jan Better Yuts jan Best. Sitah jan Verbs, To awake votun To Burn zalun », Avoid bachun ,, Blow phok diun », Ascend khasun ,», Bury garhun ,», Advance bron khasun », Buy mitl hidin » Ask prutsun ,, Come iyun & Be sompanun 2 Cat! * tsatun », Be able hekkun ,», Call nadun ,, Bring anun ,, Conquer jitun ,, Begin — lagun ,, Choose tsdérun », Bite tsétun 5, Cover vatun ,», Believe patskarun ,, Chew cud dr4mun karun Beil pakinwun , Drink chiun » Beg mangun 3» Die marun 236 To Dwell ,, Do ,», Decrease Draw ,y Drive Drown Expel Krase Knuter End Find Fight » ly Fall Fasten Forget Frighten 1) Go rive Gamble rP] Hear Increase » Join Kill ,, Know Kick Lose ° Live ,, Leave ,, Laugh 5, Learn », Hide Lift » Leap 5) Lule Meet Melt Appendix D. basun karun kamgachun lamun patrozun phatun kadit tsumun kadun andar atsun makolawun labhun ladun uphin parun lagun mashun kotsunawun gasun diun zaras gindun bozun badun melanawun marun janun lat diun haérun zindasun chhorun asun hichun khaditrozun tolun khanun apuz vanun melun galun To Move Open Play Put on Put off Pain Place Pass Plague Pour Push Read Roast Run away Reap Reckon Recollect Return Repel Retire Ride Rise Row Rouse Run Rub Stick - Swim Swell Sweep Suckle Sing Spit Sell Sit Show Send alarawun mussurun gindun gandun, chhawun ~ mutsurun, walun dod karun thawun guzarawun dek karun dalun dhakdiun parhun buzun tsalun fasl tsatun gansrun yad karun phir diun nibar kadun pat nerun khasun vathun vayun uzanawun daaiwun mathun lagun tsatwayun hunun dun chawun gewun taktrawun kunun bihun hawidun sozun, ludun Appendia D. 237 We have been Ye have been They have been I had been Thou hadst been He had been We had been Ye had been They had been as ous osmutun To Strain chhaénun To Take hiun », seek tsadun »» Laste tsuhun ») Sow vawun ,, Teach hichunawun », Strike marun » Lhrow trevitsunun », Stand istadrozun ,, Louch lagun »» Seize ratun 5, Vomit ’ khai karun 5 Shut bandh karun 5, Weave vonun 5 Say vanun 5, Weigh tolun »» See uchhun 5) Wait prarun », Smell mushakhiun Wish yatsun », Sleep shongun 5» Wash chhalun », Speak vanun CoNnsUGATIONS. Sompanun, to be. Present. Imperfect. Iam buh chus I was buh dsus Thou art tsuh chukuh Thou wast tsuh é6sukuh He is suh chuh or ché | He was suh 6us We are as chih We were as 6uis Ye are tahi chiwuh Ye were tahi 6suwuh They are tim chih They were tim duis Perfect. I have been buh ésus osmutun Thou hast been tsuh ésukuh osmutun He has been suh 6s osmutun tahi é6suwuh osmutun tim 6us osmutun Pluperfect. buh é6sus sompunwatun tsuh ésukuh sompunwatun suh 6vis sompunwatun as ous sompunwatun tahi 6ésuwuh sompunwatun tim ous sompunwatun 238 Appendia D. Future. T shall be buh heksompanit Thou shalt be tsuh hekaksompanit He shall be suh hekisompanit We shall be as hekéisompanit Ye shall be tahi hekitisompanit They shall be tim hekavisompanit To be sompanun Being sompanit Been sompun Vanun, to speak. Present. I speak or am speaking Thou speakest He speaks We speak Ye speak They speak I spoke . Thou spakest He spoke We spoke Ye spoke They spoke I have spoken Thou hast spoken He has spoken We have spoken Ye have spoken They have spoken buh chus vanan © tsuh chukuh vanan suh chuh vanan as chih vanau tahi chiwuh vanau tim chih vanau Imperfects, Perfect. mi vun tsuh vanut suh vun as vanwutun tahi vanwutun timati vanwutun mi chum vanwutun tsuh chuh vanwutun tim cha vanwutun as cha vanwutun tahi chuh vanwutun timati chuh vanwutun I had spoken Thou hadst spoken He had spoken We had spoken Ye had spoken They had spoken I shall speak Thou shalt speak He shall speak We shall speak Ye shall speak They shall speak I may speak Thou mayest speak He may speak We may speak Ye may speak They may speak Appendix D. 239 Pluperfect. Future. mi 6s vanwutun tsuh 6si vanwutun tim 6s vanwutun as Osus vanwutun tahi 6si vanwutun timéa 6s vanwutun buh hek vanit tsuh hekak vanit suh heki vanit as hekati vanit tahi hekiti vanit tim hekati vanit Potential. Speak Speaking Spoken buh vanah tsuh vanak suh vani as vanau tahi vanid tim vanat van vanan vanwutun CoNJUGATION OF THE Passtve VoICcE OF MARUN TO STRIKE. I am struck Thou art struck © He is struck We are struck Ye are struck They are struck Present. buh gasa marah tsuh gasak marah suh gasa marah as chih marah gasan tahi chuh marah gasin tim chih marah gasan 240. Appendia D. Imperfect. I was struck Thou wast struck He was struck We were struck Ye were struck They were struck T shall be struck Thou shalt be struck He shall be struck We shall be struck Ye shall be struck They shall be struck buh gés mérah tsuh g6k mérah suh gai marah as gayé marah tahi gai marah tim gayé marah Future. buh gatsa marah tsuh gatsak marah suh gatsa marah as gatsaui marah tahi gatsiii marah tim gatsad marah PRonovuns. Personal. Possesswve. I buh | Mine mitin Thou tsuh Thine chhén He, she suh His tasun We asi, ml Our mi(n Ye tahi Your chhén They tim, timat Their tasun Relative and Interjective. Indicative. Who? kus? This ih Which ? kya That uh, suh Whoever yus These yum Whatever yih Those tium He who yus Miscellaneous. Self pané Another duyum Such yithui | Any kanh All sari Every yusaka Same sarti Own panun Other bék Appendia D. Declension of Pronouns. N. I buh N. We G. Of me mitin GG; Of as Acc. Me mi Acc. Us Ab. From me mi nishin Ab. From us N. Thou tsuh N. You G. Ofthee chhon G. Of you Acc. Thee © tsih Acc. You Ab. From thee tsih nishin Ab. From you N. He suh Ny.) They G. Ofhim tasun G. Of them Acc. Him humis Ace. Them Ab. Tohim humis nishin Ab. To them N. This Th N. These G. Of this yimsun G. Of these Acc. This yimis Ace. These Ab. From this yimis nishin Ab. From these a uh, suh N. Those G. Ofthat yusun G. Of those Acc. That humis Acc. Those Ab. From that humis nishin Above Always Almost Also As Already Alone “Altogether Ab. From those Myself buh pané Of myself buh panas &e. Adverbs. plat Below dohai Backwards jaljal Except biyih Exactly yiut Enough . Wain Far kunui From sari.san Forwards — 241 mi as in singular ) tsih as in singular y ) tim i in singular J yum yuhund yiman yiman nishin tium tinhund timan timan nishin tal pat siwai thik thayu dur piath, nishin brunt 242 How How much ; How many Hither Tnside Immediately Near Now Nothing No Outside Perhaps Quickly So Slowly Suddenly According After Among Before Besides For sake of And Although But Because Alas! Ho! kiut kota yur andar jhatpat nakh vuin kechni nah nebar dewuh. jalpahan ithui lut yekayek ithui pat mauz brint varat bapat ta hargah lekin yudvane aists ! hata ! Appendix D, Still Then Thus There Thither Therefore Together Very When Where ? Prepositions. In On Towards With Without Saas Conjunctions. PES Hither Or I nterjections. Lo! What ! tamat til ithui tati hér imbapat san sitah yil kati kyazi én, 40 kitpéthin yithipothin tithipéthin andar piat tarf satin slwa es Appendia D. Cardinal Numbers. One ak Seventeen saddah Two dzuh Highteen athdah Three tré Nineteen kunuwth Four tsdr, chor Twenty wth Five pans Twenty-one* ekwith Six shah Thirty truh Seven sat Forty chatji Hight ath Fifty pansa Nine nat Sixty shet Ten dah Seventy satat Kleven kéh Kighty shit Twelve bah Ninety namat Thirteen trowah Hundred hat Fourteen chaudah Two hundred zahat Fifteen pandah Thousand dahshat, sas Sixteen shurah Lakh lach #22 dzitéwth. 49 unwanzah. 23 trawth 51 ekwanzah 24 chétiwth 52 dowanzah 25 pantsuh 53 trewanzah 26 shawwth 54 chauwanzah 27 satowth 55 panswauzah. 28 athowth 56 shahwanzah 29 untruh 57 satwanzah 31 ektruh 58 athwanzah 32 daitruh 59 unhath — 33 tehtruh 61 ekhath 34 chaitruh 62 dohath 35 panstruh 69 kunsatat 36 shahtruh ra! eksatat 37 sattruh 72, dosatat 38 athtruh - 79 kunshit 39 kuntazi 81 ekshit Al ektazi 89 kunénamat 42 ‘) 91 eknamat 43 99 namaéanamat 4A, 45 pas above 46 47 48 5 244 Appendia D. Ordinal Numbers. First godniuk 21st ekwthiim Second | duyum 22nd dzitowuhium Third -treyum 23rd trawuhium Fourth | tsurum 24th chétiwuhium Fifth -panchum 25th &e. &e. Sixth shayum Seventh satum Highth athtum Ninth hawum Tenth dahiam Eleventh kahiim Sentences, What is your name ? What is the name of this village? How far is it to Kashmir ? How many houses are there in this village ? Who is the head man ? What is the time ? Three o-clock. Bring that. Take away this. What crops ate grown here ? Are the pears ripe or unripe ? Go away. Come here. Come quickly. What does this man want ? Ask him. I cannot say: IT shall go to-morrow. It rained yesterday. It is very hot. tank chéd paminmud ki na khém buh chus sasna vanit hekan. chhén nai kya chth ? yit gamas kya chth nau ? Kashmir témut kéta chth dir? — yit gamas kuts garh chuh ? mokaddam kus chuh ? k6ta chuh dth? sihpahar chuh. uh anun. ih niun. 5 yithi kya fasl chuh sompanin? chuh ? gats. vol yur. jald volah. ih monhyti kya chuh mangan. humis pricht. buh gats phaga. rat volun rud, sitah garm chuh. Appendia D. The road is good. The road is bad. One must ascend that hill. What is the price of this ? It is dear. It is cheap. You ask too much. Are there any manufactures here ? Is cloth woven? What pay do you get? Is the Kardar a good man? I wish to find out. Ts he able to carry that load ? My horse is lame. Can you shoe him? What rent do you pay for this shop ? Six rupees a year. He began to get tired. They began to fight together. Can you read and write? A little. How do you know? In what way will you repair this? In what month is saffron gathered ? In Kartik. What colour is best ? If he takes it what will you do? Has he gone before, or is he follow- ing ? Why are you making such a noise ? Put on this dress and put off that. I went with him. He walks without shoes. When he comes tell me. Is it near or far? 245 vat chuh (or chavuh) jan. do. yit kohas piat bania khasun. yit kya chuh kimat ? drug chuh. vat yach. sug chuh. tsuh chukuh sitéh mangan. yithi bania ki tyér karun ? kapar bania vanun ? tsuh kya chuh talab inelan? Kardar ché jan monhyu ? buh chus yatsin zi madlim kar. hekya uh bor tulit ? miun gur lung chuh. tsuh hekak yimis guris nal lagit ? yit vanas kot chukuh diwan kiraya tsuh ? shah ruipi varihas. suh lug thakne. tim lég panawin harhar karani. tsuh hekak likhit, parhit ? kam kam. tsuh kitpéthin zanak ? tsuh kitpothin karan ih durust kat retas andar chih kongposhk [tsatan ? kya rang chuh sarikot jan? hargah ih heki timsritit, tsuh kya karakadah ? suh chuh brint gomut, kin-pat Kartikas andar. chuh awan ? tahi kya zichuryut krakanad karan? ih kaparu mutsar, uh tsun nil. buh chus gomut humis satin. suh chuh paizar siwai pakan. yili suh yi tili gasi mi khabar. nazdik ché, kinh dar chuh ? 246 You always delay. We are almost ready. I am hungry and thirsty. Don’t eat raw apples. I have ate enough. Where is my servant ? Is he here or there? It is still raining. Shall you sleep inside or outside ? This dog is exactly like mine. IT have already heard that story. There is a bridge opposite. Do as I say. Write accordingly as I do. Are you alone ? He fell from his horse. Throw down that blanket. Come up here. How far is it from here? It is five kos. My brother and I went home. Hither you or he will be punished. Why should I be punished ? Because you are a thief. Unless you have witnesses you will be imprisoned. This horse is better than that. What do you call that basket ? Don’t be frightened. He ought to have done so. Can you swim ? Listen! show me the road. You must do it. Taste this peach. I cannot find my coat. Look behind that wall, tsuh gatsi zarur karun. ih tsunun gatsi tsuhun. Appendia Dy tsuh chuktth déhi tsér karan. as chih thikan thikén tyar. buh chus phaké bi treshut. khém tsunt ma khit. thai, khiat. miun naukar kati chuh ? yithi ché, kinh tathi chuh ? vunyas tanyat chuh vélan. andar shongak kinh nibar ? yih hin chuh menis hinis hit. mi biz suh kissa brint. brohun kani chuh kadul. yithipsthim buh dapan chus, tithi — pothin karit. menis lekhinas hit likhii. tsuh chukuh kunezun ? suh piau guri piat visit. uh kamal sun bonkun trevit. yur khas hitr. ithi piat k6ta chuh dur? pans kréh chuh. ak buh bi min boi gaye garh. | y4 tsuh nat humis meliwuh sazé. mi ky4 zi dit saza. i awé bapat zi tsuh chukuh tsur. | hargah tsuh gawa ashinah, ta kaid fe sompanak. Bs a ih gur chuh humsin kotjan. hut fiatis kya chuh vanan ? kots muh. timis guts ih karun. tsuh hekak tsant vayut ? hata? mi hat vat. mitin kurtah chuh nah melan. hut dewaras pat kani uchhu. Appendix D. He lost Rs 50 in gambling. I won Rs. 100,, .: A snake bit him in the leg. She laughed much. We seized 10 thieves. They all escaped. . They shall leave this country. I will punish them. Can you lend me a rupee ? _ What do you teach these children ? Let him come, why do you stop him ? I beat him soundly. His house has been burnt. He will be buried to-morrow. Choose one of these apples. Cover that pan. Send me some fruit. He answered me falsely. Hang up these clothes. What are you doing? I am cutting corn. Are these cows chewing the cud? Go and see. Feed them with grass. Give them water to drink. Has the room been swept ? Can this be washed ? I have two horses. He had three wives. I shall. have plenty. I rode 10 kos without stopping. ‘What is to be done? They are drunk. We are poor. This room is 12 ft, long, 10 it. wide, 247 hum hari zaras andar pantsah ripi. » hat ” humis ditsnas sarpan langas tiop. humi us sitah. asi rit dah tstr. miziin _,, timan tsail sarf. tim tsalan yihu mulk. buh dimak adh timan saza. [dit ? tsuh hekak asi ripiyahak wozum im shitr kya chiwak hichanéwan? yiu ih kya zi chuwan ratan ? mi dint humis sitah mar. humis lug garhas nar, phaga ihi daffan karanah. [tanah. yimati tsuntai andar tsuhunak tsun- hut degchas piat thavin sarposh. asi mishin ladiu kinh mewah. tim vunasi mishin apuz jawab. ih kapar tsinun awezan. tsuh kya chukuh karan ? buh chus kanak tsatan. ih gai chuh drémun karan ? gatsit vuch. yim khiawik gas. yim chividk tresh. at kothis duwah kinh nah? ih yiya chhalanah ? mi chuh dzuh gur. timas dsah tre koleyih. mi nishin 4si ih sitah. buh gés dahan krohun guris kia lakim varai. kya gatsi karun? suh chuh mut. as chih kangal. ih koth bah pawah dsut, dah pawah 248 - and 9 ft. high. He was very lazy. Give me rather less than one seer. Weigh this ghee. How much honey for a rupee ? Change this rupee into pice. Is there any batta taken? Give that blind man, that lame man and that leper each an anna. Tare care how you carry that. =~ I shall be very glad. All the people came to see. Is this the same horse or another ? Every man was killed. ‘His father and mine are cousins. His uncle is rich. Her mother is poor. Your horse is lame. My servant is ill. Put this and that together. This is my own watch. Why was I beaten ? Shall I be beaten ? Why should I give you anything ? You should go quickly. There are rocks above and below. This language is rather difficult. With practice it will become easy Never mind, speak every day. Shall I go with or without my horse ? Why do you follow me? I want alms. Perhaps it will rain. I was wet through. Appendix D. -tsuh kya zi chukuh mi patpat wan: . khishadah, bi chuh nai pawah thid. suh 6s sitah sust. mi gatsi ak sir akich kih kom diun. ih ghiai rupia kéta chuh mach ? yit rupia aniu tiunk. vi tuliun. kinh chuh hewén ripia vat ? humis anis ta humis langis ta — humis hitriladas, akak ana dit. uh chiz gatsi khabardari san niun. buh gatsa sitah khush. sari lok aye uchhini. ih chuh suhi gur kinh bék chuh? pratakah gat marah. humsnnd mél bi miun mél chih panaion bdi bdi. humsund pitar chuh datlatmand. — humsanz m6j chuh kangal. chhén gur chuh lung. mitin monhyti chuh bemar. ak ih bi ih gachi vatun. ih chuh mi panin gar. buh ky4 zi gos marah ? buh gatsa marah ? buh kya. zi dimai tsuh kih ? chhon gatsi jald gatsun. koh chuh piat ti ta tal ti. ih zaban chuh kentsa mushkil. adat satin gatsi asan. ki parwar chunah duhi van. buh gatsah garheth knih nah ? buh chus bechan. ~ dewah valik. buh 6s sitah baranah. Appendix D. Dry my clothes in the sun. He and his brother were drowned in the river. The maharaja is very kind to arti- sans, They are never fined. He sent me a good ‘ ziafat.’ I laughed and she wept. This shawl is not worth Rs. 400. This is not the first time. The Government takes half the produce. I and you and he will go together. You will never come back. The people here are very dirty and poor. [ Kashmir ? How many boats are there in About two thousand. Do they pay any tax? If he ever do so, beat him. If you can jump over this ditch. I cannot jump over it. Can you shoot birds flying ? Is there any game in these hills? Yes, a great deal. Of what kind? There are bears and deer. How do you know? I am a sportsman. What do the bears eat ? Indian corn, walnuts and fruit. Are there any white bears? Not here, but there are beyond. In what district? , 249 mitn kapar hoknawt tapas. [ phiat. suh bi tasun bdéi daryavas andar Maharaja chuh karigaran piat sitah miharbani karan. amis chun zehti chit ivan hinah. tim laz asi zabar zidfat. mi us ta tim wud. ih doshélah ih chuh nah godinitk dé. [hund. chuh nah tsorhatun sirkar chuh nisf paidaish hewan. ak buh bi tsuh bi suh gatsénikwatén. tsuh guk nah biyi za yor. yithik 16k chih sitéh mail talryi chih kangal. Kashmiras andar kotsa nai chih? atsat chih désas. kinh chih mahstl diwaén ? hargéh suh biyi ithui kare, adh marun. [wot tarit. hargah tsuh hekak yit khandakas buh hek nah tarit. [tan ? tsuh hekak wuphun janéwar marl- yit kohas cho kinh shikar ? ad, sitah. kya kya chuh? hapat ché kinh rds chuh. ~ tsuh kitpothin zanak ? buh chus shikari. hapat kya chih khiawan ? makhai chih khiawan, dun chih khiawén, kinh mewah chih khiawan. kanu chah safid hépat ? ithi chuh nah, amma wehin chuh kut pergannahs andar ? 250 Appendia D. On this or on that side of the hill? kohas ihpar kinh chuh kinh apar | kinh chuh ? Beyond it. aparé. What kind of fish are there in the darydvas andar kami reng chih gad? river ? A great many kinds. sitahi reng chih. Do people catch them or not? low chih gad ratan kinh nah ? Attend to what I am saying. ih kinh tsuh buh vananchus, tat piat thai dhian. If you do not, you will repent it. hargah nah karak, adh pashtawak. © If you do not go, I will beat you. hargah nah gasak, adh marut. Had you done as I told you, this yithi pothin mi dah piumad, hargah | misfortune would not have hap- tithi pdihin karihiu, adh ih pened. hauwinan kanthi balai. If I were rich, I would repair this hargah buh daulatmand dsah, adh house. karahah yit kothas marammat. If he had gone there, he would hargah suh 6r gatsaheh adh bila- undoubtedly have been killed. shak gatse suh marah, | Appendia EH. 251- APPENDIX E. eee Language of Dravidian Aborigines. Notes on the Oraon Language.-— By the Rev, F. Batson. Nouns. The language is very defective in nouns. It is evident that the Oraons have lost much of their own language, and that they have made up their losses from the languages of the people amongst whom they have dwelt, chiefly Sanskrit and Hindustani. They have no original religious terms, no abstract ideas, no words for actions of the mind or thoughts. GENDER. In Oraon there are two genders, the masculine and the feminine, but there are very few nouns of the latter. Whether the noun is a masculine ‘or feminine is only to be found in the termination of the verb. Inthe declension, the gender is not or only very seldom expressed. DECLENSION. There are all the usages of the Hindi language to be found in the Oraon. The oblique cases are also formed by postpositions. Note. Pronunciation of the Roman characters as used in writing the Oraon words. & like a in father e like e in peg aa as hs ~rald OF was. --O.s 53° 80 We.) ky. POLES cite Mi: 1 meet: 3 (=) (=) a 4) a 9. roman an’ 5 “ow”... owl ey Tne eae ch +3. eh >,, churek OS as a eae 3 ch as in German doch, loch 252 | Appendix E.. SINGULAR. Nom. kukos, the boy. Gen. kukosgahi, of the boy. Dat. kukosge, for to the boy. Ace. kukosin, the boy. Abl. kukosgusti, from the boy. Instr. (?) kukusanti, from or by the boy. Loe. kukosnu, on, in, upon the boy. Agent. kukosim (?) Voc. ana ko, oh boy. PLURAL. Nom. kukor. Gen. kukorgahi. Dat. kukorge. Acc. kukorin. Abl. kukurgusti. Instr. kukoranti. Loe. kukornu. Voc. ana koe. SINGULAR. Nom. kukoi, the girl. Gen. kukoigahi. Dat. kukoige. Ace. kukoidin. Abl. kukoigusti. Instr. kukointi. Loc. kuknu. Agent. kukoidim. Voce. an koi. PLURAL. Nom. kukoier. Gen. kukoiergahi, ete. SINGULAR. Nom. chad, the boy. Gen. chadasgahi. Dat. chadge. Ace. chadin, or chadasin. Appendix E. Abl. chadgusti. Instr. chadanti. Loc. chadnu. Agont. chadasim. Loe. ana chad. PLURAL. Nom chadar. Gen chadargahi. etc. bo Ot Oc) The plural is mostly expressed in the termination of the verb, the noun remaining unaltered in the singular and plural. Masculine. tangdas gon kukos boy belas king meiut husband mercha firmament chechal earth binko star biri sun chando moon pairi morning ulla day macha night ucha darkness al man meth male mukka female kuku head kes, chuti hair chan eye kapre forehead moy nose boi mouth gale cheek Nouns. Feminine. tangri kukoi belri mukka Nouns. chebda tatcha cheka chochal pall chesar chocha kul umbalcho daughter girl queen woman ear tongue hand bone tooth shoulder back belly liver heart lungs blood foot leg finger nail heel knee arm 254 Appendia E. thapri palm of hand bercha cat gunri cow lakra tiger ado ox harha wolf era goat tsigalo jackal patha lamb cher fowl - allah dog cokro cock ‘ Pronouns. in, 1 nam we (both) nin thou em we (more than two) as he nim you ad it ar they ad she ne who end what Declension of pronouns. Singular. Plural. Nom En, I &e. . Em, we, &e. Gen enghai, of me emhai. Dat. engage emage | Acc. engan eman Abl. engusti emgustim. Instr. enganti emanti Loc. engnu emanu or emanum Agent. enim emim Nom. nin, thou nim, you Gen. ninghai nimhai Dat. ningage nimage Ace. ninin nimin, nimanun Abl. ‘ningusti nimgustim Instr. ninanti nimanti Loe. ninganu nimganu Agent. ninim (?) nimim (?) Appendix LE. 255 Nom. As, he ar, they Gen. asgahi argahi Dat. asge arge Ace. asin arin Abl. asgusti argustim Instr. asantl aranti Loc. asganu argnu Agen. 4sim arim. The dual may be formed, but does not really exist,—as nam irab, we both nim irib, you both nam irbgahi nim = irbargahi nam irbge nima_ irbarge nim irbatin nim = irbarim nam irbgusti nim _iribgusti nam irbanti nim __iribanti nam irbnu nim iribnu PosTPOsITIONs. gane, with chocha, after gusti, from mechha, above gusan, unto kuti, beside ge, to, for hiri, near anti, by, through katha, beyond nu, upon gechha, far num, in menya, up kinya, beneath mund, before ADJECTIVES. The adjectives, which are only a few, take no part in the declension. Nom, sanni alas, little man Gen, _ sanni alasgahi Dat. sani alasge AGC. sani alasin Abl. sani alasgusti etc. etc. Nom. sanni mukka, little woman Gen. sanni mukkagahi 256 Appendia E. Dat. sanni mukkage Loe. sanni mukkasin Abl. sanni mukkasgusti, ete. Comparison. - Pos. sanni, small Comp. adinti sanni, smaller Superl. ad hurminti sanni, smallest Pos. koha, great Comp. _adinti koha, greater Superl. ad hurminti koha, greatest 7 ADJECTIVES. panru, white garl, deep mocharu, black otta, heavy cheso, red nebba, _ light (not heavy) hariar, green marchia, dirty piyar, yellow kuri, hot digha, long kurna, warm pudda, short kiri, cold mot, thick bariar, strong sarhua, thin jukki, little chaika, lean chaiga, wet kuba, } TAT =’, dry benko, kira, hungry ujgo, straight didirna, satisfied (full) mechha, high nidi, empty phuda, low ninka, full maldan, ugly chandrna, sleepy sobhdas, selena ejmm, watchful kore, landi, = slow bens, good kitka, rotten malbens, bad panjka, ripe malkore, ill chena, unripe pachgi, old ghutum otaro, round joch, young tissa, sour sanni, small phari, pure bhircha, hard Appendia E. 237 Numerals. outa, one In numbering human beings, ent, | two these are the following numerals: mund, three nach, four ort alas, one man pantche, _ five . irib alar, two men Sol, six nib alar, three men sate, seven naib alar, four men athe, eight pantche Alar, five men nawe, nine etc. dase, ten There are no ordinals. ‘tara, half onghon thauna, once panr enr, twice panr mund, thrice panr nach, four times ete. VERBS. The auxiliary to be, manndge. Inpicative Moop. Present. IT am &e. Kn ira: adan rain nin ra: aday ra: adi as ra: adas ad ray ad rai em ra : adam raim nim ra: adar ra: aday ar ra ; anar ar ra: nay Imperfect. I was. En = ra:achkan_ ra: achan nin ra:achkay ra :-achki as ra : achas ad ra: acha em ra: achkam nim yra:achkar ra: ach kay ar ra ; achar ad ra ; achay 258 Appendix E. Perfect. I have been. manjkan be: edan en manjkan manjkai be : eday nin manjki manjkas be:edas § 4d manjki manjkam be : edam em manjkeem manjkar _—_ be: edar nim manjkay manjkar be : enar ad manjkay Pluperfect. Thad been. manjkan ra: achkan en manjkin manjkai _—ra : achkaij manjki manjkas ra: achas_ ad = manjki- manjkam ra: achkam manjkam manjkar ra: achkar manjkay manjkar = ra: achar manjkay Future. I shall or will be. En manon nin manoy As manos ad mano em manom nim mannor ar mannor Future completive. I shall have been, En ~—=——manj chachon, ) em manj chachom nim manj chachor ar manj chachor Imperative Moon. En manon, let me be. nin mana manai, be thou. as mana ad mani, let him, ete. be. em mannom nim mannor manj chachoy aS manj chachos, ar mannor be : be : be: : achan : achki : acha :achkam :achkay _ achay Appendix E. 259 Porrentrat Moon. Present, I can be. En- manna ongon, nin mana ongoi as manna ongos em manna ongom nim manna ongor ar manna ongor Imperfect. I might, could, &. be. Kn ~=manna ongdon nin manna ongday as manna ongdas em manna ongdam nim manna ongdar ar manna ongmar Perfect. I may have been. En ~~ manna ongkan be: edan nin manna ongkay be: eday aS manna ongkar be: edar em manna ongkam be: edam nim manna ongkar be: edar ar manna ongkar be: enar Pluperfect. I might, could, &. have been. Kn mannaongkan ra: achkan nin manna ongkay ra: achkay as manna ongkar ra: achas em manna ongkam ra: achkam nim. manna ongkar ra: achkar ar manna ongkar ra: achar Conpit1onaL Moop. Present. Ti I be. Te en manon, em manom nin manoy nim manor as manos ar manor 260 A ppendia E. Imperfect. Ii I were. Te en __holle, em _holle nin _holile nim _holle as holle ar holle IyrintttveE Moon. manna, being mannage, to be Kadlage, to go. Inpicattve Moon. Present. Mase. Fem. Dual. En kalakdan, kalagin, nam irbatim kalakda nin kalakday, — kalakdi, as kalakdas, ad kalgi, em kalakdam, kalagem, ~ nim = kalakdar, kalakday, ar kalaknar, — kalaknay, Imperfect. En ~~ kalakkan kalakkam kalakkay kalakkar kalakyas kalakyar Perfect. En kerkan be: edan kerkay be: eday kerkas be: edas kerkam be: edam kerkar be: edar kerkar be: enar Pluperfect. En kerkan ra: achkan kerkay ra: achkay kerkas ra: achas kerkam ra: achkam kerkar ra:achkar | kerkar ra: achar En En | nin En En kaun kaoy kaos kala chachor kala chachoy kala chachos kaun kdélon kaoy kalakaloi kaos kala ongon, kala ongoy kala ongos kala ongdan kala ongday kala ongdas kala ungkan kala ungkay kala ungkas kala ungkam kala ungkar kala ungkar kala ungkan kala ungkay kala ungkas kala ungkam kala ungkar kala ungkar Appendix FE, Future. kaom kaor kaor Future completive. kala chachom kala chachor kala chachor IMPERATIVE Moon. kaum kélom kaor kala kaor PorentraL Moop. Present. I can go kala ongom kala ongor kala ongor Imperfect. kala ongdam kala ongdar kala ongnar Perfect. be : edan be: eday be : edas be : edam be : edar be : edar Pluperfect. ra: achkan ra: achkay ra: achkas ra: achkam ra; achkar ra; achar 262 Appendix E. Conprtronat Moop. Present. Ii Ago! Te en kéun, — . em kaum nin kde nim kaor as kaus ar kaor Imperfect. Te en kerkan em kerkam nin kerkay nim kerkar as kerkas ar kernar PatIcIPLe. kalke kalar kalnosim Infinitive Moon. kana, going kalage, to go Nandage, to do. InpicaTiIvE Moon. Present. Kn —_nandan nandam nanday nandar nandas nandar Imperfect. En _ nanjkan nanjkam nanjkar nanjkar nanjas nanjar Perfect. Enim nanjkan be: edan ninim nanjkay be: eday asim nanjas be: edas emim nanjkam be: edam nimim nanjkar be: edar arim nanjkar be: enar Appendia E. Pluperfect. Enim nanjkan ra: achkan ninim nanjkae ra: achkay asim nanjkas ra: achas emim nanjkam ra: achkam nimim nanjkar ra: achkar arim nanjkar ra: achar Future. nannon — em nannoy nim nannos ar Future completive. nanjchachon em nanjchachoy nim nanjchachos ar Imperative Moon. nannon em nannoi nim nannos ar VERBS, to beat laona to drink ona to sleep chandrna to walk | ekna to swim ogna to plough oyna to cut choina to sow chachna to eat mochna to eat ona i to ride argna to fall katrna to rise cho : na to see erna to hear menna. . nannom nannor nhannor nanjchachom nanjchachor nanjchachor nannom nanor nannor 2638 264 Appendia E. to speak kochna karna to sing parna to blow urna to dance nalna to sit okna to tie chotna to go kana to cook biitna ADVERBS. below kinya near hiri within ekatara whence ekaiants ' how ekane not ambo yes hae whence ekaianti whither ekatara alone oatoch CoNJUNCTIONS. and dara then antle but pahe or bhel because igune also hon when ekabiri if je The Lord’s Prayer. — He embai je mercha nu ra: aday. Ninghai néme pavitr mano, Ninghai raji bar: 0; ninghai suuwak ekane mercha nu, aneho chochal — nu ho mano. Emhai ulla ullanta asma ina emage chia. Antle emhai dosan muaf nana, ekane omho emhai dosnanurin muaf nandan. Ant e : oman pariksha nu amba cha:a, pahe burainti chhar a ba:a Raji, sawang antle mahatm sadau sadau ninghai rai, Amin. | Appendix E, 265 Creed. En bishwés nandan Dhames embas nu, 4s je mercha dara che- chalgahi sdngias sirjanharas talids, antle asgahi ortostonka tangdas. Prabhus Jisus Christusnu, je Dharmatmanti Kulnu barchhas dindam Mariamauts kundrus, Pontius Pilatus tarti dukhan chedas, Krusnu kilras keras, ketchas keras, mandras keras, antle naraknu itids, ulmund- nu ketch ka gusti ujias dara chochus mercha nu argias, antle sawan- gias tambas Dharmeshgahi mandi cheka tara uk: as be: edas; eksanti as ujnarin antle ketch karin niséb nandge phen bar: os. En bishwas nandan dharmatma nu: Dharmir Christéner gahi go honda nu dhar mir gahi salha me, papgahi chhema, med gahi jia cho: ona antle jug jug gahi jia nu. Amin. Ten Commandments. 1. Dharme nimhai Dharme entol konnek anum dosar Dharmesin amba man : a. Indri im juthi gahi dewt a puja amba nana. Dharme ninghai Dharmes gahi namin begar bujhra : am amba ana. Dharmes gahi ulan paoits niage amba modr a. Ninghai 4go babasin maha tmchia, Alawein amba chetar chia. Nanna mukkargane amba nana bekamma dral tarah amba mana, Chalal amba chara. Phasiar amba ana, ninghai orsi porsir un phasiar gawahi amba OW MIA NP wb chia 10. Ninghai orsi porsir gahi erpa erpanta talach amba nana. 266 English. Man Woman Boy Girl Head Hair Kar Kye Mouth Tooth Hand . Foot Bone Blood Kgg To-day Night Sky Sun Moon Star Heat Fire Water Wind River Stone Tree Village House Snake Moondah. horo sing chandu epil Jolo singil Appendia F.. Ho, APPENDIX Brief Vocabulary of the Moondah and Kherrvah. hibo kanseldo baboo bui) boko ulloi lutur mud tamode sencom lolo tingson dah Appendix F. 267 F. cognate Languages of the Kolarian type-—By Lieut.-Col. Dauton. Putoons or Sonthal. Bhumiz Coour Juang. (Latham.) (Dr. Voysey.) juang horh horro hoko CE TRE y soos 15 os waaeee suttan lunda lundi bocob buho buho juta (H) ub ub ap lutur lutur lutur emor met met meht tamon mocha alang ah goneh datha datta saeco thi thi ais cox kata kata har (H) jang jang iyam myum myun susuté billi pito missing teheng tising berote nindha nidha akas (H) sirma reiumil suruj (H) singi singl lerung chandu chandi (H) konjinda ipil ipil ipil lalai sengel sengel singh¢l dah dah dah da koyo noi (H) garra garra olag dirri dirri sumsing daré dara. darao jaon (1H) athu hathugé Specs. ora OFF i, oarru bubung bing bing 268 Appendia G. APPENDIX G. Language of the Kolarian Aborigines ;—Grammatical construction of the Ho language.—By Lveut.-Col. Trokeu.*. T hope due allowances will be made for the imperfectness of the grammatical details here given, when it is remembered that the Ho language has no written character, nor does there exist a person, native — of the Kolehan or otherwise, who could give me the slightest assis- tance on this point. It would be trite to observe that grammar is as inherent and essen- tial to all languages, even the most barbarous, as a vocabulary itself. By first learning a number of the words and sentences arbitrarily, the system on which they are founded may be detected in due time by patient comparisons of them, even when the speakers themselves are unable to give the inquirer the least information on the construction of what they are saying. With this difficulty once mastered, it is inconceivable with what ease the most (apparently) complex and difficult languages become familiar. q The sounds of the Ho language are exceedingly pure and liquid, without strong aspirates or gutturals, and may be well rendered by the English alphabet, or still better the French one, as that admits of the slight nasal inflection which prevails in many words in the Ho dialect. Let the following conventions be made to the sound of the vowels, in the ensuing dialogues, &e. | a as in “father,” “ rather,” Gi faaudhprey, | aaa i —— ,, “skip,” “trip,” ee —— ,, ‘sheep,’ “peep,” y Tao ee? % fly,” a try,” ai or ay ,, longer sound as in ‘‘ aye, aye?” 9) —— ,, “bone,” “stone,” 00 —- , * fool,” “ stool,” +n = (nasal n) 5 ton” ‘ Fanfaron,” (Frenehy * Reprinted from As. Soc. Journal, Vol. IX. p. 1063. 7 Also g, as the French liquid g, in Cologne, Boulogne. Appendix G. 269 The long acute vowel sounds, such as 00 and ee, also the letter 7, are pronounced too liquidly and subtilely to be easily imitated by a stranger, and in some words the imflections of the vowels are in- conceivably complex and mellifluous. The general euphony or cadence of the language is sprightly and cheerful; if the subject be of a complaining nature, it subsides into a strange chaunt, the sentences being linked together by such see-saw sounds, as “‘na-do na-do enété né-do” which have no meaning, bnt serve to connect together the speaker’s ideas. When two or more words come together, the former ending, and the latter beginning with similar vowels, they are joined by ellipsis. as ‘‘ Hola’lé senicna,” instead of ‘‘ Hola allé seniéna,” we went yesterday. i ARTICLE. There is none, (properly speaking), definite or indefinite. Noun. There is no distinction of genders, marked or influenced by ter- mination, it being determined by the sense or meaning of the word, whether referring to a male or female being. Besides man and woman, “ erril” and “‘éra,” boy and girl, “ koa’ and “ kodee,’ ) names of rela- tions, and those of a few domestic animals, all other nouns are distinguished in their gender by prefixing ‘‘ Sandee” male, or “‘ Enga”’ _ female, as in Persian or English ew yy? ew woley he-bear, she-bear. _ A noun has three numbers, singular, dual, and plural, as in Greek. The nouns can scarcely be said to have declension, as the terminal does not vary either according to number or case, although a dis- tinguishing adjunct, which may be called a ‘ Pronoun article,’ from its nature and use, is added. Singular. Dual. Plural. Nom. Seta, a dog. Seta king, two dogs. Séta ko, dogs. Gen. Seta-4, of a dog. Seta kingya, of two dogs. Seta koa, of dogs. Ab. Seta-té, from a dog. Seta king td, from two dogs. Seta ko t8, from dogs. The dative, accusative, and vocative cases do not differ from the nominative, being only known from their position in a sentence. In composition, the noun in an accusative case takes the first place in the sentence, if the nominative be a pronoun; otherwise the noun- — nominative precedes, the accusative follows, and the oblique or dative case comes immediately before the verb, sometimes immediately after 270 Appendix @. it. En ho kajikeeai aya éra,” that man said to his wife, “ Dendka o€ tootigoikeea,”’ Dendka shot the bird. ‘‘ Kean hon do chowlee seta emadya,’”’ my son gave the dog some rice. ADJECTIVE. The adjective does not alter in termination, either in number, case, or gender; and always precedes the noun it qualifies. As “ Boogee ho,” a good man ; “‘ Boogee ho-a,” of a good man ; “ Boogee ho lo té,” with a good man, &c. There are no degrees of comparison, but as in Hindustani the qualifying words very, or most of all, are prefixed to denote grades of quality, as ‘‘ Etka,” bad, ‘‘ Hina té need o etka,” this is worse than that. ‘‘Sabee ré nee o etka minna,” this is worst of all. ‘ Boogee léka éra,” a pretty woman. “ Boogee léka éra ko,” pretty women. ‘ PRONOUN. The first personal pronoun has four numbers, the singular, dual, plural, and plural comprehensive. The others only the three first, as noticed in the noun-substantives. The possessive pronouns are the same as the personal, with the genitive inflection @ added. PERSONAL PRONOUNS. Singular. Dual. _ Plural. Pl. comprehensive. — Ist. Eeng or aing,Z Alleeng, we two Allé, we Aboo, we all — 2d. Um, thou Abben, you two Appé, you }: | 3d. Ay or ayo, he Aking, they two Ako, they a5 In speaking, if the person include the person addressed, himself, and every one present, as nominatives or agents, he uses the plural com- prehensive. If he exclude the person addressed, he employs the first person plural, as ‘“‘ Hola aboo seniéna,” yesterday we went (i. e. you and all of us.) “ Hola allé seniéna,” yesterday we went (i. e. not you, we alone.) ; The personal pronouns in the nominative case both precede and terminate the verb, optionally with the speaker, as, I speak, “ Heng kajitanna”’ or “ Heng kajitannaing”’ or ‘ Kajitannaing.” 3 I go, ‘Heng senotana,” or “ Heng senotannaing,” or ‘‘ Senotan-— naing.”’ ¥ And to give energy to the sentence, the pronoun is repeated, with the connect “do” between them, as ‘‘ Heng do eeng kajitanna,” “Zis I who speak,’ Um do um kombookenna,” Thou alone statest 7. Appendix G. 271 The most difficult part of their construction is in the dative and accusative cases, which are absorbed in the verbs they are governed by, in a manner unknown to other languages, being placed in the centre of the verb, after the root, and before the tense terminal. As, I speak to thee, ‘‘ Heng kajimetanna;” he spoke to me, “ ayo kajikedingia ;” he spoke to them, “ kajiked kodi;” the tiger saw me *“ koola do neldedingia ;” he killed him, “ a¥o goikedaya.” Here I have underlined the oblique or accusative pronoun, where it comes in, just before the tense terminal of the verb. PossEssive Pronouns. Singular. Dual. Plural. Pl. comp. Ist. Henga* or dingia, my alleengia alléa abooa 2d. Umma, thy abbena appéa sf 3d. Aya, his ; akingia akoa ss These always precede their substantives. DemonstRATIVE PRonovuns. Singular Dual. Plural. Nee or inee, this neeking,, these two niko, these Need or ineea, of this neekingia, of these two neekod, of these Neet¢, or ineeté, to, with, neekingté, neekoté, G&e. this En, that enking, those two enko, those Ena, of that enkinga, of those two enkoa, of those Rnté, by, from with &c. that enkingté, enkoté, “‘ Nee” this, is sometimes used idiomatically by a person referring to himself. If a Kole were to be asked what countryman he was? he would answer, ‘“ Ho nee gé,” Lam ; or literally, this isa Kole. Of what clan are you? Answer, ‘ Poortee neegé,”’ I am a Poortee. InteRRoGATIVE Pronovns. Okoi, who ? chikan, which? chia, what ? Okoid, whose ? chikana, of which ? Retative Pronouns. Relative pronouns are very vague, the sentence being generally go rendered as to obviate the necessity of them, thus, instead of saying, The man who went ; a. Kole would say, Zhe gone man, “Senien Horo.” * Pronounced, as ‘mignon,’ ‘ Ligne,’ &c, in French, 272 Appendix G. But at times ‘Chikana,” whatever, and “Ena,” that, are used relatively, as “ Chikana um kajeed, éna eeng diooma,” what you say, that I will listen to. | ; VERBS. Verbs are either active or neuter. There is no passive voice. The Infinitive mood is formed by adding téé to the root. The present participle by adding tan or #é. The Past participle by affixing kedté. In the active or transitive voice, the Present tense Indicative mood adds to the root ‘‘ tanna,” in the neuter voice, ‘‘ akanna.” Imperfect tense there is none, the Present tense being used, and — its Imperfect signification understood by the context. The Perfect tense is formed by adding in the active voice, “ kidda, — keea, kenna, lidda, or tadda,” tothe root. In the neuter voice, “‘ lena,”’ ’ or “zéna,” sometimes “ kenna.” There is no Pluperfect tense, but greater completion is expressed by — conjugating the verb ‘“chabtea,” to finish, added to the root ; much ~ the same way as “ chookna”’ in Hindustanee. : The Future is formed by adding to the root eea or od, or sometimes simply dé, in which latter case the sound of the root is prolonged. — and ‘‘ rote,” 97 Except “ nooitea,” to drink, which makes “ noonooa ; to gore (as a bull) “ roroa.”’ The Imperative is formed by adding (in the 2nd person singular) to the root, ‘‘ mén” and ‘ omén” or “ ymén,” if the root end with a con- sonant. In the other persons ké precedes the pronoun, and the simple root of the verb, which will be more clearly shown in conjugating. In a negative sense, “ alwm” or “alo” is prefixed to the 2nd personal pronoun, @ being added to the root; if in the 3rd person, singular, dual, or plural “ aloka” is prefixed to the pronoun, and the root alone of the verb is used. The Subjunctive mood is vague and imperfect. In the Present and Future tenses “ rédo” is added to the root, sometimes together with the word ‘“ honang,” “‘derang,” or “ tora” (signifying conditionality) affixed. | i The Past tense is formed in the same way ; indeed there appears to be no Past Snbjunctive tense ; but sometimes the conditional terminal ““yvédo”’ is added to the Past perfect Indicative. Appendia G. 273 This word ‘‘védo”’ admits the vowel to be affixed to it, or to come immediately before it and after the root. n Conjugation of the verb ‘‘ Kajéetea,” to speak. Inrrnttive Moon. Present tense—Kajéetéa, to speak, Present Participle—Kajitan, or Kajienté, speaking, Past Participle—Kajikedté, having spoken. , InpicativeE Moon. Present tense. Sing. Dual. Plural. 1st. Person, vm | Aen Apps Kajitanns, BE i iy Um, ¢ Kajitanna, Abben—Appé, ¢ 75 ceticakieal oe, Ayo, Aking—Ako, Perfect tense. Bee ging Anceng— All’, ) Kajikidda, Kajilidda or Kajitadda. 3d. Ayo— Aking— pes 0, ) I éc. spoke or have spoken, Future tense. Aing, Um, &c. &c. &e.—Kajeca, I dc. ec. will speak. Imprrative Moon. Sing. Dual. Plural. Heng Kakajee, Let me speak. | Kajeeabooor Abookakajee, Let us ail, Ge. ‘Um Kajeemén, Speak thou. | Kajeeben or Abbenkakajee, Speak you, Ayo Kakajee or one him| de. Kakajee o kai, speak, | Kajeealling or Allingkakajee, Letus, &c. Kajeeallé or Alléokakajee Let us, dc. Kajeeako or Akokakajee Let them, &c. Kajeeaking or Akingkakajee, Let them, ée, NEGATIVE. — Sing. Dual. Plural. Alokaing kajeea, Do not let me speak. | Alo k’aboo kajeea. } Alum kajeea, Speak not. Alo k’allé kajeea. Dove Bhas Alo kai kajeea, Do not let him speak, | Alla’bben kajeea, bee Al’appé _ kajeea. o oe Alo ka’ko kajeea. ae Aloka’ king kajeea QTA - Appendix G. Sussunetive Moon. ° Present tense. Keng Kajeerédo, If I speak. Aboo, Um Kajeeredo, Jf thou speakest. | Allé, - = | Aio Kajeeredo, If he speak. pene + Kajeerado, If we &c. speak. Ako, Aking, Perfect ar Pluperfect. ! Eeng, Um, &e. &e. &e. Kajeekedrédo, If I dc. éc. de. had spoken. CoNDITIONAL, OR PoTENTIAL. Heng Kajéaing honang, I would speak. | sig &o. &o, Kage onan Um Kajeeum honang, Thou dc. Ao Kajeea honang, He, Be We might or would speak. Norse. As has been before explained, in all these tenses and persons (except in the Imperative) the pronoun may be either prefixed, or affixed, or both. Premera The same Verb, Conjugated with its Objective pronoun. Inpicative Moop Present tense. Heng or Ayng Kajeeing tanna, J speak to myself. Kajee metanna, J speak to thee.. Kajee ditanna, I speak to him. Kajee’ létanna, I speak to ourselves, Kajee’ ling tanna, I speak to us two. Kajee’ ben tanna, I speak to you two. Kajee’ pétanna, I speak to you. Kajee king tanna, I speak to them two. Kajee kotanna, J speak to them. The same exactly for all the other persons, and tenses, &e. Perfect tense. ( Kajikedingié. ) ( spoke to myself. Kajiked’mia. spoke to thee, | Kajikedaia. spoke to him. ' .z | Kajikede’lia. spoketo ourselves Aine, ve Pack’ { Kajiked’lingia. .+ 7. ae Be 4 spoke to us two. Fy Me EY EE Kajiked’bena. cov" | snoke to you two. | Kajikedpéa. spoke to you. | Rekewbee | spoketothemtwo. Kajiked’koa. J | spoke to them. Appendia G. * 275 Examples of this construction, especially in the Imperative mood, will be given in the Vocabulary, so need not be further dwelt on here, It is scarcely possible to reduce the verb ‘‘to be” to conjugation, unless we suppose the varied forms in which it is used as inflections of separate verbs, wanting in many tenses. Tor ‘to be’’ ig expressed by different verbs, according to its allusion to time, a person, or a thing; and its relation to mere existence or to the nature of existence. In short, there is no auxiliary verb “to be” which can be independently conjugated. The unchangeable word ‘‘ minna,” or “‘ minnakana,” is applicable in the present tense alone, to denote a-state of existence, as ‘ Keng, um, ayd, &c. menna, or minnakana,” J am, thou art, he 1s, &c. But in past and future tenses some other verb denoting presence, as the verb “‘ to come,” ‘‘to reside,” &c. must be employed. But the verb ‘‘to be,” when implying the nature of existence, can be rendered in the past and future tenses, as well as the present, by adding to the participle or adjective, od in the future, and zena in the past, as ‘“‘ eeng laga akanna,” J am tured ; “ eeng lagaoa,” I shall be tired ; “eeng lagiéna,”’ I have become tired ; “ eeng rénga akanna, or renga akannaing,” J am hungry ; ‘‘ eeng rengaoa or rengaoing,” I shall be hungry; “eeng rengaiéna,” J was hungry. Od and vena, it is to be remembered, are inflections of the future and past tenses in all neuter verbs. - Again the verb ‘to be’ can be simply represented in the future and past tenses, when speaking of a thing, by the word “ hobawa,” 4 shall or will be, and “hobiena,” zt has been; also in the present, “ hobowtanna,” zt 7s. This mode of expression commonly refers to the success or accomplishment of any project. In the English idiom we should say for ‘“ hobawa,” zt will do, or at wall answer ; “ hobiena,”’ at is all over, or has succeeded ; “‘ hobowtanna,”’ a 7s govng on. _ That boy will be a thief, could not be rendered, ‘‘ En koa do komboo hobawa,” but ‘‘ En koa do. komboo oa.” Your business will be done to-morrow, not, ‘‘ Umma kajee gappa 04,” but, ‘‘ Umma kajee gappa hobawa.” This will never do, “Ka hobawa ;” go away, wt as all over “ Mar- senomén hobiéna.”’ 276 = Appendia G. In English and other languages, state, nature or condition, is render- — ed by affixing or prefixing the various tenses of the verb “‘to be” to the adjective, as to be hungry, J am hungry, I was hungry ; ““to be glad, I am glad, &c. &c.” But in the Ho dialect the adjective itself becomes a neuter verb, and is conjugated by affixing to it the different inflections denoting time and mood—to be hungry, ‘ ies >’ Lam hungry, “renga akannaing ;”’ I was hungry, “ rengaiénaing ;” W&e. Nevter Vers. After what has been said, it would be unnecessary to give any — example of the conjugation of neuter verbs. It only requires to be — remembered that their present terminal is “‘akanna’’ instead of © “tanna;’’ and their past inflection ‘iéna,’’ instead of ‘‘ kidda, tadda, — lidda, or eea,” all of which latter are transitive forms. 9 Some verbs are both neutral and transitive, as ‘‘ chabatea’’ to finial , They have therefore both inflections. In the transitive form “ chaba-_ tea’ is frequently added to the root of some other verb, to denote completion; but it may also be used alone: in the neuter form, it is of course confined to the third person. _ EXAMPLES. Yémcehabakiddai, He ate rt all up. Bychabakidallé, We finished (making) tt. Kajeechabymén, finish speaking. Gappa miang chabawa, It will be done to-morrow or next day. Nado chabiéna, Jt 2s now finished. The word “ hered’”’ is placed between the root and osetia of a verb to denote positiveness or certainty; as when the speaker means to state something as an incontrovertible fact, as, “‘ Kajee heredkiddai,” most assuredly he spoke. ‘‘ Qodoob hereémén,”’ speak positively. 4 The causal form is alee by putting “chee” between the root and terminal—as “ landated,” to laugh, makes “‘ landacheetea’’ to cause to laugh ; “ aioomtea,” to eee ‘ aioomcheetea,”’ to cause to hear, as in Hindustani @ is inserted (with a few exceptions) for the same purpose, as Hunsna, Hunsana; Soonna, Soondna, &c. Continuity Gn the Imperative mood alone) is expressed by adding “‘akén”’ to the root, as “‘ doobmén,” sé down, ‘ doobakanmen,” remav im sitting ; “‘ Aioom mén,” listen, ‘‘ Aioomakénmén,” continue listening. 7 Finally, the thoroughly performing an act, is often rendered by addin ing * Appendia G. ea the verb, “‘ jometed,”’ to eat, to the root of the expletive verb, as “ nel- joomkidallé,” we all saw it (thoroughly) ; “ aioomjémmeén,”’ listen (atten- tively) ; ‘‘Geetee jom-meén,” sleep (soundly). And should the verb be of a violent nature (referring to some violent act) the particle “tab” between the root and inflection gives force to the meaning, as a Goitabkiddai,” he slew him (outright) ; ‘ Toltab kidallé,” we bownd him (forthwith); “‘ Neertabmén,” Run (quickly) fly 1 so “‘ Ooited’’ is to jump, and ‘ Ooitabtea,”’ to bound (as a tiger). Kd before the pronoun gives the verb a negative form, as has been before explained in describing the Imperative mood. There is no verb “‘to have,’ possession being denoted in the same manner as in Hindustani. J have, ‘‘ Kengtra minna’’—‘ Méré pas hye From the foregoing remarks may be gathered, that in the active or transitive voice-— The present terminal is, “ Tanna.” The past, “ Kidda, tadda, lidda, kenna or beeen” In the Neuter Voice— The present terminal is, * akénna.” The past, “7éna or léna ;” In either Voice— The conditional, subjunctive, or potential mood terminate in ; “redo” or “ kedrado,”’ All these terminals being of course subject to the inflections of their pronouns, which are, as has been said, as often affixed as prefixed. A nondescript species of Verb is used in rendering the sentence what shall or can I, (thou, he, &c.) do? Future and Present. Ch’eeng chikya, ) TL, 7 Chee’m chikya, | Tho Chee chikya, a Cheeboo chikya, We all, Chee’lé chikya We, | Cheep chikys, | what shall or can i Wau, cae Chee’ben chikya, let ou two, Chee’ko chikya, | | They, Chee’king chikya, | | They two, Chee’ling chikya, if \Wetwo, jf 278 — Appendi« G. Past tense. Chee’ng chikakidda, what could I have done? &e. &c. &e. The verb “to be able” is rendered by “ Dytea” in its moods and tenses, as ‘‘ Niddo eeng bydya,” I can make this ; ‘‘ Umdokadya,” you cannot ; ‘‘ K’ai dyoa,” he will not be able. Many little exceptions and variations occur to these general rules, which it would be impossible to become familiar with, without con- stant practice in their arbitrary use; but the foregoing remarks com- prise all that would be of practical utility. The constant elision and confluence of words beginning and ending with vowels must be remembered, and that the particle do, has no meaning whatever. This : will render the examples above given to the different rules simple and illustrative. Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of January, 1866. Latitude 22° 23’ 1” North. Longitude 88° 20’ 34” Kast. Height of the Cistern of the Standard Barometer above the Sea-level, 18 ft. 11 in. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. Sey 2 i 2 A Range of the Barometer 'B i Range of the Tempera- of E a during the day. ale ture during the day. "| Aaa As go ; ; ad 5 ; : ea Max. Min. Diff. e a Max. Min. | Diff. or 8 Oy =| = Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. fe) oO oO fe) 1 30.056 | 30.147 | 30.006 | 0.141 . 68.3 76.4 61.0 | 15.4 2 045 184 | 29.993 141 © 68.0 77.8 60.4 | 17.4 3 .029 Is .987 126 69.1 79.4, 60.2 | 19.2 A .OO1 .082 .930 .152 72.0 82.8 62.8 | 20.0 5 29.961 .061 .886 my 73.4 83.6 65.8 | 17.8 6 .906 | 29.971 .848 123 veal 81.2 66.4 | 14.8 "5 30.007 | 30.073 .948 125 68.4 73.8 64.6 9.2 8 Be 3: 221 | 30.057 164 64.0 73.0 55.8 | 17.2 9 119 219 .064 155 63.4: 72.9 56.0 | 16.9 10 .068 .158 .004 154 65.2 75.5 57.6 | 17.9 11 .042 112 | 29.992 .120 66.9 77.0 58.6 | 18.4 12 .068 .158 | 30.003 155 66.1 76.6 57.0 | 19.6 13 .060 .140 O15 125 65.5 76.8 56.0 | 20.8 14, .060 133 | 29.995 138 67.8 79.0 58.0 | 21.0 15 .082 .183 | 30.019 164: 68.8 78.6 60.0 | 18.6 16 .036 123 | 29.969 154 67.5 77.2 59.2 | 18.0 17 .012 .098 .955 143 67.1 774 58.9 | 18.5 18 .018 107 .959 148 68.2 78.7 59.2 | 19.5 19 29.990 .056 .923 los 69.9 81.4: 61.0 | 20.4 20 30.028 .106 .967 139 70.1 81.2 61.0 | 20.2 21 .044: i3 .962 pt Tis 81.0 62.6 | 18.4 22 .080 161 | 30.033 128 F(a Das 81.3 65.0 | 16.3 23 .096 .165 .029 .1386 70.5 79.8 62.2 | 17.6 24, .105 185 .020 .165 7 fa a 81.2 62.8 | 18.4 25 077 148 | 29.989 5 aD 82.0 64.4 !} 17.6 - 26 .085 to. |. s0-018 .160 74.5 83.8 66.4 | 17.4 27 .066 152 | 29.983 .169 74.0 84.7 67.0 | 17.7 28 .042 .083 | 30.001 .082 |- 68.3 77.8 63.4 | 14.4 29 .005 .079 | 29.935 144 68.6 75.2 63.4 | 11.8 30 29.975 .056 .929 a i 68.2 72,2 63.8 8.4, 31 30.003 094 937 157 63.4 64.6 62.2 2.4: The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Ther- mometer Means are derived, from the hourly observations made, during the day. il Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of January, 1866. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.— Continued. x E 8 5) | ees o : 45 oO 5 a ead Boob ced |, Hb -Bhckcl che eee eee = a a) A ie ab ogim = wees 0 5 & HB |eak less 2 3 B | 3 2 C2 |e oe | oS wn Dateue hae 2 A = He 4.2 22 | 3 oe 4+ & os) = on .5 me (oD) hs Oo og 2 3 3 Se | 33 | Seo | Se Eo = £ du | HE | FO | esa 8 oa S a a | S, 3a |: ag ba a § a | gf] da (S88 | 88s 8 4 p> 8 PoAy ore oH [er ens ee = a) oO a = =| < | o ) fo) oO Inches. | 'T. gr. || Tog 1 62.5 5.8 57.9 10.4 | 0.488 5.38 2.22 OE 2 | 618 62 | 568 | 112 | 2470 19 34 ‘69 3 63.2 5.9 58.5 10.6 498 A8 30 70 4 | 67.3 4.7 | 63.5 8.5 | 588 | 6.43 07 16 5 68.2 5.2 64.0 9.4 597 03 4 74, 6 68.2 4.9 64.3 8.8 .603 .60 9 -75 / 62.2 6.2 57.2 11.2 A76 5.25 on .69 s | 568 Bo) W608. | 187 laa qn dae A5 63 9 | 57.3 61 tote | ie 1 heuy 42 aa 68 10 | 58.7 6S Bae) 107 | Ade 68 23 68 11 60.3 6.6 55.0 11.9 442 .90 38 .67 12 | 58.8 73 | 53.0 | 13% || J414 59 51 65 13 58.4: Gk 52.7 12.8 .409 .55 43 -65 1A IGA. 7) | eee 1 e834 agi) eae 16 71 15 61.8 7.0 56.2 12.6 A61 .O7 .64 -66 16 | 60.5 70 || ‘549 ) 126 Waal th aoe 55 66 17 | 60.6 G5 | Bea a7 ap a9 96 36 68 is | 61.1 71 | 55.4 | 12.8 | .449 95 63 65 19 | 64.4 5.5 | 60.0 99 | 523 | 5.75 23 72 20 | 641 60.4 see) | see | pit Gi 42 70 21 66.7 4.6 63.0 8.3 .578 6.35 1.98 -76 22 65.6 7.5 59.6 13.5 .516 5.64 3.15 64 23 63.1 7.4 57.2 13.3 .A76 23 2.90 64 24 64.2 7A 58.3 13.3 ADA . 42 .98 -65 25 | 67.2 5G || 625 | 10.6. | lees | ea 58 val 26 69.5 5.0 66.0 8.5 .638 .95 23 .76 27 69.3 4.7 66.0 8.0 .638 yy 07 Te 28 65.5 2.8 63.3 5.0 584 AA, 1.16 85 29 66.5 Died 64.8 3.8 .613 78 0.89 .88 30 66.2 2.0 64.6 3.6 .609 73 85 .89 31 61.8 1.6 60.4: 3.0 .530 5.91 .62 oF Meteorological Observations. iil ‘Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, in the month of January, 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. SAS 5 DO RS ES a OS 6 8 Range of the Barometer =, |Range of the Tempera- 2 o# for each hour during aS ture for each hour "80 5 ES the month. e — during the month. Hour. | 3 & RS |e aa mr & A = qo” : ; do ? F Rae Max. Min. Diff. a Max. Min. | Diff. or Ss D Ey = a Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. oO oO oO oO Mid- night. 30.046 30.119 | 29.921 0.198 65.5 72.4 60.0 | 12.4 i .039 1138 .902 wk 64.8 72.4 58.8 | 13.6 2 .030 .106 .886 .220 64.2 72.0 57.8 | 15.2 3 .021 .099 .867 202 63.6 71.8 57.4 | 14.4 A, 014 ,094 848 .246 62.9 70.4 57.0 | 13.4 5 .022 .103 861 242 62.3 69.7 56.4 | 13.3 6 .038 .120 .867 253 62.1 69.5 ba. | 18.7 7 .059 156 885 271 61.8 67.4 56.0 | 11.4 8 068 }* .190 927 .263 63.7 69.2 57.8 | 11.4 9 114 215 957 .258 67.2 73.2 61.2 | 12.0 10 122 221 971 .250 70.8 Cit 63.8 | 13.9 11 .105 197 .960 BY | a2 79.4 63.6 | 15.8 Noon. .075 .167 .935 .232 75.2 81.6 62.6 | 19.0 i .035 124 897 227 76.5 82.8 62.4 | 20.4 2 007 - 091 871 220 7 pF fa) 84.0 62.8 | 21.2 3 | 29.989 077 S861 .216 78.0 84.7 63.8 | 20.9 4 .983 .064: 851 213 76.8 82.8 64.4 | 18.4 5 .992 O77 .864 218 75.5 81.5 63.8 | 17.7 6 .999 .076 .880 .196 72.6 79.2 62.6 | 16.6 7 30.018 | .088 904 184 70.9 77.0 62.8 | 14.2 8 .035 .LO9 .929 .180 69.5 75.3 62.8 | 12.5 9. .050 aba 941 .180 68.1 74.1 62.6 | 11.5 10 .056 137 .940 197 67.0 73.4 61.8 | 11.6 if 052 132 927 205.1 ° -66.1 72.5 60.6 | 11.9 The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Thermometer Means are derived from the Observations made at the several hours during the month, iv Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, in the month of January, 1866. Hourly means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Contimued.) é eT ee 6 He | S89 |38 = $ E A ro) 3,8 5) Sime = e > HH 5 © as | eet iy BS = Ay © 2 ane ana © 3 e g Eo ee ae 38 | Sse) 33 H pO 8 2 3 2 = & > oie oP eke 4 & es] A a7 ano & Fo E ol ce oie 2 3 2 Sy og | Syd oa Fs} 2 | £ | Se] BE) eS [feels c do A ~ 2 8 a f* og @ | | aeeeee oo coe Sg b P| ps | ge | 82 |Ses| see = = e) = = = < a Oo oO oO co) Inches, |. T.. gr. Aes Mid- night.| 62.1 3.4 59.4 6.1 | 0.513 5.69 1.29 0.82 1 61.7 3.1 59.2 5.6 .509 .66 17 83 2 61.2 3.0 58.5 5.7 .498 53 16 83 3 60.7 2.9 58.1 5.5 AOL 46 ue 83 4 60.2 2.7 57.8 5.1 486 43 .00 84 5 59.7 2.6 57.4 4.9 480 36 0.95 85 6 59.7 2.4 57.5 4.6 A81 38 89 86 7 59.4 2.4 57.2 4.6 476 32 Belg 86 8 60.7 3.0 58.0 5.7 489 AA 1.15 83 9 62.7 4.5 59.1 8.1 .508 62 73 YS 10 64.4 6.4 59.3 11.5 511 -60 2.60 .68 11 65.3 7.9 59.0 14.2 .506 53 3.29 63. Noon.| 65.9 9.3 59.4 15.8 518 58 79 60 1 66.3 10.2 59.2 17.3 509 54: 4,21 57 2 66.7 10.8 59.1 18.4 .508 .50 54: 55 3 66.8 11.2 59.0 19.0 506 AT 12 54 4, 66.2 10.6 58.8 18.0 503 45 38 55 5 65.9 9.6 59,2 16.3 LACS ‘55 3.91 9 6 65.8 6.8 60.4: 12.2 530 81 2.85" |, a cs 65.1 5.8 60.5 10.4 532 85 38 oy i 8 64.4: 5.1 60.3 9.2 528 82 .06 TA 9 | 63.7 44 | 60.2 We.) ee 82 | 1.78 77 10 63.1 3.9 60,0 7.0 523 79 51 19 11 62.5 3.6 59.6 6.5 516 72 38 81 All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. ti Meteorological Observations. Vv Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, in the month of January, 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &c. Hy [toe . 32 |s8%4 Prevailing | 23 | © 8! direction of the General Aspect of the Sky. be ae A Wind. a oe 8 a3 & O Biot leis o Inches 1} 138.0 N.& W.&N.W. | Clear, slightly foggy at midnight &1 a.m, and from 8 to 11 Pp. M. 2} 134.0 N. & W. Clear, slightly foggy from 8 to 10 P. mM. 3} 134.0 S. W. &S., Clear, slightly foggy at 1 a. M. 4) 138.4 Ss. Clear to 8 p. u. Scatd. \i afterwards. 5} 139.0 Ss. Nito 8 A.M. “i to 4 P.M. clear after- wards. 6} 129.5 S. & variable. Clear to 9 a. M. Seatd. “i afterwards, slightly foggy at 5 A. M. 7| 139.0; ,.. | N. &N. W. Various clouds to 7 a.™M., clear afters wards, | 8} 129.0 N.& N. W. Clear. 9) 124.8 N. & N. W. Clear. 10} 131.0 N. W. & N. Clear, slightly foggy from 8 to 10 P. M, 11) 183.2 ; W. Clear, slightly foggy at 9 Pp, M. 12) 131.0 N. W. &N. & N. E.} Clear. 13) 129.0 W.&N. EL. &N. Clear. 14, 133.4 W. & variable. Clear, foggy at 5 and 6 A. M. 15) 133.0 N.& N. EK. Clear to 10 a. m. Scatd. “i to 5P. M. clear afterwards, slightly foggy at 10 & 11 P. mM. 16} 126.0 N.&S Clear to 6 a. M. Scatd. “i to 11 a. M., clear afterwards. : 17| 129.0; ... |N.GW.&QN. W. Clear to 9 a. mM. Scatd. \i to 6 P. M. clear afterwards. 18) 130.8 W. Clear, slightly foggy at 6 A. M. 19) 129.5 S.&N Clear to 5 A. M. 71 to 6 P. M. clear after. wards. 20) 134.5 H. & N. E. Clear, slightly foggy from 5 to_9 A. M. 21} 130.0 S. W. & W. Clear to noon, Scatd. ni to 4p. M. clear afterwards. 22) 134.0 N. Clear, foggy from 2 to 4 A. M. 23) 127.2 W.&N, Clear to Noon, Scatd. \i to 5 p. M. clear afterwards, slightly foggy from 8 to 11 P. M. 24) 130.8) ... | W. Clear to 3 Pp. mM. Scatd. “i to 8 Pp. M. clear afterwards, slightly foggy at 7 & 8p. M. 25} 135.2} ,.. |W.&S. W. Clear to 10 a. mM. Scatd. “i to 7 P. M, Scatd, i afterwards. Ni Cirri, —i 8trati, i Cumuli, i Cirro-strati, ~i Cumulo-strati, “-i Nimbi, ii Cirro-cumuli. v1 Mt eteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, in the month of January, 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &c. oOo oO us Peo é is 5.3 z Prevailing .| 2@ |O& 2] direction of tion General Aspect of the Sky. Si wd is oe Wind. o| © S [and Als ™ |p o |Inches 26) 189.5} ... | HE. & 8S. & W. Clear to 5 A. M. Scatd. “i afterwards. 27| 129.5 S. Scatd. “i to 7 p. M. clear afterwards, — slightly foggy at 7 A.M. and thin rain at 6 P. M. Dele 0.45 | HE. & S. EH. Clear to 10 a.m. Overcast to 6 P.M. wi afterwards rain between 1 & 2 P. M. and from 4 to 6 Pp. M. Thunder at 3&5 P.M. e ol aoeas 0.80 | 8. EH. & S. Overcast. Lightning towards N. at 8 & 9 Pp. M. rain after intervals. s SO aa 0:20. | N. > Scatd. “i to 5 a. M. overcast to 11 A. mM. ito 3 P.M. overcast afterwards. Light rains from 7 to 10 A. mM. and from 5 to 9 P.M. : 41h ee 0.46 |N. & N. BE. Overcast, rain at 4, 8, 9,11 and Noon, — Meteorological Observations. Vii Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of January, 1866. Monruty Resvtrs. Inches Mean height of the Barometer for the month, . we 380.041 Max. height of the Barometer occurred at 10 a. M. on the Sth, ve «930.221 Min. height of the Barometer occurred at 4 A. M. on the 6th, .. 29.848 Extreme Range of the Barometer during the month, has wath OTe Mean of the daily Max. Pressures, ... ae ne ». 30.123 Ditto ditto Min. ditto... ot seine en Mean daily range of the Barometer dnring ie oe . os 0.144 o Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer for the month, ... wa ane 69.0 Max. Temperature occurred at 3 Pp. M. on the 27th, i a 84.7 Min. Temperature occurred at 6 A. M. on the 8th, ste as 55.8 Extreme range of the Temperature during the month, sis his 28.9 Mean of the daily Max. Temperature, a ws oe 78.2 Ditto ditto Min. ditte,, ... % aa As 61.4: Mean daily range of the Temperature during the month, is 16.8 Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer for the month, . eae 63.4: Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above mean Wet Bulb eee ee ee 5.6 Computed Mean Dew-point for the month, ... : ves 58.9 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above computed mean ideas point a 10.1 Inches Mean Elastic force of Vapour for the month, ... ae vw. 0.504 5 Troy grains Rféan Weight of Vapour for the month, he wake 5.56 Additional Weight of Vapour required for complete saturation, if 2.20 Mean degree of humidity for the month, complete saturation being unity, 0.72 : Inches Rained 5 days, Max. fall of rain during 24 hours, one he 0.80 Total amount of rain during the month, iG wae -. 1.91 Total amount of rain indicated by the Gauge attached to the es meter during the month, was aes ies ane 1.70 Prevailing direction of the Wind, .., eee Hc N. & W.&S. Vili Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of ths Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of January, 1866. Monruty Rusvuts. - Tables showing the number of days on which at a given hour any particular wind blew, together with the number of days on which at the same hour, when any particular wind was blowiug, it rained. Hour. A 87 18) (8) 181.18] (Sb .78t [ale EHaaee a \ri|.a SIE) a] | StF |e) | a) 2 NéiZ SE sli eisisliie tleizigis sig No. of days. Midnight, a 4 2 3 6 9 1 9 3 3 2 6 8 2 9 4 1 1 9 7 3 li 2 4 1 vm TZ 4 4 11 3 4| 1 "7 1 4, q 5 11 3 3 6 2 4 1 6 11 6 2 6 2 A 7 1o| 1} 3 5 2 3 2 4 2 8 cB ies ee 7, 2 2 3 3 2 9 12| 21 4 3 4, 2 2 3 1 10 10) 1} 5 3 4 1} 2 2 4 1 11 8 1] 4 2 6 1 2 8 Noon. 13! 11 3 1} 1:6 i vf 1 11 2 I 4| 113 3 Fi -2 il 3 3/1 3 3 7) an 3 3 2 i 4 1 7| 113 A, 5 1 Z| a 3 2 8 5 "| 2 1 4 9 6 8} 2 Lhd 5 5 7 9 i! 2 2 3 1 3 8 9) 1! 2 1 2 2 2 3 9 9} 111 2 1 3 1 3 10 9 3| 1) 2 2 4 2 3 1 7 1h 3 2 3 6 1 1 | | | | Meteorological Observations, 1x Abstract of the Results of the Howrly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of February, 1866. Latitude 22° 23’ 1” North. Longitude 88° 20’ 34” Kast. Height of the Cistern of the Standard Barometer above the Sea-level, 18 ft. 11 in. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. SH oy Q 5 £5; | Range of the Barometer ‘2 & | Range of the Tempera« rt ra during the day. As ture during the day. ‘By = PE Hae | Ag go? : ; a 5 3 : eae Max. Min. Diff. Sf Max. Min. | Diff. or O Ey eI q Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. fe) oO oO oO 1 29.982 | 30.052 | 29.934 | 0.118 63.1 66.9 60.0 6.9 2 994 .067 .946 121 64.3 71.6 58.4 | 13.2 3 .921 .013 .840 ga 65.3 73.8 57.2 | 16.6 4, .833 | 29.898 787 Aad 63.6 70.6 60.4 | 10.2 5 .848 .925 .766 .159 66.3 75.8 DbS.o | 18 6 .983 | 30.062 915 147 69.2 78.4 61.8 | 16.6 vj 30.045 138 985 wae 70.5 80.2 61.4 | 18.8 8 .024 SEO. .967 134 70.8 80.4 65.0" |) LAA 9 .06O 132 | .997 135 68.1 75.2 64.6 | 10.6 10 051 122 .982 .140 ye 5 81.7 62.0 | 19.7 fai 29.987 O41 .915 .126 69.9 80.0 65.4 | 14.6 12 .943 .013 .850 .163 66.8 71.2 62.4 8.8 13 30.037 124 986 .138 63.8 ThA 56.4.) 1487 14 .006 .075 937 .138 64.7 73.5 Dod |) igs TS 29.975 057 .919 138 67.3 76.4 58.6 | 17.8 16 .952 .040 .888 sLO2 69.3 78.4 59.8 | 18.6 17 .966 .046 .925 121 72.6 82.0 63.2 | 18.8 18 981 .073 .930 143 72.8 78.3 68.8 9.5 19 981 .062 .886 176 7A9 86.0 67.4 | 18.6 20 953 .039 896 | 143 71.9 80.2 | 67.8 | 12.4 21 945 .0238 897 .126 Face 81.8 67.8 | 14.0 22 " ,923 | 29.992 .856 -L36 72.0 81.0 63.2 | 17.8 23 .945 |} 30.021 894 127 2b 82.6 62.2 | 20.4 24 .967 .056 .916 .140 73.0 84.8 62.8 | 22.0 25 .937 .009 874 135 Vim 87.2 64.8 | 22.4, 26 887 | 29.959 824 boo 77.0 88.2 Giso |) 20 27 843 914 791 123 Via 89.2 68.4 | 20.8 28 815 .900 736 164 79.6 91.4 70.8 | 20.6 ' The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Ther- mometer Means are derived from the hourly observations made during the day, x Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of February, 1866. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—Continued. ms : ve) 4 | Soe is Ald) SR) 1 Brees el 5 © 66. | idgeeeii sa Ay © 5 5 |) Stee o@ = >) bP SS. Gs O Sees. | Hw» & a B E Re SS |b os | OS a 2 2 a “ ze 9 paee) oo wo a a mS | g|Eee oe 2 = = S oe | S45 | MSe =o A 2 B 43 eI EO | Sera io oa a & 9 B a8 d a®%? [SS] ges SF B 5 pa | § SH |3e8)eas = A o) A =| = & ea ‘oS A 5 SHS 5 - E i) ° 3 = 8 ae on es) Sipe i 8 | s- | s2 eee 6 & S 5S) 2 a PE ls.e] 8a Es| |e = | = eS (fhe | gam a 8 a ee ee Fl aa |S SE | abe. 5 5 b> 5 be § ¢2 |SES| sek zi A Oo A = a | BA SF SO, | wees | SUR = a ome = = a | = fo) to) oe) Co) Inches. | 'T. gr.” } Doge 1 72.9 8.5 | 66.9 14.5 0.657 7.06 4.21 0.63 2 72.8 9.5 | 66.1 16.2 .640 6-87 71 59 3 70.3 TP 1 yeaa 18.9 .568 oy 5.16 54 A, 69.4: 12.4 | 60:7 Zit 536 5.75 .65 .50 5 70.2 12.2. | 61,7 20.7- 004 93 .68 OL 6 69.4 12.4 | 60.7 21.1 506 WSs 65° 59 7 76.9 Of | Tag 9.7 197 8.56- 3.12 13 8 74.5 8.9 | 68.3 15.1 .688 7.37 4.59 .62 9 77.2 6:6 | 72.6 Dh ah 790 8.47 3.63° .70 10 771.3 6.1 | 73.0 10.4: SOL 58 38 72 11 72.8 10.8 | 65.2 18.4 .621 6.66 7m 5d 12 75.3 6.1 | G26 13.8 TLE 7.68 4.28: 64 13 Tat 6.6 | 72.1 11.2 778 8.34 3.59: 70 14 rhe OS} 7026 15.8 TAL 7.89 5.17 .60 15 75.0 9.3 | 68.5 15.8 .692 AL 4.87 .60 16 73.5 11.0 | 65.8 18.7: .634 647: 5.58: DO V7 74.2 9.8 | 67.3 16.7 .666 7.12 .05 59 18 74.8 8.6 | 68.8 14.6: L090" 48 4.48 63 19 75.6 8.9 | 69.4 15.1 113 .62 73° .62 20 73.6 10.7 | 66.1 18.2 .640 6.84. 5.44 56 21 75.4 10.1 | 68.3 12: 688: 7.34 38) 58 22 76.3 TOA |. ZOE 16.6. 429 76 42. 59 23 75.6 10.8 | 68.0 TS.42~)|" 21680: .26 .80- 56 24 78.6 6.3 | 74.2 10.7 .832 8.89 3.60. , ane 25 79.6 6.8 | 74.8 11.6. .849 9.04: 4.92: - .69 26 80.8 6-6] 7638 10.6: .905 61 3.84. 7 27 76.3 9.8 | 69.4 16.7- 713 7.59 5.36. oo 28 ho 5.8 | 75.0 <5) 854 9.12 3.37 - 13 a 29 75.1 6.8 | 70.3 11.6 734 7.89 5d 69 30 75.1 D9 | “71,0 10.0 751 8.09 05 13 31 77.3 6.4 | 72.8 10.9 195 o2 y9) sh All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. — +0 Meteorological Observations. XIX Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of March 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. 6 | Range of the Barometer =. |Range of the Tempera- oo s for each hour during BS ture for each hour "ooo the month. 2 during the month. oq ce Ps 5 Hour.| © Bo Ag g°423 | Max. | Min. | Diff. | 32 | Max. | Min. | Diff ad an Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. oe) ) ) ) Mid- night.| 29.821 | 30.007 | 29.706 | 0.301 79.1 82.8 | 72.5 | 10.3 1 807 .OOL .696 «305 78.6 82.0 72.4 9.6 2 794 | 29.985 .682 303 78.1 81.6 72.8 8.8 3 784 .978 Fi" | a0F 77.5 STB i fae8 |b tek 4, 781 .982 .668 314 77.2 81.6 72.8 8.8 5 796 995 .687 .308 76.8 81.4 71.6 9.8 6 815 | 30.009 707 302 76.4 81.1 71.5 9.6 7 .839 025 730 | .295 76.7 81.4 | 71.4 | 10.0 8 869 043 748 | .295 78.8 82.8 | 73.8 | 9.0 9 885 055 761 294 81.9 86.6 76.6 | 10.0 10 .889 .060 751 309 85.1 89.8 80.0 9.8 11 878 .056 769 | .287 87.9 92.4 | 83.8 | 8.6 | Noon. 851 031 -740 291 90.3 94.6 87.6 7.0 1 818 003 “il .292 92.0 96.0 89.2 6.8 2 .784-| 29.976 .666 a LO 93.4: 97.4 91.0 6.4 3 761 957 642 old 94.1 98.4 90.6 7s A 748 933 .625 308 94.0 98.6 89.8 8.8 5 745 .939 .619 320 92.5 97.4 87.6 9.8 6 152 950 624 326 88.9 93.6 84.6 9.0 7 £09 964 .633 aL . 86.0 90.6 82.6 8.0 8 793 .990 .666 O24 84.0 87.0 81.6 5.4 9 .819 | 30.009 .693 316 82.1 84.8 73.8 | 11.0 10 .830 021 707 314 80.9 83.8 78.2 7.6 i 831 .O19 .706 303 79.8 83.0 (4.2 8.8 The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Thermometer Means are derived from the observations made at the several hours during the month. xX Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of March 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) a ee 43 om : oi | Se 3itae 2 |) a Z as | 7a | Bs = ete 6 3 Ss | aos | me. 2 © © 8 Sa uo | oe eee ee = E E E os iS) 2 ‘a8 52° H oa 2 aay 2 2 = EES) oes mel ge | cc] g | Eo) Ego) Sega Fe a | Sis, [es | ee | Sees ge} |B | | | eee So jb |) eg | pe | Se | So ee ees Ss a OS am SI = SF = Sj) sos fy) ) Oo inches.,|.'T. gr. | T. pe Mid- f night.| 75.8 ad) | Sad 5.6 0.814 8.79 1.74 0.84 il 75.6 3.0 | 73.5 51 814 81 OF 85 2 75.4 2eh |) lao 4.6 814 sy Al .86 3 75.0 2.5 | 73.2 4.3 .806 15 29 87 4, 74.7 2D | 12:0 Ans hy iS) oe .66 .29 87 3) 74.5 2.3 | a0 3.9 197 .66 AE. 88 6 74.2 2.2 | C2nb 3.7 792 61 all 89 7 74.6 2 | Vert 3.6 803 12 08 89 8 75.2 a0. | 7 2e¥ 6.1 792 58 .86 82 9 75.8 6.1 | 71.5 10.4 .763 21 3.29 | 12 10 75.7 9.4} 69.1 16.0 £06 7.03 5.04 .60 iT oO?) 1298) 67:3 20.6 .666 06 6.58 52 Noon.| 74.9 15.4 | 65.7 24.6 | .632 6.68 7.95 46 1 74.6 TZAO)) 6422, 27:8 601 2 9.04 AL 2 74.5 18.9 | 63.2 | :30.2 682 obi 88 38 3 74.3 19.8 | 62.4.|, 31.7 | 567 5.93 10.39 36 4, 74.9 19.1 | 63.4.| :30.6 O86 6.13 14 38 5 fork 17.4.| 64.7;| °27.8 611 43 9.16 AL 6 75.1 13.8 | 66.8: 22.1 655 94 7.10 AQ 7 75.5 10.5 | 68.1 17.9 .684 7.28 5.63 56 8 75.1 8.9 | (68.9 ESL yal OL OL 4.66 .62 9 75.3 6.8 | 70.5 Ba ae 93 BOO, .69 10 75.8 5.1 | 72.2 Bic) Pow 8.40 2.70 .76 11 75.9 3.9 | :73.2 6.6 .806 70 2.05 81 =} All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. Meteorological Observations. . XXxI Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, im the month of March 13866. Solar Radiation, Weather. &c. Besoin e pe & Sst Prevailing .| .8 OS 2] direction of the General Aspect of the Sky. é le rg BSS Wind. A|s* 3s 0 |Inches | LP Tae9)| .... N. W.& W. &S. | Clear. -2| 142.0]... W. Clear. 3} 142.8; ... | W.&S. W. | Clear. 4/ 141.6] ... W.&S.WK&S. Clear. 5| 148.5]... W.&S. Clear. 6 | 142.0)... W. Clear. 7 | 141.5 S.& 8S. W. Clear. Seuds from S.between 4 &7a.m. DS. dW. Clear to 4a. M., scatd. ito9a. M., 8 | 142.4 clear afterwards. 9| 136.4 S. W. Clear, slightly foggy from 4 to 6 4. m. 10 | 137.2 Dy. ALN. Clear, slightly foggy from 3 to 8 4. m. 11 | 140.0 N. & W. Clear, slightly foggy at 4.4. m. 12 | 142.0 S. & N. Clear. 13 | 137.0 8. & S. W Clear to 2 a4. M., overcast to 6 A. M., clear afterwards. 14} 140.0 S. & W. Clear, slightly foggy at 1 a. Mm. 15 | 141.0 S. & W. Clear, slightly foggy from 3 to 54. mM. 16 | 150.0 S. W. & W. Seatd. clouds to 8 a. M., clear after- wards. ay } 137.0 S.&N Clear to 7 4. M.\1i to 7 P. M., clear afterwards. 18 | 134.7 S. & S. W. Ni to 8 p. M., clear afterwards. 19 | 142.0 W.&S8S.&8.W. | Nito 84. M., clear afterwards. 20 | 149.0 S.W.&W.&N.W.| Clear, foggy from 4 to 7 a. M. 21} 142.0 W.&S.W.&S Clear to 1 Pp. m., scatd. “i to 6 P. M., elear afterwards. 22 | 142.0 S.Ww.&W.&S Clear. 23 | 146.0 S.& W. Clear. 24 | 140.5 S. Clear. 25 | 141.0 S.&S. W. Scatd.~1 to 9 a. M., clear afterwards. 26 | 146.0 Ss. Clouds of different kinds. 27 | 142.5 S. Clear. 28 | 137.0 ih cee Clear to 6 A. M., scatd.“i to 5 Pp. M., overcast afterwards. Thin rain Inght- ning. and Thunder at 10 & 11 Pp. M. 29 | 132.0 S. Overcast to 6 A. M., scatd.i to 8 P. M. over cast afterwards Thin rain at Ll Pe: M. M1 Cirri, — 1 Strati,~i Cumuli, i Cirro-strati, ~ i Cumulo strati,~-i Nimbi, “i Cirro cumuli. XX Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of March 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &c. w . (22 2S 5 se Prevailing h ee pg ee he 5 direction of the General Aspect of the Sky. £/ 82 226 Wind | A)" leas 30 | 135.0 S “i to 10 a. mM. “i to 4p. m., clear afterwards. . 31/137.0| ... | E.&8.&8.W. | Clearto4a.m. “itol rp. m. Scatd. Ni afterwads. Meteorological Observations. XX Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of March 1866. Montuyuy REsvutts. Inches. Mean height of the Barometer for the month,,... en, SOLOLE Max. height of the Barometer occurred ai 10 a. M. on the 12th, ... 30.060 Min. height of the Barometer occurred at 5 p. M. on the 22nd, _ ... 29.619 Extreme | range of the Barometer during the month, we ww. 0.441 Mean of the daily Max. Pressures, ... = se ... 29.893 Ditto ditto Min. ditto sat va. 20.740 Mean daily range of the Barometer during the month, .., a» ) Chios ) Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer for the month, ... a > oe Max. Temperature occurred at 4 Pp. M. on the 22nd, ae a | See Min. Temperature occurred at 7 a. M. on the 6th, ret ak ey Extreme range of the Temperature during the month, ... ia 20 Mean of the daily Max. Temperature .. an a a | oe Ditto ditto Min. ditto, bik GR Mean daily range of the Temperature during the month,.. av” Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer for the month, ... Go. Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer 8.8 Computed Mean Dew-point for the month, 68.9 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above computed n mean Dew-point. . 15.0 ‘ites Mean Elastic force of Vapour for the month, ... ae te O01 Troy grains. Mean Weight of Vapour for the month ese ie Additional Weight of Vapour required for complete saturation, oe) AG? Mean degree of humidity for the month, complete saturation being unity 0.62 Inches. Drizzled 2 days, —Max. fall of rain during 24 hours a sat Nil Total amount of rain during the inonth, ee Nil Prevailing direction of the ‘Wind, ee i §.& W.&S. W, XXIV Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, on the month of March 1866. Monrtuiy ReEsvutts. Tables shewing the number of days on which at a given hour any particular wind blew, together with the number of days on which at the same hour, when any particular wind was blowing, it rained. Hour. ; : : al fel ie] 2] lél lel jel/al leks gig) eke) See. F se al2 “PCPEPPePPTT Tree | | No.of days Midnight. Lp fod. Wp 3) 1 i 2} 418 8 2 2 1 20 8 2 3 Li {17 8 4 A 1| 15 9 5 5 1; 13} [10 6 6 1 1 14, | 9 5 7 1 1 12) fll 5 8 3 AD cpt 6 9 1 9 9} 10) 42 10 2 5) $10) flo) 74 11 5 1 1 3 6 9| 46 Noon. HPQ eee) Tel 5} | 4 7 7) 16 1 2| lal 42 3| | 6) fill [6 2 2 1 2 ut 3 3} 115) 74 3 4 2 1 2 6} flo} pl A, 3 2 1 6 3) Lol “pe 5 3 1 ] 1 8 2; 714) Fl 6 ja) Jil fal. 9} | 2: fiz) {2 4 2 1 2 14 1 9 42 8 2 1 17 1 9} yl 9 1 1 21 3 Al Jl 10 1 sey, a 5} 1] 3 it 1}, es 6 4' 241 et et ee Meteorological Observations. XXV Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of Aprit 1866. Latitude 22° 33’ 1” North. Longitude 88° 20734” Kast. Height of the Cistern of the Standard Barometer above the sea level, 18-11 feet. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical_elements dependent thereon. ae o 8 Range of the Barometer = = | Range of the Tempera- Stes during the da f= | ture during the d SES uring the day.. 1% ure during the day. © HS Date. | 5 Bo | 5 2 & 2° | Max. | Min. Dif. | £3 | Max. | Min. | Diff. st re) | = H Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. 0 0 0 oO 1 29.842 | 29.976 | 29.781 0.195 82.5 89.9 76.9 | 13.0 2 844 915 .796 LIQ 82.6 91.8 76.4, 15.4 3 853 955 BOL 154 77.4 83.4 73.6 9.8 4 811 882 753 129 78.6. 89.0 tLA | UG 5 -806. 879 125 1L5A) 82.1 93.0 72.8 | 20.2: 6 138 834 .620 214 83.9 95.0 78.2 | 16.8 7 -695 472 617 145 85.6: 96.8: | 77.2 | 19.6. 8 .688 760 .621 139 86.6: 97.6, | 78.0:| 19.6 9 707 794. .629 .165 88.2 98.8 | 81.0)| 17.8: 10 .655 .730 562 168 89.3 102.6 81.8 | 20.8: oe ay, .O16 685 545. 140 89.1 102.3 78:8: | 23.5. 12 -642 .709 O76. 133 88.1 100.2: 77.4. | 22.8: 13 -730 810 671 139 87.7 100.2 77.0: | 23.2) 14, 716 799 .634 165 88.5 101.8 79.2: | 22.6. 15 674 747 881 166: 88.8 102.6. 80.6 | 22.0) 16 .676 .736 .630 -LO06: 86.3 93.8: |e SO:7 1- 13et 17 -700 .766 642 124 85.3 90.8: 81.4. 9.4), 18 723 -796 .618 178 85.1 92.1 80.8 | 11.3: 19 734 .812 .679 133 86.4: 95.6 81.2 | 14.4. 20 803 -894 132 162 86.8 94.0 $1.4. | 12.6 21 914 | 30.062 .806 .256 82.4: 91.4: 69.6, | 21.8: 22° .983 074) .899 175 75.5 84.4 | 68.4 | 16.0: 23 951 -039 .845 194: 79.3 88.2 73-0.) Vue: 24 .902.| 29.973 804 169 82.5 91.2 75.0 | 16.2: 25 .835 Rey) 721 196 83.6: 94.2 | 75.7 | 18.5 26 .766 -853 .660 193 85.7 96.4 #7.4. | 419.0: 27 .796 858 Jal 127 86.1 94.4 | 77.8 | 16.6 28 853 995 788 207 80.3 89.8 72.2 | 17.6 29 874 .959 192 167 78.2 87.0 73.0 | 14.0: 30 .839 -900 751 148 81.0 90.6 72.0 | 18.6 The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb ancien Means are derived, from the hourly observations, made during e day. . XXV1 Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, in the month of April 1866. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) = ' A te = a Gy gy es ae g a aes 3 og.) 2884 ee. rahe) | ae ole Ss | Ss | See) ats a) o id & G4 42 a = ede = a > = ° o 98 Ons ~~ eat ° o ie © + e oan) of an Date. 5) 4 3 A = S "p.2 ee 2 Ee Sf + 2/2) s. | ds | SS | eae | See Pala |ze| aa | 22 | BS |geeve ee ond ~~ ~Y Sac] b | 8] be Pee | oo | ee eeee = A oS A = i hale = Oo Oo ) ) Inches. | T..er.” | “Paar 1 75.1 74} 69.9] 12.6 | 0.725 eT7 3.87 0.67 2 75.1 75 | 608 | 12:8 bes. 74, 94, .66 3 71.1 6.3 | 66.7 | 10.7 .653 07 2.94 Bri: A 69.9 67 | 628 || Was 593 6.41 3.97 62 5 73.2 8.9 | 67.0] 15.1 .659 7.08 4.43 62 6 77.3 6.6) 727 || 12 .792 8.49 3.64 70 7 95.2 | 10.4 | 67.9 | 17.7 .679 7.24, 5.52 SY 8 79.2 74) 74.8} 11.8 .849 9.04 4.10 69 9 81.2 70 | F7.05\ ) Tie .910 .67 .09 70 10 80.4 8.9 | 75.1] 14.2 .857 08 5.13 64 11 76.7 | 12.4] 69.3] 19.8 atl 7.52 6.60 53 12 75.3 | 128 | 676 | 205 .672 13 59 52 13 77.6. |)101 | Fle | 16.2 .763 8.11 5.45 .60 14 78.2 \° 90.3 | 7210") | 165 776 WA 67 59 15 79.8 9.0| 74.4] 14.4 .838 .89 at 64 16 80.7 5.6 | 76.8 9.5 .905 9.63 3.39 74 47, 79.7 5.6 | 75.8 9.5 .876 35 .29 74 18 79.7 5.4 | 75.9 9.2 879 AO a 453 19 80.1 6.3. | Yea" | 10:7 .873 .30 76 JA 20 80.4 6.4 | 76.6'| | 10:2 .899 57 64 72 21 76.2 6:2 | 71.9) 1025- 773 8.29 32 Rie! 22 70.7 4.8 | 67.3 8.2 .666 7.25 2.21 ie 23 74.6 any | Fz3 8.0 .758 8.20 .39 17 24 76.1 6.4 | 71.6] 10.9 .766 122 3.42 We: 25 78.0 5.6 | 74.1 9.5 .830 .89 14 74 26 78.7 70 | 78%) 109 .822 76 4.04, 68 27 80.6 5.5 | 76.7 9.4 .902 9.62 3.33 74 28 76.3 4.0 | 73.5 6.8 .814--| 8.78 2.13 81 29 74.0 LN rg Ui 7.1 753 16 .09 .80 30 74.1 6.9 | 69.3 | 11.7 yall 7.64 3.50 69 All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. — Meteorological Observations. XXV11 Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of April 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. 63 Range of the Barometer <=. | Range of the Tempera- 5s for each hour during a g ture for each hour ae q the month. 2 during the month. ® # Hour.| © oe = 2 aan : - 4 : ; S a oo | Max. Min. | Diff. : = Max. |-Min. | Diff. - as = Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. oy) oy) oy) ) Mid- night.| 29.783 | 30.042 | 29.623 | 0.419 79.5 83.4 68.8 | 14.6 1 771 | 29.963 .608 309 79.0 83.0 68.4 | 14.6 2 .761 .982 O93 389 78.8 82.6 68.8 | 13.8 3 752 959 O80 379 78.5 82.2 68.4 | 13.8 A 755 .960 587 373 78.2 82.0 69.0 | 13.0 5 770 982 .600 382 78.0 82.2 69.0 |, 13.2 6 .790 | 30.005 .620 385 77.8 82.2 68.6 | 13.6 7 881i 038 .640 398 78.8 83.4 70.4 | 13.0 8 833 .068 .665 403 81.2 85.8 70.4. |. Bet 9 849 O74. 684: 390 84.3 88.8 73.3 | 15.5 10 851 .070 685 385 86.9 92.2 76.0 | Wee ki 841 O14 .683 ol 89.1 95.6 76.3 | 19.3 Noon. 822 007 .662 340 90.6 98.9 77.6) 2a 1 91 | 29.971 .627 B44 91.9 100.2 78.0 | 22.2 2 757 947 585 362 92.7 101.8 82.0 | 19.8 3 129 018 565 303 93.0 102.3 82.8 | 19.5 4, 709 899 555 44 92.4 102.6 S).0 |. 216 5 705 £905 545 .360 90.6 100.8 79.0 | 21.8 6 127 917 .Od7 .360 87.7 96.4 70.2 | 29.2 7 741 948 O17 371 84.7 91.6 72.8 | 18.8 8 .768 963 605 308 82.6 89.8 73.6 | 16.2 9 783 .989 632 B07 81.6 87.0 73.4 | 13.6 10 796 | 30.016 641 Yi) 80.6 85.0 fa. | 12.8 11 195 062 .639 423 80.0 84.4 43.0 | fll. The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Thermometer Means are derived from the observations made at the several hours during the month. XXV11 Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, in the month of April 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) + : us ‘ = = eS ae Sanctions | Jer 8 aid | a | 88 2 © ry 5 Ce 45 aS Ra 3 eo) ey ie * 23 |\poel cee ‘Hour. im 7 = i 3 s Fea o 3 © Bing - ae ea a 2 =. os |e g | SEs FS ES 212. | S| ES1e es SEB ag a | Fg da | ¢ Sas | og SO b =I bo Se = = aes oS ea | F181 BS | Se | Se Seelam = = ) = = ao “5 < =~ o za) oO ° Inches: | Togr. | Tor Mid- : might.| 76.1 34 | 73.7 5.8 0.819 8.85 1.81 0.83 1 76.0: 3.0) | Fa9 ol 824 92 08 8d - 2 0.1 2.7 | {AR 4.6 832 9.00 4A, .86 ee: 76.1 2.4) 74.4 4.1 .838 08 2b .88 4 76.0 2.2 | 74.5 Bw | .840: at 14 89 3) 75.8 2.2) 74.3 Sw 835 05 14 .89 6 75.8 2.0 | 74.4 3.4 .838 10 03 .90 @ 46.3 25 | 74.5 43 .840 11 .oo 87 3 Vie 4.0 | 74.4 6.8 838 02 2.19 81 9 77.8 65 | 73.2 j1.1 -806 8.63 3.68 .70 10 78.1 8.8 | 72.8 14.1 95 47 4.78 64 a 78.1 11.0 | 71.5 17.6 763 08 6.04 OT Noon.| 77.7 12.9 | 70.0 | 20.6 ae 7.66 7.10 52 1 77.9 14.0 | 69.5 22.4 715 3 £9 AD 2 Lid 15.0 | 68.7 24.0 -697 2 8.36 APS 3 77.6 15.4 | 68.4 24.6 .696 25 56 46 A 771A 15.0 | 68.4 24.0 .690 28 .29 AT 5) Fine 13.3 | 69:3 203 gtd AO 7.26 1 6 77.5 10.2 | 71.4 16.3 761 8.08 5.48 .60 7 76.9 7.8 | 71.4 13.3 Ol 13 4.29 .66 8 76.7 5.9 | 72.6 10.0 .790 49 3.19 73 9 76.5 mi | 729) Sez foe 57 2.77 76 10 76.3 Aco. | fans isa .809 72 .29 79 at OL a9 | 7aA 6.6 Bole 18 3.06 1 All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. — Meteorological Observations. XX1X Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the mouth of April 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &c. aa |PE Prevail; |-3 8 | So ilsas revailing Ae | eee hO = 2! direction of the Pi | General Aspect of the Sky. = ie 3 & 2 & Wind. Oe AIA li Ag | o |Inches | Ib 1; 132.0| ,.. |W.S. W. & E.S.E.) 2.75 Overcast to Noon,\ni to 5 P. M., | clear afterwards. 2/1410; .,. |8.S.E. & W.S. W.| 1.25 }~i to 7 a. m., scatd. “4 tod . P. M., overcast to8 Pp. M.\l afterwards. wien |... an.& N.N. W. 2.25 \\-i to 3 P. M., overcast after- / wards. Thin rain between 6 / | &7a.M.&at8&10P. m. 4 | 128.0 iw. S. W. 0.25 \\wi tod a. m., “i to Noon, | ¢lear afterwards. 9| 135.0); ... |W.S.W.&.8.S.W] ... (Clear to 11 a. m., scatd. “i to 5 p. M., clear afterwards. Seon ... \s.5..W.&S. W. 2.25 \Clear to 7 a. m., scatd. “i to 7 p. M. clear. afterwards, light- ning totheS. H.at10&11~.m. 7 | 141.0 S.W. & W.N. W.| 0.50 |Clear scuds, from 8S. W. from 4 to 7 a. M, Foggy at 6 a. m. oie ... «is.& W.S. W. 0.25 |Clear to 10 a. m. Seatd. ito 5 P. M., clear afterwards. ' 91 140.0 S. by E. & S. ... |Scuds from S. to N. to 9 a4. M. clear afterwards. ‘10 | 143.0 S.&S.S. W. ... |Seuds from S. W. to N. E. to 8 a. M. clear afterwards. 11} 144.6; ... |S.&N. W. ... |Clear. 12/1405] ... |S. & variable 0.50 Clear. Foggy at 6 & 7 a. M. 13 | 145.5| ... |S. & variable 0.50 |Clear. Foggy from 5 to 7 4. M. ae t4g.5". ... |S... W. 0.75 |Clear. 15 | 148.4 S.S.W.&S8.byE.| ... . |Clear to 3.4. mu. Scatd. clouds to 8 a. M., clear afterwards. 16 | 132.4; ... |S. &8,S. W. (high) 2.00 [Clear to 9 4. m. Seuds from S. toN.to 3p.m.clear afterwards. 171 -199.0\ ... Ss. (high) 4.50 |Clear to 44. m. Seuds from S. . to N. to 3 vp. m. Overcast to 7 p. M. clear afterwards, light- ning to the 8. at 7 & 8a. m., thin rain between 4&5 4. M. .8. W. &S. 3.25 |Clouds of different kinds. .&5.5.W.£S.by W. 2.00 |Clouds of different kinds to 6 P. M., clear afterwards. Light- ning to the S. EH. at 44. mM. 20 | 138.0) "|S. & 8.8. W. 1.80 |Clouds of different kinds. Light- | | ning to the E. 18 | 128.7 | 19 | 130.2 MM © XXX Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of Aprit 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &c. B; |S a: Ze iy “2s 3 § qo ¢ Prevailing FE: = 6 we © © 2| direction of the ‘| General Aspect of the Sky. o Sg ia .o : 3 a iss S a i) Wind. = ; o |Inches tb 21) ...... 4|8. & 8. 8. E. 10.50 Overcast Lightning Thunder & C 0.51 rain at 10& 11 p. m. Hails at . 10 Pp. M. 22 | 123.2 ... |S. E. & variable 2.00 \Overcast to Noon\i & _i af- | terwards, Lightning & Thun- der at Midnight light rain at Midnight,1 & from 4 to 6a.m. 23 | 128.0| 0.148. W.& N. N. W. | 2.80 \Wi& ito6 Pp. . clear after- wards.Lightning toS.at9p.M. — ; Rain at 4&5 Pp. M. 24 135.8, ... |E.S. E. & variable.| 1.00 |Overcast to 3 a. m. clear to 9 A. M. Scatd.%i to 6 Pp. M. clear afterwards, Lightning to S.W ; at 1 a. M. 25 132.0| ... |IE.& 8.8. W. 1.00 |Clear to 6 a. um. Seatd. i to 4 Pp. M. clear afterwards. 26) 128.5) ... |S.S.W.&S. 1.25 |Clear to 1 Pp. m. ~i afterwards Lightning to the W. & S. at 7&8 p.m. Thunder at 7 Pp. M. Light rain between 7 & 8 P. M. Af | 1BW6 1 BY AISASE TNS. 2k 1.00 |7i to a. mM. Seuds from 8. to 10 A. M. Vi to 4 p.m. clear after- wards. it 28) | sie 1.16/S8. E. & E. 2.75 \Clear to 7 a. m. Scuds from S. tol0a.m.Overcastafterwards Lightning to the E. from 6 to — 9 p.m. Thunder at5 & 6 P.M. rain at Noon, 5,6 & 8 Pp. M. 29 | 128.0) |... |W. & variable. 2.00 |Scatd. “i to 5 a. M. \_i& “1 to lp. mM. overcast afterwards — Lightning to the EK. at8 & 9 ~ . p. Mm. Thin rain at 6 Pp. M. 30} 131.0; ... |S. W.&N.N.E. | 5.00 |Scatd. i& Vito 1 p.m. Scatd — i to5 p.m. overcast after- — wards Lightning to the S. W. © at 9 p.m. Thin rain at 10 & ll P.M. Mi Cirri, — i Strati,~i Cumuli,‘-i Cirro-strati, ~i Cumulo strati,~-i Nimbi, “i Cirro cumuli. \ a * Fell from 10 p. m. of the 21st to 6 a. mu. of the 22nd. Meteorological Observations. XXX Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of April 1866. Montuiy ReEsvtrs. Inches Mean height of the Barometer for the month,. ... 29.779 Max. height of the Barometer occurred at 9 a. Mm. on the 22nd, ... 30.074 Min. height of the Barometer occurred at 5 p. M. on the llth, ... 29.545 Extreme range of the Barometer during the month, a ... 0.529 Mean of the daily Max. Pressures, _... if one ... 29.863 Ditto ditto Min. ditto : ... 29.700 Mean daily range of the Barometer during the month, vy. Q163 oO Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer for the month, a ae Max. Temperature occurred at 4 Pp. mM. on the 10th & 15th . ... 102.6 Min. Temperature occurred at 1 & 3 4. M. on the 22nd ___.. ., GGe Extreme range of the Temperature during the month, oe we BA2 Mean of the daily Max. Temperature .. ay Si .. 940 Ditto ditto Min. ditto, — .“ cs aa Mean daily range of the Temperature during the month,.. wi Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer for the month, ... 76.9 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer, 7.2 Computed Mean Dew-point for the month, #2 71.9 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above computed mean Dew- -point. . 12.2 ‘aes Mean Elastic force of Vapour for the month, ... i ee DOTS Troy grains. Mean Weight of Vapour for the month a Bae Additional Weight of Vapour required for complete saturation, ... 3.93 Mean Eee of humidity for the month, complete saturation being unity 0.68 Inches. Rained 9 days,—Max. fall of rain during 24 hours ee oe lel G Total amount of rain during the month, | ey HSE Total amount of rain indicated by the Gauge attached to the anemo- meter during the month. ee 1.37 Prevailing direction of the Wind, .... 8.&8.8.W.& W.S. W. XXXI1 Meteorological Observations. « TS © ‘WO ULe}T| np oa Siren = = |Ad4q°N], La i=. — re Wie “WO UIR (ee ° . . i, es onlin mene | Ss NO oOA ao <> MANN} 7c "uO UIBY Chey 5 . G = 0.) wee = 5 |-vo meg => Ss re . here cal 4 — S89 SN 2 5 “MN M — SS he mecomeaucees g = a4 ON = ° 6 ae te > 1 N AQ" M = = 2y ‘UO ULB Sua ae a =a aS SS ee Sree eee 8 © | UO Urey Co. o.8 ‘ak Tee cass © Se /S 4d MM S oH Sy (qiges [OO Se leo wile wir ont oid, Or uies Fagor NAMA HID FOR WAIAAAAAAAN ~ ~~ app A 'S'’M a > .8 | -uo urey i $ aoa A SE, SOS a Sa OSes” Te ae & By, [wo uray is 3 Mg 9] OORT OOOO ONAN O AAO acs = Bef DS) ee eee > urg | UO Uley S 3 oS prado : “SE mM aqis| ANON aaAaN NORNAAAS Qa , | -uo wey = = Seas] Qh CHOFAR COW ONY BH OHSOCOWASANG ~ \ ; » 2 GaN eaee Seg ee yuo Ulhel S435 “a Aq“ abe s—4& O&O oD as 4 —— =O Se gw =| = So 2p] uo urey| ofa sia ace SA ANHOGS A = nN SS Noo AaAal = Saige saree 28 “UO ULB YT S 3 5 z : e } co] So 6 = SE 7g) waa Aaaaa ny oY S 8. |-ao ley S 86) -a-n ae ARAN 4 aa AS ihr aie! RE S [2 » | uO Uley ‘s AGEy. : = ee ek ae S 8 » | Uo uley a a a Se eee eee NS Sa ot ae ali -% Wee a GS ak ES pS a Sa eeene Say Wea ik AS SSS | uo uey ro j- ; al al i} li > y 7s [N Aq a = oy: ! ii i a ees = ee 55 SS) 6 9D: re re Ss & at NS aN a4 4 ee . . © i o be ae Li Dao cNe = 2 oe TO Uley = bp oR “ME Nebo SAAN H a4 % KEIN IN ge ‘E ‘UO UBT o) ly ae gor fe 4a a a . ro rat af gee Se ; ra | te NT ANNA Aa = an nN AA mae e cH a 5 S j re 5 = nS =o ° x Ai Meteorological Observations. XXXII Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of May 1866. Latitude 22° 33’ 1” North. Longitude 88° 20’ 34” East. Height of the Cistern of the Standard Barometer above the sea level, 18-11 feet. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. Cpe cm sg _ | Range of the Barometer = # | Range of the Tempera- aes during the day. ae ture during the day. 3 om ‘- Date. | © E a 2 2 aoc | Max. | Min. | Diff. | 23 | Max. | Min. | Diff = Sa Sia Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. ) fy) ) Co) 1 29.827 | 29.900 | 29.736 0.164 81.4 91.0 72.4 | 18.6 2 838 .890 807 083 78.8 87.4 73.6 | 228 3 “09 .855 .686 .169 78.9 88.9 71.7 | 2 4, 705 758 .628 .130 79.5 89.8 74.6 | 15.2 5 .659 126 069 157 82.2 91.2 12.7 | 186 6 079 .630 482 .148 84.2 93.2 76.6 | 16.6 7 .563 .607 O14 .093 84.4 93.0 76.0 | 170 8 583 634: 042 .092-| 87.2 94.9 82. 12.9 9 611 701 552 149 88.3 98.6 82.4 | 16.2 10 674 733 .606 ny 88.8 99.2 SL.8. | ge 11 .672 .739 064 175 86.9 97.8 78.4 | 19.4 12 .622 675 043 132 87 <7 96.7 80.8 | 15.9 13 645 694, 088 106 88.5 96.6 82.0 | 14.6 14 .681 .740 .612 128 87.4 96.4: 76.0 | 20.4 15 .680 751 595 .156 84.8 95.0 76.4 | 18.6 16 652 .693 O61 1382 85.8 96.3 74.2 | 22.1 17 .666 135 .600 135 85.9 94.3 |. 78.2 | 16.1 18 .665 720 .586 134 87.0 95.8 LiO)) LSe8 19 661 .720 604 16, +879 97.3, | (9:2 | B8eh 20 .681 740 624 116 89.3 of.9 83.0 | 14.8 21 .670 134 .576 .158 89.3 97.2 83.8 | 13.4 22 621 .672 532 .140 89.2 95.8 83.8 | 12.0 23 577 642 A495 147 89.3 96.4 83.8 | 12.6 24, 599 647 497 .150 88.3 96.8 80.4 | 16.4 25 595 657 523 134 90.0 97.8 84.0 | 13.8 26 614 .680 .5d3 27 90.7 102.6 83.0 | 19.6 27 089 .660 .505 155 92.0 105.8 83.0 | 22.8 : 28 003 617 A79 138 91.2 101.0 84.4 | 16.6 29 547 .623 476 147 90.3 98.2 84.6 | 13.6 30 .610 677 542 136 90.2 98.4, | 83.0 | 15.4 31 .633 .690 037 153 | 90.6 98.0 | 85.0 | 13.0 The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Bp moniter Means are derived, from the hourly observations, made during the day. ; XXXIV Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, im the month of May 1866. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) 1h ' fs : Ces 3 Se Sa sy os Be SieolyBa) 3°] Aovdagrac| ng Se aaa a |e > Ss | SSE /a75 a o = & G1 42 a= = ey 2-8 Z 8 é 3 © 28 = Sa | o8 bp Date. |; Poe | eee, ze ae eo | ess S23 j2 | Bo) Spd sgn) San qaee eee a & | #4 6 | 8s | ES Le oeiee es ge Bt) 8 1 8 a | ee. Pe ee 2g = pe = Pay oF oo ses] cs / A Fa oe) ey = a7 | q = ) o | 6 Oo Inches: 4 Toe.) “ae 1 72.7 8.7 | 66.6 14.8 0.651 6.99 4.28 0.62 2 744) 4.4.) 71.3 7.5 758 8.20 2.24 19 3 72.6 6.3 | 68.2 10.7 686 7.4L 3.06 py’ A 74.1 5.4 | 70.3 9.2 734 .93 2.73 74 5 76.2 6.0 | 72.0 10.2 776 8.33 3.21 72 6 79.3 Ae), SO 8.3 879 9.42 2.82 77 7 80.7 Seb Cook 6.3 943 10.10 21 82 8 82.4 4.8 | 79.5 hake 985 AQ 88 79 9 82.0 6.3 | 78.2 10.1 946 05 3.79 73 10 81.7 ie RY Fe: oa feng 922 Suri) 4.21 70 11 89.2 6.7 | 76.2 10.7 887 A5 3.80 71 12 81.5 6.2.) 77.8 Sas, 934 .93 .63 73 13 81.7 6.8 | 77.6 10.9 928 .85 4.03 71 14, 79.6 4-3-7 4.9 12.5 851 .O4 Al 67 15 78.5 6.3 | 74.1 10.7 830 8.87 3.59 71 16 80.5 5.3 | 76.8 Spa) 905 9.65 18 75 17 80.9 5.0 | 77.4 8.5. 922 83 OA 76 18 81.5 5.5 | 78.2 8.8 946 10.07 22 76 19 82.3 5.6 | 78.9 9.0 967 28 06 75 20 83.3 6.0) 29:7 SHO 992 ol 10 74 21 82.7 6.6 | 78.7 10.6" 961 18 4.03 72 22 83.1 6.1 | 79.4 9.8 983 AL 3.75 74 23 83.2 6.1 | 79.5 9.8 986 45 76 74: 24, 80.4 Loo Log 12.6 873 9.26 454 67 25 83. 6.8 | 79.1 10.9 973 10.30 20 71 26 83.6 ede Goes 11.4 979 36 44, 70 27 83.8 8:2 | 78.9 13.1 .967 20 5.16 66 28 85.0 6.2 | 81.3 2.9 1.043 11.02 4.00 73 29 84.2 6.1) SO 9.8 O17 10.76 3.87 74 30 82.7 7.0. 18.2 12.0 0.946 OO 4.59 69 dL 83.3 7.3 | 78.9 aR aay .967 22 54, 69 All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. y Meteorological Observations. XXKV Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, mm the month of May 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. 63 Range of the Barometer . | Range of the Tempera- eG. for each hour during 5S ture for each hour cE 4 the month. 2 during the month. o Hour. i ae 4 : “A qj . . ePice | Max. | Min. | Diff. | 3 | Max. | Min. | Diff. as ak Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. ) 0 ) tf) Mid- night.| 29.660 | 29.868 | 29.545 | 0.323 82.2 86.8 | 73.2 | 13.6 .650 .858 534 | .324 $1.9 86.2..| 73.2 | Taw 2 .639 .839 525 | .314 81.7 85.6 | 72.9 | Tae 3. .630 .826 511 | .815 81.4 85.8 | 72.6 | 13.2 A, 635 .823 531 | .292 81.1 85.8 | 72.2 | 13.6 5 .646 .830 540] .290 81.0 85.6 | 71.7 | 13.9 6 .660 .846 571.| 276 81.1 86.6 | 72.0 | 14.6 7. 677 .868 573 | .295 82.5 88.2 | 73.4] 14.8 8 .693 895 582.| .313 85.2 89.8 | 77.0 | F238 9 .700 .900 .582.| .318 88.1 93.6. | 80.7 | 12398 10. i) .896 .582.| 314 90.5 96.5 | 83.6 | 12.9 11 -690 874 .568 | .306 92.6 97.4 | 85.2 | 12.2 Noon. .673 851 548 .303 94.1 101.4 85.6 | 15.8 1 .650 .827 .539 292 95.1 103.0 86.8 | 16.2 2. .626 .820 O2r.| .299 95.3 104.4 74.3 | 30.1 3. .604 818 512 -306 95.4 105.8 76.7|. 29.1 A. 585 811 A481 .330 94.3 | 105.0 75.6 | 29.4 5 576 812 476 396 92.7 101.5 75.7 | 25.8 6 589 813 A488 325 89.8 96.5 74.8 | 21.7 2 .613 .822 496 326 | 86.8 91.6 74.2 | 17.4 8 .635 .838 .516 322 84.6 90.0 74.2 | 15.8 9. .653 843 549 294; 83.7 88.2 73.6 | 14.6 10. .661 842 561 281 83.3 88.0 74.2 | 13.8 11 .663 .856 573 283 82.7 87.6 73.8 | 13.8 The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Thermometer Means are derived from the observations made at the several hours during the month. XXXV1 Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of May 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—/(Continued.) Yr ‘ . = Sey gy ea, oa ik +3 hy oH © Gus as - e | gas 2 gis | 27 Bd Be za a A 2 =o oes | ase oS = 2 2 ‘$2 >) 70 lee ple = E E E se es |= eee Hour. a ’ = i = 3 a 3 a Beco D 5 Ses: 3S = @| wag Pe | | 24 3. | Se | eS seeeencee qq 4 = Ms q 2 Ss OB a re I a a a 3 | mae | sea SO bs = bs Sa S s a) eo so SA A S am Ss S-5 ar S| sss () fo) ) ) Inches. | T..gr.:| T.ge. Mid- , night.| 78.6 3.6 | 76.1 6.1 | 0.885 9.51 2.03 0.82 HT 78.7 3.2 | 76.5 5°4 .896 .65 1.79 84 2 78.7 3.0 | 76.6 5.1 .899 .67 70 85 3 78.7 2.7 | 76.8 4.6 .905 F/G! 54 .86 A 78.7 2.4 | 77.0 A.1 .910 SL 36 .88 5 3.7 2.0 | F7ek 3.9 .913 84 .30 .88 6 79.0 2 MY OS 3.6 .925 .96 21 .89 7 79.9 A6 | “7ack A.A, 943 10.14 50 87 8 81.0 4.2 | 78.1 GL .943 .08 2.53 .80 9 81.8 6.3 | 78.0 10.1 .940 9.99 3.73 73 10 82.3 8.2 | 77.4 13.1 .922 75 4.97 .66 11 83.0 S64 fie 15.4 .916 65 5.98 .62 Noon.| 83.2 10.9 | 76.7 17.4 .902 AT 6.85. 58 1 83.6 Tn |) G27. 18.4 .902 A5 7.34 06 2 83.2 Tl 768 19.4 879 21 .68 5d 3 83.1 Ws aN 5 bi 19.7 .875 13 81 4 A, 82.9 EA, to 76s 18.2 .885 .28 13 57 5 82.5 10.2 | 76.4 16.3 ' 893 Al 6.27 .60 6 | 818 | 8.0] 77.0| 12.8 .910 63. | 4.79 67 7 80.5 6.3 | FO" 10.1 .902 .60 3.61 73 8 79.4 5.2 | 75.8 8.8 .876 or .02 76 9 79.1 A.6 | 75.9 7.8 879 42 2.65 78 10 78.9 4.4. | 75.8 7.5 .876 39 54 9 il 78.8 Boo We HOul. 6.6 .885 910) .22 81 All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. — Meteorological Observations. XXXVil Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of May 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &e. "way 2 2 & 38 q Prevailing & iS s| a8 = 5| direction of the ‘cz, | General Aspect of the Sky. ~=|a KS a= mor Wind. ip Ala * |eic as o (Inches ; tb 1| 180.5; ... |S. & variable. 3.50 |Overcast to 2 a. M., scatd. \i to 3 p. M., scatd. \i & ~i after- wards. Thin rain at Midnight. 2| 126.0) ... |S. by W.&N.E. | 3.00 Scatd..ito6 a.m. \Wi to Noon \ni & \Wi afterwards. Light- ning to 8. E.atl p.m. Thunder at 2 p.m. Thin rain at2 & 8 p.m. 3| 126.0; .. |N. W. &S. by E. 1.75 |\ni to 5 a. M. scatd. \i to 11 A.M. Wi & %i afterwards. Lightning to W. at 8 & 9 P. M. 4 | 129.6| 0.88 |S. by E. & E. 2.20 \Wito34.mM. Scatd. “ito 1 Pp. m. \~i afterwards. Thunder at 3&4. mM. Lightning at4&8 p.m. Hail at 4p. m. Rain from 3 to 5 P. M. Sraco2i.. IE & S. 0.50 |Secatd. “i to 7 p. M., clear after- wards. 6| 127.0; 0.31 |IS.S.B.&S. 2.70 |Clear to 1 a. mM. Seuds from S. tolla. m., scatd. “ito 3 P. m. Overcast afterwards. Thunder at 7 & 8 p. m. Lightning from 7 tollpe. m. Rain from 6 to 8 P. M. 7| 129.0; ... |S.&8.S.E. & E. | 1.00 |\Scatd. “i to 4p. m., clear after- wards. 8| 135.0; ... |S. by BE. & 8. 1.00 |Clear to 4 4. m. Seuds from S to A.M., scatd. “i to 4 P. M., clear afterwards. 9| 135.0; ... |S. & variable 1.50 |Clear to 3 a. m. Scuds from S. to 10 a. M., clear afterwards. a) 140.0)... S. 0.50 \Clear to2 p.m. Seatd. “ito 7 p. M., clear afterwards. Light- ning to N. at 8 Pp. M. 11 | 137.0} 0.12 |S. & variable. 3.60 |Clear to5 a.m.Scatd.”ito 8 P.M., clear afterwards. Lightning to N.E.at7 & 8p. m. Rain at 7 . P. M. eS 136.0) %.. S. 0.60 |Clear. 3) 28:37) 0. 18. & SES. ER. 0.50 |Scatd. “i to 6 a. mw. Seuds from S.tol10 a. mM. Seatd. %i after- wards. Lightning to N. W. at 8,9 & ll Pp. M. 14,| 180.0} 0.55 |S. E. & S. by E. 19.50 |Clear to6 a.m. “ito7 p.m. Over- cast afterwards. Lightning from7 tollv. m. Thunder from 8 tolO p. m. Rain at 8 Pp. M. XXXVI Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, an the month of May 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &c. 24, 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 | 130.0 Ni Cirri, — i Strati radiation. Max. Solar | Rain Gua bo a © bo ge 5 feet above Ground bm B : (e) a ie (a>) M Prevailing direction of the Wind. Variable. 134.9; 0.58 |S. & S. by E. 130.2 128.0 132.0 130.0 130.2 134.0 129.0 132.0 130.0 141.6 143.0 132.0 128.0 133.0 “i Cirro cumuli. . sure of Wind 8 Max. Pres- ~ oF j=) 12.00 S. by E. & 8. by W.| 0.25 S.&8. 8. W. S.&8. 8. E. a3 & Br & gunn ADR S.&8. 8. W. S.&8. 8. W. S.&8. 8. W. 3.00 0.70 0.50 0.30 0.70 3.00 Mm General aspect of the Sky. Overcast to 4.4.M. Clear to Noon. Scatd “i to 6 p.m. Scatd \i afterwards. Scatd. \i to 5 a. M., secatd. ~1 to 6 p. m. Overcast aferwards. Lightning from 7 to 10 Pp. M. Thunder at 7 & 8 p. mM. Rain between 6 & 7 P. M. Clear to 7 a.m., scatd. “ito6 . Pp. M., clear afterwards. Clear to 6 a. M., scatd “i to6P.M. Overcast afterwards. Rain be- tween 7 & 8 P.M. Clear to 11.4. M., scatd “ito 2 P. M., clear afterwards. Clear. Scatd.\i to 4.4. M., clear after- wards. Clear. Clear to 5 a. M., secuds from S. to 1l a. m., clear afterwards. Shock of an earthquake, felt at 3-41 from N. W. toS. E., the shock, or shocks, lasted several minutes and there was apparently a cross wave from N.. ‘to 8S: Scatd. ~i to ll a. m., clear after- wards. Lighting to N. W. at 8&9P. M. Clear. Clear. Clear. : Clear to 3 A. M., scuds from S. to 7 a.M., clear to 6 Pp. M.,, scuds from S. afterwards. Scuds from S. to 9 a. m. Clouds of different kinds afterwards. Clear to 4 a. M., scatd. “i to 6 Pp. m. Overcast afterwards. Lightning to N. W. at 8 & 9 p.m. Thin rain between 1&9P.M. 0.80 |Scatd. “1. »>i Cumuli,i Cirro-strati, ~i Cumulo strati,~~i Nimbi, Meteorological Observations. XXXIX Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of May 1866, Montuity RESUtts. Inches. Mean height of the Barometer for the month... ... 29.646 Max. height of the Barometer occurred at 9 a. M. on the ‘1st, ... 29.900 Min. height of the Barometer occurred at 5 p. M. on the 29th, ... 29476 Extreme range of the Barometer during the month, ti .. 0.424, Mean of the daily Max. Pressures, ... ts 5% ... 29.708 Ditto ditto Min. ditto oy OF Mean daily range of the Barometer during the month, wie 2 OBE ) Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer for the month, __.., »” prea re Max. Temperature occurred at 3 P. M. on the 27th a (>. 9 RUBS Min. Temperature occurred at 5 a. m. on the 3rd . ay ee ee Extreme range of the Temperature during the month, fe: i. oa Mean of the daily Max. Temperature .. ey ea, > oo eae Ditto ditto Min. ditto, a aod eee Mean daily range of the Temperature during the month,.. vas? Lo Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer for the month, ... 80.7 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer, 6.3 Computed Mean Dew-point for the month, 76.9 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above computed mean Dew- -point. , 10.1 thas Mean Elastic force of Vapour for the month, ... si rp ee OOS Troy grains. Mean Weight of Vapour for the month oe ae GO Additional Weight of Vapour required for complete saturation, JA ie O8 Mean degree of humidity for the month, complete saturation being unity 0.73 Inches. Rained 9 days,—Max. fall of rain during 24 hours ar Sere.’ Total amount of rain during the month, 7 206 Total amount of rain indicated by the Gauge attached to the anemo- ineter during the month. Eo nals Prevailing direction of the Wind, ae §.&8.8.W.&8. 5S. E. pa together with the number of days on g, it rained. y particular wind blew, Monruty RESULTS. Tables shewing the number of days on which at a given hour an when any particular wind was blowin ical Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, in the month of May 1866. which at the same hour, Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorolog Meteorological Observations. UO WLBT “MM 4q° NT ‘WO ULB] "MN UN dO ULE ‘HO UlBY "nN AQ* AA “UO ULB “MM "UO UI ‘S Aq “AN "UO IBY "MSA ‘UO WIV og a ‘UO ULB "MS 'S ee eth “Mm 4q “9 ] ] ‘UO TIBI 9 ‘UO ULB ‘a Aq ‘g "HO WIV ‘A'S 9 "UO ULVYT “aS ‘UO Uleyy he eh ‘UO ULV “g Aq -oT ‘UO Ue acl ‘UO ULV 'N Aq “of “UO UleYy ‘A NW ‘UO Uley TON ‘UO UleIy ee SEE ‘a Aq “NI ‘UO UBT 'N ‘INOy] + So =p 4 | — — = — — —— SAcocs — ——— =o a =i = S| = aq - Saas OM Noa at QI SO OD OD SH SH 6 10 OD OD Ee 19 10 WHO SH KHraaan Ta aIANA MO ine) DLO aM Oma aa & oO wD © H1910 SIAN ot GY) GO ra ro OD GD 10 GD © 10 / Od re NAMAUNNATWNA MR WMO MAN 1 TAA =} im! — Nes NAAN SS ANAM MNAN SS Nr eS i re al! == re Lama OD | re ce ei Lo es oe ON Be ee LO NS re (| Lom! i N AN — — La Lat Ls | are eS ae rir re ‘ 4 i =a! i ore La vl ial i N PAN Win Om ODO 4 ON Hig ORO Or thir Tel Noon. Meteorological Observations. xh Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Caicutta, in the month of June 1866. Latitude 22° 33’ 1” North. Longitude 88° 20’ 34” East. Height of the Cistern of the Standard Barometer above the sea level, 18-11 feet. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. SH he & | Range of the Barometer = + | Range of the Tempera- a = Be during the day. gi 3 ture during the day. 2s b Date. | & Bo Ra Eph ' as 327, | Max. | Mu. Diff. po Max. | Min. | Diff. = ~~ 8 = ES Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. ) Oo Oo ry) I 29.610 | 29.662 | 29.548 0.114 89.9 99.2 83.0 | 16.2 2 .629 .682 557 .125 87.4 98.0 79.6 , 18.4 3 .625 .678 55d 123 87.8 98.4 79.2 | 19.2 4 593 647 480 167 88.9 98.2 81.4 | 16.8 5 571 628 499 129 90.2 98.4, 83.4 | 15.0 6 509 597 404 153 90.4 98.6 84.0 | 14.6 7 ADA O51 ABL .120 91.1 99.8 84.2 | 15.6 8 Od 1 612 A479 .133 91.4 101.6 83.6 | 18.0 9 570 .622 497 125 90.5 97.8 82.0 | 15.8 10 546 .621 AZ 174 89.5 98.6 76.2 | 22.4 Il 503 573 423 .15V 88.3 96.8 80.2 | 16.6 12 499 550 425 125 89.1 95.6 85.4 | 10.2 i. |. -632 .604 462 142 89.4 93.4 83.0 | 15.4 14 .538 596 450 146 89.9 98.2 84.6 | 13.6 15 492 544 440 104 83.4 86.5 80.8 5.7 16 A494 .533 443 .090 83.3 87.3 79.6 Ca 17 515 571 451 120 82.2 85.0 79.6 5.4 18 531 O70 476 .099 82.9 87.2 78.4 8.8 19 503 563 A36 17 82.7 86.8 80.0 6.8 20 425 485 290 135 84.35 89.0 81.8 7.2 21 375 416 319 097 80.9 82.4 79.0 3.4 22 429 519 .o00 154 82.1 89.2 79.0 | 10.2 23 502 097 446 dd 83.3 90.8 79.4 | 11.4 24, 483 045 408 BF 82.9 87.3 79.6 8.2 25 AAL A489 .330 .109 85.7 91.2 81.8 9.4 26 431 477 376 101 85.3 89.5 81.2 8.3 27 465 .920 A15 105 83.3 85.1 80.6 4.5 28 514 579 452 127 84.1 88.6 82.0 6.6 29 573 .637 503 134 87.2 93.4 83.4 | 10.0 30 .607 .667 .560 107 83.9 87.4 81.8 5.6 The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Thermometer Means are derived, from the hourly observations, made during the day. | xln _ . Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of June 1866. | Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—/(Continued.) 4 eee % BH | SSa}28 .~ 4 : == S ” Syne etapa eS Ecce us| eer Pfs | eee an a3 ore: ) > & Cer 19 ge S| 3 5 8 oS be are ioe to. | 5 2 = 2 SS |B Oe lo eee bets | 2 a | eet ee les |e ee ea) age) | eS BET SSD Seen ee ee oe Fe le} ekae | BS | Ro | sees ES Bs S..| 9 S| ¢o |g eB [og ono as bs = Bay se 5 a Onuere et = ohmic cour (a= = te lees = ) ) | fo) ) Inches." )"T, gr Dees a0) $99 | bP | 77764 12S") 0028. O83 — "| Aaa eelee toes Di) 4 BORO MGUP, | ewe NOM.) 208 oS) 3.8% 71 Bho SO. | 268 | YEO -10:9—| ~ 908 G4 | 4.04 a ts) -s Gop °° Ree | Fone o'G-) . OFF) 10. ga) am a 5°) | 83% | #65 | 79.8) 10.4) .995 4° | 4.05 72 Gril saad a) Pas! veers Tee Gr 16 51 69 foc Ma is EO ee set cen BA 43 105 Cle SG RS | 78a 1a) 067 20 50 6am 21) - ee Ol Aye | ysOTF Jol: | ome 00 42 68 TOS oem, | PRE | 78 AYo 11 eel” ode 00 29 70% WA) Bake! dee? | Y7aRe 10 ges) OR) Odeo aaa we WWE) | Bae) Revo ois ORF) | 10.a8 79 Pile 13:8] GAG eet OEE 1 OB 978 BS 90 vag Tat) | Sate l= OA 77 Sell. TON gar. OL SEI due 68 1S 21 2 SOW. 1 TORBL) 78S AEA OSB 10. BI” Thee 86 16%) goth VOR) 77OSe 5AM O87 06 87 84. 1 | Foe | ae 77 gee Mare! 087 08 AG 87 18."| 70 oe 97 ae 5 Bat SIRE Oa 99 83 10-2 | OB || Awe | POO B7U) OTE 1-40. 49 30 89 20°) S016 | SBN 78.05% 6.3"! 948 (iy ealpaees 82. Qa.) Rte. Yee | ees 8 Bh). (OI OLGita Rien .89 29>| Fol’ | Be 78415 Bye) 958) 10.28 28 89 28) 804 | BI) FRANZ 4/54). O58 21 72 .86 262). FOS B77 Bie St 934 03 76 85 25:3| sols! | SAR VE Re Gel BOR Ose) “Sigs 5 26) 80i4e | BiGe) 270A BiSet OUD ase Qe Me 27°) SbBe | ONE) ZO Re. Biel. GOREN Over eeN « lve 89 28% 84.7? | @.42| 80.61% 4.1%) 1.008 ue AQ 88° 29 lo (810-1) 6.2 | 973). 16.6) (OMe sy mG Nia 73 80/798 Al | 769 | ON se alee .80 “es All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. — Meteorological Observations, xliii _ Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations. taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Caleutta, en the month of June 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygremetrical elements dependent thereon. $3 Range of the Barometer | =... | Range of the Tempera- we for cach hour during | 3 ture for each hour BO = the month. Py on during the month. Hour.| © a3 | Ad l SFict | Max. | Min. | Diff. | $2 | Max. | Min. | Dif as | ue i3 | / Inches. | Inches. | Inches. Inches. ) Co) Oo ) Mid- | night.| 29.532 | 29.646 | 29.407 | 0.239 83.4 87.2 79.2 8.0 1 518 630 897 | .233 83.2 87.0 | 79.2)| \spee 2 BOT | G2i\|- 18830] .288. | 83.0 | 87.0 1.79.2 Legs 3 HOO .O33 367 206 $2.8 86.8 78.8 8.0 4 497 641 2300 276 82.7 $6.3 78.4 8.4 5 57 634 865 279 82.7 86.4 78.8 7.6 6 24 651 079 272 82.7 86.6 79.0 7.6 7 539 604 397 267 83.7 83.0 | 80.0} 8.0 8 a3 .678 E > om 56 on | 69-3 Gre | RE | eg 4. | 32 | = eee Pele) 2)2. | es | es | bse |eee ag a, A a 8, a 3 —saq|8&nhe 2 3 p | & Se 2S o¢ | So eee Gos yey ey a Sees 0 oO a) © Inches. | T. gr. | T. gr Mid- night.| 80.3 ok |) ee 5.3 0.943 10.12 1.84 0.85 IL 80.3 2.9 | 78.3 4:9 949 18 71 86 2 80.5 2.5 | 78.7 4.3 961 oo 49 87 3 80.5 2:3 | 78.9 3.9 967 oo 36 88 4 80.5 2.2 | 79.0 3.7 970 42 30 89 5 80.6 2.1 | Fo 3.6 973 A5 27 89 6 80.6 2.1) Foe 3.6 973 A5 27 89 7 81.1 2.6 | 79.3 4.4, 979 51 06 87 8 81.4 3.8 | 78.7 6.5 961 26 2.35 81 9 81.8 5.1 | 78.7 8.2 961 24 3.01 wh 10 82.0 6.5 | 78.1 10.4 943 02 86 72 41 82.3 75 140.8 12.0 934 9.89 4.53 69 Noon.| 82.8 8.1 | 77.9 13.0 -937 90: 99 67 1 82.9 O7 Nia 13.9 931 82 5.37 65 2 83.1 8.8 | 77.8 14.1 934 85 47 64, 3 82.9 9.0:| 77.5 14.4 .925 76 56 64 4 82.9 8.1 | 78.0 13.0 .940: 93 00 67 5 82.5 7.5 | 78.0 12.0 .940 95 4.55 69 6 82.2 6.0 | 78.6 9.6 .958 10.17 3.59 74 7 80.9 5.0 | 77.4 8.5 922 9.83 O04, 76 8 80.4 AT \> Goa 8.0 913 .76 2.81 78 9 80.0 4.4 | 76.9 7.5 908 410 61 79 10 80.1 3.8 | 77.4 6.5 922 .87 26 81 11 80.2 33 | 77.9 3.6 937 19.04 1.96 84 -. All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. i y Meteorological Observations. xlv Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of June 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &c. WS oe 2 8 5.25 Prevailing & = .| . 8 |O& 2) direction of the ‘c. | General aspect of the Sky. S| eae la oe Wind a) a) is a Sa eOO ind. So ale ic. = 5 o |Inches tb 1) 136.0; ... 4S. &S8.S. E. 0.80 |Clear to 5 a.m. Scatd. “i to 9 a. Mm. Seatd. Wi to 4 PP. M. Clear afterwards. 2) 132.0! 0.32 |S. 8S. E. & S. 2.00 |Clear to 5 a. Mm. Scatd “i to 4 Pp. M. Overcast afterwards. Thunder & Lightning at 6,7 &9 p.m. Rain from 5 to9 p.m. oS) ae... is. &S.E. 1.25 |Overcast to 5 A. M. \i to 6 P. M. Clear afterwards. 4| 135.0; ... |S. by E. &S. 5.00 |\i to 10 a. m. clear to 3 P. M. Overcast afterwards. Light- ning to the E. at 9 p. M. oy isand, |... OS. & S.S. W. 1.25 |Scatd. \i to 11 a. m. Seatd. “i to 5 p.M. Overcast afterwards. : Lightning to the N at7 &8 : P. M. | ae i Se W. &S. 4.25 |Clouds of various kinds. Thin rain at 9. P. M. . 5. ES&S. 2.00 |Clear to 34. Mm. Scatd. \i to 5 Pp. M. Wi & \_i afterwdrds. 8|132.0| ... |S. by E. & variable}! 3.00 |\,i to 6 4. m. Thin clouds to 10 A. M. Clear to 5 Pp. mM. Over- cast afterwards. Lightning to N. E. at 8 & 9p. mu. Thun- der at 8 ep. Mm. Light rain at 10 & ll Pp. M. 9| 135.0] 0.15 |S. W. & S. 3.00 |Overeast to 3 a. M. Seatd. “i & \i to 5 p. m. Overcast afterwards. Lightning at 8 & 10 p. m. Thunder at 10 Pp. m. Rain at 9 Pp. mM. 10| 128.0; 0.24 |S. & 8S. S. EH. 23.00 |Overcast to 4 a. mM. Scatd. “i & \ni to 5 p. M. Overcast after- wards. Rain from 7 to 9 p. M. wer i260Tr ... i. & 8.8. E. 0.25 |Scatd. \i to Tito 10 4. Mm. i to 7 p.m. Overcast afterwards. Lightning to the N. at 8 p.m. 12| 128.0; .,.. JE. S. E. & variable. | 0.30 |Overcast to 8 a.m. \Wito7 P.M. Clear afterwards. Thunder at 3 p. M. Thin rain from 7 to 9 A.M. & at 3 P. M. 313 | 136.0| ... |JE.N. E. & 8. & E.| 0.50 [Clear to 4 a. wm. \ito8a. m. Scatd. “i afterwards. Light- ning to the N. K.at 9& 10 p.m. $42 131. Ol Se eS. Ei. 0.50 |Overcast to 3 a. m. Scatd. “i to 7 P.M. Clear afterwards. Light- | ning to the N. at 1 a.m. ™M 7 | 130.0 xlvi Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of June 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &e. o4 oD Oo =) = & a9 <3 Prevailing . < é ec SE! direction of the | "*Z | General aspect of the Sky. +2 cI ce) dh leg a wo 5 sf ae Wind. = 2 . Oo |inches | 1b 165 0.38.8). de. dy ae; 0.80 iClear to 44. m. \wito 1] a.m. Overcast afterwards. 'Thun- der at 1 p.m. Rain at 6&9 A. M. & from 1 to 5 P. M. 16 0.18 |S. E. & EH. by S. 0.80 |Clear to 3 a. M. Overcast after- wards. Thunder at 74.m. Rain at5,6&7a.M. & at 2P. mM. 17 0.538 SE&XSSE&Sby EH 0.90 |Overcast. Light rain from 2 to 9 a. M. & at Land 2p. m. Light- ning at 2, 3, & 44. mM. Thun- der ab 2 & 11 a. M. 18 S.S.E.&8.8S.W.&W.| 0.50 |\\i & \Wi to 7 vp. mM. Overcast aiterwards. Lightrainatlla.m. 19 0.23 |W. & S. W. 0.40 |Overcast. Light rain after inter- vals. k 20 » |W. S.-W. 0.40 |Overcast. Thin rain at 3 a. M. & from 7 to 1] p. mM. 21 0.96 |W. by 8. &W.N.W,) 0.60 |Overcasi. Light rain after inter- vals. 22 0.58 |W. N. W. &S. 0.80 [Overcast to 54. mM. Wi & 7i to le.m.Overeast to 7p. M. Clear atterwards. Rainat3,4&7 P.M. 23 | 121.0} 2.41 |S. 8S. W. & W. 0.80 | ito3a. mM.Overcast toll a.m. “ji to 4 p. m. Overcast after- wards. Rain at 5 & from 8 to lle. m. Thunder & Lightning at 8 & OP. M. 24 0.23 |W. by S. & W.S.W.) 0.80 |Overcast nearly the whole day. Light rain from 6 toll a. m. 25 | 117.0 W.S.W.&W.by §.) 0.49 [Clear to 5 a. mM. \i to 9a.u.7i to 3 p.m. Overcast afterwards. Shioht rain between 2 & 3 p.m. 26 | 117.8 8. W.& W.N. W.| 0.40 | i & \\i to 6 p. w. Overcast af- terwards. Slight rain at 3, 10, : & led play 27 0.64 |W.S.W. & N.N.W.| 1.25 |Overcast rain at 1, 4, 5 & from | 7to9 a.m. & at 8 P. M. 28 W.S. W. & 8. W.| 0.50 |Overcast. Slight rain at 6, 10 & Li a. vore 29 | 125.0 W.by S.&N.N.W.) 0.50 \.' to3 4. M. Overcast to 7 4. ™. \ni & “ito d p. um. Overcast afterwards. . 30 0.12 |W. by N. & variable} 0.50 |Overcasi to Noon.\si, to5 P.M. Thin clouds afterwards. Rain — at 6&7 a. M. M Cirri, — i 8 /rati,~i Cumuli,\_i Cirro-strati, ~ i Cumulo strati,~-i Nimbi, “i Cirro cumuli. *Fell from 7 pv. ™. of the 20th to 10 vp. ™. of the 2lst. Meteorological Observations. ; xlvii Abstract of the Results of tre Hourly. Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Culcutta, in the month of June 1866. Monruty ReEsv.ts. Inches. Mean height of the Barometer for the month,. ... 29.518 Max. height of the Barometer occurred at 10 a. at. on the 2nd, ... 29.682 Min. height of the Barcm:ter occurred at 4 Pp. M. on the 21st, ... 29.3:9 Extreme range of the Barometer during the month, a .., -0.863 Mean of the daily Max. Pressures, _... Rs *: ... 29.575 Ditto ditto Min. ditto ce Za ... 29.449 Mean daily range ot the Barometer during the mouth, ... .. 3) SOaL2a6 oO Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer for the month, . pity .. 86.4 Max. Temperature occurred at 1 p. M. on the Sth nis . LOK Min. Temperature occurred at 7 p. M. on the 10th ... i. ves tt eine Extreme range of the Temperature during the month, ye. 0 ¢ 25a Mean of the daily Max. Temperature .. Ef tpi’ >. 92.8 Ditto — ditto Min. ditto, : wa & Sle Mean daily range of the Temperature during the month,. vet Bae Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer for the month, ... 81.4 Mean Dry Bulb Taermometer above Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer, 5.0 Computed Mean Dew- point for the month, 5 a Mean Dr y Bulb Thermometer above computed n mean Dew- -point. . 8.5 eee Mean Elastic force of Vapour for the month, ... a we OLGSF 4 Troy grains. Mean Weight of Vapour for the month 24 » 998 Additional ‘Weig ht af Vv apour required for complete saturation, Osh BOD Mean degree of humidit y tor the month, complete saturation being unity'0.76 Inches. Rained 21 days,—Max. fall of rain during 24 hours nae a OAD Total amount of rain during the month, uae 4 Ge Total amount of rain indicated by the Gauge att ached to the anemo- meter during the month. - va) “G2e Prevailing direction of the Wind, ae §.S.E.&S.& W.S. W. xlvili Meteorological Observations. Za) "UO UIG © reU = , [M4a'N re e+" ‘UO UleyYy mn Pen oe ON = —— & & [ANN ) 8 3 TS uO Uley on EN ) ra rie pee a 4 saa ey Moe —=N NS — ol <2 66 MN. ~ — — N ——4 S & UO ULey]T 2 ie as QA SSS SS ANNO AANMO HAC AAN © = [ANA i is ~ s ia | | as. ee qo! ee see a e— GC a pws mM ae neo a ‘uo Ulery ae (OS Bs I oe | = GAC. staat ee NANAAAAAAAAATH NOOO ND SH GD Si eS MS cog Me ta) 5 eae "moO ULBY an 6 6241-3. TAAHDUMAARAAAMOMDAOMAMA & EE “MS 'S Spy | uo ueYy 4 > p= rane a ANA Ae a =a oa © oe PM 4q's eee e "Uo ULB] a SBES ‘g] AHH ANN TAA MoOHMMANGTOWN me) a LS Eee, \ at ae “gq fq‘g PO TRARDAABAAA AANA S a Pl OS BE, | uo uy) ra = z 2ce e WG Gg] SC PARMAR ARGHARANAN HOGG IAN a0 RN eee Soea “UO UIBY| y, sq ee NX re 8 a 2 2 "aS NMNAAAMAMMANAHHMANAPAANAHANM S “& S @ y "uO Uley GN mo ce rc N te S BEtegm-a- 1d =H NAMANMAN AN FBAAANAHMAS SO @ fo | ase 3 hes MO ULB i, m4 ae = = S 9 “| 'Uo urexy = seus 5 AMMAN a ao & ae AL Ww «2 310 uley os) . pba oy me == = & oie [X“1 a = ate "UO TIeY ca SD | eee ; NADA ana. = Ry aH ON ‘a g g [uo wey Ps SBS ¢g aes er =a ee ee a ied) faa — S = "mO UIe yy 2 ? re ~S . ° “ re mn ere ro Se» [a NN ae : am g — [uowy che goo [A AGN her ee "UO Ue ie TS, > 2 es 4 oe = si j|—_ 8 » ; Poy , SS MM AID OR DAN SHAMTDMONDOOA S MOH] "ep ies ae =< | Meteorological Observations. xlix Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of July 1866. Latitude 22° 33’ 1” North. Longitude 88° 20’ 34” Fast. Height of the Cistern of the Standard Barometer above the sea level, 18.11 feet. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. Chey vs & _ | Range of the Barometer | = # | Range of the Tempera- ges during the day. | ra ture during the day. _ S i} ty Date. | 5 Bo | | oe 5 & 2% | Max. | Min. | Diff. == | Max. | Min. | Diff. S| 2 = eS Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. oO oO oO re) 1 | 29.602 | 29.642 | 29.551 | 0.091 | 77.7 $1.0 | 76.6 | Ba 2 597 646 537 09:1 76.2 TEA) 276.2)... ae 3 O09 63 17 O96 79.1 85.6 74.4 | 11.2 4 538 576 476 100 | 81.2 85.4 | 78.0 | 7.4 5 529 "580 ASA O96 81.3 86.6 77.4 9.2 6 604 .665 564 LOL 81.6 87.6 78.4 9.2 7 635 698 570 123 | 83.2 89.0 |:79.8 | 92 8 572 634 482 152 85.1 93.0 80.0 | 13.0 9 520 O79 A433 142 85.8 93.2 80.6 | 12.6 10 ADA, OAT 436 ED 86.2 9i.6 83.2 8.4 a 505 558 AAL a a | 90.5 | 81.0] 9.5 12 509 6i6 506 110 84.5 90.0 81.0 9.0 13 646 697 593 104 | 84.6 89.8 | 81.2) 8.6 14, .660 “714 .602 112 89.0 90.4) 80.2 | 10.2 15 579 61 459 162 83.4: 86.0 81.2 4.8 16 O21 .560 409 O91 84.2 86.7 82.0 4.7 17 555 597 522 075 | 83.2 G1.0 | S786. bes 18 563 .600 516 084 | 82.9 86.2 | 80.4 | 5.8 19 580 631 .OU9 122 83.3 88.6 Loo g.0 20 604 654 AT 107 82.3 89.0 80.2 5.8 21 615 .662 dd 107 82.7 86.8 79.2 7.6 22 587 634 34 .L00 83.4 87.0 79.8 7.2 23 614 664, 545 119 | 84.5 89.4 | 80.0 | 9.4 24, .638 681 534 O97 | 84.6 87.8) | 486) 16.0 25 634 .670 573 097 | 84.0 90.4 | 81.6 | 8.8 26 597 645 517 128 | 82.2 85.0°; | W8122>|) 3.8 27 597 .639 533 106 | 83.7 88:67 147902" |) 9.4 28 OLE .668 .5d5d 113 83.2 87.5 80.4: ya! 29 631 691 .560 sho 84.3 99.2 79.8 | 10.4 30 629 673 573 . 100 84.8 90.8 80.3 | 10.5 31 631 .668 O79 093 83.0 87.8 80.6 7.2 The Mean Height of the Teeter as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb oe Means are derived, from the hourly observations, made during the day. hie _ Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, im the month of July 1866. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) 7 ca ae e 6 6.4 | 68d |-as . eA Behe. a). A 2 e | soe | Bae a a : > Ss | mee |i 3 = ) > ° GH 42 ‘=. oS Q 3 | = Ee iS oa aye) os 5 =| 3 - fa Seely el eee 2 22 o-oo Dates) ak gM SL Te = mo | He | 25's les |} 3 | 2 | Be | gf | ee | Bel eee q | © 5 | mg a 0 | eee ee ag 2 5 as aa. | ee eee oq Ps = PAY oF Cag a OO & = A e) A = ee = fe) ) ) ) Inches. | 'T. gr. “| Toney . 1 75.3 2.4 | 73.6 4. 1 O.S1F 8.86 1.24 | 0.88 | 2 75.0 1.2 | 74.2 2.0 .832 9.05 0.61 4 3 770 PA |. 756 3.6 .868 38 1.15 89 A 78.9 31 77.3 3.9 919 90 31 88° 8 5 78.1 3.2 | 75.9 5.4 .879 AT Mis 84. a 6 79.3 28 7a 7 3.9 .931 | 10.02 32 88 7 80.4 2.8 | 78.4 4.8 952 21 68 86 8 81.0 4.1 | 78.1 7.0 943 08 2.49 80 @ 9 81.6 4:2 | 78.7 Fel 961 .26 57 80. @ 10 82.1 Al | 79:2 7.0 .976 Al 58 80 lt 80.8 43 | 77.8 7.3 934 9.99 58 80 @ 12 80.1 4.4 | 77.0 7.5 .910 73 62 79 a 13 80.6 AO! F728 6.8 934 .99 AO 3 14 0 BOR aes es 7.3 931 .96 57 30 15 81.2 22,| 79.7 3.7 .992 | 10.63 1.33 89 16 81.4 2.8.| 79.4 4.8 .983 51 73 36 17 80.4 Be | 7ea oAS 952 2) 68 86 18 80.1 | 2.8] 781 4.8 943 12 67 86: 19 80.8 2.5 | 79.0 4.3 .970 AQ 51 87 20 80.6 V7 |-79.4 2.9 .983 58 02 91 21 80.4 2.3 | 78.8 3.9 964 36 36 88 22 80.2 32.1 78.0 5.4 .940 09 87 84 23 81.4, Bul | 79.8 5.3 | .976 AB 90 85 24 81.5 3.1 | 79.3 5.3 .979 8 91 85 £5. | ein 2.9 | 79.1 4.9 .973 AQ 5 | 86 26 | 80.3 1.9 | 79.0 3.2 .970 AA 10 | = a7 80.3 3.4| 77.9 5.8 .937 04 2.03 | 88 28 80.0 3.2 | 77.8 5.4 934 038 1.96 | 64 29 80.7 3.6 | 78.2 6.1 946 13 9.15 | 83 30 | 80.5 4.3 | 77.5 7.3 925 9.90 56 80 ag a7 ae 931 <1 10.00.) Ise | 85 All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. 4a i Meteorological Observations. Ii Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations — taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of July 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. 63 Range of the Barometer = . |Range of the Tempera- “25” for each hour during me ture for each hour oe R= the month. 2 during the month. sas b 8 Hour.) = a a F a ; S233 | Max. | Min. | Diff. | $3 | Max. | Min. | Diff Ag ae Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. re) ° 0 o Mid- night.| 29.605 | 29.674 | 29.515 | 0.159 81.2 84.5 76.0 8.5 1 593 .663 AOL 172 81.0 83.8 75.8 8.0 2 583 .656 466 .190 80.7 83.5 75.4 8.1. 3 573 .650 456 194, 80.4, 83.3 74.8 8.5 A 570 659 476 -183 80.2 83.2 74.6 8.6 5 577 664 A80 184 80.4 83.4 74.4 9.0 6 591 .680 493 .187 80.6 83.4 74.5 8.9 7 -606 .700 504 196 81.2 84.0 74.6 9.4 8 .618 705 -596:| 189 {| 825 85.3 75.8 9.5 9 .626 412 530 182 84.1 87.4 76.6 | 10.8 10 .629 714 530 Bi, 84.9 88.8 77.0 | 11.8 11 620 702 529 173 85.7 90.2 76.8 | 13.4 Noon. -608 .686 509 177 86.1 91.2 i br-a\ ee 1 591 675 491 184 86.5 92.2 76.4 | 15.8 2 569 657 4.60 197 86.3 93.0 76.6 | 16.4 3 548 632 433 es Sa 85.9 93.2 75.2 | 18.0 A 536 616 439 Lif 85.6 oi@ 75.6 | 15.4 5 534 608 44.3 .165 85.3 89.6 75.5 | 14.1 6 542 .616 456 .160 84.5 88.0 75.5 | 12.5 if 560 637 A80 157 83.3 86.0 75.4 | 10.6 8 581 660 505 155 82.7 85.2 75.6 9.6 9 602 684: 527 157 82.3 84.7 75.6 Sills 10 616 697 540 157 81.8 85.2 75.6 9.6 11 616 689 542 147 81.4 85.0 75.6 9.4 See Le EBS gs TE ie ee Pe ie a ee cee 2 YA The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Thermometer Means are derived from the observations made at the several hours during the month. : hi Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, am the month of July 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) H . ; ; Bot i ~ | E Same pate © aa | ee EB = = x, A 5 > 6 | des ls. a) ) & o 5 GH 4> a5 = = Cy = & Z| > = > = o 9 y= ° 2"s S) o ° S 2 Oo i Seth poe Hour.| © a= a = ae a oe) (Day: @ $3 io eo iS oS. o a tie bh = Pe | 73 | 2 4. | Be Se | eee ce qq FA Bi) ag eg 8, 2 Be et te SS] be OB | Ore | es | ee) eee eee si =| ay 5 ala Sin S-5 oe Sj) sos fo) fo) Co) ) Inches: Ter.) vas Mid- night. 79.4, 18) etal Ean 0.943 10.16 1.05 0.91 iL 79.3 ih 4 5 Gee 2°9 943 16 0.98 91 2 rice 1.6 | 78.0 al .940 hd, ‘91 .92 - 3 79.1 £31 J82 2.2 .946 21 13 .93 4, 78.9 1-3: |. FSO 2.2 .940 15 3 .93 5 79.0 1.4 |. 78,0 2.4: .940 15 19 .93 6 79.2 4s Fasee 2.4 .946 21 .80 .93 7 79.5 17 |) f8aa 2.9 .949 22 :99 91 8 80.2 2.34) £826 3.9 .958 .30 1.34 .89 9 80.7 Ai Tee 5.8 .949 .16 2.05 83 10 80.8 7 la 9 7.0 .937 .O2 AZ .80 ii 81.2 4.5 | 78.0 ed 940 .03 airy 18 Noon. 81.2 4.9 | 77.8 8.3 .934 9.97 .98 By i. i 81.2 d.a | £00 8.5 .940 10.01 3.09 76 2 81.1 B.2- iL oD 8.8 .925 9.86 16 76 3 81.1 7 a i fe 8.2 931 94, 2.93 Boh 4, 80.8 4.8 | 77.4 8.2 .922 .85 on J 5 80.8 ALS Gf06 Tod . 928 91 13 78 6 8V.3 4.2 | 77.4 fall .922 .87 48 .80 ; 7 79.8 3:0; || dives 6.0 .919 .86 07 83 @ 8 79.8 2.9' Pia8 4.9 .934, 10.03 1.69 .86 9 79.7 236 1 jah ie 4A, .937 .08 50 87 10 79.6 2.2 | 78.1 ont 943 14 26 .89 Th 79.6 18) |) a2.Sae 3.1 .949 22 5 91 Ail the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. Meteorological Observations. hin Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutia, in the month of July 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &e. © © a: La C “1 oo | S6\|s.9¢ Prevailing mS Ms |b ss : . he Cy cap ie = 2! direction of the "a. | General aspect of the Sky. =| Ko |e oF Wind. ied 2), Ss fac So ea Mio Ag a o \Inches tb 1 0.80° |W. & S. W. Overcast. Rain day & night. 2 * 4.20 |S. W. & W. N. W.| 2.60 |Overcast. Rain day & night. 3 +1.32 |W.S.W.&S. S. E. Overcast to 11 a. m. Seaid. Wi & Ni afterwards. Rain from 5 to 10 a. M. A, S. HE. & E.S. E. 2.00 |Seatd. \i to 44. Mm. Overcast to 5 p.m.clear aiterwards. Light rainat6&104.m. &at1& ; 3 P. M. 5 | 118.4| 0.13 |S. 8: E. & 8. by E.| 1.50 |Overcast to 8 a. M. “1 after- wards.Light ran at 2,7 & 10 A.M. andat4& 10 Pp. mM. ee 0.87 |S. by E.&S. by W.| 1.00 |Overcast to 2 Pp. mM. Scatd. >i to 6p. M. clear afterwards. Ram at 2,5, 8 &lla.m. & atZ& oP. M. 7| ... | 0.61 |S.S.E.&8.& S.byW.| 0.25 |Clear to 4 a. Mm. “1 to7 P.M. clear afterwards. Rain be- tween lO &ll a.m. & at 2 P.M. Sy 1190")... |S. by W..& B. 0.30 |Overcast tod a.m.\ni to ll a.m. “i atterwards. Light rain at 4A. M. Sato | 3... |(ScS. W.&S. 0.50 (Wi to 4 Pp. M. overcast after- wards Thunder at 6 P. M. Lightning to the N. W. at 8 — bo ae — ey bo Or P. M. 10 | 125.4 S.S. E. & S. E. 0.50 |Scatd. “ito 7 p. m. clear after- wards. 11 | 128.0] 0.10 |S. E. & E. by S. 1.20 |Clear to 3 4. um. Scatd. ~i to 8 p. M. clear aiterwards. Kan between 1O & ll a. m. & be- tween 2 & 3p. M. 12 112.0} 0.09 |S. E. & E.S. E. 2.10 |Clear to 3 4. mw: \i to lla. M. Scatd.. “1 & s21 10,5 Py lee afterwards. Rain at 5 a. M. & between 9 & 10 a. M. 13 | 129.8 eh. MES: Se EB 0.70 |Seatd. 71 & Wi to 7 p. M. clear afterwards. Light rain at 6} & ll a. M. 14 | 121.0 tis. 4828: Ei. 0.50 |Clear to 4.4. m. Scatd. “i & \Wi to 7 p. M. Clear afterwards. Light rain at 6 P. M. 15 0.16 |S. by E. &S. 0.50 |Scatd \i to 44. mM. Wi & “i to 8 p. mM. clear afterwards. Light rain from 9 to ll.a. mM. *Fell from 1 p.™M. of the lst to 4 Pp. M. of the 2nd. + Do. 5 p. a. of the 2nd. to 10 a. Mm. of the 3rd. hiv Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, an the month of July 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &c. a eae bie: 3 § s ae Prevailing oie .| . 8 |O & 2] direction of the Fie | General aspect of the Sky. 2) 2S lage Wind ahs fan Ss ra oie ind. ss z i o |Inches tb LGticias 0.18 | S. 1.00.3 108 av a Aig te sae Ca. overcast to 7 Pp. M. clear afterwards. Rain from 9 a. m. to Noon. 17 | 118.0; 0.78 |S. 8S. W. & S. by W| 4.30 |Clear to 3 a.m. \i to2 P. Mu. overcast afterwards. Rain from 3 to 5 Pp. M. PS AA, a. S. W. 1.00 |Overeast, slight rain at 63, 73 & 10 a. M. 19) ... | 0.88 |S.& 8. W. & W. 1.00 |Overcast nearly the whole day. Rain from 2 to 6 a. M. & at 8 A. M. 710 0.85 |S. by E.&S8.&8.8.E.) 0.20 |Overcast to 4 P. M. “i after- wards. Rain at 10 & ll,a. m. & at l3,4&7P. mM. ZN ae vio |S. QS 0.50 |\~.i & \Wi nearly the whole day. Slight rain at 74. mM. & at 3 Pp. M. 225 = 38 0.18 |S. & 8. 8. E. 0.50 |Wi & 71. Rain at 6 & 104 a. m. & between Noon & 1 Pp. m. ZO AOS LABS SW. OSON Fg Nae es | ISS Wits. 0.50 |Scatd. \_i to 5 aA. M. overcast afterwards. 25:| 3, 14 ODORS! by Waa s. 0.60 |Overcast nearly the whole day. Rain at 3,10 & lla.m. & from 2to 4p. M. 2640 1452S. oH: 0.40 |Overcast nearly the whole day, Rain at 6 & from 8 to I]]4a4. mu. 27 | 120.0); ... |S. byW.& E. 8. E.| 0.40 |Scatd. \wi to 10 4. m. m1 to5 p. m. Scatd.\_i &\i after- : wards. 28 | 114.0) 4 a) FS aoe. 0.70 |-ito 4P.m.Sceatd. \i&\_i after- wards. Light rain at 5 & 7 a. mM. & at 3 Pp. M. 29/1340; ... |S.E.&S.S.E. 0.70 iScatd. “ito 4P. m. Seatd. \i afterwards. Rain between midnight & la. mM. & at 4P. M. 30 | 127.0| 0.10 |K.S. BE. &S.E. 0.40 |\Scatd. \i to 84. M. “ito 4 P.M, Seatd. \i afterwards. Rain at ll a. we. & at I Pom. olae h J) NaN, 0.25 |Clear to 5 a. mM. \i & Wi to 10 A. mM. Overcast afterwards. Thunder at 2p. uw. Light rain from | to 3 Pp. M. ™a Cirri, — i Strati,~i Cumuli,\—i Cirro-strati, ~i Cumulo strati,~i Nimbi, “i Cirro eumuli. EE Meteorological Observations. lv Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, in the month of July 1866. Monrtaty ReEsvutts. Inches. Mean height of the Barometer for the month,... sas SOLOST Max. height of the Barometer occurred at 10 4. a. on the 14th, ... 29.714 Min. height of the Barometer occurred at 3 Pp. M. on the 9th, —... 29.433 Extreme range of the Barometer during the month, a ian, OF2BE Mean of the daily Max. Pressures, _... pnd bd 2GaT Ditto ditto Min. ditto >. .. 29.527 Mean daily range of the Barometer during the month, ... wi) OLE ) Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer for the month, __.., abs <3. Baek Max. Temperature occurred at 3 p. M. on the 9th or, ja: - ae Min. Temperature occurred at 5 a. M. on the 3rd . oP we TAA Extreme range of the Temperature during the mont nth, a. oa: |. pans Mean of the daily Max. Temperature .. re x a OSLO Ditto ditto Min. ditto, rs oP ee’ pc Mean daily range of the Temperature during the month,.. eh 8.3 Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer for the month, ... 80.1 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer, 3.0 Computed Mean Dew-point for the month, 78.0 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above computed n mean Dew- -point. . 5.1 hae Mean Elastic force of Vapour for the month, ... Bet ».. 0.940 Troy grain. Mean Weight of Vapour for the month a5 OOS Additional Weight of Vapour required for complete saturation, ... 1.77 Mean degree of humidity for the month, complete saturation being unity 0.85 Inches. Rained 26 days,—Max. fall of rain during 24 hours Be ww 3.43 Total amount of rain during the month, & ABA? Total amount of rain indicated by the gn attached to the anemo- meter during the month. ws 12,06 Prevailing direction of the Wind, +. S&B Ee 8. B lvi ce, Caleutta, in the month of July 1866. mf ‘ ow he Surveyor General's Of MontTuuy RESULTS. 4 b taken at tons cal Observat a Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorolog riven hour any par rj sether with the number of days on a) ticular wind blew, te fon & c Tables shewing the number of days on which at a ind was blowing, it rained. any particular w , When which at the same hour Meteorological Observations. "UO UIRIy iM AqN ‘Uv ULB ee ApS - ae —— “MN UN ‘uv ULB $i RSS ~ otal — ——7 i AN Se ee ee ee — el ‘UO Wie "UO ULB = oe : — "NAG" AA ae as “ao areg Coon llumen tae! = — A are aie = —_= = AN om =-=———O€ — — “UO ULB sy aa Ey f ea NN = = Gg Aq “AA Spay eres Are a4 NA = SU uO UiBy iho nao Wiel ata GD OD GO et = ANN ‘uv ule J rt ABAMMNNA AAR AAA Ae “MA “a ANN RAANWMWDODMDIOAMANMAAWDMAAN sania ei re — No Nas pe Seer a NO AAWN So NID OM TION DION Ae M'S’S “au Utes : | aN rt eo A Ay “yl OD NM om ww 1Dd Oo SG aN on Ss oaWN GNI GS cr oO ze Tuk ik = = : ‘uv ULB yy aN a MINN ee ce “g OO wOMWILMWM BOOM ALKNOAOhATDEeLe Dood “Uv Uap : i Cm rc re ce asaamsN “y Aq “9! aS OOM MMA Naa aH TDONWM TMUMOANIAN ——— i) : * ~*~ “uv aves] “o ah aN ANA — = = aS “I lomo) 1D LID TO MIOQMAN ON MaANr~OMWANnOSO ee ws ~ ‘Us Wey Z co mown ae N |) ROMO MMMOAAKRMOAAMNROAAMADoHw a) ‘HO ULB yy “ a la “a ‘OY a NN SN ND ODO NWN Tee i ee Be ee | ama N N v | “Tu Uwe ic [| | *g £q 7g Sse SON sq as — eS "Gu t rie eo ac mo asece ie — nt Ag “Gy ne eS ‘Uy UB sy Piha . : 5 | ia Ls | [| [| sq ae OF Ne. ‘Uo Wey i ; ee _IN “oO WiBiT HN oN Uo ULB AT a Aq ‘"N uo U ey ee T aan N. —— oS . d ‘amnLopr) oS Bp IAA FID OM DAO SGHAMAMWOMOASOF sen rad ite mare A Gq Meteorological Observations. lvit Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of August 1866. Latitude 22° 33’ 1” North. Longitude 88° 20’ 34” East. Height of the Cistern of the Standard Barometer above the sea level, 18.11 feet. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. Qe fe 8 _ | Range of the Barometer = FF Range of Tompera- mad during the day. FA 3 ture during the day. 5 oS BE Date. | = BQ | Ag grin =a @ oi; | Max. | Min. Diff. & po Max. | Min. | Diff. S| ~~ 8 S = Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. ) ) ) ) 1 | 29.586 | 29.625 | 29.520) 0.105; 83.2 | 89.6 | 80.4] 9.2 2 614 .695 O44 151 80.7 83.2 78.2 5.0 3 .730 .809 .683 126 80.4 83.6 79.2 4.4) 4, 739 en 677 100 80.0 82.7 79.0 3.7 5 680 "742 .616 126 81.5 84.8 79.4 5.4: 6 540 .655 442 213 82.2 86.0 79.8 6.2 7 .390 AAI 332 117 81.2 85.4: 79.2 6.2 8 A14 499 069 130 80.9 85.2 78.2 7.0 : 9 544 .630 AT5 155 83.6 89.7 78.8 | 10.9 10 593 631 O24 -107 84.3 90.8 80.7 | 10.1 11 557 613 ATA 139 | 84.6 89:2: | Sb.8 | 7:4 12 501 ol 426 125 83.6 89.4: 80.4 9.0 13 542 595 489 .106 83.0 87.6 128 7.8 14 597 .639 541 098 | 83.3 87.4 | 80.0 | 7.4 15 .617 651 .560 O81 83.4) 89.6 80.2 9.4) 16 589 631 O31 -LOO 82.4 86.0 78.8 7.2 17 563 .623 A84 139 83.0 87.8 80.2 7.6 18 525 572 A52 120 | 82.6 86.7 | 808) 6.2 1g 505 547 AAZ 105 83.8 88:0 5). SOQ: Sh 20 .509 561 465 .096 83.2 85.6 81.5 4.1 21 548 .607 495 112 82.0 85.2 79.6 5.6 22 578 .634 516 BS. 83.7 89.4 79.4 | 10.0 23 562 .615 A75 140 84.6 90.4: 80.4 | 10.0 24 598 .613 485 .128 85.0 90.8 81.4 9.4, 25 585 .645 516 130 84.3 89.8 81.8 8.0 26 .606 657 047 110 83.6 88.4 80.6 7.8 27 .607 649 550 O99 82.3 88.4 80.3 8.1 28 .582 .636 511 125 82.0 86.0 77.4 8.6 29 .670 739 .615 124 81.9 85.8 78.6 7.2 30 754 822 691 131 84.1 90.0 79.0 | 11.0 31 723 187 .639 148 | 86.2 91.8 | 81.4} 10.4 The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb peeeno ele? Means are derived, from the hourly observations, made during the day. lvili Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, om the month of August 1866. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) P 4 fs so | E 6 5H | SSa las. A |e | 2] 4 eg | #2 | ane | Bes om © a Prue oct |. r2 o > a) +> ‘Bea 8 feyw = | b E ° O° SES | SD &H a 2 Sein 2 He |E 8 | ona Dates) oo 5: Fa A ? e oh.2 Pepe) ie te ® of | @ | S| 2.0 Sgal SSS eee Pe 2 |) s-) ee | 8°) BS |S sees dé wy aS) a3 Aas — Sr | €6°5 3 4 P> = Pry 55 oq | ses | S08 = A One = a7 |< = | ) ) Ce) Co) Inehes.|' “Tor.” Faby ae i. 79.8 3.4 | 77.4 5.8 0.922 9.89 2.00 0.83 2 79.4 6 | 780 2.7 .940 10.13 0.91 92 3 79.0 1.4 | 78.0 2.4 .940 15 79 .93 4 78.5 LS | 774 2.6 .922 9.95 .86 92 5 79.8 EY | 786 2.9 .958 10.32 .99 OP 6 80.0 2.2 | 78.5 3.7 955 27 L.2F .89 “if 79.2 20) | 77:8 3.4) 934 07 14 .90 8 79.0 on 77 4 3.2 931 04 .06 91 ) 80.1 3.5 |~77-6 6.0 928 9.95 2.08 83 10 80.9 3.4 | 78.5 5.8 955 10.23 .05 83 11 81.3 3.3 | 79.0 5.6 .970 5/6 02 84 12 80.0 a6 | 475 6.1 .925 9.92 a hk 83 13 79.9 8 a as 5.3 .931 10.00 1.82 .85 14, 80.3 3.0 | 78.2 5.1 946 15 78 85 15 80.4) 3.0 | 78.3 5.1 .949 18 78 85 16 79.8 2.6 | 78.0 4A .940 Ae 50 87 17 80.3 3.2) 78.1 5.4 943 12 .88 84 18 79.7 2D | OTA 4.9 931 .0O .68 .86 19 81.0 2.8 | 79.0 4.8 .970 40 70 .86 20 81.5 L.7 | 80.3 2.9 1.011 84 .05 91 21 80.2 1:8: | 78.9 3.1 0.967 Al .06 91 22 80.8 2.9 | 78.8 4.9 964 04 13 .86 23 81.2 3.4 | 78.8 5.8 .964 ol 2.08 83 24, 81.3 3.7 | 78.7 6.3 .961 .29 24 82 25 80.7 3.6 | 78.2 6.1 .946 13 15 83 26 80.4) 3.2 | 78.2 5.4 .946 15 1.88 84 27 79.9 2.4 | 78.2 4.1 946 17 Al 88 28 79.4 256!) F7.6 4.4, .928 9:99 48 87 29 79.8 2.1 | 78.3 3.6 949 10.20 24 .89 30 80.6 3.5 | 78.1 6.0 943 10 2.11 83 dL 82.1 4.1 | 79.2 7.0 .976 AL 08 .80 & ~All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. 4 Meteorological Observations. lix Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteoroloyical Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Caleutta, im the month of August 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. SR Range of the Barometer ot ; Range of the Tempera- aS; for each hour during mS ture for each hour ae Z a the month. = during the month. Hour.| = ay Gz nN zB e433 | Max. | Min. | Diff. | $2 | Max. | Min. | Diff. as ao Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. ) ) ) ) Mid- night.| 29.601 | 29.760 | 29.399 | 0.361 81.3 BAT. b SO) | cee 1 O89 751 O89 302 80.9 83.8 79.2 4.6 2 580 744 379 | .365 80.7 83.0 | 79.2 | 38 3 570 738 372 .366 80.5 82.6 78.9 3.7 4 .566 TAL .368 373 80.2 82.2 78.2 4.O 5 574 £750 378 372 80.1 81.8 77.4 4.4, 6 588 tik 378 | .393 80.3 82.4 | 77.8 | 4.6 7 .603 801 .393 | .408 81.0 83.2 | 78.38 | 4.4 8 .616 809 ALL 398 82.0 84.8 | 79.0] 5.8 9 .626 .816 A24, 392 83.6 87.0 79.6 74 10 .629 822 432 | .390 84.7 88.4 | 79.2 | 9.2 11 .618 812 408 | .404 86.1 69.6 | 80.5 | -91 Noon. .603 .796 084 412 85.7 90.4: 81.4.) 2 So 1 583 .766 .378 .388 86.1 91.0 81.2 9.8 2 .560 133 309 380 85.8 O12 79:2: \ V2 3 540 113 309 374 85.8 90.8 79.4 | 11.4 4 525 694 332 362 85.7 9E0 79.6 | 11.4 5 527 .693 343 999 85.0 91.8 80.0 | 11.8 6 .540 113 .000 .308 83.8 89.7 19.8) | AOE z 558 123 367 .006 83.1 87.7 79.2 8.5 8 583 748 388 .360 82.6 86.4 79.6 6.8 9 604 158 400 208 82.2 85.6 79.6 6.0 10 617 .809 ALL 398 81.9 84.8 79.6 5.2 11 .613 767 415 302 81.6 84.4 79.2 5.2 The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Thermometer Means are derived from the observations made at the several hours duzing tle month. ix Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, an the month of August 1866. =. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) Yr | ee ee ———— = +3 = = Se 5H | S Ot F Fs a S = is = ae 2" § 55 : eS Bai al.) 2 >s | essing. am 2 o 2) io) G4 45 orl oh Aes So, = > E > = O38 S's 8 | o's 5 S S 2 baie e os os | wou|@ | 2/A|4 | 8 | 22 Feel] eee | 2B ef ts = i a. ‘Be hd a ieee ee ES j= £ ae. fe yy ES So | BS's ® 5 = as 5 O~ |e a aq a xs aS, es mae | eg fo fb Leche eee (ioe SA) Gey: Tein bey cS Sea. a ) ) ) ) Inches..| 7D. .et, 0) Toe Mid- night. 79.7 1.6 | 78.6 2.7 0.958 10.32 0.92 0.92 iI 19.5 1.4 | 78.5 2.4, .955 ol 19 .93 2 79.4 Le | 4S. 2.2 .955 soil. fe .93 3 79.2 LB 18s 2.2 949 24, 74 .93 A 79.0 1.2 | 78.2 2.0 .946 21 G7 94 5 78.9 1.2.) of Oelk: 2.0 .943 18 .66 94 6 79.0 13/8 2.2 .943 18 73 .93 4 79.5 1.5 | 78.4 2.6 .952 25 .89 .92 8 80.0 2.0 | 78.6 3.4 .958 .o2 1.15 99 9 80.5 Mal | Sud 5.3 949 18 .8d .85 10 80.8 3.9 |>781 6.6 .943 .08 2.34 81 11 81.5 4.6 | 78.3 7.8 .949 12 .83 78 Noon.| 81.3 4.4,| 78.2 7h) 946 .O9 “Fl 79 a. 81.6 4.5 | 78.4 beh 952 15 .80 78 2 81.2 4.6 | 78.0 7.8 940 .03 .80 78 3 81.2 4.6 | 78.0 i 940 .03 .80 78 4, 81.2 4.5 | 78.0 hers 940 .03 ed 78 5 80.7 AS) Thar fis 931 9.96 Pay 80 6 80.4 3.4 | 78.0 5.8 940 10.07 .O3 83 | 80.2 2.9 | 78.2 4.9 946 15 Ly 86 8 80.1 20 | «oo A.3 949 .20 A8 87 9 79.9 2.) | wows 3.9 949 .20 34, 88 10 80.0 1.9 | 78.7 3.2 961 .o0 .O9 91 jE 79.9 Lh) 2.9 961 30 0.99 91 All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. Meteorological Observations, Ixi Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of August 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &e. IEE =e 2 S te0 Prevailing & = 3 © S| direction of the "<, | General aspect of the Sky. ag 256 Wind. 2° a” bas a5 Inches tb } 126. 0} 0.34 |E. N. E. & EH. 0.50 |\ni nearly the whole day. Rain between 11 & Noon & be- tween 5 & 6 P. M. 2 0.43 |E.S. E. & E. 0.80 Overcast. Rain constantly. 3 0.67 |E. S. E. &S. by E. | 0.75 jOvercast. Rain at 2, 5, 7, 9, & 10 a. M. & from 1 to 3 Pp. mM. Thunder at 8 A. M. 4| ,.. | 1.56 |S.8. E.&S. by E.| 0.75 |Overcast. Rain from 4 a. m. to . 5 p. M. Thunder & Lightning at 4.4. M. Re reves 0.21 |W.N.W. & S. S. E.| 0.40 [Clear to2 4. m. Overcast to 10 A. M. Wi to 8 Pp. M. Overcast afterwards. Rain at 10 a. m. at2 & 3 p.m. Thunder at 2 & 3 p. M. Lightning at 9 P. m. ee)... 0.44 |N. N. E. 0.50 |Overeast to 11 a. M. \i to 8 P. mM. Overcast afterwards. Rain at8 & lla.m. & at 2,6 & 9 p. M. Lightning at midnight. -& -E.| 2.12 |Overcast. Rain constantly. i& 8. SoH: Overcast to 3 Pp. M. “i to 6 P. m., clear afterwards. Rain from midnight to 4 a. M. at 8a.mM. & at 3p. mM. 9|130.0 | 0.12 |S. S. E. & S. EK. Scatd. “i to5 p.m. clear af- terwards. Rain at 4,6 & 11 A. M. & between 4 & 5 P. M. 10/125.0/ ... |S.S.E.&S.E.&SSW. Clear to 7 a. M. Seatd. “ito 8 p. M. clear afterwards. Light rain at 5 Pp. M. S. S. W. & variable Clear to2 a.m. \Wito 7 P. M. & S. by E. clear afterwards. Light rain between Noon & 1 P. M. & at 6 Pp. M. 12 |124.0 | 0.25 |S. E. & E. Clear to 4.4. mM. Secuds from E to 11 aom. Seatd. “1 to! Sez M. clear afterwards. Rain at 7,11 & Noon. 13 [130.0 | 0.17 |S. 8. E. & E. by S. Scatd.\i & \_i to 6 a. m. clouds of different kinds afterwards. Rain at 9 & between 11 & Noon & between 10 & 11 P.M. 17S aie ct joeeds: by B, Overcast tolO a.m. Wi & “i to 6 p. m. clear afterwards. OST (on) Or (oa) A Dia hy 11 | 126.0 Slight rain at 3 & 4a. M. 1 15/131.0; 0.14 |S. S. E. & S. E. Clear to 3 a. m. \ni_ afterwards. Rain betweend&64mM &at2 Pm. Ixil — Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of August 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &e. Prevailing General aspect of the Sky. direction of the Wind. Max. Solar radiation. Max. Pres- sure of Wind Rain Guage 5 feet above Ground. ° = 5 oO =F iq?) wa ot Gt) TR 2, VASE Oe: ... {Overcast to 3 Pp. Mm. \Wi to 7 P. M.\i afterwards. Light rain at2& 94a. mM. & at lf Pp. mM. mS .. |S. S.W.&S. 8. E.| ... |Wi nearly the whole day. ro ae 1.36 |S.S. W. & S. W. wwii to3.4a. M..\t fo lO Ac we Overcast afterwards, Rain at ll a. m. 123 p.m. & from 5 to ll Pp. M. Overcast nearly the whole day. Lightning & Thunder at mid- night. Shght rain from mid- night to 2 a. M. & at 6 P. M. Overcast to4 Pp. mM. “i & Wi afterwards. Rain at2 &3 4. m. & at Noon. Overcast nearly the whole day. Rain from midnight to 2 & at 5 & from 7 to 9 a. Mm. ya ASSIS by JEL. i, Ss 5: EE. Scatd. ‘i to 8 a. M. Mi tol p.m. Overcast to 6 Pp. mM. Thin clouds afterwards. OE) A Sete, ... |S. S. W. & variable BOs \) 4h. 0.44 |W. & variable 21) ... | 0.63 |S. & S. by W. Instruments out of order 23 | 133.0) ... |S. 8S. E. & S. by E. \ni to 9 a. M. i afterwards. 24)... EK. &. HK. S. E. \Wi & Mi nearly the whole day. Light, rain at 3 P. M. 25.2. OU27E- N. Bo& B.S. B. i & \\i nearly the whole day. Rain at3 & 4P. M. 26 |) 2 4 (OOS. ae. 8. N. Ee. Scatd. clouds to 7 4. M. “i to Noon. Overcast at 5 P. M. Scatd. cloudsafterwards, Rain at 1 & 43 P. M. err x. 0.30 |K. & S. S. E. Seatd. clouds to ll a. m. Over- cast to 3 p.m. Thin clouds af- terwards, Rain at ll3 a. m. 4.22 aS 0.30 |S. HE. &S.8. E. Overcast to 6 a. M. Wi & Seuds from E to ll a.m.Thin clouds to 4 p. M. Scatd. ~i afterwards. Rain from 2 to5 a. M. at 10 4. mM, Noon 34 P. mu. & at 105P. ™. 76 er 3.14 |S. by W. & variable. Overcast to 1 Pp. m. ~i to 6 P. M. clear afterwards, rain from 3 tod a.m. at 8 a.m. & at 39P.M. 30|133.0| ... IS.&S.S. W. ito 7 p.M. clear afterwards. Light rain at Noon. .__ 31/ 134.6} ... |S.S.W.&S. by W. Clear to 2 4. ™. Seatd. “i to 6 p. m. clear afterwards. fe Mi Cirri, —i Strati,~i Cumuli,\—i Cirro-strati, ~ i Cumulo strati,~1 Nimbi, “i Cirro eumuli. ; Meteorological Observations. Ix Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of August 1866. Montuity ReEsvutts. Inches. Mean height of the Barometer for the month,... 1. 29.584 Max. height of the Barometer occurred at 10 a. M. on the 30th, ... 29.822 Min. height of the Barometer occurred at 4 P.M. onthe 7th, —... 29.332 Extreme range of the Barometer during the month, a ... 0.490 Mean of the daily Max. Pressures, _... pe at .. 29.642 Ditto ditto Min. ditto +s.) 29.519 Mean daily range of the Barometer during the ‘month, a») OA2S Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer for the month, Max. Temperature occurred at 5 p. M. on the 31st, Min. Temperature occurred at 5 a. M. on the 28th, Extreme range of the Temperature nit a the month, Mean of the daily Max. Temperature .. : Ditto —_ ditto Min. ditto, .... Mean daily range of the Temperature during the month,.. NTO HATO ee ee Ue oS) STO O BB Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer for the month, ... 80.2 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer, 2.7 Computed Mean Dew-point for the month, dine ROcek Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above computed n mean Dew- -point. . 4.6 Taekee. Mean Elastic force of Vapour for the month, ... wh ». 0.949 Troy grain. Mean Weight of Vapour for the month in} I1GHS Additional Weight of Vapour required for complete saturation, ... 1.61 Mean degree of humidity for the month, complete saturation being unity 0.86 Inches. Rained 27 days,—Max. fall of rain during 24 hours Se ee ORLA Total amount of rain during the month, wi LEAS Total amount of rain indicated by the Gauge attached to the anemo- meter during the month. 10.67 Prevailing direction of the Wind, a) 808, Eo EnSen. & S. by E. lxiv ays on yor General's Office, Caleutta, in the month of August1866 together with the number of d ae: ® q 3 — R= 3 EE oF cope) ce “4 © EE Aro Ss, 4 S85 Sy Cra owoHkHs rep sa S wn QP Sa St Ss So Sp 5, mad £5 & ebaag Sodgq Sse SA. on FE eB i. ens} Gs} sl oO a which at the same hour Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observ Tables shewing the number of days on wh Meteorological Observations. ‘UO Ue “M 4q°N ‘UO ULB "M'N'N ‘UO WIRY] ‘uO ULB “NT AQ "AA ‘UO ULB ner ‘HO Urey ‘Gg Aq MM "UO ULV M'S'M "UO UleYy 2 oe ae See ‘M'S'S Liisa! “M 4q ‘9 ‘UO UIBY — ec Ce ee OD SH GO SH HO SOD AN NAN AN = Le oe OO N to) in| SSS SS ee ee [1 | oa reat SSS St SN a ee ] Tal — Loe | QT OD NI OO I 1D OD 10 OD SHAD 20 10 et | ANNAN TOA wIdANAA =! lt ‘'§ ‘mo Urey] ae OAT RAHANN N = Ln le De ee OCD ee OCI oe i Are) | AMMAN TWIMNAN SS No NID AN AAO CO Re CO R16 4 ‘aA Aq ‘g ‘HO UIE = = No ew i ‘a 'S ‘8 "UO UR} a a LD UD 1D CO SH XH OD 20 0D 10 IN OD) SH SO SH CO SH SH GD 10 6 oa OD ro rt N “HS ‘UO UB “a Goat “uO uley ‘HO ULB “ "HO WIRY "nN AQ “q ‘UO UIeyy "as IN ak ‘uO WIRY "ol “NI ‘UO UII “NM “uo Uley “a Aq *N “TO Uley Fo Nl OANM DONA Lan = = OANMOR TR TNAN dl rd HN = i= foal ial il al I ral i) at ANNA TSA AA 4g moH| = A HANNMOANMAMONNMUWAANAN TG N Cee ee OO oe oe en OO) AND NATANWMONWOMMDHANMAATSH (a) il teal is! re NAN SNM AAAMAOOMAMAMNAMATAN SHO 10 re N aoe ANN OD taht — FASTA MANTANANANA TS mim” La Pal teal i! ili! i] = ei Meteorological Observations. lxv Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of September 1866. Latitude 22° 33’ 1” North. Longitude 88° 20’ 34” East. Height of the Cistern of the Standard Barometer above the sea level, 18.11 feet. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. Ce cs Ee DES a9 Date. | = 3 = ee a = Ss Inches. 5 29.669 2 .646 3 598 4 570 5 .612 6 .666 z .667 8 571 9 498 10 548 11 .626 12 615 13 .638 14 642 15 579 16 579 17 599 —=18 .643 19 .730 20 741 21 412 22 .763 23 .802 24 BY 25 729 26 hon 27 .767 28 152 29 51 30 .760 Range of the Barometer during the day. Max. Inches. 29.730 715 .669 .627 °683 .726 126 .652 559d .607 .687 .672 691 694, .618 .622 645 724 .786 197 .762 812 .855 834 176 182 842 811 .803 831 Min. Inches. 29.582 O76 517 494 .650 615 O84 473 A444 904 .569 534 .586 .o190 515 ll 23 .576 674 681 .645 vile 746 .698 .657 .652 .688 .676 .676 677 Diff. Inches. 0.148 139 152 133 133 dd 142 179 il 103 118 138 105 119 103 dai 122 148 2 116 117 099 109 136 119 130 154 135 127 154 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer. O 87.0 86.8 86.5 83.1 83.9 85.7 83.5 80.8 83.3 83.2 84.2 84.9 84.8 85.8 84.5 82.9 82.9 83.2 82.5 82.6 84.1 85.1 84.1 82.2 83.9 85.4: 86.2 86.5 86.5 Range of Tempera- ture during the day. Max. O 93.2 93.0 92.0 87.2 89.4 88.4. 90.2 89.0 82.8 87.3 87.0 90.1 91.8 88.0 91.6 92.8 86.2 86.3 89.0 87.6 87.5 89.8 90.8 89.0 84.0 90.0 91.2 91.4 93.2 93.6 Min. | Diff. | _ _ SUD SVU $0 F320. SEPP iPU Gist a ee SON kOOS c© < > * DOW ERODDANANWEROCORMNOSDBRHEALKLADMND eo arg) The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Thermometer Means are derived, from the hourly observations, made during the day. xvi Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, an the month of September 1866. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) ‘ : 3 oR = ri; GH my at pes Bo fae) Bo] ecculoopet if ila) a ga S) Ee = > s |S 3e ees - 2D) a > 2 an 2 = on , 8 = 2 e = 3S | Sables 2 5 E a = =e ie Sg | 22 op Date.) | SS ea os ze ae fo1| fe'3 2 | 2 | B | So) Sool Sat soa Fo 3 | 2. 64 | 83 | ES | ooee ee AS oy 7) Ss wey = 3 = 3 = as 3 & & ay a Pom & > oo ceo] eos = A}Oo] A a Sashes a | ) Oo Ce) ) Inches: | -T. gr. | T. or 1 82.9 4.1 | 80.4 6.6 1.014 10.79 2.50 0.81 2 82.7 4.1 | 80.2 6.6 008 13 48 81 3 82.5 4.0 | 80.1 6.4 O08 aL 9 82 4 89.6 2.5 | 78.8 4.3 0.964: 36 1.50 87 53) 80.5 2.8 | 78.5 4.8 955 25 68 86 6 81.4 2.5 | 79.6 4.3 989 .60 53 87 7 82.4 3.3 | 80.1 5.6 1.005 Wy as 2.09 84 8 80.6 2.9 | 78.6 4.9 0.958 .28 1.72 .86 9 79.3 fo} 782 2.6 946 ee 0.88 92 10 80.7 2.6 | 78.9 4.4 -967 39 1.54 .87 11 Fo 4.1 | 76.2 7.0 .887 9.52 2.37 .80 12 80.8 3.4 | 78.4 5.8 952 10.19 05 83 13 81.5 3.4 |} 79.1 5.8 973 AO .O9 83 14 82.1 2.7 | 80.2 4.6 1.008 AT 1.69 56 15 82.1 3.4 | 79.0 6.3 0.986 53 2.30 82 16 81.4 3.1 | 79.2 5.3 7G A5 1.90 .85 7. 81.0 I iW 3.2 .992 .66 13 .90 18 80.5 2.4) 78.8 4.1 964 06 43 88 19 80.7 2.9) 139 4.3 967 -o9 50 .87 20 80.2 2.3 | 78.6 3.9 958 30 od 89 21 79.4 3.2 | 772 5.4 .916 9.85 83 84 22 80.4 a Galen ee: 6.3 934, 10.01 2.20 82 23 31.5 3.6 | 79.0 6.1 970 o7 .20 83 24 peas 4.4 | 76.6 Lo 899 9.61 60 vis 25 79.4 2:3: Tie 4.8 922 91 1.63 86 26 79.3 4.6 | 76.1 7.8 885 48 2.65 78 27 80.8 4.6 | 77.6 7.8 928 91 dd 78 28 81.9 4.3 | 78.9 7.3 967 10.32 67 79 29 81.5 5.0 | 78.5 8.0 955 LS 92 78 30 81.8 4.7 | 79.0 7.5 970 3d fe 79 “All the H ygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Consfants. Meteorological Observations. Ixvii Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, am the month of September 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. 63 Range of the Barometer = .. | Range of the Tempera- ae for each hour during ea) 8 ture for each hour ae & the month. =~ during the month. o S Py Hour.) © = A : ses | Max. | Min. | Dif. | 2S | Max. | Min. | Dif. wo oe as = Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. oO oO re) o Mid- night.| 29.681 | 29.807 | 29.537 | 0.270 82.2 84.6 79.0 | 5.6 I .672 £805 O19 .286 82.0 84.2 79.2 5.0 2 .663 .800 .503 297 81.7 83.8 78.8 5.0 3 .655 91 488 .803 81.4 83.2 78.4 4.8 4 .648 781 .469 312 81.2 83.0 78.2 4.3 5 .656 .798 A464 334 81.1 82.8 78.0 4.8 6 671 811 479 .Bo2 81.0 83.0 78.2 | 4.8 7 .687 824, 499 3825 82.0 84.8 79.6 §.2 8 705 .846 O06 340 83.8 87.0 81.3 5.7 9 716 .851 O19 .332 85.3 88.2 81.8 6.4 10 718 .855 523 .332 86.3 90.2 82.2 8.0 11 .708 .846 O16 .330 87.2 91.0 82.2 8.8 Noon. .688 .836 502 Bo4 87.8 91.2 80.4 | 10.8 1 661 .808 A481 327 88.2 92.8 81.2 | 11.6 2 .633 782 461 321 88.1 92.8 80.0 | 12.8 3 611 .769 444 32d 88.2 93.6 80.7 | 12.9 4 .603 758 A448 310 87.7 93.0 81.4) 11.6 5 604 746 456 .290 86.8 92.6 80.2 | 12.4 6 622 .760 480 .280 85.2 $0.7 80.5 | 10.2 7 .642 174 A909 284 84.4 89.0 80.5 8.5 8 .666 .786 519 .267 83.6 88.4 80.4 8.0 9 .686 801 551 .250 83.0 85.8 80.0 5.8 10 .695 .812 555 257 82.7 85.6 jo0 6.0 11 .690 .809 .590 .209 82.4 85.0 79.2 5.8 The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Thermometer Means are derived from the observations mace at the several hours during the month. Ixviul Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of September 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) | Z : gi 5 = Ge > Sy = Se | = eo) wear) oe S aia |. | Be eae gins |) Ba | 2: | BS | SES THe e a © © S poe Sy ee eae = 5 5 5 = 238 |22e) oss Hour. S a = 3 S ais Bo 3 Boe Ses | Bo) a S| ae | Fe i@2 | s\ 2. | Ae | FS | Soares ag | A a | Pe as, | « SRS) oo so Ps = ae) Ss as Tw SR BOS | Sa) 8/8 | fi | ge | Ea | Ses] ges 7) ) Oo Inches... ‘Ter. ||) aie Mid- might.| 80.4 1.8 | 7084 3.1 0.973 10.47 1.07 0.91 1 80.2 1.8 | “7839 3.1 .967 Al .06 91 2 80.2 1) | Oe 2.6 973 AT 0.90 92 3 80.0 1.4 | 79.0 2.4 .970 46, 81 .93 A, 79.8 1.4] 78.8 2.4 .964 40 81 .93 9) 79.8 1.3 | 78.9 2.2 .967 43 74 93 6 79.8 A. | 2.920 2.0 .970 46 68 |: .94 7 80.4 £6 | 7933 2.7 73 53 94 92 8 81.0 2.8 | 790 4.8 .970 40 1.70 .86 9 81.5 3.8 | 78.8 6.5 974 .29 2.35 81 10 81.6 Ad (83 8.0 .949 12 .90 78 11 81.8 5.4 | 78.6 8.6 .958 ES) 3.18 76 Noon.| 82.0 5.8 | 78.5 9.3 955 .16 AA, 15 1 82.3 5.9 | 78.8 9.4, 964) .25 OL 15 2 81.9 6.2 | 78.2 9.9 .946 07 .65 43 3 82.2 6.0 | 78.6 9.6 .958 | 59 74 4 81.9 5.8 | 78.4 9.3 952 12 44, 75 5 81.4) 5.4 | 78.2 8.6 .946 OF 14 .76 6 81.2 4.0 | 78.4 6.8 952 whe 2.44 81 7 81.2 3.2 | 79.0 5.4 .970 40 1.94 85 8 80.9 24 | TOD 4.6 .970 40 .63 87 9 80.5 2.6 | £oxh 4.3 .961 oo 49 87 10 80.5 2.2 | 79.0 3.7 .970 42 .30 .89 11 80.5 TD es e2 3.2 076 .50 ture during the day. 3 oe Pe Date. ae) a Q ‘i z e2% | Max. | Min. | Diff. | £3 | Max. | Min. | Diff. | a) S H Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. ) fe) Oo ty) 1 | 29.759 | 29.808 | 29.689 | 0.119} 85.2 91.2 | 82.0] 9.2 2 795 857 745 112 84.3 92.2 81.4 , 10.8 3 853 915 #91 124 85.6 90.4 81.0 9.4 a 849 .913 785 128 84.0 90.6 80.0 | 10.6 5 815 864: 733 131 84.4 91.2 80.4 | 10.8 6 821 884 759 125 83.7 88.0 81.0 7.0 7 819 882 748 134 84.1 89.8 79.6. | 10:2 8 847 901 .780 121 82.7 87.4 79.4 8.0 9 841 .903 782 121 81.5 89.2 77.8 | 11.4 10 779 854 705 149 | 80.2 85.4 | 77.0 | 8.4 11 799 875 743 132 82.5 88.6 78.0 | 10.6 12 .876 .938 832 -106 83.1 89.8 78.0 | 10S 13 877 953 .808 146 84.1 89.9 (92 | 10.7 14 855 .923 fab 126 85.0 90.5 81.0 9.5 16 .839 902 773 129 84.4: 90.2 80.7 9.5 16 .869 928 816 112 81.9 88.4 78.8 9.6 17 905 951 857 094 83.2 90.0 78.0 | 12.0 18 936 -998 .880 118 82.4 88.0 77.4 | 10.6 19 .909 .981 841 140 82.6 88.8 77.0 | 11.8 20 -869 .965 ite 7 178 83.7 90.2 77.6 | 12.6 21 -820 875 751 124 81.5 85.6 ies 7.9 22 178 836 -706 -130 80.5 84.2 78.0 6.2 23 749 .810 .668 142 | 80.2 84.0: || > Fees Wek 24 .638 715 566 -149 75.9 77.5 74.0 3.5 25 .628 802 O14 .288 79.2 82.7 76.5 6.2 26 .850 915 178 137 75.8 79.4 71.9 7.5 27 924 .982 843 134 78.2 83.4) 73.6 9.8 28 .950 | 30.004 .900 104 78.9 86.0 73.6 | 12.4 29 922 | 29.994 879 116 79.6 85.6 74.0 | 11.6 30 .904 .966 .849 «LEG, 79.3 85.4 74.8 | 10.6 31 895 954 843 LLIN ~ FONG 84.6 | 75.4] 9.2 The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb orn amaa Means are derived, from the hourly observations, made during e day. Ixxiv Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of October 1866. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) ' : Sit =e GH ey os t apg ale ae 28 | 228s | ee Be ee hee | ee = e 1) each B e SS | Fas | ss fa ab) Be ye 2 £2 |B eS | one Date. Levee 3 ry s = ap © ee © hes 28 | Sect Et BS yudt S Sekt SS 4 ee ee |e) eo) ge) Be") BS) Somme as 24 a5 qe 4,3 |53a2 ea é | b> z bay E Ss é q | Se 8 i ait co i ee aa = a stale ) ) re) re) Inches: |'“T. gr.) D.. ge. 1.| 814 | 38) 787] 65 | 0.961 | 1026 | 2.36 | 0.81 2isi|° 80.7 | 1G | Fear Ca 946 13 15 83 iii SME | ete pee 19% 937 00 .76 78 4: | 80% || ome) 78m Bese) — 082 19 | 1.98 84, Si 80.6. |) sae 770i. 6s 937 02 | 2.25 81 6 | 80.7 | 30] 786] 6.1 958 23} 1.79 85 711 | Foe | cea) Fes 73 905 | 9.69 | 2.52 79 Ba |) Fo ee | F7a~ Be 919 88 | 1.84 84 9 | 785 | 80) 764): 6.1 893 62 69 85 1011) 7a | eee 76g “4a 885 55 33 88 446) Rute 4) eB: | Fe Aale. - lal 922 91 73 85 12 | 792 | 39|.765] 6.6 896 61 | 2.25 81 13)| 79.6 | 45/7641, 77 893 56 65 78 14: | 800: | sO} 765 4 Bz 896 BT .96 76 6 | 794 | 60! 759) | 86 879 40 91 76 | 16 | 37.9 | 40/ 751| 68 85 21 23 81 17 | 7.0 | 62| 72.7| 105 | .792 | 849 | 3.40 71 | 18. | | Sek |} pew | FkOde T14 751 07 54 70 | 19. |. Zee | pea | TBs a 763 20 48 70 | 20 | 77.6 | G&l| 733] 104 | .809 66 Al 2 21,| 78:2 | 83.) al, Be 879 | 9.46 | 1.85 84, | 2 | 7.6 | 29| 756) 49 871 39 59 86 23.| 72 | Ba) galt ba 857 25 63 85 24 | Fh | ee weeds By 806 | 8.77 | 0.80 92 25 | 75.8 | 34| 734) 68 Sil 76 | 1.80 83 266) 72:6 | Be) 7OAIn oe 736 02 52 84 27 | Fhe | AO Tie Baer) Mae DIO 28 80 28) Be | 62 Jade Bs 729 | 7.89 58 75 29 | 74.3 | 5.3| 70.6| 9.0 741 | 8.00 69 75 301 1744 140] 710) BS 751 ig AT 77 Bley 932° |---G:4r 68-7 | 109 607 | 7.52 | 3.17 19 = All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. Meteorological Observations. ixxv | Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of October 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. 63 Range of the Barometer | 5 .. oe for each hour during aS we a the month. 2 o = vn ADR Moh ee si Hour.| = Bs a) Z é ™ 3 | Max. Min. | Diff. & = Max. ad a Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. ° re) Mid- night.| 29.842 | 29.953 | 29.560 | 0.393 79.8 84.4 1 834 .949 534 -415 79.5 84.2 2 826 -946 522 424 79.2 83.8 3 819 .939 421 -408 78.9 84.0 4 817 -936 514 -422 78.7 83.8 5 830 -954 523 A431 78.5 83.6 6 846 .970 533 437 78.3 83.0 7 861 .987 562 425 79.1 83.8 8 881 | 30.001 -596 405 80.9 86.8 9 891 .004 627 377 82.7 87.8 10 895 .004 .648 .356 84.0 90.4 11 .880 | 29.998 645 303 85.1 91.0 Noon. -856 .965 631 304 85.6 91.2 Fe .825 .937 .621 316 86.3 91.4 2 800 .921 -606 315 86.8 92.2 3 785 911 577 334 86.4 91.2 4 787 .904 577 327 84.7 90.4 5 791 .913 573 340 84.2 90.4 6 804 .923 571 302 82.5 88.0 7 821 .935 .566 369 oe 86.6 8 842 .945 590 355 ped bee 86.0 9 856 954 597 307 80.6 85.3 10 862 .961 588 313 80.2 85.2 a 855 958 576 382 79.8 85.0 Range of the Tempera- ture for each hour during the month. Min. Diff. Se oe gd pet gg gg be wR © OG s The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Thermometer Means are derived from the observations made at the several hours during the month. Ixxvi Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of October 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) e 4 e S Se fy ae Beye | a] BS | ee | oa a e pen) ies Ss Se, | So:8 2 = Da eo No we os A Py = © o ) GH 45 om "Sy See ey z Bites |S lie 28 |EEE| ces How! vee 8 | me] Sou] Boor] Shee ge met Be |e | 2\'3, | Ba | eS | oes om) ac 3 as = O 2 om gree) q q ay A ds, ai Bag! €nq og P> = ae oS $4. |S eueee.2 ) Oo ty) Inches. |: Ti gr: | Tigre Mid- night.) 77.7 2.1/ 76.2 3.6 0.887 9.58 Ee bf 0.89 if 77.5 2.0 | 76.1 3.4 .885 57 i: eee .90 2 fs LD |) 76.0 3.2 .882 04 .O2 .90 3 i a 1.8 | 75.8 Bek .876 A8 0.99 91 4, 76.9 1.8 | 75.6 ae: 871 AZ .99 91 5 76.8 17.) ORG 2.9 871 AZ .93 91 6 76.7 1.6 | 75.6 2.7 871 AZ .86 92 f 77.0 2.1 | 75.5 3.6 868 38 1.15 89 8 77.2 3.7 | 74.6 6.3 843 .O9 2.01 82 9 77.9 4.8 | 74.5 8.2 840 .03 .69 77 10 78.2 5.8 > 74.1 9.9 830 8.89 3.28 73 11 78.4 GH le ark 11.4 819 76 81 70 Noon.| 78.4 F.2 | (RA | § 120 811 .66 4.10 68 1 78.5 4:8 | 73.0 13.3 801 .o3 49 66 2 78.5 8.3 | 73.5 Lo. 814 .67 oO 66 3 78.3 8.1 | 72.6 13.8 790 A2 64, 65 A, 77.6 ik | G26 12.4: 790 45 3.97 68 5 A ie | 6.5 | 73.1 Ptah 803 .60 .64 70 6 47.8 AT | 74.5 8.0 840 9.03 2.61 78 a 77.9 3.8 | 75.2 6.5 860 24 3 81 8 77.9 D2 | fone 5.4 873 Al 1.76 84 9 78.0 2.6 | 76.2 A.A, 887 m3) 43 87 10 77.8 ak | Gul: 4.1 885 333) 3] 88 at 17.5 2.3 | 75.9 3.9 879 AQ 26 88 All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. Meteorological Observations. Ixxvil - Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of October 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &c. — = > See tes nas 2 & ara ° Prevailing & = 3 a 16 4 a direction of the ‘s. | General aspect of the Sky. 3/83 |dud| Wind. or ALA [eas a8 o {Inches tb 1} 148.4 0.05 |S. by W. Scatd. %i to 2 p. m. Overcast to 6 p.m. Clear afterwards. Rain at Noon & 6p. mM. Thunder from 1 to5e. m. Lightning at 4 P. M. 2/148.0/] 0.45 |S. & variable Clear to 5 a. M. Seatd. “ito 6 p. M. Clear afterwards. Rain from 3 to 5 P. M. 3} 143.7| ... |W. by N. & variable Clear to 7 a. m. Scatd. “i to 5 p. M. Clear afterwards. - 4/| 127.2) 1.14 |W. by N.& S.8.E. Clear to 7 a. M. 71 & \Wi to 2 P. mM. Overcast afterwards. Rain from 4 to 6 P. M. §6| 154.2) ... |S.S.E. & S. W. Clear to 5 a. mM. Seatd. ~i to 7 p. mM. Clear afterwards. Grhay.t.: ... 1S. & variable. Clear to 5 a.M. Scatd. ~i to Noon. Wi & Wi afterwards. 7 440-2)" 4: 1S. & 8. S. E. Seatd. -~ito 6p. M. i after- wards. Light rain between Noon & 1 P. M. 8/1201} ... |S. & variable. Clear to 7 a. mM. Seatd. “i to 7 p. M. Clear afterwards. Light rain at 4 P. M. 9/ 126.2} 1.23 |K. by N. & E:S. E. Scatd. \_i to 3 a. mM. Scatd. \wi to 9 a. Mm. Seatd. 71 to 3 P.M. Overcast to 7 Pp. m. Clear af- terwards. Rain from 3 to 7 P. M. 10 | 115.2; 1.39 IN. N. E. & N. E. Clear to 5 a. mM. Overcast to 6 P.M. \~i afterwards. Rain between 3 & 4 P. M. 1) aes 3. SIND NN? Bee & EH. Overcast to 3 a. M. >i to 6 P. M. Clear afterwards. 12 | 144.0 arieictNis Bp Clear to 6 a. M. Scatd. ~1i to 6 p. M. Clear afterwards. fay 143.00). s IN: Bk N. N. W. Clear to 7 a. M. Seatd. 7~i to 4 . Pp. M. Seatd. —i afterwards. 14) 143.5); ... |W.N. W.& N. W. Scatd. “i to 5 p. m. Clear after- wards. 151,126.00; ... |S. He@e: S. B. Clouds of different kinds till 10 A.-M. Seatd. 1 ‘to 9p! Mm. Clear afterwards. xxvii Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, in the month of October 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &c. 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 Max. Solar radiation. i Oo bo 144.6 140.2 144.8 142.2 146.8 115.0 130.0 146.5 147.0 146.0 Rain Guage 1 — 5 az Ge =a ® wm ft. 2 in. above Ground Prevailing direction of the Wind. S. by E. & N. W. E. N. E. &S. by E. N.E.& N. by E. N. by E. & N.E. NE.&ENE.&NNE. S.&N.E.&S.S. E. N.NE.&SSE&ESE. N.N.E.& N. E. EK. N. E. W.S. W.&S. W. N.N.W.&N. W. N..N.. We N.N.W.& N. W. N.N. W. N.N. W. N.W.&N.byW.&N. ure of Wind. Max. Pres- Ss : General aspect of the Sky. Clear to 5 a. um. Scatd. \Wi to 9 A.M. “ito 3 Pp. M. Seatd. Wi afterwards. Clear nearly the whole day. Foggy from 9 to 11 P. m. Clear to 11 a. um. Wito 3 P.M. Clear to 8 p. M. Scatd. \_i af- terwards. Foggy at 11 Pp. m. Clear to 10 a. m. Seatd. “i to 4 p. m. Clear afterwards. Clear to 5 a. M. Wi & 7 after- wards. Overcast to 11 a. m. Seatd. “i to 6 p.m. Thin clouds after- wards. Thin clouds to 3 4. m. Overcast to10 a. m. Wi afterwards. Rain from 5 to 8 a. M. Overcast & \wi. Rain from 7 to 9a.m. & between3 & 4 P.M. Overcast. Low. scuds from E from Noon to 6 pv. mM. Rain nearly the whole day. ‘ni & “i Low scuds from S from 7 a. M. to2 p. M. Light rain at midnight, 4 & 5 a. M. & at 8 Pp. M. Clouds of different kinds to 6 p. M. Clear afterwards. Scatd. \i to Noon. Scatd. \wi to 5 p. m. Clear afterwards. Clear to 10 4. m. Seatd. \i to 7 p. m. Clear afterwards. Foggy at midnight. Clear to 9 a. m. Scatd. “i to 4 p. Mm. Clear afterwards. Clear to 7 a. m. Scatd. ~i to 4 Pp. M. \_i & \Wi afterwards. \Wi & “ito dp. M. Clear after- wards. Mi Cirri, — i Strati,>i Cumuli,—i Cirro-strati, ~i Cumulo strati,~i Nimbi, “i Cirro eumuli. Ls Y.-S PF Meteorological Observations. xxix Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of October 1866. MontTuHiy REsvutts. Inches. Mean height of the Barometer for the month.. . 29.838 Max. height of the Barometer occurred at 9 & 10 4. a. on the 28th... 30.004 Min. height of the Barometer occurred at 4a. M. on the 25th ... 29.514 Extreme range of the Barometer during the month mA! ... 0.490 Mean of the daily Max. Pressures ... = iis ... 29.905 Ditto ditto Min. ditto ah Bote Mean daily range of the Barometer during the month ... wy O32 oO Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer for the month 81.9 Max. Temperature occurred at 2 P.M. on the 2nd 92.2 Min. Temperature occurred at 6 a. m. on the 26th 71.9 Extreme range of the Temperature awe the month 20.3 Mean of the daily Max. Temperature .. 87.5 Ditto ditto Min. ditto, .. 77.8 Mean daily range of the Temperature during the month.. 9.7 Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer for the month ... Thr Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer 4.2 Computed Mean Dew-point for the month S 74.8 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above computed mean Dew- -point . hod elie Mean Elastic force of Vapour for the month ..., ie ». 0.849 Troy grain. Mean Weight of Vapour for the month sey i Gola Additional Weight of Vapour required for complete saturation ... 2.31 Mean degree of humidity for the month, complete saturation being unity 0.80 Inches. Rained 12 days,—Max. fall of rain during 24 hours ik eg! 2200 Total amount of rain during the month . 0.88 Total amount of rain indicated by the Gauge attached to the anemo- meter during the month __.. : 7.25 Prevailing direction of the Wind aa . NN.W.&N. E. Ixxx Montuty RESULTS. given hour any particular wind blew, ical Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, in the month of Oct. 1866. - when any particular wind was blowin Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorolog together with the number of days on o, it rained. which at the same hour, Tables shewing the number of days on which at a a 6 0) ULeyYy ‘M4q ‘NT ‘UO ULB "MM ' NN uO UlBy] “MN MA "UO ULB "Nr AQ* AA re Meteorological Observations. (=a) i=l 9S i OC ie Bee ae re ce fac) NA Laon =| CO OD “HOR OO OD ra rd oO 10 Oo mes ie aA 2 © 2 & Gy 42 oS os e 6 5 oS : =e = 28 | 52 wp Date. | ("ss ar = 3s 5 ‘So. |= eee ee e282 PS) Bs ey Se4) Sas eee Fe )2|2| és | #3 | BS | sse)so¢ dso = 5 as A 3 Sad qos S 4 aaa Oe Poy 5 5 oq | Ses] SOR = A Poa eS = a ie: = | ) ) ) ) Inches. | T. gr. | 1. ge 1 73.3 6.7 | 68.6 11.4 0.695 7.50 3.01 0.69 2 73.8 6.1 | 69.5 10.4 415 42 .06 42 3 76.4 5.3 | 72.7 9.0 792 8.52 2.85 15 4, 76.2 po) Tea 10.0 178 510) 3.15 WY 5 74.0 5.9 | 69.9 10.0 120 7.82 2.96 13 6 73.3 6.2 | 69.0 10.5 704 .o9 3.07 2k 7 72.2 6.7 | 67.5 11.4 .670 .26 21 .69 | 8 72.4 6.2.) 68.1 10.5 .684 08 .00 ve 4 9 71.8 6.5 | 67.2 Lint .664 19 .O9 70 10 68.1 8.6 | 62.1 14.6 O61 6.08 2 .62 11 67.8 7.9 | 62.3 13.4 .065 15 10) 65 12 69.6 7.0 | 64.7 11.9 611 64 13 .68 13 70.2 70-1" “Gaa8 11.9 623 76 19 .68 14 70.6 6.8 | 65.8 11.6 .634 87 14 .69 15 70.5 6.6 | 65.9 11.2 .636 .90 02 70 16 70.5 6.5 | 60.9 ied .636 .90 2.99 70 17 68.9 7.3 | 63.8 12.4 593 45 3.21 67 18 69.6 6.4 | 65.1 10.9 019 4 2.86 70 i 70.2 5.8 | 66.1 9.9 .640 .96 64 13 20 69.4 Gedo a nope: 10.4 .619 65) Hh 71 21 68.8 6.6 | 64.2 11.2 .601 4 .89 .69 22 67.1 7.0 | 62.2 11.9 063 14 .93 .68 23 66.2 6.9 | 60.7 12.4 .036 5.86 93 67 24 94.3 7.1) 58.6 12.8 499 7 .88 .66 25 64.8 6.5 | 59.6 yb reg .o16 66 .67 .68 26 63.4 7.0 | 57.8 12.6 486 34 76 .66 27 64.2 5.9 | 59.5 10.6 old .65 38 70 28 65.9 6.1 | 61.0 LLO 541 .93 57 70 29 65.7 6.1 | 60:8 11.0 537 .89 56 .70 30 65.4 6.3 | 60.4 11.3 .530 82 61 69 All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. | ae e 4 A. ee, = oe ee ae Meteorological Observations. | Ixxxili Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, un the month of November 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. 63 Range of the Barometer | Range of the Tempera- b= we for each hour during as ture for each hour 22 m= the month. sie during the month. Hour.| = a Gz N = 233 | Max. | Min. | Dif. | 38 | Max. | Min. | Dif. as a Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. ) ) 0 0) Mid- night.| 29.990 | 30.104 | 29.861 | 0.243 73.2 80.8 67.4 | 13.4 4A 984, .102 852 .250 72.6 80.2 66.6 | 13.6 2 977 .L00 845 .255 72.0 79.4 65.6 | 13.8 3 971 .100 833 .267 71.6 79.0 64.8 | 14.2 4, .969 105 .829 .276 71.0 78.0 64.0 | 14.0 5 .978 hl .850 .261 70.4 77.4 64.0 | 13.4 6 994, 122 872 .250 69.9 27.0 63.2 | 13.8 7 30.016 144 894 .250 70.3 77.4 62.0 | 15.4 8 .037 154 .902 .252 73.0 79.8 64.4 | 15.4 9 .052 163 a0 253 75.6 81.8 67.0 | 14.8 10 .050 157 915 242 78.7 85.2 69.9 | 15.3 11 .028 132 893 | .239 80.7 87.0 | 73.2 | 13.8 Noon. .002 105 .860 245 82.0 87.4 | 75.0 | 12.4 a 29.971 072 825 247 82.6 87.8 (RY i ae RS 2 949 049 801 248 83.1 87.4 77.4 | 10.0 3 .936 .037 .786 251 83.0 88.6 78.0 | 10.6 4 932 043 789 254 81.5 87.0 76.4 | 10.6 5 941 .059 798 .261 80.3 85.8 75.8 | 10.0 6 953 072 805 267 78.2 84.2 73.3 | 10.9 7 O71 .087 .840 247 - 76.8 83.0 71.6 | 11.4 8 .989 095 853 .242 75.9 82.3 69.6 | 12.7 9 30.001 112 866 | .246 75.1 81.6 69.4 | 12.2 10 .007 LT 867 244 74.3 81.2 68.6 | 12.6 11 .002 .L08 .868 240 73.6 80.8 68.2 | 12.6 The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Thermometer Means are derived from the observations made at the several hours during the month. Ixxxiv Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of November 1866. Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) = t J s | oe a ie = en) SSalae = = | 28 2 Se, | See fe eS | A > >So | "oes eee © © iS Se +2 1S eigen ete 2 S| eal be a = 8. | & ete Hour. " — A = de mee S = toa, a D 5 “= ro is Boo ‘3 '5 ao | 84 eS) S| 24 3. | Bs | eS | eee ad ra Ee —Q = anon AS 1B O'R 4 ) is) be = bd a & act |oa'e | ses | o 4 LA OD Cd SS 2) O ori | ) ) ry Ce) Inches. | T. gr. | T. gr Mid- | night. 69.1 4.1 | 65.8 7.4 | 0.634 6.94 1.88 0.79 i 68.6 4.0 | 65.4 7.2 626 .85 81 79 2 68.2 3.8 | 65.2 6.8 621 81 .69 80 3 67.7 39 | GAG 7.0 609 69. ay | 80 4 67.3 3:/ | G43 6.7 603 .63 .62 80 5 66.9 oo | Gaia 6.3 599 .o9 OL 81 6 66.6 3.3 | 64.0 5.9 597 a4 AL 82 7 66.8 3.5 | 64.0 6.3 597 57 ol 81 8 68.1 A.9 | 64.2 8.8 601 as ee 2.19 75 9 69.4) 6.2 + 65.1 10.5 619 TA, 4 va: 10 40.7 S20) oh ee. 13.6 619 70 otk 64, A 71.3 9.4 | 64.7 16.0 611 58 4.46 60 Noon. Tas 10.7 | 63.8 18.2 593 ay 5210 56 i: 71.0 41.6 | 62.9 19.7 .576 17 51 5d 2 71.0 12.1 | 62.5 20.6 568 08 73 al F 70.9 12.1 | 6214 20.6 567 06 76 51 4, 70.4 1k. |. G2 18.9 570 13 18 5A 5 70.7 9.6 | 64.0 16:3 597 4A, 4.47 59 6 71.2 7.0 | 66.3 17:9 644 .98 3.27 68 4 70.9 5.9 | 66.8 10.0 695 Felt 2.72 72 8 70.5 5.4 | 66.7 9.2 693 AEG) oo 74, 9 70.0 onl | Geax 87 646 04 30 75 10 69.7 4.6 | 66.5 7.8 648 O7 05 78 ll 69.3 4.3 | 66.3 io 644, .05 1.88 79 All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants, Meteorological Observations. lxxxv Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, im the month of November 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &c. Date. Max. Solar radiation. ol So oa) 145.0 145.0 147.0 141.0 145.5 145.0 146°0 148.0 143.0 138.0 140.0 140.0 142.8 147.0 149.0 138.0 148.0 144.4 148.0 145.5 141.4 Prevailing direction of the Wind. N. by W. & N. W. N.&N.E.&N. by W. Noa N= N.OW. ia... W.: N.&N.N.W.&N.W. a ae Sas ae NW&NbyE&EN.E. N. N. E. N. N. W.&N.by W. N.N.E.&N.NW. N.W. & NN. Max. Pres- — as q Mas S Cy ° i) PE) y 23 b General aspect of the Sky. 7 tea a... \_1 to leis oe & \Wi tod Pp. Mm., clear after- wards. Clear to 34. M. Witod Pp. mM., clear afterwards. Clear to 5 p. M. \Wito 10 4. m. \i & 71 to7 e. M., clear after- wards. Clear to.7 4.™M. \ai.to 6 P. mu. “j afterwards. Aito7 a. M. \Wito 3 Pp. M. Over- east afterwards, Thin Rain at 5,6& 1l p.m. Overcast to 6 a. M., \Wi to 2 P. m., clear afterwards, Slight Rain at 4 A. M. Clear to 9 a. M. Seatd. \Wi to 1 p. M., clear afterwards. Clear Clear to 7 a. M. Scatd. \i to 6 p. m., clear afterwards. Clear. Clear. \ni to 8 a. M. clear to 11] a. m. ni to 5 p. M. \Wi afterwards. Clear to 10 a. m. Scatd. \ni to 7 p.M., clear afterwards. Clear, slightly foggy at 10 p. M. Clear to 10 a. m. Scatd. ~i to 4p. mM. Seatd. \i afterwards. Clear to 4 a. M. Seattered \—i to .7 «A: wi Scatd. “1 & Nat afterwards. Clear to 9 a. M. Scatd. \_i to 6 Pp. mM. Seatd. \i afterwards. Slightly foggy at 7 & 8 P. M. Clear to 11 a. m. Scattered “i afterwards. Scatd. “1 & \i to2 Pp. M-, clear afterwards. Clear to 19 a. m. Sceatd. “i to3 P. M. Wi afterwards. Clear to 10 a. m Seatd.>i to 4 Pp. M., clear afterwards. Clear to Noon. Scatd. \1 after- wards. Slightly Foggy from 8 to ll Pp. M. Ixxxvi Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of November 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &c. Ces fee?) i Bal ies i age a &§ PS 5 Prevailing 2 iE ‘ ne is < =| direction of the gi General aspect of the Sky. oS |oo o 3e/| esa 18 i rr) ais 3 . O Wind. Ss 8 ; ao in n o |Inches tb 23 | 142.0; ... |N.N.E.& N.by W.| ... {Clouds of different kinds to 5 p. M., Clear afterwards, Fog- gy at ll Pp. M. 24)140.2) ... IN. Scatd. i to 9 a. M., \i after- wards. Foggy at 8 Pp. M. 26 | 137.0%) <... iN. byl Woes IN. WW. Clear to 10 a. m. Scatd. “i to 6 Pp. M., clear afterwards. 26 | 139.8:| .... [Ne WegeaN. NW. ~ |Clear to 11 a. m. Scatd. 71 to3 p. M., clear afterwards. | 27 | 1383.0) 6. )2 (NIN WE Chiefly clear. | 28/145.0) ... |N. by W.&N. byE. Clear toll a.m. Scatd.nito5 Pp. M., clear afterwards. 29|140.0/ ... |N. by E. & N. W. Clear. 30 | 142.0; ... |N.W.&N.by E. Clear. a” oe _ £ . i Cirri, —i Strati,>i Cumuli,—i Cirro-strati, ~i Cumulo strati,~i Nimbi, “i Cirro cumuli. : mali: ico Meteorological Observations. Ixxxvii Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, in the month of November 1866. Montuty REsvtts. Inches ‘Mean height of the Barometer for the month.. »». 29.988 Max. height of the Barometer occurred at 9 a. a. on the 17th ... 30.163 Min. height of the Barometer occurred at 3 Pp. M. on the 10th ... 29.786 * Extreme range of the Barometer during the month a ee O.e Mean of the daily Max. Pressures _... a ie ... 30.053 Ditto ditto Min. ditto wat s«. 29.930 Mean daily range of the Barometer during the month ... ww.” 0.128 ) Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer for the month __.., aes Ges Seem Max. Temperature occurred at 3p. M. on the 3rd bit 9 eee Min. Temperature occurred at 7 a. M. on the 27th nee «| 30200 Extreme range of the Temperature ese the month a fia” ol Mean of the daily Max. Temperature .. bis on és. Ditto ditto Min. ditto, = en oue Mean daily range of the bs osgnana during the month. ac’ (koe Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer for the month . 69.5 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer 6.6 Computed Mean Dew-point for the month 64.9 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above computed mean Dew- -point . 11.2 | iohes Mean Elastic force of Vapour for the month .., xs vw. 0.615 Troy grain. Mean Weight of Sa la for the month be Ode Additional Weight of Vapour required for complete saturation ... 2.93 Mean degree of es for the month, complete saturation being unity 0.70 Inches. Drizzled 2 days,—Max. fall of rain during 24 hours we Bi) ioe ANE Total amount of rain during the month bie er Na Total amount of rain indicated by the Gauge attached to the anemo- meter during the month __.. Ma Pu Nil Prevailing direction of the Wind a6 .. N.W.N.N. W.&QN.: Ixxxvill taken at the Surveyor General's Office,Calcutta, in the month of Nov. 1866. Montuuy RE&svUtrtTs. tOons cal Observat Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorologi wind was blowing, it rained. uv any particular wind blew, together with the number of days on h at a given hour Tables shewing the number of days on whic , when any particular which at the same hour "HO UB} Meteorological Observations. FMM OASHAOHA ANT MOR DSCSCMm WS — a "HO ULB “NC AQ "AA "uO ULB ‘UO WIRY EC } UO ULB yy | AAS AL mene) ULB Yy “M °S m0 C6) ULG ef “MS S$ ‘HO ULB Pa Aq 9) ‘WO Wey ~ “dO UiBsf ly Aq 9 KC “UO UTR as Cid HAM ATO OAO MM OM RMIDOOROOMNO ; * | HNMNMNMOMAMHNARONOMDNRAOR® fe eh ee | NANA A TRA RRR RRR RRR TNANNANANN S No.of day 1 |} Uo Wie }-ao wey uO ULeYy | Uv TiByy ‘a ‘NA f° UO WiexT Bee: Bs 1-1O Urey ra NON ace) Ulery ba Aq Ny } UO ULexT re “dno FT ; uo UBT “Ta teal ual ell i NANANTAN TAN Se ed AMA MMNAMAMArOHWMWANWMWAAN NN MH FD DW WODANMMNAMIOMMNAANAAAN TM OOO DrOMAMOSODArRAOMAAIAIAAAN es AN Fp Orono HNO Hin Ore OO Ord ae ae : Zi Meteorological Observations. Ixxx1x Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, e in the month of December 1866. Latitude 22° 33’ 1” North. Longitude 88° 20’ 34” East. Height of the Cistern of the Standard Barometer above the sea level, 18.11 feet. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. Cet 5 3 _ | Range of the Barometer = + |Range of the Tempera- a3+ during the day. om $s ture during the day. 3 Se EB (ie Date. | Ae, | | A BL | | s2° | Max. | Min. | Dif. | 3 | Max. | Min. | Diff Ss me | a | ie "| | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. ra) ra) o oO 1 30.023 | 30.072 | 29.962 0.110 717 82.0 64.0 | 18.0 2 O17 O88 935 153 71.8 80.6 64.6 , 16.0 a O14 .1L00 947 -153 69.8 80.6 61.4 | 192 4, O11 065 941 124 68.4 78.0 60.2 | 17.8 5 29.985 ‘O62 911 151 68.2 78.0 60.0 | 18.0 6 961 O44 904 140 67.0 76.6 60.6 | 16.0 7 30.006 .071 944, mys 65.9 77.0 57.6 | 19.4 8 oy 1 .159 | 30.000 159 65.8 76.0 57.0 | 19.0 9 O71 hol .029 102 65.4 76.0 56.8 | 19.2 10°: 104, Ea a 054, 119 67.1 76.4 89.0 | 17.4 Peel ~ 145830 -185 O85 -LO0O 67.9 78.0 60.0 | 18.0 12 413 .195 045 .150 67.0 76.8 59.0 | 17.8 i3 .025 .096 | 29.955 141 67.5 | 77.0 59.6 | 17.4 14 014 .078 959 .119 68.0 FH Pe 60.6 | 16.6 15 .065 122 | 30.022 . LOO 67.2 Cie ee 58.7 | 18.5 16 .136 .208 .087 121 67.9 I7 6 59.8 | 17.7 17 145 222 .O76 146 66.7 76.6 08.8 | 17.8 18 144 217 O88 129 68.0 77.2 61.0 | 16.2 19 ial .256 119 a rf 67.5 ye 8) 58.4 | 18.9 20 195 213 AZ1 2152 66.9 76.6 58.6 | 18.0 21 164 .226 108 118 67.1 76.0 58.8 | 17.2 22 164 .232 aEky 115 67.1 76.0 58:8. | 17.2 23 .158 201 .097 134 66.5 76.0 58/2 TAL7S 24, .170 .254 124, .130 66.0 FAS AS) 58.0 | 17.6 25 .163 .249 .O96 sLb3 65.3 74.2 57.4 | 16.8 26 .119 .186 050 136 65.4 75.8 56.6 | 19.2 27 .075 138 012 126 65.4 75.4 56.0 | 19.4 28 .O88 159 .035 124, 65.1 75 A 56.4 | 19.0 29 .023 113 | 29.952 .161 64.8 75.8 56.8 | 19.0 30 29.960 .033 .890 143 65.4 77 A 55.6 | 21.8 31 979 .049 934 is) aS: 67.1 77.0 58.0 | 19.0 The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb shernoneren Means are derived, from the hourly observations, made during e day. xc Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, an the month of December 1866. Daily Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) fon Bu ; 43 E 6 Beat.) Same gt Bob loR |B | 8 aligesaletges Se = Ee E g Se | Sge a= = S E 5 - 6S | Saat oer > om ea 3 S 3 a es Se es ae Bake. NE sn NARS fo) a 8 = "ep © Ro | fs's ee | 9 eS [Su thes (os Sees sel adt2| en | Be | eC \eae qj ; S = 1g; $3 |p| — | pe | 8F | 84 | Ses] sek = ents eh yen) bet = = a | = oy) ) Co) Co) Inches. |. 'T. gr.) 3s A 65.6 6.1 | 60.7 11.0 | 0.536 5.87 2.56 0.70 2 64.4 7.4 | 58.5 i3:3 498 45 3.00 .65 3 63.2 6.6 | 57.9 i? .488 .36 2.59 67 4 60.6 7.8 | 54.4 14.0 A434, 4.78 84 63 5 61.6 6.6 | 56.3 11.9 462 | 5.10 .48 .67 6 59.8 7.2 | 54.0 13.0 428 | 4.73 57 .65 Z |. 69.3 6.6 | 54.0 i BS) 428 74 32 .67 8 | 68.8 7.0 | 53.2 12.6 416 .62 42 .66 9 59.4 6.0 | 54.6 10.8 437 85 10 70 10 61.3 5.8 | 56.7 10.4 469 5.18 14 AE - a1 62.7 5.2 | 58.5 9.4 498 00 .O1 73 12 61.9 5. | 3h.8 9.2 486 .38 1-92 74 is 61.5 6.0 | 56.7 10.8 469 Ay 2.25 .70 14 61.5 6.5 | 56.3 in ay 462 10 43 .68 15 61.0 6.2 | 56.0 11.2 458 .O7 .28 .69 16 61.6 6.3 | 56.6 11.3 467 16 9) .69 17 60.7 6.0 | 55.9 10.8 456 05 18 70 18 61.5 6.5 | 56.3 i We 462 .10 43 .68 19 60.9 6.6 | 55.6 is i) 452 .00 42 .67 20 60.1 6.8 | 54.7 12.2 438 4.85 43 .67 21 60.6 6.5 | 55.4 les 449 .96 .36. .68 22 60.8 6.3 | 55.8 11.3 455 5:04. P28 69 23 59.9 6.6 | 54.6 11.9 437 4.84, .00 67 24, 58.9 vipa es 12.8 416 .62 46 .65 25 58.3 70 | p24 12.6 409 55 38 66 | 26 58.1 13 |. d2.0 13.1, 404 49 46 68: 27 58.9 6.5 | 53.7 iW 423 70 .25 .68 28 59.3 5.8 | 54.7 10.4 438 .87 .O2 71 29 59.6 5.2 | 55.4 9.4 449 99 1.84 73 30 59.9 5.5 | 55.5 99 450 5.00 95 [2 31 61.6 5.5 | 57.2 9.9 476 .26 2.06 Jie “All the H ygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. Meteorological Observations. XC1 Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, im the month of December 1866, Hourly Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon. Sa Range of the Barometer =. | Range of the Tempera- £6 . for each hour during ms ture for each hour Ce a the month. = during the month. vo . Hour.| © a = 2 | ef | Max. | Min. | Diff. | $3 | Max. | Min. | Diff As ae | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. | Inches. ) ) oO ) Mid- night.| 30.082 | 30.205 | 29.958 | 0.247 63.2 68.6 58.6 | 10.0 %) 076 195 952 .243 62.6 68.4 58.4 | 10.0 2 .069 188 946 .242 61.9 68.0 58.2 9.8 3 .063 186 943 243 61.2 67.4 58.0 9.4 4 .060 .182 .940 242 60.6 67.0 57 A 9.6 5 070 196 949 247 60.0 66.3 56.7 9.6 6 O85 212 .968 244 59.2 65.0 56.4 8.6 5 103 231 .982 249 59.0 64.6 55.6 9.0 8 126 .253 993 .260 62.2 66.5 57.6 8.9 9 148 .266 | 30.033 233 65.9 69.8 62.6 7.2 10 .150 .273 O31 | .242 69.6 73.2 | 65.0| 8.2 11 131 209 008 251 12.6 76.4 69.2 fr Noon. 097 231 | 29.973 .258 74.7 79.0 ZL0 8.0 1 O64 -186-) -~..930'| >, .256 75.8 80.0 | 73.2 | 6.8 2 .040 157 908 .249 76.8 81.2 74.2 7.0 3 .026 135 891 244, 76.8 82.0 74.1 ie) 4 021 124 .890 234 75.2 80.2 F290 7.3 5 .030 129 904 225 73.3 71.6 71.3 6.3 6 044 142 .914 .228 70.3 74.7 68.5 6.2 7 .960 162 932 .230 68.3 73.0 66.0 70) 8 .076 174 949 .225 66.9 72.0 64.2 7.8 9 UGE 194 .967 227 65.8 70.7 62.6 8.1 10 101 .221 -969 .252 64.9 69.8 59.9 9:9 11 .093 .212 961 201 64.1 692° 4739.0 | 10.2 The Mean Height of the Barometer, as likewise the Dry and Wet Bulb Thermometer Means are derived from the observations made at the several hours during the month. ; x¢cll Meteoiologicul Observations, ddbstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations tuken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, an the mouth of December 1866. Hour) y Means, &c. of the Observations and of the Hygrometrical elements dependent thereon.—(Continued.) r | ‘ > ei | SS eee Stl antag | | We eae Rd | S&¢| 8s et a a $ >s | Sos fins . rs SS = = os oO Taw CO Se aa S S 3 2 $2 E =e 625 Hour.) = 3 B 3 6 ae Gok) ea Se | oa | 8 | 2 ae... | os | "a. Simoes Fe |} 2 tle | Bao) Be) BS See es ge) + 8 48 fie lee | Siege st | & | & | &e | ge | gs | Ses ous o oO 0 ° Inches. | T. gr. | T. gr | Mid- | night.| 59.6 3.6| 56.4] 68 | 0464 | 5.17 1.32 | 0.80 l 59.1 3.5 | 55.9 6.7 ASG 09 28 80 2 58.6 | 3.3 | 55.6 6.3 452 06 17 81 3 58.1 3.1 | 55.3 5.9 4A7 Ol 09 82 A 57.6 3.0 | 54.9 5.7 AAL 4.94, O04 83 5 | 57.1 9.9 | 545 5.5 435 88 | 0.99 83 6 56.7 951 54.4} 4.8 434, 87 86 85 7 56.4 | 2.6 | 54.1 4.9 429 83 86 85 -8 57.9 4.3 | 54.0 8.2 AS? 78 1.51 76 9 59.9 6.0 | 58.1] 10.8 Add} | 98 2.13 70 10} — @iee 7.9| 5A] 142 449 94 96 63 rh 62.8 9.8 | 55.0| 17.6 AAQ 84 | 3.82 56 Noon.| 63.3 | 11.4] 55.3 | 19.4 AAT gg | 4.35 53 1 63.4 | 19.4 | 54.7] 21.1 438 76 78 50 2 63.8 | 13.0 | 54.71 229.1 438 5 5.08 48 3 63. 13.1] 545] 29.3 A35 72, 11 48 4 | 63.2 | 19.0} 648 | 20.4 AAO 78 | 4.59 51 5 63.8 95 | 56.2 17.1 A61 5.03 3.81 57 6 63.6 6.71 58.2 | 121 A93 42 | 2.66 67 ‘ 62.9 5.4] 58.6 9.7 A99 51 09 73 8 62.1 4.8 | 58.3 8.6 AOA AG 1.82 75 9 61.6 4.2 | 58.2 7.6 A493 AG 58 78 10 '| ‘61.0 |°-3.0)) G70 7.0 488 Al 44, 79 11 60.3 3.8 | 56.9 ce. 472 25 42 79 All the Hygrometrical elements are computed by the Greenwich Constants. Meteorological Observations. x¢elll Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of December 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &e. —— € |S5. ae So 6 | are Prevailing FS < - S & e A direction of the Pur | General aspect of the Sky. — a o [_ & Wind. a 2 tae | a. Ss 4 a=fee a o |Inches tb eee... IN. by W.aN.N.W. Clear to 4 Pp. m. Scatd. \Wi to 8 p. M., clear afterwards. 2 | 141.2 N. & N. by W Clear to 7 a. M. \i & Uitos p. M., clear afterwards. 3 | 143.4 N.& N. by E Clear to 11 a. M.\_ito3 P.M., clear afterwards. 4 | 138.4 W.N.W.&N.N.W Clear. Slightly foggy at 9 & 10 Pp. M. 5 | 138.0 W. by N. & N. W. Clear. 6 | 138.8 W.& W.N. W. Clear 7 | 139.0 N.W.&N.N. W. Clear. Foggy from 7 to 11 Pp. m. 8 | 138-0 N.N.E.&N.N.W. Clear. 9 | 135.0 vs: YY Clear 10 | 134.2 N.W.& W.&N. Clear. 11 | 136.0 IN. & NN: W. Clear. Slightly foggy at 7 p. m. 12 | 138.0 Ns aN. OW. Clear. Slightly foggy at 10 & LPR. Bi 13 | 137.0 W.N.W.&W.S.W Clear. Foggy at6&7a4.m. & from 7 to 1l Pp. M. 14, | 140.0 W.S. W.& variable. Clear. 15 | 131.2 N. by E.& W. by N. Clear. Slightly foggy from 7 0 10 P. ot. 16 | 138.0 N. & variable. Chiefly clear. Foggy from 7 t« Io's. M. 17 | 135.5 N.by E& N. W Clear. Foggy at 64. m. & fron 7 toll P.M. 18 | 134.0 N. & N.N.E Clear to 54. mM. \i tol Pp. M. clear afterwards. Foggy fron Midnight to 44. m.& at 9 & 10 P. M. 19 | 189.0 N. by W. &N. Clear. 20 | 136.0 N. by W.&N.N. W. Clear. 21 | 133.0 NN. W..aN W. Clear. 22 | 135.0 N.byW.&N&NNW Clear to 9 a. m. Seatd. \i to € Pp. M., clear afterwards. 23 | 136.0 N. by W. Clear to 6 a. m. Scatd. \i to ( p.M., clear afterwards. Fogg at 8 & 9 Pp. M. 24 | 136.8 N. W. Clear. 25 | 133.0 N.N.W.&N.by W Clear. 26 | 137.6 N. Clear. 27 | 136.0 N. by W. Clear. Slightly foggy from 8 t TPs. 28 | 135.2 N. by W.&N.N.W Clear. Foggy from Midnight t & N. W. 2a.M. & from 7 toll P.M. xeiv Meteorological Observations. Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General’s Office, Calcutta, in the month of December 1866. Solar Radiation, Weather, &e. rote aoa -- | 3 a 8 wd Prevailing | © é sane = £| direction of the | “© | General aspect of the Sky. Mo cle ee KO es | Ss Load Wind. a) 4 Snr. beef o |Inches tb | 29/133.0) ... |N.W.&N.N.W.&N.| ... |Clear. Foggy from Midnight to 4 a.m. & from’8 to 11 P. m. 30 | 138.2) ... |W.N.W.&SSW.&S. Clear. Slightly foggy from Mid- night to6a.m.&at8&9p.m. 31 | 138.0° S. Chiefly clear. ma Cirri, —1i Strati,~i Cumuli,\—i Cirro-strati, ~i Cumulo strati,~i Nimbi, “i Cirro cumuli. ; Meteorological Observati Ons. xev Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorological Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, in the month of December 1866. Monrsuyuy ReEsutrs. Inches. Mean height of the Barometer for the month.. iv. SOLES Max. height of the Barometer occurred at 10 a.m. on the 20th .. 80.273 Min. height of the Barometer occurred at 4p. M. on the 30th —... 29.890 Extreme range of the Barometer during the month ns ., Oe Mean of the daily Max. Pressures... oy re i. BOnkou ~ Ditto ditto Min. ditto : m i. SOMITE Mean daily range of the Barometer during the month ... 3, Ooi oy) Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer for the month Max. Temperature occurred at 3 p. M. on the Ist Min. Temperature occurred at 7 4. M. on the 80th Extreme range of the Temperature auntie the month Mean of the daily Max. Temperature .. Ditto ditto Min. ditto, Mean daily range of the Temperature during the month.. mH orb or MD QO CONT OD OVW sy POoOoOkRaAOe Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer for the month... 60.7 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above Mean Wet Bulb Thermometer 6.4 Computed Mean Dew-point for the month , 55.6 Mean Dry Bulb Thermometer above computed n mean Dew-point .. 11.5 nolo Mean Elastic force of Vapour for the month ... os .. 0.452 Troy grain. Mean Weight of Vapour os the month an 6083 Additional Weight of Vapour required for complete saturation ... 2.32 Mean degree of humidity for the month, complete saturation being unity 0.68 Inches. Rained No. days,—Max. fall of rain during 24 hours... rh) or Nol Total amount of rain during the month ws Nil Total amount of rain indicated by the Gauge attached to the anemo- meter during the month __. Nil Prevailing direction of the Wind.. . N.&N.N.W.&N. W. xevl al Observations taken at the Surveyor General's Office, Calcutta, in the month of Dec. 1866. (1G Abstract of the Results of the Hourly Meteorolog MontHiy RESULTS. articular wind blew, together with the number of days on lar wind was blowing, it rained. which at the same hour, when any particu Tables shewing the number of days on which at a given hour any p Meteorological Observations. ‘UO ULB "UO ULB “MN UN UO TRI MUN ‘WO UIRyY “MONT M 1D Od BC SO B= DH DH =H 10 © Aaa OD OD OD OD OD SH Od Be OD OO HOD HOD SO SO SH ee DN 2G SH OH OOD SO FD 19 109 O HANA OM OD 10 SH I OH 19 DH DO OD D210 aSsoqantnn es ‘uo UlBYy “NAG AA "WO UIRY “MM SS _ | _ 1 ANNTRAANAA ‘UO Uley ‘9 Aq “MA "UO WIRY MS" M “uo ULB YT “MS 10 ULe a | Vel Sea) li on ah CD 6 69 OD OD MO OD GD SD St Ssesqena Aaa eS rt "M'S'S ‘UO UIRYy MASS uo UleYy iS “UO ULb EY ‘a Aq 's "UO ULV LF re co el ar Sm RR RNNANSN ‘W'S 8 “HO WIRY “Ss ‘UO UIeY eh mo ULE “UO ULRT ‘UO Uiey iioct GN ‘wo Urey “a ON UN “HO ULC No.of days NX imal eal ial AANTMANANS ANNA TO “a Aq “NT “UO ULBY ATT “INO FP, N NAN OD OD OD rH HGS Hid 6 f= OC OD Mid night ) ia! il 10 ADE (mal fami le! Lea ora et ann ANH AIBA OoOrM ODO ae t t ‘ oa ‘ tat | ee oe ees . em sae Soe Fwy Pek ie de be dk be oe Bree Dae Sees e~geerne ~ - te we hp = Ob HEME ry em @o8~4-8-"*-8 dele be bead hel ' : : . . 7 Ps i aty ey tO ~~ bmw ’ : . é - 6 prere er ree te nr ty Sr rt bee | - ~ b= 5m e -mEe o- 6 > -8 7 8- gen bmw ne Seta esha eres e- " r i te Serer ira Pre 4;ere (2. Shye i ity = P Seok bt ke ete eras o-4-+~ / e 2 = res yo a” 8 Foran k SE ~ Oe +1. S42) sho yee ee egereses eee sa Sette ~ “ 48 Sy eee aa oss ts ee 6-s e845 - a eh OO 88 tO HE -t~ ee k~ se~ Ve Sete we z 2 yrreererirr yr rte fe et bibl a oe 2 eer te ee eee oa = af enh rane - \-e- - < - fn - hoe 8 She 958 te ee re we ee ee Bed " ae ares B-5es— eee reer =e+6-6 =i OREM = ey . * rf - a Gt 18 wy hee B® be ete ee rrr ers { . - aoe ha c . a A= 9-4 i 4-0-4 — hh 2 ee NS epee Perey = wo - | - - , , eee - oe -* Lod ss - nd . “ ‘ ‘ - Pe Bane ee bed or ate t : . * ; ‘ , — ‘ arsé + 4~— 4S Hen be RekER Ow ern oO 8 eee : . " . 7 => ee tn ne eae a f << SR eee = B50 shh Rd ry ORM h SPOHS ECHR 6 KR omy =F oF peer eet ee bee ere ee bad 4 =P. a> 6-2) 270-2- es > ae Lh Sear eerie he ee Hate UH BR eta Gee: HS Kr EF ot ons 6 ye hem Shah 4 eareet= bs _ pt i aie Sat hy he ~ Hy ae 6.8 ' . ‘ +o & ao oK8 et ee > 9282 Seg rh ohoee ees * dtd ~ nr rte ht he re mre er e-F-es Ot a dehed CT seem 4-0-6 @~ a= Gn b~a- eee wan ee HF Om 2 Te rt . b*o = @ ~eob— e+ £ ob~ oe eer - Peer rr tr Pe ere yneee. , =e Rea O~4 Oo ~ Tr ee etns [nd op aeRO bone Ch aco he pohemag ~ ere ppeereae- or aes -em ed ae pa ne ee mere iy: <4 Nye eB ons eer ee teresa cusnowne + rye eek ew: rrr err et hr ne ek ed Sip lucetes Se enerete * eoh* 27 Bab ‘ , o-8 ona stateeres tee, ther cana Le tien we hae 4 O=e-are FADE HH HOO 8 Gos - Herm ase: ateresbSscatest eats Sena i PR ererr tier tt er eta te ed rl ech~2= $e he eR SO ~ &—k- Hw - oo =e © .* east rs => mtn we Pe Pn PELE RIP Es ee Te Ot | bial Sate Amar hs OH O-man ee” e+" = " 2 ahr 2h tbs b= lee bw othe bh eh OO eae fo A OO Rae HT US @- ee~ Bois =i 3-9 - a- He ag eeeare- a ae PAPER prt ti Aes eee ie Oe ore art pane rer pd 0 ore Em - oe mi 4 Perera ter =b= tab = ene me fe yt Hk ee owe nk BAS ae ee sees at oyna 2 une 8 Suef ae bk ite hed er ir. he eee ‘ toto per et ae = 8 ~ 9-8 om ee sress 6518! wt Ste 46 mee 6 e5e- <=a-8 anes’ “OR t= oP PY FEIT BETS ee ee ee eee es ~My Be ae & reer prem = 6 ate= ‘ hay Oa dee mrt 2 ; per pere te a Perr er te hak "epee % re toe ee et et Sh ieee o— oe a4 Ye eee ee a~mee “ Pere ocere «~~ ete aa o-9*e - a= oy & 4% a keee wee PEt pel pe 218 8 oe 2-6 OF ae y : 1<9—e- Tae f= *- e-aee a beta pee paired = Seen = oN 5 a @ ace ~ @rere SEDER ey Ore ARS PA- BE Gonm—d-@ any een $ ~4+ 8-6 Re ~~ ee da Wolpe dendgrty enh RE CRSeC iP mE eH Oe= Se eee Pw) eee hee + —h- o— — e- w . bf “< ee ee aed thd SG Geeta soy sh ea™ teh Oy ya To saaleate = was ebrg—y ~e- 26-2 sata —a> per re Bs te he S29- GSE as so tem is ae le ~ 8S th 0 Oe Sars ane ores =~ SG Goad SO reer e~ i riety poy ee bi >t) bee} hel tt e had hehe rs rt htrh. on poe ° 4